doc: Expand sane-service-type documentation.
[jackhill/guix/guix.git] / doc / guix.texi
1 \input texinfo
2 @c -*-texinfo-*-
3
4 @c %**start of header
5 @setfilename guix.info
6 @documentencoding UTF-8
7 @settitle GNU Guix Reference Manual
8 @c %**end of header
9
10 @include version.texi
11
12 @c Identifier of the OpenPGP key used to sign tarballs and such.
13 @set OPENPGP-SIGNING-KEY-ID 3CE464558A84FDC69DB40CFB090B11993D9AEBB5
14 @set OPENPGP-SIGNING-KEY-URL https://sv.gnu.org/people/viewgpg.php?user_id=15145
15
16 @c Base URL for downloads.
17 @set BASE-URL https://ftp.gnu.org/gnu/guix
18
19 @c The official substitute server used by default.
20 @set SUBSTITUTE-SERVER ci.guix.gnu.org
21 @set SUBSTITUTE-URL https://@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}
22
23 @copying
24 Copyright @copyright{} 2012, 2013, 2014, 2015, 2016, 2017, 2018, 2019, 2020, 2021 Ludovic Courtès@*
25 Copyright @copyright{} 2013, 2014, 2016 Andreas Enge@*
26 Copyright @copyright{} 2013 Nikita Karetnikov@*
27 Copyright @copyright{} 2014, 2015, 2016 Alex Kost@*
28 Copyright @copyright{} 2015, 2016 Mathieu Lirzin@*
29 Copyright @copyright{} 2014 Pierre-Antoine Rault@*
30 Copyright @copyright{} 2015 Taylan Ulrich Bayırlı/Kammer@*
31 Copyright @copyright{} 2015, 2016, 2017, 2019, 2020, 2021 Leo Famulari@*
32 Copyright @copyright{} 2015, 2016, 2017, 2018, 2019, 2020 Ricardo Wurmus@*
33 Copyright @copyright{} 2016 Ben Woodcroft@*
34 Copyright @copyright{} 2016, 2017, 2018 Chris Marusich@*
35 Copyright @copyright{} 2016, 2017, 2018, 2019, 2020 Efraim Flashner@*
36 Copyright @copyright{} 2016 John Darrington@*
37 Copyright @copyright{} 2016, 2017 Nikita Gillmann@*
38 Copyright @copyright{} 2016, 2017, 2018, 2019, 2020 Jan Nieuwenhuizen@*
39 Copyright @copyright{} 2016, 2017, 2018, 2019, 2020 Julien Lepiller@*
40 Copyright @copyright{} 2016 Alex ter Weele@*
41 Copyright @copyright{} 2016, 2017, 2018, 2019 Christopher Baines@*
42 Copyright @copyright{} 2017, 2018, 2019 Clément Lassieur@*
43 Copyright @copyright{} 2017, 2018, 2020, 2021 Mathieu Othacehe@*
44 Copyright @copyright{} 2017 Federico Beffa@*
45 Copyright @copyright{} 2017, 2018 Carlo Zancanaro@*
46 Copyright @copyright{} 2017 Thomas Danckaert@*
47 Copyright @copyright{} 2017 humanitiesNerd@*
48 Copyright @copyright{} 2017, 2021 Christopher Lemmer Webber@*
49 Copyright @copyright{} 2017, 2018, 2019, 2020 Marius Bakke@*
50 Copyright @copyright{} 2017, 2019, 2020 Hartmut Goebel@*
51 Copyright @copyright{} 2017, 2019, 2020, 2021 Maxim Cournoyer@*
52 Copyright @copyright{} 2017, 2018, 2019, 2020 Tobias Geerinckx-Rice@*
53 Copyright @copyright{} 2017 George Clemmer@*
54 Copyright @copyright{} 2017 Andy Wingo@*
55 Copyright @copyright{} 2017, 2018, 2019, 2020 Arun Isaac@*
56 Copyright @copyright{} 2017 nee@*
57 Copyright @copyright{} 2018 Rutger Helling@*
58 Copyright @copyright{} 2018, 2021 Oleg Pykhalov@*
59 Copyright @copyright{} 2018 Mike Gerwitz@*
60 Copyright @copyright{} 2018 Pierre-Antoine Rouby@*
61 Copyright @copyright{} 2018, 2019 Gábor Boskovits@*
62 Copyright @copyright{} 2018, 2019, 2020 Florian Pelz@*
63 Copyright @copyright{} 2018 Laura Lazzati@*
64 Copyright @copyright{} 2018 Alex Vong@*
65 Copyright @copyright{} 2019 Josh Holland@*
66 Copyright @copyright{} 2019, 2020 Diego Nicola Barbato@*
67 Copyright @copyright{} 2019 Ivan Petkov@*
68 Copyright @copyright{} 2019 Jakob L. Kreuze@*
69 Copyright @copyright{} 2019 Kyle Andrews@*
70 Copyright @copyright{} 2019 Alex Griffin@*
71 Copyright @copyright{} 2019, 2020 Guillaume Le Vaillant@*
72 Copyright @copyright{} 2020 Leo Prikler@*
73 Copyright @copyright{} 2019, 2020 Simon Tournier@*
74 Copyright @copyright{} 2020 Wiktor Żelazny@*
75 Copyright @copyright{} 2020 Damien Cassou@*
76 Copyright @copyright{} 2020 Jakub Kądziołka@*
77 Copyright @copyright{} 2020 Jack Hill@*
78 Copyright @copyright{} 2020 Naga Malleswari@*
79 Copyright @copyright{} 2020 Brice Waegeneire@*
80 Copyright @copyright{} 2020 R Veera Kumar@*
81 Copyright @copyright{} 2020 Pierre Langlois@*
82 Copyright @copyright{} 2020 pinoaffe@*
83 Copyright @copyright{} 2020 André Batista@*
84 Copyright @copyright{} 2020, 2021 Alexandru-Sergiu Marton@*
85 Copyright @copyright{} 2020 raingloom@*
86 Copyright @copyright{} 2020 Daniel Brooks@*
87 Copyright @copyright{} 2020 John Soo@*
88 Copyright @copyright{} 2020 Jonathan Brielmaier@*
89
90 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
91 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3 or
92 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with no
93 Invariant Sections, no Front-Cover Texts, and no Back-Cover Texts. A
94 copy of the license is included in the section entitled ``GNU Free
95 Documentation License''.
96 @end copying
97
98 @dircategory System administration
99 @direntry
100 * Guix: (guix). Manage installed software and system configuration.
101 * guix package: (guix)Invoking guix package. Installing, removing, and upgrading packages.
102 * guix gc: (guix)Invoking guix gc. Reclaiming unused disk space.
103 * guix pull: (guix)Invoking guix pull. Update the list of available packages.
104 * guix system: (guix)Invoking guix system. Manage the operating system configuration.
105 * guix deploy: (guix)Invoking guix deploy. Manage operating system configurations for remote hosts.
106 @end direntry
107
108 @dircategory Software development
109 @direntry
110 * guix environment: (guix)Invoking guix environment. Building development environments with Guix.
111 * guix build: (guix)Invoking guix build. Building packages.
112 * guix pack: (guix)Invoking guix pack. Creating binary bundles.
113 @end direntry
114
115 @titlepage
116 @title GNU Guix Reference Manual
117 @subtitle Using the GNU Guix Functional Package Manager
118 @author The GNU Guix Developers
119
120 @page
121 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
122 Edition @value{EDITION} @*
123 @value{UPDATED} @*
124
125 @insertcopying
126 @end titlepage
127
128 @contents
129
130 @c *********************************************************************
131 @node Top
132 @top GNU Guix
133
134 This document describes GNU Guix version @value{VERSION}, a functional
135 package management tool written for the GNU system.
136
137 @c TRANSLATORS: You can replace the following paragraph with information on
138 @c how to join your own translation team and how to report issues with the
139 @c translation.
140 This manual is also available in Simplified Chinese (@pxref{Top,,, guix.zh_CN,
141 GNU Guix参考手册}), French (@pxref{Top,,, guix.fr, Manuel de référence de GNU
142 Guix}), German (@pxref{Top,,, guix.de, Referenzhandbuch zu GNU Guix}),
143 Spanish (@pxref{Top,,, guix.es, Manual de referencia de GNU Guix}), and
144 Russian (@pxref{Top,,, guix.ru, Руководство GNU Guix}). If you
145 would like to translate it in your native language, consider joining
146 @uref{https://translate.fedoraproject.org/projects/guix/documentation-manual,
147 Weblate}.
148
149 @menu
150 * Introduction:: What is Guix about?
151 * Installation:: Installing Guix.
152 * System Installation:: Installing the whole operating system.
153 * Getting Started:: Your first steps.
154 * Package Management:: Package installation, upgrade, etc.
155 * Channels:: Customizing the package collection.
156 * Development:: Guix-aided software development.
157 * Programming Interface:: Using Guix in Scheme.
158 * Utilities:: Package management commands.
159 * System Configuration:: Configuring the operating system.
160 * Documentation:: Browsing software user manuals.
161 * Installing Debugging Files:: Feeding the debugger.
162 * Security Updates:: Deploying security fixes quickly.
163 * Bootstrapping:: GNU/Linux built from scratch.
164 * Porting:: Targeting another platform or kernel.
165 * Contributing:: Your help needed!
166
167 * Acknowledgments:: Thanks!
168 * GNU Free Documentation License:: The license of this manual.
169 * Concept Index:: Concepts.
170 * Programming Index:: Data types, functions, and variables.
171
172 @detailmenu
173 --- The Detailed Node Listing ---
174
175 Introduction
176
177 * Managing Software the Guix Way:: What's special.
178 * GNU Distribution:: The packages and tools.
179
180 Installation
181
182 * Binary Installation:: Getting Guix running in no time!
183 * Requirements:: Software needed to build and run Guix.
184 * Running the Test Suite:: Testing Guix.
185 * Setting Up the Daemon:: Preparing the build daemon's environment.
186 * Invoking guix-daemon:: Running the build daemon.
187 * Application Setup:: Application-specific setup.
188 * Upgrading Guix:: Upgrading Guix and its build daemon.
189
190 Setting Up the Daemon
191
192 * Build Environment Setup:: Preparing the isolated build environment.
193 * Daemon Offload Setup:: Offloading builds to remote machines.
194 * SELinux Support:: Using an SELinux policy for the daemon.
195
196 System Installation
197
198 * Limitations:: What you can expect.
199 * Hardware Considerations:: Supported hardware.
200 * USB Stick and DVD Installation:: Preparing the installation medium.
201 * Preparing for Installation:: Networking, partitioning, etc.
202 * Guided Graphical Installation:: Easy graphical installation.
203 * Manual Installation:: Manual installation for wizards.
204 * After System Installation:: When installation succeeded.
205 * Installing Guix in a VM:: Guix System playground.
206 * Building the Installation Image:: How this comes to be.
207
208 Manual Installation
209
210 * Keyboard Layout and Networking and Partitioning:: Initial setup.
211 * Proceeding with the Installation:: Installing.
212
213 Package Management
214
215 * Features:: How Guix will make your life brighter.
216 * Invoking guix package:: Package installation, removal, etc.
217 * Substitutes:: Downloading pre-built binaries.
218 * Packages with Multiple Outputs:: Single source package, multiple outputs.
219 * Invoking guix gc:: Running the garbage collector.
220 * Invoking guix pull:: Fetching the latest Guix and distribution.
221 * Invoking guix time-machine:: Running an older revision of Guix.
222 * Inferiors:: Interacting with another revision of Guix.
223 * Invoking guix describe:: Display information about your Guix revision.
224 * Invoking guix archive:: Exporting and importing store files.
225
226 Substitutes
227
228 * Official Substitute Server:: One particular source of substitutes.
229 * Substitute Server Authorization:: How to enable or disable substitutes.
230 * Getting Substitutes from Other Servers:: Substitute diversity.
231 * Substitute Authentication:: How Guix verifies substitutes.
232 * Proxy Settings:: How to get substitutes via proxy.
233 * Substitution Failure:: What happens when substitution fails.
234 * On Trusting Binaries:: How can you trust that binary blob?
235
236 Channels
237
238 * Specifying Additional Channels:: Extending the package collection.
239 * Using a Custom Guix Channel:: Using a customized Guix.
240 * Replicating Guix:: Running the @emph{exact same} Guix.
241 * Channel Authentication:: How Guix verifies what it fetches.
242 * Creating a Channel:: How to write your custom channel.
243 * Package Modules in a Sub-directory:: Specifying the channel's package modules location.
244 * Declaring Channel Dependencies:: How to depend on other channels.
245 * Specifying Channel Authorizations:: Defining channel authors authorizations.
246 * Primary URL:: Distinguishing mirror to original.
247 * Writing Channel News:: Communicating information to channel's users.
248 * Channels with Substitutes:: Using channels with available substitutes.
249
250 Development
251
252 * Invoking guix environment:: Setting up development environments.
253 * Invoking guix pack:: Creating software bundles.
254 * The GCC toolchain:: Working with languages supported by GCC.
255 * Invoking guix git authenticate:: Authenticating Git repositories.
256
257 Programming Interface
258
259 * Package Modules:: Packages from the programmer's viewpoint.
260 * Defining Packages:: Defining new packages.
261 * Defining Package Variants:: Customizing packages.
262 * Build Systems:: Specifying how packages are built.
263 * Build Phases:: Phases of the build process of a package.
264 * Build Utilities:: Helpers for your package definitions and more.
265 * The Store:: Manipulating the package store.
266 * Derivations:: Low-level interface to package derivations.
267 * The Store Monad:: Purely functional interface to the store.
268 * G-Expressions:: Manipulating build expressions.
269 * Invoking guix repl:: Programming Guix in Guile.
270
271 Defining Packages
272
273 * package Reference:: The package data type.
274 * origin Reference:: The origin data type.
275
276 Utilities
277
278 * Invoking guix build:: Building packages from the command line.
279 * Invoking guix edit:: Editing package definitions.
280 * Invoking guix download:: Downloading a file and printing its hash.
281 * Invoking guix hash:: Computing the cryptographic hash of a file.
282 * Invoking guix import:: Importing package definitions.
283 * Invoking guix refresh:: Updating package definitions.
284 * Invoking guix lint:: Finding errors in package definitions.
285 * Invoking guix size:: Profiling disk usage.
286 * Invoking guix graph:: Visualizing the graph of packages.
287 * Invoking guix publish:: Sharing substitutes.
288 * Invoking guix challenge:: Challenging substitute servers.
289 * Invoking guix copy:: Copying to and from a remote store.
290 * Invoking guix container:: Process isolation.
291 * Invoking guix weather:: Assessing substitute availability.
292 * Invoking guix processes:: Listing client processes.
293
294 Invoking @command{guix build}
295
296 * Common Build Options:: Build options for most commands.
297 * Package Transformation Options:: Creating variants of packages.
298 * Additional Build Options:: Options specific to 'guix build'.
299 * Debugging Build Failures:: Real life packaging experience.
300
301 System Configuration
302
303 * Using the Configuration System:: Customizing your GNU system.
304 * operating-system Reference:: Detail of operating-system declarations.
305 * File Systems:: Configuring file system mounts.
306 * Mapped Devices:: Block device extra processing.
307 * User Accounts:: Specifying user accounts.
308 * Keyboard Layout:: How the system interprets key strokes.
309 * Locales:: Language and cultural convention settings.
310 * Services:: Specifying system services.
311 * Setuid Programs:: Programs running with root privileges.
312 * X.509 Certificates:: Authenticating HTTPS servers.
313 * Name Service Switch:: Configuring libc's name service switch.
314 * Initial RAM Disk:: Linux-Libre bootstrapping.
315 * Bootloader Configuration:: Configuring the boot loader.
316 * Invoking guix system:: Instantiating a system configuration.
317 * Invoking guix deploy:: Deploying a system configuration to a remote host.
318 * Running Guix in a VM:: How to run Guix System in a virtual machine.
319 * Defining Services:: Adding new service definitions.
320
321 Services
322
323 * Base Services:: Essential system services.
324 * Scheduled Job Execution:: The mcron service.
325 * Log Rotation:: The rottlog service.
326 * Networking Services:: Network setup, SSH daemon, etc.
327 * Unattended Upgrades:: Automated system upgrades.
328 * X Window:: Graphical display.
329 * Printing Services:: Local and remote printer support.
330 * Desktop Services:: D-Bus and desktop services.
331 * Sound Services:: ALSA and Pulseaudio services.
332 * Database Services:: SQL databases, key-value stores, etc.
333 * Mail Services:: IMAP, POP3, SMTP, and all that.
334 * Messaging Services:: Messaging services.
335 * Telephony Services:: Telephony services.
336 * Monitoring Services:: Monitoring services.
337 * Kerberos Services:: Kerberos services.
338 * LDAP Services:: LDAP services.
339 * Web Services:: Web servers.
340 * Certificate Services:: TLS certificates via Let's Encrypt.
341 * DNS Services:: DNS daemons.
342 * VPN Services:: VPN daemons.
343 * Network File System:: NFS related services.
344 * Continuous Integration:: The Cuirass service.
345 * Power Management Services:: Extending battery life.
346 * Audio Services:: The MPD.
347 * Virtualization Services:: Virtualization services.
348 * Version Control Services:: Providing remote access to Git repositories.
349 * Game Services:: Game servers.
350 * PAM Mount Service:: Service to mount volumes when logging in.
351 * Guix Services:: Services relating specifically to Guix.
352 * Linux Services:: Services tied to the Linux kernel.
353 * Hurd Services:: Services specific for a Hurd System.
354 * Miscellaneous Services:: Other services.
355
356 Defining Services
357
358 * Service Composition:: The model for composing services.
359 * Service Types and Services:: Types and services.
360 * Service Reference:: API reference.
361 * Shepherd Services:: A particular type of service.
362
363 Installing Debugging Files
364
365 * Separate Debug Info:: Installing 'debug' outputs.
366 * Rebuilding Debug Info:: Building missing debug info.
367
368 Bootstrapping
369
370 * Reduced Binary Seed Bootstrap:: A Bootstrap worthy of GNU.
371 * Preparing to Use the Bootstrap Binaries:: Building that what matters most.
372
373 @end detailmenu
374 @end menu
375
376 @c *********************************************************************
377 @node Introduction
378 @chapter Introduction
379
380 @cindex purpose
381 GNU Guix@footnote{``Guix'' is pronounced like ``geeks'', or ``ɡiːks''
382 using the international phonetic alphabet (IPA).} is a package
383 management tool for and distribution of the GNU system.
384 Guix makes it easy for unprivileged
385 users to install, upgrade, or remove software packages, to roll back to a
386 previous package set, to build packages from source, and generally
387 assists with the creation and maintenance of software environments.
388
389 @cindex Guix System
390 @cindex GuixSD, now Guix System
391 @cindex Guix System Distribution, now Guix System
392 You can install GNU@tie{}Guix on top of an existing GNU/Linux system where it
393 complements the available tools without interference (@pxref{Installation}),
394 or you can use it as a standalone operating system distribution,
395 @dfn{Guix@tie{}System}@footnote{We used to refer to Guix System as ``Guix
396 System Distribution'' or ``GuixSD''. We now consider it makes more sense to
397 group everything under the ``Guix'' banner since, after all, Guix System is
398 readily available through the @command{guix system} command, even if you're
399 using a different distro underneath!}. @xref{GNU Distribution}.
400
401 @menu
402 * Managing Software the Guix Way:: What's special.
403 * GNU Distribution:: The packages and tools.
404 @end menu
405
406 @node Managing Software the Guix Way
407 @section Managing Software the Guix Way
408
409 @cindex user interfaces
410 Guix provides a command-line package management interface
411 (@pxref{Package Management}), tools to help with software development
412 (@pxref{Development}), command-line utilities for more advanced usage
413 (@pxref{Utilities}), as well as Scheme programming interfaces
414 (@pxref{Programming Interface}).
415 @cindex build daemon
416 Its @dfn{build daemon} is responsible for building packages on behalf of
417 users (@pxref{Setting Up the Daemon}) and for downloading pre-built
418 binaries from authorized sources (@pxref{Substitutes}).
419
420 @cindex extensibility of the distribution
421 @cindex customization, of packages
422 Guix includes package definitions for many GNU and non-GNU packages, all
423 of which @uref{https://www.gnu.org/philosophy/free-sw.html, respect the
424 user's computing freedom}. It is @emph{extensible}: users can write
425 their own package definitions (@pxref{Defining Packages}) and make them
426 available as independent package modules (@pxref{Package Modules}). It
427 is also @emph{customizable}: users can @emph{derive} specialized package
428 definitions from existing ones, including from the command line
429 (@pxref{Package Transformation Options}).
430
431 @cindex functional package management
432 @cindex isolation
433 Under the hood, Guix implements the @dfn{functional package management}
434 discipline pioneered by Nix (@pxref{Acknowledgments}).
435 In Guix, the package build and installation process is seen
436 as a @emph{function}, in the mathematical sense. That function takes inputs,
437 such as build scripts, a compiler, and libraries, and
438 returns an installed package. As a pure function, its result depends
439 solely on its inputs---for instance, it cannot refer to software or
440 scripts that were not explicitly passed as inputs. A build function
441 always produces the same result when passed a given set of inputs. It
442 cannot alter the environment of the running system in
443 any way; for instance, it cannot create, modify, or delete files outside
444 of its build and installation directories. This is achieved by running
445 build processes in isolated environments (or @dfn{containers}), where only their
446 explicit inputs are visible.
447
448 @cindex store
449 The result of package build functions is @dfn{cached} in the file
450 system, in a special directory called @dfn{the store} (@pxref{The
451 Store}). Each package is installed in a directory of its own in the
452 store---by default under @file{/gnu/store}. The directory name contains
453 a hash of all the inputs used to build that package; thus, changing an
454 input yields a different directory name.
455
456 This approach is the foundation for the salient features of Guix: support
457 for transactional package upgrade and rollback, per-user installation, and
458 garbage collection of packages (@pxref{Features}).
459
460
461 @node GNU Distribution
462 @section GNU Distribution
463
464 @cindex Guix System
465 Guix comes with a distribution of the GNU system consisting entirely of
466 free software@footnote{The term ``free'' here refers to the
467 @url{https://www.gnu.org/philosophy/free-sw.html,freedom provided to
468 users of that software}.}. The
469 distribution can be installed on its own (@pxref{System Installation}),
470 but it is also possible to install Guix as a package manager on top of
471 an installed GNU/Linux system (@pxref{Installation}). When we need to
472 distinguish between the two, we refer to the standalone distribution as
473 Guix@tie{}System.
474
475 The distribution provides core GNU packages such as GNU libc, GCC, and
476 Binutils, as well as many GNU and non-GNU applications. The complete
477 list of available packages can be browsed
478 @url{https://www.gnu.org/software/guix/packages,on-line} or by
479 running @command{guix package} (@pxref{Invoking guix package}):
480
481 @example
482 guix package --list-available
483 @end example
484
485 Our goal is to provide a practical 100% free software distribution of
486 Linux-based and other variants of GNU, with a focus on the promotion and
487 tight integration of GNU components, and an emphasis on programs and
488 tools that help users exert that freedom.
489
490 Packages are currently available on the following platforms:
491
492 @table @code
493
494 @item x86_64-linux
495 Intel/AMD @code{x86_64} architecture, Linux-Libre kernel.
496
497 @item i686-linux
498 Intel 32-bit architecture (IA32), Linux-Libre kernel.
499
500 @item armhf-linux
501 ARMv7-A architecture with hard float, Thumb-2 and NEON,
502 using the EABI hard-float application binary interface (ABI),
503 and Linux-Libre kernel.
504
505 @item aarch64-linux
506 little-endian 64-bit ARMv8-A processors, Linux-Libre kernel.
507
508 @item i586-gnu
509 @uref{https://hurd.gnu.org, GNU/Hurd} on the Intel 32-bit architecture
510 (IA32).
511
512 This configuration is experimental and under development. The easiest
513 way for you to give it a try is by setting up an instance of
514 @code{hurd-vm-service-type} on your GNU/Linux machine
515 (@pxref{transparent-emulation-qemu, @code{hurd-vm-service-type}}).
516 @xref{Contributing}, on how to help!
517
518 @item mips64el-linux (deprecated)
519 little-endian 64-bit MIPS processors, specifically the Loongson series,
520 n32 ABI, and Linux-Libre kernel. This configuration is no longer fully
521 supported; in particular, there is no ongoing work to ensure that this
522 architecture still works. Should someone decide they wish to revive this
523 architecture then the code is still available.
524
525 @end table
526
527 With Guix@tie{}System, you @emph{declare} all aspects of the operating system
528 configuration and Guix takes care of instantiating the configuration in a
529 transactional, reproducible, and stateless fashion (@pxref{System
530 Configuration}). Guix System uses the Linux-libre kernel, the Shepherd
531 initialization system (@pxref{Introduction,,, shepherd, The GNU Shepherd
532 Manual}), the well-known GNU utilities and tool chain, as well as the
533 graphical environment or system services of your choice.
534
535 Guix System is available on all the above platforms except
536 @code{mips64el-linux}.
537
538 @noindent
539 For information on porting to other architectures or kernels,
540 @pxref{Porting}.
541
542 Building this distribution is a cooperative effort, and you are invited
543 to join! @xref{Contributing}, for information about how you can help.
544
545
546 @c *********************************************************************
547 @node Installation
548 @chapter Installation
549
550 @cindex installing Guix
551
552 @quotation Note
553 We recommend the use of this
554 @uref{https://git.savannah.gnu.org/cgit/guix.git/plain/etc/guix-install.sh,
555 shell installer script} to install Guix on top of a running GNU/Linux system,
556 thereafter called a @dfn{foreign distro}.@footnote{This section is concerned
557 with the installation of the package manager, which can be done on top of a
558 running GNU/Linux system. If, instead, you want to install the complete GNU
559 operating system, @pxref{System Installation}.} The script automates the
560 download, installation, and initial configuration of Guix. It should be run
561 as the root user.
562 @end quotation
563
564 @cindex foreign distro
565 @cindex directories related to foreign distro
566 When installed on a foreign distro, GNU@tie{}Guix complements the available
567 tools without interference. Its data lives exclusively in two directories,
568 usually @file{/gnu/store} and @file{/var/guix}; other files on your system,
569 such as @file{/etc}, are left untouched.
570
571 Once installed, Guix can be updated by running @command{guix pull}
572 (@pxref{Invoking guix pull}).
573
574 If you prefer to perform the installation steps manually or want to tweak
575 them, you may find the following subsections useful. They describe the
576 software requirements of Guix, as well as how to install it manually and get
577 ready to use it.
578
579 @menu
580 * Binary Installation:: Getting Guix running in no time!
581 * Requirements:: Software needed to build and run Guix.
582 * Running the Test Suite:: Testing Guix.
583 * Setting Up the Daemon:: Preparing the build daemon's environment.
584 * Invoking guix-daemon:: Running the build daemon.
585 * Application Setup:: Application-specific setup.
586 * Upgrading Guix:: Upgrading Guix and its build daemon.
587 @end menu
588
589 @node Binary Installation
590 @section Binary Installation
591
592 @cindex installing Guix from binaries
593 @cindex installer script
594 This section describes how to install Guix on an arbitrary system from a
595 self-contained tarball providing binaries for Guix and for all its
596 dependencies. This is often quicker than installing from source, which
597 is described in the next sections. The only requirement is to have
598 GNU@tie{}tar and Xz.
599
600 @c Note duplicated from the ``Installation'' node.
601 @quotation Note
602 We recommend the use of this
603 @uref{https://git.savannah.gnu.org/cgit/guix.git/plain/etc/guix-install.sh,
604 shell installer script}. The script automates the download, installation, and
605 initial configuration steps described below. It should be run as the root
606 user. As root, you can thus run this:
607
608 @example
609 cd /tmp
610 wget https://git.savannah.gnu.org/cgit/guix.git/plain/etc/guix-install.sh
611 chmod +x guix-install.sh
612 ./guix-install.sh
613 @end example
614
615 When you're done, @pxref{Application Setup} for extra configuration you
616 might need, and @ref{Getting Started} for your first steps!
617 @end quotation
618
619 Installing goes along these lines:
620
621 @enumerate
622 @item
623 @cindex downloading Guix binary
624 Download the binary tarball from
625 @indicateurl{@value{BASE-URL}/guix-binary-@value{VERSION}.x86_64-linux.tar.xz},
626 where @code{x86_64-linux} can be replaced with @code{i686-linux} for an
627 @code{i686} (32-bits) machine already running the kernel Linux, and so on
628 (@pxref{GNU Distribution}).
629
630 @c The following is somewhat duplicated in ``System Installation''.
631 Make sure to download the associated @file{.sig} file and to verify the
632 authenticity of the tarball against it, along these lines:
633
634 @example
635 $ wget @value{BASE-URL}/guix-binary-@value{VERSION}.x86_64-linux.tar.xz.sig
636 $ gpg --verify guix-binary-@value{VERSION}.x86_64-linux.tar.xz.sig
637 @end example
638
639 If that command fails because you do not have the required public key,
640 then run this command to import it:
641
642 @example
643 $ wget @value{OPENPGP-SIGNING-KEY-URL} \
644 -qO - | gpg --import -
645 @end example
646
647 @noindent
648 and rerun the @code{gpg --verify} command.
649
650 Take note that a warning like ``This key is not certified with a trusted
651 signature!'' is normal.
652
653 @c end authentication part
654
655 @item
656 Now, you need to become the @code{root} user. Depending on your distribution,
657 you may have to run @code{su -} or @code{sudo -i}. As @code{root}, run:
658
659 @example
660 # cd /tmp
661 # tar --warning=no-timestamp -xf \
662 /path/to/guix-binary-@value{VERSION}.x86_64-linux.tar.xz
663 # mv var/guix /var/ && mv gnu /
664 @end example
665
666 This creates @file{/gnu/store} (@pxref{The Store}) and @file{/var/guix}.
667 The latter contains a ready-to-use profile for @code{root} (see next
668 step).
669
670 Do @emph{not} unpack the tarball on a working Guix system since that
671 would overwrite its own essential files.
672
673 The @option{--warning=no-timestamp} option makes sure GNU@tie{}tar does
674 not emit warnings about ``implausibly old time stamps'' (such
675 warnings were triggered by GNU@tie{}tar 1.26 and older; recent
676 versions are fine).
677 They stem from the fact that all the
678 files in the archive have their modification time set to 1 (which
679 means January 1st, 1970). This is done on purpose to make sure the
680 archive content is independent of its creation time, thus making it
681 reproducible.
682
683 @item
684 Make the profile available under @file{~root/.config/guix/current}, which is
685 where @command{guix pull} will install updates (@pxref{Invoking guix pull}):
686
687 @example
688 # mkdir -p ~root/.config/guix
689 # ln -sf /var/guix/profiles/per-user/root/current-guix \
690 ~root/.config/guix/current
691 @end example
692
693 Source @file{etc/profile} to augment @env{PATH} and other relevant
694 environment variables:
695
696 @example
697 # GUIX_PROFILE="`echo ~root`/.config/guix/current" ; \
698 source $GUIX_PROFILE/etc/profile
699 @end example
700
701 @item
702 Create the group and user accounts for build users as explained below
703 (@pxref{Build Environment Setup}).
704
705 @item
706 Run the daemon, and set it to automatically start on boot.
707
708 If your host distro uses the systemd init system, this can be achieved
709 with these commands:
710
711 @c Versions of systemd that supported symlinked service files are not
712 @c yet widely deployed, so we should suggest that users copy the service
713 @c files into place.
714 @c
715 @c See this thread for more information:
716 @c https://lists.gnu.org/archive/html/guix-devel/2017-01/msg01199.html
717
718 @example
719 # cp ~root/.config/guix/current/lib/systemd/system/gnu-store.mount \
720 ~root/.config/guix/current/lib/systemd/system/guix-daemon.service \
721 /etc/systemd/system/
722 # systemctl enable --now gnu-store.mount guix-daemon
723 @end example
724
725 If your host distro uses the Upstart init system:
726
727 @example
728 # initctl reload-configuration
729 # cp ~root/.config/guix/current/lib/upstart/system/guix-daemon.conf \
730 /etc/init/
731 # start guix-daemon
732 @end example
733
734 Otherwise, you can still start the daemon manually with:
735
736 @example
737 # ~root/.config/guix/current/bin/guix-daemon \
738 --build-users-group=guixbuild
739 @end example
740
741 @item
742 Make the @command{guix} command available to other users on the machine,
743 for instance with:
744
745 @example
746 # mkdir -p /usr/local/bin
747 # cd /usr/local/bin
748 # ln -s /var/guix/profiles/per-user/root/current-guix/bin/guix
749 @end example
750
751 It is also a good idea to make the Info version of this manual available
752 there:
753
754 @example
755 # mkdir -p /usr/local/share/info
756 # cd /usr/local/share/info
757 # for i in /var/guix/profiles/per-user/root/current-guix/share/info/* ;
758 do ln -s $i ; done
759 @end example
760
761 That way, assuming @file{/usr/local/share/info} is in the search path,
762 running @command{info guix} will open this manual (@pxref{Other Info
763 Directories,,, texinfo, GNU Texinfo}, for more details on changing the
764 Info search path).
765
766 @item
767 @cindex substitutes, authorization thereof
768 To use substitutes from @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}} or one of its mirrors
769 (@pxref{Substitutes}), authorize them:
770
771 @example
772 # guix archive --authorize < \
773 ~root/.config/guix/current/share/guix/@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}.pub
774 @end example
775
776 @item
777 Each user may need to perform a few additional steps to make their Guix
778 environment ready for use, @pxref{Application Setup}.
779 @end enumerate
780
781 Voilà, the installation is complete!
782
783 You can confirm that Guix is working by installing a sample package into
784 the root profile:
785
786 @example
787 # guix install hello
788 @end example
789
790 The binary installation tarball can be (re)produced and verified simply
791 by running the following command in the Guix source tree:
792
793 @example
794 make guix-binary.@var{system}.tar.xz
795 @end example
796
797 @noindent
798 ...@: which, in turn, runs:
799
800 @example
801 guix pack -s @var{system} --localstatedir \
802 --profile-name=current-guix guix
803 @end example
804
805 @xref{Invoking guix pack}, for more info on this handy tool.
806
807 @node Requirements
808 @section Requirements
809
810 This section lists requirements when building Guix from source. The
811 build procedure for Guix is the same as for other GNU software, and is
812 not covered here. Please see the files @file{README} and @file{INSTALL}
813 in the Guix source tree for additional details.
814
815 @cindex official website
816 GNU Guix is available for download from its website at
817 @url{https://www.gnu.org/software/guix/}.
818
819 GNU Guix depends on the following packages:
820
821 @itemize
822 @item @url{https://gnu.org/software/guile/, GNU Guile}, version 3.0.x or
823 2.2.x;
824 @item @url{https://notabug.org/cwebber/guile-gcrypt, Guile-Gcrypt}, version
825 0.1.0 or later;
826 @item
827 @uref{https://gnutls.org/, GnuTLS}, specifically its Guile bindings
828 (@pxref{Guile Preparations, how to install the GnuTLS bindings for
829 Guile,, gnutls-guile, GnuTLS-Guile});
830 @item
831 @uref{https://notabug.org/guile-sqlite3/guile-sqlite3, Guile-SQLite3}, version 0.1.0
832 or later;
833 @item @uref{https://notabug.org/guile-zlib/guile-zlib, Guile-zlib};
834 @item @uref{https://notabug.org/guile-lzlib/guile-lzlib, Guile-lzlib};
835 @item @uref{https://www.nongnu.org/guile-avahi/, Guile-Avahi};
836 @item
837 @c FIXME: Specify a version number once a release has been made.
838 @uref{https://gitlab.com/guile-git/guile-git, Guile-Git}, version 0.3.0
839 or later;
840 @item @uref{https://savannah.nongnu.org/projects/guile-json/, Guile-JSON}
841 4.3.0 or later;
842 @item @url{https://www.gnu.org/software/make/, GNU Make}.
843 @end itemize
844
845 The following dependencies are optional:
846
847 @itemize
848 @item
849 @c Note: We need at least 0.13.0 for #:nodelay.
850 Support for build offloading (@pxref{Daemon Offload Setup}) and
851 @command{guix copy} (@pxref{Invoking guix copy}) depends on
852 @uref{https://github.com/artyom-poptsov/guile-ssh, Guile-SSH},
853 version 0.13.0 or later.
854
855 @item
856 @uref{https://notabug.org/guile-zstd/guile-zstd, Guile-zstd}, for zstd
857 compression and decompression in @command{guix publish} and for
858 substitutes (@pxref{Invoking guix publish}).
859
860 @item
861 @uref{https://ngyro.com/software/guile-semver.html, Guile-Semver} for
862 the @code{crate} importer (@pxref{Invoking guix import}).
863
864 @item
865 When @url{http://www.bzip.org, libbz2} is available,
866 @command{guix-daemon} can use it to compress build logs.
867 @end itemize
868
869 Unless @option{--disable-daemon} was passed to @command{configure}, the
870 following packages are also needed:
871
872 @itemize
873 @item @url{https://gnupg.org/, GNU libgcrypt};
874 @item @url{https://sqlite.org, SQLite 3};
875 @item @url{https://gcc.gnu.org, GCC's g++}, with support for the
876 C++11 standard.
877 @end itemize
878
879 @cindex state directory
880 When configuring Guix on a system that already has a Guix installation,
881 be sure to specify the same state directory as the existing installation
882 using the @option{--localstatedir} option of the @command{configure}
883 script (@pxref{Directory Variables, @code{localstatedir},, standards,
884 GNU Coding Standards}). Usually, this @var{localstatedir} option is
885 set to the value @file{/var}. The @command{configure} script protects
886 against unintended misconfiguration of @var{localstatedir} so you do not
887 inadvertently corrupt your store (@pxref{The Store}).
888
889 @node Running the Test Suite
890 @section Running the Test Suite
891
892 @cindex test suite
893 After a successful @command{configure} and @code{make} run, it is a good
894 idea to run the test suite. It can help catch issues with the setup or
895 environment, or bugs in Guix itself---and really, reporting test
896 failures is a good way to help improve the software. To run the test
897 suite, type:
898
899 @example
900 make check
901 @end example
902
903 Test cases can run in parallel: you can use the @code{-j} option of
904 GNU@tie{}make to speed things up. The first run may take a few minutes
905 on a recent machine; subsequent runs will be faster because the store
906 that is created for test purposes will already have various things in
907 cache.
908
909 It is also possible to run a subset of the tests by defining the
910 @code{TESTS} makefile variable as in this example:
911
912 @example
913 make check TESTS="tests/store.scm tests/cpio.scm"
914 @end example
915
916 By default, tests results are displayed at a file level. In order to
917 see the details of every individual test cases, it is possible to define
918 the @code{SCM_LOG_DRIVER_FLAGS} makefile variable as in this example:
919
920 @example
921 make check TESTS="tests/base64.scm" SCM_LOG_DRIVER_FLAGS="--brief=no"
922 @end example
923
924 The underlying SRFI 64 custom Automake test driver used for the 'check'
925 test suite (located at @file{build-aux/test-driver.scm}) also allows
926 selecting which test cases to run at a finer level, via its
927 @option{--select} and @option{--exclude} options. Here's an example, to
928 run all the test cases from the @file{tests/packages.scm} test file
929 whose names start with ``transaction-upgrade-entry'':
930
931 @example
932 export SCM_LOG_DRIVER_FLAGS="--select=^transaction-upgrade-entry"
933 make check TESTS="tests/packages.scm"
934 @end example
935
936 Those wishing to inspect the results of failed tests directly from the
937 command line can add the @option{--errors-only=yes} option to the
938 @code{SCM_LOG_DRIVER_FLAGS} makefile variable and set the @code{VERBOSE}
939 Automake makefile variable, as in:
940
941 @example
942 make check SCM_LOG_DRIVER_FLAGS="--brief=no --errors-only=yes" VERBOSE=1
943 @end example
944
945 The @option{--show-duration=yes} option can be used to print the
946 duration of the individual test cases, when used in combination with
947 @option{--brief=no}:
948
949 @example
950 make check SCM_LOG_DRIVER_FLAGS="--brief=no --show-duration=yes"
951 @end example
952
953 @xref{Parallel Test Harness,,,automake,GNU Automake} for more
954 information about the Automake Parallel Test Harness.
955
956 Upon failure, please email @email{bug-guix@@gnu.org} and attach the
957 @file{test-suite.log} file. Please specify the Guix version being used
958 as well as version numbers of the dependencies (@pxref{Requirements}) in
959 your message.
960
961 Guix also comes with a whole-system test suite that tests complete
962 Guix System instances. It can only run on systems where
963 Guix is already installed, using:
964
965 @example
966 make check-system
967 @end example
968
969 @noindent
970 or, again, by defining @code{TESTS} to select a subset of tests to run:
971
972 @example
973 make check-system TESTS="basic mcron"
974 @end example
975
976 These system tests are defined in the @code{(gnu tests @dots{})}
977 modules. They work by running the operating systems under test with
978 lightweight instrumentation in a virtual machine (VM). They can be
979 computationally intensive or rather cheap, depending on whether
980 substitutes are available for their dependencies (@pxref{Substitutes}).
981 Some of them require a lot of storage space to hold VM images.
982
983 Again in case of test failures, please send @email{bug-guix@@gnu.org}
984 all the details.
985
986 @node Setting Up the Daemon
987 @section Setting Up the Daemon
988
989 @cindex daemon
990 Operations such as building a package or running the garbage collector
991 are all performed by a specialized process, the @dfn{build daemon}, on
992 behalf of clients. Only the daemon may access the store and its
993 associated database. Thus, any operation that manipulates the store
994 goes through the daemon. For instance, command-line tools such as
995 @command{guix package} and @command{guix build} communicate with the
996 daemon (@i{via} remote procedure calls) to instruct it what to do.
997
998 The following sections explain how to prepare the build daemon's
999 environment. See also @ref{Substitutes}, for information on how to allow
1000 the daemon to download pre-built binaries.
1001
1002 @menu
1003 * Build Environment Setup:: Preparing the isolated build environment.
1004 * Daemon Offload Setup:: Offloading builds to remote machines.
1005 * SELinux Support:: Using an SELinux policy for the daemon.
1006 @end menu
1007
1008 @node Build Environment Setup
1009 @subsection Build Environment Setup
1010
1011 @cindex build environment
1012 In a standard multi-user setup, Guix and its daemon---the
1013 @command{guix-daemon} program---are installed by the system
1014 administrator; @file{/gnu/store} is owned by @code{root} and
1015 @command{guix-daemon} runs as @code{root}. Unprivileged users may use
1016 Guix tools to build packages or otherwise access the store, and the
1017 daemon will do it on their behalf, ensuring that the store is kept in a
1018 consistent state, and allowing built packages to be shared among users.
1019
1020 @cindex build users
1021 When @command{guix-daemon} runs as @code{root}, you may not want package
1022 build processes themselves to run as @code{root} too, for obvious
1023 security reasons. To avoid that, a special pool of @dfn{build users}
1024 should be created for use by build processes started by the daemon.
1025 These build users need not have a shell and a home directory: they will
1026 just be used when the daemon drops @code{root} privileges in build
1027 processes. Having several such users allows the daemon to launch
1028 distinct build processes under separate UIDs, which guarantees that they
1029 do not interfere with each other---an essential feature since builds are
1030 regarded as pure functions (@pxref{Introduction}).
1031
1032 On a GNU/Linux system, a build user pool may be created like this (using
1033 Bash syntax and the @code{shadow} commands):
1034
1035 @c See https://lists.gnu.org/archive/html/bug-guix/2013-01/msg00239.html
1036 @c for why `-G' is needed.
1037 @example
1038 # groupadd --system guixbuild
1039 # for i in `seq -w 1 10`;
1040 do
1041 useradd -g guixbuild -G guixbuild \
1042 -d /var/empty -s `which nologin` \
1043 -c "Guix build user $i" --system \
1044 guixbuilder$i;
1045 done
1046 @end example
1047
1048 @noindent
1049 The number of build users determines how many build jobs may run in
1050 parallel, as specified by the @option{--max-jobs} option
1051 (@pxref{Invoking guix-daemon, @option{--max-jobs}}). To use
1052 @command{guix system vm} and related commands, you may need to add the
1053 build users to the @code{kvm} group so they can access @file{/dev/kvm},
1054 using @code{-G guixbuild,kvm} instead of @code{-G guixbuild}
1055 (@pxref{Invoking guix system}).
1056
1057 The @code{guix-daemon} program may then be run as @code{root} with the
1058 following command@footnote{If your machine uses the systemd init system,
1059 dropping the @file{@var{prefix}/lib/systemd/system/guix-daemon.service}
1060 file in @file{/etc/systemd/system} will ensure that
1061 @command{guix-daemon} is automatically started. Similarly, if your
1062 machine uses the Upstart init system, drop the
1063 @file{@var{prefix}/lib/upstart/system/guix-daemon.conf}
1064 file in @file{/etc/init}.}:
1065
1066 @example
1067 # guix-daemon --build-users-group=guixbuild
1068 @end example
1069
1070 @cindex chroot
1071 @noindent
1072 This way, the daemon starts build processes in a chroot, under one of
1073 the @code{guixbuilder} users. On GNU/Linux, by default, the chroot
1074 environment contains nothing but:
1075
1076 @c Keep this list in sync with libstore/build.cc! -----------------------
1077 @itemize
1078 @item
1079 a minimal @code{/dev} directory, created mostly independently from the
1080 host @code{/dev}@footnote{``Mostly'', because while the set of files
1081 that appear in the chroot's @code{/dev} is fixed, most of these files
1082 can only be created if the host has them.};
1083
1084 @item
1085 the @code{/proc} directory; it only shows the processes of the container
1086 since a separate PID name space is used;
1087
1088 @item
1089 @file{/etc/passwd} with an entry for the current user and an entry for
1090 user @file{nobody};
1091
1092 @item
1093 @file{/etc/group} with an entry for the user's group;
1094
1095 @item
1096 @file{/etc/hosts} with an entry that maps @code{localhost} to
1097 @code{127.0.0.1};
1098
1099 @item
1100 a writable @file{/tmp} directory.
1101 @end itemize
1102
1103 You can influence the directory where the daemon stores build trees
1104 @i{via} the @env{TMPDIR} environment variable. However, the build tree
1105 within the chroot is always called @file{/tmp/guix-build-@var{name}.drv-0},
1106 where @var{name} is the derivation name---e.g., @code{coreutils-8.24}.
1107 This way, the value of @env{TMPDIR} does not leak inside build
1108 environments, which avoids discrepancies in cases where build processes
1109 capture the name of their build tree.
1110
1111 @vindex http_proxy
1112 @vindex https_proxy
1113 The daemon also honors the @env{http_proxy} and @env{https_proxy}
1114 environment variables for HTTP and HTTPS downloads it performs, be it
1115 for fixed-output derivations (@pxref{Derivations}) or for substitutes
1116 (@pxref{Substitutes}).
1117
1118 If you are installing Guix as an unprivileged user, it is still possible
1119 to run @command{guix-daemon} provided you pass @option{--disable-chroot}.
1120 However, build processes will not be isolated from one another, and not
1121 from the rest of the system. Thus, build processes may interfere with
1122 each other, and may access programs, libraries, and other files
1123 available on the system---making it much harder to view them as
1124 @emph{pure} functions.
1125
1126
1127 @node Daemon Offload Setup
1128 @subsection Using the Offload Facility
1129
1130 @cindex offloading
1131 @cindex build hook
1132 When desired, the build daemon can @dfn{offload} derivation builds to
1133 other machines running Guix, using the @code{offload} @dfn{build
1134 hook}@footnote{This feature is available only when
1135 @uref{https://github.com/artyom-poptsov/guile-ssh, Guile-SSH} is
1136 present.}. When that feature is enabled, a list of user-specified build
1137 machines is read from @file{/etc/guix/machines.scm}; every time a build
1138 is requested, for instance via @code{guix build}, the daemon attempts to
1139 offload it to one of the machines that satisfy the constraints of the
1140 derivation, in particular its system types---e.g., @code{x86_64-linux}.
1141 A single machine can have multiple system types, either because its
1142 architecture natively supports it, via emulation
1143 (@pxref{transparent-emulation-qemu, Transparent Emulation with QEMU}),
1144 or both. Missing prerequisites for the build are
1145 copied over SSH to the target machine, which then proceeds with the
1146 build; upon success the output(s) of the build are copied back to the
1147 initial machine. The offload facility comes with a basic scheduler that
1148 attempts to select the best machine. The best machine is chosen among
1149 the available machines based on criteria such as:
1150
1151 @enumerate
1152 @item
1153 The availability of a build slot. A build machine can have as many
1154 build slots (connections) as the value of the @code{parallel-builds}
1155 field of its @code{build-machine} object.
1156
1157 @item
1158 Its relative speed, as defined via the @code{speed} field of its
1159 @code{build-machine} object.
1160
1161 @item
1162 Its load. The normalized machine load must be lower than a threshold
1163 value, configurable via the @code{overload-threshold} field of its
1164 @code{build-machine} object.
1165
1166 @item
1167 Disk space availability. More than a 100 MiB must be available.
1168 @end enumerate
1169
1170 The @file{/etc/guix/machines.scm} file typically looks like this:
1171
1172 @lisp
1173 (list (build-machine
1174 (name "eightysix.example.org")
1175 (systems (list "x86_64-linux" "i686-linux"))
1176 (host-key "ssh-ed25519 AAAAC3Nza@dots{}")
1177 (user "bob")
1178 (speed 2.)) ;incredibly fast!
1179
1180 (build-machine
1181 (name "armeight.example.org")
1182 (systems (list "aarch64-linux"))
1183 (host-key "ssh-rsa AAAAB3Nza@dots{}")
1184 (user "alice")
1185 (private-key
1186 (string-append (getenv "HOME")
1187 "/.ssh/identity-for-guix"))))
1188 @end lisp
1189
1190 @noindent
1191 In the example above we specify a list of two build machines, one for
1192 the @code{x86_64} and @code{i686} architectures and one for the
1193 @code{aarch64} architecture.
1194
1195 In fact, this file is---not surprisingly!---a Scheme file that is
1196 evaluated when the @code{offload} hook is started. Its return value
1197 must be a list of @code{build-machine} objects. While this example
1198 shows a fixed list of build machines, one could imagine, say, using
1199 DNS-SD to return a list of potential build machines discovered in the
1200 local network (@pxref{Introduction, Guile-Avahi,, guile-avahi, Using
1201 Avahi in Guile Scheme Programs}). The @code{build-machine} data type is
1202 detailed below.
1203
1204 @deftp {Data Type} build-machine
1205 This data type represents build machines to which the daemon may offload
1206 builds. The important fields are:
1207
1208 @table @code
1209
1210 @item name
1211 The host name of the remote machine.
1212
1213 @item systems
1214 The system types the remote machine supports---e.g., @code{(list
1215 "x86_64-linux" "i686-linux")}.
1216
1217 @item user
1218 The user account to use when connecting to the remote machine over SSH.
1219 Note that the SSH key pair must @emph{not} be passphrase-protected, to
1220 allow non-interactive logins.
1221
1222 @item host-key
1223 This must be the machine's SSH @dfn{public host key} in OpenSSH format.
1224 This is used to authenticate the machine when we connect to it. It is a
1225 long string that looks like this:
1226
1227 @example
1228 ssh-ed25519 AAAAC3NzaC@dots{}mde+UhL hint@@example.org
1229 @end example
1230
1231 If the machine is running the OpenSSH daemon, @command{sshd}, the host
1232 key can be found in a file such as
1233 @file{/etc/ssh/ssh_host_ed25519_key.pub}.
1234
1235 If the machine is running the SSH daemon of GNU@tie{}lsh,
1236 @command{lshd}, the host key is in @file{/etc/lsh/host-key.pub} or a
1237 similar file. It can be converted to the OpenSSH format using
1238 @command{lsh-export-key} (@pxref{Converting keys,,, lsh, LSH Manual}):
1239
1240 @example
1241 $ lsh-export-key --openssh < /etc/lsh/host-key.pub
1242 ssh-rsa AAAAB3NzaC1yc2EAAAAEOp8FoQAAAQEAs1eB46LV@dots{}
1243 @end example
1244
1245 @end table
1246
1247 A number of optional fields may be specified:
1248
1249 @table @asis
1250
1251 @item @code{port} (default: @code{22})
1252 Port number of SSH server on the machine.
1253
1254 @item @code{private-key} (default: @file{~root/.ssh/id_rsa})
1255 The SSH private key file to use when connecting to the machine, in
1256 OpenSSH format. This key must not be protected with a passphrase.
1257
1258 Note that the default value is the private key @emph{of the root
1259 account}. Make sure it exists if you use the default.
1260
1261 @item @code{compression} (default: @code{"zlib@@openssh.com,zlib"})
1262 @itemx @code{compression-level} (default: @code{3})
1263 The SSH-level compression methods and compression level requested.
1264
1265 Note that offloading relies on SSH compression to reduce bandwidth usage
1266 when transferring files to and from build machines.
1267
1268 @item @code{daemon-socket} (default: @code{"/var/guix/daemon-socket/socket"})
1269 File name of the Unix-domain socket @command{guix-daemon} is listening
1270 to on that machine.
1271
1272 @item @code{overload-threshold} (default: @code{0.6})
1273 The load threshold above which a potential offload machine is
1274 disregarded by the offload scheduler. The value roughly translates to
1275 the total processor usage of the build machine, ranging from 0.0 (0%) to
1276 1.0 (100%). It can also be disabled by setting
1277 @code{overload-threshold} to @code{#f}.
1278
1279 @item @code{parallel-builds} (default: @code{1})
1280 The number of builds that may run in parallel on the machine.
1281
1282 @item @code{speed} (default: @code{1.0})
1283 A ``relative speed factor''. The offload scheduler will tend to prefer
1284 machines with a higher speed factor.
1285
1286 @item @code{features} (default: @code{'()})
1287 A list of strings denoting specific features supported by the machine.
1288 An example is @code{"kvm"} for machines that have the KVM Linux modules
1289 and corresponding hardware support. Derivations can request features by
1290 name, and they will be scheduled on matching build machines.
1291
1292 @end table
1293 @end deftp
1294
1295 The @command{guix} command must be in the search path on the build
1296 machines. You can check whether this is the case by running:
1297
1298 @example
1299 ssh build-machine guix repl --version
1300 @end example
1301
1302 There is one last thing to do once @file{machines.scm} is in place. As
1303 explained above, when offloading, files are transferred back and forth
1304 between the machine stores. For this to work, you first need to
1305 generate a key pair on each machine to allow the daemon to export signed
1306 archives of files from the store (@pxref{Invoking guix archive}):
1307
1308 @example
1309 # guix archive --generate-key
1310 @end example
1311
1312 @noindent
1313 Each build machine must authorize the key of the master machine so that
1314 it accepts store items it receives from the master:
1315
1316 @example
1317 # guix archive --authorize < master-public-key.txt
1318 @end example
1319
1320 @noindent
1321 Likewise, the master machine must authorize the key of each build machine.
1322
1323 All the fuss with keys is here to express pairwise mutual trust
1324 relations between the master and the build machines. Concretely, when
1325 the master receives files from a build machine (and @i{vice versa}), its
1326 build daemon can make sure they are genuine, have not been tampered
1327 with, and that they are signed by an authorized key.
1328
1329 @cindex offload test
1330 To test whether your setup is operational, run this command on the
1331 master node:
1332
1333 @example
1334 # guix offload test
1335 @end example
1336
1337 This will attempt to connect to each of the build machines specified in
1338 @file{/etc/guix/machines.scm}, make sure Guix is
1339 available on each machine, attempt to export to the machine and import
1340 from it, and report any error in the process.
1341
1342 If you want to test a different machine file, just specify it on the
1343 command line:
1344
1345 @example
1346 # guix offload test machines-qualif.scm
1347 @end example
1348
1349 Last, you can test the subset of the machines whose name matches a
1350 regular expression like this:
1351
1352 @example
1353 # guix offload test machines.scm '\.gnu\.org$'
1354 @end example
1355
1356 @cindex offload status
1357 To display the current load of all build hosts, run this command on the
1358 main node:
1359
1360 @example
1361 # guix offload status
1362 @end example
1363
1364
1365 @node SELinux Support
1366 @subsection SELinux Support
1367
1368 @cindex SELinux, daemon policy
1369 @cindex mandatory access control, SELinux
1370 @cindex security, guix-daemon
1371 Guix includes an SELinux policy file at @file{etc/guix-daemon.cil} that
1372 can be installed on a system where SELinux is enabled, in order to label
1373 Guix files and to specify the expected behavior of the daemon. Since
1374 Guix System does not provide an SELinux base policy, the daemon policy cannot
1375 be used on Guix System.
1376
1377 @subsubsection Installing the SELinux policy
1378 @cindex SELinux, policy installation
1379 To install the policy run this command as root:
1380
1381 @example
1382 semodule -i etc/guix-daemon.cil
1383 @end example
1384
1385 Then relabel the file system with @code{restorecon} or by a different
1386 mechanism provided by your system.
1387
1388 Once the policy is installed, the file system has been relabeled, and
1389 the daemon has been restarted, it should be running in the
1390 @code{guix_daemon_t} context. You can confirm this with the following
1391 command:
1392
1393 @example
1394 ps -Zax | grep guix-daemon
1395 @end example
1396
1397 Monitor the SELinux log files as you run a command like @code{guix build
1398 hello} to convince yourself that SELinux permits all necessary
1399 operations.
1400
1401 @subsubsection Limitations
1402 @cindex SELinux, limitations
1403
1404 This policy is not perfect. Here is a list of limitations or quirks
1405 that should be considered when deploying the provided SELinux policy for
1406 the Guix daemon.
1407
1408 @enumerate
1409 @item
1410 @code{guix_daemon_socket_t} isn’t actually used. None of the socket
1411 operations involve contexts that have anything to do with
1412 @code{guix_daemon_socket_t}. It doesn’t hurt to have this unused label,
1413 but it would be preferrable to define socket rules for only this label.
1414
1415 @item
1416 @code{guix gc} cannot access arbitrary links to profiles. By design,
1417 the file label of the destination of a symlink is independent of the
1418 file label of the link itself. Although all profiles under
1419 $localstatedir are labelled, the links to these profiles inherit the
1420 label of the directory they are in. For links in the user’s home
1421 directory this will be @code{user_home_t}. But for links from the root
1422 user’s home directory, or @file{/tmp}, or the HTTP server’s working
1423 directory, etc, this won’t work. @code{guix gc} would be prevented from
1424 reading and following these links.
1425
1426 @item
1427 The daemon’s feature to listen for TCP connections might no longer work.
1428 This might require extra rules, because SELinux treats network sockets
1429 differently from files.
1430
1431 @item
1432 Currently all files with a name matching the regular expression
1433 @code{/gnu/store/.+-(guix-.+|profile)/bin/guix-daemon} are assigned the
1434 label @code{guix_daemon_exec_t}; this means that @emph{any} file with
1435 that name in any profile would be permitted to run in the
1436 @code{guix_daemon_t} domain. This is not ideal. An attacker could
1437 build a package that provides this executable and convince a user to
1438 install and run it, which lifts it into the @code{guix_daemon_t} domain.
1439 At that point SELinux could not prevent it from accessing files that are
1440 allowed for processes in that domain.
1441
1442 You will need to relabel the store directory after all upgrades to
1443 @file{guix-daemon}, such as after running @code{guix pull}. Assuming the
1444 store is in @file{/gnu}, you can do this with @code{restorecon -vR /gnu},
1445 or by other means provided by your operating system.
1446
1447 We could generate a much more restrictive policy at installation time,
1448 so that only the @emph{exact} file name of the currently installed
1449 @code{guix-daemon} executable would be labelled with
1450 @code{guix_daemon_exec_t}, instead of using a broad regular expression.
1451 The downside is that root would have to install or upgrade the policy at
1452 installation time whenever the Guix package that provides the
1453 effectively running @code{guix-daemon} executable is upgraded.
1454 @end enumerate
1455
1456 @node Invoking guix-daemon
1457 @section Invoking @command{guix-daemon}
1458
1459 The @command{guix-daemon} program implements all the functionality to
1460 access the store. This includes launching build processes, running the
1461 garbage collector, querying the availability of a build result, etc. It
1462 is normally run as @code{root} like this:
1463
1464 @example
1465 # guix-daemon --build-users-group=guixbuild
1466 @end example
1467
1468 @noindent
1469 For details on how to set it up, @pxref{Setting Up the Daemon}.
1470
1471 @cindex chroot
1472 @cindex container, build environment
1473 @cindex build environment
1474 @cindex reproducible builds
1475 By default, @command{guix-daemon} launches build processes under
1476 different UIDs, taken from the build group specified with
1477 @option{--build-users-group}. In addition, each build process is run in a
1478 chroot environment that only contains the subset of the store that the
1479 build process depends on, as specified by its derivation
1480 (@pxref{Programming Interface, derivation}), plus a set of specific
1481 system directories. By default, the latter contains @file{/dev} and
1482 @file{/dev/pts}. Furthermore, on GNU/Linux, the build environment is a
1483 @dfn{container}: in addition to having its own file system tree, it has
1484 a separate mount name space, its own PID name space, network name space,
1485 etc. This helps achieve reproducible builds (@pxref{Features}).
1486
1487 When the daemon performs a build on behalf of the user, it creates a
1488 build directory under @file{/tmp} or under the directory specified by
1489 its @env{TMPDIR} environment variable. This directory is shared with
1490 the container for the duration of the build, though within the container,
1491 the build tree is always called @file{/tmp/guix-build-@var{name}.drv-0}.
1492
1493 The build directory is automatically deleted upon completion, unless the
1494 build failed and the client specified @option{--keep-failed}
1495 (@pxref{Invoking guix build, @option{--keep-failed}}).
1496
1497 The daemon listens for connections and spawns one sub-process for each session
1498 started by a client (one of the @command{guix} sub-commands). The
1499 @command{guix processes} command allows you to get an overview of the activity
1500 on your system by viewing each of the active sessions and clients.
1501 @xref{Invoking guix processes}, for more information.
1502
1503 The following command-line options are supported:
1504
1505 @table @code
1506 @item --build-users-group=@var{group}
1507 Take users from @var{group} to run build processes (@pxref{Setting Up
1508 the Daemon, build users}).
1509
1510 @item --no-substitutes
1511 @cindex substitutes
1512 Do not use substitutes for build products. That is, always build things
1513 locally instead of allowing downloads of pre-built binaries
1514 (@pxref{Substitutes}).
1515
1516 When the daemon runs with @option{--no-substitutes}, clients can still
1517 explicitly enable substitution @i{via} the @code{set-build-options}
1518 remote procedure call (@pxref{The Store}).
1519
1520 @anchor{daemon-substitute-urls}
1521 @item --substitute-urls=@var{urls}
1522 Consider @var{urls} the default whitespace-separated list of substitute
1523 source URLs. When this option is omitted,
1524 @indicateurl{https://@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}} is used.
1525
1526 This means that substitutes may be downloaded from @var{urls}, as long
1527 as they are signed by a trusted signature (@pxref{Substitutes}).
1528
1529 @xref{Getting Substitutes from Other Servers}, for more information on
1530 how to configure the daemon to get substitutes from other servers.
1531
1532 @cindex offloading
1533 @item --no-offload
1534 Do not use offload builds to other machines (@pxref{Daemon Offload
1535 Setup}). That is, always build things locally instead of offloading
1536 builds to remote machines.
1537
1538 @item --cache-failures
1539 Cache build failures. By default, only successful builds are cached.
1540
1541 When this option is used, @command{guix gc --list-failures} can be used
1542 to query the set of store items marked as failed; @command{guix gc
1543 --clear-failures} removes store items from the set of cached failures.
1544 @xref{Invoking guix gc}.
1545
1546 @item --cores=@var{n}
1547 @itemx -c @var{n}
1548 Use @var{n} CPU cores to build each derivation; @code{0} means as many
1549 as available.
1550
1551 The default value is @code{0}, but it may be overridden by clients, such
1552 as the @option{--cores} option of @command{guix build} (@pxref{Invoking
1553 guix build}).
1554
1555 The effect is to define the @env{NIX_BUILD_CORES} environment variable
1556 in the build process, which can then use it to exploit internal
1557 parallelism---for instance, by running @code{make -j$NIX_BUILD_CORES}.
1558
1559 @item --max-jobs=@var{n}
1560 @itemx -M @var{n}
1561 Allow at most @var{n} build jobs in parallel. The default value is
1562 @code{1}. Setting it to @code{0} means that no builds will be performed
1563 locally; instead, the daemon will offload builds (@pxref{Daemon Offload
1564 Setup}), or simply fail.
1565
1566 @item --max-silent-time=@var{seconds}
1567 When the build or substitution process remains silent for more than
1568 @var{seconds}, terminate it and report a build failure.
1569
1570 The default value is @code{0}, which disables the timeout.
1571
1572 The value specified here can be overridden by clients (@pxref{Common
1573 Build Options, @option{--max-silent-time}}).
1574
1575 @item --timeout=@var{seconds}
1576 Likewise, when the build or substitution process lasts for more than
1577 @var{seconds}, terminate it and report a build failure.
1578
1579 The default value is @code{0}, which disables the timeout.
1580
1581 The value specified here can be overridden by clients (@pxref{Common
1582 Build Options, @option{--timeout}}).
1583
1584 @item --rounds=@var{N}
1585 Build each derivation @var{n} times in a row, and raise an error if
1586 consecutive build results are not bit-for-bit identical. Note that this
1587 setting can be overridden by clients such as @command{guix build}
1588 (@pxref{Invoking guix build}).
1589
1590 When used in conjunction with @option{--keep-failed}, the differing
1591 output is kept in the store, under @file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-check}.
1592 This makes it easy to look for differences between the two results.
1593
1594 @item --debug
1595 Produce debugging output.
1596
1597 This is useful to debug daemon start-up issues, but then it may be
1598 overridden by clients, for example the @option{--verbosity} option of
1599 @command{guix build} (@pxref{Invoking guix build}).
1600
1601 @item --chroot-directory=@var{dir}
1602 Add @var{dir} to the build chroot.
1603
1604 Doing this may change the result of build processes---for instance if
1605 they use optional dependencies found in @var{dir} when it is available,
1606 and not otherwise. For that reason, it is not recommended to do so.
1607 Instead, make sure that each derivation declares all the inputs that it
1608 needs.
1609
1610 @item --disable-chroot
1611 Disable chroot builds.
1612
1613 Using this option is not recommended since, again, it would allow build
1614 processes to gain access to undeclared dependencies. It is necessary,
1615 though, when @command{guix-daemon} is running under an unprivileged user
1616 account.
1617
1618 @item --log-compression=@var{type}
1619 Compress build logs according to @var{type}, one of @code{gzip},
1620 @code{bzip2}, or @code{none}.
1621
1622 Unless @option{--lose-logs} is used, all the build logs are kept in the
1623 @var{localstatedir}. To save space, the daemon automatically compresses
1624 them with Bzip2 by default.
1625
1626 @item --discover[=yes|no]
1627 Whether to discover substitute servers on the local network using mDNS
1628 and DNS-SD.
1629
1630 This feature is still experimental. However, here are a few
1631 considerations.
1632
1633 @enumerate
1634 @item
1635 It might be faster/less expensive than fetching from remote servers;
1636 @item
1637 There are no security risks, only genuine substitutes will be used
1638 (@pxref{Substitute Authentication});
1639 @item
1640 An attacker advertising @command{guix publish} on your LAN cannot serve
1641 you malicious binaries, but they can learn what software you’re
1642 installing;
1643 @item
1644 Servers may serve substitute over HTTP, unencrypted, so anyone on the
1645 LAN can see what software you’re installing.
1646 @end enumerate
1647
1648 It is also possible to enable or disable substitute server discovery at
1649 run-time by running:
1650
1651 @example
1652 herd discover guix-daemon on
1653 herd discover guix-daemon off
1654 @end example
1655
1656 @item --disable-deduplication
1657 @cindex deduplication
1658 Disable automatic file ``deduplication'' in the store.
1659
1660 By default, files added to the store are automatically ``deduplicated'':
1661 if a newly added file is identical to another one found in the store,
1662 the daemon makes the new file a hard link to the other file. This can
1663 noticeably reduce disk usage, at the expense of slightly increased
1664 input/output load at the end of a build process. This option disables
1665 this optimization.
1666
1667 @item --gc-keep-outputs[=yes|no]
1668 Tell whether the garbage collector (GC) must keep outputs of live
1669 derivations.
1670
1671 @cindex GC roots
1672 @cindex garbage collector roots
1673 When set to @code{yes}, the GC will keep the outputs of any live
1674 derivation available in the store---the @file{.drv} files. The default
1675 is @code{no}, meaning that derivation outputs are kept only if they are
1676 reachable from a GC root. @xref{Invoking guix gc}, for more on GC
1677 roots.
1678
1679 @item --gc-keep-derivations[=yes|no]
1680 Tell whether the garbage collector (GC) must keep derivations
1681 corresponding to live outputs.
1682
1683 When set to @code{yes}, as is the case by default, the GC keeps
1684 derivations---i.e., @file{.drv} files---as long as at least one of their
1685 outputs is live. This allows users to keep track of the origins of
1686 items in their store. Setting it to @code{no} saves a bit of disk
1687 space.
1688
1689 In this way, setting @option{--gc-keep-derivations} to @code{yes} causes
1690 liveness to flow from outputs to derivations, and setting
1691 @option{--gc-keep-outputs} to @code{yes} causes liveness to flow from
1692 derivations to outputs. When both are set to @code{yes}, the effect is
1693 to keep all the build prerequisites (the sources, compiler, libraries,
1694 and other build-time tools) of live objects in the store, regardless of
1695 whether these prerequisites are reachable from a GC root. This is
1696 convenient for developers since it saves rebuilds or downloads.
1697
1698 @item --impersonate-linux-2.6
1699 On Linux-based systems, impersonate Linux 2.6. This means that the
1700 kernel's @command{uname} system call will report 2.6 as the release number.
1701
1702 This might be helpful to build programs that (usually wrongfully) depend
1703 on the kernel version number.
1704
1705 @item --lose-logs
1706 Do not keep build logs. By default they are kept under
1707 @file{@var{localstatedir}/guix/log}.
1708
1709 @item --system=@var{system}
1710 Assume @var{system} as the current system type. By default it is the
1711 architecture/kernel pair found at configure time, such as
1712 @code{x86_64-linux}.
1713
1714 @item --listen=@var{endpoint}
1715 Listen for connections on @var{endpoint}. @var{endpoint} is interpreted
1716 as the file name of a Unix-domain socket if it starts with
1717 @code{/} (slash sign). Otherwise, @var{endpoint} is interpreted as a
1718 host name or host name and port to listen to. Here are a few examples:
1719
1720 @table @code
1721 @item --listen=/gnu/var/daemon
1722 Listen for connections on the @file{/gnu/var/daemon} Unix-domain socket,
1723 creating it if needed.
1724
1725 @item --listen=localhost
1726 @cindex daemon, remote access
1727 @cindex remote access to the daemon
1728 @cindex daemon, cluster setup
1729 @cindex clusters, daemon setup
1730 Listen for TCP connections on the network interface corresponding to
1731 @code{localhost}, on port 44146.
1732
1733 @item --listen=128.0.0.42:1234
1734 Listen for TCP connections on the network interface corresponding to
1735 @code{128.0.0.42}, on port 1234.
1736 @end table
1737
1738 This option can be repeated multiple times, in which case
1739 @command{guix-daemon} accepts connections on all the specified
1740 endpoints. Users can tell client commands what endpoint to connect to
1741 by setting the @env{GUIX_DAEMON_SOCKET} environment variable
1742 (@pxref{The Store, @env{GUIX_DAEMON_SOCKET}}).
1743
1744 @quotation Note
1745 The daemon protocol is @emph{unauthenticated and unencrypted}. Using
1746 @option{--listen=@var{host}} is suitable on local networks, such as
1747 clusters, where only trusted nodes may connect to the build daemon. In
1748 other cases where remote access to the daemon is needed, we recommend
1749 using Unix-domain sockets along with SSH.
1750 @end quotation
1751
1752 When @option{--listen} is omitted, @command{guix-daemon} listens for
1753 connections on the Unix-domain socket located at
1754 @file{@var{localstatedir}/guix/daemon-socket/socket}.
1755 @end table
1756
1757
1758 @node Application Setup
1759 @section Application Setup
1760
1761 @cindex foreign distro
1762 When using Guix on top of GNU/Linux distribution other than Guix System---a
1763 so-called @dfn{foreign distro}---a few additional steps are needed to
1764 get everything in place. Here are some of them.
1765
1766 @subsection Locales
1767
1768 @anchor{locales-and-locpath}
1769 @cindex locales, when not on Guix System
1770 @vindex LOCPATH
1771 @vindex GUIX_LOCPATH
1772 Packages installed @i{via} Guix will not use the locale data of the
1773 host system. Instead, you must first install one of the locale packages
1774 available with Guix and then define the @env{GUIX_LOCPATH} environment
1775 variable:
1776
1777 @example
1778 $ guix install glibc-locales
1779 $ export GUIX_LOCPATH=$HOME/.guix-profile/lib/locale
1780 @end example
1781
1782 Note that the @code{glibc-locales} package contains data for all the
1783 locales supported by the GNU@tie{}libc and weighs in at around
1784 917@tie{}MiB@. Alternatively, the @code{glibc-utf8-locales} is smaller but
1785 limited to a few UTF-8 locales.
1786
1787 The @env{GUIX_LOCPATH} variable plays a role similar to @env{LOCPATH}
1788 (@pxref{Locale Names, @env{LOCPATH},, libc, The GNU C Library Reference
1789 Manual}). There are two important differences though:
1790
1791 @enumerate
1792 @item
1793 @env{GUIX_LOCPATH} is honored only by the libc in Guix, and not by the libc
1794 provided by foreign distros. Thus, using @env{GUIX_LOCPATH} allows you
1795 to make sure the programs of the foreign distro will not end up loading
1796 incompatible locale data.
1797
1798 @item
1799 libc suffixes each entry of @env{GUIX_LOCPATH} with @code{/X.Y}, where
1800 @code{X.Y} is the libc version---e.g., @code{2.22}. This means that,
1801 should your Guix profile contain a mixture of programs linked against
1802 different libc version, each libc version will only try to load locale
1803 data in the right format.
1804 @end enumerate
1805
1806 This is important because the locale data format used by different libc
1807 versions may be incompatible.
1808
1809 @subsection Name Service Switch
1810
1811 @cindex name service switch, glibc
1812 @cindex NSS (name service switch), glibc
1813 @cindex nscd (name service caching daemon)
1814 @cindex name service caching daemon (nscd)
1815 When using Guix on a foreign distro, we @emph{strongly recommend} that
1816 the system run the GNU C library's @dfn{name service cache daemon},
1817 @command{nscd}, which should be listening on the
1818 @file{/var/run/nscd/socket} socket. Failing to do that, applications
1819 installed with Guix may fail to look up host names or user accounts, or
1820 may even crash. The next paragraphs explain why.
1821
1822 @cindex @file{nsswitch.conf}
1823 The GNU C library implements a @dfn{name service switch} (NSS), which is
1824 an extensible mechanism for ``name lookups'' in general: host name
1825 resolution, user accounts, and more (@pxref{Name Service Switch,,, libc,
1826 The GNU C Library Reference Manual}).
1827
1828 @cindex Network information service (NIS)
1829 @cindex NIS (Network information service)
1830 Being extensible, the NSS supports @dfn{plugins}, which provide new name
1831 lookup implementations: for example, the @code{nss-mdns} plugin allow
1832 resolution of @code{.local} host names, the @code{nis} plugin allows
1833 user account lookup using the Network information service (NIS), and so
1834 on. These extra ``lookup services'' are configured system-wide in
1835 @file{/etc/nsswitch.conf}, and all the programs running on the system
1836 honor those settings (@pxref{NSS Configuration File,,, libc, The GNU C
1837 Reference Manual}).
1838
1839 When they perform a name lookup---for instance by calling the
1840 @code{getaddrinfo} function in C---applications first try to connect to
1841 the nscd; on success, nscd performs name lookups on their behalf. If
1842 the nscd is not running, then they perform the name lookup by
1843 themselves, by loading the name lookup services into their own address
1844 space and running it. These name lookup services---the
1845 @file{libnss_*.so} files---are @code{dlopen}'d, but they may come from
1846 the host system's C library, rather than from the C library the
1847 application is linked against (the C library coming from Guix).
1848
1849 And this is where the problem is: if your application is linked against
1850 Guix's C library (say, glibc 2.24) and tries to load NSS plugins from
1851 another C library (say, @code{libnss_mdns.so} for glibc 2.22), it will
1852 likely crash or have its name lookups fail unexpectedly.
1853
1854 Running @command{nscd} on the system, among other advantages, eliminates
1855 this binary incompatibility problem because those @code{libnss_*.so}
1856 files are loaded in the @command{nscd} process, not in applications
1857 themselves.
1858
1859 @subsection X11 Fonts
1860
1861 @cindex fonts
1862 The majority of graphical applications use Fontconfig to locate and
1863 load fonts and perform X11-client-side rendering. The @code{fontconfig}
1864 package in Guix looks for fonts in @file{$HOME/.guix-profile}
1865 by default. Thus, to allow graphical applications installed with Guix
1866 to display fonts, you have to install fonts with Guix as well.
1867 Essential font packages include @code{gs-fonts}, @code{font-dejavu}, and
1868 @code{font-gnu-freefont}.
1869
1870 @cindex @code{fc-cache}
1871 @cindex font cache
1872 Once you have installed or removed fonts, or when you notice an
1873 application that does not find fonts, you may need to install Fontconfig
1874 and to force an update of its font cache by running:
1875
1876 @example
1877 guix install fontconfig
1878 fc-cache -rv
1879 @end example
1880
1881 To display text written in Chinese languages, Japanese, or Korean in
1882 graphical applications, consider installing
1883 @code{font-adobe-source-han-sans} or @code{font-wqy-zenhei}. The former
1884 has multiple outputs, one per language family (@pxref{Packages with
1885 Multiple Outputs}). For instance, the following command installs fonts
1886 for Chinese languages:
1887
1888 @example
1889 guix install font-adobe-source-han-sans:cn
1890 @end example
1891
1892 @cindex @code{xterm}
1893 Older programs such as @command{xterm} do not use Fontconfig and instead
1894 rely on server-side font rendering. Such programs require to specify a
1895 full name of a font using XLFD (X Logical Font Description), like this:
1896
1897 @example
1898 -*-dejavu sans-medium-r-normal-*-*-100-*-*-*-*-*-1
1899 @end example
1900
1901 To be able to use such full names for the TrueType fonts installed in
1902 your Guix profile, you need to extend the font path of the X server:
1903
1904 @c Note: 'xset' does not accept symlinks so the trick below arranges to
1905 @c get at the real directory. See <https://bugs.gnu.org/30655>.
1906 @example
1907 xset +fp $(dirname $(readlink -f ~/.guix-profile/share/fonts/truetype/fonts.dir))
1908 @end example
1909
1910 @cindex @code{xlsfonts}
1911 After that, you can run @code{xlsfonts} (from @code{xlsfonts} package)
1912 to make sure your TrueType fonts are listed there.
1913
1914
1915 @subsection X.509 Certificates
1916
1917 @cindex @code{nss-certs}
1918 The @code{nss-certs} package provides X.509 certificates, which allow
1919 programs to authenticate Web servers accessed over HTTPS.
1920
1921 When using Guix on a foreign distro, you can install this package and
1922 define the relevant environment variables so that packages know where to
1923 look for certificates. @xref{X.509 Certificates}, for detailed
1924 information.
1925
1926 @subsection Emacs Packages
1927
1928 @cindex @code{emacs}
1929 When you install Emacs packages with Guix, the Elisp files are placed
1930 under the @file{share/emacs/site-lisp/} directory of the profile in
1931 which they are installed. The Elisp libraries are made available to
1932 Emacs through the @env{EMACSLOADPATH} environment variable, which is
1933 set when installing Emacs itself.
1934
1935 Additionally, autoload definitions are automatically evaluated at the
1936 initialization of Emacs, by the Guix-specific
1937 @code{guix-emacs-autoload-packages} procedure. If, for some reason, you
1938 want to avoid auto-loading the Emacs packages installed with Guix, you
1939 can do so by running Emacs with the @option{--no-site-file} option
1940 (@pxref{Init File,,, emacs, The GNU Emacs Manual}).
1941
1942
1943 @node Upgrading Guix
1944 @section Upgrading Guix
1945
1946 @cindex Upgrading Guix, on a foreign distro
1947
1948 To upgrade Guix, run:
1949
1950 @example
1951 guix pull
1952 @end example
1953
1954 @xref{Invoking guix pull}, for more information.
1955
1956 @cindex upgrading Guix for the root user, on a foreign distro
1957 @cindex upgrading the Guix daemon, on a foreign distro
1958 @cindex @command{guix pull} for the root user, on a foreign distro
1959
1960 On a foreign distro, you can upgrade the build daemon by running:
1961
1962 @example
1963 sudo -i guix pull
1964 @end example
1965
1966 @noindent
1967 followed by (assuming your distro uses the systemd service management
1968 tool):
1969
1970 @example
1971 systemctl restart guix-daemon.service
1972 @end example
1973
1974 On Guix System, upgrading the daemon is achieved by reconfiguring the
1975 system (@pxref{Invoking guix system, @code{guix system reconfigure}}).
1976
1977 @c TODO What else?
1978
1979 @c *********************************************************************
1980 @node System Installation
1981 @chapter System Installation
1982
1983 @cindex installing Guix System
1984 @cindex Guix System, installation
1985 This section explains how to install Guix System
1986 on a machine. Guix, as a package manager, can
1987 also be installed on top of a running GNU/Linux system,
1988 @pxref{Installation}.
1989
1990 @ifinfo
1991 @quotation Note
1992 @c This paragraph is for people reading this from tty2 of the
1993 @c installation image.
1994 You are reading this documentation with an Info reader. For details on
1995 how to use it, hit the @key{RET} key (``return'' or ``enter'') on the
1996 link that follows: @pxref{Top, Info reader,, info-stnd, Stand-alone GNU
1997 Info}. Hit @kbd{l} afterwards to come back here.
1998
1999 Alternatively, run @command{info info} in another tty to keep the manual
2000 available.
2001 @end quotation
2002 @end ifinfo
2003
2004 @menu
2005 * Limitations:: What you can expect.
2006 * Hardware Considerations:: Supported hardware.
2007 * USB Stick and DVD Installation:: Preparing the installation medium.
2008 * Preparing for Installation:: Networking, partitioning, etc.
2009 * Guided Graphical Installation:: Easy graphical installation.
2010 * Manual Installation:: Manual installation for wizards.
2011 * After System Installation:: When installation succeeded.
2012 * Installing Guix in a VM:: Guix System playground.
2013 * Building the Installation Image:: How this comes to be.
2014 @end menu
2015
2016 @node Limitations
2017 @section Limitations
2018
2019 We consider Guix System to be ready for a wide range of ``desktop'' and server
2020 use cases. The reliability guarantees it provides---transactional upgrades
2021 and rollbacks, reproducibility---make it a solid foundation.
2022
2023 Nevertheless, before you proceed with the installation, be aware of the
2024 following noteworthy limitations applicable to version @value{VERSION}:
2025
2026 @itemize
2027 @item
2028 More and more system services are provided (@pxref{Services}), but some
2029 may be missing.
2030
2031 @item
2032 GNOME, Xfce, LXDE, and Enlightenment are available (@pxref{Desktop Services}),
2033 as well as a number of X11 window managers. However, KDE is currently
2034 missing.
2035 @end itemize
2036
2037 More than a disclaimer, this is an invitation to report issues (and success
2038 stories!), and to join us in improving it. @xref{Contributing}, for more
2039 info.
2040
2041
2042 @node Hardware Considerations
2043 @section Hardware Considerations
2044
2045 @cindex hardware support on Guix System
2046 GNU@tie{}Guix focuses on respecting the user's computing freedom. It
2047 builds around the kernel Linux-libre, which means that only hardware for
2048 which free software drivers and firmware exist is supported. Nowadays,
2049 a wide range of off-the-shelf hardware is supported on
2050 GNU/Linux-libre---from keyboards to graphics cards to scanners and
2051 Ethernet controllers. Unfortunately, there are still areas where
2052 hardware vendors deny users control over their own computing, and such
2053 hardware is not supported on Guix System.
2054
2055 @cindex WiFi, hardware support
2056 One of the main areas where free drivers or firmware are lacking is WiFi
2057 devices. WiFi devices known to work include those using Atheros chips
2058 (AR9271 and AR7010), which corresponds to the @code{ath9k} Linux-libre
2059 driver, and those using Broadcom/AirForce chips (BCM43xx with
2060 Wireless-Core Revision 5), which corresponds to the @code{b43-open}
2061 Linux-libre driver. Free firmware exists for both and is available
2062 out-of-the-box on Guix System, as part of @code{%base-firmware}
2063 (@pxref{operating-system Reference, @code{firmware}}).
2064
2065 @cindex RYF, Respects Your Freedom
2066 The @uref{https://www.fsf.org/, Free Software Foundation} runs
2067 @uref{https://www.fsf.org/ryf, @dfn{Respects Your Freedom}} (RYF), a
2068 certification program for hardware products that respect your freedom
2069 and your privacy and ensure that you have control over your device. We
2070 encourage you to check the list of RYF-certified devices.
2071
2072 Another useful resource is the @uref{https://www.h-node.org/, H-Node}
2073 web site. It contains a catalog of hardware devices with information
2074 about their support in GNU/Linux.
2075
2076
2077 @node USB Stick and DVD Installation
2078 @section USB Stick and DVD Installation
2079
2080 An ISO-9660 installation image that can be written to a USB stick or
2081 burnt to a DVD can be downloaded from
2082 @indicateurl{@value{BASE-URL}/guix-system-install-@value{VERSION}.x86_64-linux.iso.xz},
2083 where you can replace @code{x86_64-linux} with one of:
2084
2085 @table @code
2086 @item x86_64-linux
2087 for a GNU/Linux system on Intel/AMD-compatible 64-bit CPUs;
2088
2089 @item i686-linux
2090 for a 32-bit GNU/Linux system on Intel-compatible CPUs.
2091 @end table
2092
2093 @c start duplication of authentication part from ``Binary Installation''
2094 Make sure to download the associated @file{.sig} file and to verify the
2095 authenticity of the image against it, along these lines:
2096
2097 @example
2098 $ wget @value{BASE-URL}/guix-system-install-@value{VERSION}.x86_64-linux.iso.xz.sig
2099 $ gpg --verify guix-system-install-@value{VERSION}.x86_64-linux.iso.xz.sig
2100 @end example
2101
2102 If that command fails because you do not have the required public key,
2103 then run this command to import it:
2104
2105 @example
2106 $ wget @value{OPENPGP-SIGNING-KEY-URL} \
2107 -qO - | gpg --import -
2108 @end example
2109
2110 @noindent
2111 and rerun the @code{gpg --verify} command.
2112
2113 Take note that a warning like ``This key is not certified with a trusted
2114 signature!'' is normal.
2115
2116 @c end duplication
2117
2118 This image contains the tools necessary for an installation.
2119 It is meant to be copied @emph{as is} to a large-enough USB stick or DVD.
2120
2121 @unnumberedsubsec Copying to a USB Stick
2122
2123 To copy the image to a USB stick, follow these steps:
2124
2125 @enumerate
2126 @item
2127 Decompress the image using the @command{xz} command:
2128
2129 @example
2130 xz -d guix-system-install-@value{VERSION}.x86_64-linux.iso.xz
2131 @end example
2132
2133 @item
2134 Insert a USB stick of 1@tie{}GiB or more into your machine, and determine
2135 its device name. Assuming that the USB stick is known as @file{/dev/sdX},
2136 copy the image with:
2137
2138 @example
2139 dd if=guix-system-install-@value{VERSION}.x86_64-linux.iso of=/dev/sdX status=progress
2140 sync
2141 @end example
2142
2143 Access to @file{/dev/sdX} usually requires root privileges.
2144 @end enumerate
2145
2146 @unnumberedsubsec Burning on a DVD
2147
2148 To copy the image to a DVD, follow these steps:
2149
2150 @enumerate
2151 @item
2152 Decompress the image using the @command{xz} command:
2153
2154 @example
2155 xz -d guix-system-install-@value{VERSION}.x86_64-linux.iso.xz
2156 @end example
2157
2158 @item
2159 Insert a blank DVD into your machine, and determine
2160 its device name. Assuming that the DVD drive is known as @file{/dev/srX},
2161 copy the image with:
2162
2163 @example
2164 growisofs -dvd-compat -Z /dev/srX=guix-system-install-@value{VERSION}.x86_64-linux.iso
2165 @end example
2166
2167 Access to @file{/dev/srX} usually requires root privileges.
2168 @end enumerate
2169
2170 @unnumberedsubsec Booting
2171
2172 Once this is done, you should be able to reboot the system and boot from
2173 the USB stick or DVD@. The latter usually requires you to get in the
2174 BIOS or UEFI boot menu, where you can choose to boot from the USB stick.
2175 In order to boot from Libreboot, switch to the command mode by pressing
2176 the @kbd{c} key and type @command{search_grub usb}.
2177
2178 @xref{Installing Guix in a VM}, if, instead, you would like to install
2179 Guix System in a virtual machine (VM).
2180
2181
2182 @node Preparing for Installation
2183 @section Preparing for Installation
2184
2185 Once you have booted, you can use the guided graphical installer, which makes
2186 it easy to get started (@pxref{Guided Graphical Installation}). Alternatively,
2187 if you are already familiar with GNU/Linux and if you want more control than
2188 what the graphical installer provides, you can choose the ``manual''
2189 installation process (@pxref{Manual Installation}).
2190
2191 The graphical installer is available on TTY1. You can obtain root shells on
2192 TTYs 3 to 6 by hitting @kbd{ctrl-alt-f3}, @kbd{ctrl-alt-f4}, etc. TTY2 shows
2193 this documentation and you can reach it with @kbd{ctrl-alt-f2}. Documentation
2194 is browsable using the Info reader commands (@pxref{Top,,, info-stnd,
2195 Stand-alone GNU Info}). The installation system runs the GPM mouse daemon,
2196 which allows you to select text with the left mouse button and to paste it
2197 with the middle button.
2198
2199 @quotation Note
2200 Installation requires access to the Internet so that any missing
2201 dependencies of your system configuration can be downloaded. See the
2202 ``Networking'' section below.
2203 @end quotation
2204
2205 @node Guided Graphical Installation
2206 @section Guided Graphical Installation
2207
2208 The graphical installer is a text-based user interface. It will guide you,
2209 with dialog boxes, through the steps needed to install GNU@tie{}Guix System.
2210
2211 The first dialog boxes allow you to set up the system as you use it during the
2212 installation: you can choose the language, keyboard layout, and set up
2213 networking, which will be used during the installation. The image below shows
2214 the networking dialog.
2215
2216 @image{images/installer-network,5in,, networking setup with the graphical installer}
2217
2218 Later steps allow you to partition your hard disk, as shown in the image
2219 below, to choose whether or not to use encrypted file systems, to enter the
2220 host name and root password, and to create an additional account, among other
2221 things.
2222
2223 @image{images/installer-partitions,5in,, partitioning with the graphical installer}
2224
2225 Note that, at any time, the installer allows you to exit the current
2226 installation step and resume at a previous step, as show in the image below.
2227
2228 @image{images/installer-resume,5in,, resuming the installation process}
2229
2230 Once you're done, the installer produces an operating system configuration and
2231 displays it (@pxref{Using the Configuration System}). At that point you can
2232 hit ``OK'' and installation will proceed. On success, you can reboot into the
2233 new system and enjoy. @xref{After System Installation}, for what's next!
2234
2235
2236 @node Manual Installation
2237 @section Manual Installation
2238
2239 This section describes how you would ``manually'' install GNU@tie{}Guix System
2240 on your machine. This option requires familiarity with GNU/Linux, with the
2241 shell, and with common administration tools. If you think this is not for
2242 you, consider using the guided graphical installer (@pxref{Guided Graphical
2243 Installation}).
2244
2245 The installation system provides root shells on TTYs 3 to 6; press
2246 @kbd{ctrl-alt-f3}, @kbd{ctrl-alt-f4}, and so on to reach them. It includes
2247 many common tools needed to install the system. But it is also a full-blown
2248 Guix System, which means that you can install additional packages, should you
2249 need it, using @command{guix package} (@pxref{Invoking guix package}).
2250
2251 @menu
2252 * Keyboard Layout and Networking and Partitioning:: Initial setup.
2253 * Proceeding with the Installation:: Installing.
2254 @end menu
2255
2256 @node Keyboard Layout and Networking and Partitioning
2257 @subsection Keyboard Layout, Networking, and Partitioning
2258
2259 Before you can install the system, you may want to adjust the keyboard layout,
2260 set up networking, and partition your target hard disk. This section will
2261 guide you through this.
2262
2263 @subsubsection Keyboard Layout
2264
2265 @cindex keyboard layout
2266 The installation image uses the US qwerty keyboard layout. If you want
2267 to change it, you can use the @command{loadkeys} command. For example,
2268 the following command selects the Dvorak keyboard layout:
2269
2270 @example
2271 loadkeys dvorak
2272 @end example
2273
2274 See the files under @file{/run/current-system/profile/share/keymaps} for
2275 a list of available keyboard layouts. Run @command{man loadkeys} for
2276 more information.
2277
2278 @subsubsection Networking
2279
2280 Run the following command to see what your network interfaces are called:
2281
2282 @example
2283 ifconfig -a
2284 @end example
2285
2286 @noindent
2287 @dots{} or, using the GNU/Linux-specific @command{ip} command:
2288
2289 @example
2290 ip address
2291 @end example
2292
2293 @c https://cgit.freedesktop.org/systemd/systemd/tree/src/udev/udev-builtin-net_id.c#n20
2294 Wired interfaces have a name starting with @samp{e}; for example, the
2295 interface corresponding to the first on-board Ethernet controller is
2296 called @samp{eno1}. Wireless interfaces have a name starting with
2297 @samp{w}, like @samp{w1p2s0}.
2298
2299 @table @asis
2300 @item Wired connection
2301 To configure a wired network run the following command, substituting
2302 @var{interface} with the name of the wired interface you want to use.
2303
2304 @example
2305 ifconfig @var{interface} up
2306 @end example
2307
2308 @noindent
2309 @dots{} or, using the GNU/Linux-specific @command{ip} command:
2310
2311 @example
2312 ip link set @var{interface} up
2313 @end example
2314
2315 @item Wireless connection
2316 @cindex wireless
2317 @cindex WiFi
2318 To configure wireless networking, you can create a configuration file
2319 for the @command{wpa_supplicant} configuration tool (its location is not
2320 important) using one of the available text editors such as
2321 @command{nano}:
2322
2323 @example
2324 nano wpa_supplicant.conf
2325 @end example
2326
2327 As an example, the following stanza can go to this file and will work
2328 for many wireless networks, provided you give the actual SSID and
2329 passphrase for the network you are connecting to:
2330
2331 @example
2332 network=@{
2333 ssid="@var{my-ssid}"
2334 key_mgmt=WPA-PSK
2335 psk="the network's secret passphrase"
2336 @}
2337 @end example
2338
2339 Start the wireless service and run it in the background with the
2340 following command (substitute @var{interface} with the name of the
2341 network interface you want to use):
2342
2343 @example
2344 wpa_supplicant -c wpa_supplicant.conf -i @var{interface} -B
2345 @end example
2346
2347 Run @command{man wpa_supplicant} for more information.
2348 @end table
2349
2350 @cindex DHCP
2351 At this point, you need to acquire an IP address. On a network where IP
2352 addresses are automatically assigned @i{via} DHCP, you can run:
2353
2354 @example
2355 dhclient -v @var{interface}
2356 @end example
2357
2358 Try to ping a server to see if networking is up and running:
2359
2360 @example
2361 ping -c 3 gnu.org
2362 @end example
2363
2364 Setting up network access is almost always a requirement because the
2365 image does not contain all the software and tools that may be needed.
2366
2367 @cindex proxy, during system installation
2368 If you need HTTP and HTTPS access to go through a proxy, run the
2369 following command:
2370
2371 @example
2372 herd set-http-proxy guix-daemon @var{URL}
2373 @end example
2374
2375 @noindent
2376 where @var{URL} is the proxy URL, for example
2377 @code{http://example.org:8118}.
2378
2379 @cindex installing over SSH
2380 If you want to, you can continue the installation remotely by starting
2381 an SSH server:
2382
2383 @example
2384 herd start ssh-daemon
2385 @end example
2386
2387 Make sure to either set a password with @command{passwd}, or configure
2388 OpenSSH public key authentication before logging in.
2389
2390 @subsubsection Disk Partitioning
2391
2392 Unless this has already been done, the next step is to partition, and
2393 then format the target partition(s).
2394
2395 The installation image includes several partitioning tools, including
2396 Parted (@pxref{Overview,,, parted, GNU Parted User Manual}),
2397 @command{fdisk}, and @command{cfdisk}. Run it and set up your disk with
2398 the partition layout you want:
2399
2400 @example
2401 cfdisk
2402 @end example
2403
2404 If your disk uses the GUID Partition Table (GPT) format and you plan to
2405 install BIOS-based GRUB (which is the default), make sure a BIOS Boot
2406 Partition is available (@pxref{BIOS installation,,, grub, GNU GRUB
2407 manual}).
2408
2409 @cindex EFI, installation
2410 @cindex UEFI, installation
2411 @cindex ESP, EFI system partition
2412 If you instead wish to use EFI-based GRUB, a FAT32 @dfn{EFI System Partition}
2413 (ESP) is required. This partition can be mounted at @file{/boot/efi} for
2414 instance and must have the @code{esp} flag set. E.g., for @command{parted}:
2415
2416 @example
2417 parted /dev/sda set 1 esp on
2418 @end example
2419
2420 @quotation Note
2421 @vindex grub-bootloader
2422 @vindex grub-efi-bootloader
2423 Unsure whether to use EFI- or BIOS-based GRUB? If the directory
2424 @file{/sys/firmware/efi} exists in the installation image, then you should
2425 probably perform an EFI installation, using @code{grub-efi-bootloader}.
2426 Otherwise you should use the BIOS-based GRUB, known as
2427 @code{grub-bootloader}. @xref{Bootloader Configuration}, for more info on
2428 bootloaders.
2429 @end quotation
2430
2431 Once you are done partitioning the target hard disk drive, you have to
2432 create a file system on the relevant partition(s)@footnote{Currently
2433 Guix System only supports ext4, btrfs, JFS, and F2FS file systems. In
2434 particular, code that reads file system UUIDs and labels only works for these
2435 file system types.}. For the ESP, if you have one and assuming it is
2436 @file{/dev/sda1}, run:
2437
2438 @example
2439 mkfs.fat -F32 /dev/sda1
2440 @end example
2441
2442 For the root file system, ext4 is the most widely used format. Other
2443 file systems, such as Btrfs, support compression, which is reported to
2444 nicely complement file deduplication that the daemon performs
2445 independently of the file system (@pxref{Invoking guix-daemon,
2446 deduplication}).
2447
2448 Preferably, assign file systems a label so that you can easily and
2449 reliably refer to them in @code{file-system} declarations (@pxref{File
2450 Systems}). This is typically done using the @code{-L} option of
2451 @command{mkfs.ext4} and related commands. So, assuming the target root
2452 partition lives at @file{/dev/sda2}, a file system with the label
2453 @code{my-root} can be created with:
2454
2455 @example
2456 mkfs.ext4 -L my-root /dev/sda2
2457 @end example
2458
2459 @cindex encrypted disk
2460 If you are instead planning to encrypt the root partition, you can use
2461 the Cryptsetup/LUKS utilities to do that (see @inlinefmtifelse{html,
2462 @uref{https://linux.die.net/man/8/cryptsetup, @code{man cryptsetup}},
2463 @code{man cryptsetup}} for more information). Assuming you want to
2464 store the root partition on @file{/dev/sda2}, the command sequence would
2465 be along these lines:
2466
2467 @example
2468 cryptsetup luksFormat /dev/sda2
2469 cryptsetup open --type luks /dev/sda2 my-partition
2470 mkfs.ext4 -L my-root /dev/mapper/my-partition
2471 @end example
2472
2473 Once that is done, mount the target file system under @file{/mnt}
2474 with a command like (again, assuming @code{my-root} is the label of the
2475 root file system):
2476
2477 @example
2478 mount LABEL=my-root /mnt
2479 @end example
2480
2481 Also mount any other file systems you would like to use on the target
2482 system relative to this path. If you have opted for @file{/boot/efi} as an
2483 EFI mount point for example, mount it at @file{/mnt/boot/efi} now so it is
2484 found by @code{guix system init} afterwards.
2485
2486 Finally, if you plan to use one or more swap partitions (@pxref{Memory
2487 Concepts, swap space,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}), make
2488 sure to initialize them with @command{mkswap}. Assuming you have one
2489 swap partition on @file{/dev/sda3}, you would run:
2490
2491 @example
2492 mkswap /dev/sda3
2493 swapon /dev/sda3
2494 @end example
2495
2496 Alternatively, you may use a swap file. For example, assuming that in
2497 the new system you want to use the file @file{/swapfile} as a swap file,
2498 you would run@footnote{This example will work for many types of file
2499 systems (e.g., ext4). However, for copy-on-write file systems (e.g.,
2500 btrfs), the required steps may be different. For details, see the
2501 manual pages for @command{mkswap} and @command{swapon}.}:
2502
2503 @example
2504 # This is 10 GiB of swap space. Adjust "count" to change the size.
2505 dd if=/dev/zero of=/mnt/swapfile bs=1MiB count=10240
2506 # For security, make the file readable and writable only by root.
2507 chmod 600 /mnt/swapfile
2508 mkswap /mnt/swapfile
2509 swapon /mnt/swapfile
2510 @end example
2511
2512 Note that if you have encrypted the root partition and created a swap
2513 file in its file system as described above, then the encryption also
2514 protects the swap file, just like any other file in that file system.
2515
2516 @node Proceeding with the Installation
2517 @subsection Proceeding with the Installation
2518
2519 With the target partitions ready and the target root mounted on
2520 @file{/mnt}, we're ready to go. First, run:
2521
2522 @example
2523 herd start cow-store /mnt
2524 @end example
2525
2526 This makes @file{/gnu/store} copy-on-write, such that packages added to it
2527 during the installation phase are written to the target disk on @file{/mnt}
2528 rather than kept in memory. This is necessary because the first phase of
2529 the @command{guix system init} command (see below) entails downloads or
2530 builds to @file{/gnu/store} which, initially, is an in-memory file system.
2531
2532 Next, you have to edit a file and
2533 provide the declaration of the operating system to be installed. To
2534 that end, the installation system comes with three text editors. We
2535 recommend GNU nano (@pxref{Top,,, nano, GNU nano Manual}), which
2536 supports syntax highlighting and parentheses matching; other editors
2537 include GNU Zile (an Emacs clone), and
2538 nvi (a clone of the original BSD @command{vi} editor).
2539 We strongly recommend storing that file on the target root file system, say,
2540 as @file{/mnt/etc/config.scm}. Failing to do that, you will have lost your
2541 configuration file once you have rebooted into the newly-installed system.
2542
2543 @xref{Using the Configuration System}, for an overview of the
2544 configuration file. The example configurations discussed in that
2545 section are available under @file{/etc/configuration} in the
2546 installation image. Thus, to get started with a system configuration
2547 providing a graphical display server (a ``desktop'' system), you can run
2548 something along these lines:
2549
2550 @example
2551 # mkdir /mnt/etc
2552 # cp /etc/configuration/desktop.scm /mnt/etc/config.scm
2553 # nano /mnt/etc/config.scm
2554 @end example
2555
2556 You should pay attention to what your configuration file contains, and
2557 in particular:
2558
2559 @itemize
2560 @item
2561 Make sure the @code{bootloader-configuration} form refers to the target
2562 you want to install GRUB on. It should mention @code{grub-bootloader} if
2563 you are installing GRUB in the legacy way, or @code{grub-efi-bootloader}
2564 for newer UEFI systems. For legacy systems, the @code{target} field
2565 names a device, like @code{/dev/sda}; for UEFI systems it names a path
2566 to a mounted EFI partition, like @code{/boot/efi}; do make sure the path is
2567 currently mounted and a @code{file-system} entry is specified in your
2568 configuration.
2569
2570 @item
2571 Be sure that your file system labels match the value of their respective
2572 @code{device} fields in your @code{file-system} configuration, assuming
2573 your @code{file-system} configuration uses the @code{file-system-label}
2574 procedure in its @code{device} field.
2575
2576 @item
2577 If there are encrypted or RAID partitions, make sure to add a
2578 @code{mapped-devices} field to describe them (@pxref{Mapped Devices}).
2579 @end itemize
2580
2581 Once you are done preparing the configuration file, the new system must
2582 be initialized (remember that the target root file system is mounted
2583 under @file{/mnt}):
2584
2585 @example
2586 guix system init /mnt/etc/config.scm /mnt
2587 @end example
2588
2589 @noindent
2590 This copies all the necessary files and installs GRUB on
2591 @file{/dev/sdX}, unless you pass the @option{--no-bootloader} option. For
2592 more information, @pxref{Invoking guix system}. This command may trigger
2593 downloads or builds of missing packages, which can take some time.
2594
2595 Once that command has completed---and hopefully succeeded!---you can run
2596 @command{reboot} and boot into the new system. The @code{root} password
2597 in the new system is initially empty; other users' passwords need to be
2598 initialized by running the @command{passwd} command as @code{root},
2599 unless your configuration specifies otherwise
2600 (@pxref{user-account-password, user account passwords}).
2601 @xref{After System Installation}, for what's next!
2602
2603
2604 @node After System Installation
2605 @section After System Installation
2606
2607 Success, you've now booted into Guix System! From then on, you can update the
2608 system whenever you want by running, say:
2609
2610 @example
2611 guix pull
2612 sudo guix system reconfigure /etc/config.scm
2613 @end example
2614
2615 @noindent
2616 This builds a new system generation with the latest packages and services
2617 (@pxref{Invoking guix system}). We recommend doing that regularly so that
2618 your system includes the latest security updates (@pxref{Security Updates}).
2619
2620 @c See <https://lists.gnu.org/archive/html/guix-devel/2019-01/msg00268.html>.
2621 @quotation Note
2622 @cindex sudo vs. @command{guix pull}
2623 Note that @command{sudo guix} runs your user's @command{guix} command and
2624 @emph{not} root's, because @command{sudo} leaves @env{PATH} unchanged. To
2625 explicitly run root's @command{guix}, type @command{sudo -i guix @dots{}}.
2626
2627 The difference matters here, because @command{guix pull} updates
2628 the @command{guix} command and package definitions only for the user it is ran
2629 as. This means that if you choose to use @command{guix system reconfigure} in
2630 root's login shell, you'll need to @command{guix pull} separately.
2631 @end quotation
2632
2633 Now, @pxref{Getting Started}, and
2634 join us on @code{#guix} on the Freenode IRC network or on
2635 @email{guix-devel@@gnu.org} to share your experience!
2636
2637
2638 @node Installing Guix in a VM
2639 @section Installing Guix in a Virtual Machine
2640
2641 @cindex virtual machine, Guix System installation
2642 @cindex virtual private server (VPS)
2643 @cindex VPS (virtual private server)
2644 If you'd like to install Guix System in a virtual machine (VM) or on a
2645 virtual private server (VPS) rather than on your beloved machine, this
2646 section is for you.
2647
2648 To boot a @uref{https://qemu.org/,QEMU} VM for installing Guix System in a
2649 disk image, follow these steps:
2650
2651 @enumerate
2652 @item
2653 First, retrieve and decompress the Guix system installation image as
2654 described previously (@pxref{USB Stick and DVD Installation}).
2655
2656 @item
2657 Create a disk image that will hold the installed system. To make a
2658 qcow2-formatted disk image, use the @command{qemu-img} command:
2659
2660 @example
2661 qemu-img create -f qcow2 guix-system.img 50G
2662 @end example
2663
2664 The resulting file will be much smaller than 50 GB (typically less than
2665 1 MB), but it will grow as the virtualized storage device is filled up.
2666
2667 @item
2668 Boot the USB installation image in an VM:
2669
2670 @example
2671 qemu-system-x86_64 -m 1024 -smp 1 -enable-kvm \
2672 -nic user,model=virtio-net-pci -boot menu=on,order=d \
2673 -drive file=guix-system.img \
2674 -drive media=cdrom,file=guix-system-install-@value{VERSION}.@var{system}.iso
2675 @end example
2676
2677 @code{-enable-kvm} is optional, but significantly improves performance,
2678 @pxref{Running Guix in a VM}.
2679
2680 @item
2681 You're now root in the VM, proceed with the installation process.
2682 @xref{Preparing for Installation}, and follow the instructions.
2683 @end enumerate
2684
2685 Once installation is complete, you can boot the system that's on your
2686 @file{guix-system.img} image. @xref{Running Guix in a VM}, for how to do
2687 that.
2688
2689 @node Building the Installation Image
2690 @section Building the Installation Image
2691
2692 @cindex installation image
2693 The installation image described above was built using the @command{guix
2694 system} command, specifically:
2695
2696 @example
2697 guix system image -t iso9660 gnu/system/install.scm
2698 @end example
2699
2700 Have a look at @file{gnu/system/install.scm} in the source tree,
2701 and see also @ref{Invoking guix system} for more information
2702 about the installation image.
2703
2704 @section Building the Installation Image for ARM Boards
2705
2706 Many ARM boards require a specific variant of the
2707 @uref{https://www.denx.de/wiki/U-Boot/, U-Boot} bootloader.
2708
2709 If you build a disk image and the bootloader is not available otherwise
2710 (on another boot drive etc), it's advisable to build an image that
2711 includes the bootloader, specifically:
2712
2713 @example
2714 guix system image --system=armhf-linux -e '((@@ (gnu system install) os-with-u-boot) (@@ (gnu system install) installation-os) "A20-OLinuXino-Lime2")'
2715 @end example
2716
2717 @code{A20-OLinuXino-Lime2} is the name of the board. If you specify an invalid
2718 board, a list of possible boards will be printed.
2719
2720 @c *********************************************************************
2721 @node Getting Started
2722 @chapter Getting Started
2723
2724 Presumably, you've reached this section because either you have
2725 installed Guix on top of another distribution (@pxref{Installation}), or
2726 you've installed the standalone Guix System (@pxref{System
2727 Installation}). It's time for you to get started using Guix and this
2728 section aims to help you do that and give you a feel of what it's like.
2729
2730 Guix is about installing software, so probably the first thing you'll
2731 want to do is to actually look for software. Let's say you're looking
2732 for a text editor, you can run:
2733
2734 @example
2735 guix search text editor
2736 @end example
2737
2738 This command shows you a number of matching @dfn{packages}, each time
2739 showing the package's name, version, a description, and additional info.
2740 Once you've found out the one you want to use, let's say Emacs (ah ha!),
2741 you can go ahead and install it (run this command as a regular user,
2742 @emph{no need for root privileges}!):
2743
2744 @example
2745 guix install emacs
2746 @end example
2747
2748 You've installed your first package, congrats! In the process, you've
2749 probably noticed that Guix downloaded pre-built binaries; or, if you
2750 explicitly chose to @emph{not} use pre-built binaries, then probably
2751 Guix is still building software (@pxref{Substitutes}, for more info).
2752
2753 Unless you're using Guix System, the @command{guix install} command must
2754 have printed this hint:
2755
2756 @example
2757 hint: Consider setting the necessary environment variables by running:
2758
2759 GUIX_PROFILE="$HOME/.guix-profile"
2760 . "$GUIX_PROFILE/etc/profile"
2761
2762 Alternately, see `guix package --search-paths -p "$HOME/.guix-profile"'.
2763 @end example
2764
2765 Indeed, you must now tell your shell where @command{emacs} and other
2766 programs installed with Guix are to be found. Pasting the two lines
2767 above will do just that: it will add
2768 @code{$HOME/.guix-profile/bin}---which is where the installed package
2769 is---to the @code{PATH} environment variable. You can paste these two
2770 lines in your shell so they take effect right away, but more importantly
2771 you should add them to @file{~/.bash_profile} (or equivalent file if you
2772 do not use Bash) so that environment variables are set next time you
2773 spawn a shell. You only need to do this once and other search paths
2774 environment variables will be taken care of similarly---e.g., if you
2775 eventually install @code{python} and Python libraries, @code{PYTHONPATH}
2776 will be defined.
2777
2778 You can go on installing packages at your will. To list installed
2779 packages, run:
2780
2781 @example
2782 guix package --list-installed
2783 @end example
2784
2785 To remove a package, you would unsurprisingly run @command{guix remove}.
2786 A distinguishing feature is the ability to @dfn{roll back} any operation
2787 you made---installation, removal, upgrade---by simply typing:
2788
2789 @example
2790 guix package --roll-back
2791 @end example
2792
2793 This is because each operation is in fact a @dfn{transaction} that
2794 creates a new @dfn{generation}. These generations and the difference
2795 between them can be displayed by running:
2796
2797 @example
2798 guix package --list-generations
2799 @end example
2800
2801 Now you know the basics of package management!
2802
2803 @quotation Going further
2804 @xref{Package Management}, for more about package management. You may
2805 like @dfn{declarative} package management with @command{guix package
2806 --manifest}, managing separate @dfn{profiles} with @option{--profile},
2807 deleting old generations, collecting garbage, and other nifty features
2808 that will come in handy as you become more familiar with Guix. If you
2809 are a developer, @pxref{Development} for additional tools. And if
2810 you're curious, @pxref{Features}, to peek under the hood.
2811 @end quotation
2812
2813 Once you've installed a set of packages, you will want to periodically
2814 @emph{upgrade} them to the latest and greatest version. To do that, you
2815 will first pull the latest revision of Guix and its package collection:
2816
2817 @example
2818 guix pull
2819 @end example
2820
2821 The end result is a new @command{guix} command, under
2822 @file{~/.config/guix/current/bin}. Unless you're on Guix System, the
2823 first time you run @command{guix pull}, be sure to follow the hint that
2824 the command prints and, similar to what we saw above, paste these two
2825 lines in your terminal and @file{.bash_profile}:
2826
2827 @example
2828 GUIX_PROFILE="$HOME/.config/guix/current"
2829 . "$GUIX_PROFILE/etc/profile"
2830 @end example
2831
2832 @noindent
2833 You must also instruct your shell to point to this new @command{guix}:
2834
2835 @example
2836 hash guix
2837 @end example
2838
2839 At this point, you're running a brand new Guix. You can thus go ahead
2840 and actually upgrade all the packages you previously installed:
2841
2842 @example
2843 guix upgrade
2844 @end example
2845
2846 As you run this command, you will see that binaries are downloaded (or
2847 perhaps some packages are built), and eventually you end up with the
2848 upgraded packages. Should one of these upgraded packages not be to your
2849 liking, remember you can always roll back!
2850
2851 You can display the exact revision of Guix you're currently using by
2852 running:
2853
2854 @example
2855 guix describe
2856 @end example
2857
2858 The information it displays is @emph{all it takes to reproduce the exact
2859 same Guix}, be it at a different point in time or on a different
2860 machine.
2861
2862 @quotation Going further
2863 @xref{Invoking guix pull}, for more information. @xref{Channels}, on
2864 how to specify additional @dfn{channels} to pull packages from, how to
2865 replicate Guix, and more. You may also find @command{time-machine}
2866 handy (@pxref{Invoking guix time-machine}).
2867 @end quotation
2868
2869 If you installed Guix System, one of the first things you'll want to do
2870 is to upgrade your system. Once you've run @command{guix pull} to get
2871 the latest Guix, you can upgrade the system like this:
2872
2873 @example
2874 sudo guix system reconfigure /etc/config.scm
2875 @end example
2876
2877 Upon completion, the system runs the latest versions of its software
2878 packages. When you eventually reboot, you'll notice a sub-menu in the
2879 bootloader that reads ``Old system generations'': it's what allows you
2880 to boot @emph{an older generation of your system}, should the latest
2881 generation be ``broken'' or otherwise unsatisfying. Just like for
2882 packages, you can always @emph{roll back} to a previous generation
2883 @emph{of the whole system}:
2884
2885 @example
2886 sudo guix system roll-back
2887 @end example
2888
2889 There are many things you'll probably want to tweak on your system:
2890 adding new user accounts, adding new system services, fiddling with the
2891 configuration of those services, etc. The system configuration is
2892 @emph{entirely} described in the @file{/etc/config.scm} file.
2893 @xref{Using the Configuration System}, to learn how to change it.
2894
2895 Now you know enough to get started!
2896
2897 @quotation Resources
2898 The rest of this manual provides a reference for all things Guix. Here
2899 are some additional resources you may find useful:
2900
2901 @itemize
2902 @item
2903 @xref{Top,,, guix-cookbook, The GNU Guix Cookbook}, for a list of
2904 ``how-to'' style of recipes for a variety of applications.
2905
2906 @item
2907 The @uref{https://guix.gnu.org/guix-refcard.pdf, GNU Guix Reference
2908 Card} lists in two pages most of the commands and options you'll ever
2909 need.
2910
2911 @item
2912 The web site contains @uref{https://guix.gnu.org/en/videos/,
2913 instructional videos} covering topics such as everyday use of Guix, how
2914 to get help, and how to become a contributor.
2915
2916 @item
2917 @xref{Documentation}, to learn how to access documentation on your
2918 computer.
2919 @end itemize
2920
2921 We hope you will enjoy Guix as much as the community enjoys building it!
2922 @end quotation
2923
2924 @c *********************************************************************
2925 @node Package Management
2926 @chapter Package Management
2927
2928 @cindex packages
2929 The purpose of GNU Guix is to allow users to easily install, upgrade, and
2930 remove software packages, without having to know about their build
2931 procedures or dependencies. Guix also goes beyond this obvious set of
2932 features.
2933
2934 This chapter describes the main features of Guix, as well as the
2935 package management tools it provides. Along with the command-line
2936 interface described below (@pxref{Invoking guix package, @code{guix
2937 package}}), you may also use the Emacs-Guix interface (@pxref{Top,,,
2938 emacs-guix, The Emacs-Guix Reference Manual}), after installing
2939 @code{emacs-guix} package (run @kbd{M-x guix-help} command to start
2940 with it):
2941
2942 @example
2943 guix install emacs-guix
2944 @end example
2945
2946 @menu
2947 * Features:: How Guix will make your life brighter.
2948 * Invoking guix package:: Package installation, removal, etc.
2949 * Substitutes:: Downloading pre-built binaries.
2950 * Packages with Multiple Outputs:: Single source package, multiple outputs.
2951 * Invoking guix gc:: Running the garbage collector.
2952 * Invoking guix pull:: Fetching the latest Guix and distribution.
2953 * Invoking guix time-machine:: Running an older revision of Guix.
2954 * Inferiors:: Interacting with another revision of Guix.
2955 * Invoking guix describe:: Display information about your Guix revision.
2956 * Invoking guix archive:: Exporting and importing store files.
2957 @end menu
2958
2959 @node Features
2960 @section Features
2961
2962 Here we assume you've already made your first steps with Guix
2963 (@pxref{Getting Started}) and would like to get an overview about what's
2964 going on under the hood.
2965
2966 When using Guix, each package ends up in the @dfn{package store}, in its
2967 own directory---something that resembles
2968 @file{/gnu/store/xxx-package-1.2}, where @code{xxx} is a base32 string.
2969
2970 Instead of referring to these directories, users have their own
2971 @dfn{profile}, which points to the packages that they actually want to
2972 use. These profiles are stored within each user's home directory, at
2973 @code{$HOME/.guix-profile}.
2974
2975 For example, @code{alice} installs GCC 4.7.2. As a result,
2976 @file{/home/alice/.guix-profile/bin/gcc} points to
2977 @file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-gcc-4.7.2/bin/gcc}. Now, on the same machine,
2978 @code{bob} had already installed GCC 4.8.0. The profile of @code{bob}
2979 simply continues to point to
2980 @file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-gcc-4.8.0/bin/gcc}---i.e., both versions of GCC
2981 coexist on the same system without any interference.
2982
2983 The @command{guix package} command is the central tool to manage
2984 packages (@pxref{Invoking guix package}). It operates on the per-user
2985 profiles, and can be used @emph{with normal user privileges}.
2986
2987 @cindex transactions
2988 The command provides the obvious install, remove, and upgrade
2989 operations. Each invocation is actually a @emph{transaction}: either
2990 the specified operation succeeds, or nothing happens. Thus, if the
2991 @command{guix package} process is terminated during the transaction,
2992 or if a power outage occurs during the transaction, then the user's
2993 profile remains in its previous state, and remains usable.
2994
2995 In addition, any package transaction may be @emph{rolled back}. So, if,
2996 for example, an upgrade installs a new version of a package that turns
2997 out to have a serious bug, users may roll back to the previous instance
2998 of their profile, which was known to work well. Similarly, the global
2999 system configuration on Guix is subject to
3000 transactional upgrades and roll-back
3001 (@pxref{Using the Configuration System}).
3002
3003 All packages in the package store may be @emph{garbage-collected}.
3004 Guix can determine which packages are still referenced by user
3005 profiles, and remove those that are provably no longer referenced
3006 (@pxref{Invoking guix gc}). Users may also explicitly remove old
3007 generations of their profile so that the packages they refer to can be
3008 collected.
3009
3010 @cindex reproducibility
3011 @cindex reproducible builds
3012 Guix takes a @dfn{purely functional} approach to package
3013 management, as described in the introduction (@pxref{Introduction}).
3014 Each @file{/gnu/store} package directory name contains a hash of all the
3015 inputs that were used to build that package---compiler, libraries, build
3016 scripts, etc. This direct correspondence allows users to make sure a
3017 given package installation matches the current state of their
3018 distribution. It also helps maximize @dfn{build reproducibility}:
3019 thanks to the isolated build environments that are used, a given build
3020 is likely to yield bit-identical files when performed on different
3021 machines (@pxref{Invoking guix-daemon, container}).
3022
3023 @cindex substitutes
3024 This foundation allows Guix to support @dfn{transparent binary/source
3025 deployment}. When a pre-built binary for a @file{/gnu/store} item is
3026 available from an external source---a @dfn{substitute}, Guix just
3027 downloads it and unpacks it;
3028 otherwise, it builds the package from source, locally
3029 (@pxref{Substitutes}). Because build results are usually bit-for-bit
3030 reproducible, users do not have to trust servers that provide
3031 substitutes: they can force a local build and @emph{challenge} providers
3032 (@pxref{Invoking guix challenge}).
3033
3034 Control over the build environment is a feature that is also useful for
3035 developers. The @command{guix environment} command allows developers of
3036 a package to quickly set up the right development environment for their
3037 package, without having to manually install the dependencies of the
3038 package into their profile (@pxref{Invoking guix environment}).
3039
3040 @cindex replication, of software environments
3041 @cindex provenance tracking, of software artifacts
3042 All of Guix and its package definitions is version-controlled, and
3043 @command{guix pull} allows you to ``travel in time'' on the history of Guix
3044 itself (@pxref{Invoking guix pull}). This makes it possible to replicate a
3045 Guix instance on a different machine or at a later point in time, which in
3046 turn allows you to @emph{replicate complete software environments}, while
3047 retaining precise @dfn{provenance tracking} of the software.
3048
3049 @node Invoking guix package
3050 @section Invoking @command{guix package}
3051
3052 @cindex installing packages
3053 @cindex removing packages
3054 @cindex package installation
3055 @cindex package removal
3056 The @command{guix package} command is the tool that allows users to
3057 install, upgrade, and remove packages, as well as rolling back to
3058 previous configurations. It operates only on the user's own profile,
3059 and works with normal user privileges (@pxref{Features}). Its syntax
3060 is:
3061
3062 @example
3063 guix package @var{options}
3064 @end example
3065
3066 @cindex transactions
3067 Primarily, @var{options} specifies the operations to be performed during
3068 the transaction. Upon completion, a new profile is created, but
3069 previous @dfn{generations} of the profile remain available, should the user
3070 want to roll back.
3071
3072 For example, to remove @code{lua} and install @code{guile} and
3073 @code{guile-cairo} in a single transaction:
3074
3075 @example
3076 guix package -r lua -i guile guile-cairo
3077 @end example
3078
3079 @cindex aliases, for @command{guix package}
3080 For your convenience, we also provide the following aliases:
3081
3082 @itemize
3083 @item
3084 @command{guix search} is an alias for @command{guix package -s},
3085 @item
3086 @command{guix install} is an alias for @command{guix package -i},
3087 @item
3088 @command{guix remove} is an alias for @command{guix package -r},
3089 @item
3090 @command{guix upgrade} is an alias for @command{guix package -u},
3091 @item
3092 and @command{guix show} is an alias for @command{guix package --show=}.
3093 @end itemize
3094
3095 These aliases are less expressive than @command{guix package} and provide
3096 fewer options, so in some cases you'll probably want to use @command{guix
3097 package} directly.
3098
3099 @command{guix package} also supports a @dfn{declarative approach}
3100 whereby the user specifies the exact set of packages to be available and
3101 passes it @i{via} the @option{--manifest} option
3102 (@pxref{profile-manifest, @option{--manifest}}).
3103
3104 @cindex profile
3105 For each user, a symlink to the user's default profile is automatically
3106 created in @file{$HOME/.guix-profile}. This symlink always points to the
3107 current generation of the user's default profile. Thus, users can add
3108 @file{$HOME/.guix-profile/bin} to their @env{PATH} environment
3109 variable, and so on.
3110 @cindex search paths
3111 If you are not using Guix System, consider adding the
3112 following lines to your @file{~/.bash_profile} (@pxref{Bash Startup
3113 Files,,, bash, The GNU Bash Reference Manual}) so that newly-spawned
3114 shells get all the right environment variable definitions:
3115
3116 @example
3117 GUIX_PROFILE="$HOME/.guix-profile" ; \
3118 source "$GUIX_PROFILE/etc/profile"
3119 @end example
3120
3121 In a multi-user setup, user profiles are stored in a place registered as
3122 a @dfn{garbage-collector root}, which @file{$HOME/.guix-profile} points
3123 to (@pxref{Invoking guix gc}). That directory is normally
3124 @code{@var{localstatedir}/guix/profiles/per-user/@var{user}}, where
3125 @var{localstatedir} is the value passed to @code{configure} as
3126 @option{--localstatedir}, and @var{user} is the user name. The
3127 @file{per-user} directory is created when @command{guix-daemon} is
3128 started, and the @var{user} sub-directory is created by @command{guix
3129 package}.
3130
3131 The @var{options} can be among the following:
3132
3133 @table @code
3134
3135 @item --install=@var{package} @dots{}
3136 @itemx -i @var{package} @dots{}
3137 Install the specified @var{package}s.
3138
3139 Each @var{package} may specify either a simple package name, such as
3140 @code{guile}, or a package name followed by an at-sign and version number,
3141 such as @code{guile@@1.8.8} or simply @code{guile@@1.8} (in the latter
3142 case, the newest version prefixed by @code{1.8} is selected).
3143
3144 If no version number is specified, the
3145 newest available version will be selected. In addition, @var{package}
3146 may contain a colon, followed by the name of one of the outputs of the
3147 package, as in @code{gcc:doc} or @code{binutils@@2.22:lib}
3148 (@pxref{Packages with Multiple Outputs}). Packages with a corresponding
3149 name (and optionally version) are searched for among the GNU
3150 distribution modules (@pxref{Package Modules}).
3151
3152 @cindex propagated inputs
3153 Sometimes packages have @dfn{propagated inputs}: these are dependencies
3154 that automatically get installed along with the required package
3155 (@pxref{package-propagated-inputs, @code{propagated-inputs} in
3156 @code{package} objects}, for information about propagated inputs in
3157 package definitions).
3158
3159 @anchor{package-cmd-propagated-inputs}
3160 An example is the GNU MPC library: its C header files refer to those of
3161 the GNU MPFR library, which in turn refer to those of the GMP library.
3162 Thus, when installing MPC, the MPFR and GMP libraries also get installed
3163 in the profile; removing MPC also removes MPFR and GMP---unless they had
3164 also been explicitly installed by the user.
3165
3166 Besides, packages sometimes rely on the definition of environment
3167 variables for their search paths (see explanation of
3168 @option{--search-paths} below). Any missing or possibly incorrect
3169 environment variable definitions are reported here.
3170
3171 @item --install-from-expression=@var{exp}
3172 @itemx -e @var{exp}
3173 Install the package @var{exp} evaluates to.
3174
3175 @var{exp} must be a Scheme expression that evaluates to a
3176 @code{<package>} object. This option is notably useful to disambiguate
3177 between same-named variants of a package, with expressions such as
3178 @code{(@@ (gnu packages base) guile-final)}.
3179
3180 Note that this option installs the first output of the specified
3181 package, which may be insufficient when needing a specific output of a
3182 multiple-output package.
3183
3184 @item --install-from-file=@var{file}
3185 @itemx -f @var{file}
3186 Install the package that the code within @var{file} evaluates to.
3187
3188 As an example, @var{file} might contain a definition like this
3189 (@pxref{Defining Packages}):
3190
3191 @lisp
3192 @include package-hello.scm
3193 @end lisp
3194
3195 Developers may find it useful to include such a @file{guix.scm} file
3196 in the root of their project source tree that can be used to test
3197 development snapshots and create reproducible development environments
3198 (@pxref{Invoking guix environment}).
3199
3200 The @var{file} may also contain a JSON representation of one or more
3201 package definitions. Running @code{guix package -f} on
3202 @file{hello.json} with the following contents would result in installing
3203 the package @code{greeter} after building @code{myhello}:
3204
3205 @example
3206 @verbatiminclude package-hello.json
3207 @end example
3208
3209 @item --remove=@var{package} @dots{}
3210 @itemx -r @var{package} @dots{}
3211 Remove the specified @var{package}s.
3212
3213 As for @option{--install}, each @var{package} may specify a version number
3214 and/or output name in addition to the package name. For instance,
3215 @samp{-r glibc:debug} would remove the @code{debug} output of
3216 @code{glibc}.
3217
3218 @item --upgrade[=@var{regexp} @dots{}]
3219 @itemx -u [@var{regexp} @dots{}]
3220 @cindex upgrading packages
3221 Upgrade all the installed packages. If one or more @var{regexp}s are
3222 specified, upgrade only installed packages whose name matches a
3223 @var{regexp}. Also see the @option{--do-not-upgrade} option below.
3224
3225 Note that this upgrades package to the latest version of packages found
3226 in the distribution currently installed. To update your distribution,
3227 you should regularly run @command{guix pull} (@pxref{Invoking guix
3228 pull}).
3229
3230 @cindex package transformations, upgrades
3231 When upgrading, package transformations that were originally applied
3232 when creating the profile are automatically re-applied (@pxref{Package
3233 Transformation Options}). For example, assume you first installed Emacs
3234 from the tip of its development branch with:
3235
3236 @example
3237 guix install emacs-next --with-branch=emacs-next=master
3238 @end example
3239
3240 Next time you run @command{guix upgrade}, Guix will again pull the tip
3241 of the Emacs development branch and build @code{emacs-next} from that
3242 checkout.
3243
3244 Note that transformation options such as @option{--with-branch} and
3245 @option{--with-source} depend on external state; it is up to you to
3246 ensure that they work as expected. You can also discard a
3247 transformations that apply to a package by running:
3248
3249 @example
3250 guix install @var{package}
3251 @end example
3252
3253 @item --do-not-upgrade[=@var{regexp} @dots{}]
3254 When used together with the @option{--upgrade} option, do @emph{not}
3255 upgrade any packages whose name matches a @var{regexp}. For example, to
3256 upgrade all packages in the current profile except those containing the
3257 substring ``emacs'':
3258
3259 @example
3260 $ guix package --upgrade . --do-not-upgrade emacs
3261 @end example
3262
3263 @item @anchor{profile-manifest}--manifest=@var{file}
3264 @itemx -m @var{file}
3265 @cindex profile declaration
3266 @cindex profile manifest
3267 Create a new generation of the profile from the manifest object
3268 returned by the Scheme code in @var{file}. This option can be repeated
3269 several times, in which case the manifests are concatenated.
3270
3271 This allows you to @emph{declare} the profile's contents rather than
3272 constructing it through a sequence of @option{--install} and similar
3273 commands. The advantage is that @var{file} can be put under version
3274 control, copied to different machines to reproduce the same profile, and
3275 so on.
3276
3277 @c FIXME: Add reference to (guix profile) documentation when available.
3278 @var{file} must return a @dfn{manifest} object, which is roughly a list
3279 of packages:
3280
3281 @findex packages->manifest
3282 @lisp
3283 (use-package-modules guile emacs)
3284
3285 (packages->manifest
3286 (list emacs
3287 guile-2.0
3288 ;; Use a specific package output.
3289 (list guile-2.0 "debug")))
3290 @end lisp
3291
3292 @findex specifications->manifest
3293 In this example we have to know which modules define the @code{emacs}
3294 and @code{guile-2.0} variables to provide the right
3295 @code{use-package-modules} line, which can be cumbersome. We can
3296 instead provide regular package specifications and let
3297 @code{specifications->manifest} look up the corresponding package
3298 objects, like this:
3299
3300 @lisp
3301 (specifications->manifest
3302 '("emacs" "guile@@2.2" "guile@@2.2:debug"))
3303 @end lisp
3304
3305 @xref{export-manifest, @option{--export-manifest}}, to learn how to
3306 obtain a manifest file from an existing profile.
3307
3308 @item --roll-back
3309 @cindex rolling back
3310 @cindex undoing transactions
3311 @cindex transactions, undoing
3312 Roll back to the previous @dfn{generation} of the profile---i.e., undo
3313 the last transaction.
3314
3315 When combined with options such as @option{--install}, roll back occurs
3316 before any other actions.
3317
3318 When rolling back from the first generation that actually contains
3319 installed packages, the profile is made to point to the @dfn{zeroth
3320 generation}, which contains no files apart from its own metadata.
3321
3322 After having rolled back, installing, removing, or upgrading packages
3323 overwrites previous future generations. Thus, the history of the
3324 generations in a profile is always linear.
3325
3326 @item --switch-generation=@var{pattern}
3327 @itemx -S @var{pattern}
3328 @cindex generations
3329 Switch to a particular generation defined by @var{pattern}.
3330
3331 @var{pattern} may be either a generation number or a number prefixed
3332 with ``+'' or ``-''. The latter means: move forward/backward by a
3333 specified number of generations. For example, if you want to return to
3334 the latest generation after @option{--roll-back}, use
3335 @option{--switch-generation=+1}.
3336
3337 The difference between @option{--roll-back} and
3338 @option{--switch-generation=-1} is that @option{--switch-generation} will
3339 not make a zeroth generation, so if a specified generation does not
3340 exist, the current generation will not be changed.
3341
3342 @item --search-paths[=@var{kind}]
3343 @cindex search paths
3344 Report environment variable definitions, in Bash syntax, that may be
3345 needed in order to use the set of installed packages. These environment
3346 variables are used to specify @dfn{search paths} for files used by some
3347 of the installed packages.
3348
3349 For example, GCC needs the @env{CPATH} and @env{LIBRARY_PATH}
3350 environment variables to be defined so it can look for headers and
3351 libraries in the user's profile (@pxref{Environment Variables,,, gcc,
3352 Using the GNU Compiler Collection (GCC)}). If GCC and, say, the C
3353 library are installed in the profile, then @option{--search-paths} will
3354 suggest setting these variables to @file{@var{profile}/include} and
3355 @file{@var{profile}/lib}, respectively.
3356
3357 The typical use case is to define these environment variables in the
3358 shell:
3359
3360 @example
3361 $ eval `guix package --search-paths`
3362 @end example
3363
3364 @var{kind} may be one of @code{exact}, @code{prefix}, or @code{suffix},
3365 meaning that the returned environment variable definitions will either
3366 be exact settings, or prefixes or suffixes of the current value of these
3367 variables. When omitted, @var{kind} defaults to @code{exact}.
3368
3369 This option can also be used to compute the @emph{combined} search paths
3370 of several profiles. Consider this example:
3371
3372 @example
3373 $ guix package -p foo -i guile
3374 $ guix package -p bar -i guile-json
3375 $ guix package -p foo -p bar --search-paths
3376 @end example
3377
3378 The last command above reports about the @env{GUILE_LOAD_PATH}
3379 variable, even though, taken individually, neither @file{foo} nor
3380 @file{bar} would lead to that recommendation.
3381
3382
3383 @item --profile=@var{profile}
3384 @itemx -p @var{profile}
3385 Use @var{profile} instead of the user's default profile.
3386
3387 @var{profile} must be the name of a file that will be created upon
3388 completion. Concretely, @var{profile} will be a mere symbolic link
3389 (``symlink'') pointing to the actual profile where packages are
3390 installed:
3391
3392 @example
3393 $ guix install hello -p ~/code/my-profile
3394 @dots{}
3395 $ ~/code/my-profile/bin/hello
3396 Hello, world!
3397 @end example
3398
3399 All it takes to get rid of the profile is to remove this symlink and its
3400 siblings that point to specific generations:
3401
3402 @example
3403 $ rm ~/code/my-profile ~/code/my-profile-*-link
3404 @end example
3405
3406 @item --list-profiles
3407 List all the user's profiles:
3408
3409 @example
3410 $ guix package --list-profiles
3411 /home/charlie/.guix-profile
3412 /home/charlie/code/my-profile
3413 /home/charlie/code/devel-profile
3414 /home/charlie/tmp/test
3415 @end example
3416
3417 When running as root, list all the profiles of all the users.
3418
3419 @cindex collisions, in a profile
3420 @cindex colliding packages in profiles
3421 @cindex profile collisions
3422 @item --allow-collisions
3423 Allow colliding packages in the new profile. Use at your own risk!
3424
3425 By default, @command{guix package} reports as an error @dfn{collisions}
3426 in the profile. Collisions happen when two or more different versions
3427 or variants of a given package end up in the profile.
3428
3429 @item --bootstrap
3430 Use the bootstrap Guile to build the profile. This option is only
3431 useful to distribution developers.
3432
3433 @end table
3434
3435 In addition to these actions, @command{guix package} supports the
3436 following options to query the current state of a profile, or the
3437 availability of packages:
3438
3439 @table @option
3440
3441 @item --search=@var{regexp}
3442 @itemx -s @var{regexp}
3443 @anchor{guix-search}
3444 @cindex searching for packages
3445 List the available packages whose name, synopsis, or description matches
3446 @var{regexp} (in a case-insensitive fashion), sorted by relevance.
3447 Print all the metadata of matching packages in
3448 @code{recutils} format (@pxref{Top, GNU recutils databases,, recutils,
3449 GNU recutils manual}).
3450
3451 This allows specific fields to be extracted using the @command{recsel}
3452 command, for instance:
3453
3454 @example
3455 $ guix package -s malloc | recsel -p name,version,relevance
3456 name: jemalloc
3457 version: 4.5.0
3458 relevance: 6
3459
3460 name: glibc
3461 version: 2.25
3462 relevance: 1
3463
3464 name: libgc
3465 version: 7.6.0
3466 relevance: 1
3467 @end example
3468
3469 Similarly, to show the name of all the packages available under the
3470 terms of the GNU@tie{}LGPL version 3:
3471
3472 @example
3473 $ guix package -s "" | recsel -p name -e 'license ~ "LGPL 3"'
3474 name: elfutils
3475
3476 name: gmp
3477 @dots{}
3478 @end example
3479
3480 It is also possible to refine search results using several @code{-s} flags to
3481 @command{guix package}, or several arguments to @command{guix search}. For
3482 example, the following command returns a list of board games (this time using
3483 the @command{guix search} alias):
3484
3485 @example
3486 $ guix search '\<board\>' game | recsel -p name
3487 name: gnubg
3488 @dots{}
3489 @end example
3490
3491 If we were to omit @code{-s game}, we would also get software packages
3492 that deal with printed circuit boards; removing the angle brackets
3493 around @code{board} would further add packages that have to do with
3494 keyboards.
3495
3496 And now for a more elaborate example. The following command searches
3497 for cryptographic libraries, filters out Haskell, Perl, Python, and Ruby
3498 libraries, and prints the name and synopsis of the matching packages:
3499
3500 @example
3501 $ guix search crypto library | \
3502 recsel -e '! (name ~ "^(ghc|perl|python|ruby)")' -p name,synopsis
3503 @end example
3504
3505 @noindent
3506 @xref{Selection Expressions,,, recutils, GNU recutils manual}, for more
3507 information on @dfn{selection expressions} for @code{recsel -e}.
3508
3509 @item --show=@var{package}
3510 Show details about @var{package}, taken from the list of available packages, in
3511 @code{recutils} format (@pxref{Top, GNU recutils databases,, recutils, GNU
3512 recutils manual}).
3513
3514 @example
3515 $ guix package --show=python | recsel -p name,version
3516 name: python
3517 version: 2.7.6
3518
3519 name: python
3520 version: 3.3.5
3521 @end example
3522
3523 You may also specify the full name of a package to only get details about a
3524 specific version of it (this time using the @command{guix show} alias):
3525 @example
3526 $ guix show python@@3.4 | recsel -p name,version
3527 name: python
3528 version: 3.4.3
3529 @end example
3530
3531
3532
3533 @item --list-installed[=@var{regexp}]
3534 @itemx -I [@var{regexp}]
3535 List the currently installed packages in the specified profile, with the
3536 most recently installed packages shown last. When @var{regexp} is
3537 specified, list only installed packages whose name matches @var{regexp}.
3538
3539 For each installed package, print the following items, separated by
3540 tabs: the package name, its version string, the part of the package that
3541 is installed (for instance, @code{out} for the default output,
3542 @code{include} for its headers, etc.), and the path of this package in
3543 the store.
3544
3545 @item --list-available[=@var{regexp}]
3546 @itemx -A [@var{regexp}]
3547 List packages currently available in the distribution for this system
3548 (@pxref{GNU Distribution}). When @var{regexp} is specified, list only
3549 available packages whose name matches @var{regexp}.
3550
3551 For each package, print the following items separated by tabs: its name,
3552 its version string, the parts of the package (@pxref{Packages with
3553 Multiple Outputs}), and the source location of its definition.
3554
3555 @item --list-generations[=@var{pattern}]
3556 @itemx -l [@var{pattern}]
3557 @cindex generations
3558 Return a list of generations along with their creation dates; for each
3559 generation, show the installed packages, with the most recently
3560 installed packages shown last. Note that the zeroth generation is never
3561 shown.
3562
3563 For each installed package, print the following items, separated by
3564 tabs: the name of a package, its version string, the part of the package
3565 that is installed (@pxref{Packages with Multiple Outputs}), and the
3566 location of this package in the store.
3567
3568 When @var{pattern} is used, the command returns only matching
3569 generations. Valid patterns include:
3570
3571 @itemize
3572 @item @emph{Integers and comma-separated integers}. Both patterns denote
3573 generation numbers. For instance, @option{--list-generations=1} returns
3574 the first one.
3575
3576 And @option{--list-generations=1,8,2} outputs three generations in the
3577 specified order. Neither spaces nor trailing commas are allowed.
3578
3579 @item @emph{Ranges}. @option{--list-generations=2..9} prints the
3580 specified generations and everything in between. Note that the start of
3581 a range must be smaller than its end.
3582
3583 It is also possible to omit the endpoint. For example,
3584 @option{--list-generations=2..}, returns all generations starting from the
3585 second one.
3586
3587 @item @emph{Durations}. You can also get the last @emph{N}@tie{}days, weeks,
3588 or months by passing an integer along with the first letter of the
3589 duration. For example, @option{--list-generations=20d} lists generations
3590 that are up to 20 days old.
3591 @end itemize
3592
3593 @item --delete-generations[=@var{pattern}]
3594 @itemx -d [@var{pattern}]
3595 When @var{pattern} is omitted, delete all generations except the current
3596 one.
3597
3598 This command accepts the same patterns as @option{--list-generations}.
3599 When @var{pattern} is specified, delete the matching generations. When
3600 @var{pattern} specifies a duration, generations @emph{older} than the
3601 specified duration match. For instance, @option{--delete-generations=1m}
3602 deletes generations that are more than one month old.
3603
3604 If the current generation matches, it is @emph{not} deleted. Also, the
3605 zeroth generation is never deleted.
3606
3607 Note that deleting generations prevents rolling back to them.
3608 Consequently, this command must be used with care.
3609
3610 @cindex manifest, exporting
3611 @anchor{export-manifest}
3612 @item --export-manifest
3613 Write to standard output a manifest suitable for @option{--manifest}
3614 corresponding to the chosen profile(s).
3615
3616 This option is meant to help you migrate from the ``imperative''
3617 operating mode---running @command{guix install}, @command{guix upgrade},
3618 etc.---to the declarative mode that @option{--manifest} offers.
3619
3620 Be aware that the resulting manifest @emph{approximates} what your
3621 profile actually contains; for instance, depending on how your profile
3622 was created, it can refer to packages or package versions that are not
3623 exactly what you specified.
3624
3625 Keep in mind that a manifest is purely symbolic: it only contains
3626 package names and possibly versions, and their meaning varies over time.
3627 If you wish to ``pin'' channels to the revisions that were used to build
3628 the profile(s), see @option{--export-channels} below.
3629
3630 @cindex pinning, channel revisions of a profile
3631 @item --export-channels
3632 Write to standard output the list of channels used by the chosen
3633 profile(s), in a format suitable for @command{guix pull --channels} or
3634 @command{guix time-machine --channels} (@pxref{Channels}).
3635
3636 Together with @option{--export-manifest}, this option provides
3637 information allowing you to replicate the current profile
3638 (@pxref{Replicating Guix}).
3639
3640 However, note that the output of this command @emph{approximates} what
3641 was actually used to build this profile. In particular, a single
3642 profile might have been built from several different revisions of the
3643 same channel. In that case, @option{--export-manifest} chooses the last
3644 one and writes the list of other revisions in a comment. If you really
3645 need to pick packages from different channel revisions, you can use
3646 inferiors in your manifest to do so (@pxref{Inferiors}).
3647
3648 Together with @option{--export-manifest}, this is a good starting point
3649 if you are willing to migrate from the ``imperative'' model to the fully
3650 declarative model consisting of a manifest file along with a channels
3651 file pinning the exact channel revision(s) you want.
3652 @end table
3653
3654 Finally, since @command{guix package} may actually start build
3655 processes, it supports all the common build options (@pxref{Common Build
3656 Options}). It also supports package transformation options, such as
3657 @option{--with-source}, and preserves them across upgrades
3658 (@pxref{Package Transformation Options}).
3659
3660 @node Substitutes
3661 @section Substitutes
3662
3663 @cindex substitutes
3664 @cindex pre-built binaries
3665 Guix supports transparent source/binary deployment, which means that it
3666 can either build things locally, or download pre-built items from a
3667 server, or both. We call these pre-built items @dfn{substitutes}---they
3668 are substitutes for local build results. In many cases, downloading a
3669 substitute is much faster than building things locally.
3670
3671 Substitutes can be anything resulting from a derivation build
3672 (@pxref{Derivations}). Of course, in the common case, they are
3673 pre-built package binaries, but source tarballs, for instance, which
3674 also result from derivation builds, can be available as substitutes.
3675
3676 @menu
3677 * Official Substitute Server:: One particular source of substitutes.
3678 * Substitute Server Authorization:: How to enable or disable substitutes.
3679 * Getting Substitutes from Other Servers:: Substitute diversity.
3680 * Substitute Authentication:: How Guix verifies substitutes.
3681 * Proxy Settings:: How to get substitutes via proxy.
3682 * Substitution Failure:: What happens when substitution fails.
3683 * On Trusting Binaries:: How can you trust that binary blob?
3684 @end menu
3685
3686 @node Official Substitute Server
3687 @subsection Official Substitute Server
3688
3689 @cindex build farm
3690 The @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}} server is a front-end to an official build farm
3691 that builds packages from Guix continuously for some
3692 architectures, and makes them available as substitutes. This is the
3693 default source of substitutes; it can be overridden by passing the
3694 @option{--substitute-urls} option either to @command{guix-daemon}
3695 (@pxref{daemon-substitute-urls,, @code{guix-daemon --substitute-urls}})
3696 or to client tools such as @command{guix package}
3697 (@pxref{client-substitute-urls,, client @option{--substitute-urls}
3698 option}).
3699
3700 Substitute URLs can be either HTTP or HTTPS.
3701 HTTPS is recommended because communications are encrypted; conversely,
3702 using HTTP makes all communications visible to an eavesdropper, who
3703 could use the information gathered to determine, for instance, whether
3704 your system has unpatched security vulnerabilities.
3705
3706 Substitutes from the official build farm are enabled by default when
3707 using Guix System (@pxref{GNU Distribution}). However,
3708 they are disabled by default when using Guix on a foreign distribution,
3709 unless you have explicitly enabled them via one of the recommended
3710 installation steps (@pxref{Installation}). The following paragraphs
3711 describe how to enable or disable substitutes for the official build
3712 farm; the same procedure can also be used to enable substitutes for any
3713 other substitute server.
3714
3715 @node Substitute Server Authorization
3716 @subsection Substitute Server Authorization
3717
3718 @cindex security
3719 @cindex substitutes, authorization thereof
3720 @cindex access control list (ACL), for substitutes
3721 @cindex ACL (access control list), for substitutes
3722 To allow Guix to download substitutes from @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}} or a
3723 mirror thereof, you
3724 must add its public key to the access control list (ACL) of archive
3725 imports, using the @command{guix archive} command (@pxref{Invoking guix
3726 archive}). Doing so implies that you trust @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}} to not
3727 be compromised and to serve genuine substitutes.
3728
3729 @quotation Note
3730 If you are using Guix System, you can skip this section: Guix System
3731 authorizes substitutes from @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}} by default.
3732 @end quotation
3733
3734 The public key for @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}} is installed along with Guix, in
3735 @code{@var{prefix}/share/guix/@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}.pub}, where @var{prefix} is
3736 the installation prefix of Guix. If you installed Guix from source,
3737 make sure you checked the GPG signature of
3738 @file{guix-@value{VERSION}.tar.gz}, which contains this public key file.
3739 Then, you can run something like this:
3740
3741 @example
3742 # guix archive --authorize < @var{prefix}/share/guix/@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}.pub
3743 @end example
3744
3745 Once this is in place, the output of a command like @code{guix build}
3746 should change from something like:
3747
3748 @example
3749 $ guix build emacs --dry-run
3750 The following derivations would be built:
3751 /gnu/store/yr7bnx8xwcayd6j95r2clmkdl1qh688w-emacs-24.3.drv
3752 /gnu/store/x8qsh1hlhgjx6cwsjyvybnfv2i37z23w-dbus-1.6.4.tar.gz.drv
3753 /gnu/store/1ixwp12fl950d15h2cj11c73733jay0z-alsa-lib-1.0.27.1.tar.bz2.drv
3754 /gnu/store/nlma1pw0p603fpfiqy7kn4zm105r5dmw-util-linux-2.21.drv
3755 @dots{}
3756 @end example
3757
3758 @noindent
3759 to something like:
3760
3761 @example
3762 $ guix build emacs --dry-run
3763 112.3 MB would be downloaded:
3764 /gnu/store/pk3n22lbq6ydamyymqkkz7i69wiwjiwi-emacs-24.3
3765 /gnu/store/2ygn4ncnhrpr61rssa6z0d9x22si0va3-libjpeg-8d
3766 /gnu/store/71yz6lgx4dazma9dwn2mcjxaah9w77jq-cairo-1.12.16
3767 /gnu/store/7zdhgp0n1518lvfn8mb96sxqfmvqrl7v-libxrender-0.9.7
3768 @dots{}
3769 @end example
3770
3771 @noindent
3772 The text changed from ``The following derivations would be built'' to
3773 ``112.3 MB would be downloaded''. This indicates that substitutes from
3774 @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}} are usable and will be downloaded, when
3775 possible, for future builds.
3776
3777 @cindex substitutes, how to disable
3778 The substitute mechanism can be disabled globally by running
3779 @code{guix-daemon} with @option{--no-substitutes} (@pxref{Invoking
3780 guix-daemon}). It can also be disabled temporarily by passing the
3781 @option{--no-substitutes} option to @command{guix package},
3782 @command{guix build}, and other command-line tools.
3783
3784 @node Getting Substitutes from Other Servers
3785 @subsection Getting Substitutes from Other Servers
3786
3787 @cindex substitute servers, adding more
3788 Guix can look up and fetch substitutes from several servers. This is
3789 useful when you are using packages from additional channels for which
3790 the official server does not have substitutes but another server
3791 provides them. Another situation where this is useful is when you would
3792 prefer to download from your organization's substitute server, resorting
3793 to the official server only as a fallback or dismissing it altogether.
3794
3795 You can give Guix a list of substitute server URLs and it will check
3796 them in the specified order. You also need to explicitly authorize the
3797 public keys of substitute servers to instruct Guix to accept the
3798 substitutes they sign.
3799
3800 On Guix System, this is achieved by modifying the configuration of the
3801 @code{guix} service. Since the @code{guix} service is part of the
3802 default lists of services, @code{%base-services} and
3803 @code{%desktop-services}, you can use @code{modify-services} to change
3804 its configuration and add the URLs and substitute keys that you want
3805 (@pxref{Service Reference, @code{modify-services}}).
3806
3807 As an example, suppose you want to fetch substitutes from
3808 @code{guix.example.org} and to authorize the signing key of that server,
3809 in addition to the default @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}}. The
3810 resulting operating system configuration will look something like:
3811
3812 @lisp
3813 (operating-system
3814 ;; @dots{}
3815 (services
3816 ;; Assume we're starting from '%desktop-services'. Replace it
3817 ;; with the list of services you're actually using.
3818 (modify-services %desktop-services
3819 (guix-service-type config =>
3820 (guix-configuration
3821 (inherit config)
3822 (substitute-urls
3823 (append (list "https://guix.example.org")
3824 %default-substitute-urls))
3825 (authorized-keys
3826 (append (list (local-file "./key.pub"))
3827 %default-authorized-guix-keys)))))))
3828 @end lisp
3829
3830 This assumes that the file @file{key.pub} contains the signing key of
3831 @code{guix.example.org}. With this change in place in your operating
3832 system configuration file (say @file{/etc/config.scm}), you can
3833 reconfigure and restart the @code{guix-daemon} service or reboot so the
3834 changes take effect:
3835
3836 @example
3837 $ sudo guix system reconfigure /etc/config.scm
3838 $ sudo herd restart guix-daemon
3839 @end example
3840
3841 If you're running Guix on a ``foreign distro'', you would instead take
3842 the following steps to get substitutes from additional servers:
3843
3844 @enumerate
3845 @item
3846 Edit the service configuration file for @code{guix-daemon}; when using
3847 systemd, this is normally
3848 @file{/etc/systemd/system/guix-daemon.service}. Add the
3849 @option{--substitute-urls} option on the @command{guix-daemon} command
3850 line and list the URLs of interest (@pxref{daemon-substitute-urls,
3851 @code{guix-daemon --substitute-urls}}):
3852
3853 @example
3854 @dots{} --substitute-urls='https://guix.example.org https://@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}'
3855 @end example
3856
3857 @item
3858 Restart the daemon. For systemd, it goes like this:
3859
3860 @example
3861 systemctl daemon-reload
3862 systemctl restart guix-daemon.service
3863 @end example
3864
3865 @item
3866 Authorize the key of the new server (@pxref{Invoking guix archive}):
3867
3868 @example
3869 guix archive --authorize < key.pub
3870 @end example
3871
3872 Again this assumes @file{key.pub} contains the public key that
3873 @code{guix.example.org} uses to sign substitutes.
3874 @end enumerate
3875
3876 Now you're all set! Substitutes will be preferably taken from
3877 @code{https://guix.example.org}, using @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}}
3878 as a fallback. Of course you can list as many substitute servers as you
3879 like, with the caveat that substitute lookup can be slowed down if too
3880 many servers need to be contacted.
3881
3882 Note that there are also situations where one may want to add the URL of
3883 a substitute server @emph{without} authorizing its key.
3884 @xref{Substitute Authentication}, to understand this fine point.
3885
3886 @node Substitute Authentication
3887 @subsection Substitute Authentication
3888
3889 @cindex digital signatures
3890 Guix detects and raises an error when attempting to use a substitute
3891 that has been tampered with. Likewise, it ignores substitutes that are
3892 not signed, or that are not signed by one of the keys listed in the ACL.
3893
3894 There is one exception though: if an unauthorized server provides
3895 substitutes that are @emph{bit-for-bit identical} to those provided by
3896 an authorized server, then the unauthorized server becomes eligible for
3897 downloads. For example, assume we have chosen two substitute servers
3898 with this option:
3899
3900 @example
3901 --substitute-urls="https://a.example.org https://b.example.org"
3902 @end example
3903
3904 @noindent
3905 @cindex reproducible builds
3906 If the ACL contains only the key for @samp{b.example.org}, and if
3907 @samp{a.example.org} happens to serve the @emph{exact same} substitutes,
3908 then Guix will download substitutes from @samp{a.example.org} because it
3909 comes first in the list and can be considered a mirror of
3910 @samp{b.example.org}. In practice, independent build machines usually
3911 produce the same binaries, thanks to bit-reproducible builds (see
3912 below).
3913
3914 When using HTTPS, the server's X.509 certificate is @emph{not} validated
3915 (in other words, the server is not authenticated), contrary to what
3916 HTTPS clients such as Web browsers usually do. This is because Guix
3917 authenticates substitute information itself, as explained above, which
3918 is what we care about (whereas X.509 certificates are about
3919 authenticating bindings between domain names and public keys).
3920
3921 @node Proxy Settings
3922 @subsection Proxy Settings
3923
3924 @vindex http_proxy
3925 @vindex https_proxy
3926 Substitutes are downloaded over HTTP or HTTPS@. The @env{http_proxy} and
3927 @env{https_proxy} environment variables can be set in the environment of
3928 @command{guix-daemon} and are honored for downloads of substitutes.
3929 Note that the value of those environment variables in the environment
3930 where @command{guix build}, @command{guix package}, and other client
3931 commands are run has @emph{absolutely no effect}.
3932
3933 @node Substitution Failure
3934 @subsection Substitution Failure
3935
3936 Even when a substitute for a derivation is available, sometimes the
3937 substitution attempt will fail. This can happen for a variety of
3938 reasons: the substitute server might be offline, the substitute may
3939 recently have been deleted, the connection might have been interrupted,
3940 etc.
3941
3942 When substitutes are enabled and a substitute for a derivation is
3943 available, but the substitution attempt fails, Guix will attempt to
3944 build the derivation locally depending on whether or not
3945 @option{--fallback} was given (@pxref{fallback-option,, common build
3946 option @option{--fallback}}). Specifically, if @option{--fallback} was
3947 omitted, then no local build will be performed, and the derivation is
3948 considered to have failed. However, if @option{--fallback} was given,
3949 then Guix will attempt to build the derivation locally, and the success
3950 or failure of the derivation depends on the success or failure of the
3951 local build. Note that when substitutes are disabled or no substitute
3952 is available for the derivation in question, a local build will
3953 @emph{always} be performed, regardless of whether or not
3954 @option{--fallback} was given.
3955
3956 To get an idea of how many substitutes are available right now, you can
3957 try running the @command{guix weather} command (@pxref{Invoking guix
3958 weather}). This command provides statistics on the substitutes provided
3959 by a server.
3960
3961 @node On Trusting Binaries
3962 @subsection On Trusting Binaries
3963
3964 @cindex trust, of pre-built binaries
3965 Today, each individual's control over their own computing is at the
3966 mercy of institutions, corporations, and groups with enough power and
3967 determination to subvert the computing infrastructure and exploit its
3968 weaknesses. While using @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}} substitutes can be
3969 convenient, we encourage users to also build on their own, or even run
3970 their own build farm, such that @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}} is less of an
3971 interesting target. One way to help is by publishing the software you
3972 build using @command{guix publish} so that others have one more choice
3973 of server to download substitutes from (@pxref{Invoking guix publish}).
3974
3975 Guix has the foundations to maximize build reproducibility
3976 (@pxref{Features}). In most cases, independent builds of a given
3977 package or derivation should yield bit-identical results. Thus, through
3978 a diverse set of independent package builds, we can strengthen the
3979 integrity of our systems. The @command{guix challenge} command aims to
3980 help users assess substitute servers, and to assist developers in
3981 finding out about non-deterministic package builds (@pxref{Invoking guix
3982 challenge}). Similarly, the @option{--check} option of @command{guix
3983 build} allows users to check whether previously-installed substitutes
3984 are genuine by rebuilding them locally (@pxref{build-check,
3985 @command{guix build --check}}).
3986
3987 In the future, we want Guix to have support to publish and retrieve
3988 binaries to/from other users, in a peer-to-peer fashion. If you would
3989 like to discuss this project, join us on @email{guix-devel@@gnu.org}.
3990
3991 @node Packages with Multiple Outputs
3992 @section Packages with Multiple Outputs
3993
3994 @cindex multiple-output packages
3995 @cindex package outputs
3996 @cindex outputs
3997
3998 Often, packages defined in Guix have a single @dfn{output}---i.e., the
3999 source package leads to exactly one directory in the store. When running
4000 @command{guix install glibc}, one installs the default output of the
4001 GNU libc package; the default output is called @code{out}, but its name
4002 can be omitted as shown in this command. In this particular case, the
4003 default output of @code{glibc} contains all the C header files, shared
4004 libraries, static libraries, Info documentation, and other supporting
4005 files.
4006
4007 Sometimes it is more appropriate to separate the various types of files
4008 produced from a single source package into separate outputs. For
4009 instance, the GLib C library (used by GTK+ and related packages)
4010 installs more than 20 MiB of reference documentation as HTML pages.
4011 To save space for users who do not need it, the documentation goes to a
4012 separate output, called @code{doc}. To install the main GLib output,
4013 which contains everything but the documentation, one would run:
4014
4015 @example
4016 guix install glib
4017 @end example
4018
4019 @cindex documentation
4020 The command to install its documentation is:
4021
4022 @example
4023 guix install glib:doc
4024 @end example
4025
4026 Some packages install programs with different ``dependency footprints''.
4027 For instance, the WordNet package installs both command-line tools and
4028 graphical user interfaces (GUIs). The former depend solely on the C
4029 library, whereas the latter depend on Tcl/Tk and the underlying X
4030 libraries. In this case, we leave the command-line tools in the default
4031 output, whereas the GUIs are in a separate output. This allows users
4032 who do not need the GUIs to save space. The @command{guix size} command
4033 can help find out about such situations (@pxref{Invoking guix size}).
4034 @command{guix graph} can also be helpful (@pxref{Invoking guix graph}).
4035
4036 There are several such multiple-output packages in the GNU distribution.
4037 Other conventional output names include @code{lib} for libraries and
4038 possibly header files, @code{bin} for stand-alone programs, and
4039 @code{debug} for debugging information (@pxref{Installing Debugging
4040 Files}). The outputs of a packages are listed in the third column of
4041 the output of @command{guix package --list-available} (@pxref{Invoking
4042 guix package}).
4043
4044
4045 @node Invoking guix gc
4046 @section Invoking @command{guix gc}
4047
4048 @cindex garbage collector
4049 @cindex disk space
4050 Packages that are installed, but not used, may be @dfn{garbage-collected}.
4051 The @command{guix gc} command allows users to explicitly run the garbage
4052 collector to reclaim space from the @file{/gnu/store} directory. It is
4053 the @emph{only} way to remove files from @file{/gnu/store}---removing
4054 files or directories manually may break it beyond repair!
4055
4056 @cindex GC roots
4057 @cindex garbage collector roots
4058 The garbage collector has a set of known @dfn{roots}: any file under
4059 @file{/gnu/store} reachable from a root is considered @dfn{live} and
4060 cannot be deleted; any other file is considered @dfn{dead} and may be
4061 deleted. The set of garbage collector roots (``GC roots'' for short)
4062 includes default user profiles; by default, the symlinks under
4063 @file{/var/guix/gcroots} represent these GC roots. New GC roots can be
4064 added with @command{guix build --root}, for example (@pxref{Invoking
4065 guix build}). The @command{guix gc --list-roots} command lists them.
4066
4067 Prior to running @code{guix gc --collect-garbage} to make space, it is
4068 often useful to remove old generations from user profiles; that way, old
4069 package builds referenced by those generations can be reclaimed. This
4070 is achieved by running @code{guix package --delete-generations}
4071 (@pxref{Invoking guix package}).
4072
4073 Our recommendation is to run a garbage collection periodically, or when
4074 you are short on disk space. For instance, to guarantee that at least
4075 5@tie{}GB are available on your disk, simply run:
4076
4077 @example
4078 guix gc -F 5G
4079 @end example
4080
4081 It is perfectly safe to run as a non-interactive periodic job
4082 (@pxref{Scheduled Job Execution}, for how to set up such a job).
4083 Running @command{guix gc} with no arguments will collect as
4084 much garbage as it can, but that is often inconvenient: you may find
4085 yourself having to rebuild or re-download software that is ``dead'' from
4086 the GC viewpoint but that is necessary to build other pieces of
4087 software---e.g., the compiler tool chain.
4088
4089 The @command{guix gc} command has three modes of operation: it can be
4090 used to garbage-collect any dead files (the default), to delete specific
4091 files (the @option{--delete} option), to print garbage-collector
4092 information, or for more advanced queries. The garbage collection
4093 options are as follows:
4094
4095 @table @code
4096 @item --collect-garbage[=@var{min}]
4097 @itemx -C [@var{min}]
4098 Collect garbage---i.e., unreachable @file{/gnu/store} files and
4099 sub-directories. This is the default operation when no option is
4100 specified.
4101
4102 When @var{min} is given, stop once @var{min} bytes have been collected.
4103 @var{min} may be a number of bytes, or it may include a unit as a
4104 suffix, such as @code{MiB} for mebibytes and @code{GB} for gigabytes
4105 (@pxref{Block size, size specifications,, coreutils, GNU Coreutils}).
4106
4107 When @var{min} is omitted, collect all the garbage.
4108
4109 @item --free-space=@var{free}
4110 @itemx -F @var{free}
4111 Collect garbage until @var{free} space is available under
4112 @file{/gnu/store}, if possible; @var{free} denotes storage space, such
4113 as @code{500MiB}, as described above.
4114
4115 When @var{free} or more is already available in @file{/gnu/store}, do
4116 nothing and exit immediately.
4117
4118 @item --delete-generations[=@var{duration}]
4119 @itemx -d [@var{duration}]
4120 Before starting the garbage collection process, delete all the generations
4121 older than @var{duration}, for all the user profiles; when run as root, this
4122 applies to all the profiles @emph{of all the users}.
4123
4124 For example, this command deletes all the generations of all your profiles
4125 that are older than 2 months (except generations that are current), and then
4126 proceeds to free space until at least 10 GiB are available:
4127
4128 @example
4129 guix gc -d 2m -F 10G
4130 @end example
4131
4132 @item --delete
4133 @itemx -D
4134 Attempt to delete all the store files and directories specified as
4135 arguments. This fails if some of the files are not in the store, or if
4136 they are still live.
4137
4138 @item --list-failures
4139 List store items corresponding to cached build failures.
4140
4141 This prints nothing unless the daemon was started with
4142 @option{--cache-failures} (@pxref{Invoking guix-daemon,
4143 @option{--cache-failures}}).
4144
4145 @item --list-roots
4146 List the GC roots owned by the user; when run as root, list @emph{all} the GC
4147 roots.
4148
4149 @item --list-busy
4150 List store items in use by currently running processes. These store
4151 items are effectively considered GC roots: they cannot be deleted.
4152
4153 @item --clear-failures
4154 Remove the specified store items from the failed-build cache.
4155
4156 Again, this option only makes sense when the daemon is started with
4157 @option{--cache-failures}. Otherwise, it does nothing.
4158
4159 @item --list-dead
4160 Show the list of dead files and directories still present in the
4161 store---i.e., files and directories no longer reachable from any root.
4162
4163 @item --list-live
4164 Show the list of live store files and directories.
4165
4166 @end table
4167
4168 In addition, the references among existing store files can be queried:
4169
4170 @table @code
4171
4172 @item --references
4173 @itemx --referrers
4174 @cindex package dependencies
4175 List the references (respectively, the referrers) of store files given
4176 as arguments.
4177
4178 @item --requisites
4179 @itemx -R
4180 @cindex closure
4181 List the requisites of the store files passed as arguments. Requisites
4182 include the store files themselves, their references, and the references
4183 of these, recursively. In other words, the returned list is the
4184 @dfn{transitive closure} of the store files.
4185
4186 @xref{Invoking guix size}, for a tool to profile the size of the closure
4187 of an element. @xref{Invoking guix graph}, for a tool to visualize
4188 the graph of references.
4189
4190 @item --derivers
4191 @cindex derivation
4192 Return the derivation(s) leading to the given store items
4193 (@pxref{Derivations}).
4194
4195 For example, this command:
4196
4197 @example
4198 guix gc --derivers `guix package -I ^emacs$ | cut -f4`
4199 @end example
4200
4201 @noindent
4202 returns the @file{.drv} file(s) leading to the @code{emacs} package
4203 installed in your profile.
4204
4205 Note that there may be zero matching @file{.drv} files, for instance
4206 because these files have been garbage-collected. There can also be more
4207 than one matching @file{.drv} due to fixed-output derivations.
4208 @end table
4209
4210 Lastly, the following options allow you to check the integrity of the
4211 store and to control disk usage.
4212
4213 @table @option
4214
4215 @item --verify[=@var{options}]
4216 @cindex integrity, of the store
4217 @cindex integrity checking
4218 Verify the integrity of the store.
4219
4220 By default, make sure that all the store items marked as valid in the
4221 database of the daemon actually exist in @file{/gnu/store}.
4222
4223 When provided, @var{options} must be a comma-separated list containing one
4224 or more of @code{contents} and @code{repair}.
4225
4226 When passing @option{--verify=contents}, the daemon computes the
4227 content hash of each store item and compares it against its hash in the
4228 database. Hash mismatches are reported as data corruptions. Because it
4229 traverses @emph{all the files in the store}, this command can take a
4230 long time, especially on systems with a slow disk drive.
4231
4232 @cindex repairing the store
4233 @cindex corruption, recovering from
4234 Using @option{--verify=repair} or @option{--verify=contents,repair}
4235 causes the daemon to try to repair corrupt store items by fetching
4236 substitutes for them (@pxref{Substitutes}). Because repairing is not
4237 atomic, and thus potentially dangerous, it is available only to the
4238 system administrator. A lightweight alternative, when you know exactly
4239 which items in the store are corrupt, is @command{guix build --repair}
4240 (@pxref{Invoking guix build}).
4241
4242 @item --optimize
4243 @cindex deduplication
4244 Optimize the store by hard-linking identical files---this is
4245 @dfn{deduplication}.
4246
4247 The daemon performs deduplication after each successful build or archive
4248 import, unless it was started with @option{--disable-deduplication}
4249 (@pxref{Invoking guix-daemon, @option{--disable-deduplication}}). Thus,
4250 this option is primarily useful when the daemon was running with
4251 @option{--disable-deduplication}.
4252
4253 @end table
4254
4255 @node Invoking guix pull
4256 @section Invoking @command{guix pull}
4257
4258 @cindex upgrading Guix
4259 @cindex updating Guix
4260 @cindex @command{guix pull}
4261 @cindex pull
4262 @cindex security, @command{guix pull}
4263 @cindex authenticity, of code obtained with @command{guix pull}
4264 Packages are installed or upgraded to the latest version available in
4265 the distribution currently available on your local machine. To update
4266 that distribution, along with the Guix tools, you must run @command{guix
4267 pull}: the command downloads the latest Guix source code and package
4268 descriptions, and deploys it. Source code is downloaded from a
4269 @uref{https://git-scm.com, Git} repository, by default the official
4270 GNU@tie{}Guix repository, though this can be customized. @command{guix
4271 pull} ensures that the code it downloads is @emph{authentic} by
4272 verifying that commits are signed by Guix developers.
4273
4274 Specifically, @command{guix pull} downloads code from the @dfn{channels}
4275 (@pxref{Channels}) specified by one of the followings, in this order:
4276
4277 @enumerate
4278 @item
4279 the @option{--channels} option;
4280 @item
4281 the user's @file{~/.config/guix/channels.scm} file;
4282 @item
4283 the system-wide @file{/etc/guix/channels.scm} file;
4284 @item
4285 the built-in default channels specified in the @code{%default-channels}
4286 variable.
4287 @end enumerate
4288
4289 On completion, @command{guix package} will use packages and package
4290 versions from this just-retrieved copy of Guix. Not only that, but all
4291 the Guix commands and Scheme modules will also be taken from that latest
4292 version. New @command{guix} sub-commands added by the update also
4293 become available.
4294
4295 Any user can update their Guix copy using @command{guix pull}, and the
4296 effect is limited to the user who ran @command{guix pull}. For
4297 instance, when user @code{root} runs @command{guix pull}, this has no
4298 effect on the version of Guix that user @code{alice} sees, and vice
4299 versa.
4300
4301 The result of running @command{guix pull} is a @dfn{profile} available
4302 under @file{~/.config/guix/current} containing the latest Guix. Thus,
4303 make sure to add it to the beginning of your search path so that you use
4304 the latest version, and similarly for the Info manual
4305 (@pxref{Documentation}):
4306
4307 @example
4308 export PATH="$HOME/.config/guix/current/bin:$PATH"
4309 export INFOPATH="$HOME/.config/guix/current/share/info:$INFOPATH"
4310 @end example
4311
4312 The @option{--list-generations} or @option{-l} option lists past generations
4313 produced by @command{guix pull}, along with details about their provenance:
4314
4315 @example
4316 $ guix pull -l
4317 Generation 1 Jun 10 2018 00:18:18
4318 guix 65956ad
4319 repository URL: https://git.savannah.gnu.org/git/guix.git
4320 branch: origin/master
4321 commit: 65956ad3526ba09e1f7a40722c96c6ef7c0936fe
4322
4323 Generation 2 Jun 11 2018 11:02:49
4324 guix e0cc7f6
4325 repository URL: https://git.savannah.gnu.org/git/guix.git
4326 branch: origin/master
4327 commit: e0cc7f669bec22c37481dd03a7941c7d11a64f1d
4328 2 new packages: keepalived, libnfnetlink
4329 6 packages upgraded: emacs-nix-mode@@2.0.4,
4330 guile2.0-guix@@0.14.0-12.77a1aac, guix@@0.14.0-12.77a1aac,
4331 heimdal@@7.5.0, milkytracker@@1.02.00, nix@@2.0.4
4332
4333 Generation 3 Jun 13 2018 23:31:07 (current)
4334 guix 844cc1c
4335 repository URL: https://git.savannah.gnu.org/git/guix.git
4336 branch: origin/master
4337 commit: 844cc1c8f394f03b404c5bb3aee086922373490c
4338 28 new packages: emacs-helm-ls-git, emacs-helm-mu, @dots{}
4339 69 packages upgraded: borg@@1.1.6, cheese@@3.28.0, @dots{}
4340 @end example
4341
4342 @xref{Invoking guix describe, @command{guix describe}}, for other ways to
4343 describe the current status of Guix.
4344
4345 This @code{~/.config/guix/current} profile works exactly like the profiles
4346 created by @command{guix package} (@pxref{Invoking guix package}). That
4347 is, you can list generations, roll back to the previous
4348 generation---i.e., the previous Guix---and so on:
4349
4350 @example
4351 $ guix pull --roll-back
4352 switched from generation 3 to 2
4353 $ guix pull --delete-generations=1
4354 deleting /var/guix/profiles/per-user/charlie/current-guix-1-link
4355 @end example
4356
4357 You can also use @command{guix package} (@pxref{Invoking guix package})
4358 to manage the profile by naming it explicitly:
4359 @example
4360 $ guix package -p ~/.config/guix/current --roll-back
4361 switched from generation 3 to 2
4362 $ guix package -p ~/.config/guix/current --delete-generations=1
4363 deleting /var/guix/profiles/per-user/charlie/current-guix-1-link
4364 @end example
4365
4366 The @command{guix pull} command is usually invoked with no arguments,
4367 but it supports the following options:
4368
4369 @table @code
4370 @item --url=@var{url}
4371 @itemx --commit=@var{commit}
4372 @itemx --branch=@var{branch}
4373 Download code for the @code{guix} channel from the specified @var{url}, at the
4374 given @var{commit} (a valid Git commit ID represented as a hexadecimal
4375 string), or @var{branch}.
4376
4377 @cindex @file{channels.scm}, configuration file
4378 @cindex configuration file for channels
4379 These options are provided for convenience, but you can also specify your
4380 configuration in the @file{~/.config/guix/channels.scm} file or using the
4381 @option{--channels} option (see below).
4382
4383 @item --channels=@var{file}
4384 @itemx -C @var{file}
4385 Read the list of channels from @var{file} instead of
4386 @file{~/.config/guix/channels.scm} or @file{/etc/guix/channels.scm}.
4387 @var{file} must contain Scheme code that
4388 evaluates to a list of channel objects. @xref{Channels}, for more
4389 information.
4390
4391 @cindex channel news
4392 @item --news
4393 @itemx -N
4394 Display the list of packages added or upgraded since the previous
4395 generation, as well as, occasionally, news written by channel authors
4396 for their users (@pxref{Channels, Writing Channel News}).
4397
4398 The package information is the same as displayed upon @command{guix
4399 pull} completion, but without ellipses; it is also similar to the output
4400 of @command{guix pull -l} for the last generation (see below).
4401
4402 @item --list-generations[=@var{pattern}]
4403 @itemx -l [@var{pattern}]
4404 List all the generations of @file{~/.config/guix/current} or, if @var{pattern}
4405 is provided, the subset of generations that match @var{pattern}.
4406 The syntax of @var{pattern} is the same as with @code{guix package
4407 --list-generations} (@pxref{Invoking guix package}).
4408
4409 @item --roll-back
4410 @cindex rolling back
4411 @cindex undoing transactions
4412 @cindex transactions, undoing
4413 Roll back to the previous @dfn{generation} of @file{~/.config/guix/current}---i.e.,
4414 undo the last transaction.
4415
4416 @item --switch-generation=@var{pattern}
4417 @itemx -S @var{pattern}
4418 @cindex generations
4419 Switch to a particular generation defined by @var{pattern}.
4420
4421 @var{pattern} may be either a generation number or a number prefixed
4422 with ``+'' or ``-''. The latter means: move forward/backward by a
4423 specified number of generations. For example, if you want to return to
4424 the latest generation after @option{--roll-back}, use
4425 @option{--switch-generation=+1}.
4426
4427 @item --delete-generations[=@var{pattern}]
4428 @itemx -d [@var{pattern}]
4429 When @var{pattern} is omitted, delete all generations except the current
4430 one.
4431
4432 This command accepts the same patterns as @option{--list-generations}.
4433 When @var{pattern} is specified, delete the matching generations. When
4434 @var{pattern} specifies a duration, generations @emph{older} than the
4435 specified duration match. For instance, @option{--delete-generations=1m}
4436 deletes generations that are more than one month old.
4437
4438 If the current generation matches, it is @emph{not} deleted.
4439
4440 Note that deleting generations prevents rolling back to them.
4441 Consequently, this command must be used with care.
4442
4443 @xref{Invoking guix describe}, for a way to display information about the
4444 current generation only.
4445
4446 @item --profile=@var{profile}
4447 @itemx -p @var{profile}
4448 Use @var{profile} instead of @file{~/.config/guix/current}.
4449
4450 @item --dry-run
4451 @itemx -n
4452 Show which channel commit(s) would be used and what would be built or
4453 substituted but do not actually do it.
4454
4455 @item --allow-downgrades
4456 Allow pulling older or unrelated revisions of channels than those
4457 currently in use.
4458
4459 @cindex downgrade attacks, protection against
4460 By default, @command{guix pull} protects against so-called ``downgrade
4461 attacks'' whereby the Git repository of a channel would be reset to an
4462 earlier or unrelated revision of itself, potentially leading you to
4463 install older, known-vulnerable versions of software packages.
4464
4465 @quotation Note
4466 Make sure you understand its security implications before using
4467 @option{--allow-downgrades}.
4468 @end quotation
4469
4470 @item --disable-authentication
4471 Allow pulling channel code without authenticating it.
4472
4473 @cindex authentication, of channel code
4474 By default, @command{guix pull} authenticates code downloaded from
4475 channels by verifying that its commits are signed by authorized
4476 developers, and raises an error if this is not the case. This option
4477 instructs it to not perform any such verification.
4478
4479 @quotation Note
4480 Make sure you understand its security implications before using
4481 @option{--disable-authentication}.
4482 @end quotation
4483
4484 @item --system=@var{system}
4485 @itemx -s @var{system}
4486 Attempt to build for @var{system}---e.g., @code{i686-linux}---instead of
4487 the system type of the build host.
4488
4489 @item --bootstrap
4490 Use the bootstrap Guile to build the latest Guix. This option is only
4491 useful to Guix developers.
4492 @end table
4493
4494 The @dfn{channel} mechanism allows you to instruct @command{guix pull} which
4495 repository and branch to pull from, as well as @emph{additional} repositories
4496 containing package modules that should be deployed. @xref{Channels}, for more
4497 information.
4498
4499 In addition, @command{guix pull} supports all the common build options
4500 (@pxref{Common Build Options}).
4501
4502 @node Invoking guix time-machine
4503 @section Invoking @command{guix time-machine}
4504
4505 @cindex @command{guix time-machine}
4506 @cindex pinning, channels
4507 @cindex replicating Guix
4508 @cindex reproducibility, of Guix
4509
4510 The @command{guix time-machine} command provides access to other
4511 revisions of Guix, for example to install older versions of packages,
4512 or to reproduce a computation in an identical environment. The revision
4513 of Guix to be used is defined by a commit or by a channel
4514 description file created by @command{guix describe}
4515 (@pxref{Invoking guix describe}).
4516
4517 The general syntax is:
4518
4519 @example
4520 guix time-machine @var{options}@dots{} -- @var{command} @var {arg}@dots{}
4521 @end example
4522
4523 where @var{command} and @var{arg}@dots{} are passed unmodified to the
4524 @command{guix} command of the specified revision. The @var{options} that define
4525 this revision are the same as for @command{guix pull} (@pxref{Invoking guix pull}):
4526
4527 @table @code
4528 @item --url=@var{url}
4529 @itemx --commit=@var{commit}
4530 @itemx --branch=@var{branch}
4531 Use the @code{guix} channel from the specified @var{url}, at the
4532 given @var{commit} (a valid Git commit ID represented as a hexadecimal
4533 string), or @var{branch}.
4534
4535 @item --channels=@var{file}
4536 @itemx -C @var{file}
4537 Read the list of channels from @var{file}. @var{file} must contain
4538 Scheme code that evaluates to a list of channel objects.
4539 @xref{Channels} for more information.
4540 @end table
4541
4542 As for @command{guix pull}, the absence of any options means that the
4543 latest commit on the master branch will be used. The command
4544
4545 @example
4546 guix time-machine -- build hello
4547 @end example
4548
4549 will thus build the package @code{hello} as defined in the master branch,
4550 which is in general a newer revision of Guix than you have installed.
4551 Time travel works in both directions!
4552
4553 Note that @command{guix time-machine} can trigger builds of channels and
4554 their dependencies, and these are controlled by the standard build
4555 options (@pxref{Common Build Options}).
4556
4557 @node Inferiors
4558 @section Inferiors
4559
4560 @c TODO: Remove this once we're more confident about API stability.
4561 @quotation Note
4562 The functionality described here is a ``technology preview'' as of version
4563 @value{VERSION}. As such, the interface is subject to change.
4564 @end quotation
4565
4566 @cindex inferiors
4567 @cindex composition of Guix revisions
4568 Sometimes you might need to mix packages from the revision of Guix you're
4569 currently running with packages available in a different revision of Guix.
4570 Guix @dfn{inferiors} allow you to achieve that by composing different Guix
4571 revisions in arbitrary ways.
4572
4573 @cindex inferior packages
4574 Technically, an ``inferior'' is essentially a separate Guix process connected
4575 to your main Guix process through a REPL (@pxref{Invoking guix repl}). The
4576 @code{(guix inferior)} module allows you to create inferiors and to
4577 communicate with them. It also provides a high-level interface to browse and
4578 manipulate the packages that an inferior provides---@dfn{inferior packages}.
4579
4580 When combined with channels (@pxref{Channels}), inferiors provide a simple way
4581 to interact with a separate revision of Guix. For example, let's assume you
4582 want to install in your profile the current @code{guile} package, along with
4583 the @code{guile-json} as it existed in an older revision of Guix---perhaps
4584 because the newer @code{guile-json} has an incompatible API and you want to
4585 run your code against the old API@. To do that, you could write a manifest for
4586 use by @code{guix package --manifest} (@pxref{Invoking guix package}); in that
4587 manifest, you would create an inferior for that old Guix revision you care
4588 about, and you would look up the @code{guile-json} package in the inferior:
4589
4590 @lisp
4591 (use-modules (guix inferior) (guix channels)
4592 (srfi srfi-1)) ;for 'first'
4593
4594 (define channels
4595 ;; This is the old revision from which we want to
4596 ;; extract guile-json.
4597 (list (channel
4598 (name 'guix)
4599 (url "https://git.savannah.gnu.org/git/guix.git")
4600 (commit
4601 "65956ad3526ba09e1f7a40722c96c6ef7c0936fe"))))
4602
4603 (define inferior
4604 ;; An inferior representing the above revision.
4605 (inferior-for-channels channels))
4606
4607 ;; Now create a manifest with the current "guile" package
4608 ;; and the old "guile-json" package.
4609 (packages->manifest
4610 (list (first (lookup-inferior-packages inferior "guile-json"))
4611 (specification->package "guile")))
4612 @end lisp
4613
4614 On its first run, @command{guix package --manifest} might have to build the
4615 channel you specified before it can create the inferior; subsequent runs will
4616 be much faster because the Guix revision will be cached.
4617
4618 The @code{(guix inferior)} module provides the following procedures to open an
4619 inferior:
4620
4621 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} inferior-for-channels @var{channels} @
4622 [#:cache-directory] [#:ttl]
4623 Return an inferior for @var{channels}, a list of channels. Use the cache at
4624 @var{cache-directory}, where entries can be reclaimed after @var{ttl} seconds.
4625 This procedure opens a new connection to the build daemon.
4626
4627 As a side effect, this procedure may build or substitute binaries for
4628 @var{channels}, which can take time.
4629 @end deffn
4630
4631 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} open-inferior @var{directory} @
4632 [#:command "bin/guix"]
4633 Open the inferior Guix in @var{directory}, running
4634 @code{@var{directory}/@var{command} repl} or equivalent. Return @code{#f} if
4635 the inferior could not be launched.
4636 @end deffn
4637
4638 @cindex inferior packages
4639 The procedures listed below allow you to obtain and manipulate inferior
4640 packages.
4641
4642 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} inferior-packages @var{inferior}
4643 Return the list of packages known to @var{inferior}.
4644 @end deffn
4645
4646 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} lookup-inferior-packages @var{inferior} @var{name} @
4647 [@var{version}]
4648 Return the sorted list of inferior packages matching @var{name} in
4649 @var{inferior}, with highest version numbers first. If @var{version} is true,
4650 return only packages with a version number prefixed by @var{version}.
4651 @end deffn
4652
4653 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} inferior-package? @var{obj}
4654 Return true if @var{obj} is an inferior package.
4655 @end deffn
4656
4657 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} inferior-package-name @var{package}
4658 @deffnx {Scheme Procedure} inferior-package-version @var{package}
4659 @deffnx {Scheme Procedure} inferior-package-synopsis @var{package}
4660 @deffnx {Scheme Procedure} inferior-package-description @var{package}
4661 @deffnx {Scheme Procedure} inferior-package-home-page @var{package}
4662 @deffnx {Scheme Procedure} inferior-package-location @var{package}
4663 @deffnx {Scheme Procedure} inferior-package-inputs @var{package}
4664 @deffnx {Scheme Procedure} inferior-package-native-inputs @var{package}
4665 @deffnx {Scheme Procedure} inferior-package-propagated-inputs @var{package}
4666 @deffnx {Scheme Procedure} inferior-package-transitive-propagated-inputs @var{package}
4667 @deffnx {Scheme Procedure} inferior-package-native-search-paths @var{package}
4668 @deffnx {Scheme Procedure} inferior-package-transitive-native-search-paths @var{package}
4669 @deffnx {Scheme Procedure} inferior-package-search-paths @var{package}
4670 These procedures are the counterpart of package record accessors
4671 (@pxref{package Reference}). Most of them work by querying the inferior
4672 @var{package} comes from, so the inferior must still be live when you call
4673 these procedures.
4674 @end deffn
4675
4676 Inferior packages can be used transparently like any other package or
4677 file-like object in G-expressions (@pxref{G-Expressions}). They are also
4678 transparently handled by the @code{packages->manifest} procedure, which is
4679 commonly use in manifests (@pxref{Invoking guix package, the
4680 @option{--manifest} option of @command{guix package}}). Thus you can insert
4681 an inferior package pretty much anywhere you would insert a regular package:
4682 in manifests, in the @code{packages} field of your @code{operating-system}
4683 declaration, and so on.
4684
4685 @node Invoking guix describe
4686 @section Invoking @command{guix describe}
4687
4688 @cindex reproducibility
4689 @cindex replicating Guix
4690 Often you may want to answer questions like: ``Which revision of Guix am I
4691 using?'' or ``Which channels am I using?'' This is useful information in many
4692 situations: if you want to @emph{replicate} an environment on a different
4693 machine or user account, if you want to report a bug or to determine what
4694 change in the channels you are using caused it, or if you want to record your
4695 system state for reproducibility purposes. The @command{guix describe}
4696 command answers these questions.
4697
4698 When run from a @command{guix pull}ed @command{guix}, @command{guix describe}
4699 displays the channel(s) that it was built from, including their repository URL
4700 and commit IDs (@pxref{Channels}):
4701
4702 @example
4703 $ guix describe
4704 Generation 10 Sep 03 2018 17:32:44 (current)
4705 guix e0fa68c
4706 repository URL: https://git.savannah.gnu.org/git/guix.git
4707 branch: master
4708 commit: e0fa68c7718fffd33d81af415279d6ddb518f727
4709 @end example
4710
4711 If you're familiar with the Git version control system, this is similar in
4712 spirit to @command{git describe}; the output is also similar to that of
4713 @command{guix pull --list-generations}, but limited to the current generation
4714 (@pxref{Invoking guix pull, the @option{--list-generations} option}). Because
4715 the Git commit ID shown above unambiguously refers to a snapshot of Guix, this
4716 information is all it takes to describe the revision of Guix you're using, and
4717 also to replicate it.
4718
4719 To make it easier to replicate Guix, @command{guix describe} can also be asked
4720 to return a list of channels instead of the human-readable description above:
4721
4722 @example
4723 $ guix describe -f channels
4724 (list (channel
4725 (name 'guix)
4726 (url "https://git.savannah.gnu.org/git/guix.git")
4727 (commit
4728 "e0fa68c7718fffd33d81af415279d6ddb518f727")
4729 (introduction
4730 (make-channel-introduction
4731 "9edb3f66fd807b096b48283debdcddccfea34bad"
4732 (openpgp-fingerprint
4733 "BBB0 2DDF 2CEA F6A8 0D1D E643 A2A0 6DF2 A33A 54FA")))))
4734 @end example
4735
4736 @noindent
4737 You can save this to a file and feed it to @command{guix pull -C} on some
4738 other machine or at a later point in time, which will instantiate @emph{this
4739 exact Guix revision} (@pxref{Invoking guix pull, the @option{-C} option}).
4740 From there on, since you're able to deploy the same revision of Guix, you can
4741 just as well @emph{replicate a complete software environment}. We humbly
4742 think that this is @emph{awesome}, and we hope you'll like it too!
4743
4744 The details of the options supported by @command{guix describe} are as
4745 follows:
4746
4747 @table @code
4748 @item --format=@var{format}
4749 @itemx -f @var{format}
4750 Produce output in the specified @var{format}, one of:
4751
4752 @table @code
4753 @item human
4754 produce human-readable output;
4755 @item channels
4756 produce a list of channel specifications that can be passed to @command{guix
4757 pull -C} or installed as @file{~/.config/guix/channels.scm} (@pxref{Invoking
4758 guix pull});
4759 @item channels-sans-intro
4760 like @code{channels}, but omit the @code{introduction} field; use it to
4761 produce a channel specification suitable for Guix version 1.1.0 or
4762 earlier---the @code{introduction} field has to do with channel
4763 authentication (@pxref{Channels, Channel Authentication}) and is not
4764 supported by these older versions;
4765 @item json
4766 @cindex JSON
4767 produce a list of channel specifications in JSON format;
4768 @item recutils
4769 produce a list of channel specifications in Recutils format.
4770 @end table
4771
4772 @item --list-formats
4773 Display available formats for @option{--format} option.
4774
4775 @item --profile=@var{profile}
4776 @itemx -p @var{profile}
4777 Display information about @var{profile}.
4778 @end table
4779
4780 @node Invoking guix archive
4781 @section Invoking @command{guix archive}
4782
4783 @cindex @command{guix archive}
4784 @cindex archive
4785 The @command{guix archive} command allows users to @dfn{export} files
4786 from the store into a single archive, and to later @dfn{import} them on
4787 a machine that runs Guix.
4788 In particular, it allows store files to be transferred from one machine
4789 to the store on another machine.
4790
4791 @quotation Note
4792 If you're looking for a way to produce archives in a format suitable for
4793 tools other than Guix, @pxref{Invoking guix pack}.
4794 @end quotation
4795
4796 @cindex exporting store items
4797 To export store files as an archive to standard output, run:
4798
4799 @example
4800 guix archive --export @var{options} @var{specifications}...
4801 @end example
4802
4803 @var{specifications} may be either store file names or package
4804 specifications, as for @command{guix package} (@pxref{Invoking guix
4805 package}). For instance, the following command creates an archive
4806 containing the @code{gui} output of the @code{git} package and the main
4807 output of @code{emacs}:
4808
4809 @example
4810 guix archive --export git:gui /gnu/store/...-emacs-24.3 > great.nar
4811 @end example
4812
4813 If the specified packages are not built yet, @command{guix archive}
4814 automatically builds them. The build process may be controlled with the
4815 common build options (@pxref{Common Build Options}).
4816
4817 To transfer the @code{emacs} package to a machine connected over SSH,
4818 one would run:
4819
4820 @example
4821 guix archive --export -r emacs | ssh the-machine guix archive --import
4822 @end example
4823
4824 @noindent
4825 Similarly, a complete user profile may be transferred from one machine
4826 to another like this:
4827
4828 @example
4829 guix archive --export -r $(readlink -f ~/.guix-profile) | \
4830 ssh the-machine guix archive --import
4831 @end example
4832
4833 @noindent
4834 However, note that, in both examples, all of @code{emacs} and the
4835 profile as well as all of their dependencies are transferred (due to
4836 @option{-r}), regardless of what is already available in the store on
4837 the target machine. The @option{--missing} option can help figure out
4838 which items are missing from the target store. The @command{guix copy}
4839 command simplifies and optimizes this whole process, so this is probably
4840 what you should use in this case (@pxref{Invoking guix copy}).
4841
4842 @cindex nar, archive format
4843 @cindex normalized archive (nar)
4844 @cindex nar bundle, archive format
4845 Each store item is written in the @dfn{normalized archive} or @dfn{nar}
4846 format (described below), and the output of @command{guix archive
4847 --export} (and input of @command{guix archive --import}) is a @dfn{nar
4848 bundle}.
4849
4850 The nar format is
4851 comparable in spirit to `tar', but with differences
4852 that make it more appropriate for our purposes. First, rather than
4853 recording all Unix metadata for each file, the nar format only mentions
4854 the file type (regular, directory, or symbolic link); Unix permissions
4855 and owner/group are dismissed. Second, the order in which directory
4856 entries are stored always follows the order of file names according to
4857 the C locale collation order. This makes archive production fully
4858 deterministic.
4859
4860 That nar bundle format is essentially the concatenation of zero or more
4861 nars along with metadata for each store item it contains: its file name,
4862 references, corresponding derivation, and a digital signature.
4863
4864 When exporting, the daemon digitally signs the contents of the archive,
4865 and that digital signature is appended. When importing, the daemon
4866 verifies the signature and rejects the import in case of an invalid
4867 signature or if the signing key is not authorized.
4868 @c FIXME: Add xref to daemon doc about signatures.
4869
4870 The main options are:
4871
4872 @table @code
4873 @item --export
4874 Export the specified store files or packages (see below). Write the
4875 resulting archive to the standard output.
4876
4877 Dependencies are @emph{not} included in the output, unless
4878 @option{--recursive} is passed.
4879
4880 @item -r
4881 @itemx --recursive
4882 When combined with @option{--export}, this instructs @command{guix archive}
4883 to include dependencies of the given items in the archive. Thus, the
4884 resulting archive is self-contained: it contains the closure of the
4885 exported store items.
4886
4887 @item --import
4888 Read an archive from the standard input, and import the files listed
4889 therein into the store. Abort if the archive has an invalid digital
4890 signature, or if it is signed by a public key not among the authorized
4891 keys (see @option{--authorize} below).
4892
4893 @item --missing
4894 Read a list of store file names from the standard input, one per line,
4895 and write on the standard output the subset of these files missing from
4896 the store.
4897
4898 @item --generate-key[=@var{parameters}]
4899 @cindex signing, archives
4900 Generate a new key pair for the daemon. This is a prerequisite before
4901 archives can be exported with @option{--export}. This
4902 operation is usually instantaneous but it can take time if the system's
4903 entropy pool needs to be refilled. On Guix System,
4904 @code{guix-service-type} takes care of generating this key pair the
4905 first boot.
4906
4907 The generated key pair is typically stored under @file{/etc/guix}, in
4908 @file{signing-key.pub} (public key) and @file{signing-key.sec} (private
4909 key, which must be kept secret). When @var{parameters} is omitted,
4910 an ECDSA key using the Ed25519 curve is generated, or, for Libgcrypt
4911 versions before 1.6.0, it is a 4096-bit RSA key.
4912 Alternatively, @var{parameters} can specify
4913 @code{genkey} parameters suitable for Libgcrypt (@pxref{General
4914 public-key related Functions, @code{gcry_pk_genkey},, gcrypt, The
4915 Libgcrypt Reference Manual}).
4916
4917 @item --authorize
4918 @cindex authorizing, archives
4919 Authorize imports signed by the public key passed on standard input.
4920 The public key must be in ``s-expression advanced format''---i.e., the
4921 same format as the @file{signing-key.pub} file.
4922
4923 The list of authorized keys is kept in the human-editable file
4924 @file{/etc/guix/acl}. The file contains
4925 @url{https://people.csail.mit.edu/rivest/Sexp.txt, ``advanced-format
4926 s-expressions''} and is structured as an access-control list in the
4927 @url{https://theworld.com/~cme/spki.txt, Simple Public-Key Infrastructure
4928 (SPKI)}.
4929
4930 @item --extract=@var{directory}
4931 @itemx -x @var{directory}
4932 Read a single-item archive as served by substitute servers
4933 (@pxref{Substitutes}) and extract it to @var{directory}. This is a
4934 low-level operation needed in only very narrow use cases; see below.
4935
4936 For example, the following command extracts the substitute for Emacs
4937 served by @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}} to @file{/tmp/emacs}:
4938
4939 @example
4940 $ wget -O - \
4941 https://@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}/nar/gzip/@dots{}-emacs-24.5 \
4942 | gunzip | guix archive -x /tmp/emacs
4943 @end example
4944
4945 Single-item archives are different from multiple-item archives produced
4946 by @command{guix archive --export}; they contain a single store item,
4947 and they do @emph{not} embed a signature. Thus this operation does
4948 @emph{no} signature verification and its output should be considered
4949 unsafe.
4950
4951 The primary purpose of this operation is to facilitate inspection of
4952 archive contents coming from possibly untrusted substitute servers
4953 (@pxref{Invoking guix challenge}).
4954
4955 @item --list
4956 @itemx -t
4957 Read a single-item archive as served by substitute servers
4958 (@pxref{Substitutes}) and print the list of files it contains, as in
4959 this example:
4960
4961 @example
4962 $ wget -O - \
4963 https://@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}/nar/lzip/@dots{}-emacs-26.3 \
4964 | lzip -d | guix archive -t
4965 @end example
4966
4967 @end table
4968
4969 @c *********************************************************************
4970 @node Channels
4971 @chapter Channels
4972
4973 @cindex channels
4974 @cindex @file{channels.scm}, configuration file
4975 @cindex configuration file for channels
4976 @cindex @command{guix pull}, configuration file
4977 @cindex configuration of @command{guix pull}
4978 Guix and its package collection are updated by running @command{guix pull}
4979 (@pxref{Invoking guix pull}). By default @command{guix pull} downloads and
4980 deploys Guix itself from the official GNU@tie{}Guix repository. This can be
4981 customized by defining @dfn{channels} in the
4982 @file{~/.config/guix/channels.scm} file. A channel specifies a URL and branch
4983 of a Git repository to be deployed, and @command{guix pull} can be instructed
4984 to pull from one or more channels. In other words, channels can be used
4985 to @emph{customize} and to @emph{extend} Guix, as we will see below.
4986 Guix is able to take into account security concerns and deal with authenticated
4987 updates.
4988
4989 @menu
4990 * Specifying Additional Channels:: Extending the package collection.
4991 * Using a Custom Guix Channel:: Using a customized Guix.
4992 * Replicating Guix:: Running the @emph{exact same} Guix.
4993 * Channel Authentication:: How Guix verifies what it fetches.
4994 * Creating a Channel:: How to write your custom channel.
4995 * Package Modules in a Sub-directory:: Specifying the channel's package modules location.
4996 * Declaring Channel Dependencies:: How to depend on other channels.
4997 * Specifying Channel Authorizations:: Defining channel authors authorizations.
4998 * Primary URL:: Distinguishing mirror to original.
4999 * Writing Channel News:: Communicating information to channel's users.
5000 * Channels with Substitutes:: Using channels with available substitutes.
5001 @end menu
5002
5003 @node Specifying Additional Channels
5004 @section Specifying Additional Channels
5005
5006 @cindex extending the package collection (channels)
5007 @cindex variant packages (channels)
5008 You can specify @emph{additional channels} to pull from. To use a channel, write
5009 @code{~/.config/guix/channels.scm} to instruct @command{guix pull} to pull from it
5010 @emph{in addition} to the default Guix channel(s):
5011
5012 @vindex %default-channels
5013 @lisp
5014 ;; Add variant packages to those Guix provides.
5015 (cons (channel
5016 (name 'variant-packages)
5017 (url "https://example.org/variant-packages.git"))
5018 %default-channels)
5019 @end lisp
5020
5021 @noindent
5022 Note that the snippet above is (as always!)@: Scheme code; we use @code{cons} to
5023 add a channel the list of channels that the variable @code{%default-channels}
5024 is bound to (@pxref{Pairs, @code{cons} and lists,, guile, GNU Guile Reference
5025 Manual}). With this file in place, @command{guix pull} builds not only Guix
5026 but also the package modules from your own repository. The result in
5027 @file{~/.config/guix/current} is the union of Guix with your own package
5028 modules:
5029
5030 @example
5031 $ guix pull --list-generations
5032 @dots{}
5033 Generation 19 Aug 27 2018 16:20:48
5034 guix d894ab8
5035 repository URL: https://git.savannah.gnu.org/git/guix.git
5036 branch: master
5037 commit: d894ab8e9bfabcefa6c49d9ba2e834dd5a73a300
5038 variant-packages dd3df5e
5039 repository URL: https://example.org/variant-packages.git
5040 branch: master
5041 commit: dd3df5e2c8818760a8fc0bd699e55d3b69fef2bb
5042 11 new packages: variant-gimp, variant-emacs-with-cool-features, @dots{}
5043 4 packages upgraded: emacs-racket-mode@@0.0.2-2.1b78827, @dots{}
5044 @end example
5045
5046 @noindent
5047 The output of @command{guix pull} above shows that Generation@tie{}19 includes
5048 both Guix and packages from the @code{variant-personal-packages} channel. Among
5049 the new and upgraded packages that are listed, some like @code{variant-gimp} and
5050 @code{variant-emacs-with-cool-features} might come from
5051 @code{variant-packages}, while others come from the Guix default channel.
5052
5053 @node Using a Custom Guix Channel
5054 @section Using a Custom Guix Channel
5055
5056 The channel called @code{guix} specifies where Guix itself---its command-line
5057 tools as well as its package collection---should be downloaded. For instance,
5058 suppose you want to update from another copy of the Guix repository at
5059 @code{example.org}, and specifically the @code{super-hacks} branch, you can
5060 write in @code{~/.config/guix/channels.scm} this specification:
5061
5062 @lisp
5063 ;; Tell 'guix pull' to use another repo.
5064 (list (channel
5065 (name 'guix)
5066 (url "https://example.org/another-guix.git")
5067 (branch "super-hacks")))
5068 @end lisp
5069
5070 @noindent
5071 From there on, @command{guix pull} will fetch code from the @code{super-hacks}
5072 branch of the repository at @code{example.org}. The authentication concern is
5073 addressed below ((@pxref{Channel Authentication}).
5074
5075 @node Replicating Guix
5076 @section Replicating Guix
5077
5078 @cindex pinning, channels
5079 @cindex replicating Guix
5080 @cindex reproducibility, of Guix
5081 The @command{guix pull --list-generations} output above shows precisely which
5082 commits were used to build this instance of Guix. We can thus replicate it,
5083 say, on another machine, by providing a channel specification in
5084 @file{~/.config/guix/channels.scm} that is ``pinned'' to these commits:
5085
5086 @lisp
5087 ;; Deploy specific commits of my channels of interest.
5088 (list (channel
5089 (name 'guix)
5090 (url "https://git.savannah.gnu.org/git/guix.git")
5091 (commit "6298c3ffd9654d3231a6f25390b056483e8f407c"))
5092 (channel
5093 (name 'variant-packages)
5094 (url "https://example.org/variant-packages.git")
5095 (commit "dd3df5e2c8818760a8fc0bd699e55d3b69fef2bb")))
5096 @end lisp
5097
5098 The @command{guix describe --format=channels} command can even generate this
5099 list of channels directly (@pxref{Invoking guix describe}). The resulting
5100 file can be used with the -C options of @command{guix pull}
5101 (@pxref{Invoking guix pull}) or @command{guix time-machine}
5102 (@pxref{Invoking guix time-machine}).
5103
5104 At this point the two machines run the @emph{exact same Guix}, with access to
5105 the @emph{exact same packages}. The output of @command{guix build gimp} on
5106 one machine will be exactly the same, bit for bit, as the output of the same
5107 command on the other machine. It also means both machines have access to all
5108 the source code of Guix and, transitively, to all the source code of every
5109 package it defines.
5110
5111 This gives you super powers, allowing you to track the provenance of binary
5112 artifacts with very fine grain, and to reproduce software environments at
5113 will---some sort of ``meta reproducibility'' capabilities, if you will.
5114 @xref{Inferiors}, for another way to take advantage of these super powers.
5115
5116 @node Channel Authentication
5117 @section Channel Authentication
5118
5119 @anchor{channel-authentication}
5120 @cindex authentication, of channel code
5121 The @command{guix pull} and @command{guix time-machine} commands
5122 @dfn{authenticate} the code retrieved from channels: they make sure each
5123 commit that is fetched is signed by an authorized developer. The goal
5124 is to protect from unauthorized modifications to the channel that would
5125 lead users to run malicious code.
5126
5127 As a user, you must provide a @dfn{channel introduction} in your
5128 channels file so that Guix knows how to authenticate its first commit.
5129 A channel specification, including its introduction, looks something
5130 along these lines:
5131
5132 @lisp
5133 (channel
5134 (name 'some-channel)
5135 (url "https://example.org/some-channel.git")
5136 (introduction
5137 (make-channel-introduction
5138 "6f0d8cc0d88abb59c324b2990bfee2876016bb86"
5139 (openpgp-fingerprint
5140 "CABB A931 C0FF EEC6 900D 0CFB 090B 1199 3D9A EBB5"))))
5141 @end lisp
5142
5143 The specification above shows the name and URL of the channel. The call
5144 to @code{make-channel-introduction} above specifies that authentication
5145 of this channel starts at commit @code{6f0d8cc@dots{}}, which is signed
5146 by the OpenPGP key with fingerprint @code{CABB A931@dots{}}.
5147
5148 For the main channel, called @code{guix}, you automatically get that
5149 information from your Guix installation. For other channels, include
5150 the channel introduction provided by the channel authors in your
5151 @file{channels.scm} file. Make sure you retrieve the channel
5152 introduction from a trusted source since that is the root of your trust.
5153
5154 If you're curious about the authentication mechanics, read on!
5155
5156 @node Creating a Channel
5157 @section Creating a Channel
5158
5159 @cindex personal packages (channels)
5160 @cindex channels, for personal packages
5161 Let's say you have a bunch of custom package variants or personal packages
5162 that you think would make little sense to contribute to the Guix project, but
5163 would like to have these packages transparently available to you at the
5164 command line. You would first write modules containing those package
5165 definitions (@pxref{Package Modules}), maintain them in a Git repository, and
5166 then you and anyone else can use it as an additional channel to get packages
5167 from. Neat, no?
5168
5169 @c What follows stems from discussions at
5170 @c <https://debbugs.gnu.org/cgi/bugreport.cgi?bug=22629#134> as well as
5171 @c earlier discussions on guix-devel@gnu.org.
5172 @quotation Warning
5173 Before you, dear user, shout---``woow this is @emph{soooo coool}!''---and
5174 publish your personal channel to the world, we would like to share a few words
5175 of caution:
5176
5177 @itemize
5178 @item
5179 Before publishing a channel, please consider contributing your package
5180 definitions to Guix proper (@pxref{Contributing}). Guix as a project is open
5181 to free software of all sorts, and packages in Guix proper are readily
5182 available to all Guix users and benefit from the project's quality assurance
5183 process.
5184
5185 @item
5186 When you maintain package definitions outside Guix, we, Guix developers,
5187 consider that @emph{the compatibility burden is on you}. Remember that
5188 package modules and package definitions are just Scheme code that uses various
5189 programming interfaces (APIs). We want to remain free to change these APIs to
5190 keep improving Guix, possibly in ways that break your channel. We never
5191 change APIs gratuitously, but we will @emph{not} commit to freezing APIs
5192 either.
5193
5194 @item
5195 Corollary: if you're using an external channel and that channel breaks, please
5196 @emph{report the issue to the channel authors}, not to the Guix project.
5197 @end itemize
5198
5199 You've been warned! Having said this, we believe external channels are a
5200 practical way to exert your freedom to augment Guix' package collection and to
5201 share your improvements, which are basic tenets of
5202 @uref{https://www.gnu.org/philosophy/free-sw.html, free software}. Please
5203 email us at @email{guix-devel@@gnu.org} if you'd like to discuss this.
5204 @end quotation
5205
5206 To create a channel, create a Git repository containing your own package
5207 modules and make it available. The repository can contain anything, but a
5208 useful channel will contain Guile modules that export packages. Once you
5209 start using a channel, Guix will behave as if the root directory of that
5210 channel's Git repository has been added to the Guile load path (@pxref{Load
5211 Paths,,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}). For example, if your channel
5212 contains a file at @file{my-packages/my-tools.scm} that defines a Guile
5213 module, then the module will be available under the name @code{(my-packages
5214 my-tools)}, and you will be able to use it like any other module
5215 (@pxref{Modules,,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}).
5216
5217 As a channel author, consider bundling authentication material with your
5218 channel so that users can authenticate it. @xref{Channel
5219 Authentication}, and @ref{Specifying Channel Authorizations}, for info
5220 on how to do it.
5221
5222
5223 @node Package Modules in a Sub-directory
5224 @section Package Modules in a Sub-directory
5225
5226 @cindex subdirectory, channels
5227 As a channel author, you may want to keep your channel modules in a
5228 sub-directory. If your modules are in the sub-directory @file{guix}, you must
5229 add a meta-data file @file{.guix-channel} that contains:
5230
5231 @lisp
5232 (channel
5233 (version 0)
5234 (directory "guix"))
5235 @end lisp
5236
5237 @node Declaring Channel Dependencies
5238 @section Declaring Channel Dependencies
5239
5240 @cindex dependencies, channels
5241 @cindex meta-data, channels
5242 Channel authors may decide to augment a package collection provided by other
5243 channels. They can declare their channel to be dependent on other channels in
5244 a meta-data file @file{.guix-channel}, which is to be placed in the root of
5245 the channel repository.
5246
5247 The meta-data file should contain a simple S-expression like this:
5248
5249 @lisp
5250 (channel
5251 (version 0)
5252 (dependencies
5253 (channel
5254 (name 'some-collection)
5255 (url "https://example.org/first-collection.git")
5256
5257 ;; The 'introduction' bit below is optional: you would
5258 ;; provide it for dependencies that can be authenticated.
5259 (introduction
5260 (channel-introduction
5261 (version 0)
5262 (commit "a8883b58dc82e167c96506cf05095f37c2c2c6cd")
5263 (signer "CABB A931 C0FF EEC6 900D 0CFB 090B 1199 3D9A EBB5"))))
5264 (channel
5265 (name 'some-other-collection)
5266 (url "https://example.org/second-collection.git")
5267 (branch "testing"))))
5268 @end lisp
5269
5270 In the above example this channel is declared to depend on two other channels,
5271 which will both be fetched automatically. The modules provided by the channel
5272 will be compiled in an environment where the modules of all these declared
5273 channels are available.
5274
5275 For the sake of reliability and maintainability, you should avoid dependencies
5276 on channels that you don't control, and you should aim to keep the number of
5277 dependencies to a minimum.
5278
5279 @node Specifying Channel Authorizations
5280 @section Specifying Channel Authorizations
5281
5282 @cindex channel authorizations
5283 @anchor{channel-authorizations}
5284 As we saw above, Guix ensures the source code it pulls from channels
5285 comes from authorized developers. As a channel author, you need to
5286 specify the list of authorized developers in the
5287 @file{.guix-authorizations} file in the channel's Git repository. The
5288 authentication rule is simple: each commit must be signed by a key
5289 listed in the @file{.guix-authorizations} file of its parent
5290 commit(s)@footnote{Git commits form a @dfn{directed acyclic graph}
5291 (DAG). Each commit can have zero or more parents; ``regular'' commits
5292 have one parent and merge commits have two parent commits. Read
5293 @uref{https://eagain.net/articles/git-for-computer-scientists/, @i{Git
5294 for Computer Scientists}} for a great overview.} The
5295 @file{.guix-authorizations} file looks like this:
5296
5297 @lisp
5298 ;; Example '.guix-authorizations' file.
5299
5300 (authorizations
5301 (version 0) ;current file format version
5302
5303 (("AD17 A21E F8AE D8F1 CC02 DBD9 F8AE D8F1 765C 61E3"
5304 (name "alice"))
5305 ("2A39 3FFF 68F4 EF7A 3D29 12AF 68F4 EF7A 22FB B2D5"
5306 (name "bob"))
5307 ("CABB A931 C0FF EEC6 900D 0CFB 090B 1199 3D9A EBB5"
5308 (name "charlie"))))
5309 @end lisp
5310
5311 Each fingerprint is followed by optional key/value pairs, as in the
5312 example above. Currently these key/value pairs are ignored.
5313
5314 This authentication rule creates a chicken-and-egg issue: how do we
5315 authenticate the first commit? Related to that: how do we deal with
5316 channels whose repository history contains unsigned commits and lack
5317 @file{.guix-authorizations}? And how do we fork existing channels?
5318
5319 @cindex channel introduction
5320 Channel introductions answer these questions by describing the first
5321 commit of a channel that should be authenticated. The first time a
5322 channel is fetched with @command{guix pull} or @command{guix
5323 time-machine}, the command looks up the introductory commit and verifies
5324 that it is signed by the specified OpenPGP key. From then on, it
5325 authenticates commits according to the rule above.
5326
5327 Additionally, your channel must provide all the OpenPGP keys that were
5328 ever mentioned in @file{.guix-authorizations}, stored as @file{.key}
5329 files, which can be either binary or ``ASCII-armored''. By default,
5330 those @file{.key} files are searched for in the branch named
5331 @code{keyring} but you can specify a different branch name in
5332 @code{.guix-channel} like so:
5333
5334 @lisp
5335 (channel
5336 (version 0)
5337 (keyring-reference "my-keyring-branch"))
5338 @end lisp
5339
5340 To summarize, as the author of a channel, there are three things you have
5341 to do to allow users to authenticate your code:
5342
5343 @enumerate
5344 @item
5345 Export the OpenPGP keys of past and present committers with @command{gpg
5346 --export} and store them in @file{.key} files, by default in a branch
5347 named @code{keyring} (we recommend making it an @dfn{orphan branch}).
5348
5349 @item
5350 Introduce an initial @file{.guix-authorizations} in the channel's
5351 repository. Do that in a signed commit (@pxref{Commit Access}, for
5352 information on how to sign Git commits.)
5353
5354 @item
5355 Advertise the channel introduction, for instance on your channel's web
5356 page. The channel introduction, as we saw above, is the commit/key
5357 pair---i.e., the commit that introduced @file{.guix-authorizations}, and
5358 the fingerprint of the OpenPGP used to sign it.
5359 @end enumerate
5360
5361 Before pushing to your public Git repository, you can run @command{guix
5362 git-authenticate} to verify that you did sign all the commits you are
5363 about to push with an authorized key:
5364
5365 @example
5366 guix git authenticate @var{commit} @var{signer}
5367 @end example
5368
5369 @noindent
5370 where @var{commit} and @var{signer} are your channel introduction.
5371 @xref{Invoking guix git authenticate}, for details.
5372
5373 Publishing a signed channel requires discipline: any mistake, such as an
5374 unsigned commit or a commit signed by an unauthorized key, will prevent
5375 users from pulling from your channel---well, that's the whole point of
5376 authentication! Pay attention to merges in particular: merge commits
5377 are considered authentic if and only if they are signed by a key present
5378 in the @file{.guix-authorizations} file of @emph{both} branches.
5379
5380 @node Primary URL
5381 @section Primary URL
5382
5383 @cindex primary URL, channels
5384 Channel authors can indicate the primary URL of their channel's Git
5385 repository in the @file{.guix-channel} file, like so:
5386
5387 @lisp
5388 (channel
5389 (version 0)
5390 (url "https://example.org/guix.git"))
5391 @end lisp
5392
5393 This allows @command{guix pull} to determine whether it is pulling code
5394 from a mirror of the channel; when that is the case, it warns the user
5395 that the mirror might be stale and displays the primary URL@. That way,
5396 users cannot be tricked into fetching code from a stale mirror that does
5397 not receive security updates.
5398
5399 This feature only makes sense for authenticated repositories, such as
5400 the official @code{guix} channel, for which @command{guix pull} ensures
5401 the code it fetches is authentic.
5402
5403 @node Writing Channel News
5404 @section Writing Channel News
5405
5406 @cindex news, for channels
5407 Channel authors may occasionally want to communicate to their users
5408 information about important changes in the channel. You'd send them all
5409 an email, but that's not convenient.
5410
5411 Instead, channels can provide a @dfn{news file}; when the channel users
5412 run @command{guix pull}, that news file is automatically read and
5413 @command{guix pull --news} can display the announcements that correspond
5414 to the new commits that have been pulled, if any.
5415
5416 To do that, channel authors must first declare the name of the news file
5417 in their @file{.guix-channel} file:
5418
5419 @lisp
5420 (channel
5421 (version 0)
5422 (news-file "etc/news.txt"))
5423 @end lisp
5424
5425 The news file itself, @file{etc/news.txt} in this example, must look
5426 something like this:
5427
5428 @lisp
5429 (channel-news
5430 (version 0)
5431 (entry (tag "the-bug-fix")
5432 (title (en "Fixed terrible bug")
5433 (fr "Oh la la"))
5434 (body (en "@@emph@{Good news@}! It's fixed!")
5435 (eo "Certe ĝi pli bone funkcias nun!")))
5436 (entry (commit "bdcabe815cd28144a2d2b4bc3c5057b051fa9906")
5437 (title (en "Added a great package")
5438 (ca "Què vol dir guix?"))
5439 (body (en "Don't miss the @@code@{hello@} package!"))))
5440 @end lisp
5441
5442 While the news file is using the Scheme syntax, avoid naming it with a
5443 @file{.scm} extension or else it will get picked up when building the
5444 channel and yield an error since it is not a valid module.
5445 Alternatively, you can move the channel module to a subdirectory and
5446 store the news file in another directory.
5447
5448 The file consists of a list of @dfn{news entries}. Each entry is
5449 associated with a commit or tag: it describes changes made in this
5450 commit, possibly in preceding commits as well. Users see entries only
5451 the first time they obtain the commit the entry refers to.
5452
5453 The @code{title} field should be a one-line summary while @code{body}
5454 can be arbitrarily long, and both can contain Texinfo markup
5455 (@pxref{Overview,,, texinfo, GNU Texinfo}). Both the title and body are
5456 a list of language tag/message tuples, which allows @command{guix pull}
5457 to display news in the language that corresponds to the user's locale.
5458
5459 If you want to translate news using a gettext-based workflow, you can
5460 extract translatable strings with @command{xgettext} (@pxref{xgettext
5461 Invocation,,, gettext, GNU Gettext Utilities}). For example, assuming
5462 you write news entries in English first, the command below creates a PO
5463 file containing the strings to translate:
5464
5465 @example
5466 xgettext -o news.po -l scheme -ken etc/news.txt
5467 @end example
5468
5469 To sum up, yes, you could use your channel as a blog. But beware, this
5470 is @emph{not quite} what your users might expect.
5471
5472 @node Channels with Substitutes
5473 @section Channels with Substitutes
5474
5475 When running @command{guix pull}, Guix will first compile the
5476 definitions of every available package. This is an expensive operation
5477 for which substitutes (@pxref{Substitutes}) may be available. The
5478 following snippet in @file{channels.scm} will ensure that @command{guix
5479 pull} uses the latest commit with available substitutes for the package
5480 definitions: this is done by querying the continuous integration
5481 server at @url{https://ci.guix.gnu.org}.
5482
5483 @lisp
5484 (use-modules (guix ci))
5485
5486 (list (channel-with-substitutes-available
5487 %default-guix-channel
5488 "https://ci.guix.gnu.org"))
5489 @end lisp
5490
5491 Note that this does not mean that all the packages that you will
5492 install after running @command{guix pull} will have available
5493 substitutes. It only ensures that @command{guix pull} will not try to
5494 compile package definitions. This is particularly useful when using
5495 machines with limited resources.
5496
5497 @c *********************************************************************
5498 @node Development
5499 @chapter Development
5500
5501 @cindex software development
5502 If you are a software developer, Guix provides tools that you should find
5503 helpful---independently of the language you're developing in. This is what
5504 this chapter is about.
5505
5506 The @command{guix environment} command provides a convenient way to set up
5507 @dfn{development environments} containing all the dependencies and tools
5508 necessary to work on the software package of your choice. The @command{guix
5509 pack} command allows you to create @dfn{application bundles} that can be
5510 easily distributed to users who do not run Guix.
5511
5512 @menu
5513 * Invoking guix environment:: Setting up development environments.
5514 * Invoking guix pack:: Creating software bundles.
5515 * The GCC toolchain:: Working with languages supported by GCC.
5516 * Invoking guix git authenticate:: Authenticating Git repositories.
5517 @end menu
5518
5519 @node Invoking guix environment
5520 @section Invoking @command{guix environment}
5521
5522 @cindex reproducible build environments
5523 @cindex development environments
5524 @cindex @command{guix environment}
5525 @cindex environment, package build environment
5526 The purpose of @command{guix environment} is to assist hackers in
5527 creating reproducible development environments without polluting their
5528 package profile. The @command{guix environment} tool takes one or more
5529 packages, builds all of their inputs, and creates a shell
5530 environment to use them.
5531
5532 The general syntax is:
5533
5534 @example
5535 guix environment @var{options} @var{package}@dots{}
5536 @end example
5537
5538 The following example spawns a new shell set up for the development of
5539 GNU@tie{}Guile:
5540
5541 @example
5542 guix environment guile
5543 @end example
5544
5545 If the needed dependencies are not built yet, @command{guix environment}
5546 automatically builds them. The environment of the new shell is an
5547 augmented version of the environment that @command{guix environment} was
5548 run in. It contains the necessary search paths for building the given
5549 package added to the existing environment variables. To create
5550 a ``pure'' environment, in which the original environment variables have
5551 been unset, use the @option{--pure} option@footnote{Users sometimes
5552 wrongfully augment environment variables such as @env{PATH} in their
5553 @file{~/.bashrc} file. As a consequence, when @command{guix
5554 environment} launches it, Bash may read @file{~/.bashrc}, thereby
5555 introducing ``impurities'' in these environment variables. It is an
5556 error to define such environment variables in @file{.bashrc}; instead,
5557 they should be defined in @file{.bash_profile}, which is sourced only by
5558 log-in shells. @xref{Bash Startup Files,,, bash, The GNU Bash Reference
5559 Manual}, for details on Bash start-up files.}.
5560
5561 Exiting from a Guix environment is the same as exiting from the shell,
5562 and will place the user back in the old environment before @command{guix
5563 environment} was invoked. The next garbage collection (@pxref{Invoking
5564 guix gc}) will clean up packages that were installed from within the
5565 environment and are no longer used outside of it.
5566
5567 @vindex GUIX_ENVIRONMENT
5568 @command{guix environment} defines the @env{GUIX_ENVIRONMENT}
5569 variable in the shell it spawns; its value is the file name of the
5570 profile of this environment. This allows users to, say, define a
5571 specific prompt for development environments in their @file{.bashrc}
5572 (@pxref{Bash Startup Files,,, bash, The GNU Bash Reference Manual}):
5573
5574 @example
5575 if [ -n "$GUIX_ENVIRONMENT" ]
5576 then
5577 export PS1="\u@@\h \w [dev]\$ "
5578 fi
5579 @end example
5580
5581 @noindent
5582 ...@: or to browse the profile:
5583
5584 @example
5585 $ ls "$GUIX_ENVIRONMENT/bin"
5586 @end example
5587
5588 Additionally, more than one package may be specified, in which case the
5589 union of the inputs for the given packages are used. For example, the
5590 command below spawns a shell where all of the dependencies of both Guile
5591 and Emacs are available:
5592
5593 @example
5594 guix environment guile emacs
5595 @end example
5596
5597 Sometimes an interactive shell session is not desired. An arbitrary
5598 command may be invoked by placing the @code{--} token to separate the
5599 command from the rest of the arguments:
5600
5601 @example
5602 guix environment guile -- make -j4
5603 @end example
5604
5605 In other situations, it is more convenient to specify the list of
5606 packages needed in the environment. For example, the following command
5607 runs @command{python} from an environment containing Python@tie{}2.7 and
5608 NumPy:
5609
5610 @example
5611 guix environment --ad-hoc python2-numpy python-2.7 -- python
5612 @end example
5613
5614 Furthermore, one might want the dependencies of a package and also some
5615 additional packages that are not build-time or runtime dependencies, but
5616 are useful when developing nonetheless. Because of this, the
5617 @option{--ad-hoc} flag is positional. Packages appearing before
5618 @option{--ad-hoc} are interpreted as packages whose dependencies will be
5619 added to the environment. Packages appearing after are interpreted as
5620 packages that will be added to the environment directly. For example,
5621 the following command creates a Guix development environment that
5622 additionally includes Git and strace:
5623
5624 @example
5625 guix environment --pure guix --ad-hoc git strace
5626 @end example
5627
5628 @cindex container
5629 Sometimes it is desirable to isolate the environment as much as
5630 possible, for maximal purity and reproducibility. In particular, when
5631 using Guix on a host distro that is not Guix System, it is desirable to
5632 prevent access to @file{/usr/bin} and other system-wide resources from
5633 the development environment. For example, the following command spawns
5634 a Guile REPL in a ``container'' where only the store and the current
5635 working directory are mounted:
5636
5637 @example
5638 guix environment --ad-hoc --container guile -- guile
5639 @end example
5640
5641 @quotation Note
5642 The @option{--container} option requires Linux-libre 3.19 or newer.
5643 @end quotation
5644
5645 @cindex certificates
5646 Another typical use case for containers is to run security-sensitive
5647 applications such as a web browser. To run Eolie, we must expose and
5648 share some files and directories; we include @code{nss-certs} and expose
5649 @file{/etc/ssl/certs/} for HTTPS authentication; finally we preserve the
5650 @env{DISPLAY} environment variable since containerized graphical
5651 applications won't display without it.
5652
5653 @example
5654 guix environment --preserve='^DISPLAY$' --container --network \
5655 --expose=/etc/machine-id \
5656 --expose=/etc/ssl/certs/ \
5657 --share=$HOME/.local/share/eolie/=$HOME/.local/share/eolie/ \
5658 --ad-hoc eolie nss-certs dbus -- eolie
5659 @end example
5660
5661 The available options are summarized below.
5662
5663 @table @code
5664 @item --root=@var{file}
5665 @itemx -r @var{file}
5666 @cindex persistent environment
5667 @cindex garbage collector root, for environments
5668 Make @var{file} a symlink to the profile for this environment, and
5669 register it as a garbage collector root.
5670
5671 This is useful if you want to protect your environment from garbage
5672 collection, to make it ``persistent''.
5673
5674 When this option is omitted, the environment is protected from garbage
5675 collection only for the duration of the @command{guix environment}
5676 session. This means that next time you recreate the same environment,
5677 you could have to rebuild or re-download packages. @xref{Invoking guix
5678 gc}, for more on GC roots.
5679
5680 @item --expression=@var{expr}
5681 @itemx -e @var{expr}
5682 Create an environment for the package or list of packages that
5683 @var{expr} evaluates to.
5684
5685 For example, running:
5686
5687 @example
5688 guix environment -e '(@@ (gnu packages maths) petsc-openmpi)'
5689 @end example
5690
5691 starts a shell with the environment for this specific variant of the
5692 PETSc package.
5693
5694 Running:
5695
5696 @example
5697 guix environment --ad-hoc -e '(@@ (gnu) %base-packages)'
5698 @end example
5699
5700 starts a shell with all the base system packages available.
5701
5702 The above commands only use the default output of the given packages.
5703 To select other outputs, two element tuples can be specified:
5704
5705 @example
5706 guix environment --ad-hoc -e '(list (@@ (gnu packages bash) bash) "include")'
5707 @end example
5708
5709 @item --load=@var{file}
5710 @itemx -l @var{file}
5711 Create an environment for the package or list of packages that the code
5712 within @var{file} evaluates to.
5713
5714 As an example, @var{file} might contain a definition like this
5715 (@pxref{Defining Packages}):
5716
5717 @lisp
5718 @verbatiminclude environment-gdb.scm
5719 @end lisp
5720
5721 @item --manifest=@var{file}
5722 @itemx -m @var{file}
5723 Create an environment for the packages contained in the manifest object
5724 returned by the Scheme code in @var{file}. This option can be repeated
5725 several times, in which case the manifests are concatenated.
5726
5727 This is similar to the same-named option in @command{guix package}
5728 (@pxref{profile-manifest, @option{--manifest}}) and uses the same
5729 manifest files.
5730
5731 @item --ad-hoc
5732 Include all specified packages in the resulting environment, as if an
5733 @i{ad hoc} package were defined with them as inputs. This option is
5734 useful for quickly creating an environment without having to write a
5735 package expression to contain the desired inputs.
5736
5737 For instance, the command:
5738
5739 @example
5740 guix environment --ad-hoc guile guile-sdl -- guile
5741 @end example
5742
5743 runs @command{guile} in an environment where Guile and Guile-SDL are
5744 available.
5745
5746 Note that this example implicitly asks for the default output of
5747 @code{guile} and @code{guile-sdl}, but it is possible to ask for a
5748 specific output---e.g., @code{glib:bin} asks for the @code{bin} output
5749 of @code{glib} (@pxref{Packages with Multiple Outputs}).
5750
5751 This option may be composed with the default behavior of @command{guix
5752 environment}. Packages appearing before @option{--ad-hoc} are
5753 interpreted as packages whose dependencies will be added to the
5754 environment, the default behavior. Packages appearing after are
5755 interpreted as packages that will be added to the environment directly.
5756
5757 @item --pure
5758 Unset existing environment variables when building the new environment, except
5759 those specified with @option{--preserve} (see below). This has the effect of
5760 creating an environment in which search paths only contain package inputs.
5761
5762 @item --preserve=@var{regexp}
5763 @itemx -E @var{regexp}
5764 When used alongside @option{--pure}, preserve the environment variables
5765 matching @var{regexp}---in other words, put them on a ``white list'' of
5766 environment variables that must be preserved. This option can be repeated
5767 several times.
5768
5769 @example
5770 guix environment --pure --preserve=^SLURM --ad-hoc openmpi @dots{} \
5771 -- mpirun @dots{}
5772 @end example
5773
5774 This example runs @command{mpirun} in a context where the only environment
5775 variables defined are @env{PATH}, environment variables whose name starts
5776 with @samp{SLURM}, as well as the usual ``precious'' variables (@env{HOME},
5777 @env{USER}, etc.).
5778
5779 @item --search-paths
5780 Display the environment variable definitions that make up the
5781 environment.
5782
5783 @item --system=@var{system}
5784 @itemx -s @var{system}
5785 Attempt to build for @var{system}---e.g., @code{i686-linux}.
5786
5787 @item --container
5788 @itemx -C
5789 @cindex container
5790 Run @var{command} within an isolated container. The current working
5791 directory outside the container is mapped inside the container.
5792 Additionally, unless overridden with @option{--user}, a dummy home
5793 directory is created that matches the current user's home directory, and
5794 @file{/etc/passwd} is configured accordingly.
5795
5796 The spawned process runs as the current user outside the container. Inside
5797 the container, it has the same UID and GID as the current user, unless
5798 @option{--user} is passed (see below).
5799
5800 @item --network
5801 @itemx -N
5802 For containers, share the network namespace with the host system.
5803 Containers created without this flag only have access to the loopback
5804 device.
5805
5806 @item --link-profile
5807 @itemx -P
5808 For containers, link the environment profile to @file{~/.guix-profile}
5809 within the container and set @code{GUIX_ENVIRONMENT} to that.
5810 This is equivalent to making @file{~/.guix-profile} a symlink to the
5811 actual profile within the container.
5812 Linking will fail and abort the environment if the directory already
5813 exists, which will certainly be the case if @command{guix environment}
5814 was invoked in the user's home directory.
5815
5816 Certain packages are configured to look in @file{~/.guix-profile} for
5817 configuration files and data;@footnote{For example, the
5818 @code{fontconfig} package inspects @file{~/.guix-profile/share/fonts}
5819 for additional fonts.} @option{--link-profile} allows these programs to
5820 behave as expected within the environment.
5821
5822 @item --user=@var{user}
5823 @itemx -u @var{user}
5824 For containers, use the username @var{user} in place of the current
5825 user. The generated @file{/etc/passwd} entry within the container will
5826 contain the name @var{user}, the home directory will be
5827 @file{/home/@var{user}}, and no user GECOS data will be copied. Furthermore,
5828 the UID and GID inside the container are 1000. @var{user}
5829 need not exist on the system.
5830
5831 Additionally, any shared or exposed path (see @option{--share} and
5832 @option{--expose} respectively) whose target is within the current user's
5833 home directory will be remapped relative to @file{/home/USER}; this
5834 includes the automatic mapping of the current working directory.
5835
5836 @example
5837 # will expose paths as /home/foo/wd, /home/foo/test, and /home/foo/target
5838 cd $HOME/wd
5839 guix environment --container --user=foo \
5840 --expose=$HOME/test \
5841 --expose=/tmp/target=$HOME/target
5842 @end example
5843
5844 While this will limit the leaking of user identity through home paths
5845 and each of the user fields, this is only one useful component of a
5846 broader privacy/anonymity solution---not one in and of itself.
5847
5848 @item --no-cwd
5849 For containers, the default behavior is to share the current working
5850 directory with the isolated container and immediately change to that
5851 directory within the container. If this is undesirable,
5852 @option{--no-cwd} will cause the current working directory to @emph{not}
5853 be automatically shared and will change to the user's home directory
5854 within the container instead. See also @option{--user}.
5855
5856 @item --expose=@var{source}[=@var{target}]
5857 @itemx --share=@var{source}[=@var{target}]
5858 For containers, @option{--expose} (resp. @option{--share}) exposes the
5859 file system @var{source} from the host system as the read-only
5860 (resp. writable) file system @var{target} within the container. If
5861 @var{target} is not specified, @var{source} is used as the target mount
5862 point in the container.
5863
5864 The example below spawns a Guile REPL in a container in which the user's
5865 home directory is accessible read-only via the @file{/exchange}
5866 directory:
5867
5868 @example
5869 guix environment --container --expose=$HOME=/exchange --ad-hoc guile -- guile
5870 @end example
5871
5872 @end table
5873
5874 @command{guix environment}
5875 also supports all of the common build options that @command{guix
5876 build} supports (@pxref{Common Build Options}) as well as package
5877 transformation options (@pxref{Package Transformation Options}).
5878
5879 @node Invoking guix pack
5880 @section Invoking @command{guix pack}
5881
5882 Occasionally you want to pass software to people who are not (yet!)
5883 lucky enough to be using Guix. You'd tell them to run @command{guix
5884 package -i @var{something}}, but that's not possible in this case. This
5885 is where @command{guix pack} comes in.
5886
5887 @quotation Note
5888 If you are looking for ways to exchange binaries among machines that
5889 already run Guix, @pxref{Invoking guix copy}, @ref{Invoking guix
5890 publish}, and @ref{Invoking guix archive}.
5891 @end quotation
5892
5893 @cindex pack
5894 @cindex bundle
5895 @cindex application bundle
5896 @cindex software bundle
5897 The @command{guix pack} command creates a shrink-wrapped @dfn{pack} or
5898 @dfn{software bundle}: it creates a tarball or some other archive
5899 containing the binaries of the software you're interested in, and all
5900 its dependencies. The resulting archive can be used on any machine that
5901 does not have Guix, and people can run the exact same binaries as those
5902 you have with Guix. The pack itself is created in a bit-reproducible
5903 fashion, so anyone can verify that it really contains the build results
5904 that you pretend to be shipping.
5905
5906 For example, to create a bundle containing Guile, Emacs, Geiser, and all
5907 their dependencies, you can run:
5908
5909 @example
5910 $ guix pack guile emacs geiser
5911 @dots{}
5912 /gnu/store/@dots{}-pack.tar.gz
5913 @end example
5914
5915 The result here is a tarball containing a @file{/gnu/store} directory
5916 with all the relevant packages. The resulting tarball contains a
5917 @dfn{profile} with the three packages of interest; the profile is the
5918 same as would be created by @command{guix package -i}. It is this
5919 mechanism that is used to create Guix's own standalone binary tarball
5920 (@pxref{Binary Installation}).
5921
5922 Users of this pack would have to run
5923 @file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-profile/bin/guile} to run Guile, which you may
5924 find inconvenient. To work around it, you can create, say, a
5925 @file{/opt/gnu/bin} symlink to the profile:
5926
5927 @example
5928 guix pack -S /opt/gnu/bin=bin guile emacs geiser
5929 @end example
5930
5931 @noindent
5932 That way, users can happily type @file{/opt/gnu/bin/guile} and enjoy.
5933
5934 @cindex relocatable binaries, with @command{guix pack}
5935 What if the recipient of your pack does not have root privileges on
5936 their machine, and thus cannot unpack it in the root file system? In
5937 that case, you will want to use the @option{--relocatable} option (see
5938 below). This option produces @dfn{relocatable binaries}, meaning they
5939 they can be placed anywhere in the file system hierarchy: in the example
5940 above, users can unpack your tarball in their home directory and
5941 directly run @file{./opt/gnu/bin/guile}.
5942
5943 @cindex Docker, build an image with guix pack
5944 Alternatively, you can produce a pack in the Docker image format using
5945 the following command:
5946
5947 @example
5948 guix pack -f docker -S /bin=bin guile guile-readline
5949 @end example
5950
5951 @noindent
5952 The result is a tarball that can be passed to the @command{docker load}
5953 command, followed by @code{docker run}:
5954
5955 @example
5956 docker load < @var{file}
5957 docker run -ti guile-guile-readline /bin/guile
5958 @end example
5959
5960 @noindent
5961 where @var{file} is the image returned by @var{guix pack}, and
5962 @code{guile-guile-readline} is its ``image tag''. See the
5963 @uref{https://docs.docker.com/engine/reference/commandline/load/, Docker
5964 documentation} for more information.
5965
5966 @cindex Singularity, build an image with guix pack
5967 @cindex SquashFS, build an image with guix pack
5968 Yet another option is to produce a SquashFS image with the following
5969 command:
5970
5971 @example
5972 guix pack -f squashfs bash guile emacs geiser
5973 @end example
5974
5975 @noindent
5976 The result is a SquashFS file system image that can either be mounted or
5977 directly be used as a file system container image with the
5978 @uref{https://www.sylabs.io/docs/, Singularity container execution
5979 environment}, using commands like @command{singularity shell} or
5980 @command{singularity exec}.
5981
5982 Several command-line options allow you to customize your pack:
5983
5984 @table @code
5985 @item --format=@var{format}
5986 @itemx -f @var{format}
5987 Produce a pack in the given @var{format}.
5988
5989 The available formats are:
5990
5991 @table @code
5992 @item tarball
5993 This is the default format. It produces a tarball containing all the
5994 specified binaries and symlinks.
5995
5996 @item docker
5997 This produces a tarball that follows the
5998 @uref{https://github.com/docker/docker/blob/master/image/spec/v1.2.md,
5999 Docker Image Specification}. The ``repository name'' as it appears in
6000 the output of the @command{docker images} command is computed from
6001 package names passed on the command line or in the manifest file.
6002
6003 @item squashfs
6004 This produces a SquashFS image containing all the specified binaries and
6005 symlinks, as well as empty mount points for virtual file systems like
6006 procfs.
6007
6008 @quotation Note
6009 Singularity @emph{requires} you to provide @file{/bin/sh} in the image.
6010 For that reason, @command{guix pack -f squashfs} always implies @code{-S
6011 /bin=bin}. Thus, your @command{guix pack} invocation must always start
6012 with something like:
6013
6014 @example
6015 guix pack -f squashfs bash @dots{}
6016 @end example
6017
6018 If you forget the @code{bash} (or similar) package, @command{singularity
6019 run} and @command{singularity exec} will fail with an unhelpful ``no
6020 such file or directory'' message.
6021 @end quotation
6022 @end table
6023
6024 @cindex relocatable binaries
6025 @item --relocatable
6026 @itemx -R
6027 Produce @dfn{relocatable binaries}---i.e., binaries that can be placed
6028 anywhere in the file system hierarchy and run from there.
6029
6030 When this option is passed once, the resulting binaries require support for
6031 @dfn{user namespaces} in the kernel Linux; when passed
6032 @emph{twice}@footnote{Here's a trick to memorize it: @code{-RR}, which adds
6033 PRoot support, can be thought of as the abbreviation of ``Really
6034 Relocatable''. Neat, isn't it?}, relocatable binaries fall to back to
6035 other techniques if user namespaces are unavailable, and essentially
6036 work anywhere---see below for the implications.
6037
6038 For example, if you create a pack containing Bash with:
6039
6040 @example
6041 guix pack -RR -S /mybin=bin bash
6042 @end example
6043
6044 @noindent
6045 ...@: you can copy that pack to a machine that lacks Guix, and from your
6046 home directory as a normal user, run:
6047
6048 @example
6049 tar xf pack.tar.gz
6050 ./mybin/sh
6051 @end example
6052
6053 @noindent
6054 In that shell, if you type @code{ls /gnu/store}, you'll notice that
6055 @file{/gnu/store} shows up and contains all the dependencies of
6056 @code{bash}, even though the machine actually lacks @file{/gnu/store}
6057 altogether! That is probably the simplest way to deploy Guix-built
6058 software on a non-Guix machine.
6059
6060 @quotation Note
6061 By default, relocatable binaries rely on the @dfn{user namespace} feature of
6062 the kernel Linux, which allows unprivileged users to mount or change root.
6063 Old versions of Linux did not support it, and some GNU/Linux distributions
6064 turn it off.
6065
6066 To produce relocatable binaries that work even in the absence of user
6067 namespaces, pass @option{--relocatable} or @option{-R} @emph{twice}. In that
6068 case, binaries will try user namespace support and fall back to another
6069 @dfn{execution engine} if user namespaces are not supported. The
6070 following execution engines are supported:
6071
6072 @table @code
6073 @item default
6074 Try user namespaces and fall back to PRoot if user namespaces are not
6075 supported (see below).
6076
6077 @item performance
6078 Try user namespaces and fall back to Fakechroot if user namespaces are
6079 not supported (see below).
6080
6081 @item userns
6082 Run the program through user namespaces and abort if they are not
6083 supported.
6084
6085 @item proot
6086 Run through PRoot. The @uref{https://proot-me.github.io/, PRoot} program
6087 provides the necessary
6088 support for file system virtualization. It achieves that by using the
6089 @code{ptrace} system call on the running program. This approach has the
6090 advantage to work without requiring special kernel support, but it incurs
6091 run-time overhead every time a system call is made.
6092
6093 @item fakechroot
6094 Run through Fakechroot. @uref{https://github.com/dex4er/fakechroot/,
6095 Fakechroot} virtualizes file system accesses by intercepting calls to C
6096 library functions such as @code{open}, @code{stat}, @code{exec}, and so
6097 on. Unlike PRoot, it incurs very little overhead. However, it does not
6098 always work: for example, some file system accesses made from within the
6099 C library are not intercepted, and file system accesses made @i{via}
6100 direct syscalls are not intercepted either, leading to erratic behavior.
6101 @end table
6102
6103 @vindex GUIX_EXECUTION_ENGINE
6104 When running a wrapped program, you can explicitly request one of the
6105 execution engines listed above by setting the
6106 @env{GUIX_EXECUTION_ENGINE} environment variable accordingly.
6107 @end quotation
6108
6109 @cindex entry point, for Docker images
6110 @item --entry-point=@var{command}
6111 Use @var{command} as the @dfn{entry point} of the resulting pack, if the pack
6112 format supports it---currently @code{docker} and @code{squashfs} (Singularity)
6113 support it. @var{command} must be relative to the profile contained in the
6114 pack.
6115
6116 The entry point specifies the command that tools like @code{docker run} or
6117 @code{singularity run} automatically start by default. For example, you can
6118 do:
6119
6120 @example
6121 guix pack -f docker --entry-point=bin/guile guile
6122 @end example
6123
6124 The resulting pack can easily be loaded and @code{docker run} with no extra
6125 arguments will spawn @code{bin/guile}:
6126
6127 @example
6128 docker load -i pack.tar.gz
6129 docker run @var{image-id}
6130 @end example
6131
6132 @item --expression=@var{expr}
6133 @itemx -e @var{expr}
6134 Consider the package @var{expr} evaluates to.
6135
6136 This has the same purpose as the same-named option in @command{guix
6137 build} (@pxref{Additional Build Options, @option{--expression} in
6138 @command{guix build}}).
6139
6140 @item --manifest=@var{file}
6141 @itemx -m @var{file}
6142 Use the packages contained in the manifest object returned by the Scheme
6143 code in @var{file}. This option can be repeated several times, in which
6144 case the manifests are concatenated.
6145
6146 This has a similar purpose as the same-named option in @command{guix
6147 package} (@pxref{profile-manifest, @option{--manifest}}) and uses the
6148 same manifest files. It allows you to define a collection of packages
6149 once and use it both for creating profiles and for creating archives
6150 for use on machines that do not have Guix installed. Note that you can
6151 specify @emph{either} a manifest file @emph{or} a list of packages,
6152 but not both.
6153
6154 @item --system=@var{system}
6155 @itemx -s @var{system}
6156 Attempt to build for @var{system}---e.g., @code{i686-linux}---instead of
6157 the system type of the build host.
6158
6159 @item --target=@var{triplet}
6160 @cindex cross-compilation
6161 Cross-build for @var{triplet}, which must be a valid GNU triplet, such
6162 as @code{"aarch64-linux-gnu"} (@pxref{Specifying target triplets, GNU
6163 configuration triplets,, autoconf, Autoconf}).
6164
6165 @item --compression=@var{tool}
6166 @itemx -C @var{tool}
6167 Compress the resulting tarball using @var{tool}---one of @code{gzip},
6168 @code{zstd}, @code{bzip2}, @code{xz}, @code{lzip}, or @code{none} for no
6169 compression.
6170
6171 @item --symlink=@var{spec}
6172 @itemx -S @var{spec}
6173 Add the symlinks specified by @var{spec} to the pack. This option can
6174 appear several times.
6175
6176 @var{spec} has the form @code{@var{source}=@var{target}}, where
6177 @var{source} is the symlink that will be created and @var{target} is the
6178 symlink target.
6179
6180 For instance, @code{-S /opt/gnu/bin=bin} creates a @file{/opt/gnu/bin}
6181 symlink pointing to the @file{bin} sub-directory of the profile.
6182
6183 @item --save-provenance
6184 Save provenance information for the packages passed on the command line.
6185 Provenance information includes the URL and commit of the channels in use
6186 (@pxref{Channels}).
6187
6188 Provenance information is saved in the
6189 @file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-profile/manifest} file in the pack, along with the
6190 usual package metadata---the name and version of each package, their
6191 propagated inputs, and so on. It is useful information to the recipient of
6192 the pack, who then knows how the pack was (supposedly) obtained.
6193
6194 This option is not enabled by default because, like timestamps, provenance
6195 information contributes nothing to the build process. In other words, there
6196 is an infinity of channel URLs and commit IDs that can lead to the same pack.
6197 Recording such ``silent'' metadata in the output thus potentially breaks the
6198 source-to-binary bitwise reproducibility property.
6199
6200 @item --root=@var{file}
6201 @itemx -r @var{file}
6202 @cindex garbage collector root, for packs
6203 Make @var{file} a symlink to the resulting pack, and register it as a garbage
6204 collector root.
6205
6206 @item --localstatedir
6207 @itemx --profile-name=@var{name}
6208 Include the ``local state directory'', @file{/var/guix}, in the resulting
6209 pack, and notably the @file{/var/guix/profiles/per-user/root/@var{name}}
6210 profile---by default @var{name} is @code{guix-profile}, which corresponds to
6211 @file{~root/.guix-profile}.
6212
6213 @file{/var/guix} contains the store database (@pxref{The Store}) as well
6214 as garbage-collector roots (@pxref{Invoking guix gc}). Providing it in
6215 the pack means that the store is ``complete'' and manageable by Guix;
6216 not providing it pack means that the store is ``dead'': items cannot be
6217 added to it or removed from it after extraction of the pack.
6218
6219 One use case for this is the Guix self-contained binary tarball
6220 (@pxref{Binary Installation}).
6221
6222 @item --derivation
6223 @itemx -d
6224 Print the name of the derivation that builds the pack.
6225
6226 @item --bootstrap
6227 Use the bootstrap binaries to build the pack. This option is only
6228 useful to Guix developers.
6229 @end table
6230
6231 In addition, @command{guix pack} supports all the common build options
6232 (@pxref{Common Build Options}) and all the package transformation
6233 options (@pxref{Package Transformation Options}).
6234
6235
6236 @node The GCC toolchain
6237 @section The GCC toolchain
6238
6239 @cindex GCC
6240 @cindex ld-wrapper
6241 @cindex linker wrapper
6242 @cindex toolchain, for C development
6243 @cindex toolchain, for Fortran development
6244
6245 If you need a complete toolchain for compiling and linking C or C++
6246 source code, use the @code{gcc-toolchain} package. This package
6247 provides a complete GCC toolchain for C/C++ development, including GCC
6248 itself, the GNU C Library (headers and binaries, plus debugging symbols
6249 in the @code{debug} output), Binutils, and a linker wrapper.
6250
6251 The wrapper's purpose is to inspect the @code{-L} and @code{-l} switches
6252 passed to the linker, add corresponding @code{-rpath} arguments, and
6253 invoke the actual linker with this new set of arguments. You can instruct the
6254 wrapper to refuse to link against libraries not in the store by setting the
6255 @env{GUIX_LD_WRAPPER_ALLOW_IMPURITIES} environment variable to @code{no}.
6256
6257 The package @code{gfortran-toolchain} provides a complete GCC toolchain
6258 for Fortran development. For other languages, please use
6259 @samp{guix search gcc toolchain} (@pxref{guix-search,, Invoking guix package}).
6260
6261
6262 @node Invoking guix git authenticate
6263 @section Invoking @command{guix git authenticate}
6264
6265 The @command{guix git authenticate} command authenticates a Git checkout
6266 following the same rule as for channels (@pxref{channel-authentication,
6267 channel authentication}). That is, starting from a given commit, it
6268 ensures that all subsequent commits are signed by an OpenPGP key whose
6269 fingerprint appears in the @file{.guix-authorizations} file of its
6270 parent commit(s).
6271
6272 You will find this command useful if you maintain a channel. But in
6273 fact, this authentication mechanism is useful in a broader context, so
6274 you might want to use it for Git repositories that have nothing to do
6275 with Guix.
6276
6277 The general syntax is:
6278
6279 @example
6280 guix git authenticate @var{commit} @var{signer} [@var{options}@dots{}]
6281 @end example
6282
6283 By default, this command authenticates the Git checkout in the current
6284 directory; it outputs nothing and exits with exit code zero on success
6285 and non-zero on failure. @var{commit} above denotes the first commit
6286 where authentication takes place, and @var{signer} is the OpenPGP
6287 fingerprint of public key used to sign @var{commit}. Together, they
6288 form a ``channel introduction'' (@pxref{channel-authentication, channel
6289 introduction}). The options below allow you to fine-tune the process.
6290
6291 @table @code
6292 @item --repository=@var{directory}
6293 @itemx -r @var{directory}
6294 Open the Git repository in @var{directory} instead of the current
6295 directory.
6296
6297 @item --keyring=@var{reference}
6298 @itemx -k @var{reference}
6299 Load OpenPGP keyring from @var{reference}, the reference of a branch
6300 such as @code{origin/keyring} or @code{my-keyring}. The branch must
6301 contain OpenPGP public keys in @file{.key} files, either in binary form
6302 or ``ASCII-armored''. By default the keyring is loaded from the branch
6303 named @code{keyring}.
6304
6305 @item --stats
6306 Display commit signing statistics upon completion.
6307
6308 @item --cache-key=@var{key}
6309 Previously-authenticated commits are cached in a file under
6310 @file{~/.cache/guix/authentication}. This option forces the cache to be
6311 stored in file @var{key} in that directory.
6312
6313 @item --historical-authorizations=@var{file}
6314 By default, any commit whose parent commit(s) lack the
6315 @file{.guix-authorizations} file is considered inauthentic. In
6316 contrast, this option considers the authorizations in @var{file} for any
6317 commit that lacks @file{.guix-authorizations}. The format of @var{file}
6318 is the same as that of @file{.guix-authorizations}
6319 (@pxref{channel-authorizations, @file{.guix-authorizations} format}).
6320 @end table
6321
6322
6323 @c *********************************************************************
6324 @node Programming Interface
6325 @chapter Programming Interface
6326
6327 GNU Guix provides several Scheme programming interfaces (APIs) to
6328 define, build, and query packages. The first interface allows users to
6329 write high-level package definitions. These definitions refer to
6330 familiar packaging concepts, such as the name and version of a package,
6331 its build system, and its dependencies. These definitions can then be
6332 turned into concrete build actions.
6333
6334 Build actions are performed by the Guix daemon, on behalf of users. In a
6335 standard setup, the daemon has write access to the store---the
6336 @file{/gnu/store} directory---whereas users do not. The recommended
6337 setup also has the daemon perform builds in chroots, under specific
6338 build users, to minimize interference with the rest of the system.
6339
6340 @cindex derivation
6341 Lower-level APIs are available to interact with the daemon and the
6342 store. To instruct the daemon to perform a build action, users actually
6343 provide it with a @dfn{derivation}. A derivation is a low-level
6344 representation of the build actions to be taken, and the environment in
6345 which they should occur---derivations are to package definitions what
6346 assembly is to C programs. The term ``derivation'' comes from the fact
6347 that build results @emph{derive} from them.
6348
6349 This chapter describes all these APIs in turn, starting from high-level
6350 package definitions.
6351
6352 @menu
6353 * Package Modules:: Packages from the programmer's viewpoint.
6354 * Defining Packages:: Defining new packages.
6355 * Defining Package Variants:: Customizing packages.
6356 * Build Systems:: Specifying how packages are built.
6357 * Build Phases:: Phases of the build process of a package.
6358 * Build Utilities:: Helpers for your package definitions and more.
6359 * The Store:: Manipulating the package store.
6360 * Derivations:: Low-level interface to package derivations.
6361 * The Store Monad:: Purely functional interface to the store.
6362 * G-Expressions:: Manipulating build expressions.
6363 * Invoking guix repl:: Programming Guix in Guile
6364 @end menu
6365
6366 @node Package Modules
6367 @section Package Modules
6368
6369 From a programming viewpoint, the package definitions of the
6370 GNU distribution are provided by Guile modules in the @code{(gnu packages
6371 @dots{})} name space@footnote{Note that packages under the @code{(gnu
6372 packages @dots{})} module name space are not necessarily ``GNU
6373 packages''. This module naming scheme follows the usual Guile module
6374 naming convention: @code{gnu} means that these modules are distributed
6375 as part of the GNU system, and @code{packages} identifies modules that
6376 define packages.} (@pxref{Modules, Guile modules,, guile, GNU Guile
6377 Reference Manual}). For instance, the @code{(gnu packages emacs)}
6378 module exports a variable named @code{emacs}, which is bound to a
6379 @code{<package>} object (@pxref{Defining Packages}).
6380
6381 The @code{(gnu packages @dots{})} module name space is
6382 automatically scanned for packages by the command-line tools. For
6383 instance, when running @code{guix install emacs}, all the @code{(gnu
6384 packages @dots{})} modules are scanned until one that exports a package
6385 object whose name is @code{emacs} is found. This package search
6386 facility is implemented in the @code{(gnu packages)} module.
6387
6388 @cindex customization, of packages
6389 @cindex package module search path
6390 Users can store package definitions in modules with different
6391 names---e.g., @code{(my-packages emacs)}@footnote{Note that the file
6392 name and module name must match. For instance, the @code{(my-packages
6393 emacs)} module must be stored in a @file{my-packages/emacs.scm} file
6394 relative to the load path specified with @option{--load-path} or
6395 @env{GUIX_PACKAGE_PATH}. @xref{Modules and the File System,,,
6396 guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}, for details.}. There are two ways to make
6397 these package definitions visible to the user interfaces:
6398
6399 @enumerate
6400 @item
6401 By adding the directory containing your package modules to the search path
6402 with the @code{-L} flag of @command{guix package} and other commands
6403 (@pxref{Common Build Options}), or by setting the @env{GUIX_PACKAGE_PATH}
6404 environment variable described below.
6405
6406 @item
6407 By defining a @dfn{channel} and configuring @command{guix pull} so that it
6408 pulls from it. A channel is essentially a Git repository containing package
6409 modules. @xref{Channels}, for more information on how to define and use
6410 channels.
6411 @end enumerate
6412
6413 @env{GUIX_PACKAGE_PATH} works similarly to other search path variables:
6414
6415 @defvr {Environment Variable} GUIX_PACKAGE_PATH
6416 This is a colon-separated list of directories to search for additional
6417 package modules. Directories listed in this variable take precedence
6418 over the own modules of the distribution.
6419 @end defvr
6420
6421 The distribution is fully @dfn{bootstrapped} and @dfn{self-contained}:
6422 each package is built based solely on other packages in the
6423 distribution. The root of this dependency graph is a small set of
6424 @dfn{bootstrap binaries}, provided by the @code{(gnu packages
6425 bootstrap)} module. For more information on bootstrapping,
6426 @pxref{Bootstrapping}.
6427
6428 @node Defining Packages
6429 @section Defining Packages
6430
6431 The high-level interface to package definitions is implemented in the
6432 @code{(guix packages)} and @code{(guix build-system)} modules. As an
6433 example, the package definition, or @dfn{recipe}, for the GNU Hello
6434 package looks like this:
6435
6436 @lisp
6437 (define-module (gnu packages hello)
6438 #:use-module (guix packages)
6439 #:use-module (guix download)
6440 #:use-module (guix build-system gnu)
6441 #:use-module (guix licenses)
6442 #:use-module (gnu packages gawk))
6443
6444 (define-public hello
6445 (package
6446 (name "hello")
6447 (version "2.10")
6448 (source (origin
6449 (method url-fetch)
6450 (uri (string-append "mirror://gnu/hello/hello-" version
6451 ".tar.gz"))
6452 (sha256
6453 (base32
6454 "0ssi1wpaf7plaswqqjwigppsg5fyh99vdlb9kzl7c9lng89ndq1i"))))
6455 (build-system gnu-build-system)
6456 (arguments '(#:configure-flags '("--enable-silent-rules")))
6457 (inputs `(("gawk" ,gawk)))
6458 (synopsis "Hello, GNU world: An example GNU package")
6459 (description "Guess what GNU Hello prints!")
6460 (home-page "https://www.gnu.org/software/hello/")
6461 (license gpl3+)))
6462 @end lisp
6463
6464 @noindent
6465 Without being a Scheme expert, the reader may have guessed the meaning
6466 of the various fields here. This expression binds the variable
6467 @code{hello} to a @code{<package>} object, which is essentially a record
6468 (@pxref{SRFI-9, Scheme records,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}).
6469 This package object can be inspected using procedures found in the
6470 @code{(guix packages)} module; for instance, @code{(package-name hello)}
6471 returns---surprise!---@code{"hello"}.
6472
6473 With luck, you may be able to import part or all of the definition of
6474 the package you are interested in from another repository, using the
6475 @code{guix import} command (@pxref{Invoking guix import}).
6476
6477 In the example above, @code{hello} is defined in a module of its own,
6478 @code{(gnu packages hello)}. Technically, this is not strictly
6479 necessary, but it is convenient to do so: all the packages defined in
6480 modules under @code{(gnu packages @dots{})} are automatically known to
6481 the command-line tools (@pxref{Package Modules}).
6482
6483 There are a few points worth noting in the above package definition:
6484
6485 @itemize
6486 @item
6487 The @code{source} field of the package is an @code{<origin>} object
6488 (@pxref{origin Reference}, for the complete reference).
6489 Here, the @code{url-fetch} method from @code{(guix download)} is used,
6490 meaning that the source is a file to be downloaded over FTP or HTTP.
6491
6492 The @code{mirror://gnu} prefix instructs @code{url-fetch} to use one of
6493 the GNU mirrors defined in @code{(guix download)}.
6494
6495 The @code{sha256} field specifies the expected SHA256 hash of the file
6496 being downloaded. It is mandatory, and allows Guix to check the
6497 integrity of the file. The @code{(base32 @dots{})} form introduces the
6498 base32 representation of the hash. You can obtain this information with
6499 @code{guix download} (@pxref{Invoking guix download}) and @code{guix
6500 hash} (@pxref{Invoking guix hash}).
6501
6502 @cindex patches
6503 When needed, the @code{origin} form can also have a @code{patches} field
6504 listing patches to be applied, and a @code{snippet} field giving a
6505 Scheme expression to modify the source code.
6506
6507 @item
6508 @cindex GNU Build System
6509 The @code{build-system} field specifies the procedure to build the
6510 package (@pxref{Build Systems}). Here, @code{gnu-build-system}
6511 represents the familiar GNU Build System, where packages may be
6512 configured, built, and installed with the usual @code{./configure &&
6513 make && make check && make install} command sequence.
6514
6515 When you start packaging non-trivial software, you may need tools to
6516 manipulate those build phases, manipulate files, and so on. @xref{Build
6517 Utilities}, for more on this.
6518
6519 @item
6520 The @code{arguments} field specifies options for the build system
6521 (@pxref{Build Systems}). Here it is interpreted by
6522 @code{gnu-build-system} as a request run @file{configure} with the
6523 @option{--enable-silent-rules} flag.
6524
6525 @cindex quote
6526 @cindex quoting
6527 @findex '
6528 @findex quote
6529 What about these quote (@code{'}) characters? They are Scheme syntax to
6530 introduce a literal list; @code{'} is synonymous with @code{quote}.
6531 @xref{Expression Syntax, quoting,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual},
6532 for details. Here the value of the @code{arguments} field is a list of
6533 arguments passed to the build system down the road, as with @code{apply}
6534 (@pxref{Fly Evaluation, @code{apply},, guile, GNU Guile Reference
6535 Manual}).
6536
6537 The hash-colon (@code{#:}) sequence defines a Scheme @dfn{keyword}
6538 (@pxref{Keywords,,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}), and
6539 @code{#:configure-flags} is a keyword used to pass a keyword argument
6540 to the build system (@pxref{Coding With Keywords,,, guile, GNU Guile
6541 Reference Manual}).
6542
6543 @item
6544 The @code{inputs} field specifies inputs to the build process---i.e.,
6545 build-time or run-time dependencies of the package. Here, we define an
6546 input called @code{"gawk"} whose value is that of the @code{gawk}
6547 variable; @code{gawk} is itself bound to a @code{<package>} object.
6548
6549 @cindex backquote (quasiquote)
6550 @findex `
6551 @findex quasiquote
6552 @cindex comma (unquote)
6553 @findex ,
6554 @findex unquote
6555 @findex ,@@
6556 @findex unquote-splicing
6557 Again, @code{`} (a backquote, synonymous with @code{quasiquote}) allows
6558 us to introduce a literal list in the @code{inputs} field, while
6559 @code{,} (a comma, synonymous with @code{unquote}) allows us to insert a
6560 value in that list (@pxref{Expression Syntax, unquote,, guile, GNU Guile
6561 Reference Manual}).
6562
6563 Note that GCC, Coreutils, Bash, and other essential tools do not need to
6564 be specified as inputs here. Instead, @code{gnu-build-system} takes care
6565 of ensuring that they are present (@pxref{Build Systems}).
6566
6567 However, any other dependencies need to be specified in the
6568 @code{inputs} field. Any dependency not specified here will simply be
6569 unavailable to the build process, possibly leading to a build failure.
6570 @end itemize
6571
6572 @xref{package Reference}, for a full description of possible fields.
6573
6574 Once a package definition is in place, the
6575 package may actually be built using the @code{guix build} command-line
6576 tool (@pxref{Invoking guix build}), troubleshooting any build failures
6577 you encounter (@pxref{Debugging Build Failures}). You can easily jump back to the
6578 package definition using the @command{guix edit} command
6579 (@pxref{Invoking guix edit}).
6580 @xref{Packaging Guidelines}, for
6581 more information on how to test package definitions, and
6582 @ref{Invoking guix lint}, for information on how to check a definition
6583 for style conformance.
6584 @vindex GUIX_PACKAGE_PATH
6585 Lastly, @pxref{Channels}, for information
6586 on how to extend the distribution by adding your own package definitions
6587 in a ``channel''.
6588
6589 Finally, updating the package definition to a new upstream version
6590 can be partly automated by the @command{guix refresh} command
6591 (@pxref{Invoking guix refresh}).
6592
6593 Behind the scenes, a derivation corresponding to the @code{<package>}
6594 object is first computed by the @code{package-derivation} procedure.
6595 That derivation is stored in a @file{.drv} file under @file{/gnu/store}.
6596 The build actions it prescribes may then be realized by using the
6597 @code{build-derivations} procedure (@pxref{The Store}).
6598
6599 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} package-derivation @var{store} @var{package} [@var{system}]
6600 Return the @code{<derivation>} object of @var{package} for @var{system}
6601 (@pxref{Derivations}).
6602
6603 @var{package} must be a valid @code{<package>} object, and @var{system}
6604 must be a string denoting the target system type---e.g.,
6605 @code{"x86_64-linux"} for an x86_64 Linux-based GNU system. @var{store}
6606 must be a connection to the daemon, which operates on the store
6607 (@pxref{The Store}).
6608 @end deffn
6609
6610 @noindent
6611 @cindex cross-compilation
6612 Similarly, it is possible to compute a derivation that cross-builds a
6613 package for some other system:
6614
6615 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} package-cross-derivation @var{store} @
6616 @var{package} @var{target} [@var{system}]
6617 Return the @code{<derivation>} object of @var{package} cross-built from
6618 @var{system} to @var{target}.
6619
6620 @var{target} must be a valid GNU triplet denoting the target hardware
6621 and operating system, such as @code{"aarch64-linux-gnu"}
6622 (@pxref{Specifying Target Triplets,,, autoconf, Autoconf}).
6623 @end deffn
6624
6625 Once you have package definitions, you can easily define @emph{variants}
6626 of those packages. @xref{Defining Package Variants}, for more on that.
6627
6628 @menu
6629 * package Reference:: The package data type.
6630 * origin Reference:: The origin data type.
6631 @end menu
6632
6633
6634 @node package Reference
6635 @subsection @code{package} Reference
6636
6637 This section summarizes all the options available in @code{package}
6638 declarations (@pxref{Defining Packages}).
6639
6640 @deftp {Data Type} package
6641 This is the data type representing a package recipe.
6642
6643 @table @asis
6644 @item @code{name}
6645 The name of the package, as a string.
6646
6647 @item @code{version}
6648 The version of the package, as a string.
6649
6650 @item @code{source}
6651 An object telling how the source code for the package should be
6652 acquired. Most of the time, this is an @code{origin} object, which
6653 denotes a file fetched from the Internet (@pxref{origin Reference}). It
6654 can also be any other ``file-like'' object such as a @code{local-file},
6655 which denotes a file from the local file system (@pxref{G-Expressions,
6656 @code{local-file}}).
6657
6658 @item @code{build-system}
6659 The build system that should be used to build the package (@pxref{Build
6660 Systems}).
6661
6662 @item @code{arguments} (default: @code{'()})
6663 The arguments that should be passed to the build system. This is a
6664 list, typically containing sequential keyword-value pairs.
6665
6666 @item @code{inputs} (default: @code{'()})
6667 @itemx @code{native-inputs} (default: @code{'()})
6668 @itemx @code{propagated-inputs} (default: @code{'()})
6669 @cindex inputs, of packages
6670 These fields list dependencies of the package. Each one is a list of
6671 tuples, where each tuple has a label for the input (a string) as its
6672 first element, a package, origin, or derivation as its second element,
6673 and optionally the name of the output thereof that should be used, which
6674 defaults to @code{"out"} (@pxref{Packages with Multiple Outputs}, for
6675 more on package outputs). For example, the list below specifies three
6676 inputs:
6677
6678 @lisp
6679 `(("libffi" ,libffi)
6680 ("libunistring" ,libunistring)
6681 ("glib:bin" ,glib "bin")) ;the "bin" output of Glib
6682 @end lisp
6683
6684 @cindex cross compilation, package dependencies
6685 The distinction between @code{native-inputs} and @code{inputs} is
6686 necessary when considering cross-compilation. When cross-compiling,
6687 dependencies listed in @code{inputs} are built for the @emph{target}
6688 architecture; conversely, dependencies listed in @code{native-inputs}
6689 are built for the architecture of the @emph{build} machine.
6690
6691 @code{native-inputs} is typically used to list tools needed at
6692 build time, but not at run time, such as Autoconf, Automake, pkg-config,
6693 Gettext, or Bison. @command{guix lint} can report likely mistakes in
6694 this area (@pxref{Invoking guix lint}).
6695
6696 @anchor{package-propagated-inputs}
6697 Lastly, @code{propagated-inputs} is similar to @code{inputs}, but the
6698 specified packages will be automatically installed to profiles
6699 (@pxref{Features, the role of profiles in Guix}) alongside the package
6700 they belong to (@pxref{package-cmd-propagated-inputs, @command{guix
6701 package}}, for information on how @command{guix package} deals with
6702 propagated inputs).
6703
6704 For example this is necessary when packaging a C/C++ library that needs
6705 headers of another library to compile, or when a pkg-config file refers
6706 to another one @i{via} its @code{Requires} field.
6707
6708 Another example where @code{propagated-inputs} is useful is for languages
6709 that lack a facility to record the run-time search path akin to the
6710 @code{RUNPATH} of ELF files; this includes Guile, Python, Perl, and
6711 more. When packaging libraries written in those languages, ensure they
6712 can find library code they depend on at run time by listing run-time
6713 dependencies in @code{propagated-inputs} rather than @code{inputs}.
6714
6715 @item @code{outputs} (default: @code{'("out")})
6716 The list of output names of the package. @xref{Packages with Multiple
6717 Outputs}, for typical uses of additional outputs.
6718
6719 @item @code{native-search-paths} (default: @code{'()})
6720 @itemx @code{search-paths} (default: @code{'()})
6721 A list of @code{search-path-specification} objects describing
6722 search-path environment variables honored by the package.
6723
6724 @item @code{replacement} (default: @code{#f})
6725 This must be either @code{#f} or a package object that will be used as a
6726 @dfn{replacement} for this package. @xref{Security Updates, grafts},
6727 for details.
6728
6729 @item @code{synopsis}
6730 A one-line description of the package.
6731
6732 @item @code{description}
6733 A more elaborate description of the package.
6734
6735 @item @code{license}
6736 @cindex license, of packages
6737 The license of the package; a value from @code{(guix licenses)},
6738 or a list of such values.
6739
6740 @item @code{home-page}
6741 The URL to the home-page of the package, as a string.
6742
6743 @item @code{supported-systems} (default: @code{%supported-systems})
6744 The list of systems supported by the package, as strings of the form
6745 @code{architecture-kernel}, for example @code{"x86_64-linux"}.
6746
6747 @item @code{location} (default: source location of the @code{package} form)
6748 The source location of the package. It is useful to override this when
6749 inheriting from another package, in which case this field is not
6750 automatically corrected.
6751 @end table
6752 @end deftp
6753
6754 @deffn {Scheme Syntax} this-package
6755 When used in the @emph{lexical scope} of a package field definition, this
6756 identifier resolves to the package being defined.
6757
6758 The example below shows how to add a package as a native input of itself when
6759 cross-compiling:
6760
6761 @lisp
6762 (package
6763 (name "guile")
6764 ;; ...
6765
6766 ;; When cross-compiled, Guile, for example, depends on
6767 ;; a native version of itself. Add it here.
6768 (native-inputs (if (%current-target-system)
6769 `(("self" ,this-package))
6770 '())))
6771 @end lisp
6772
6773 It is an error to refer to @code{this-package} outside a package definition.
6774 @end deffn
6775
6776 Because packages are regular Scheme objects that capture a complete
6777 dependency graph and associated build procedures, it is often useful to
6778 write procedures that take a package and return a modified version
6779 thereof according to some parameters. Below are a few examples.
6780
6781 @cindex tool chain, choosing a package's tool chain
6782 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} package-with-c-toolchain @var{package} @var{toolchain}
6783 Return a variant of @var{package} that uses @var{toolchain} instead of
6784 the default GNU C/C++ toolchain. @var{toolchain} must be a list of
6785 inputs (label/package tuples) providing equivalent functionality, such
6786 as the @code{gcc-toolchain} package.
6787
6788 The example below returns a variant of the @code{hello} package built
6789 with GCC@tie{}10.x and the rest of the GNU tool chain (Binutils and the
6790 GNU C Library) instead of the default tool chain:
6791
6792 @lisp
6793 (let ((toolchain (specification->package "gcc-toolchain@@10")))
6794 (package-with-c-toolchain hello `(("toolchain" ,toolchain))))
6795 @end lisp
6796
6797 The build tool chain is part of the @dfn{implicit inputs} of
6798 packages---it's usually not listed as part of the various ``inputs''
6799 fields and is instead pulled in by the build system. Consequently, this
6800 procedure works by changing the build system of @var{package} so that it
6801 pulls in @var{toolchain} instead of the defaults. @ref{Build Systems},
6802 for more on build systems.
6803 @end deffn
6804
6805 @node origin Reference
6806 @subsection @code{origin} Reference
6807
6808 This section documents @dfn{origins}. An @code{origin} declaration
6809 specifies data that must be ``produced''---downloaded, usually---and
6810 whose content hash is known in advance. Origins are primarily used to
6811 represent the source code of packages (@pxref{Defining Packages}). For
6812 that reason, the @code{origin} form allows you to declare patches to
6813 apply to the original source code as well as code snippets to modify it.
6814
6815 @deftp {Data Type} origin
6816 This is the data type representing a source code origin.
6817
6818 @table @asis
6819 @item @code{uri}
6820 An object containing the URI of the source. The object type depends on
6821 the @code{method} (see below). For example, when using the
6822 @var{url-fetch} method of @code{(guix download)}, the valid @code{uri}
6823 values are: a URL represented as a string, or a list thereof.
6824
6825 @cindex fixed-output derivations, for download
6826 @item @code{method}
6827 A monadic procedure that handles the given URI@. The procedure must
6828 accept at least three arguments: the value of the @code{uri} field and
6829 the hash algorithm and hash value specified by the @code{hash} field.
6830 It must return a store item or a derivation in the store monad
6831 (@pxref{The Store Monad}); most methods return a fixed-output derivation
6832 (@pxref{Derivations}).
6833
6834 Commonly used methods include @code{url-fetch}, which fetches data from
6835 a URL, and @code{git-fetch}, which fetches data from a Git repository
6836 (see below).
6837
6838 @item @code{sha256}
6839 A bytevector containing the SHA-256 hash of the source. This is
6840 equivalent to providing a @code{content-hash} SHA256 object in the
6841 @code{hash} field described below.
6842
6843 @item @code{hash}
6844 The @code{content-hash} object of the source---see below for how to use
6845 @code{content-hash}.
6846
6847 You can obtain this information using @code{guix download}
6848 (@pxref{Invoking guix download}) or @code{guix hash} (@pxref{Invoking
6849 guix hash}).
6850
6851 @item @code{file-name} (default: @code{#f})
6852 The file name under which the source code should be saved. When this is
6853 @code{#f}, a sensible default value will be used in most cases. In case
6854 the source is fetched from a URL, the file name from the URL will be
6855 used. For version control checkouts, it is recommended to provide the
6856 file name explicitly because the default is not very descriptive.
6857
6858 @item @code{patches} (default: @code{'()})
6859 A list of file names, origins, or file-like objects (@pxref{G-Expressions,
6860 file-like objects}) pointing to patches to be applied to the source.
6861
6862 This list of patches must be unconditional. In particular, it cannot
6863 depend on the value of @code{%current-system} or
6864 @code{%current-target-system}.
6865
6866 @item @code{snippet} (default: @code{#f})
6867 A G-expression (@pxref{G-Expressions}) or S-expression that will be run
6868 in the source directory. This is a convenient way to modify the source,
6869 sometimes more convenient than a patch.
6870
6871 @item @code{patch-flags} (default: @code{'("-p1")})
6872 A list of command-line flags that should be passed to the @code{patch}
6873 command.
6874
6875 @item @code{patch-inputs} (default: @code{#f})
6876 Input packages or derivations to the patching process. When this is
6877 @code{#f}, the usual set of inputs necessary for patching are provided,
6878 such as GNU@tie{}Patch.
6879
6880 @item @code{modules} (default: @code{'()})
6881 A list of Guile modules that should be loaded during the patching
6882 process and while running the code in the @code{snippet} field.
6883
6884 @item @code{patch-guile} (default: @code{#f})
6885 The Guile package that should be used in the patching process. When
6886 this is @code{#f}, a sensible default is used.
6887 @end table
6888 @end deftp
6889
6890 @deftp {Data Type} content-hash @var{value} [@var{algorithm}]
6891 Construct a content hash object for the given @var{algorithm}, and with
6892 @var{value} as its hash value. When @var{algorithm} is omitted, assume
6893 it is @code{sha256}.
6894
6895 @var{value} can be a literal string, in which case it is base32-decoded,
6896 or it can be a bytevector.
6897
6898 The following forms are all equivalent:
6899
6900 @lisp
6901 (content-hash "05zxkyz9bv3j9h0xyid1rhvh3klhsmrpkf3bcs6frvlgyr2gwilj")
6902 (content-hash "05zxkyz9bv3j9h0xyid1rhvh3klhsmrpkf3bcs6frvlgyr2gwilj"
6903 sha256)
6904 (content-hash (base32
6905 "05zxkyz9bv3j9h0xyid1rhvh3klhsmrpkf3bcs6frvlgyr2gwilj"))
6906 (content-hash (base64 "kkb+RPaP7uyMZmu4eXPVkM4BN8yhRd8BTHLslb6f/Rc=")
6907 sha256)
6908 @end lisp
6909
6910 Technically, @code{content-hash} is currently implemented as a macro.
6911 It performs sanity checks at macro-expansion time, when possible, such
6912 as ensuring that @var{value} has the right size for @var{algorithm}.
6913 @end deftp
6914
6915 As we have seen above, how exactly the data an origin refers to is
6916 retrieved is determined by its @code{method} field. The @code{(guix
6917 download)} module provides the most common method, @code{url-fetch},
6918 described below.
6919
6920 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} url-fetch @var{url} @var{hash-algo} @var{hash} @
6921 [name] [#:executable? #f]
6922 Return a fixed-output derivation that fetches data from @var{url} (a
6923 string, or a list of strings denoting alternate URLs), which is expected
6924 to have hash @var{hash} of type @var{hash-algo} (a symbol). By default,
6925 the file name is the base name of URL; optionally, @var{name} can
6926 specify a different file name. When @var{executable?} is true, make the
6927 downloaded file executable.
6928
6929 When one of the URL starts with @code{mirror://}, then its host part is
6930 interpreted as the name of a mirror scheme, taken from @file{%mirror-file}.
6931
6932 Alternatively, when URL starts with @code{file://}, return the
6933 corresponding file name in the store.
6934 @end deffn
6935
6936 Likewise, the @code{(guix git-download)} module defines the
6937 @code{git-fetch} origin method, which fetches data from a Git version
6938 control repository, and the @code{git-reference} data type to describe
6939 the repository and revision to fetch.
6940
6941 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} git-fetch @var{ref} @var{hash-algo} @var{hash}
6942 Return a fixed-output derivation that fetches @var{ref}, a
6943 @code{<git-reference>} object. The output is expected to have recursive
6944 hash @var{hash} of type @var{hash-algo} (a symbol). Use @var{name} as
6945 the file name, or a generic name if @code{#f}.
6946 @end deffn
6947
6948 @deftp {Data Type} git-reference
6949 This data type represents a Git reference for @code{git-fetch} to
6950 retrieve.
6951
6952 @table @asis
6953 @item @code{url}
6954 The URL of the Git repository to clone.
6955
6956 @item @code{commit}
6957 This string denotes either the commit to fetch (a hexadecimal string,
6958 either the full SHA1 commit or a ``short'' commit string; the latter is
6959 not recommended) or the tag to fetch.
6960
6961 @item @code{recursive?} (default: @code{#f})
6962 This Boolean indicates whether to recursively fetch Git sub-modules.
6963 @end table
6964
6965 The example below denotes the @code{v2.10} tag of the GNU@tie{}Hello
6966 repository:
6967
6968 @lisp
6969 (git-reference
6970 (url "https://git.savannah.gnu.org/git/hello.git")
6971 (commit "v2.10"))
6972 @end lisp
6973
6974 This is equivalent to the reference below, which explicitly names the
6975 commit:
6976
6977 @lisp
6978 (git-reference
6979 (url "https://git.savannah.gnu.org/git/hello.git")
6980 (commit "dc7dc56a00e48fe6f231a58f6537139fe2908fb9"))
6981 @end lisp
6982 @end deftp
6983
6984 For Mercurial repositories, the module @code{(guix hg-download)} defines
6985 the @code{hg-fetch} origin method and @code{hg-reference} data type for
6986 support of the Mercurial version control system.
6987
6988 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} hg-fetch @var{ref} @var{hash-algo} @var{hash} @
6989 [name]
6990 Return a fixed-output derivation that fetches @var{ref}, a
6991 @code{<hg-reference>} object. The output is expected to have recursive
6992 hash @var{hash} of type @var{hash-algo} (a symbol). Use @var{name} as
6993 the file name, or a generic name if @code{#false}.
6994 @end deffn
6995
6996 @node Defining Package Variants
6997 @section Defining Package Variants
6998
6999 @cindex customizing packages
7000 @cindex variants, of packages
7001 One of the nice things with Guix is that, given a package definition,
7002 you can easily @emph{derive} variants of that package---for a different
7003 upstream version, with different dependencies, different compilation
7004 options, and so on. Some of these custom packages can be defined
7005 straight from the command line (@pxref{Package Transformation Options}).
7006 This section describes how to define package variants in code. This can
7007 be useful in ``manifests'' (@pxref{profile-manifest,
7008 @option{--manifest}}) and in your own package collection
7009 (@pxref{Creating a Channel}), among others!
7010
7011 @cindex inherit, for package definitions
7012 As discussed earlier, packages are first-class objects in the Scheme
7013 language. The @code{(guix packages)} module provides the @code{package}
7014 construct to define new package objects (@pxref{package Reference}).
7015 The easiest way to define a package variant is using the @code{inherit}
7016 keyword together with @code{package}. This allows you to inherit from a
7017 package definition while overriding the fields you want.
7018
7019 For example, given the @code{hello} variable, which contains a
7020 definition for the current version of GNU@tie{}Hello, here's how you
7021 would define a variant for version 2.2 (released in 2006, it's
7022 vintage!):
7023
7024 @lisp
7025 (use-modules (gnu packages base)) ;for 'hello'
7026
7027 (define hello-2.2
7028 (package
7029 (inherit hello)
7030 (version "2.2")
7031 (source (origin
7032 (method url-fetch)
7033 (uri (string-append "mirror://gnu/hello/hello-" version
7034 ".tar.gz"))
7035 (sha256
7036 (base32
7037 "0lappv4slgb5spyqbh6yl5r013zv72yqg2pcl30mginf3wdqd8k9"))))))
7038 @end lisp
7039
7040 The example above corresponds to what the @option{--with-source} package
7041 transformation option does. Essentially @code{hello-2.2} preserves all
7042 the fields of @code{hello}, except @code{version} and @code{source},
7043 which it overrides. Note that the original @code{hello} variable is
7044 still there, in the @code{(gnu packages base)} module, unchanged. When
7045 you define a custom package like this, you are really @emph{adding} a
7046 new package definition; the original one remains available.
7047
7048 You can just as well define variants with a different set of
7049 dependencies than the original package. For example, the default
7050 @code{gdb} package depends on @code{guile}, but since that is an
7051 optional dependency, you can define a variant that removes that
7052 dependency like so:
7053
7054 @lisp
7055 (use-modules (gnu packages gdb) ;for 'gdb'
7056 (srfi srfi-1)) ;for 'alist-delete'
7057
7058 (define gdb-sans-guile
7059 (package
7060 (inherit gdb)
7061 (inputs (alist-delete "guile"
7062 (package-inputs gdb)))))
7063 @end lisp
7064
7065 The @code{alist-delete} call above removes the tuple from the
7066 @code{inputs} field that has @code{"guile"} as its first element
7067 (@pxref{SRFI-1 Association Lists,,, guile, GNU Guile Reference
7068 Manual}).
7069
7070 In some cases, you may find it useful to write functions
7071 (``procedures'', in Scheme parlance) that return a package based on some
7072 parameters. For example, consider the @code{luasocket} library for the
7073 Lua programming language. We want to create @code{luasocket} packages
7074 for major versions of Lua. One way to do that is to define a procedure
7075 that takes a Lua package and returns a @code{luasocket} package that
7076 depends on it:
7077
7078 @lisp
7079 (define (make-lua-socket name lua)
7080 ;; Return a luasocket package built with LUA.
7081 (package
7082 (name name)
7083 (version "3.0")
7084 ;; several fields omitted
7085 (inputs
7086 `(("lua" ,lua)))
7087 (synopsis "Socket library for Lua")))
7088
7089 (define-public lua5.1-socket
7090 (make-lua-socket "lua5.1-socket" lua-5.1))
7091
7092 (define-public lua5.2-socket
7093 (make-lua-socket "lua5.2-socket" lua-5.2))
7094 @end lisp
7095
7096 Here we have defined packages @code{lua5.1-socket} and
7097 @code{lua5.2-socket} by calling @code{make-lua-socket} with different
7098 arguments. @xref{Procedures,,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}, for
7099 more info on procedures. Having top-level public definitions for these
7100 two packages means that they can be referred to from the command line
7101 (@pxref{Package Modules}).
7102
7103 @cindex package transformations
7104 These are pretty simple package variants. As a convenience, the
7105 @code{(guix transformations)} module provides a high-level interface
7106 that directly maps to the more sophisticated package transformation
7107 options (@pxref{Package Transformation Options}):
7108
7109 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} options->transformation @var{opts}
7110 Return a procedure that, when passed an object to build (package,
7111 derivation, etc.), applies the transformations specified by @var{opts} and returns
7112 the resulting objects. @var{opts} must be a list of symbol/string pairs such as:
7113
7114 @lisp
7115 ((with-branch . "guile-gcrypt=master")
7116 (without-tests . "libgcrypt"))
7117 @end lisp
7118
7119 Each symbol names a transformation and the corresponding string is an argument
7120 to that transformation.
7121 @end deffn
7122
7123 For instance, a manifest equivalent to this command:
7124
7125 @example
7126 guix build guix \
7127 --with-branch=guile-gcrypt=master \
7128 --with-debug-info=zlib
7129 @end example
7130
7131 @noindent
7132 ... would look like this:
7133
7134 @lisp
7135 (use-modules (guix transformations))
7136
7137 (define transform
7138 ;; The package transformation procedure.
7139 (options->transformation
7140 '((with-branch . "guile-gcrypt=master")
7141 (with-debug-info . "zlib"))))
7142
7143 (packages->manifest
7144 (list (transform (specification->package "guix"))))
7145 @end lisp
7146
7147 @cindex input rewriting
7148 @cindex dependency graph rewriting
7149 The @code{options->transformation} procedure is convenient, but it's
7150 perhaps also not as flexible as you may like. How is it implemented?
7151 The astute reader probably noticed that most package transformation
7152 options go beyond the superficial changes shown in the first examples of
7153 this section: they involve @dfn{input rewriting}, whereby the dependency
7154 graph of a package is rewritten by replacing specific inputs by others.
7155
7156 Dependency graph rewriting, for the purposes of swapping packages in the
7157 graph, is what the @code{package-input-rewriting} procedure in
7158 @code{(guix packages)} implements.
7159
7160 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} package-input-rewriting @var{replacements} @
7161 [@var{rewrite-name}] [#:deep? #t]
7162 Return a procedure that, when passed a package, replaces its direct and
7163 indirect dependencies, including implicit inputs when @var{deep?} is
7164 true, according to @var{replacements}. @var{replacements} is a list of
7165 package pairs; the first element of each pair is the package to replace,
7166 and the second one is the replacement.
7167
7168 Optionally, @var{rewrite-name} is a one-argument procedure that takes
7169 the name of a package and returns its new name after rewrite.
7170 @end deffn
7171
7172 @noindent
7173 Consider this example:
7174
7175 @lisp
7176 (define libressl-instead-of-openssl
7177 ;; This is a procedure to replace OPENSSL by LIBRESSL,
7178 ;; recursively.
7179 (package-input-rewriting `((,openssl . ,libressl))))
7180
7181 (define git-with-libressl
7182 (libressl-instead-of-openssl git))
7183 @end lisp
7184
7185 @noindent
7186 Here we first define a rewriting procedure that replaces @var{openssl}
7187 with @var{libressl}. Then we use it to define a @dfn{variant} of the
7188 @var{git} package that uses @var{libressl} instead of @var{openssl}.
7189 This is exactly what the @option{--with-input} command-line option does
7190 (@pxref{Package Transformation Options, @option{--with-input}}).
7191
7192 The following variant of @code{package-input-rewriting} can match packages to
7193 be replaced by name rather than by identity.
7194
7195 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} package-input-rewriting/spec @var{replacements} [#:deep? #t]
7196 Return a procedure that, given a package, applies the given
7197 @var{replacements} to all the package graph, including implicit inputs
7198 unless @var{deep?} is false. @var{replacements} is a list of
7199 spec/procedures pair; each spec is a package specification such as
7200 @code{"gcc"} or @code{"guile@@2"}, and each procedure takes a matching
7201 package and returns a replacement for that package.
7202 @end deffn
7203
7204 The example above could be rewritten this way:
7205
7206 @lisp
7207 (define libressl-instead-of-openssl
7208 ;; Replace all the packages called "openssl" with LibreSSL.
7209 (package-input-rewriting/spec `(("openssl" . ,(const libressl)))))
7210 @end lisp
7211
7212 The key difference here is that, this time, packages are matched by spec and
7213 not by identity. In other words, any package in the graph that is called
7214 @code{openssl} will be replaced.
7215
7216 A more generic procedure to rewrite a package dependency graph is
7217 @code{package-mapping}: it supports arbitrary changes to nodes in the
7218 graph.
7219
7220 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} package-mapping @var{proc} [@var{cut?}] [#:deep? #f]
7221 Return a procedure that, given a package, applies @var{proc} to all the packages
7222 depended on and returns the resulting package. The procedure stops recursion
7223 when @var{cut?} returns true for a given package. When @var{deep?} is true, @var{proc} is
7224 applied to implicit inputs as well.
7225 @end deffn
7226
7227
7228 @node Build Systems
7229 @section Build Systems
7230
7231 @cindex build system
7232 Each package definition specifies a @dfn{build system} and arguments for
7233 that build system (@pxref{Defining Packages}). This @code{build-system}
7234 field represents the build procedure of the package, as well as implicit
7235 dependencies of that build procedure.
7236
7237 Build systems are @code{<build-system>} objects. The interface to
7238 create and manipulate them is provided by the @code{(guix build-system)}
7239 module, and actual build systems are exported by specific modules.
7240
7241 @cindex bag (low-level package representation)
7242 Under the hood, build systems first compile package objects to
7243 @dfn{bags}. A @dfn{bag} is like a package, but with less
7244 ornamentation---in other words, a bag is a lower-level representation of
7245 a package, which includes all the inputs of that package, including some
7246 that were implicitly added by the build system. This intermediate
7247 representation is then compiled to a derivation (@pxref{Derivations}).
7248 The @code{package-with-c-toolchain} is an example of a way to change the
7249 implicit inputs that a package's build system pulls in (@pxref{package
7250 Reference, @code{package-with-c-toolchain}}).
7251
7252 Build systems accept an optional list of @dfn{arguments}. In package
7253 definitions, these are passed @i{via} the @code{arguments} field
7254 (@pxref{Defining Packages}). They are typically keyword arguments
7255 (@pxref{Optional Arguments, keyword arguments in Guile,, guile, GNU
7256 Guile Reference Manual}). The value of these arguments is usually
7257 evaluated in the @dfn{build stratum}---i.e., by a Guile process launched
7258 by the daemon (@pxref{Derivations}).
7259
7260 The main build system is @code{gnu-build-system}, which implements the
7261 standard build procedure for GNU and many other packages. It
7262 is provided by the @code{(guix build-system gnu)} module.
7263
7264 @defvr {Scheme Variable} gnu-build-system
7265 @code{gnu-build-system} represents the GNU Build System, and variants
7266 thereof (@pxref{Configuration, configuration and makefile conventions,,
7267 standards, GNU Coding Standards}).
7268
7269 @cindex build phases
7270 In a nutshell, packages using it are configured, built, and installed with
7271 the usual @code{./configure && make && make check && make install}
7272 command sequence. In practice, a few additional steps are often needed.
7273 All these steps are split up in separate @dfn{phases},
7274 notably@footnote{Please see the @code{(guix build gnu-build-system)}
7275 modules for more details about the build phases.}:
7276
7277 @table @code
7278 @item unpack
7279 Unpack the source tarball, and change the current directory to the
7280 extracted source tree. If the source is actually a directory, copy it
7281 to the build tree, and enter that directory.
7282
7283 @item patch-source-shebangs
7284 Patch shebangs encountered in source files so they refer to the right
7285 store file names. For instance, this changes @code{#!/bin/sh} to
7286 @code{#!/gnu/store/@dots{}-bash-4.3/bin/sh}.
7287
7288 @item configure
7289 Run the @file{configure} script with a number of default options, such
7290 as @option{--prefix=/gnu/store/@dots{}}, as well as the options specified
7291 by the @code{#:configure-flags} argument.
7292
7293 @item build
7294 Run @code{make} with the list of flags specified with
7295 @code{#:make-flags}. If the @code{#:parallel-build?} argument is true
7296 (the default), build with @code{make -j}.
7297
7298 @item check
7299 Run @code{make check}, or some other target specified with
7300 @code{#:test-target}, unless @code{#:tests? #f} is passed. If the
7301 @code{#:parallel-tests?} argument is true (the default), run @code{make
7302 check -j}.
7303
7304 @item install
7305 Run @code{make install} with the flags listed in @code{#:make-flags}.
7306
7307 @item patch-shebangs
7308 Patch shebangs on the installed executable files.
7309
7310 @item strip
7311 Strip debugging symbols from ELF files (unless @code{#:strip-binaries?}
7312 is false), copying them to the @code{debug} output when available
7313 (@pxref{Installing Debugging Files}).
7314 @end table
7315
7316 @vindex %standard-phases
7317 The build-side module @code{(guix build gnu-build-system)} defines
7318 @code{%standard-phases} as the default list of build phases.
7319 @code{%standard-phases} is a list of symbol/procedure pairs, where the
7320 procedure implements the actual phase.
7321
7322 @xref{Build Phases}, for more info on build phases and ways to customize
7323 them.
7324
7325 In addition, this build system ensures that the ``standard'' environment
7326 for GNU packages is available. This includes tools such as GCC, libc,
7327 Coreutils, Bash, Make, Diffutils, grep, and sed (see the @code{(guix
7328 build-system gnu)} module for a complete list). We call these the
7329 @dfn{implicit inputs} of a package, because package definitions do not
7330 have to mention them.
7331 @end defvr
7332
7333 Other @code{<build-system>} objects are defined to support other
7334 conventions and tools used by free software packages. They inherit most
7335 of @code{gnu-build-system}, and differ mainly in the set of inputs
7336 implicitly added to the build process, and in the list of phases
7337 executed. Some of these build systems are listed below.
7338
7339 @defvr {Scheme Variable} ant-build-system
7340 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system ant)}. It
7341 implements the build procedure for Java packages that can be built with
7342 @url{https://ant.apache.org/, Ant build tool}.
7343
7344 It adds both @code{ant} and the @dfn{Java Development Kit} (JDK) as
7345 provided by the @code{icedtea} package to the set of inputs. Different
7346 packages can be specified with the @code{#:ant} and @code{#:jdk}
7347 parameters, respectively.
7348
7349 When the original package does not provide a suitable Ant build file,
7350 the parameter @code{#:jar-name} can be used to generate a minimal Ant
7351 build file @file{build.xml} with tasks to build the specified jar
7352 archive. In this case the parameter @code{#:source-dir} can be used to
7353 specify the source sub-directory, defaulting to ``src''.
7354
7355 The @code{#:main-class} parameter can be used with the minimal ant
7356 buildfile to specify the main class of the resulting jar. This makes the
7357 jar file executable. The @code{#:test-include} parameter can be used to
7358 specify the list of junit tests to run. It defaults to
7359 @code{(list "**/*Test.java")}. The @code{#:test-exclude} can be used to
7360 disable some tests. It defaults to @code{(list "**/Abstract*.java")},
7361 because abstract classes cannot be run as tests.
7362
7363 The parameter @code{#:build-target} can be used to specify the Ant task
7364 that should be run during the @code{build} phase. By default the
7365 ``jar'' task will be run.
7366
7367 @end defvr
7368
7369 @defvr {Scheme Variable} android-ndk-build-system
7370 @cindex Android distribution
7371 @cindex Android NDK build system
7372 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system android-ndk)}. It
7373 implements a build procedure for Android NDK (native development kit)
7374 packages using a Guix-specific build process.
7375
7376 The build system assumes that packages install their public interface
7377 (header) files to the subdirectory @file{include} of the @code{out} output and
7378 their libraries to the subdirectory @file{lib} the @code{out} output.
7379
7380 It's also assumed that the union of all the dependencies of a package
7381 has no conflicting files.
7382
7383 For the time being, cross-compilation is not supported - so right now
7384 the libraries and header files are assumed to be host tools.
7385
7386 @end defvr
7387
7388 @defvr {Scheme Variable} asdf-build-system/source
7389 @defvrx {Scheme Variable} asdf-build-system/sbcl
7390 @defvrx {Scheme Variable} asdf-build-system/ecl
7391
7392 These variables, exported by @code{(guix build-system asdf)}, implement
7393 build procedures for Common Lisp packages using
7394 @url{https://common-lisp.net/project/asdf/, ``ASDF''}. ASDF is a system
7395 definition facility for Common Lisp programs and libraries.
7396
7397 The @code{asdf-build-system/source} system installs the packages in
7398 source form, and can be loaded using any common lisp implementation, via
7399 ASDF@. The others, such as @code{asdf-build-system/sbcl}, install binary
7400 systems in the format which a particular implementation understands.
7401 These build systems can also be used to produce executable programs, or
7402 lisp images which contain a set of packages pre-loaded.
7403
7404 The build system uses naming conventions. For binary packages, the
7405 package name should be prefixed with the lisp implementation, such as
7406 @code{sbcl-} for @code{asdf-build-system/sbcl}.
7407
7408 Additionally, the corresponding source package should be labeled using
7409 the same convention as python packages (see @ref{Python Modules}), using
7410 the @code{cl-} prefix.
7411
7412 In order to create executable programs and images, the build-side
7413 procedures @code{build-program} and @code{build-image} can be used.
7414 They should be called in a build phase after the
7415 @code{create-asdf-configuration} phase, so that the system which was
7416 just built can be used within the resulting image. @code{build-program}
7417 requires a list of Common Lisp expressions to be passed as the
7418 @code{#:entry-program} argument.
7419
7420 By default, all the @file{.asd} files present in the sources are read to
7421 find system definitions. The @code{#:asd-files} parameter can be used
7422 to specify the list of @file{.asd} files to read. Furthermore, if the
7423 package defines a system for its tests in a separate file, it will be
7424 loaded before the tests are run if it is specified by the
7425 @code{#:test-asd-file} parameter. If it is not set, the files
7426 @code{<system>-tests.asd}, @code{<system>-test.asd}, @code{tests.asd},
7427 and @code{test.asd} will be tried if they exist.
7428
7429 If for some reason the package must be named in a different way than the
7430 naming conventions suggest, or if several systems must be compiled, the
7431 @code{#:asd-systems} parameter can be used to specify the list of system
7432 names.
7433
7434 @end defvr
7435
7436 @defvr {Scheme Variable} cargo-build-system
7437 @cindex Rust programming language
7438 @cindex Cargo (Rust build system)
7439 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system cargo)}. It
7440 supports builds of packages using Cargo, the build tool of the
7441 @uref{https://www.rust-lang.org, Rust programming language}.
7442
7443 It adds @code{rustc} and @code{cargo} to the set of inputs.
7444 A different Rust package can be specified with the @code{#:rust} parameter.
7445
7446 Regular cargo dependencies should be added to the package definition via the
7447 @code{#:cargo-inputs} parameter as a list of name and spec pairs, where the
7448 spec can be a package or a source definition. Note that the spec must
7449 evaluate to a path to a gzipped tarball which includes a @code{Cargo.toml}
7450 file at its root, or it will be ignored. Similarly, cargo dev-dependencies
7451 should be added to the package definition via the
7452 @code{#:cargo-development-inputs} parameter.
7453
7454 In its @code{configure} phase, this build system will make any source inputs
7455 specified in the @code{#:cargo-inputs} and @code{#:cargo-development-inputs}
7456 parameters available to cargo. It will also remove an included
7457 @code{Cargo.lock} file to be recreated by @code{cargo} during the
7458 @code{build} phase. The @code{install} phase installs the binaries
7459 defined by the crate.
7460 @end defvr
7461
7462 @defvr {Scheme Variable} chicken-build-system
7463 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system chicken)}. It
7464 builds @uref{https://call-cc.org/, CHICKEN Scheme} modules, also called
7465 ``eggs'' or ``extensions''. CHICKEN generates C source code, which then
7466 gets compiled by a C compiler, in this case GCC.
7467
7468 This build system adds @code{chicken} to the package inputs, as well as
7469 the packages of @code{gnu-build-system}.
7470
7471 The build system can't (yet) deduce the egg's name automatically, so just like
7472 with @code{go-build-system} and its @code{#:import-path}, you should define
7473 @code{#:egg-name} in the package's @code{arguments} field.
7474
7475 For example, if you are packaging the @code{srfi-1} egg:
7476
7477 @lisp
7478 (arguments '(#:egg-name "srfi-1"))
7479 @end lisp
7480
7481 Egg dependencies must be defined in @code{propagated-inputs}, not @code{inputs}
7482 because CHICKEN doesn't embed absolute references in compiled eggs.
7483 Test dependencies should go to @code{native-inputs}, as usual.
7484 @end defvr
7485
7486 @defvr {Scheme Variable} copy-build-system
7487 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system copy)}. It
7488 supports builds of simple packages that don't require much compiling,
7489 mostly just moving files around.
7490
7491 It adds much of the @code{gnu-build-system} packages to the set of
7492 inputs. Because of this, the @code{copy-build-system} does not require
7493 all the boilerplate code often needed for the
7494 @code{trivial-build-system}.
7495
7496 To further simplify the file installation process, an
7497 @code{#:install-plan} argument is exposed to let the packager specify
7498 which files go where. The install plan is a list of @code{(@var{source}
7499 @var{target} [@var{filters}])}. @var{filters} are optional.
7500
7501 @itemize
7502 @item When @var{source} matches a file or directory without trailing slash, install it to @var{target}.
7503 @itemize
7504 @item If @var{target} has a trailing slash, install @var{source} basename beneath @var{target}.
7505 @item Otherwise install @var{source} as @var{target}.
7506 @end itemize
7507
7508 @item When @var{source} is a directory with a trailing slash, or when @var{filters} are used,
7509 the trailing slash of @var{target} is implied with the same meaning
7510 as above.
7511 @itemize
7512 @item Without @var{filters}, install the full @var{source} @emph{content} to @var{target}.
7513 @item With @var{filters} among @code{#:include}, @code{#:include-regexp}, @code{#:exclude},
7514 @code{#:exclude-regexp}, only select files are installed depending on
7515 the filters. Each filters is specified by a list of strings.
7516 @itemize
7517 @item With @code{#:include}, install all the files which the path suffix matches
7518 at least one of the elements in the given list.
7519 @item With @code{#:include-regexp}, install all the files which the
7520 subpaths match at least one of the regular expressions in the given
7521 list.
7522 @item The @code{#:exclude} and @code{#:exclude-regexp} filters
7523 are the complement of their inclusion counterpart. Without @code{#:include} flags,
7524 install all files but those matching the exclusion filters.
7525 If both inclusions and exclusions are specified, the exclusions are done
7526 on top of the inclusions.
7527 @end itemize
7528 @end itemize
7529 In all cases, the paths relative to @var{source} are preserved within
7530 @var{target}.
7531 @end itemize
7532
7533 Examples:
7534
7535 @itemize
7536 @item @code{("foo/bar" "share/my-app/")}: Install @file{bar} to @file{share/my-app/bar}.
7537 @item @code{("foo/bar" "share/my-app/baz")}: Install @file{bar} to @file{share/my-app/baz}.
7538 @item @code{("foo/" "share/my-app")}: Install the content of @file{foo} inside @file{share/my-app},
7539 e.g., install @file{foo/sub/file} to @file{share/my-app/sub/file}.
7540 @item @code{("foo/" "share/my-app" #:include ("sub/file"))}: Install only @file{foo/sub/file} to
7541 @file{share/my-app/sub/file}.
7542 @item @code{("foo/sub" "share/my-app" #:include ("file"))}: Install @file{foo/sub/file} to
7543 @file{share/my-app/file}.
7544 @end itemize
7545 @end defvr
7546
7547
7548 @cindex Clojure (programming language)
7549 @cindex simple Clojure build system
7550 @defvr {Scheme Variable} clojure-build-system
7551 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system clojure)}. It implements
7552 a simple build procedure for @uref{https://clojure.org/, Clojure} packages
7553 using plain old @code{compile} in Clojure. Cross-compilation is not supported
7554 yet.
7555
7556 It adds @code{clojure}, @code{icedtea} and @code{zip} to the set of inputs.
7557 Different packages can be specified with the @code{#:clojure}, @code{#:jdk} and
7558 @code{#:zip} parameters, respectively.
7559
7560 A list of source directories, test directories and jar names can be specified
7561 with the @code{#:source-dirs}, @code{#:test-dirs} and @code{#:jar-names}
7562 parameters, respectively. Compile directory and main class can be specified
7563 with the @code{#:compile-dir} and @code{#:main-class} parameters, respectively.
7564 Other parameters are documented below.
7565
7566 This build system is an extension of @code{ant-build-system}, but with the
7567 following phases changed:
7568
7569 @table @code
7570
7571 @item build
7572 This phase calls @code{compile} in Clojure to compile source files and runs
7573 @command{jar} to create jars from both source files and compiled files
7574 according to the include list and exclude list specified in
7575 @code{#:aot-include} and @code{#:aot-exclude}, respectively. The exclude list
7576 has priority over the include list. These lists consist of symbols
7577 representing Clojure libraries or the special keyword @code{#:all} representing
7578 all Clojure libraries found under the source directories. The parameter
7579 @code{#:omit-source?} decides if source should be included into the jars.
7580
7581 @item check
7582 This phase runs tests according to the include list and exclude list specified
7583 in @code{#:test-include} and @code{#:test-exclude}, respectively. Their
7584 meanings are analogous to that of @code{#:aot-include} and
7585 @code{#:aot-exclude}, except that the special keyword @code{#:all} now
7586 stands for all Clojure libraries found under the test directories. The
7587 parameter @code{#:tests?} decides if tests should be run.
7588
7589 @item install
7590 This phase installs all jars built previously.
7591 @end table
7592
7593 Apart from the above, this build system also contains an additional phase:
7594
7595 @table @code
7596
7597 @item install-doc
7598 This phase installs all top-level files with base name matching
7599 @code{%doc-regex}. A different regex can be specified with the
7600 @code{#:doc-regex} parameter. All files (recursively) inside the documentation
7601 directories specified in @code{#:doc-dirs} are installed as well.
7602 @end table
7603 @end defvr
7604
7605 @defvr {Scheme Variable} cmake-build-system
7606 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system cmake)}. It
7607 implements the build procedure for packages using the
7608 @url{https://www.cmake.org, CMake build tool}.
7609
7610 It automatically adds the @code{cmake} package to the set of inputs.
7611 Which package is used can be specified with the @code{#:cmake}
7612 parameter.
7613
7614 The @code{#:configure-flags} parameter is taken as a list of flags
7615 passed to the @command{cmake} command. The @code{#:build-type}
7616 parameter specifies in abstract terms the flags passed to the compiler;
7617 it defaults to @code{"RelWithDebInfo"} (short for ``release mode with
7618 debugging information''), which roughly means that code is compiled with
7619 @code{-O2 -g}, as is the case for Autoconf-based packages by default.
7620 @end defvr
7621
7622 @defvr {Scheme Variable} dune-build-system
7623 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system dune)}. It
7624 supports builds of packages using @uref{https://dune.build/, Dune}, a build
7625 tool for the OCaml programming language. It is implemented as an extension
7626 of the @code{ocaml-build-system} which is described below. As such, the
7627 @code{#:ocaml} and @code{#:findlib} parameters can be passed to this build
7628 system.
7629
7630 It automatically adds the @code{dune} package to the set of inputs.
7631 Which package is used can be specified with the @code{#:dune}
7632 parameter.
7633
7634 There is no @code{configure} phase because dune packages typically don't
7635 need to be configured. The @code{#:build-flags} parameter is taken as a
7636 list of flags passed to the @code{dune} command during the build.
7637
7638 The @code{#:jbuild?} parameter can be passed to use the @code{jbuild}
7639 command instead of the more recent @code{dune} command while building
7640 a package. Its default value is @code{#f}.
7641
7642 The @code{#:package} parameter can be passed to specify a package name, which
7643 is useful when a package contains multiple packages and you want to build
7644 only one of them. This is equivalent to passing the @code{-p} argument to
7645 @code{dune}.
7646 @end defvr
7647
7648 @defvr {Scheme Variable} go-build-system
7649 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system go)}. It
7650 implements a build procedure for Go packages using the standard
7651 @url{https://golang.org/cmd/go/#hdr-Compile_packages_and_dependencies,
7652 Go build mechanisms}.
7653
7654 The user is expected to provide a value for the key @code{#:import-path}
7655 and, in some cases, @code{#:unpack-path}. The
7656 @url{https://golang.org/doc/code.html#ImportPaths, import path}
7657 corresponds to the file system path expected by the package's build
7658 scripts and any referring packages, and provides a unique way to
7659 refer to a Go package. It is typically based on a combination of the
7660 package source code's remote URI and file system hierarchy structure. In
7661 some cases, you will need to unpack the package's source code to a
7662 different directory structure than the one indicated by the import path,
7663 and @code{#:unpack-path} should be used in such cases.
7664
7665 Packages that provide Go libraries should install their source code into
7666 the built output. The key @code{#:install-source?}, which defaults to
7667 @code{#t}, controls whether or not the source code is installed. It can
7668 be set to @code{#f} for packages that only provide executable files.
7669 @end defvr
7670
7671 @defvr {Scheme Variable} glib-or-gtk-build-system
7672 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system glib-or-gtk)}. It
7673 is intended for use with packages making use of GLib or GTK+.
7674
7675 This build system adds the following two phases to the ones defined by
7676 @code{gnu-build-system}:
7677
7678 @table @code
7679 @item glib-or-gtk-wrap
7680 The phase @code{glib-or-gtk-wrap} ensures that programs in
7681 @file{bin/} are able to find GLib ``schemas'' and
7682 @uref{https://developer.gnome.org/gtk3/stable/gtk-running.html, GTK+
7683 modules}. This is achieved by wrapping the programs in launch scripts
7684 that appropriately set the @env{XDG_DATA_DIRS} and @env{GTK_PATH}
7685 environment variables.
7686
7687 It is possible to exclude specific package outputs from that wrapping
7688 process by listing their names in the
7689 @code{#:glib-or-gtk-wrap-excluded-outputs} parameter. This is useful
7690 when an output is known not to contain any GLib or GTK+ binaries, and
7691 where wrapping would gratuitously add a dependency of that output on
7692 GLib and GTK+.
7693
7694 @item glib-or-gtk-compile-schemas
7695 The phase @code{glib-or-gtk-compile-schemas} makes sure that all
7696 @uref{https://developer.gnome.org/gio/stable/glib-compile-schemas.html,
7697 GSettings schemas} of GLib are compiled. Compilation is performed by the
7698 @command{glib-compile-schemas} program. It is provided by the package
7699 @code{glib:bin} which is automatically imported by the build system.
7700 The @code{glib} package providing @command{glib-compile-schemas} can be
7701 specified with the @code{#:glib} parameter.
7702 @end table
7703
7704 Both phases are executed after the @code{install} phase.
7705 @end defvr
7706
7707 @defvr {Scheme Variable} guile-build-system
7708 This build system is for Guile packages that consist exclusively of Scheme
7709 code and that are so lean that they don't even have a makefile, let alone a
7710 @file{configure} script. It compiles Scheme code using @command{guild
7711 compile} (@pxref{Compilation,,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}) and
7712 installs the @file{.scm} and @file{.go} files in the right place. It also
7713 installs documentation.
7714
7715 This build system supports cross-compilation by using the
7716 @option{--target} option of @samp{guild compile}.
7717
7718 Packages built with @code{guile-build-system} must provide a Guile package in
7719 their @code{native-inputs} field.
7720 @end defvr
7721
7722 @defvr {Scheme Variable} julia-build-system
7723 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system julia)}. It
7724 implements the build procedure used by @uref{https://julialang.org/,
7725 julia} packages, which essentially is similar to running @samp{julia -e
7726 'using Pkg; Pkg.add(package)'} in an environment where
7727 @env{JULIA_LOAD_PATH} contains the paths to all Julia package inputs.
7728 Tests are run by calling @code{/test/runtests.jl}.
7729
7730 The Julia package name is read from the file @file{Project.toml}. This
7731 value can be overridden by passing the argument @code{#:julia-file-name}
7732 (which must be correctly capitalized).
7733
7734 For packages requiring shared library dependencies, you may need to write the
7735 @file{/deps/deps.jl} file manually. It's usually a line of @code{const
7736 variable = /gnu/store/library.so} for each dependency, plus a void function
7737 @code{check_deps() = nothing}.
7738
7739 Some older packages that aren't using @file{Package.toml} yet, will require
7740 this file to be created, too. The function @code{julia-create-package-toml}
7741 helps creating the file. You need to pass the outputs and the source of the
7742 package, it's name (the same as the @code{file-name} parameter), the package
7743 uuid, the package version, and a list of dependencies specified by their name
7744 and their uuid.
7745 @end defvr
7746
7747 @defvr {Scheme Variable} maven-build-system
7748 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system maven)}. It implements
7749 a build procedure for @uref{https://maven.apache.org, Maven} packages. Maven
7750 is a dependency and lifecycle management tool for Java. A user of Maven
7751 specifies dependencies and plugins in a @file{pom.xml} file that Maven reads.
7752 When Maven does not have one of the dependencies or plugins in its repository,
7753 it will download them and use them to build the package.
7754
7755 The maven build system ensures that maven will not try to download any
7756 dependency by running in offline mode. Maven will fail if a dependency is
7757 missing. Before running Maven, the @file{pom.xml} (and subprojects) are
7758 modified to specify the version of dependencies and plugins that match the
7759 versions available in the guix build environment. Dependencies and plugins
7760 must be installed in the fake maven repository at @file{lib/m2}, and are
7761 symlinked into a proper repository before maven is run. Maven is instructed
7762 to use that repository for the build and installs built artifacts there.
7763 Changed files are copied to the @file{lib/m2} directory of the package output.
7764
7765 You can specify a @file{pom.xml} file with the @code{#:pom-file} argument,
7766 or let the build system use the default @file{pom.xml} file in the sources.
7767
7768 In case you need to specify a dependency's version manually, you can use the
7769 @code{#:local-packages} argument. It takes an association list where the key
7770 is the groupId of the package and its value is an association list where the
7771 key is the artifactId of the package and its value is the version you want to
7772 override in the @file{pom.xml}.
7773
7774 Some packages use dependencies or plugins that are not useful at runtime nor
7775 at build time in Guix. You can alter the @file{pom.xml} file to remove them
7776 using the @code{#:exclude} argument. Its value is an association list where
7777 the key is the groupId of the plugin or dependency you want to remove, and
7778 the value is a list of artifactId you want to remove.
7779
7780 You can override the default @code{jdk} and @code{maven} packages with the
7781 corresponding argument, @code{#:jdk} and @code{#:maven}.
7782
7783 The @code{#:maven-plugins} argument is a list of maven plugins used during
7784 the build, with the same format as the @code{inputs} fields of the package
7785 declaration. Its default value is @code{(default-maven-plugins)} which is
7786 also exported.
7787 @end defvr
7788
7789 @defvr {Scheme Variable} minify-build-system
7790 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system minify)}. It
7791 implements a minification procedure for simple JavaScript packages.
7792
7793 It adds @code{uglify-js} to the set of inputs and uses it to compress
7794 all JavaScript files in the @file{src} directory. A different minifier
7795 package can be specified with the @code{#:uglify-js} parameter, but it
7796 is expected that the package writes the minified code to the standard
7797 output.
7798
7799 When the input JavaScript files are not all located in the @file{src}
7800 directory, the parameter @code{#:javascript-files} can be used to
7801 specify a list of file names to feed to the minifier.
7802 @end defvr
7803
7804 @defvr {Scheme Variable} ocaml-build-system
7805 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system ocaml)}. It implements
7806 a build procedure for @uref{https://ocaml.org, OCaml} packages, which consists
7807 of choosing the correct set of commands to run for each package. OCaml
7808 packages can expect many different commands to be run. This build system will
7809 try some of them.
7810
7811 When the package has a @file{setup.ml} file present at the top-level, it will
7812 run @code{ocaml setup.ml -configure}, @code{ocaml setup.ml -build} and
7813 @code{ocaml setup.ml -install}. The build system will assume that this file
7814 was generated by @uref{http://oasis.forge.ocamlcore.org/, OASIS} and will take
7815 care of setting the prefix and enabling tests if they are not disabled. You
7816 can pass configure and build flags with the @code{#:configure-flags} and
7817 @code{#:build-flags}. The @code{#:test-flags} key can be passed to change the
7818 set of flags used to enable tests. The @code{#:use-make?} key can be used to
7819 bypass this system in the build and install phases.
7820
7821 When the package has a @file{configure} file, it is assumed that it is a
7822 hand-made configure script that requires a different argument format than
7823 in the @code{gnu-build-system}. You can add more flags with the
7824 @code{#:configure-flags} key.
7825
7826 When the package has a @file{Makefile} file (or @code{#:use-make?} is
7827 @code{#t}), it will be used and more flags can be passed to the build and
7828 install phases with the @code{#:make-flags} key.
7829
7830 Finally, some packages do not have these files and use a somewhat standard
7831 location for its build system. In that case, the build system will run
7832 @code{ocaml pkg/pkg.ml} or @code{ocaml pkg/build.ml} and take care of
7833 providing the path to the required findlib module. Additional flags can
7834 be passed via the @code{#:build-flags} key. Install is taken care of by
7835 @command{opam-installer}. In this case, the @code{opam} package must
7836 be added to the @code{native-inputs} field of the package definition.
7837
7838 Note that most OCaml packages assume they will be installed in the same
7839 directory as OCaml, which is not what we want in guix. In particular, they
7840 will install @file{.so} files in their module's directory, which is usually
7841 fine because it is in the OCaml compiler directory. In guix though, these
7842 libraries cannot be found and we use @env{CAML_LD_LIBRARY_PATH}. This
7843 variable points to @file{lib/ocaml/site-lib/stubslibs} and this is where
7844 @file{.so} libraries should be installed.
7845 @end defvr
7846
7847 @defvr {Scheme Variable} python-build-system
7848 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system python)}. It
7849 implements the more or less standard build procedure used by Python
7850 packages, which consists in running @code{python setup.py build} and
7851 then @code{python setup.py install --prefix=/gnu/store/@dots{}}.
7852
7853 For packages that install stand-alone Python programs under @code{bin/},
7854 it takes care of wrapping these programs so that their @env{PYTHONPATH}
7855 environment variable points to all the Python libraries they depend on.
7856
7857 Which Python package is used to perform the build can be specified with
7858 the @code{#:python} parameter. This is a useful way to force a package
7859 to be built for a specific version of the Python interpreter, which
7860 might be necessary if the package is only compatible with a single
7861 interpreter version.
7862
7863 By default guix calls @code{setup.py} under control of
7864 @code{setuptools}, much like @command{pip} does. Some packages are not
7865 compatible with setuptools (and pip), thus you can disable this by
7866 setting the @code{#:use-setuptools?} parameter to @code{#f}.
7867 @end defvr
7868
7869 @defvr {Scheme Variable} perl-build-system
7870 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system perl)}. It
7871 implements the standard build procedure for Perl packages, which either
7872 consists in running @code{perl Build.PL --prefix=/gnu/store/@dots{}},
7873 followed by @code{Build} and @code{Build install}; or in running
7874 @code{perl Makefile.PL PREFIX=/gnu/store/@dots{}}, followed by
7875 @code{make} and @code{make install}, depending on which of
7876 @code{Build.PL} or @code{Makefile.PL} is present in the package
7877 distribution. Preference is given to the former if both @code{Build.PL}
7878 and @code{Makefile.PL} exist in the package distribution. This
7879 preference can be reversed by specifying @code{#t} for the
7880 @code{#:make-maker?} parameter.
7881
7882 The initial @code{perl Makefile.PL} or @code{perl Build.PL} invocation
7883 passes flags specified by the @code{#:make-maker-flags} or
7884 @code{#:module-build-flags} parameter, respectively.
7885
7886 Which Perl package is used can be specified with @code{#:perl}.
7887 @end defvr
7888
7889 @defvr {Scheme Variable} renpy-build-system
7890 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system renpy)}. It implements
7891 the more or less standard build procedure used by Ren'py games, which consists
7892 of loading @code{#:game} once, thereby creating bytecode for it.
7893
7894 It further creates a wrapper script in @code{bin/} and a desktop entry in
7895 @code{share/applications}, both of which can be used to launch the game.
7896
7897 Which Ren'py package is used can be specified with @code{#:renpy}.
7898 Games can also be installed in outputs other than ``out'' by using
7899 @code{#:output}.
7900 @end defvr
7901
7902 @defvr {Scheme Variable} qt-build-system
7903 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system qt)}. It
7904 is intended for use with applications using Qt or KDE.
7905
7906 This build system adds the following two phases to the ones defined by
7907 @code{cmake-build-system}:
7908
7909 @table @code
7910 @item check-setup
7911 The phase @code{check-setup} prepares the environment for running
7912 the checks as commonly used by Qt test programs.
7913 For now this only sets some environment variables:
7914 @code{QT_QPA_PLATFORM=offscreen},
7915 @code{DBUS_FATAL_WARNINGS=0} and
7916 @code{CTEST_OUTPUT_ON_FAILURE=1}.
7917
7918 This phase is added before the @code{check} phase.
7919 It's a separate phase to ease adjusting if necessary.
7920
7921 @item qt-wrap
7922 The phase @code{qt-wrap}
7923 searches for Qt5 plugin paths, QML paths and some XDG in the inputs
7924 and output. In case some path is found, all programs in the output's
7925 @file{bin/}, @file{sbin/}, @file{libexec/} and @file{lib/libexec/} directories
7926 are wrapped in scripts defining the necessary environment variables.
7927
7928 It is possible to exclude specific package outputs from that wrapping process
7929 by listing their names in the @code{#:qt-wrap-excluded-outputs} parameter.
7930 This is useful when an output is known not to contain any Qt binaries, and
7931 where wrapping would gratuitously add a dependency of that output on Qt, KDE,
7932 or such.
7933
7934 This phase is added after the @code{install} phase.
7935 @end table
7936 @end defvr
7937
7938 @defvr {Scheme Variable} r-build-system
7939 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system r)}. It
7940 implements the build procedure used by @uref{https://r-project.org, R}
7941 packages, which essentially is little more than running @samp{R CMD
7942 INSTALL --library=/gnu/store/@dots{}} in an environment where
7943 @env{R_LIBS_SITE} contains the paths to all R package inputs. Tests are
7944 run after installation using the R function
7945 @code{tools::testInstalledPackage}.
7946 @end defvr
7947
7948 @defvr {Scheme Variable} rakudo-build-system
7949 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system rakudo)}. It
7950 implements the build procedure used by @uref{https://rakudo.org/,
7951 Rakudo} for @uref{https://perl6.org/, Perl6} packages. It installs the
7952 package to @code{/gnu/store/@dots{}/NAME-VERSION/share/perl6} and
7953 installs the binaries, library files and the resources, as well as wrap
7954 the files under the @code{bin/} directory. Tests can be skipped by
7955 passing @code{#f} to the @code{tests?} parameter.
7956
7957 Which rakudo package is used can be specified with @code{rakudo}.
7958 Which perl6-tap-harness package used for the tests can be specified with
7959 @code{#:prove6} or removed by passing @code{#f} to the
7960 @code{with-prove6?} parameter.
7961 Which perl6-zef package used for tests and installing can be specified
7962 with @code{#:zef} or removed by passing @code{#f} to the
7963 @code{with-zef?} parameter.
7964 @end defvr
7965
7966 @defvr {Scheme Variable} texlive-build-system
7967 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system texlive)}. It is
7968 used to build TeX packages in batch mode with a specified engine. The
7969 build system sets the @env{TEXINPUTS} variable to find all TeX source
7970 files in the inputs.
7971
7972 By default it runs @code{luatex} on all files ending on @code{ins}. A
7973 different engine and format can be specified with the
7974 @code{#:tex-format} argument. Different build targets can be specified
7975 with the @code{#:build-targets} argument, which expects a list of file
7976 names. The build system adds only @code{texlive-bin} and
7977 @code{texlive-latex-base} (both from @code{(gnu packages tex}) to the
7978 inputs. Both can be overridden with the arguments @code{#:texlive-bin}
7979 and @code{#:texlive-latex-base}, respectively.
7980
7981 The @code{#:tex-directory} parameter tells the build system where to
7982 install the built files under the texmf tree.
7983 @end defvr
7984
7985 @defvr {Scheme Variable} ruby-build-system
7986 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system ruby)}. It
7987 implements the RubyGems build procedure used by Ruby packages, which
7988 involves running @code{gem build} followed by @code{gem install}.
7989
7990 The @code{source} field of a package that uses this build system
7991 typically references a gem archive, since this is the format that Ruby
7992 developers use when releasing their software. The build system unpacks
7993 the gem archive, potentially patches the source, runs the test suite,
7994 repackages the gem, and installs it. Additionally, directories and
7995 tarballs may be referenced to allow building unreleased gems from Git or
7996 a traditional source release tarball.
7997
7998 Which Ruby package is used can be specified with the @code{#:ruby}
7999 parameter. A list of additional flags to be passed to the @command{gem}
8000 command can be specified with the @code{#:gem-flags} parameter.
8001 @end defvr
8002
8003 @defvr {Scheme Variable} waf-build-system
8004 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system waf)}. It
8005 implements a build procedure around the @code{waf} script. The common
8006 phases---@code{configure}, @code{build}, and @code{install}---are
8007 implemented by passing their names as arguments to the @code{waf}
8008 script.
8009
8010 The @code{waf} script is executed by the Python interpreter. Which
8011 Python package is used to run the script can be specified with the
8012 @code{#:python} parameter.
8013 @end defvr
8014
8015 @defvr {Scheme Variable} scons-build-system
8016 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system scons)}. It
8017 implements the build procedure used by the SCons software construction
8018 tool. This build system runs @code{scons} to build the package,
8019 @code{scons test} to run tests, and then @code{scons install} to install
8020 the package.
8021
8022 Additional flags to be passed to @code{scons} can be specified with the
8023 @code{#:scons-flags} parameter. The default build and install targets
8024 can be overridden with @code{#:build-targets} and
8025 @code{#:install-targets} respectively. The version of Python used to
8026 run SCons can be specified by selecting the appropriate SCons package
8027 with the @code{#:scons} parameter.
8028 @end defvr
8029
8030 @defvr {Scheme Variable} haskell-build-system
8031 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system haskell)}. It
8032 implements the Cabal build procedure used by Haskell packages, which
8033 involves running @code{runhaskell Setup.hs configure
8034 --prefix=/gnu/store/@dots{}} and @code{runhaskell Setup.hs build}.
8035 Instead of installing the package by running @code{runhaskell Setup.hs
8036 install}, to avoid trying to register libraries in the read-only
8037 compiler store directory, the build system uses @code{runhaskell
8038 Setup.hs copy}, followed by @code{runhaskell Setup.hs register}. In
8039 addition, the build system generates the package documentation by
8040 running @code{runhaskell Setup.hs haddock}, unless @code{#:haddock? #f}
8041 is passed. Optional Haddock parameters can be passed with the help of
8042 the @code{#:haddock-flags} parameter. If the file @code{Setup.hs} is
8043 not found, the build system looks for @code{Setup.lhs} instead.
8044
8045 Which Haskell compiler is used can be specified with the @code{#:haskell}
8046 parameter which defaults to @code{ghc}.
8047 @end defvr
8048
8049 @defvr {Scheme Variable} dub-build-system
8050 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system dub)}. It
8051 implements the Dub build procedure used by D packages, which
8052 involves running @code{dub build} and @code{dub run}.
8053 Installation is done by copying the files manually.
8054
8055 Which D compiler is used can be specified with the @code{#:ldc}
8056 parameter which defaults to @code{ldc}.
8057 @end defvr
8058
8059 @anchor{emacs-build-system}
8060 @defvr {Scheme Variable} emacs-build-system
8061 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system emacs)}. It
8062 implements an installation procedure similar to the packaging system
8063 of Emacs itself (@pxref{Packages,,, emacs, The GNU Emacs Manual}).
8064
8065 It first creates the @code{@code{package}-autoloads.el} file, then it
8066 byte compiles all Emacs Lisp files. Differently from the Emacs
8067 packaging system, the Info documentation files are moved to the standard
8068 documentation directory and the @file{dir} file is deleted. The Elisp
8069 package files are installed directly under @file{share/emacs/site-lisp}.
8070 @end defvr
8071
8072 @defvr {Scheme Variable} font-build-system
8073 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system font)}. It
8074 implements an installation procedure for font packages where upstream
8075 provides pre-compiled TrueType, OpenType, etc.@: font files that merely
8076 need to be copied into place. It copies font files to standard
8077 locations in the output directory.
8078 @end defvr
8079
8080 @defvr {Scheme Variable} meson-build-system
8081 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system meson)}. It
8082 implements the build procedure for packages that use
8083 @url{https://mesonbuild.com, Meson} as their build system.
8084
8085 It adds both Meson and @uref{https://ninja-build.org/, Ninja} to the set
8086 of inputs, and they can be changed with the parameters @code{#:meson}
8087 and @code{#:ninja} if needed. The default Meson is
8088 @code{meson-for-build}, which is special because it doesn't clear the
8089 @code{RUNPATH} of binaries and libraries when they are installed.
8090
8091 This build system is an extension of @code{gnu-build-system}, but with the
8092 following phases changed to some specific for Meson:
8093
8094 @table @code
8095
8096 @item configure
8097 The phase runs @code{meson} with the flags specified in
8098 @code{#:configure-flags}. The flag @option{--buildtype} is always set to
8099 @code{debugoptimized} unless something else is specified in
8100 @code{#:build-type}.
8101
8102 @item build
8103 The phase runs @code{ninja} to build the package in parallel by default, but
8104 this can be changed with @code{#:parallel-build?}.
8105
8106 @item check
8107 The phase runs @code{ninja} with the target specified in @code{#:test-target},
8108 which is @code{"test"} by default.
8109
8110 @item install
8111 The phase runs @code{ninja install} and can not be changed.
8112 @end table
8113
8114 Apart from that, the build system also adds the following phases:
8115
8116 @table @code
8117
8118 @item fix-runpath
8119 This phase ensures that all binaries can find the libraries they need.
8120 It searches for required libraries in subdirectories of the package being
8121 built, and adds those to @code{RUNPATH} where needed. It also removes
8122 references to libraries left over from the build phase by
8123 @code{meson-for-build}, such as test dependencies, that aren't actually
8124 required for the program to run.
8125
8126 @item glib-or-gtk-wrap
8127 This phase is the phase provided by @code{glib-or-gtk-build-system}, and it
8128 is not enabled by default. It can be enabled with @code{#:glib-or-gtk?}.
8129
8130 @item glib-or-gtk-compile-schemas
8131 This phase is the phase provided by @code{glib-or-gtk-build-system}, and it
8132 is not enabled by default. It can be enabled with @code{#:glib-or-gtk?}.
8133 @end table
8134 @end defvr
8135
8136 @defvr {Scheme Variable} linux-module-build-system
8137 @code{linux-module-build-system} allows building Linux kernel modules.
8138
8139 @cindex build phases
8140 This build system is an extension of @code{gnu-build-system}, but with the
8141 following phases changed:
8142
8143 @table @code
8144
8145 @item configure
8146 This phase configures the environment so that the Linux kernel's Makefile
8147 can be used to build the external kernel module.
8148
8149 @item build
8150 This phase uses the Linux kernel's Makefile in order to build the external
8151 kernel module.
8152
8153 @item install
8154 This phase uses the Linux kernel's Makefile in order to install the external
8155 kernel module.
8156 @end table
8157
8158 It is possible and useful to specify the Linux kernel to use for building
8159 the module (in the @code{arguments} form of a package using the
8160 @code{linux-module-build-system}, use the key @code{#:linux} to specify it).
8161 @end defvr
8162
8163 @defvr {Scheme Variable} node-build-system
8164 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system node)}. It
8165 implements the build procedure used by @uref{https://nodejs.org,
8166 Node.js}, which implements an approximation of the @code{npm install}
8167 command, followed by an @code{npm test} command.
8168
8169 Which Node.js package is used to interpret the @code{npm} commands can
8170 be specified with the @code{#:node} parameter which defaults to
8171 @code{node}.
8172 @end defvr
8173
8174 Lastly, for packages that do not need anything as sophisticated, a
8175 ``trivial'' build system is provided. It is trivial in the sense that
8176 it provides basically no support: it does not pull any implicit inputs,
8177 and does not have a notion of build phases.
8178
8179 @defvr {Scheme Variable} trivial-build-system
8180 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system trivial)}.
8181
8182 This build system requires a @code{#:builder} argument. This argument
8183 must be a Scheme expression that builds the package output(s)---as
8184 with @code{build-expression->derivation} (@pxref{Derivations,
8185 @code{build-expression->derivation}}).
8186 @end defvr
8187
8188 @node Build Phases
8189 @section Build Phases
8190
8191 @cindex build phases, for packages
8192 Almost all package build systems implement a notion @dfn{build phases}:
8193 a sequence of actions that the build system executes, when you build the
8194 package, leading to the installed byproducts in the store. A notable
8195 exception is the ``bare-bones'' @code{trivial-build-system}
8196 (@pxref{Build Systems}).
8197
8198 As discussed in the previous section, those build systems provide a
8199 standard list of phases. For @code{gnu-build-system}, the standard
8200 phases include an @code{unpack} phase to unpack the source code tarball,
8201 a @command{configure} phase to run @code{./configure}, a @code{build}
8202 phase to run @command{make}, and (among others) an @code{install} phase
8203 to run @command{make install}; @pxref{Build Systems}, for a more
8204 detailed view of these phases. Likewise, @code{cmake-build-system}
8205 inherits these phases, but its @code{configure} phase runs
8206 @command{cmake} instead of @command{./configure}. Other build systems,
8207 such as @code{python-build-system}, have a wholly different list of
8208 standard phases. All this code runs on the @dfn{build side}: it is
8209 evaluated when you actually build the package, in a dedicated build
8210 process spawned by the build daemon (@pxref{Invoking guix-daemon}).
8211
8212 Build phases are represented as association lists or ``alists''
8213 (@pxref{Association Lists,,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}) where
8214 each key is a symbol for the name of the phase and the associated value
8215 is a procedure that accepts an arbitrary number of arguments. By
8216 convention, those procedures receive information about the build in the
8217 form of @dfn{keyword parameters}, which they can use or ignore.
8218
8219 For example, here is how @code{(guix build gnu-build-system)} defines
8220 @code{%standard-phases}, the variable holding its alist of build
8221 phases@footnote{We present a simplified view of those build phases, but
8222 do take a look at @code{(guix build gnu-build-system)} to see all the
8223 details!}:
8224
8225 @lisp
8226 ;; The build phases of 'gnu-build-system'.
8227
8228 (define* (unpack #:key source #:allow-other-keys)
8229 ;; Extract the source tarball.
8230 (invoke "tar" "xvf" source))
8231
8232 (define* (configure #:key outputs #:allow-other-keys)
8233 ;; Run the 'configure' script. Install to output "out".
8234 (let ((out (assoc-ref outputs "out")))
8235 (invoke "./configure"
8236 (string-append "--prefix=" out))))
8237
8238 (define* (build #:allow-other-keys)
8239 ;; Compile.
8240 (invoke "make"))
8241
8242 (define* (check #:key (test-target "check") (tests? #true)
8243 #:allow-other-keys)
8244 ;; Run the test suite.
8245 (if tests?
8246 (invoke "make" test-target)
8247 (display "test suite not run\n")))
8248
8249 (define* (install #:allow-other-keys)
8250 ;; Install files to the prefix 'configure' specified.
8251 (invoke "make" "install"))
8252
8253 (define %standard-phases
8254 ;; The list of standard phases (quite a few are omitted
8255 ;; for brevity). Each element is a symbol/procedure pair.
8256 (list (cons 'unpack unpack)
8257 (cons 'configure configure)
8258 (cons 'build build)
8259 (cons 'check check)
8260 (cons 'install install)))
8261 @end lisp
8262
8263 This shows how @code{%standard-phases} is defined as a list of
8264 symbol/procedure pairs (@pxref{Pairs,,, guile, GNU Guile Reference
8265 Manual}). The first pair associates the @code{unpack} procedure with
8266 the @code{unpack} symbol---a name; the second pair defines the
8267 @code{configure} phase similarly, and so on. When building a package
8268 that uses @code{gnu-build-system} with its default list of phases, those
8269 phases are executed sequentially. You can see the name of each phase
8270 started and completed in the build log of packages that you build.
8271
8272 Let's now look at the procedures themselves. Each one is defined with
8273 @code{define*}: @code{#:key} lists keyword parameters the procedure
8274 accepts, possibly with a default value, and @code{#:allow-other-keys}
8275 specifies that other keyword parameters are ignored (@pxref{Optional
8276 Arguments,,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}).
8277
8278 The @code{unpack} procedure honors the @code{source} parameter, which
8279 the build system uses to pass the file name of the source tarball (or
8280 version control checkout), and it ignores other parameters. The
8281 @code{configure} phase only cares about the @code{outputs} parameter, an
8282 alist mapping package output names to their store file name
8283 (@pxref{Packages with Multiple Outputs}). It extracts the file name of
8284 for @code{out}, the default output, and passes it to
8285 @command{./configure} as the installation prefix, meaning that
8286 @command{make install} will eventually copy all the files in that
8287 directory (@pxref{Configuration, configuration and makefile
8288 conventions,, standards, GNU Coding Standards}). @code{build} and
8289 @code{install} ignore all their arguments. @code{check} honors the
8290 @code{test-target} argument, which specifies the name of the Makefile
8291 target to run tests; it prints a message and skips tests when
8292 @code{tests?} is false.
8293
8294 @cindex build phases, customizing
8295 The list of phases used for a particular package can be changed with the
8296 @code{#:phases} parameter of the build system. Changing the set of
8297 build phases boils down to building a new alist of phases based on the
8298 @code{%standard-phases} alist described above. This can be done with
8299 standard alist procedures such as @code{alist-delete} (@pxref{SRFI-1
8300 Association Lists,,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}); however, it is
8301 more convenient to do so with @code{modify-phases} (@pxref{Build
8302 Utilities, @code{modify-phases}}).
8303
8304 Here is an example of a package definition that removes the
8305 @code{configure} phase of @code{%standard-phases} and inserts a new
8306 phase before the @code{build} phase, called
8307 @code{set-prefix-in-makefile}:
8308
8309 @lisp
8310 (define-public example
8311 (package
8312 (name "example")
8313 ;; other fields omitted
8314 (build-system gnu-build-system)
8315 (arguments
8316 '(#:phases (modify-phases %standard-phases
8317 (delete 'configure)
8318 (add-before 'build 'set-prefix-in-makefile
8319 (lambda* (#:key outputs #:allow-other-keys)
8320 ;; Modify the makefile so that its
8321 ;; 'PREFIX' variable points to "out".
8322 (let ((out (assoc-ref outputs "out")))
8323 (substitute* "Makefile"
8324 (("PREFIX =.*")
8325 (string-append "PREFIX = "
8326 out "\n")))
8327 #true))))))))
8328 @end lisp
8329
8330 The new phase that is inserted is written as an anonymous procedure,
8331 introduced with @code{lambda*}; it honors the @code{outputs} parameter
8332 we have seen before. @xref{Build Utilities}, for more about the helpers
8333 used by this phase, and for more examples of @code{modify-phases}.
8334
8335 @cindex code staging
8336 @cindex staging, of code
8337 Keep in mind that build phases are code evaluated at the time the
8338 package is actually built. This explains why the whole
8339 @code{modify-phases} expression above is quoted (it comes after the
8340 @code{'} or apostrophe): it is @dfn{staged} for later execution.
8341 @xref{G-Expressions}, for an explanation of code staging and the
8342 @dfn{code strata} involved.
8343
8344 @node Build Utilities
8345 @section Build Utilities
8346
8347 As soon as you start writing non-trivial package definitions
8348 (@pxref{Defining Packages}) or other build actions
8349 (@pxref{G-Expressions}), you will likely start looking for helpers for
8350 ``shell-like'' actions---creating directories, copying and deleting
8351 files recursively, manipulating build phases, and so on. The
8352 @code{(guix build utils)} module provides such utility procedures.
8353
8354 Most build systems load @code{(guix build utils)} (@pxref{Build
8355 Systems}). Thus, when writing custom build phases for your package
8356 definitions, you can usually assume those procedures are in scope.
8357
8358 When writing G-expressions, you can import @code{(guix build utils)} on
8359 the ``build side'' using @code{with-imported-modules} and then put it in
8360 scope with the @code{use-modules} form (@pxref{Using Guile Modules,,,
8361 guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}):
8362
8363 @lisp
8364 (with-imported-modules '((guix build utils)) ;import it
8365 (computed-file "empty-tree"
8366 #~(begin
8367 ;; Put it in scope.
8368 (use-modules (guix build utils))
8369
8370 ;; Happily use its 'mkdir-p' procedure.
8371 (mkdir-p (string-append #$output "/a/b/c")))))
8372 @end lisp
8373
8374 The remainder of this section is the reference for most of the utility
8375 procedures provided by @code{(guix build utils)}.
8376
8377 @c TODO Document what's missing.
8378
8379 @subsection Dealing with Store File Names
8380
8381 This section documents procedures that deal with store file names.
8382
8383 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} %store-directory
8384 Return the directory name of the store.
8385 @end deffn
8386
8387 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} store-file-name? @var{file}
8388 Return true if @var{file} is in the store.
8389 @end deffn
8390
8391 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} strip-store-file-name @var{file}
8392 Strip the @file{/gnu/store} and hash from @var{file}, a store file name.
8393 The result is typically a @code{"@var{package}-@var{version}"} string.
8394 @end deffn
8395
8396 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} package-name->name+version @var{name}
8397 Given @var{name}, a package name like @code{"foo-0.9.1b"}, return two
8398 values: @code{"foo"} and @code{"0.9.1b"}. When the version part is
8399 unavailable, @var{name} and @code{#f} are returned. The first hyphen
8400 followed by a digit is considered to introduce the version part.
8401 @end deffn
8402
8403 @subsection File Types
8404
8405 The procedures below deal with files and file types.
8406
8407 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} directory-exists? @var{dir}
8408 Return @code{#t} if @var{dir} exists and is a directory.
8409 @end deffn
8410
8411 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} executable-file? @var{file}
8412 Return @code{#t} if @var{file} exists and is executable.
8413 @end deffn
8414
8415 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} symbolic-link? @var{file}
8416 Return @code{#t} if @var{file} is a symbolic link (aka. a ``symlink'').
8417 @end deffn
8418
8419 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} elf-file? @var{file}
8420 @deffnx {Scheme Procedure} ar-file? @var{file}
8421 @deffnx {Scheme Procedure} gzip-file? @var{file}
8422 Return @code{#t} if @var{file} is, respectively, an ELF file, an
8423 @code{ar} archive (such as a @file{.a} static library), or a gzip file.
8424 @end deffn
8425
8426 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} reset-gzip-timestamp @var{file} [#:keep-mtime? #t]
8427 If @var{file} is a gzip file, reset its embedded timestamp (as with
8428 @command{gzip --no-name}) and return true. Otherwise return @code{#f}.
8429 When @var{keep-mtime?} is true, preserve @var{file}'s modification time.
8430 @end deffn
8431
8432 @subsection File Manipulation
8433
8434 The following procedures and macros help create, modify, and delete
8435 files. They provide functionality comparable to common shell utilities
8436 such as @command{mkdir -p}, @command{cp -r}, @command{rm -r}, and
8437 @command{sed}. They complement Guile's extensive, but low-level, file
8438 system interface (@pxref{POSIX,,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}).
8439
8440 @deffn {Scheme Syntax} with-directory-excursion @var{directory} @var{body}@dots{}
8441 Run @var{body} with @var{directory} as the process's current directory.
8442
8443 Essentially, this macro changes the current directory to @var{directory}
8444 before evaluating @var{body}, using @code{chdir} (@pxref{Processes,,,
8445 guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}). It changes back to the initial
8446 directory when the dynamic extent of @var{body} is left, be it @i{via}
8447 normal procedure return or @i{via} a non-local exit such as an
8448 exception.
8449 @end deffn
8450
8451 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} mkdir-p @var{dir}
8452 Create directory @var{dir} and all its ancestors.
8453 @end deffn
8454
8455 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} install-file @var{file} @var{directory}
8456 Create @var{directory} if it does not exist and copy @var{file} in there
8457 under the same name.
8458 @end deffn
8459
8460 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} make-file-writable @var{file}
8461 Make @var{file} writable for its owner.
8462 @end deffn
8463
8464 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} copy-recursively @var{source} @var{destination} @
8465 [#:log (current-output-port)] [#:follow-symlinks? #f] [#:keep-mtime? #f]
8466 Copy @var{source} directory to @var{destination}. Follow symlinks if
8467 @var{follow-symlinks?} is true; otherwise, just preserve them. When
8468 @var{keep-mtime?} is true, keep the modification time of the files in
8469 @var{source} on those of @var{destination}. Write verbose output to the
8470 @var{log} port.
8471 @end deffn
8472
8473 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} delete-file-recursively @var{dir} @
8474 [#:follow-mounts? #f]
8475 Delete @var{dir} recursively, like @command{rm -rf}, without following
8476 symlinks. Don't follow mount points either, unless @var{follow-mounts?}
8477 is true. Report but ignore errors.
8478 @end deffn
8479
8480 @deffn {Scheme Syntax} substitute* @var{file} @
8481 ((@var{regexp} @var{match-var}@dots{}) @var{body}@dots{}) @dots{}
8482 Substitute @var{regexp} in @var{file} by the string returned by
8483 @var{body}. @var{body} is evaluated with each @var{match-var} bound to
8484 the corresponding positional regexp sub-expression. For example:
8485
8486 @lisp
8487 (substitute* file
8488 (("hello")
8489 "good morning\n")
8490 (("foo([a-z]+)bar(.*)$" all letters end)
8491 (string-append "baz" letter end)))
8492 @end lisp
8493
8494 Here, anytime a line of @var{file} contains @code{hello}, it is replaced
8495 by @code{good morning}. Anytime a line of @var{file} matches the second
8496 regexp, @code{all} is bound to the complete match, @code{letters} is bound
8497 to the first sub-expression, and @code{end} is bound to the last one.
8498
8499 When one of the @var{match-var} is @code{_}, no variable is bound to the
8500 corresponding match substring.
8501
8502 Alternatively, @var{file} may be a list of file names, in which case
8503 they are all subject to the substitutions.
8504
8505 Be careful about using @code{$} to match the end of a line; by itself it
8506 won't match the terminating newline of a line.
8507 @end deffn
8508
8509 @subsection File Search
8510
8511 @cindex file, searching
8512 This section documents procedures to search and filter files.
8513
8514 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} file-name-predicate @var{regexp}
8515 Return a predicate that returns true when passed a file name whose base
8516 name matches @var{regexp}.
8517 @end deffn
8518
8519 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} find-files @var{dir} [@var{pred}] @
8520 [#:stat lstat] [#:directories? #f] [#:fail-on-error? #f]
8521 Return the lexicographically sorted list of files under @var{dir} for
8522 which @var{pred} returns true. @var{pred} is passed two arguments: the
8523 absolute file name, and its stat buffer; the default predicate always
8524 returns true. @var{pred} can also be a regular expression, in which
8525 case it is equivalent to @code{(file-name-predicate @var{pred})}.
8526 @var{stat} is used to obtain file information; using @code{lstat} means
8527 that symlinks are not followed. If @var{directories?} is true, then
8528 directories will also be included. If @var{fail-on-error?} is true,
8529 raise an exception upon error.
8530 @end deffn
8531
8532 Here are a few examples where we assume that the current directory is
8533 the root of the Guix source tree:
8534
8535 @lisp
8536 ;; List all the regular files in the current directory.
8537 (find-files ".")
8538 @result{} ("./.dir-locals.el" "./.gitignore" @dots{})
8539
8540 ;; List all the .scm files under gnu/services.
8541 (find-files "gnu/services" "\\.scm$")
8542 @result{} ("gnu/services/admin.scm" "gnu/services/audio.scm" @dots{})
8543
8544 ;; List ar files in the current directory.
8545 (find-files "." (lambda (file stat) (ar-file? file)))
8546 @result{} ("./libformat.a" "./libstore.a" @dots{})
8547 @end lisp
8548
8549 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} which @var{program}
8550 Return the complete file name for @var{program} as found in
8551 @code{$PATH}, or @code{#f} if @var{program} could not be found.
8552 @end deffn
8553
8554 @subsection Build Phases
8555
8556 @cindex build phases
8557 The @code{(guix build utils)} also contains tools to manipulate build
8558 phases as used by build systems (@pxref{Build Systems}). Build phases
8559 are represented as association lists or ``alists'' (@pxref{Association
8560 Lists,,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}) where each key is a symbol
8561 naming the phase and the associated value is a procedure (@pxref{Build
8562 Phases}).
8563
8564 Guile core and the @code{(srfi srfi-1)} module both provide tools to
8565 manipulate alists. The @code{(guix build utils)} module complements
8566 those with tools written with build phases in mind.
8567
8568 @cindex build phases, modifying
8569 @deffn {Scheme Syntax} modify-phases @var{phases} @var{clause}@dots{}
8570 Modify @var{phases} sequentially as per each @var{clause}, which may
8571 have one of the following forms:
8572
8573 @lisp
8574 (delete @var{old-phase-name})
8575 (replace @var{old-phase-name} @var{new-phase})
8576 (add-before @var{old-phase-name} @var{new-phase-name} @var{new-phase})
8577 (add-after @var{old-phase-name} @var{new-phase-name} @var{new-phase})
8578 @end lisp
8579
8580 Where every @var{phase-name} above is an expression evaluating to a
8581 symbol, and @var{new-phase} an expression evaluating to a procedure.
8582 @end deffn
8583
8584 The example below is taken from the definition of the @code{grep}
8585 package. It adds a phase to run after the @code{install} phase, called
8586 @code{fix-egrep-and-fgrep}. That phase is a procedure (@code{lambda*}
8587 is for anonymous procedures) that takes a @code{#:outputs} keyword
8588 argument and ignores extra keyword arguments (@pxref{Optional
8589 Arguments,,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}, for more on
8590 @code{lambda*} and optional and keyword arguments.) The phase uses
8591 @code{substitute*} to modify the installed @file{egrep} and @file{fgrep}
8592 scripts so that they refer to @code{grep} by its absolute file name:
8593
8594 @lisp
8595 (modify-phases %standard-phases
8596 (add-after 'install 'fix-egrep-and-fgrep
8597 ;; Patch 'egrep' and 'fgrep' to execute 'grep' via its
8598 ;; absolute file name instead of searching for it in $PATH.
8599 (lambda* (#:key outputs #:allow-other-keys)
8600 (let* ((out (assoc-ref outputs "out"))
8601 (bin (string-append out "/bin")))
8602 (substitute* (list (string-append bin "/egrep")
8603 (string-append bin "/fgrep"))
8604 (("^exec grep")
8605 (string-append "exec " bin "/grep")))
8606 #t))))
8607 @end lisp
8608
8609 In the example below, phases are modified in two ways: the standard
8610 @code{configure} phase is deleted, presumably because the package does
8611 not have a @file{configure} script or anything similar, and the default
8612 @code{install} phase is replaced by one that manually copies the
8613 executable files to be installed:
8614
8615 @lisp
8616 (modify-phases %standard-phases
8617 (delete 'configure) ;no 'configure' script
8618 (replace 'install
8619 (lambda* (#:key outputs #:allow-other-keys)
8620 ;; The package's Makefile doesn't provide an "install"
8621 ;; rule so do it by ourselves.
8622 (let ((bin (string-append (assoc-ref outputs "out")
8623 "/bin")))
8624 (install-file "footswitch" bin)
8625 (install-file "scythe" bin)
8626 #t))))
8627 @end lisp
8628
8629 @c TODO: Add more examples.
8630
8631 @node The Store
8632 @section The Store
8633
8634 @cindex store
8635 @cindex store items
8636 @cindex store paths
8637
8638 Conceptually, the @dfn{store} is the place where derivations that have
8639 been built successfully are stored---by default, @file{/gnu/store}.
8640 Sub-directories in the store are referred to as @dfn{store items} or
8641 sometimes @dfn{store paths}. The store has an associated database that
8642 contains information such as the store paths referred to by each store
8643 path, and the list of @emph{valid} store items---results of successful
8644 builds. This database resides in @file{@var{localstatedir}/guix/db},
8645 where @var{localstatedir} is the state directory specified @i{via}
8646 @option{--localstatedir} at configure time, usually @file{/var}.
8647
8648 The store is @emph{always} accessed by the daemon on behalf of its clients
8649 (@pxref{Invoking guix-daemon}). To manipulate the store, clients
8650 connect to the daemon over a Unix-domain socket, send requests to it,
8651 and read the result---these are remote procedure calls, or RPCs.
8652
8653 @quotation Note
8654 Users must @emph{never} modify files under @file{/gnu/store} directly.
8655 This would lead to inconsistencies and break the immutability
8656 assumptions of Guix's functional model (@pxref{Introduction}).
8657
8658 @xref{Invoking guix gc, @command{guix gc --verify}}, for information on
8659 how to check the integrity of the store and attempt recovery from
8660 accidental modifications.
8661 @end quotation
8662
8663 The @code{(guix store)} module provides procedures to connect to the
8664 daemon, and to perform RPCs. These are described below. By default,
8665 @code{open-connection}, and thus all the @command{guix} commands,
8666 connect to the local daemon or to the URI specified by the
8667 @env{GUIX_DAEMON_SOCKET} environment variable.
8668
8669 @defvr {Environment Variable} GUIX_DAEMON_SOCKET
8670 When set, the value of this variable should be a file name or a URI
8671 designating the daemon endpoint. When it is a file name, it denotes a
8672 Unix-domain socket to connect to. In addition to file names, the
8673 supported URI schemes are:
8674
8675 @table @code
8676 @item file
8677 @itemx unix
8678 These are for Unix-domain sockets.
8679 @code{file:///var/guix/daemon-socket/socket} is equivalent to
8680 @file{/var/guix/daemon-socket/socket}.
8681
8682 @item guix
8683 @cindex daemon, remote access
8684 @cindex remote access to the daemon
8685 @cindex daemon, cluster setup
8686 @cindex clusters, daemon setup
8687 These URIs denote connections over TCP/IP, without encryption nor
8688 authentication of the remote host. The URI must specify the host name
8689 and optionally a port number (by default port 44146 is used):
8690
8691 @example
8692 guix://master.guix.example.org:1234
8693 @end example
8694
8695 This setup is suitable on local networks, such as clusters, where only
8696 trusted nodes may connect to the build daemon at
8697 @code{master.guix.example.org}.
8698
8699 The @option{--listen} option of @command{guix-daemon} can be used to
8700 instruct it to listen for TCP connections (@pxref{Invoking guix-daemon,
8701 @option{--listen}}).
8702
8703 @item ssh
8704 @cindex SSH access to build daemons
8705 These URIs allow you to connect to a remote daemon over SSH@. This
8706 feature requires Guile-SSH (@pxref{Requirements}) and a working
8707 @command{guile} binary in @env{PATH} on the destination machine. It
8708 supports public key and GSSAPI authentication. A typical URL might look
8709 like this:
8710
8711 @example
8712 ssh://charlie@@guix.example.org:22
8713 @end example
8714
8715 As for @command{guix copy}, the usual OpenSSH client configuration files
8716 are honored (@pxref{Invoking guix copy}).
8717 @end table
8718
8719 Additional URI schemes may be supported in the future.
8720
8721 @c XXX: Remove this note when the protocol incurs fewer round trips
8722 @c and when (guix derivations) no longer relies on file system access.
8723 @quotation Note
8724 The ability to connect to remote build daemons is considered
8725 experimental as of @value{VERSION}. Please get in touch with us to
8726 share any problems or suggestions you may have (@pxref{Contributing}).
8727 @end quotation
8728 @end defvr
8729
8730 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} open-connection [@var{uri}] [#:reserve-space? #t]
8731 Connect to the daemon over the Unix-domain socket at @var{uri} (a string). When
8732 @var{reserve-space?} is true, instruct it to reserve a little bit of
8733 extra space on the file system so that the garbage collector can still
8734 operate should the disk become full. Return a server object.
8735
8736 @var{file} defaults to @code{%default-socket-path}, which is the normal
8737 location given the options that were passed to @command{configure}.
8738 @end deffn
8739
8740 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} close-connection @var{server}
8741 Close the connection to @var{server}.
8742 @end deffn
8743
8744 @defvr {Scheme Variable} current-build-output-port
8745 This variable is bound to a SRFI-39 parameter, which refers to the port
8746 where build and error logs sent by the daemon should be written.
8747 @end defvr
8748
8749 Procedures that make RPCs all take a server object as their first
8750 argument.
8751
8752 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} valid-path? @var{server} @var{path}
8753 @cindex invalid store items
8754 Return @code{#t} when @var{path} designates a valid store item and
8755 @code{#f} otherwise (an invalid item may exist on disk but still be
8756 invalid, for instance because it is the result of an aborted or failed
8757 build).
8758
8759 A @code{&store-protocol-error} condition is raised if @var{path} is not
8760 prefixed by the store directory (@file{/gnu/store}).
8761 @end deffn
8762
8763 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} add-text-to-store @var{server} @var{name} @var{text} [@var{references}]
8764 Add @var{text} under file @var{name} in the store, and return its store
8765 path. @var{references} is the list of store paths referred to by the
8766 resulting store path.
8767 @end deffn
8768
8769 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} build-derivations @var{store} @var{derivations} @
8770 [@var{mode}]
8771 Build @var{derivations}, a list of @code{<derivation>} objects, @file{.drv}
8772 file names, or derivation/output pairs, using the specified
8773 @var{mode}---@code{(build-mode normal)} by default.
8774 @end deffn
8775
8776 Note that the @code{(guix monads)} module provides a monad as well as
8777 monadic versions of the above procedures, with the goal of making it
8778 more convenient to work with code that accesses the store (@pxref{The
8779 Store Monad}).
8780
8781 @c FIXME
8782 @i{This section is currently incomplete.}
8783
8784 @node Derivations
8785 @section Derivations
8786
8787 @cindex derivations
8788 Low-level build actions and the environment in which they are performed
8789 are represented by @dfn{derivations}. A derivation contains the
8790 following pieces of information:
8791
8792 @itemize
8793 @item
8794 The outputs of the derivation---derivations produce at least one file or
8795 directory in the store, but may produce more.
8796
8797 @item
8798 @cindex build-time dependencies
8799 @cindex dependencies, build-time
8800 The inputs of the derivations---i.e., its build-time dependencies---which may
8801 be other derivations or plain files in the store (patches, build scripts,
8802 etc.).
8803
8804 @item
8805 The system type targeted by the derivation---e.g., @code{x86_64-linux}.
8806
8807 @item
8808 The file name of a build script in the store, along with the arguments
8809 to be passed.
8810
8811 @item
8812 A list of environment variables to be defined.
8813
8814 @end itemize
8815
8816 @cindex derivation path
8817 Derivations allow clients of the daemon to communicate build actions to
8818 the store. They exist in two forms: as an in-memory representation,
8819 both on the client- and daemon-side, and as files in the store whose
8820 name end in @file{.drv}---these files are referred to as @dfn{derivation
8821 paths}. Derivations paths can be passed to the @code{build-derivations}
8822 procedure to perform the build actions they prescribe (@pxref{The
8823 Store}).
8824
8825 @cindex fixed-output derivations
8826 Operations such as file downloads and version-control checkouts for
8827 which the expected content hash is known in advance are modeled as
8828 @dfn{fixed-output derivations}. Unlike regular derivations, the outputs
8829 of a fixed-output derivation are independent of its inputs---e.g., a
8830 source code download produces the same result regardless of the download
8831 method and tools being used.
8832
8833 @cindex references
8834 @cindex run-time dependencies
8835 @cindex dependencies, run-time
8836 The outputs of derivations---i.e., the build results---have a set of
8837 @dfn{references}, as reported by the @code{references} RPC or the
8838 @command{guix gc --references} command (@pxref{Invoking guix gc}). References
8839 are the set of run-time dependencies of the build results. References are a
8840 subset of the inputs of the derivation; this subset is automatically computed
8841 by the build daemon by scanning all the files in the outputs.
8842
8843 The @code{(guix derivations)} module provides a representation of
8844 derivations as Scheme objects, along with procedures to create and
8845 otherwise manipulate derivations. The lowest-level primitive to create
8846 a derivation is the @code{derivation} procedure:
8847
8848 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} derivation @var{store} @var{name} @var{builder} @
8849 @var{args} [#:outputs '("out")] [#:hash #f] [#:hash-algo #f] @
8850 [#:recursive? #f] [#:inputs '()] [#:env-vars '()] @
8851 [#:system (%current-system)] [#:references-graphs #f] @
8852 [#:allowed-references #f] [#:disallowed-references #f] @
8853 [#:leaked-env-vars #f] [#:local-build? #f] @
8854 [#:substitutable? #t] [#:properties '()]
8855 Build a derivation with the given arguments, and return the resulting
8856 @code{<derivation>} object.
8857
8858 When @var{hash} and @var{hash-algo} are given, a
8859 @dfn{fixed-output derivation} is created---i.e., one whose result is
8860 known in advance, such as a file download. If, in addition,
8861 @var{recursive?} is true, then that fixed output may be an executable
8862 file or a directory and @var{hash} must be the hash of an archive
8863 containing this output.
8864
8865 When @var{references-graphs} is true, it must be a list of file
8866 name/store path pairs. In that case, the reference graph of each store
8867 path is exported in the build environment in the corresponding file, in
8868 a simple text format.
8869
8870 When @var{allowed-references} is true, it must be a list of store items
8871 or outputs that the derivation's output may refer to. Likewise,
8872 @var{disallowed-references}, if true, must be a list of things the
8873 outputs may @emph{not} refer to.
8874
8875 When @var{leaked-env-vars} is true, it must be a list of strings
8876 denoting environment variables that are allowed to ``leak'' from the
8877 daemon's environment to the build environment. This is only applicable
8878 to fixed-output derivations---i.e., when @var{hash} is true. The main
8879 use is to allow variables such as @code{http_proxy} to be passed to
8880 derivations that download files.
8881
8882 When @var{local-build?} is true, declare that the derivation is not a
8883 good candidate for offloading and should rather be built locally
8884 (@pxref{Daemon Offload Setup}). This is the case for small derivations
8885 where the costs of data transfers would outweigh the benefits.
8886
8887 When @var{substitutable?} is false, declare that substitutes of the
8888 derivation's output should not be used (@pxref{Substitutes}). This is
8889 useful, for instance, when building packages that capture details of the
8890 host CPU instruction set.
8891
8892 @var{properties} must be an association list describing ``properties'' of the
8893 derivation. It is kept as-is, uninterpreted, in the derivation.
8894 @end deffn
8895
8896 @noindent
8897 Here's an example with a shell script as its builder, assuming
8898 @var{store} is an open connection to the daemon, and @var{bash} points
8899 to a Bash executable in the store:
8900
8901 @lisp
8902 (use-modules (guix utils)
8903 (guix store)
8904 (guix derivations))
8905
8906 (let ((builder ; add the Bash script to the store
8907 (add-text-to-store store "my-builder.sh"
8908 "echo hello world > $out\n" '())))
8909 (derivation store "foo"
8910 bash `("-e" ,builder)
8911 #:inputs `((,bash) (,builder))
8912 #:env-vars '(("HOME" . "/homeless"))))
8913 @result{} #<derivation /gnu/store/@dots{}-foo.drv => /gnu/store/@dots{}-foo>
8914 @end lisp
8915
8916 As can be guessed, this primitive is cumbersome to use directly. A
8917 better approach is to write build scripts in Scheme, of course! The
8918 best course of action for that is to write the build code as a
8919 ``G-expression'', and to pass it to @code{gexp->derivation}. For more
8920 information, @pxref{G-Expressions}.
8921
8922 Once upon a time, @code{gexp->derivation} did not exist and constructing
8923 derivations with build code written in Scheme was achieved with
8924 @code{build-expression->derivation}, documented below. This procedure
8925 is now deprecated in favor of the much nicer @code{gexp->derivation}.
8926
8927 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} build-expression->derivation @var{store} @
8928 @var{name} @var{exp} @
8929 [#:system (%current-system)] [#:inputs '()] @
8930 [#:outputs '("out")] [#:hash #f] [#:hash-algo #f] @
8931 [#:recursive? #f] [#:env-vars '()] [#:modules '()] @
8932 [#:references-graphs #f] [#:allowed-references #f] @
8933 [#:disallowed-references #f] @
8934 [#:local-build? #f] [#:substitutable? #t] [#:guile-for-build #f]
8935 Return a derivation that executes Scheme expression @var{exp} as a
8936 builder for derivation @var{name}. @var{inputs} must be a list of
8937 @code{(name drv-path sub-drv)} tuples; when @var{sub-drv} is omitted,
8938 @code{"out"} is assumed. @var{modules} is a list of names of Guile
8939 modules from the current search path to be copied in the store,
8940 compiled, and made available in the load path during the execution of
8941 @var{exp}---e.g., @code{((guix build utils) (guix build
8942 gnu-build-system))}.
8943
8944 @var{exp} is evaluated in an environment where @code{%outputs} is bound
8945 to a list of output/path pairs, and where @code{%build-inputs} is bound
8946 to a list of string/output-path pairs made from @var{inputs}.
8947 Optionally, @var{env-vars} is a list of string pairs specifying the name
8948 and value of environment variables visible to the builder. The builder
8949 terminates by passing the result of @var{exp} to @code{exit}; thus, when
8950 @var{exp} returns @code{#f}, the build is considered to have failed.
8951
8952 @var{exp} is built using @var{guile-for-build} (a derivation). When
8953 @var{guile-for-build} is omitted or is @code{#f}, the value of the
8954 @code{%guile-for-build} fluid is used instead.
8955
8956 See the @code{derivation} procedure for the meaning of
8957 @var{references-graphs}, @var{allowed-references},
8958 @var{disallowed-references}, @var{local-build?}, and
8959 @var{substitutable?}.
8960 @end deffn
8961
8962 @noindent
8963 Here's an example of a single-output derivation that creates a directory
8964 containing one file:
8965
8966 @lisp
8967 (let ((builder '(let ((out (assoc-ref %outputs "out")))
8968 (mkdir out) ; create /gnu/store/@dots{}-goo
8969 (call-with-output-file (string-append out "/test")
8970 (lambda (p)
8971 (display '(hello guix) p))))))
8972 (build-expression->derivation store "goo" builder))
8973
8974 @result{} #<derivation /gnu/store/@dots{}-goo.drv => @dots{}>
8975 @end lisp
8976
8977
8978 @node The Store Monad
8979 @section The Store Monad
8980
8981 @cindex monad
8982
8983 The procedures that operate on the store described in the previous
8984 sections all take an open connection to the build daemon as their first
8985 argument. Although the underlying model is functional, they either have
8986 side effects or depend on the current state of the store.
8987
8988 The former is inconvenient: the connection to the build daemon has to be
8989 carried around in all those functions, making it impossible to compose
8990 functions that do not take that parameter with functions that do. The
8991 latter can be problematic: since store operations have side effects
8992 and/or depend on external state, they have to be properly sequenced.
8993
8994 @cindex monadic values
8995 @cindex monadic functions
8996 This is where the @code{(guix monads)} module comes in. This module
8997 provides a framework for working with @dfn{monads}, and a particularly
8998 useful monad for our uses, the @dfn{store monad}. Monads are a
8999 construct that allows two things: associating ``context'' with values
9000 (in our case, the context is the store), and building sequences of
9001 computations (here computations include accesses to the store). Values
9002 in a monad---values that carry this additional context---are called
9003 @dfn{monadic values}; procedures that return such values are called
9004 @dfn{monadic procedures}.
9005
9006 Consider this ``normal'' procedure:
9007
9008 @lisp
9009 (define (sh-symlink store)
9010 ;; Return a derivation that symlinks the 'bash' executable.
9011 (let* ((drv (package-derivation store bash))
9012 (out (derivation->output-path drv))
9013 (sh (string-append out "/bin/bash")))
9014 (build-expression->derivation store "sh"
9015 `(symlink ,sh %output))))
9016 @end lisp
9017
9018 Using @code{(guix monads)} and @code{(guix gexp)}, it may be rewritten
9019 as a monadic function:
9020
9021 @lisp
9022 (define (sh-symlink)
9023 ;; Same, but return a monadic value.
9024 (mlet %store-monad ((drv (package->derivation bash)))
9025 (gexp->derivation "sh"
9026 #~(symlink (string-append #$drv "/bin/bash")
9027 #$output))))
9028 @end lisp
9029
9030 There are several things to note in the second version: the @code{store}
9031 parameter is now implicit and is ``threaded'' in the calls to the
9032 @code{package->derivation} and @code{gexp->derivation} monadic
9033 procedures, and the monadic value returned by @code{package->derivation}
9034 is @dfn{bound} using @code{mlet} instead of plain @code{let}.
9035
9036 As it turns out, the call to @code{package->derivation} can even be
9037 omitted since it will take place implicitly, as we will see later
9038 (@pxref{G-Expressions}):
9039
9040 @lisp
9041 (define (sh-symlink)
9042 (gexp->derivation "sh"
9043 #~(symlink (string-append #$bash "/bin/bash")
9044 #$output)))
9045 @end lisp
9046
9047 @c See
9048 @c <https://syntaxexclamation.wordpress.com/2014/06/26/escaping-continuations/>
9049 @c for the funny quote.
9050 Calling the monadic @code{sh-symlink} has no effect. As someone once
9051 said, ``you exit a monad like you exit a building on fire: by running''.
9052 So, to exit the monad and get the desired effect, one must use
9053 @code{run-with-store}:
9054
9055 @lisp
9056 (run-with-store (open-connection) (sh-symlink))
9057 @result{} /gnu/store/...-sh-symlink
9058 @end lisp
9059
9060 Note that the @code{(guix monad-repl)} module extends the Guile REPL with
9061 new ``meta-commands'' to make it easier to deal with monadic procedures:
9062 @code{run-in-store}, and @code{enter-store-monad}. The former is used
9063 to ``run'' a single monadic value through the store:
9064
9065 @example
9066 scheme@@(guile-user)> ,run-in-store (package->derivation hello)
9067 $1 = #<derivation /gnu/store/@dots{}-hello-2.9.drv => @dots{}>
9068 @end example
9069
9070 The latter enters a recursive REPL, where all the return values are
9071 automatically run through the store:
9072
9073 @example
9074 scheme@@(guile-user)> ,enter-store-monad
9075 store-monad@@(guile-user) [1]> (package->derivation hello)
9076 $2 = #<derivation /gnu/store/@dots{}-hello-2.9.drv => @dots{}>
9077 store-monad@@(guile-user) [1]> (text-file "foo" "Hello!")
9078 $3 = "/gnu/store/@dots{}-foo"
9079 store-monad@@(guile-user) [1]> ,q
9080 scheme@@(guile-user)>
9081 @end example
9082
9083 @noindent
9084 Note that non-monadic values cannot be returned in the
9085 @code{store-monad} REPL.
9086
9087 The main syntactic forms to deal with monads in general are provided by
9088 the @code{(guix monads)} module and are described below.
9089
9090 @deffn {Scheme Syntax} with-monad @var{monad} @var{body} ...
9091 Evaluate any @code{>>=} or @code{return} forms in @var{body} as being
9092 in @var{monad}.
9093 @end deffn
9094
9095 @deffn {Scheme Syntax} return @var{val}
9096 Return a monadic value that encapsulates @var{val}.
9097 @end deffn
9098
9099 @deffn {Scheme Syntax} >>= @var{mval} @var{mproc} ...
9100 @dfn{Bind} monadic value @var{mval}, passing its ``contents'' to monadic
9101 procedures @var{mproc}@dots{}@footnote{This operation is commonly
9102 referred to as ``bind'', but that name denotes an unrelated procedure in
9103 Guile. Thus we use this somewhat cryptic symbol inherited from the
9104 Haskell language.}. There can be one @var{mproc} or several of them, as
9105 in this example:
9106
9107 @lisp
9108 (run-with-state
9109 (with-monad %state-monad
9110 (>>= (return 1)
9111 (lambda (x) (return (+ 1 x)))
9112 (lambda (x) (return (* 2 x)))))
9113 'some-state)
9114
9115 @result{} 4
9116 @result{} some-state
9117 @end lisp
9118 @end deffn
9119
9120 @deffn {Scheme Syntax} mlet @var{monad} ((@var{var} @var{mval}) ...) @
9121 @var{body} ...
9122 @deffnx {Scheme Syntax} mlet* @var{monad} ((@var{var} @var{mval}) ...) @
9123 @var{body} ...
9124 Bind the variables @var{var} to the monadic values @var{mval} in
9125 @var{body}, which is a sequence of expressions. As with the bind
9126 operator, this can be thought of as ``unpacking'' the raw, non-monadic
9127 value ``contained'' in @var{mval} and making @var{var} refer to that
9128 raw, non-monadic value within the scope of the @var{body}. The form
9129 (@var{var} -> @var{val}) binds @var{var} to the ``normal'' value
9130 @var{val}, as per @code{let}. The binding operations occur in sequence
9131 from left to right. The last expression of @var{body} must be a monadic
9132 expression, and its result will become the result of the @code{mlet} or
9133 @code{mlet*} when run in the @var{monad}.
9134
9135 @code{mlet*} is to @code{mlet} what @code{let*} is to @code{let}
9136 (@pxref{Local Bindings,,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}).
9137 @end deffn
9138
9139 @deffn {Scheme System} mbegin @var{monad} @var{mexp} ...
9140 Bind @var{mexp} and the following monadic expressions in sequence,
9141 returning the result of the last expression. Every expression in the
9142 sequence must be a monadic expression.
9143
9144 This is akin to @code{mlet}, except that the return values of the
9145 monadic expressions are ignored. In that sense, it is analogous to
9146 @code{begin}, but applied to monadic expressions.
9147 @end deffn
9148
9149 @deffn {Scheme System} mwhen @var{condition} @var{mexp0} @var{mexp*} ...
9150 When @var{condition} is true, evaluate the sequence of monadic
9151 expressions @var{mexp0}..@var{mexp*} as in an @code{mbegin}. When
9152 @var{condition} is false, return @code{*unspecified*} in the current
9153 monad. Every expression in the sequence must be a monadic expression.
9154 @end deffn
9155
9156 @deffn {Scheme System} munless @var{condition} @var{mexp0} @var{mexp*} ...
9157 When @var{condition} is false, evaluate the sequence of monadic
9158 expressions @var{mexp0}..@var{mexp*} as in an @code{mbegin}. When
9159 @var{condition} is true, return @code{*unspecified*} in the current
9160 monad. Every expression in the sequence must be a monadic expression.
9161 @end deffn
9162
9163 @cindex state monad
9164 The @code{(guix monads)} module provides the @dfn{state monad}, which
9165 allows an additional value---the state---to be @emph{threaded} through
9166 monadic procedure calls.
9167
9168 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %state-monad
9169 The state monad. Procedures in the state monad can access and change
9170 the state that is threaded.
9171
9172 Consider the example below. The @code{square} procedure returns a value
9173 in the state monad. It returns the square of its argument, but also
9174 increments the current state value:
9175
9176 @lisp
9177 (define (square x)
9178 (mlet %state-monad ((count (current-state)))
9179 (mbegin %state-monad
9180 (set-current-state (+ 1 count))
9181 (return (* x x)))))
9182
9183 (run-with-state (sequence %state-monad (map square (iota 3))) 0)
9184 @result{} (0 1 4)
9185 @result{} 3
9186 @end lisp
9187
9188 When ``run'' through @code{%state-monad}, we obtain that additional state
9189 value, which is the number of @code{square} calls.
9190 @end defvr
9191
9192 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} current-state
9193 Return the current state as a monadic value.
9194 @end deffn
9195
9196 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} set-current-state @var{value}
9197 Set the current state to @var{value} and return the previous state as a
9198 monadic value.
9199 @end deffn
9200
9201 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} state-push @var{value}
9202 Push @var{value} to the current state, which is assumed to be a list,
9203 and return the previous state as a monadic value.
9204 @end deffn
9205
9206 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} state-pop
9207 Pop a value from the current state and return it as a monadic value.
9208 The state is assumed to be a list.
9209 @end deffn
9210
9211 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} run-with-state @var{mval} [@var{state}]
9212 Run monadic value @var{mval} starting with @var{state} as the initial
9213 state. Return two values: the resulting value, and the resulting state.
9214 @end deffn
9215
9216 The main interface to the store monad, provided by the @code{(guix
9217 store)} module, is as follows.
9218
9219 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %store-monad
9220 The store monad---an alias for @code{%state-monad}.
9221
9222 Values in the store monad encapsulate accesses to the store. When its
9223 effect is needed, a value of the store monad must be ``evaluated'' by
9224 passing it to the @code{run-with-store} procedure (see below).
9225 @end defvr
9226
9227 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} run-with-store @var{store} @var{mval} [#:guile-for-build] [#:system (%current-system)]
9228 Run @var{mval}, a monadic value in the store monad, in @var{store}, an
9229 open store connection.
9230 @end deffn
9231
9232 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} text-file @var{name} @var{text} [@var{references}]
9233 Return as a monadic value the absolute file name in the store of the file
9234 containing @var{text}, a string. @var{references} is a list of store items that the
9235 resulting text file refers to; it defaults to the empty list.
9236 @end deffn
9237
9238 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} binary-file @var{name} @var{data} [@var{references}]
9239 Return as a monadic value the absolute file name in the store of the file
9240 containing @var{data}, a bytevector. @var{references} is a list of store
9241 items that the resulting binary file refers to; it defaults to the empty list.
9242 @end deffn
9243
9244 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} interned-file @var{file} [@var{name}] @
9245 [#:recursive? #t] [#:select? (const #t)]
9246 Return the name of @var{file} once interned in the store. Use
9247 @var{name} as its store name, or the basename of @var{file} if
9248 @var{name} is omitted.
9249
9250 When @var{recursive?} is true, the contents of @var{file} are added
9251 recursively; if @var{file} designates a flat file and @var{recursive?}
9252 is true, its contents are added, and its permission bits are kept.
9253
9254 When @var{recursive?} is true, call @code{(@var{select?} @var{file}
9255 @var{stat})} for each directory entry, where @var{file} is the entry's
9256 absolute file name and @var{stat} is the result of @code{lstat}; exclude
9257 entries for which @var{select?} does not return true.
9258
9259 The example below adds a file to the store, under two different names:
9260
9261 @lisp
9262 (run-with-store (open-connection)
9263 (mlet %store-monad ((a (interned-file "README"))
9264 (b (interned-file "README" "LEGU-MIN")))
9265 (return (list a b))))
9266
9267 @result{} ("/gnu/store/rwm@dots{}-README" "/gnu/store/44i@dots{}-LEGU-MIN")
9268 @end lisp
9269
9270 @end deffn
9271
9272 The @code{(guix packages)} module exports the following package-related
9273 monadic procedures:
9274
9275 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} package-file @var{package} [@var{file}] @
9276 [#:system (%current-system)] [#:target #f] @
9277 [#:output "out"]
9278 Return as a monadic
9279 value in the absolute file name of @var{file} within the @var{output}
9280 directory of @var{package}. When @var{file} is omitted, return the name
9281 of the @var{output} directory of @var{package}. When @var{target} is
9282 true, use it as a cross-compilation target triplet.
9283
9284 Note that this procedure does @emph{not} build @var{package}. Thus, the
9285 result might or might not designate an existing file. We recommend not
9286 using this procedure unless you know what you are doing.
9287 @end deffn
9288
9289 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} package->derivation @var{package} [@var{system}]
9290 @deffnx {Monadic Procedure} package->cross-derivation @var{package} @
9291 @var{target} [@var{system}]
9292 Monadic version of @code{package-derivation} and
9293 @code{package-cross-derivation} (@pxref{Defining Packages}).
9294 @end deffn
9295
9296
9297 @node G-Expressions
9298 @section G-Expressions
9299
9300 @cindex G-expression
9301 @cindex build code quoting
9302 So we have ``derivations'', which represent a sequence of build actions
9303 to be performed to produce an item in the store (@pxref{Derivations}).
9304 These build actions are performed when asking the daemon to actually
9305 build the derivations; they are run by the daemon in a container
9306 (@pxref{Invoking guix-daemon}).
9307
9308 @cindex code staging
9309 @cindex staging, of code
9310 @cindex strata of code
9311 It should come as no surprise that we like to write these build actions
9312 in Scheme. When we do that, we end up with two @dfn{strata} of Scheme
9313 code@footnote{The term @dfn{stratum} in this context was coined by
9314 Manuel Serrano et al.@: in the context of their work on Hop. Oleg
9315 Kiselyov, who has written insightful
9316 @url{http://okmij.org/ftp/meta-programming/#meta-scheme, essays and code
9317 on this topic}, refers to this kind of code generation as
9318 @dfn{staging}.}: the ``host code''---code that defines packages, talks
9319 to the daemon, etc.---and the ``build code''---code that actually
9320 performs build actions, such as making directories, invoking
9321 @command{make}, and so on (@pxref{Build Phases}).
9322
9323 To describe a derivation and its build actions, one typically needs to
9324 embed build code inside host code. It boils down to manipulating build
9325 code as data, and the homoiconicity of Scheme---code has a direct
9326 representation as data---comes in handy for that. But we need more than
9327 the normal @code{quasiquote} mechanism in Scheme to construct build
9328 expressions.
9329
9330 The @code{(guix gexp)} module implements @dfn{G-expressions}, a form of
9331 S-expressions adapted to build expressions. G-expressions, or
9332 @dfn{gexps}, consist essentially of three syntactic forms: @code{gexp},
9333 @code{ungexp}, and @code{ungexp-splicing} (or simply: @code{#~},
9334 @code{#$}, and @code{#$@@}), which are comparable to
9335 @code{quasiquote}, @code{unquote}, and @code{unquote-splicing},
9336 respectively (@pxref{Expression Syntax, @code{quasiquote},, guile,
9337 GNU Guile Reference Manual}). However, there are major differences:
9338
9339 @itemize
9340 @item
9341 Gexps are meant to be written to a file and run or manipulated by other
9342 processes.
9343
9344 @item
9345 When a high-level object such as a package or derivation is unquoted
9346 inside a gexp, the result is as if its output file name had been
9347 introduced.
9348
9349 @item
9350 Gexps carry information about the packages or derivations they refer to,
9351 and these dependencies are automatically added as inputs to the build
9352 processes that use them.
9353 @end itemize
9354
9355 @cindex lowering, of high-level objects in gexps
9356 This mechanism is not limited to package and derivation
9357 objects: @dfn{compilers} able to ``lower'' other high-level objects to
9358 derivations or files in the store can be defined,
9359 such that these objects can also be inserted
9360 into gexps. For example, a useful type of high-level objects that can be
9361 inserted in a gexp is ``file-like objects'', which make it easy to
9362 add files to the store and to refer to them in
9363 derivations and such (see @code{local-file} and @code{plain-file}
9364 below).
9365
9366 To illustrate the idea, here is an example of a gexp:
9367
9368 @lisp
9369 (define build-exp
9370 #~(begin
9371 (mkdir #$output)
9372 (chdir #$output)
9373 (symlink (string-append #$coreutils "/bin/ls")
9374 "list-files")))
9375 @end lisp
9376
9377 This gexp can be passed to @code{gexp->derivation}; we obtain a
9378 derivation that builds a directory containing exactly one symlink to
9379 @file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-coreutils-8.22/bin/ls}:
9380
9381 @lisp
9382 (gexp->derivation "the-thing" build-exp)
9383 @end lisp
9384
9385 As one would expect, the @code{"/gnu/store/@dots{}-coreutils-8.22"} string is
9386 substituted to the reference to the @var{coreutils} package in the
9387 actual build code, and @var{coreutils} is automatically made an input to
9388 the derivation. Likewise, @code{#$output} (equivalent to @code{(ungexp
9389 output)}) is replaced by a string containing the directory name of the
9390 output of the derivation.
9391
9392 @cindex cross compilation
9393 In a cross-compilation context, it is useful to distinguish between
9394 references to the @emph{native} build of a package---that can run on the
9395 host---versus references to cross builds of a package. To that end, the
9396 @code{#+} plays the same role as @code{#$}, but is a reference to a
9397 native package build:
9398
9399 @lisp
9400 (gexp->derivation "vi"
9401 #~(begin
9402 (mkdir #$output)
9403 (mkdir (string-append #$output "/bin"))
9404 (system* (string-append #+coreutils "/bin/ln")
9405 "-s"
9406 (string-append #$emacs "/bin/emacs")
9407 (string-append #$output "/bin/vi")))
9408 #:target "aarch64-linux-gnu")
9409 @end lisp
9410
9411 @noindent
9412 In the example above, the native build of @var{coreutils} is used, so
9413 that @command{ln} can actually run on the host; but then the
9414 cross-compiled build of @var{emacs} is referenced.
9415
9416 @cindex imported modules, for gexps
9417 @findex with-imported-modules
9418 Another gexp feature is @dfn{imported modules}: sometimes you want to be
9419 able to use certain Guile modules from the ``host environment'' in the
9420 gexp, so those modules should be imported in the ``build environment''.
9421 The @code{with-imported-modules} form allows you to express that:
9422
9423 @lisp
9424 (let ((build (with-imported-modules '((guix build utils))
9425 #~(begin
9426 (use-modules (guix build utils))
9427 (mkdir-p (string-append #$output "/bin"))))))
9428 (gexp->derivation "empty-dir"
9429 #~(begin
9430 #$build
9431 (display "success!\n")
9432 #t)))
9433 @end lisp
9434
9435 @noindent
9436 In this example, the @code{(guix build utils)} module is automatically
9437 pulled into the isolated build environment of our gexp, such that
9438 @code{(use-modules (guix build utils))} works as expected.
9439
9440 @cindex module closure
9441 @findex source-module-closure
9442 Usually you want the @emph{closure} of the module to be imported---i.e.,
9443 the module itself and all the modules it depends on---rather than just
9444 the module; failing to do that, attempts to use the module will fail
9445 because of missing dependent modules. The @code{source-module-closure}
9446 procedure computes the closure of a module by looking at its source file
9447 headers, which comes in handy in this case:
9448
9449 @lisp
9450 (use-modules (guix modules)) ;for 'source-module-closure'
9451
9452 (with-imported-modules (source-module-closure
9453 '((guix build utils)
9454 (gnu build vm)))
9455 (gexp->derivation "something-with-vms"
9456 #~(begin
9457 (use-modules (guix build utils)
9458 (gnu build vm))
9459 @dots{})))
9460 @end lisp
9461
9462 @cindex extensions, for gexps
9463 @findex with-extensions
9464 In the same vein, sometimes you want to import not just pure-Scheme
9465 modules, but also ``extensions'' such as Guile bindings to C libraries
9466 or other ``full-blown'' packages. Say you need the @code{guile-json}
9467 package available on the build side, here's how you would do it:
9468
9469 @lisp
9470 (use-modules (gnu packages guile)) ;for 'guile-json'
9471
9472 (with-extensions (list guile-json)
9473 (gexp->derivation "something-with-json"
9474 #~(begin
9475 (use-modules (json))
9476 @dots{})))
9477 @end lisp
9478
9479 The syntactic form to construct gexps is summarized below.
9480
9481 @deffn {Scheme Syntax} #~@var{exp}
9482 @deffnx {Scheme Syntax} (gexp @var{exp})
9483 Return a G-expression containing @var{exp}. @var{exp} may contain one
9484 or more of the following forms:
9485
9486 @table @code
9487 @item #$@var{obj}
9488 @itemx (ungexp @var{obj})
9489 Introduce a reference to @var{obj}. @var{obj} may have one of the
9490 supported types, for example a package or a
9491 derivation, in which case the @code{ungexp} form is replaced by its
9492 output file name---e.g., @code{"/gnu/store/@dots{}-coreutils-8.22}.
9493
9494 If @var{obj} is a list, it is traversed and references to supported
9495 objects are substituted similarly.
9496
9497 If @var{obj} is another gexp, its contents are inserted and its
9498 dependencies are added to those of the containing gexp.
9499
9500 If @var{obj} is another kind of object, it is inserted as is.
9501
9502 @item #$@var{obj}:@var{output}
9503 @itemx (ungexp @var{obj} @var{output})
9504 This is like the form above, but referring explicitly to the
9505 @var{output} of @var{obj}---this is useful when @var{obj} produces
9506 multiple outputs (@pxref{Packages with Multiple Outputs}).
9507
9508 @item #+@var{obj}
9509 @itemx #+@var{obj}:output
9510 @itemx (ungexp-native @var{obj})
9511 @itemx (ungexp-native @var{obj} @var{output})
9512 Same as @code{ungexp}, but produces a reference to the @emph{native}
9513 build of @var{obj} when used in a cross compilation context.
9514
9515 @item #$output[:@var{output}]
9516 @itemx (ungexp output [@var{output}])
9517 Insert a reference to derivation output @var{output}, or to the main
9518 output when @var{output} is omitted.
9519
9520 This only makes sense for gexps passed to @code{gexp->derivation}.
9521
9522 @item #$@@@var{lst}
9523 @itemx (ungexp-splicing @var{lst})
9524 Like the above, but splices the contents of @var{lst} inside the
9525 containing list.
9526
9527 @item #+@@@var{lst}
9528 @itemx (ungexp-native-splicing @var{lst})
9529 Like the above, but refers to native builds of the objects listed in
9530 @var{lst}.
9531
9532 @end table
9533
9534 G-expressions created by @code{gexp} or @code{#~} are run-time objects
9535 of the @code{gexp?} type (see below).
9536 @end deffn
9537
9538 @deffn {Scheme Syntax} with-imported-modules @var{modules} @var{body}@dots{}
9539 Mark the gexps defined in @var{body}@dots{} as requiring @var{modules}
9540 in their execution environment.
9541
9542 Each item in @var{modules} can be the name of a module, such as
9543 @code{(guix build utils)}, or it can be a module name, followed by an
9544 arrow, followed by a file-like object:
9545
9546 @lisp
9547 `((guix build utils)
9548 (guix gcrypt)
9549 ((guix config) => ,(scheme-file "config.scm"
9550 #~(define-module @dots{}))))
9551 @end lisp
9552
9553 @noindent
9554 In the example above, the first two modules are taken from the search
9555 path, and the last one is created from the given file-like object.
9556
9557 This form has @emph{lexical} scope: it has an effect on the gexps
9558 directly defined in @var{body}@dots{}, but not on those defined, say, in
9559 procedures called from @var{body}@dots{}.
9560 @end deffn
9561
9562 @deffn {Scheme Syntax} with-extensions @var{extensions} @var{body}@dots{}
9563 Mark the gexps defined in @var{body}@dots{} as requiring
9564 @var{extensions} in their build and execution environment.
9565 @var{extensions} is typically a list of package objects such as those
9566 defined in the @code{(gnu packages guile)} module.
9567
9568 Concretely, the packages listed in @var{extensions} are added to the
9569 load path while compiling imported modules in @var{body}@dots{}; they
9570 are also added to the load path of the gexp returned by
9571 @var{body}@dots{}.
9572 @end deffn
9573
9574 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} gexp? @var{obj}
9575 Return @code{#t} if @var{obj} is a G-expression.
9576 @end deffn
9577
9578 G-expressions are meant to be written to disk, either as code building
9579 some derivation, or as plain files in the store. The monadic procedures
9580 below allow you to do that (@pxref{The Store Monad}, for more
9581 information about monads).
9582
9583 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} gexp->derivation @var{name} @var{exp} @
9584 [#:system (%current-system)] [#:target #f] [#:graft? #t] @
9585 [#:hash #f] [#:hash-algo #f] @
9586 [#:recursive? #f] [#:env-vars '()] [#:modules '()] @
9587 [#:module-path @code{%load-path}] @
9588 [#:effective-version "2.2"] @
9589 [#:references-graphs #f] [#:allowed-references #f] @
9590 [#:disallowed-references #f] @
9591 [#:leaked-env-vars #f] @
9592 [#:script-name (string-append @var{name} "-builder")] @
9593 [#:deprecation-warnings #f] @
9594 [#:local-build? #f] [#:substitutable? #t] @
9595 [#:properties '()] [#:guile-for-build #f]
9596 Return a derivation @var{name} that runs @var{exp} (a gexp) with
9597 @var{guile-for-build} (a derivation) on @var{system}; @var{exp} is
9598 stored in a file called @var{script-name}. When @var{target} is true,
9599 it is used as the cross-compilation target triplet for packages referred
9600 to by @var{exp}.
9601
9602 @var{modules} is deprecated in favor of @code{with-imported-modules}.
9603 Its meaning is to
9604 make @var{modules} available in the evaluation context of @var{exp};
9605 @var{modules} is a list of names of Guile modules searched in
9606 @var{module-path} to be copied in the store, compiled, and made available in
9607 the load path during the execution of @var{exp}---e.g., @code{((guix
9608 build utils) (guix build gnu-build-system))}.
9609
9610 @var{effective-version} determines the string to use when adding extensions of
9611 @var{exp} (see @code{with-extensions}) to the search path---e.g., @code{"2.2"}.
9612
9613 @var{graft?} determines whether packages referred to by @var{exp} should be grafted when
9614 applicable.
9615
9616 When @var{references-graphs} is true, it must be a list of tuples of one of the
9617 following forms:
9618
9619 @example
9620 (@var{file-name} @var{package})
9621 (@var{file-name} @var{package} @var{output})
9622 (@var{file-name} @var{derivation})
9623 (@var{file-name} @var{derivation} @var{output})
9624 (@var{file-name} @var{store-item})
9625 @end example
9626
9627 The right-hand-side of each element of @var{references-graphs} is automatically made
9628 an input of the build process of @var{exp}. In the build environment, each
9629 @var{file-name} contains the reference graph of the corresponding item, in a simple
9630 text format.
9631
9632 @var{allowed-references} must be either @code{#f} or a list of output names and packages.
9633 In the latter case, the list denotes store items that the result is allowed to
9634 refer to. Any reference to another store item will lead to a build error.
9635 Similarly for @var{disallowed-references}, which can list items that must not be
9636 referenced by the outputs.
9637
9638 @var{deprecation-warnings} determines whether to show deprecation warnings while
9639 compiling modules. It can be @code{#f}, @code{#t}, or @code{'detailed}.
9640
9641 The other arguments are as for @code{derivation} (@pxref{Derivations}).
9642 @end deffn
9643
9644 @cindex file-like objects
9645 The @code{local-file}, @code{plain-file}, @code{computed-file},
9646 @code{program-file}, and @code{scheme-file} procedures below return
9647 @dfn{file-like objects}. That is, when unquoted in a G-expression,
9648 these objects lead to a file in the store. Consider this G-expression:
9649
9650 @lisp
9651 #~(system* #$(file-append glibc "/sbin/nscd") "-f"
9652 #$(local-file "/tmp/my-nscd.conf"))
9653 @end lisp
9654
9655 The effect here is to ``intern'' @file{/tmp/my-nscd.conf} by copying it
9656 to the store. Once expanded, for instance @i{via}
9657 @code{gexp->derivation}, the G-expression refers to that copy under
9658 @file{/gnu/store}; thus, modifying or removing the file in @file{/tmp}
9659 does not have any effect on what the G-expression does.
9660 @code{plain-file} can be used similarly; it differs in that the file
9661 content is directly passed as a string.
9662
9663 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} local-file @var{file} [@var{name}] @
9664 [#:recursive? #f] [#:select? (const #t)]
9665 Return an object representing local file @var{file} to add to the store;
9666 this object can be used in a gexp. If @var{file} is a literal string
9667 denoting a relative file name, it is looked up relative to the source
9668 file where it appears; if @var{file} is not a literal string, it is
9669 looked up relative to the current working directory at run time.
9670 @var{file} will be added to the store under @var{name}--by default the
9671 base name of @var{file}.
9672
9673 When @var{recursive?} is true, the contents of @var{file} are added recursively; if @var{file}
9674 designates a flat file and @var{recursive?} is true, its contents are added, and its
9675 permission bits are kept.
9676
9677 When @var{recursive?} is true, call @code{(@var{select?} @var{file}
9678 @var{stat})} for each directory entry, where @var{file} is the entry's
9679 absolute file name and @var{stat} is the result of @code{lstat}; exclude
9680 entries for which @var{select?} does not return true.
9681
9682 This is the declarative counterpart of the @code{interned-file} monadic
9683 procedure (@pxref{The Store Monad, @code{interned-file}}).
9684 @end deffn
9685
9686 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} plain-file @var{name} @var{content}
9687 Return an object representing a text file called @var{name} with the given
9688 @var{content} (a string or a bytevector) to be added to the store.
9689
9690 This is the declarative counterpart of @code{text-file}.
9691 @end deffn
9692
9693 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} computed-file @var{name} @var{gexp} @
9694 [#:local-build? #t]
9695 [#:options '()]
9696 Return an object representing the store item @var{name}, a file or
9697 directory computed by @var{gexp}. When @var{local-build?} is true (the
9698 default), the derivation is built locally. @var{options} is a list of
9699 additional arguments to pass to @code{gexp->derivation}.
9700
9701 This is the declarative counterpart of @code{gexp->derivation}.
9702 @end deffn
9703
9704 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} gexp->script @var{name} @var{exp} @
9705 [#:guile (default-guile)] [#:module-path %load-path] @
9706 [#:system (%current-system)] [#:target #f]
9707 Return an executable script @var{name} that runs @var{exp} using
9708 @var{guile}, with @var{exp}'s imported modules in its search path.
9709 Look up @var{exp}'s modules in @var{module-path}.
9710
9711 The example below builds a script that simply invokes the @command{ls}
9712 command:
9713
9714 @lisp
9715 (use-modules (guix gexp) (gnu packages base))
9716
9717 (gexp->script "list-files"
9718 #~(execl #$(file-append coreutils "/bin/ls")
9719 "ls"))
9720 @end lisp
9721
9722 When ``running'' it through the store (@pxref{The Store Monad,
9723 @code{run-with-store}}), we obtain a derivation that produces an
9724 executable file @file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-list-files} along these lines:
9725
9726 @example
9727 #!/gnu/store/@dots{}-guile-2.0.11/bin/guile -ds
9728 !#
9729 (execl "/gnu/store/@dots{}-coreutils-8.22"/bin/ls" "ls")
9730 @end example
9731 @end deffn
9732
9733 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} program-file @var{name} @var{exp} @
9734 [#:guile #f] [#:module-path %load-path]
9735 Return an object representing the executable store item @var{name} that
9736 runs @var{gexp}. @var{guile} is the Guile package used to execute that
9737 script. Imported modules of @var{gexp} are looked up in @var{module-path}.
9738
9739 This is the declarative counterpart of @code{gexp->script}.
9740 @end deffn
9741
9742 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} gexp->file @var{name} @var{exp} @
9743 [#:set-load-path? #t] [#:module-path %load-path] @
9744 [#:splice? #f] @
9745 [#:guile (default-guile)]
9746 Return a derivation that builds a file @var{name} containing @var{exp}.
9747 When @var{splice?} is true, @var{exp} is considered to be a list of
9748 expressions that will be spliced in the resulting file.
9749
9750 When @var{set-load-path?} is true, emit code in the resulting file to
9751 set @code{%load-path} and @code{%load-compiled-path} to honor
9752 @var{exp}'s imported modules. Look up @var{exp}'s modules in
9753 @var{module-path}.
9754
9755 The resulting file holds references to all the dependencies of @var{exp}
9756 or a subset thereof.
9757 @end deffn
9758
9759 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} scheme-file @var{name} @var{exp} @
9760 [#:splice? #f] [#:set-load-path? #t]
9761 Return an object representing the Scheme file @var{name} that contains
9762 @var{exp}.
9763
9764 This is the declarative counterpart of @code{gexp->file}.
9765 @end deffn
9766
9767 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} text-file* @var{name} @var{text} @dots{}
9768 Return as a monadic value a derivation that builds a text file
9769 containing all of @var{text}. @var{text} may list, in addition to
9770 strings, objects of any type that can be used in a gexp: packages,
9771 derivations, local file objects, etc. The resulting store file holds
9772 references to all these.
9773
9774 This variant should be preferred over @code{text-file} anytime the file
9775 to create will reference items from the store. This is typically the
9776 case when building a configuration file that embeds store file names,
9777 like this:
9778
9779 @lisp
9780 (define (profile.sh)
9781 ;; Return the name of a shell script in the store that
9782 ;; initializes the 'PATH' environment variable.
9783 (text-file* "profile.sh"
9784 "export PATH=" coreutils "/bin:"
9785 grep "/bin:" sed "/bin\n"))
9786 @end lisp
9787
9788 In this example, the resulting @file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-profile.sh} file
9789 will reference @var{coreutils}, @var{grep}, and @var{sed}, thereby
9790 preventing them from being garbage-collected during its lifetime.
9791 @end deffn
9792
9793 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} mixed-text-file @var{name} @var{text} @dots{}
9794 Return an object representing store file @var{name} containing
9795 @var{text}. @var{text} is a sequence of strings and file-like objects,
9796 as in:
9797
9798 @lisp
9799 (mixed-text-file "profile"
9800 "export PATH=" coreutils "/bin:" grep "/bin")
9801 @end lisp
9802
9803 This is the declarative counterpart of @code{text-file*}.
9804 @end deffn
9805
9806 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} file-union @var{name} @var{files}
9807 Return a @code{<computed-file>} that builds a directory containing all of @var{files}.
9808 Each item in @var{files} must be a two-element list where the first element is the
9809 file name to use in the new directory, and the second element is a gexp
9810 denoting the target file. Here's an example:
9811
9812 @lisp
9813 (file-union "etc"
9814 `(("hosts" ,(plain-file "hosts"
9815 "127.0.0.1 localhost"))
9816 ("bashrc" ,(plain-file "bashrc"
9817 "alias ls='ls --color=auto'"))))
9818 @end lisp
9819
9820 This yields an @code{etc} directory containing these two files.
9821 @end deffn
9822
9823 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} directory-union @var{name} @var{things}
9824 Return a directory that is the union of @var{things}, where @var{things} is a list of
9825 file-like objects denoting directories. For example:
9826
9827 @lisp
9828 (directory-union "guile+emacs" (list guile emacs))
9829 @end lisp
9830
9831 yields a directory that is the union of the @code{guile} and @code{emacs} packages.
9832 @end deffn
9833
9834 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} file-append @var{obj} @var{suffix} @dots{}
9835 Return a file-like object that expands to the concatenation of @var{obj}
9836 and @var{suffix}, where @var{obj} is a lowerable object and each
9837 @var{suffix} is a string.
9838
9839 As an example, consider this gexp:
9840
9841 @lisp
9842 (gexp->script "run-uname"
9843 #~(system* #$(file-append coreutils
9844 "/bin/uname")))
9845 @end lisp
9846
9847 The same effect could be achieved with:
9848
9849 @lisp
9850 (gexp->script "run-uname"
9851 #~(system* (string-append #$coreutils
9852 "/bin/uname")))
9853 @end lisp
9854
9855 There is one difference though: in the @code{file-append} case, the
9856 resulting script contains the absolute file name as a string, whereas in
9857 the second case, the resulting script contains a @code{(string-append
9858 @dots{})} expression to construct the file name @emph{at run time}.
9859 @end deffn
9860
9861 @deffn {Scheme Syntax} let-system @var{system} @var{body}@dots{}
9862 @deffnx {Scheme Syntax} let-system (@var{system} @var{target}) @var{body}@dots{}
9863 Bind @var{system} to the currently targeted system---e.g.,
9864 @code{"x86_64-linux"}---within @var{body}.
9865
9866 In the second case, additionally bind @var{target} to the current
9867 cross-compilation target---a GNU triplet such as
9868 @code{"arm-linux-gnueabihf"}---or @code{#f} if we are not
9869 cross-compiling.
9870
9871 @code{let-system} is useful in the occasional case where the object
9872 spliced into the gexp depends on the target system, as in this example:
9873
9874 @lisp
9875 #~(system*
9876 #+(let-system system
9877 (cond ((string-prefix? "armhf-" system)
9878 (file-append qemu "/bin/qemu-system-arm"))
9879 ((string-prefix? "x86_64-" system)
9880 (file-append qemu "/bin/qemu-system-x86_64"))
9881 (else
9882 (error "dunno!"))))
9883 "-net" "user" #$image)
9884 @end lisp
9885 @end deffn
9886
9887 @deffn {Scheme Syntax} with-parameters ((@var{parameter} @var{value}) @dots{}) @var{exp}
9888 This macro is similar to the @code{parameterize} form for
9889 dynamically-bound @dfn{parameters} (@pxref{Parameters,,, guile, GNU
9890 Guile Reference Manual}). The key difference is that it takes effect
9891 when the file-like object returned by @var{exp} is lowered to a
9892 derivation or store item.
9893
9894 A typical use of @code{with-parameters} is to force the system in effect
9895 for a given object:
9896
9897 @lisp
9898 (with-parameters ((%current-system "i686-linux"))
9899 coreutils)
9900 @end lisp
9901
9902 The example above returns an object that corresponds to the i686 build
9903 of Coreutils, regardless of the current value of @code{%current-system}.
9904 @end deffn
9905
9906
9907 Of course, in addition to gexps embedded in ``host'' code, there are
9908 also modules containing build tools. To make it clear that they are
9909 meant to be used in the build stratum, these modules are kept in the
9910 @code{(guix build @dots{})} name space.
9911
9912 @cindex lowering, of high-level objects in gexps
9913 Internally, high-level objects are @dfn{lowered}, using their compiler,
9914 to either derivations or store items. For instance, lowering a package
9915 yields a derivation, and lowering a @code{plain-file} yields a store
9916 item. This is achieved using the @code{lower-object} monadic procedure.
9917
9918 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} lower-object @var{obj} [@var{system}] @
9919 [#:target #f]
9920 Return as a value in @code{%store-monad} the derivation or store item
9921 corresponding to @var{obj} for @var{system}, cross-compiling for
9922 @var{target} if @var{target} is true. @var{obj} must be an object that
9923 has an associated gexp compiler, such as a @code{<package>}.
9924 @end deffn
9925
9926 @node Invoking guix repl
9927 @section Invoking @command{guix repl}
9928
9929 @cindex REPL, read-eval-print loop, script
9930 The @command{guix repl} command makes it easier to program Guix in Guile
9931 by launching a Guile @dfn{read-eval-print loop} (REPL) for interactive
9932 programming (@pxref{Using Guile Interactively,,, guile,
9933 GNU Guile Reference Manual}), or by running Guile scripts
9934 (@pxref{Running Guile Scripts,,, guile,
9935 GNU Guile Reference Manual}).
9936 Compared to just launching the @command{guile}
9937 command, @command{guix repl} guarantees that all the Guix modules and all its
9938 dependencies are available in the search path.
9939
9940 The general syntax is:
9941
9942 @example
9943 guix repl @var{options} [@var{file} @var{args}]
9944 @end example
9945
9946 When a @var{file} argument is provided, @var{file} is
9947 executed as a Guile scripts:
9948
9949 @example
9950 guix repl my-script.scm
9951 @end example
9952
9953 To pass arguments to the script, use @code{--} to prevent them from
9954 being interpreted as arguments to @command{guix repl} itself:
9955
9956 @example
9957 guix repl -- my-script.scm --input=foo.txt
9958 @end example
9959
9960 To make a script executable directly from the shell, using the guix
9961 executable that is on the user's search path, add the following two
9962 lines at the top of the script:
9963
9964 @example
9965 @code{#!/usr/bin/env -S guix repl --}
9966 @code{!#}
9967 @end example
9968
9969 Without a file name argument, a Guile REPL is started:
9970
9971 @example
9972 $ guix repl
9973 scheme@@(guile-user)> ,use (gnu packages base)
9974 scheme@@(guile-user)> coreutils
9975 $1 = #<package coreutils@@8.29 gnu/packages/base.scm:327 3e28300>
9976 @end example
9977
9978 @cindex inferiors
9979 In addition, @command{guix repl} implements a simple machine-readable REPL
9980 protocol for use by @code{(guix inferior)}, a facility to interact with
9981 @dfn{inferiors}, separate processes running a potentially different revision
9982 of Guix.
9983
9984 The available options are as follows:
9985
9986 @table @code
9987 @item --type=@var{type}
9988 @itemx -t @var{type}
9989 Start a REPL of the given @var{TYPE}, which can be one of the following:
9990
9991 @table @code
9992 @item guile
9993 This is default, and it spawns a standard full-featured Guile REPL.
9994 @item machine
9995 Spawn a REPL that uses the machine-readable protocol. This is the protocol
9996 that the @code{(guix inferior)} module speaks.
9997 @end table
9998
9999 @item --listen=@var{endpoint}
10000 By default, @command{guix repl} reads from standard input and writes to
10001 standard output. When this option is passed, it will instead listen for
10002 connections on @var{endpoint}. Here are examples of valid options:
10003
10004 @table @code
10005 @item --listen=tcp:37146
10006 Accept connections on localhost on port 37146.
10007
10008 @item --listen=unix:/tmp/socket
10009 Accept connections on the Unix-domain socket @file{/tmp/socket}.
10010 @end table
10011
10012 @item --load-path=@var{directory}
10013 @itemx -L @var{directory}
10014 Add @var{directory} to the front of the package module search path
10015 (@pxref{Package Modules}).
10016
10017 This allows users to define their own packages and make them visible to
10018 the script or REPL.
10019
10020 @item -q
10021 Inhibit loading of the @file{~/.guile} file. By default, that
10022 configuration file is loaded when spawning a @code{guile} REPL.
10023 @end table
10024
10025 @c *********************************************************************
10026 @node Utilities
10027 @chapter Utilities
10028
10029 This section describes Guix command-line utilities. Some of them are
10030 primarily targeted at developers and users who write new package
10031 definitions, while others are more generally useful. They complement
10032 the Scheme programming interface of Guix in a convenient way.
10033
10034 @menu
10035 * Invoking guix build:: Building packages from the command line.
10036 * Invoking guix edit:: Editing package definitions.
10037 * Invoking guix download:: Downloading a file and printing its hash.
10038 * Invoking guix hash:: Computing the cryptographic hash of a file.
10039 * Invoking guix import:: Importing package definitions.
10040 * Invoking guix refresh:: Updating package definitions.
10041 * Invoking guix lint:: Finding errors in package definitions.
10042 * Invoking guix size:: Profiling disk usage.
10043 * Invoking guix graph:: Visualizing the graph of packages.
10044 * Invoking guix publish:: Sharing substitutes.
10045 * Invoking guix challenge:: Challenging substitute servers.
10046 * Invoking guix copy:: Copying to and from a remote store.
10047 * Invoking guix container:: Process isolation.
10048 * Invoking guix weather:: Assessing substitute availability.
10049 * Invoking guix processes:: Listing client processes.
10050 @end menu
10051
10052 @node Invoking guix build
10053 @section Invoking @command{guix build}
10054
10055 @cindex package building
10056 @cindex @command{guix build}
10057 The @command{guix build} command builds packages or derivations and
10058 their dependencies, and prints the resulting store paths. Note that it
10059 does not modify the user's profile---this is the job of the
10060 @command{guix package} command (@pxref{Invoking guix package}). Thus,
10061 it is mainly useful for distribution developers.
10062
10063 The general syntax is:
10064
10065 @example
10066 guix build @var{options} @var{package-or-derivation}@dots{}
10067 @end example
10068
10069 As an example, the following command builds the latest versions of Emacs
10070 and of Guile, displays their build logs, and finally displays the
10071 resulting directories:
10072
10073 @example
10074 guix build emacs guile
10075 @end example
10076
10077 Similarly, the following command builds all the available packages:
10078
10079 @example
10080 guix build --quiet --keep-going \
10081 `guix package -A | cut -f1,2 --output-delimiter=@@`
10082 @end example
10083
10084 @var{package-or-derivation} may be either the name of a package found in
10085 the software distribution such as @code{coreutils} or
10086 @code{coreutils@@8.20}, or a derivation such as
10087 @file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-coreutils-8.19.drv}. In the former case, a
10088 package with the corresponding name (and optionally version) is searched
10089 for among the GNU distribution modules (@pxref{Package Modules}).
10090
10091 Alternatively, the @option{--expression} option may be used to specify a
10092 Scheme expression that evaluates to a package; this is useful when
10093 disambiguating among several same-named packages or package variants is
10094 needed.
10095
10096 There may be zero or more @var{options}. The available options are
10097 described in the subsections below.
10098
10099 @menu
10100 * Common Build Options:: Build options for most commands.
10101 * Package Transformation Options:: Creating variants of packages.
10102 * Additional Build Options:: Options specific to 'guix build'.
10103 * Debugging Build Failures:: Real life packaging experience.
10104 @end menu
10105
10106 @node Common Build Options
10107 @subsection Common Build Options
10108
10109 A number of options that control the build process are common to
10110 @command{guix build} and other commands that can spawn builds, such as
10111 @command{guix package} or @command{guix archive}. These are the
10112 following:
10113
10114 @table @code
10115
10116 @item --load-path=@var{directory}
10117 @itemx -L @var{directory}
10118 Add @var{directory} to the front of the package module search path
10119 (@pxref{Package Modules}).
10120
10121 This allows users to define their own packages and make them visible to
10122 the command-line tools.
10123
10124 @item --keep-failed
10125 @itemx -K
10126 Keep the build tree of failed builds. Thus, if a build fails, its build
10127 tree is kept under @file{/tmp}, in a directory whose name is shown at
10128 the end of the build log. This is useful when debugging build issues.
10129 @xref{Debugging Build Failures}, for tips and tricks on how to debug
10130 build issues.
10131
10132 This option implies @option{--no-offload}, and it has no effect when
10133 connecting to a remote daemon with a @code{guix://} URI (@pxref{The
10134 Store, the @env{GUIX_DAEMON_SOCKET} variable}).
10135
10136 @item --keep-going
10137 @itemx -k
10138 Keep going when some of the derivations fail to build; return only once
10139 all the builds have either completed or failed.
10140
10141 The default behavior is to stop as soon as one of the specified
10142 derivations has failed.
10143
10144 @item --dry-run
10145 @itemx -n
10146 Do not build the derivations.
10147
10148 @anchor{fallback-option}
10149 @item --fallback
10150 When substituting a pre-built binary fails, fall back to building
10151 packages locally (@pxref{Substitution Failure}).
10152
10153 @item --substitute-urls=@var{urls}
10154 @anchor{client-substitute-urls}
10155 Consider @var{urls} the whitespace-separated list of substitute source
10156 URLs, overriding the default list of URLs of @command{guix-daemon}
10157 (@pxref{daemon-substitute-urls,, @command{guix-daemon} URLs}).
10158
10159 This means that substitutes may be downloaded from @var{urls}, provided
10160 they are signed by a key authorized by the system administrator
10161 (@pxref{Substitutes}).
10162
10163 When @var{urls} is the empty string, substitutes are effectively
10164 disabled.
10165
10166 @item --no-substitutes
10167 Do not use substitutes for build products. That is, always build things
10168 locally instead of allowing downloads of pre-built binaries
10169 (@pxref{Substitutes}).
10170
10171 @item --no-grafts
10172 Do not ``graft'' packages. In practice, this means that package updates
10173 available as grafts are not applied. @xref{Security Updates}, for more
10174 information on grafts.
10175
10176 @item --rounds=@var{n}
10177 Build each derivation @var{n} times in a row, and raise an error if
10178 consecutive build results are not bit-for-bit identical.
10179
10180 This is a useful way to detect non-deterministic builds processes.
10181 Non-deterministic build processes are a problem because they make it
10182 practically impossible for users to @emph{verify} whether third-party
10183 binaries are genuine. @xref{Invoking guix challenge}, for more.
10184
10185 When used in conjunction with @option{--keep-failed}, the differing
10186 output is kept in the store, under @file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-check}.
10187 This makes it easy to look for differences between the two results.
10188
10189 @item --no-offload
10190 Do not use offload builds to other machines (@pxref{Daemon Offload
10191 Setup}). That is, always build things locally instead of offloading
10192 builds to remote machines.
10193
10194 @item --max-silent-time=@var{seconds}
10195 When the build or substitution process remains silent for more than
10196 @var{seconds}, terminate it and report a build failure.
10197
10198 By default, the daemon's setting is honored (@pxref{Invoking
10199 guix-daemon, @option{--max-silent-time}}).
10200
10201 @item --timeout=@var{seconds}
10202 Likewise, when the build or substitution process lasts for more than
10203 @var{seconds}, terminate it and report a build failure.
10204
10205 By default, the daemon's setting is honored (@pxref{Invoking
10206 guix-daemon, @option{--timeout}}).
10207
10208 @c Note: This option is actually not part of %standard-build-options but
10209 @c most programs honor it.
10210 @cindex verbosity, of the command-line tools
10211 @cindex build logs, verbosity
10212 @item -v @var{level}
10213 @itemx --verbosity=@var{level}
10214 Use the given verbosity @var{level}, an integer. Choosing 0 means that no
10215 output is produced, 1 is for quiet output, and 2 shows all the build log
10216 output on standard error.
10217
10218 @item --cores=@var{n}
10219 @itemx -c @var{n}
10220 Allow the use of up to @var{n} CPU cores for the build. The special
10221 value @code{0} means to use as many CPU cores as available.
10222
10223 @item --max-jobs=@var{n}
10224 @itemx -M @var{n}
10225 Allow at most @var{n} build jobs in parallel. @xref{Invoking
10226 guix-daemon, @option{--max-jobs}}, for details about this option and the
10227 equivalent @command{guix-daemon} option.
10228
10229 @item --debug=@var{level}
10230 Produce debugging output coming from the build daemon. @var{level} must be an
10231 integer between 0 and 5; higher means more verbose output. Setting a level of
10232 4 or more may be helpful when debugging setup issues with the build daemon.
10233
10234 @end table
10235
10236 Behind the scenes, @command{guix build} is essentially an interface to
10237 the @code{package-derivation} procedure of the @code{(guix packages)}
10238 module, and to the @code{build-derivations} procedure of the @code{(guix
10239 derivations)} module.
10240
10241 In addition to options explicitly passed on the command line,
10242 @command{guix build} and other @command{guix} commands that support
10243 building honor the @env{GUIX_BUILD_OPTIONS} environment variable.
10244
10245 @defvr {Environment Variable} GUIX_BUILD_OPTIONS
10246 Users can define this variable to a list of command line options that
10247 will automatically be used by @command{guix build} and other
10248 @command{guix} commands that can perform builds, as in the example
10249 below:
10250
10251 @example
10252 $ export GUIX_BUILD_OPTIONS="--no-substitutes -c 2 -L /foo/bar"
10253 @end example
10254
10255 These options are parsed independently, and the result is appended to
10256 the parsed command-line options.
10257 @end defvr
10258
10259
10260 @node Package Transformation Options
10261 @subsection Package Transformation Options
10262
10263 @cindex package variants
10264 Another set of command-line options supported by @command{guix build}
10265 and also @command{guix package} are @dfn{package transformation
10266 options}. These are options that make it possible to define @dfn{package
10267 variants}---for instance, packages built from different source code.
10268 This is a convenient way to create customized packages on the fly
10269 without having to type in the definitions of package variants
10270 (@pxref{Defining Packages}).
10271
10272 Package transformation options are preserved across upgrades:
10273 @command{guix upgrade} attempts to apply transformation options
10274 initially used when creating the profile to the upgraded packages.
10275
10276 The available options are listed below. Most commands support them and
10277 also support a @option{--help-transform} option that lists all the
10278 available options and a synopsis (these options are not shown in the
10279 @option{--help} output for brevity).
10280
10281 @table @code
10282
10283 @item --with-source=@var{source}
10284 @itemx --with-source=@var{package}=@var{source}
10285 @itemx --with-source=@var{package}@@@var{version}=@var{source}
10286 Use @var{source} as the source of @var{package}, and @var{version} as
10287 its version number.
10288 @var{source} must be a file name or a URL, as for @command{guix
10289 download} (@pxref{Invoking guix download}).
10290
10291 When @var{package} is omitted,
10292 it is taken to be the package name specified on the
10293 command line that matches the base of @var{source}---e.g.,
10294 if @var{source} is @code{/src/guile-2.0.10.tar.gz}, the corresponding
10295 package is @code{guile}.
10296
10297 Likewise, when @var{version} is omitted, the version string is inferred from
10298 @var{source}; in the previous example, it is @code{2.0.10}.
10299
10300 This option allows users to try out versions of packages other than the
10301 one provided by the distribution. The example below downloads
10302 @file{ed-1.7.tar.gz} from a GNU mirror and uses that as the source for
10303 the @code{ed} package:
10304
10305 @example
10306 guix build ed --with-source=mirror://gnu/ed/ed-1.7.tar.gz
10307 @end example
10308
10309 As a developer, @option{--with-source} makes it easy to test release
10310 candidates:
10311
10312 @example
10313 guix build guile --with-source=../guile-2.0.9.219-e1bb7.tar.xz
10314 @end example
10315
10316 @dots{} or to build from a checkout in a pristine environment:
10317
10318 @example
10319 $ git clone git://git.sv.gnu.org/guix.git
10320 $ guix build guix --with-source=guix@@1.0=./guix
10321 @end example
10322
10323 @item --with-input=@var{package}=@var{replacement}
10324 Replace dependency on @var{package} by a dependency on
10325 @var{replacement}. @var{package} must be a package name, and
10326 @var{replacement} must be a package specification such as @code{guile}
10327 or @code{guile@@1.8}.
10328
10329 For instance, the following command builds Guix, but replaces its
10330 dependency on the current stable version of Guile with a dependency on
10331 the legacy version of Guile, @code{guile@@2.0}:
10332
10333 @example
10334 guix build --with-input=guile=guile@@2.0 guix
10335 @end example
10336
10337 This is a recursive, deep replacement. So in this example, both
10338 @code{guix} and its dependency @code{guile-json} (which also depends on
10339 @code{guile}) get rebuilt against @code{guile@@2.0}.
10340
10341 This is implemented using the @code{package-input-rewriting} Scheme
10342 procedure (@pxref{Defining Packages, @code{package-input-rewriting}}).
10343
10344 @item --with-graft=@var{package}=@var{replacement}
10345 This is similar to @option{--with-input} but with an important difference:
10346 instead of rebuilding the whole dependency chain, @var{replacement} is
10347 built and then @dfn{grafted} onto the binaries that were initially
10348 referring to @var{package}. @xref{Security Updates}, for more
10349 information on grafts.
10350
10351 For example, the command below grafts version 3.5.4 of GnuTLS onto Wget
10352 and all its dependencies, replacing references to the version of GnuTLS
10353 they currently refer to:
10354
10355 @example
10356 guix build --with-graft=gnutls=gnutls@@3.5.4 wget
10357 @end example
10358
10359 This has the advantage of being much faster than rebuilding everything.
10360 But there is a caveat: it works if and only if @var{package} and
10361 @var{replacement} are strictly compatible---for example, if they provide
10362 a library, the application binary interface (ABI) of those libraries
10363 must be compatible. If @var{replacement} is somehow incompatible with
10364 @var{package}, then the resulting package may be unusable. Use with
10365 care!
10366
10367 @cindex debugging info, rebuilding
10368 @item --with-debug-info=@var{package}
10369 Build @var{package} in a way that preserves its debugging info and graft
10370 it onto packages that depend on it. This is useful if @var{package}
10371 does not already provide debugging info as a @code{debug} output
10372 (@pxref{Installing Debugging Files}).
10373
10374 For example, suppose you're experiencing a crash in Inkscape and would
10375 like to see what's up in GLib, a library deep down in Inkscape's
10376 dependency graph. GLib lacks a @code{debug} output, so debugging is
10377 tough. Fortunately, you rebuild GLib with debugging info and tack it on
10378 Inkscape:
10379
10380 @example
10381 guix install inkscape --with-debug-info=glib
10382 @end example
10383
10384 Only GLib needs to be recompiled so this takes a reasonable amount of
10385 time. @xref{Installing Debugging Files}, for more info.
10386
10387 @quotation Note
10388 Under the hood, this option works by passing the @samp{#:strip-binaries?
10389 #f} to the build system of the package of interest (@pxref{Build
10390 Systems}). Most build systems support that option but some do not. In
10391 that case, an error is raised.
10392
10393 Likewise, if a C/C++ package is built without @code{-g} (which is rarely
10394 the case), debugging info will remain unavailable even when
10395 @code{#:strip-binaries?} is false.
10396 @end quotation
10397
10398 @cindex tool chain, changing the build tool chain of a package
10399 @item --with-c-toolchain=@var{package}=@var{toolchain}
10400 This option changes the compilation of @var{package} and everything that
10401 depends on it so that they get built with @var{toolchain} instead of the
10402 default GNU tool chain for C/C++.
10403
10404 Consider this example:
10405
10406 @example
10407 guix build octave-cli \
10408 --with-c-toolchain=fftw=gcc-toolchain@@10 \
10409 --with-c-toolchain=fftwf=gcc-toolchain@@10
10410 @end example
10411
10412 The command above builds a variant of the @code{fftw} and @code{fftwf}
10413 packages using version 10 of @code{gcc-toolchain} instead of the default
10414 tool chain, and then builds a variant of the GNU@tie{}Octave
10415 command-line interface using them. GNU@tie{}Octave itself is also built
10416 with @code{gcc-toolchain@@10}.
10417
10418 This other example builds the Hardware Locality (@code{hwloc}) library
10419 and its dependents up to @code{intel-mpi-benchmarks} with the Clang C
10420 compiler:
10421
10422 @example
10423 guix build --with-c-toolchain=hwloc=clang-toolchain \
10424 intel-mpi-benchmarks
10425 @end example
10426
10427 @quotation Note
10428 There can be application binary interface (ABI) incompatibilities among
10429 tool chains. This is particularly true of the C++ standard library and
10430 run-time support libraries such as that of OpenMP@. By rebuilding all
10431 dependents with the same tool chain, @option{--with-c-toolchain} minimizes
10432 the risks of incompatibility but cannot entirely eliminate them. Choose
10433 @var{package} wisely.
10434 @end quotation
10435
10436 @item --with-git-url=@var{package}=@var{url}
10437 @cindex Git, using the latest commit
10438 @cindex latest commit, building
10439 Build @var{package} from the latest commit of the @code{master} branch of the
10440 Git repository at @var{url}. Git sub-modules of the repository are fetched,
10441 recursively.
10442
10443 For example, the following command builds the NumPy Python library against the
10444 latest commit of the master branch of Python itself:
10445
10446 @example
10447 guix build python-numpy \
10448 --with-git-url=python=https://github.com/python/cpython
10449 @end example
10450
10451 This option can also be combined with @option{--with-branch} or
10452 @option{--with-commit} (see below).
10453
10454 @cindex continuous integration
10455 Obviously, since it uses the latest commit of the given branch, the result of
10456 such a command varies over time. Nevertheless it is a convenient way to
10457 rebuild entire software stacks against the latest commit of one or more
10458 packages. This is particularly useful in the context of continuous
10459 integration (CI).
10460
10461 Checkouts are kept in a cache under @file{~/.cache/guix/checkouts} to speed up
10462 consecutive accesses to the same repository. You may want to clean it up once
10463 in a while to save disk space.
10464
10465 @item --with-branch=@var{package}=@var{branch}
10466 Build @var{package} from the latest commit of @var{branch}. If the
10467 @code{source} field of @var{package} is an origin with the @code{git-fetch}
10468 method (@pxref{origin Reference}) or a @code{git-checkout} object, the
10469 repository URL is taken from that @code{source}. Otherwise you have to use
10470 @option{--with-git-url} to specify the URL of the Git repository.
10471
10472 For instance, the following command builds @code{guile-sqlite3} from the
10473 latest commit of its @code{master} branch, and then builds @code{guix} (which
10474 depends on it) and @code{cuirass} (which depends on @code{guix}) against this
10475 specific @code{guile-sqlite3} build:
10476
10477 @example
10478 guix build --with-branch=guile-sqlite3=master cuirass
10479 @end example
10480
10481 @item --with-commit=@var{package}=@var{commit}
10482 This is similar to @option{--with-branch}, except that it builds from
10483 @var{commit} rather than the tip of a branch. @var{commit} must be a valid
10484 Git commit SHA1 identifier or a tag.
10485
10486 @item --with-patch=@var{package}=@var{file}
10487 Add @var{file} to the list of patches applied to @var{package}, where
10488 @var{package} is a spec such as @code{python@@3.8} or @code{glibc}.
10489 @var{file} must contain a patch; it is applied with the flags specified
10490 in the @code{origin} of @var{package} (@pxref{origin Reference}), which
10491 by default includes @code{-p1} (@pxref{patch Directories,,, diffutils,
10492 Comparing and Merging Files}).
10493
10494 As an example, the command below rebuilds Coreutils with the GNU C
10495 Library (glibc) patched with the given patch:
10496
10497 @example
10498 guix build coreutils --with-patch=glibc=./glibc-frob.patch
10499 @end example
10500
10501 In this example, glibc itself as well as everything that leads to
10502 Coreutils in the dependency graph is rebuilt.
10503
10504 @cindex upstream, latest version
10505 @item --with-latest=@var{package}
10506 So you like living on the bleeding edge? This option is for you! It
10507 replaces occurrences of @var{package} in the dependency graph with its
10508 latest upstream version, as reported by @command{guix refresh}
10509 (@pxref{Invoking guix refresh}).
10510
10511 It does so by determining the latest upstream release of @var{package}
10512 (if possible), downloading it, and authenticating it @emph{if} it comes
10513 with an OpenPGP signature.
10514
10515 As an example, the command below builds Guix against the latest version
10516 of Guile-JSON:
10517
10518 @example
10519 guix build guix --with-latest=guile-json
10520 @end example
10521
10522 There are limitations. First, in cases where the tool cannot or does
10523 not know how to authenticate source code, you are at risk of running
10524 malicious code; a warning is emitted in this case. Second, this option
10525 simply changes the source used in the existing package definitions,
10526 which is not always sufficient: there might be additional dependencies
10527 that need to be added, patches to apply, and more generally the quality
10528 assurance work that Guix developers normally do will be missing.
10529
10530 You've been warned! In all the other cases, it's a snappy way to stay
10531 on top. We encourage you to submit patches updating the actual package
10532 definitions once you have successfully tested an upgrade
10533 (@pxref{Contributing}).
10534
10535 @cindex test suite, skipping
10536 @item --without-tests=@var{package}
10537 Build @var{package} without running its tests. This can be useful in
10538 situations where you want to skip the lengthy test suite of a
10539 intermediate package, or if a package's test suite fails in a
10540 non-deterministic fashion. It should be used with care because running
10541 the test suite is a good way to ensure a package is working as intended.
10542
10543 Turning off tests leads to a different store item. Consequently, when
10544 using this option, anything that depends on @var{package} must be
10545 rebuilt, as in this example:
10546
10547 @example
10548 guix install --without-tests=python python-notebook
10549 @end example
10550
10551 The command above installs @code{python-notebook} on top of
10552 @code{python} built without running its test suite. To do so, it also
10553 rebuilds everything that depends on @code{python}, including
10554 @code{python-notebook} itself.
10555
10556 Internally, @option{--without-tests} relies on changing the
10557 @code{#:tests?} option of a package's @code{check} phase (@pxref{Build
10558 Systems}). Note that some packages use a customized @code{check} phase
10559 that does not respect a @code{#:tests? #f} setting. Therefore,
10560 @option{--without-tests} has no effect on these packages.
10561
10562 @end table
10563
10564 Wondering how to achieve the same effect using Scheme code, for example
10565 in your manifest, or how to write your own package transformation?
10566 @xref{Defining Package Variants}, for an overview of the programming
10567 interfaces available.
10568
10569 @node Additional Build Options
10570 @subsection Additional Build Options
10571
10572 The command-line options presented below are specific to @command{guix
10573 build}.
10574
10575 @table @code
10576
10577 @item --quiet
10578 @itemx -q
10579 Build quietly, without displaying the build log; this is equivalent to
10580 @option{--verbosity=0}. Upon completion, the build log is kept in @file{/var}
10581 (or similar) and can always be retrieved using the @option{--log-file} option.
10582
10583 @item --file=@var{file}
10584 @itemx -f @var{file}
10585 Build the package, derivation, or other file-like object that the code within
10586 @var{file} evaluates to (@pxref{G-Expressions, file-like objects}).
10587
10588 As an example, @var{file} might contain a package definition like this
10589 (@pxref{Defining Packages}):
10590
10591 @lisp
10592 @include package-hello.scm
10593 @end lisp
10594
10595 The @var{file} may also contain a JSON representation of one or more
10596 package definitions. Running @code{guix build -f} on @file{hello.json}
10597 with the following contents would result in building the packages
10598 @code{myhello} and @code{greeter}:
10599
10600 @example
10601 @verbatiminclude package-hello.json
10602 @end example
10603
10604 @item --manifest=@var{manifest}
10605 @itemx -m @var{manifest}
10606 Build all packages listed in the given @var{manifest}
10607 (@pxref{profile-manifest, @option{--manifest}}).
10608
10609 @item --expression=@var{expr}
10610 @itemx -e @var{expr}
10611 Build the package or derivation @var{expr} evaluates to.
10612
10613 For example, @var{expr} may be @code{(@@ (gnu packages guile)
10614 guile-1.8)}, which unambiguously designates this specific variant of
10615 version 1.8 of Guile.
10616
10617 Alternatively, @var{expr} may be a G-expression, in which case it is used
10618 as a build program passed to @code{gexp->derivation}
10619 (@pxref{G-Expressions}).
10620
10621 Lastly, @var{expr} may refer to a zero-argument monadic procedure
10622 (@pxref{The Store Monad}). The procedure must return a derivation as a
10623 monadic value, which is then passed through @code{run-with-store}.
10624
10625 @item --source
10626 @itemx -S
10627 Build the source derivations of the packages, rather than the packages
10628 themselves.
10629
10630 For instance, @code{guix build -S gcc} returns something like
10631 @file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-gcc-4.7.2.tar.bz2}, which is the GCC
10632 source tarball.
10633
10634 The returned source tarball is the result of applying any patches and
10635 code snippets specified in the package @code{origin} (@pxref{Defining
10636 Packages}).
10637
10638 @cindex source, verification
10639 As with other derivations, the result of building a source derivation
10640 can be verified using the @option{--check} option (@pxref{build-check}).
10641 This is useful to validate that a (potentially already built or
10642 substituted, thus cached) package source matches against its declared
10643 hash.
10644
10645 Note that @command{guix build -S} compiles the sources only of the
10646 specified packages. They do not include the sources of statically
10647 linked dependencies and by themselves are insufficient for reproducing
10648 the packages.
10649
10650 @item --sources
10651 Fetch and return the source of @var{package-or-derivation} and all their
10652 dependencies, recursively. This is a handy way to obtain a local copy
10653 of all the source code needed to build @var{packages}, allowing you to
10654 eventually build them even without network access. It is an extension
10655 of the @option{--source} option and can accept one of the following
10656 optional argument values:
10657
10658 @table @code
10659 @item package
10660 This value causes the @option{--sources} option to behave in the same way
10661 as the @option{--source} option.
10662
10663 @item all
10664 Build the source derivations of all packages, including any source that
10665 might be listed as @code{inputs}. This is the default value.
10666
10667 @example
10668 $ guix build --sources tzdata
10669 The following derivations will be built:
10670 /gnu/store/@dots{}-tzdata2015b.tar.gz.drv
10671 /gnu/store/@dots{}-tzcode2015b.tar.gz.drv
10672 @end example
10673
10674 @item transitive
10675 Build the source derivations of all packages, as well of all transitive
10676 inputs to the packages. This can be used e.g.@: to
10677 prefetch package source for later offline building.
10678
10679 @example
10680 $ guix build --sources=transitive tzdata
10681 The following derivations will be built:
10682 /gnu/store/@dots{}-tzcode2015b.tar.gz.drv
10683 /gnu/store/@dots{}-findutils-4.4.2.tar.xz.drv
10684 /gnu/store/@dots{}-grep-2.21.tar.xz.drv
10685 /gnu/store/@dots{}-coreutils-8.23.tar.xz.drv
10686 /gnu/store/@dots{}-make-4.1.tar.xz.drv
10687 /gnu/store/@dots{}-bash-4.3.tar.xz.drv
10688 @dots{}
10689 @end example
10690
10691 @end table
10692
10693 @item --system=@var{system}
10694 @itemx -s @var{system}
10695 Attempt to build for @var{system}---e.g., @code{i686-linux}---instead of
10696 the system type of the build host. The @command{guix build} command allows
10697 you to repeat this option several times, in which case it builds for all the
10698 specified systems; other commands ignore extraneous @option{-s} options.
10699
10700 @quotation Note
10701 The @option{--system} flag is for @emph{native} compilation and must not
10702 be confused with cross-compilation. See @option{--target} below for
10703 information on cross-compilation.
10704 @end quotation
10705
10706 An example use of this is on Linux-based systems, which can emulate
10707 different personalities. For instance, passing
10708 @option{--system=i686-linux} on an @code{x86_64-linux} system or
10709 @option{--system=armhf-linux} on an @code{aarch64-linux} system allows
10710 you to build packages in a complete 32-bit environment.
10711
10712 @quotation Note
10713 Building for an @code{armhf-linux} system is unconditionally enabled on
10714 @code{aarch64-linux} machines, although certain aarch64 chipsets do not
10715 allow for this functionality, notably the ThunderX.
10716 @end quotation
10717
10718 Similarly, when transparent emulation with QEMU and @code{binfmt_misc}
10719 is enabled (@pxref{Virtualization Services,
10720 @code{qemu-binfmt-service-type}}), you can build for any system for
10721 which a QEMU @code{binfmt_misc} handler is installed.
10722
10723 Builds for a system other than that of the machine you are using can
10724 also be offloaded to a remote machine of the right architecture.
10725 @xref{Daemon Offload Setup}, for more information on offloading.
10726
10727 @item --target=@var{triplet}
10728 @cindex cross-compilation
10729 Cross-build for @var{triplet}, which must be a valid GNU triplet, such
10730 as @code{"aarch64-linux-gnu"} (@pxref{Specifying Target Triplets, GNU
10731 configuration triplets,, autoconf, Autoconf}).
10732
10733 @anchor{build-check}
10734 @item --check
10735 @cindex determinism, checking
10736 @cindex reproducibility, checking
10737 Rebuild @var{package-or-derivation}, which are already available in the
10738 store, and raise an error if the build results are not bit-for-bit
10739 identical.
10740
10741 This mechanism allows you to check whether previously installed
10742 substitutes are genuine (@pxref{Substitutes}), or whether the build result
10743 of a package is deterministic. @xref{Invoking guix challenge}, for more
10744 background information and tools.
10745
10746 When used in conjunction with @option{--keep-failed}, the differing
10747 output is kept in the store, under @file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-check}.
10748 This makes it easy to look for differences between the two results.
10749
10750 @item --repair
10751 @cindex repairing store items
10752 @cindex corruption, recovering from
10753 Attempt to repair the specified store items, if they are corrupt, by
10754 re-downloading or rebuilding them.
10755
10756 This operation is not atomic and thus restricted to @code{root}.
10757
10758 @item --derivations
10759 @itemx -d
10760 Return the derivation paths, not the output paths, of the given
10761 packages.
10762
10763 @item --root=@var{file}
10764 @itemx -r @var{file}
10765 @cindex GC roots, adding
10766 @cindex garbage collector roots, adding
10767 Make @var{file} a symlink to the result, and register it as a garbage
10768 collector root.
10769
10770 Consequently, the results of this @command{guix build} invocation are
10771 protected from garbage collection until @var{file} is removed. When
10772 that option is omitted, build results are eligible for garbage
10773 collection as soon as the build completes. @xref{Invoking guix gc}, for
10774 more on GC roots.
10775
10776 @item --log-file
10777 @cindex build logs, access
10778 Return the build log file names or URLs for the given
10779 @var{package-or-derivation}, or raise an error if build logs are
10780 missing.
10781
10782 This works regardless of how packages or derivations are specified. For
10783 instance, the following invocations are equivalent:
10784
10785 @example
10786 guix build --log-file `guix build -d guile`
10787 guix build --log-file `guix build guile`
10788 guix build --log-file guile
10789 guix build --log-file -e '(@@ (gnu packages guile) guile-2.0)'
10790 @end example
10791
10792 If a log is unavailable locally, and unless @option{--no-substitutes} is
10793 passed, the command looks for a corresponding log on one of the
10794 substitute servers (as specified with @option{--substitute-urls}).
10795
10796 So for instance, imagine you want to see the build log of GDB on MIPS,
10797 but you are actually on an @code{x86_64} machine:
10798
10799 @example
10800 $ guix build --log-file gdb -s aarch64-linux
10801 https://@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}/log/@dots{}-gdb-7.10
10802 @end example
10803
10804 You can freely access a huge library of build logs!
10805 @end table
10806
10807 @node Debugging Build Failures
10808 @subsection Debugging Build Failures
10809
10810 @cindex build failures, debugging
10811 When defining a new package (@pxref{Defining Packages}), you will
10812 probably find yourself spending some time debugging and tweaking the
10813 build until it succeeds. To do that, you need to operate the build
10814 commands yourself in an environment as close as possible to the one the
10815 build daemon uses.
10816
10817 To that end, the first thing to do is to use the @option{--keep-failed}
10818 or @option{-K} option of @command{guix build}, which will keep the
10819 failed build tree in @file{/tmp} or whatever directory you specified as
10820 @env{TMPDIR} (@pxref{Invoking guix build, @option{--keep-failed}}).
10821
10822 From there on, you can @command{cd} to the failed build tree and source
10823 the @file{environment-variables} file, which contains all the
10824 environment variable definitions that were in place when the build
10825 failed. So let's say you're debugging a build failure in package
10826 @code{foo}; a typical session would look like this:
10827
10828 @example
10829 $ guix build foo -K
10830 @dots{} @i{build fails}
10831 $ cd /tmp/guix-build-foo.drv-0
10832 $ source ./environment-variables
10833 $ cd foo-1.2
10834 @end example
10835
10836 Now, you can invoke commands as if you were the daemon (almost) and
10837 troubleshoot your build process.
10838
10839 Sometimes it happens that, for example, a package's tests pass when you
10840 run them manually but they fail when the daemon runs them. This can
10841 happen because the daemon runs builds in containers where, unlike in our
10842 environment above, network access is missing, @file{/bin/sh} does not
10843 exist, etc. (@pxref{Build Environment Setup}).
10844
10845 In such cases, you may need to run inspect the build process from within
10846 a container similar to the one the build daemon creates:
10847
10848 @example
10849 $ guix build -K foo
10850 @dots{}
10851 $ cd /tmp/guix-build-foo.drv-0
10852 $ guix environment --no-grafts -C foo --ad-hoc strace gdb
10853 [env]# source ./environment-variables
10854 [env]# cd foo-1.2
10855 @end example
10856
10857 Here, @command{guix environment -C} creates a container and spawns a new
10858 shell in it (@pxref{Invoking guix environment}). The @command{--ad-hoc
10859 strace gdb} part adds the @command{strace} and @command{gdb} commands to
10860 the container, which you may find handy while debugging. The
10861 @option{--no-grafts} option makes sure we get the exact same
10862 environment, with ungrafted packages (@pxref{Security Updates}, for more
10863 info on grafts).
10864
10865 To get closer to a container like that used by the build daemon, we can
10866 remove @file{/bin/sh}:
10867
10868 @example
10869 [env]# rm /bin/sh
10870 @end example
10871
10872 (Don't worry, this is harmless: this is all happening in the throw-away
10873 container created by @command{guix environment}.)
10874
10875 The @command{strace} command is probably not in the search path, but we
10876 can run:
10877
10878 @example
10879 [env]# $GUIX_ENVIRONMENT/bin/strace -f -o log make check
10880 @end example
10881
10882 In this way, not only you will have reproduced the environment variables
10883 the daemon uses, you will also be running the build process in a container
10884 similar to the one the daemon uses.
10885
10886
10887 @node Invoking guix edit
10888 @section Invoking @command{guix edit}
10889
10890 @cindex @command{guix edit}
10891 @cindex package definition, editing
10892 So many packages, so many source files! The @command{guix edit} command
10893 facilitates the life of users and packagers by pointing their editor at
10894 the source file containing the definition of the specified packages.
10895 For instance:
10896
10897 @example
10898 guix edit gcc@@4.9 vim
10899 @end example
10900
10901 @noindent
10902 launches the program specified in the @env{VISUAL} or in the
10903 @env{EDITOR} environment variable to view the recipe of GCC@tie{}4.9.3
10904 and that of Vim.
10905
10906 If you are using a Guix Git checkout (@pxref{Building from Git}), or
10907 have created your own packages on @env{GUIX_PACKAGE_PATH}
10908 (@pxref{Package Modules}), you will be able to edit the package
10909 recipes. In other cases, you will be able to examine the read-only recipes
10910 for packages currently in the store.
10911
10912 Instead of @env{GUIX_PACKAGE_PATH}, the command-line option
10913 @option{--load-path=@var{directory}} (or in short @option{-L
10914 @var{directory}}) allows you to add @var{directory} to the front of the
10915 package module search path and so make your own packages visible.
10916
10917 @node Invoking guix download
10918 @section Invoking @command{guix download}
10919
10920 @cindex @command{guix download}
10921 @cindex downloading package sources
10922 When writing a package definition, developers typically need to download
10923 a source tarball, compute its SHA256 hash, and write that
10924 hash in the package definition (@pxref{Defining Packages}). The
10925 @command{guix download} tool helps with this task: it downloads a file
10926 from the given URI, adds it to the store, and prints both its file name
10927 in the store and its SHA256 hash.
10928
10929 The fact that the downloaded file is added to the store saves bandwidth:
10930 when the developer eventually tries to build the newly defined package
10931 with @command{guix build}, the source tarball will not have to be
10932 downloaded again because it is already in the store. It is also a
10933 convenient way to temporarily stash files, which may be deleted
10934 eventually (@pxref{Invoking guix gc}).
10935
10936 The @command{guix download} command supports the same URIs as used in
10937 package definitions. In particular, it supports @code{mirror://} URIs.
10938 @code{https} URIs (HTTP over TLS) are supported @emph{provided} the
10939 Guile bindings for GnuTLS are available in the user's environment; when
10940 they are not available, an error is raised. @xref{Guile Preparations,
10941 how to install the GnuTLS bindings for Guile,, gnutls-guile,
10942 GnuTLS-Guile}, for more information.
10943
10944 @command{guix download} verifies HTTPS server certificates by loading
10945 the certificates of X.509 authorities from the directory pointed to by
10946 the @env{SSL_CERT_DIR} environment variable (@pxref{X.509
10947 Certificates}), unless @option{--no-check-certificate} is used.
10948
10949 The following options are available:
10950
10951 @table @code
10952 @item --hash=@var{algorithm}
10953 @itemx -H @var{algorithm}
10954 Compute a hash using the specified @var{algorithm}. @xref{Invoking guix
10955 hash}, for more information.
10956
10957 @item --format=@var{fmt}
10958 @itemx -f @var{fmt}
10959 Write the hash in the format specified by @var{fmt}. For more
10960 information on the valid values for @var{fmt}, @pxref{Invoking guix hash}.
10961
10962 @item --no-check-certificate
10963 Do not validate the X.509 certificates of HTTPS servers.
10964
10965 When using this option, you have @emph{absolutely no guarantee} that you
10966 are communicating with the authentic server responsible for the given
10967 URL, which makes you vulnerable to ``man-in-the-middle'' attacks.
10968
10969 @item --output=@var{file}
10970 @itemx -o @var{file}
10971 Save the downloaded file to @var{file} instead of adding it to the
10972 store.
10973 @end table
10974
10975 @node Invoking guix hash
10976 @section Invoking @command{guix hash}
10977
10978 @cindex @command{guix hash}
10979 The @command{guix hash} command computes the hash of a file.
10980 It is primarily a convenience tool for anyone contributing to the
10981 distribution: it computes the cryptographic hash of a file, which can be
10982 used in the definition of a package (@pxref{Defining Packages}).
10983
10984 The general syntax is:
10985
10986 @example
10987 guix hash @var{option} @var{file}
10988 @end example
10989
10990 When @var{file} is @code{-} (a hyphen), @command{guix hash} computes the
10991 hash of data read from standard input. @command{guix hash} has the
10992 following options:
10993
10994 @table @code
10995
10996 @item --hash=@var{algorithm}
10997 @itemx -H @var{algorithm}
10998 Compute a hash using the specified @var{algorithm}, @code{sha256} by
10999 default.
11000
11001 @var{algorithm} must the name of a cryptographic hash algorithm
11002 supported by Libgcrypt @i{via} Guile-Gcrypt---e.g., @code{sha512} or
11003 @code{sha3-256} (@pxref{Hash Functions,,, guile-gcrypt, Guile-Gcrypt
11004 Reference Manual}).
11005
11006 @item --format=@var{fmt}
11007 @itemx -f @var{fmt}
11008 Write the hash in the format specified by @var{fmt}.
11009
11010 Supported formats: @code{base64}, @code{nix-base32}, @code{base32}, @code{base16}
11011 (@code{hex} and @code{hexadecimal} can be used as well).
11012
11013 If the @option{--format} option is not specified, @command{guix hash}
11014 will output the hash in @code{nix-base32}. This representation is used
11015 in the definitions of packages.
11016
11017 @item --recursive
11018 @itemx -r
11019 Compute the hash on @var{file} recursively.
11020
11021 In this case, the hash is computed on an archive containing @var{file},
11022 including its children if it is a directory. Some of the metadata of
11023 @var{file} is part of the archive; for instance, when @var{file} is a
11024 regular file, the hash is different depending on whether @var{file} is
11025 executable or not. Metadata such as time stamps has no impact on the
11026 hash (@pxref{Invoking guix archive}).
11027 @c FIXME: Replace xref above with xref to an ``Archive'' section when
11028 @c it exists.
11029
11030 @item --exclude-vcs
11031 @itemx -x
11032 When combined with @option{--recursive}, exclude version control system
11033 directories (@file{.bzr}, @file{.git}, @file{.hg}, etc.).
11034
11035 @vindex git-fetch
11036 As an example, here is how you would compute the hash of a Git checkout,
11037 which is useful when using the @code{git-fetch} method (@pxref{origin
11038 Reference}):
11039
11040 @example
11041 $ git clone http://example.org/foo.git
11042 $ cd foo
11043 $ guix hash -rx .
11044 @end example
11045 @end table
11046
11047 @node Invoking guix import
11048 @section Invoking @command{guix import}
11049
11050 @cindex importing packages
11051 @cindex package import
11052 @cindex package conversion
11053 @cindex Invoking @command{guix import}
11054 The @command{guix import} command is useful for people who would like to
11055 add a package to the distribution with as little work as
11056 possible---a legitimate demand. The command knows of a few
11057 repositories from which it can ``import'' package metadata. The result
11058 is a package definition, or a template thereof, in the format we know
11059 (@pxref{Defining Packages}).
11060
11061 The general syntax is:
11062
11063 @example
11064 guix import @var{importer} @var{options}@dots{}
11065 @end example
11066
11067 @var{importer} specifies the source from which to import package
11068 metadata, and @var{options} specifies a package identifier and other
11069 options specific to @var{importer}.
11070
11071 Some of the importers rely on the ability to run the @command{gpgv} command.
11072 For these, GnuPG must be installed and in @code{$PATH}; run @code{guix install
11073 gnupg} if needed.
11074
11075 Currently, the available ``importers'' are:
11076
11077 @table @code
11078 @item gnu
11079 Import metadata for the given GNU package. This provides a template
11080 for the latest version of that GNU package, including the hash of its
11081 source tarball, and its canonical synopsis and description.
11082
11083 Additional information such as the package dependencies and its
11084 license needs to be figured out manually.
11085
11086 For example, the following command returns a package definition for
11087 GNU@tie{}Hello:
11088
11089 @example
11090 guix import gnu hello
11091 @end example
11092
11093 Specific command-line options are:
11094
11095 @table @code
11096 @item --key-download=@var{policy}
11097 As for @command{guix refresh}, specify the policy to handle missing
11098 OpenPGP keys when verifying the package signature. @xref{Invoking guix
11099 refresh, @option{--key-download}}.
11100 @end table
11101
11102 @item pypi
11103 @cindex pypi
11104 Import metadata from the @uref{https://pypi.python.org/, Python Package
11105 Index}. Information is taken from the JSON-formatted description
11106 available at @code{pypi.python.org} and usually includes all the relevant
11107 information, including package dependencies. For maximum efficiency, it
11108 is recommended to install the @command{unzip} utility, so that the
11109 importer can unzip Python wheels and gather data from them.
11110
11111 The command below imports metadata for the @code{itsdangerous} Python
11112 package:
11113
11114 @example
11115 guix import pypi itsdangerous
11116 @end example
11117
11118 @table @code
11119 @item --recursive
11120 @itemx -r
11121 Traverse the dependency graph of the given upstream package recursively
11122 and generate package expressions for all those packages that are not yet
11123 in Guix.
11124 @end table
11125
11126 @item gem
11127 @cindex gem
11128 Import metadata from @uref{https://rubygems.org/, RubyGems}. Information
11129 is taken from the JSON-formatted description available at
11130 @code{rubygems.org} and includes most relevant information, including
11131 runtime dependencies. There are some caveats, however. The metadata
11132 doesn't distinguish between synopses and descriptions, so the same string
11133 is used for both fields. Additionally, the details of non-Ruby
11134 dependencies required to build native extensions is unavailable and left
11135 as an exercise to the packager.
11136
11137 The command below imports metadata for the @code{rails} Ruby package:
11138
11139 @example
11140 guix import gem rails
11141 @end example
11142
11143 @table @code
11144 @item --recursive
11145 @itemx -r
11146 Traverse the dependency graph of the given upstream package recursively
11147 and generate package expressions for all those packages that are not yet
11148 in Guix.
11149 @end table
11150
11151 @item cpan
11152 @cindex CPAN
11153 Import metadata from @uref{https://www.metacpan.org/, MetaCPAN}.
11154 Information is taken from the JSON-formatted metadata provided through
11155 @uref{https://fastapi.metacpan.org/, MetaCPAN's API} and includes most
11156 relevant information, such as module dependencies. License information
11157 should be checked closely. If Perl is available in the store, then the
11158 @code{corelist} utility will be used to filter core modules out of the
11159 list of dependencies.
11160
11161 The command command below imports metadata for the Acme::Boolean Perl
11162 module:
11163
11164 @example
11165 guix import cpan Acme::Boolean
11166 @end example
11167
11168 @item cran
11169 @cindex CRAN
11170 @cindex Bioconductor
11171 Import metadata from @uref{https://cran.r-project.org/, CRAN}, the
11172 central repository for the @uref{https://r-project.org, GNU@tie{}R
11173 statistical and graphical environment}.
11174
11175 Information is extracted from the @file{DESCRIPTION} file of the package.
11176
11177 The command command below imports metadata for the Cairo R package:
11178
11179 @example
11180 guix import cran Cairo
11181 @end example
11182
11183 When @option{--recursive} is added, the importer will traverse the
11184 dependency graph of the given upstream package recursively and generate
11185 package expressions for all those packages that are not yet in Guix.
11186
11187 When @option{--style=specification} is added, the importer will generate
11188 package definitions whose inputs are package specifications instead of
11189 references to package variables. This is useful when generated package
11190 definitions are to be appended to existing user modules, as the list of
11191 used package modules need not be changed. The default is
11192 @option{--style=variable}.
11193
11194 When @option{--archive=bioconductor} is added, metadata is imported from
11195 @uref{https://www.bioconductor.org/, Bioconductor}, a repository of R
11196 packages for the analysis and comprehension of high-throughput
11197 genomic data in bioinformatics.
11198
11199 Information is extracted from the @file{DESCRIPTION} file contained in the
11200 package archive.
11201
11202 The command below imports metadata for the GenomicRanges R package:
11203
11204 @example
11205 guix import cran --archive=bioconductor GenomicRanges
11206 @end example
11207
11208 Finally, you can also import R packages that have not yet been published on
11209 CRAN or Bioconductor as long as they are in a git repository. Use
11210 @option{--archive=git} followed by the URL of the git repository:
11211
11212 @example
11213 guix import cran --archive=git https://github.com/immunogenomics/harmony
11214 @end example
11215
11216 @item texlive
11217 @cindex TeX Live
11218 @cindex CTAN
11219 Import metadata from @uref{https://www.ctan.org/, CTAN}, the
11220 comprehensive TeX archive network for TeX packages that are part of the
11221 @uref{https://www.tug.org/texlive/, TeX Live distribution}.
11222
11223 Information about the package is obtained through the XML API provided
11224 by CTAN, while the source code is downloaded from the SVN repository of
11225 the Tex Live project. This is done because the CTAN does not keep
11226 versioned archives.
11227
11228 The command command below imports metadata for the @code{fontspec}
11229 TeX package:
11230
11231 @example
11232 guix import texlive fontspec
11233 @end example
11234
11235 When @option{--archive=@var{directory}} is added, the source code is
11236 downloaded not from the @file{latex} sub-directory of the
11237 @file{texmf-dist/source} tree in the TeX Live SVN repository, but from
11238 the specified sibling @var{directory} under the same root.
11239
11240 The command below imports metadata for the @code{ifxetex} package from
11241 CTAN while fetching the sources from the directory
11242 @file{texmf/source/generic}:
11243
11244 @example
11245 guix import texlive --archive=generic ifxetex
11246 @end example
11247
11248 @item json
11249 @cindex JSON, import
11250 Import package metadata from a local JSON file. Consider the following
11251 example package definition in JSON format:
11252
11253 @example
11254 @{
11255 "name": "hello",
11256 "version": "2.10",
11257 "source": "mirror://gnu/hello/hello-2.10.tar.gz",
11258 "build-system": "gnu",
11259 "home-page": "https://www.gnu.org/software/hello/",
11260 "synopsis": "Hello, GNU world: An example GNU package",
11261 "description": "GNU Hello prints a greeting.",
11262 "license": "GPL-3.0+",
11263 "native-inputs": ["gettext"]
11264 @}
11265 @end example
11266
11267 The field names are the same as for the @code{<package>} record
11268 (@xref{Defining Packages}). References to other packages are provided
11269 as JSON lists of quoted package specification strings such as
11270 @code{guile} or @code{guile@@2.0}.
11271
11272 The importer also supports a more explicit source definition using the
11273 common fields for @code{<origin>} records:
11274
11275 @example
11276 @{
11277 @dots{}
11278 "source": @{
11279 "method": "url-fetch",
11280 "uri": "mirror://gnu/hello/hello-2.10.tar.gz",
11281 "sha256": @{
11282 "base32": "0ssi1wpaf7plaswqqjwigppsg5fyh99vdlb9kzl7c9lng89ndq1i"
11283 @}
11284 @}
11285 @dots{}
11286 @}
11287 @end example
11288
11289 The command below reads metadata from the JSON file @code{hello.json}
11290 and outputs a package expression:
11291
11292 @example
11293 guix import json hello.json
11294 @end example
11295
11296 @item nix
11297 Import metadata from a local copy of the source of the
11298 @uref{https://nixos.org/nixpkgs/, Nixpkgs distribution}@footnote{This
11299 relies on the @command{nix-instantiate} command of
11300 @uref{https://nixos.org/nix/, Nix}.}. Package definitions in Nixpkgs are
11301 typically written in a mixture of Nix-language and Bash code. This
11302 command only imports the high-level package structure that is written in
11303 the Nix language. It normally includes all the basic fields of a
11304 package definition.
11305
11306 When importing a GNU package, the synopsis and descriptions are replaced
11307 by their canonical upstream variant.
11308
11309 Usually, you will first need to do:
11310
11311 @example
11312 export NIX_REMOTE=daemon
11313 @end example
11314
11315 @noindent
11316 so that @command{nix-instantiate} does not try to open the Nix database.
11317
11318 As an example, the command below imports the package definition of
11319 LibreOffice (more precisely, it imports the definition of the package
11320 bound to the @code{libreoffice} top-level attribute):
11321
11322 @example
11323 guix import nix ~/path/to/nixpkgs libreoffice
11324 @end example
11325
11326 @item hackage
11327 @cindex hackage
11328 Import metadata from the Haskell community's central package archive
11329 @uref{https://hackage.haskell.org/, Hackage}. Information is taken from
11330 Cabal files and includes all the relevant information, including package
11331 dependencies.
11332
11333 Specific command-line options are:
11334
11335 @table @code
11336 @item --stdin
11337 @itemx -s
11338 Read a Cabal file from standard input.
11339 @item --no-test-dependencies
11340 @itemx -t
11341 Do not include dependencies required only by the test suites.
11342 @item --cabal-environment=@var{alist}
11343 @itemx -e @var{alist}
11344 @var{alist} is a Scheme alist defining the environment in which the
11345 Cabal conditionals are evaluated. The accepted keys are: @code{os},
11346 @code{arch}, @code{impl} and a string representing the name of a flag.
11347 The value associated with a flag has to be either the symbol
11348 @code{true} or @code{false}. The value associated with other keys
11349 has to conform to the Cabal file format definition. The default value
11350 associated with the keys @code{os}, @code{arch} and @code{impl} is
11351 @samp{linux}, @samp{x86_64} and @samp{ghc}, respectively.
11352 @item --recursive
11353 @itemx -r
11354 Traverse the dependency graph of the given upstream package recursively
11355 and generate package expressions for all those packages that are not yet
11356 in Guix.
11357 @end table
11358
11359 The command below imports metadata for the latest version of the
11360 HTTP Haskell package without including test dependencies and
11361 specifying the value of the flag @samp{network-uri} as @code{false}:
11362
11363 @example
11364 guix import hackage -t -e "'((\"network-uri\" . false))" HTTP
11365 @end example
11366
11367 A specific package version may optionally be specified by following the
11368 package name by an at-sign and a version number as in the following example:
11369
11370 @example
11371 guix import hackage mtl@@2.1.3.1
11372 @end example
11373
11374 @item stackage
11375 @cindex stackage
11376 The @code{stackage} importer is a wrapper around the @code{hackage} one.
11377 It takes a package name, looks up the package version included in a
11378 long-term support (LTS) @uref{https://www.stackage.org, Stackage}
11379 release and uses the @code{hackage} importer to retrieve its metadata.
11380 Note that it is up to you to select an LTS release compatible with the
11381 GHC compiler used by Guix.
11382
11383 Specific command-line options are:
11384
11385 @table @code
11386 @item --no-test-dependencies
11387 @itemx -t
11388 Do not include dependencies required only by the test suites.
11389 @item --lts-version=@var{version}
11390 @itemx -l @var{version}
11391 @var{version} is the desired LTS release version. If omitted the latest
11392 release is used.
11393 @item --recursive
11394 @itemx -r
11395 Traverse the dependency graph of the given upstream package recursively
11396 and generate package expressions for all those packages that are not yet
11397 in Guix.
11398 @end table
11399
11400 The command below imports metadata for the HTTP Haskell package
11401 included in the LTS Stackage release version 7.18:
11402
11403 @example
11404 guix import stackage --lts-version=7.18 HTTP
11405 @end example
11406
11407 @item elpa
11408 @cindex elpa
11409 Import metadata from an Emacs Lisp Package Archive (ELPA) package
11410 repository (@pxref{Packages,,, emacs, The GNU Emacs Manual}).
11411
11412 Specific command-line options are:
11413
11414 @table @code
11415 @item --archive=@var{repo}
11416 @itemx -a @var{repo}
11417 @var{repo} identifies the archive repository from which to retrieve the
11418 information. Currently the supported repositories and their identifiers
11419 are:
11420 @itemize -
11421 @item
11422 @uref{https://elpa.gnu.org/packages, GNU}, selected by the @code{gnu}
11423 identifier. This is the default.
11424
11425 Packages from @code{elpa.gnu.org} are signed with one of the keys
11426 contained in the GnuPG keyring at
11427 @file{share/emacs/25.1/etc/package-keyring.gpg} (or similar) in the
11428 @code{emacs} package (@pxref{Package Installation, ELPA package
11429 signatures,, emacs, The GNU Emacs Manual}).
11430
11431 @item
11432 @uref{https://stable.melpa.org/packages, MELPA-Stable}, selected by the
11433 @code{melpa-stable} identifier.
11434
11435 @item
11436 @uref{https://melpa.org/packages, MELPA}, selected by the @code{melpa}
11437 identifier.
11438 @end itemize
11439
11440 @item --recursive
11441 @itemx -r
11442 Traverse the dependency graph of the given upstream package recursively
11443 and generate package expressions for all those packages that are not yet
11444 in Guix.
11445 @end table
11446
11447 @item crate
11448 @cindex crate
11449 Import metadata from the crates.io Rust package repository
11450 @uref{https://crates.io, crates.io}, as in this example:
11451
11452 @example
11453 guix import crate blake2-rfc
11454 @end example
11455
11456 The crate importer also allows you to specify a version string:
11457
11458 @example
11459 guix import crate constant-time-eq@@0.1.0
11460 @end example
11461
11462 Additional options include:
11463
11464 @table @code
11465 @item --recursive
11466 @itemx -r
11467 Traverse the dependency graph of the given upstream package recursively
11468 and generate package expressions for all those packages that are not yet
11469 in Guix.
11470 @end table
11471
11472 @item opam
11473 @cindex OPAM
11474 @cindex OCaml
11475 Import metadata from the @uref{https://opam.ocaml.org/, OPAM} package
11476 repository used by the OCaml community.
11477
11478 Additional options include:
11479
11480 @table @code
11481 @item --recursive
11482 @itemx -r
11483 Traverse the dependency graph of the given upstream package recursively
11484 and generate package expressions for all those packages that are not yet
11485 in Guix.
11486 @item --repo
11487 Select the given repository (a repository name). Possible values include:
11488 @itemize
11489 @item @code{opam}, the default opam repository,
11490 @item @code{coq} or @code{coq-released}, the stable repository for coq packages,
11491 @item @code{coq-core-dev}, the repository that contains development versions of coq,
11492 @item @code{coq-extra-dev}, the repository that contains development versions
11493 of coq packages.
11494 @end itemize
11495 @end table
11496 @end table
11497
11498 The structure of the @command{guix import} code is modular. It would be
11499 useful to have more importers for other package formats, and your help
11500 is welcome here (@pxref{Contributing}).
11501
11502 @node Invoking guix refresh
11503 @section Invoking @command{guix refresh}
11504
11505 @cindex @command {guix refresh}
11506 The primary audience of the @command{guix refresh} command is developers
11507 of the GNU software distribution. By default, it reports any packages
11508 provided by the distribution that are outdated compared to the latest
11509 upstream version, like this:
11510
11511 @example
11512 $ guix refresh
11513 gnu/packages/gettext.scm:29:13: gettext would be upgraded from 0.18.1.1 to 0.18.2.1
11514 gnu/packages/glib.scm:77:12: glib would be upgraded from 2.34.3 to 2.37.0
11515 @end example
11516
11517 Alternatively, one can specify packages to consider, in which case a
11518 warning is emitted for packages that lack an updater:
11519
11520 @example
11521 $ guix refresh coreutils guile guile-ssh
11522 gnu/packages/ssh.scm:205:2: warning: no updater for guile-ssh
11523 gnu/packages/guile.scm:136:12: guile would be upgraded from 2.0.12 to 2.0.13
11524 @end example
11525
11526 @command{guix refresh} browses the upstream repository of each package and determines
11527 the highest version number of the releases therein. The command
11528 knows how to update specific types of packages: GNU packages, ELPA
11529 packages, etc.---see the documentation for @option{--type} below. There
11530 are many packages, though, for which it lacks a method to determine
11531 whether a new upstream release is available. However, the mechanism is
11532 extensible, so feel free to get in touch with us to add a new method!
11533
11534 @table @code
11535
11536 @item --recursive
11537 Consider the packages specified, and all the packages upon which they depend.
11538
11539 @example
11540 $ guix refresh --recursive coreutils
11541 gnu/packages/acl.scm:35:2: warning: no updater for acl
11542 gnu/packages/m4.scm:30:12: info: 1.4.18 is already the latest version of m4
11543 gnu/packages/xml.scm:68:2: warning: no updater for expat
11544 gnu/packages/multiprecision.scm:40:12: info: 6.1.2 is already the latest version of gmp
11545 @dots{}
11546 @end example
11547
11548 @end table
11549
11550 Sometimes the upstream name differs from the package name used in Guix,
11551 and @command{guix refresh} needs a little help. Most updaters honor the
11552 @code{upstream-name} property in package definitions, which can be used
11553 to that effect:
11554
11555 @lisp
11556 (define-public network-manager
11557 (package
11558 (name "network-manager")
11559 ;; @dots{}
11560 (properties '((upstream-name . "NetworkManager")))))
11561 @end lisp
11562
11563 When passed @option{--update}, it modifies distribution source files to
11564 update the version numbers and source tarball hashes of those package
11565 recipes (@pxref{Defining Packages}). This is achieved by downloading
11566 each package's latest source tarball and its associated OpenPGP
11567 signature, authenticating the downloaded tarball against its signature
11568 using @command{gpgv}, and finally computing its hash---note that GnuPG must be
11569 installed and in @code{$PATH}; run @code{guix install gnupg} if needed.
11570
11571 When the public
11572 key used to sign the tarball is missing from the user's keyring, an
11573 attempt is made to automatically retrieve it from a public key server;
11574 when this is successful, the key is added to the user's keyring; otherwise,
11575 @command{guix refresh} reports an error.
11576
11577 The following options are supported:
11578
11579 @table @code
11580
11581 @item --expression=@var{expr}
11582 @itemx -e @var{expr}
11583 Consider the package @var{expr} evaluates to.
11584
11585 This is useful to precisely refer to a package, as in this example:
11586
11587 @example
11588 guix refresh -l -e '(@@@@ (gnu packages commencement) glibc-final)'
11589 @end example
11590
11591 This command lists the dependents of the ``final'' libc (essentially all
11592 the packages).
11593
11594 @item --update
11595 @itemx -u
11596 Update distribution source files (package recipes) in place. This is
11597 usually run from a checkout of the Guix source tree (@pxref{Running
11598 Guix Before It Is Installed}):
11599
11600 @example
11601 $ ./pre-inst-env guix refresh -s non-core -u
11602 @end example
11603
11604 @xref{Defining Packages}, for more information on package definitions.
11605
11606 @item --select=[@var{subset}]
11607 @itemx -s @var{subset}
11608 Select all the packages in @var{subset}, one of @code{core} or
11609 @code{non-core}.
11610
11611 The @code{core} subset refers to all the packages at the core of the
11612 distribution---i.e., packages that are used to build ``everything
11613 else''. This includes GCC, libc, Binutils, Bash, etc. Usually,
11614 changing one of these packages in the distribution entails a rebuild of
11615 all the others. Thus, such updates are an inconvenience to users in
11616 terms of build time or bandwidth used to achieve the upgrade.
11617
11618 The @code{non-core} subset refers to the remaining packages. It is
11619 typically useful in cases where an update of the core packages would be
11620 inconvenient.
11621
11622 @item --manifest=@var{file}
11623 @itemx -m @var{file}
11624 Select all the packages from the manifest in @var{file}. This is useful to
11625 check if any packages of the user manifest can be updated.
11626
11627 @item --type=@var{updater}
11628 @itemx -t @var{updater}
11629 Select only packages handled by @var{updater} (may be a comma-separated
11630 list of updaters). Currently, @var{updater} may be one of:
11631
11632 @table @code
11633 @item gnu
11634 the updater for GNU packages;
11635 @item savannah
11636 the updater for packages hosted at @uref{https://savannah.gnu.org, Savannah};
11637 @item gnome
11638 the updater for GNOME packages;
11639 @item kde
11640 the updater for KDE packages;
11641 @item xorg
11642 the updater for X.org packages;
11643 @item kernel.org
11644 the updater for packages hosted on kernel.org;
11645 @item elpa
11646 the updater for @uref{https://elpa.gnu.org/, ELPA} packages;
11647 @item cran
11648 the updater for @uref{https://cran.r-project.org/, CRAN} packages;
11649 @item bioconductor
11650 the updater for @uref{https://www.bioconductor.org/, Bioconductor} R packages;
11651 @item cpan
11652 the updater for @uref{https://www.cpan.org/, CPAN} packages;
11653 @item pypi
11654 the updater for @uref{https://pypi.python.org, PyPI} packages.
11655 @item gem
11656 the updater for @uref{https://rubygems.org, RubyGems} packages.
11657 @item github
11658 the updater for @uref{https://github.com, GitHub} packages.
11659 @item hackage
11660 the updater for @uref{https://hackage.haskell.org, Hackage} packages.
11661 @item stackage
11662 the updater for @uref{https://www.stackage.org, Stackage} packages.
11663 @item crate
11664 the updater for @uref{https://crates.io, Crates} packages.
11665 @item launchpad
11666 the updater for @uref{https://launchpad.net, Launchpad} packages.
11667 @end table
11668
11669 For instance, the following command only checks for updates of Emacs
11670 packages hosted at @code{elpa.gnu.org} and for updates of CRAN packages:
11671
11672 @example
11673 $ guix refresh --type=elpa,cran
11674 gnu/packages/statistics.scm:819:13: r-testthat would be upgraded from 0.10.0 to 0.11.0
11675 gnu/packages/emacs.scm:856:13: emacs-auctex would be upgraded from 11.88.6 to 11.88.9
11676 @end example
11677
11678 @end table
11679
11680 In addition, @command{guix refresh} can be passed one or more package
11681 names, as in this example:
11682
11683 @example
11684 $ ./pre-inst-env guix refresh -u emacs idutils gcc@@4.8
11685 @end example
11686
11687 @noindent
11688 The command above specifically updates the @code{emacs} and
11689 @code{idutils} packages. The @option{--select} option would have no
11690 effect in this case.
11691
11692 When considering whether to upgrade a package, it is sometimes
11693 convenient to know which packages would be affected by the upgrade and
11694 should be checked for compatibility. For this the following option may
11695 be used when passing @command{guix refresh} one or more package names:
11696
11697 @table @code
11698
11699 @item --list-updaters
11700 @itemx -L
11701 List available updaters and exit (see @option{--type} above).
11702
11703 For each updater, display the fraction of packages it covers; at the
11704 end, display the fraction of packages covered by all these updaters.
11705
11706 @item --list-dependent
11707 @itemx -l
11708 List top-level dependent packages that would need to be rebuilt as a
11709 result of upgrading one or more packages.
11710
11711 @xref{Invoking guix graph, the @code{reverse-package} type of
11712 @command{guix graph}}, for information on how to visualize the list of
11713 dependents of a package.
11714
11715 @end table
11716
11717 Be aware that the @option{--list-dependent} option only
11718 @emph{approximates} the rebuilds that would be required as a result of
11719 an upgrade. More rebuilds might be required under some circumstances.
11720
11721 @example
11722 $ guix refresh --list-dependent flex
11723 Building the following 120 packages would ensure 213 dependent packages are rebuilt:
11724 hop@@2.4.0 geiser@@0.4 notmuch@@0.18 mu@@0.9.9.5 cflow@@1.4 idutils@@4.6 @dots{}
11725 @end example
11726
11727 The command above lists a set of packages that could be built to check
11728 for compatibility with an upgraded @code{flex} package.
11729
11730 @table @code
11731
11732 @item --list-transitive
11733 List all the packages which one or more packages depend upon.
11734
11735 @example
11736 $ guix refresh --list-transitive flex
11737 flex@@2.6.4 depends on the following 25 packages: perl@@5.28.0 help2man@@1.47.6
11738 bison@@3.0.5 indent@@2.2.10 tar@@1.30 gzip@@1.9 bzip2@@1.0.6 xz@@5.2.4 file@@5.33 @dots{}
11739 @end example
11740
11741 @end table
11742
11743 The command above lists a set of packages which, when changed, would cause
11744 @code{flex} to be rebuilt.
11745
11746 The following options can be used to customize GnuPG operation:
11747
11748 @table @code
11749
11750 @item --gpg=@var{command}
11751 Use @var{command} as the GnuPG 2.x command. @var{command} is searched
11752 for in @code{$PATH}.
11753
11754 @item --keyring=@var{file}
11755 Use @var{file} as the keyring for upstream keys. @var{file} must be in the
11756 @dfn{keybox format}. Keybox files usually have a name ending in @file{.kbx}
11757 and the GNU@tie{}Privacy Guard (GPG) can manipulate these files
11758 (@pxref{kbxutil, @command{kbxutil},, gnupg, Using the GNU Privacy Guard}, for
11759 information on a tool to manipulate keybox files).
11760
11761 When this option is omitted, @command{guix refresh} uses
11762 @file{~/.config/guix/upstream/trustedkeys.kbx} as the keyring for upstream
11763 signing keys. OpenPGP signatures are checked against keys from this keyring;
11764 missing keys are downloaded to this keyring as well (see
11765 @option{--key-download} below).
11766
11767 You can export keys from your default GPG keyring into a keybox file using
11768 commands like this one:
11769
11770 @example
11771 gpg --export rms@@gnu.org | kbxutil --import-openpgp >> mykeyring.kbx
11772 @end example
11773
11774 Likewise, you can fetch keys to a specific keybox file like this:
11775
11776 @example
11777 gpg --no-default-keyring --keyring mykeyring.kbx \
11778 --recv-keys @value{OPENPGP-SIGNING-KEY-ID}
11779 @end example
11780
11781 @ref{GPG Configuration Options, @option{--keyring},, gnupg, Using the GNU
11782 Privacy Guard}, for more information on GPG's @option{--keyring} option.
11783
11784 @item --key-download=@var{policy}
11785 Handle missing OpenPGP keys according to @var{policy}, which may be one
11786 of:
11787
11788 @table @code
11789 @item always
11790 Always download missing OpenPGP keys from the key server, and add them
11791 to the user's GnuPG keyring.
11792
11793 @item never
11794 Never try to download missing OpenPGP keys. Instead just bail out.
11795
11796 @item interactive
11797 When a package signed with an unknown OpenPGP key is encountered, ask
11798 the user whether to download it or not. This is the default behavior.
11799 @end table
11800
11801 @item --key-server=@var{host}
11802 Use @var{host} as the OpenPGP key server when importing a public key.
11803
11804 @item --load-path=@var{directory}
11805 Add @var{directory} to the front of the package module search path
11806 (@pxref{Package Modules}).
11807
11808 This allows users to define their own packages and make them visible to
11809 the command-line tools.
11810
11811 @end table
11812
11813 The @code{github} updater uses the
11814 @uref{https://developer.github.com/v3/, GitHub API} to query for new
11815 releases. When used repeatedly e.g.@: when refreshing all packages,
11816 GitHub will eventually refuse to answer any further API requests. By
11817 default 60 API requests per hour are allowed, and a full refresh on all
11818 GitHub packages in Guix requires more than this. Authentication with
11819 GitHub through the use of an API token alleviates these limits. To use
11820 an API token, set the environment variable @env{GUIX_GITHUB_TOKEN} to a
11821 token procured from @uref{https://github.com/settings/tokens} or
11822 otherwise.
11823
11824
11825 @node Invoking guix lint
11826 @section Invoking @command{guix lint}
11827
11828 @cindex @command{guix lint}
11829 @cindex package, checking for errors
11830 The @command{guix lint} command is meant to help package developers avoid
11831 common errors and use a consistent style. It runs a number of checks on
11832 a given set of packages in order to find common mistakes in their
11833 definitions. Available @dfn{checkers} include (see
11834 @option{--list-checkers} for a complete list):
11835
11836 @table @code
11837 @item synopsis
11838 @itemx description
11839 Validate certain typographical and stylistic rules about package
11840 descriptions and synopses.
11841
11842 @item inputs-should-be-native
11843 Identify inputs that should most likely be native inputs.
11844
11845 @item source
11846 @itemx home-page
11847 @itemx mirror-url
11848 @itemx github-url
11849 @itemx source-file-name
11850 Probe @code{home-page} and @code{source} URLs and report those that are
11851 invalid. Suggest a @code{mirror://} URL when applicable. If the
11852 @code{source} URL redirects to a GitHub URL, recommend usage of the GitHub
11853 URL@. Check that the source file name is meaningful, e.g.@: is not just a
11854 version number or ``git-checkout'', without a declared @code{file-name}
11855 (@pxref{origin Reference}).
11856
11857 @item source-unstable-tarball
11858 Parse the @code{source} URL to determine if a tarball from GitHub is
11859 autogenerated or if it is a release tarball. Unfortunately GitHub's
11860 autogenerated tarballs are sometimes regenerated.
11861
11862 @item derivation
11863 Check that the derivation of the given packages can be successfully
11864 computed for all the supported systems (@pxref{Derivations}).
11865
11866 @item profile-collisions
11867 Check whether installing the given packages in a profile would lead to
11868 collisions. Collisions occur when several packages with the same name
11869 but a different version or a different store file name are propagated.
11870 @xref{package Reference, @code{propagated-inputs}}, for more information
11871 on propagated inputs.
11872
11873 @item archival
11874 @cindex Software Heritage, source code archive
11875 @cindex archival of source code, Software Heritage
11876 Checks whether the package's source code is archived at
11877 @uref{https://www.softwareheritage.org, Software Heritage}.
11878
11879 When the source code that is not archived comes from a version-control system
11880 (VCS)---e.g., it's obtained with @code{git-fetch}, send Software Heritage a
11881 ``save'' request so that it eventually archives it. This ensures that the
11882 source will remain available in the long term, and that Guix can fall back to
11883 Software Heritage should the source code disappear from its original host.
11884 The status of recent ``save'' requests can be
11885 @uref{https://archive.softwareheritage.org/save/#requests, viewed on-line}.
11886
11887 When source code is a tarball obtained with @code{url-fetch}, simply print a
11888 message when it is not archived. As of this writing, Software Heritage does
11889 not allow requests to save arbitrary tarballs; we are working on ways to
11890 ensure that non-VCS source code is also archived.
11891
11892 Software Heritage
11893 @uref{https://archive.softwareheritage.org/api/#rate-limiting, limits the
11894 request rate per IP address}. When the limit is reached, @command{guix lint}
11895 prints a message and the @code{archival} checker stops doing anything until
11896 that limit has been reset.
11897
11898 @item cve
11899 @cindex security vulnerabilities
11900 @cindex CVE, Common Vulnerabilities and Exposures
11901 Report known vulnerabilities found in the Common Vulnerabilities and
11902 Exposures (CVE) databases of the current and past year
11903 @uref{https://nvd.nist.gov/vuln/data-feeds, published by the US
11904 NIST}.
11905
11906 To view information about a particular vulnerability, visit pages such as:
11907
11908 @itemize
11909 @item
11910 @indicateurl{https://web.nvd.nist.gov/view/vuln/detail?vulnId=CVE-YYYY-ABCD}
11911 @item
11912 @indicateurl{https://cve.mitre.org/cgi-bin/cvename.cgi?name=CVE-YYYY-ABCD}
11913 @end itemize
11914
11915 @noindent
11916 where @code{CVE-YYYY-ABCD} is the CVE identifier---e.g.,
11917 @code{CVE-2015-7554}.
11918
11919 Package developers can specify in package recipes the
11920 @uref{https://nvd.nist.gov/products/cpe,Common Platform Enumeration (CPE)}
11921 name and version of the package when they differ from the name or version
11922 that Guix uses, as in this example:
11923
11924 @lisp
11925 (package
11926 (name "grub")
11927 ;; @dots{}
11928 ;; CPE calls this package "grub2".
11929 (properties '((cpe-name . "grub2")
11930 (cpe-version . "2.3"))))
11931 @end lisp
11932
11933 @c See <https://www.openwall.com/lists/oss-security/2017/03/15/3>.
11934 Some entries in the CVE database do not specify which version of a
11935 package they apply to, and would thus ``stick around'' forever. Package
11936 developers who found CVE alerts and verified they can be ignored can
11937 declare them as in this example:
11938
11939 @lisp
11940 (package
11941 (name "t1lib")
11942 ;; @dots{}
11943 ;; These CVEs no longer apply and can be safely ignored.
11944 (properties `((lint-hidden-cve . ("CVE-2011-0433"
11945 "CVE-2011-1553"
11946 "CVE-2011-1554"
11947 "CVE-2011-5244")))))
11948 @end lisp
11949
11950 @item formatting
11951 Warn about obvious source code formatting issues: trailing white space,
11952 use of tabulations, etc.
11953 @end table
11954
11955 The general syntax is:
11956
11957 @example
11958 guix lint @var{options} @var{package}@dots{}
11959 @end example
11960
11961 If no package is given on the command line, then all packages are checked.
11962 The @var{options} may be zero or more of the following:
11963
11964 @table @code
11965 @item --list-checkers
11966 @itemx -l
11967 List and describe all the available checkers that will be run on packages
11968 and exit.
11969
11970 @item --checkers
11971 @itemx -c
11972 Only enable the checkers specified in a comma-separated list using the
11973 names returned by @option{--list-checkers}.
11974
11975 @item --exclude
11976 @itemx -x
11977 Only disable the checkers specified in a comma-separated list using the
11978 names returned by @option{--list-checkers}.
11979
11980 @item --no-network
11981 @itemx -n
11982 Only enable the checkers that do not depend on Internet access.
11983
11984 @item --load-path=@var{directory}
11985 @itemx -L @var{directory}
11986 Add @var{directory} to the front of the package module search path
11987 (@pxref{Package Modules}).
11988
11989 This allows users to define their own packages and make them visible to
11990 the command-line tools.
11991
11992 @end table
11993
11994 @node Invoking guix size
11995 @section Invoking @command{guix size}
11996
11997 @cindex size
11998 @cindex package size
11999 @cindex closure
12000 @cindex @command{guix size}
12001 The @command{guix size} command helps package developers profile the
12002 disk usage of packages. It is easy to overlook the impact of an
12003 additional dependency added to a package, or the impact of using a
12004 single output for a package that could easily be split (@pxref{Packages
12005 with Multiple Outputs}). Such are the typical issues that
12006 @command{guix size} can highlight.
12007
12008 The command can be passed one or more package specifications
12009 such as @code{gcc@@4.8}
12010 or @code{guile:debug}, or a file name in the store. Consider this
12011 example:
12012
12013 @example
12014 $ guix size coreutils
12015 store item total self
12016 /gnu/store/@dots{}-gcc-5.5.0-lib 60.4 30.1 38.1%
12017 /gnu/store/@dots{}-glibc-2.27 30.3 28.8 36.6%
12018 /gnu/store/@dots{}-coreutils-8.28 78.9 15.0 19.0%
12019 /gnu/store/@dots{}-gmp-6.1.2 63.1 2.7 3.4%
12020 /gnu/store/@dots{}-bash-static-4.4.12 1.5 1.5 1.9%
12021 /gnu/store/@dots{}-acl-2.2.52 61.1 0.4 0.5%
12022 /gnu/store/@dots{}-attr-2.4.47 60.6 0.2 0.3%
12023 /gnu/store/@dots{}-libcap-2.25 60.5 0.2 0.2%
12024 total: 78.9 MiB
12025 @end example
12026
12027 @cindex closure
12028 The store items listed here constitute the @dfn{transitive closure} of
12029 Coreutils---i.e., Coreutils and all its dependencies, recursively---as
12030 would be returned by:
12031
12032 @example
12033 $ guix gc -R /gnu/store/@dots{}-coreutils-8.23
12034 @end example
12035
12036 Here the output shows three columns next to store items. The first column,
12037 labeled ``total'', shows the size in mebibytes (MiB) of the closure of
12038 the store item---that is, its own size plus the size of all its
12039 dependencies. The next column, labeled ``self'', shows the size of the
12040 item itself. The last column shows the ratio of the size of the item
12041 itself to the space occupied by all the items listed here.
12042
12043 In this example, we see that the closure of Coreutils weighs in at
12044 79@tie{}MiB, most of which is taken by libc and GCC's run-time support
12045 libraries. (That libc and GCC's libraries represent a large fraction of
12046 the closure is not a problem @i{per se} because they are always available
12047 on the system anyway.)
12048
12049 Since the command also accepts store file names, assessing the size of
12050 a build result is straightforward:
12051
12052 @example
12053 guix size $(guix system build config.scm)
12054 @end example
12055
12056 When the package(s) passed to @command{guix size} are available in the
12057 store@footnote{More precisely, @command{guix size} looks for the
12058 @emph{ungrafted} variant of the given package(s), as returned by
12059 @code{guix build @var{package} --no-grafts}. @xref{Security Updates},
12060 for information on grafts.}, @command{guix size} queries the daemon to determine its
12061 dependencies, and measures its size in the store, similar to @command{du
12062 -ms --apparent-size} (@pxref{du invocation,,, coreutils, GNU
12063 Coreutils}).
12064
12065 When the given packages are @emph{not} in the store, @command{guix size}
12066 reports information based on the available substitutes
12067 (@pxref{Substitutes}). This makes it possible it to profile disk usage of
12068 store items that are not even on disk, only available remotely.
12069
12070 You can also specify several package names:
12071
12072 @example
12073 $ guix size coreutils grep sed bash
12074 store item total self
12075 /gnu/store/@dots{}-coreutils-8.24 77.8 13.8 13.4%
12076 /gnu/store/@dots{}-grep-2.22 73.1 0.8 0.8%
12077 /gnu/store/@dots{}-bash-4.3.42 72.3 4.7 4.6%
12078 /gnu/store/@dots{}-readline-6.3 67.6 1.2 1.2%
12079 @dots{}
12080 total: 102.3 MiB
12081 @end example
12082
12083 @noindent
12084 In this example we see that the combination of the four packages takes
12085 102.3@tie{}MiB in total, which is much less than the sum of each closure
12086 since they have a lot of dependencies in common.
12087
12088 When looking at the profile returned by @command{guix size}, you may
12089 find yourself wondering why a given package shows up in the profile at
12090 all. To understand it, you can use @command{guix graph --path -t
12091 references} to display the shortest path between the two packages
12092 (@pxref{Invoking guix graph}).
12093
12094 The available options are:
12095
12096 @table @option
12097
12098 @item --substitute-urls=@var{urls}
12099 Use substitute information from @var{urls}.
12100 @xref{client-substitute-urls, the same option for @code{guix build}}.
12101
12102 @item --sort=@var{key}
12103 Sort lines according to @var{key}, one of the following options:
12104
12105 @table @code
12106 @item self
12107 the size of each item (the default);
12108 @item closure
12109 the total size of the item's closure.
12110 @end table
12111
12112 @item --map-file=@var{file}
12113 Write a graphical map of disk usage in PNG format to @var{file}.
12114
12115 For the example above, the map looks like this:
12116
12117 @image{images/coreutils-size-map,5in,, map of Coreutils disk usage
12118 produced by @command{guix size}}
12119
12120 This option requires that
12121 @uref{https://wingolog.org/software/guile-charting/, Guile-Charting} be
12122 installed and visible in Guile's module search path. When that is not
12123 the case, @command{guix size} fails as it tries to load it.
12124
12125 @item --system=@var{system}
12126 @itemx -s @var{system}
12127 Consider packages for @var{system}---e.g., @code{x86_64-linux}.
12128
12129 @item --load-path=@var{directory}
12130 @itemx -L @var{directory}
12131 Add @var{directory} to the front of the package module search path
12132 (@pxref{Package Modules}).
12133
12134 This allows users to define their own packages and make them visible to
12135 the command-line tools.
12136 @end table
12137
12138 @node Invoking guix graph
12139 @section Invoking @command{guix graph}
12140
12141 @cindex DAG
12142 @cindex @command{guix graph}
12143 @cindex package dependencies
12144 Packages and their dependencies form a @dfn{graph}, specifically a
12145 directed acyclic graph (DAG). It can quickly become difficult to have a
12146 mental model of the package DAG, so the @command{guix graph} command
12147 provides a visual representation of the DAG@. By default,
12148 @command{guix graph} emits a DAG representation in the input format of
12149 @uref{https://www.graphviz.org/, Graphviz}, so its output can be passed
12150 directly to the @command{dot} command of Graphviz. It can also emit an
12151 HTML page with embedded JavaScript code to display a ``chord diagram''
12152 in a Web browser, using the @uref{https://d3js.org/, d3.js} library, or
12153 emit Cypher queries to construct a graph in a graph database supporting
12154 the @uref{https://www.opencypher.org/, openCypher} query language. With
12155 @option{--path}, it simply displays the shortest path between two
12156 packages. The general syntax is:
12157
12158 @example
12159 guix graph @var{options} @var{package}@dots{}
12160 @end example
12161
12162 For example, the following command generates a PDF file representing the
12163 package DAG for the GNU@tie{}Core Utilities, showing its build-time
12164 dependencies:
12165
12166 @example
12167 guix graph coreutils | dot -Tpdf > dag.pdf
12168 @end example
12169
12170 The output looks like this:
12171
12172 @image{images/coreutils-graph,2in,,Dependency graph of the GNU Coreutils}
12173
12174 Nice little graph, no?
12175
12176 You may find it more pleasant to navigate the graph interactively with
12177 @command{xdot} (from the @code{xdot} package):
12178
12179 @example
12180 guix graph coreutils | xdot -
12181 @end example
12182
12183 But there is more than one graph! The one above is concise: it is the
12184 graph of package objects, omitting implicit inputs such as GCC, libc,
12185 grep, etc. It is often useful to have such a concise graph, but
12186 sometimes one may want to see more details. @command{guix graph} supports
12187 several types of graphs, allowing you to choose the level of detail:
12188
12189 @table @code
12190 @item package
12191 This is the default type used in the example above. It shows the DAG of
12192 package objects, excluding implicit dependencies. It is concise, but
12193 filters out many details.
12194
12195 @item reverse-package
12196 This shows the @emph{reverse} DAG of packages. For example:
12197
12198 @example
12199 guix graph --type=reverse-package ocaml
12200 @end example
12201
12202 ...@: yields the graph of packages that @emph{explicitly} depend on OCaml (if
12203 you are also interested in cases where OCaml is an implicit dependency, see
12204 @code{reverse-bag} below).
12205
12206 Note that for core packages this can yield huge graphs. If all you want
12207 is to know the number of packages that depend on a given package, use
12208 @command{guix refresh --list-dependent} (@pxref{Invoking guix refresh,
12209 @option{--list-dependent}}).
12210
12211 @item bag-emerged
12212 This is the package DAG, @emph{including} implicit inputs.
12213
12214 For instance, the following command:
12215
12216 @example
12217 guix graph --type=bag-emerged coreutils
12218 @end example
12219
12220 ...@: yields this bigger graph:
12221
12222 @image{images/coreutils-bag-graph,,5in,Detailed dependency graph of the GNU Coreutils}
12223
12224 At the bottom of the graph, we see all the implicit inputs of
12225 @var{gnu-build-system} (@pxref{Build Systems, @code{gnu-build-system}}).
12226
12227 Now, note that the dependencies of these implicit inputs---that is, the
12228 @dfn{bootstrap dependencies} (@pxref{Bootstrapping})---are not shown
12229 here, for conciseness.
12230
12231 @item bag
12232 Similar to @code{bag-emerged}, but this time including all the bootstrap
12233 dependencies.
12234
12235 @item bag-with-origins
12236 Similar to @code{bag}, but also showing origins and their dependencies.
12237
12238 @item reverse-bag
12239 This shows the @emph{reverse} DAG of packages. Unlike @code{reverse-package},
12240 it also takes implicit dependencies into account. For example:
12241
12242 @example
12243 guix graph -t reverse-bag dune
12244 @end example
12245
12246 @noindent
12247 ...@: yields the graph of all packages that depend on Dune, directly or
12248 indirectly. Since Dune is an @emph{implicit} dependency of many packages
12249 @i{via} @code{dune-build-system}, this shows a large number of packages,
12250 whereas @code{reverse-package} would show very few if any.
12251
12252 @item derivation
12253 This is the most detailed representation: It shows the DAG of
12254 derivations (@pxref{Derivations}) and plain store items. Compared to
12255 the above representation, many additional nodes are visible, including
12256 build scripts, patches, Guile modules, etc.
12257
12258 For this type of graph, it is also possible to pass a @file{.drv} file
12259 name instead of a package name, as in:
12260
12261 @example
12262 guix graph -t derivation `guix system build -d my-config.scm`
12263 @end example
12264
12265 @item module
12266 This is the graph of @dfn{package modules} (@pxref{Package Modules}).
12267 For example, the following command shows the graph for the package
12268 module that defines the @code{guile} package:
12269
12270 @example
12271 guix graph -t module guile | xdot -
12272 @end example
12273 @end table
12274
12275 All the types above correspond to @emph{build-time dependencies}. The
12276 following graph type represents the @emph{run-time dependencies}:
12277
12278 @table @code
12279 @item references
12280 This is the graph of @dfn{references} of a package output, as returned
12281 by @command{guix gc --references} (@pxref{Invoking guix gc}).
12282
12283 If the given package output is not available in the store, @command{guix
12284 graph} attempts to obtain dependency information from substitutes.
12285
12286 Here you can also pass a store file name instead of a package name. For
12287 example, the command below produces the reference graph of your profile
12288 (which can be big!):
12289
12290 @example
12291 guix graph -t references `readlink -f ~/.guix-profile`
12292 @end example
12293
12294 @item referrers
12295 This is the graph of the @dfn{referrers} of a store item, as returned by
12296 @command{guix gc --referrers} (@pxref{Invoking guix gc}).
12297
12298 This relies exclusively on local information from your store. For
12299 instance, let us suppose that the current Inkscape is available in 10
12300 profiles on your machine; @command{guix graph -t referrers inkscape}
12301 will show a graph rooted at Inkscape and with those 10 profiles linked
12302 to it.
12303
12304 It can help determine what is preventing a store item from being garbage
12305 collected.
12306
12307 @end table
12308
12309 @cindex shortest path, between packages
12310 Often, the graph of the package you are interested in does not fit on
12311 your screen, and anyway all you want to know is @emph{why} that package
12312 actually depends on some seemingly unrelated package. The
12313 @option{--path} option instructs @command{guix graph} to display the
12314 shortest path between two packages (or derivations, or store items,
12315 etc.):
12316
12317 @example
12318 $ guix graph --path emacs libunistring
12319 emacs@@26.3
12320 mailutils@@3.9
12321 libunistring@@0.9.10
12322 $ guix graph --path -t derivation emacs libunistring
12323 /gnu/store/@dots{}-emacs-26.3.drv
12324 /gnu/store/@dots{}-mailutils-3.9.drv
12325 /gnu/store/@dots{}-libunistring-0.9.10.drv
12326 $ guix graph --path -t references emacs libunistring
12327 /gnu/store/@dots{}-emacs-26.3
12328 /gnu/store/@dots{}-libidn2-2.2.0
12329 /gnu/store/@dots{}-libunistring-0.9.10
12330 @end example
12331
12332 The available options are the following:
12333
12334 @table @option
12335 @item --type=@var{type}
12336 @itemx -t @var{type}
12337 Produce a graph output of @var{type}, where @var{type} must be one of
12338 the values listed above.
12339
12340 @item --list-types
12341 List the supported graph types.
12342
12343 @item --backend=@var{backend}
12344 @itemx -b @var{backend}
12345 Produce a graph using the selected @var{backend}.
12346
12347 @item --list-backends
12348 List the supported graph backends.
12349
12350 Currently, the available backends are Graphviz and d3.js.
12351
12352 @item --path
12353 Display the shortest path between two nodes of the type specified by
12354 @option{--type}. The example below shows the shortest path between
12355 @code{libreoffice} and @code{llvm} according to the references of
12356 @code{libreoffice}:
12357
12358 @example
12359 $ guix graph --path -t references libreoffice llvm
12360 /gnu/store/@dots{}-libreoffice-6.4.2.2
12361 /gnu/store/@dots{}-libepoxy-1.5.4
12362 /gnu/store/@dots{}-mesa-19.3.4
12363 /gnu/store/@dots{}-llvm-9.0.1
12364 @end example
12365
12366 @item --expression=@var{expr}
12367 @itemx -e @var{expr}
12368 Consider the package @var{expr} evaluates to.
12369
12370 This is useful to precisely refer to a package, as in this example:
12371
12372 @example
12373 guix graph -e '(@@@@ (gnu packages commencement) gnu-make-final)'
12374 @end example
12375
12376 @item --system=@var{system}
12377 @itemx -s @var{system}
12378 Display the graph for @var{system}---e.g., @code{i686-linux}.
12379
12380 The package dependency graph is largely architecture-independent, but there
12381 are some architecture-dependent bits that this option allows you to visualize.
12382
12383 @item --load-path=@var{directory}
12384 @itemx -L @var{directory}
12385 Add @var{directory} to the front of the package module search path
12386 (@pxref{Package Modules}).
12387
12388 This allows users to define their own packages and make them visible to
12389 the command-line tools.
12390 @end table
12391
12392 On top of that, @command{guix graph} supports all the usual package
12393 transformation options (@pxref{Package Transformation Options}). This
12394 makes it easy to view the effect of a graph-rewriting transformation
12395 such as @option{--with-input}. For example, the command below outputs
12396 the graph of @code{git} once @code{openssl} has been replaced by
12397 @code{libressl} everywhere in the graph:
12398
12399 @example
12400 guix graph git --with-input=openssl=libressl
12401 @end example
12402
12403 So many possibilities, so much fun!
12404
12405 @node Invoking guix publish
12406 @section Invoking @command{guix publish}
12407
12408 @cindex @command{guix publish}
12409 The purpose of @command{guix publish} is to enable users to easily share
12410 their store with others, who can then use it as a substitute server
12411 (@pxref{Substitutes}).
12412
12413 When @command{guix publish} runs, it spawns an HTTP server which allows
12414 anyone with network access to obtain substitutes from it. This means
12415 that any machine running Guix can also act as if it were a build farm,
12416 since the HTTP interface is compatible with Cuirass, the software behind
12417 the @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}} build farm.
12418
12419 For security, each substitute is signed, allowing recipients to check
12420 their authenticity and integrity (@pxref{Substitutes}). Because
12421 @command{guix publish} uses the signing key of the system, which is only
12422 readable by the system administrator, it must be started as root; the
12423 @option{--user} option makes it drop root privileges early on.
12424
12425 The signing key pair must be generated before @command{guix publish} is
12426 launched, using @command{guix archive --generate-key} (@pxref{Invoking
12427 guix archive}).
12428
12429 When the @option{--advertise} option is passed, the server advertises
12430 its availability on the local network using multicast DNS (mDNS) and DNS
12431 service discovery (DNS-SD), currently @i{via} Guile-Avahi (@pxref{Top,,,
12432 guile-avahi, Using Avahi in Guile Scheme Programs}).
12433
12434 The general syntax is:
12435
12436 @example
12437 guix publish @var{options}@dots{}
12438 @end example
12439
12440 Running @command{guix publish} without any additional arguments will
12441 spawn an HTTP server on port 8080:
12442
12443 @example
12444 guix publish
12445 @end example
12446
12447 Once a publishing server has been authorized, the daemon may download
12448 substitutes from it. @xref{Getting Substitutes from Other Servers}.
12449
12450 By default, @command{guix publish} compresses archives on the fly as it
12451 serves them. This ``on-the-fly'' mode is convenient in that it requires
12452 no setup and is immediately available. However, when serving lots of
12453 clients, we recommend using the @option{--cache} option, which enables
12454 caching of the archives before they are sent to clients---see below for
12455 details. The @command{guix weather} command provides a handy way to
12456 check what a server provides (@pxref{Invoking guix weather}).
12457
12458 As a bonus, @command{guix publish} also serves as a content-addressed
12459 mirror for source files referenced in @code{origin} records
12460 (@pxref{origin Reference}). For instance, assuming @command{guix
12461 publish} is running on @code{example.org}, the following URL returns the
12462 raw @file{hello-2.10.tar.gz} file with the given SHA256 hash
12463 (represented in @code{nix-base32} format, @pxref{Invoking guix hash}):
12464
12465 @example
12466 http://example.org/file/hello-2.10.tar.gz/sha256/0ssi1@dots{}ndq1i
12467 @end example
12468
12469 Obviously, these URLs only work for files that are in the store; in
12470 other cases, they return 404 (``Not Found'').
12471
12472 @cindex build logs, publication
12473 Build logs are available from @code{/log} URLs like:
12474
12475 @example
12476 http://example.org/log/gwspk@dots{}-guile-2.2.3
12477 @end example
12478
12479 @noindent
12480 When @command{guix-daemon} is configured to save compressed build logs,
12481 as is the case by default (@pxref{Invoking guix-daemon}), @code{/log}
12482 URLs return the compressed log as-is, with an appropriate
12483 @code{Content-Type} and/or @code{Content-Encoding} header. We recommend
12484 running @command{guix-daemon} with @option{--log-compression=gzip} since
12485 Web browsers can automatically decompress it, which is not the case with
12486 Bzip2 compression.
12487
12488 The following options are available:
12489
12490 @table @code
12491 @item --port=@var{port}
12492 @itemx -p @var{port}
12493 Listen for HTTP requests on @var{port}.
12494
12495 @item --listen=@var{host}
12496 Listen on the network interface for @var{host}. The default is to
12497 accept connections from any interface.
12498
12499 @item --user=@var{user}
12500 @itemx -u @var{user}
12501 Change privileges to @var{user} as soon as possible---i.e., once the
12502 server socket is open and the signing key has been read.
12503
12504 @item --compression[=@var{method}[:@var{level}]]
12505 @itemx -C [@var{method}[:@var{level}]]
12506 Compress data using the given @var{method} and @var{level}. @var{method} is
12507 one of @code{lzip}, @code{zstd}, and @code{gzip}; when @var{method} is
12508 omitted, @code{gzip} is used.
12509
12510 When @var{level} is zero, disable compression. The range 1 to 9 corresponds
12511 to different compression levels: 1 is the fastest, and 9 is the best
12512 (CPU-intensive). The default is 3.
12513
12514 Usually, @code{lzip} compresses noticeably better than @code{gzip} for a
12515 small increase in CPU usage; see
12516 @uref{https://nongnu.org/lzip/lzip_benchmark.html,benchmarks on the lzip
12517 Web page}. However, @code{lzip} achieves low decompression throughput
12518 (on the order of 50@tie{}MiB/s on modern hardware), which can be a
12519 bottleneck for someone who downloads over a fast network connection.
12520
12521 The compression ratio of @code{zstd} is between that of @code{lzip} and
12522 that of @code{gzip}; its main advantage is a
12523 @uref{https://facebook.github.io/zstd/,high decompression speed}.
12524
12525 Unless @option{--cache} is used, compression occurs on the fly and
12526 the compressed streams are not
12527 cached. Thus, to reduce load on the machine that runs @command{guix
12528 publish}, it may be a good idea to choose a low compression level, to
12529 run @command{guix publish} behind a caching proxy, or to use
12530 @option{--cache}. Using @option{--cache} has the advantage that it
12531 allows @command{guix publish} to add @code{Content-Length} HTTP header
12532 to its responses.
12533
12534 This option can be repeated, in which case every substitute gets compressed
12535 using all the selected methods, and all of them are advertised. This is
12536 useful when users may not support all the compression methods: they can select
12537 the one they support.
12538
12539 @item --cache=@var{directory}
12540 @itemx -c @var{directory}
12541 Cache archives and meta-data (@code{.narinfo} URLs) to @var{directory}
12542 and only serve archives that are in cache.
12543
12544 When this option is omitted, archives and meta-data are created
12545 on-the-fly. This can reduce the available bandwidth, especially when
12546 compression is enabled, since this may become CPU-bound. Another
12547 drawback of the default mode is that the length of archives is not known
12548 in advance, so @command{guix publish} does not add a
12549 @code{Content-Length} HTTP header to its responses, which in turn
12550 prevents clients from knowing the amount of data being downloaded.
12551
12552 Conversely, when @option{--cache} is used, the first request for a store
12553 item (@i{via} a @code{.narinfo} URL) triggers a
12554 background process to @dfn{bake} the archive---computing its
12555 @code{.narinfo} and compressing the archive, if needed. Once the
12556 archive is cached in @var{directory}, subsequent requests succeed and
12557 are served directly from the cache, which guarantees that clients get
12558 the best possible bandwidth.
12559
12560 That first @code{.narinfo} request nonetheless returns 200, provided the
12561 requested store item is ``small enough'', below the cache bypass
12562 threshold---see @option{--cache-bypass-threshold} below. That way,
12563 clients do not have to wait until the archive is baked. For larger
12564 store items, the first @code{.narinfo} request returns 404, meaning that
12565 clients have to wait until the archive is baked.
12566
12567 The ``baking'' process is performed by worker threads. By default, one
12568 thread per CPU core is created, but this can be customized. See
12569 @option{--workers} below.
12570
12571 When @option{--ttl} is used, cached entries are automatically deleted
12572 when they have expired.
12573
12574 @item --workers=@var{N}
12575 When @option{--cache} is used, request the allocation of @var{N} worker
12576 threads to ``bake'' archives.
12577
12578 @item --ttl=@var{ttl}
12579 Produce @code{Cache-Control} HTTP headers that advertise a time-to-live
12580 (TTL) of @var{ttl}. @var{ttl} must denote a duration: @code{5d} means 5
12581 days, @code{1m} means 1 month, and so on.
12582
12583 This allows the user's Guix to keep substitute information in cache for
12584 @var{ttl}. However, note that @code{guix publish} does not itself
12585 guarantee that the store items it provides will indeed remain available
12586 for as long as @var{ttl}.
12587
12588 Additionally, when @option{--cache} is used, cached entries that have
12589 not been accessed for @var{ttl} and that no longer have a corresponding
12590 item in the store, may be deleted.
12591
12592 @item --cache-bypass-threshold=@var{size}
12593 When used in conjunction with @option{--cache}, store items smaller than
12594 @var{size} are immediately available, even when they are not yet in
12595 cache. @var{size} is a size in bytes, or it can be suffixed by @code{M}
12596 for megabytes and so on. The default is @code{10M}.
12597
12598 ``Cache bypass'' allows you to reduce the publication delay for clients
12599 at the expense of possibly additional I/O and CPU use on the server
12600 side: depending on the client access patterns, those store items can end
12601 up being baked several times until a copy is available in cache.
12602
12603 Increasing the threshold may be useful for sites that have few users, or
12604 to guarantee that users get substitutes even for store items that are
12605 not popular.
12606
12607 @item --nar-path=@var{path}
12608 Use @var{path} as the prefix for the URLs of ``nar'' files
12609 (@pxref{Invoking guix archive, normalized archives}).
12610
12611 By default, nars are served at a URL such as
12612 @code{/nar/gzip/@dots{}-coreutils-8.25}. This option allows you to
12613 change the @code{/nar} part to @var{path}.
12614
12615 @item --public-key=@var{file}
12616 @itemx --private-key=@var{file}
12617 Use the specific @var{file}s as the public/private key pair used to sign
12618 the store items being published.
12619
12620 The files must correspond to the same key pair (the private key is used
12621 for signing and the public key is merely advertised in the signature
12622 metadata). They must contain keys in the canonical s-expression format
12623 as produced by @command{guix archive --generate-key} (@pxref{Invoking
12624 guix archive}). By default, @file{/etc/guix/signing-key.pub} and
12625 @file{/etc/guix/signing-key.sec} are used.
12626
12627 @item --repl[=@var{port}]
12628 @itemx -r [@var{port}]
12629 Spawn a Guile REPL server (@pxref{REPL Servers,,, guile, GNU Guile
12630 Reference Manual}) on @var{port} (37146 by default). This is used
12631 primarily for debugging a running @command{guix publish} server.
12632 @end table
12633
12634 Enabling @command{guix publish} on Guix System is a one-liner: just
12635 instantiate a @code{guix-publish-service-type} service in the @code{services} field
12636 of the @code{operating-system} declaration (@pxref{guix-publish-service-type,
12637 @code{guix-publish-service-type}}).
12638
12639 If you are instead running Guix on a ``foreign distro'', follow these
12640 instructions:
12641
12642 @itemize
12643 @item
12644 If your host distro uses the systemd init system:
12645
12646 @example
12647 # ln -s ~root/.guix-profile/lib/systemd/system/guix-publish.service \
12648 /etc/systemd/system/
12649 # systemctl start guix-publish && systemctl enable guix-publish
12650 @end example
12651
12652 @item
12653 If your host distro uses the Upstart init system:
12654
12655 @example
12656 # ln -s ~root/.guix-profile/lib/upstart/system/guix-publish.conf /etc/init/
12657 # start guix-publish
12658 @end example
12659
12660 @item
12661 Otherwise, proceed similarly with your distro's init system.
12662 @end itemize
12663
12664 @node Invoking guix challenge
12665 @section Invoking @command{guix challenge}
12666
12667 @cindex reproducible builds
12668 @cindex verifiable builds
12669 @cindex @command{guix challenge}
12670 @cindex challenge
12671 Do the binaries provided by this server really correspond to the source
12672 code it claims to build? Is a package build process deterministic?
12673 These are the questions the @command{guix challenge} command attempts to
12674 answer.
12675
12676 The former is obviously an important question: Before using a substitute
12677 server (@pxref{Substitutes}), one had better @emph{verify} that it
12678 provides the right binaries, and thus @emph{challenge} it. The latter
12679 is what enables the former: If package builds are deterministic, then
12680 independent builds of the package should yield the exact same result,
12681 bit for bit; if a server provides a binary different from the one
12682 obtained locally, it may be either corrupt or malicious.
12683
12684 We know that the hash that shows up in @file{/gnu/store} file names is
12685 the hash of all the inputs of the process that built the file or
12686 directory---compilers, libraries, build scripts,
12687 etc. (@pxref{Introduction}). Assuming deterministic build processes,
12688 one store file name should map to exactly one build output.
12689 @command{guix challenge} checks whether there is, indeed, a single
12690 mapping by comparing the build outputs of several independent builds of
12691 any given store item.
12692
12693 The command output looks like this:
12694
12695 @smallexample
12696 $ guix challenge --substitute-urls="https://@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER} https://guix.example.org"
12697 updating list of substitutes from 'https://@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}'... 100.0%
12698 updating list of substitutes from 'https://guix.example.org'... 100.0%
12699 /gnu/store/@dots{}-openssl-1.0.2d contents differ:
12700 local hash: 0725l22r5jnzazaacncwsvp9kgf42266ayyp814v7djxs7nk963q
12701 https://@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}/nar/@dots{}-openssl-1.0.2d: 0725l22r5jnzazaacncwsvp9kgf42266ayyp814v7djxs7nk963q
12702 https://guix.example.org/nar/@dots{}-openssl-1.0.2d: 1zy4fmaaqcnjrzzajkdn3f5gmjk754b43qkq47llbyak9z0qjyim
12703 differing files:
12704 /lib/libcrypto.so.1.1
12705 /lib/libssl.so.1.1
12706
12707 /gnu/store/@dots{}-git-2.5.0 contents differ:
12708 local hash: 00p3bmryhjxrhpn2gxs2fy0a15lnip05l97205pgbk5ra395hyha
12709 https://@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}/nar/@dots{}-git-2.5.0: 069nb85bv4d4a6slrwjdy8v1cn4cwspm3kdbmyb81d6zckj3nq9f
12710 https://guix.example.org/nar/@dots{}-git-2.5.0: 0mdqa9w1p6cmli6976v4wi0sw9r4p5prkj7lzfd1877wk11c9c73
12711 differing file:
12712 /libexec/git-core/git-fsck
12713
12714 /gnu/store/@dots{}-pius-2.1.1 contents differ:
12715 local hash: 0k4v3m9z1zp8xzzizb7d8kjj72f9172xv078sq4wl73vnq9ig3ax
12716 https://@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}/nar/@dots{}-pius-2.1.1: 0k4v3m9z1zp8xzzizb7d8kjj72f9172xv078sq4wl73vnq9ig3ax
12717 https://guix.example.org/nar/@dots{}-pius-2.1.1: 1cy25x1a4fzq5rk0pmvc8xhwyffnqz95h2bpvqsz2mpvlbccy0gs
12718 differing file:
12719 /share/man/man1/pius.1.gz
12720
12721 @dots{}
12722
12723 6,406 store items were analyzed:
12724 - 4,749 (74.1%) were identical
12725 - 525 (8.2%) differed
12726 - 1,132 (17.7%) were inconclusive
12727 @end smallexample
12728
12729 @noindent
12730 In this example, @command{guix challenge} first scans the store to
12731 determine the set of locally-built derivations---as opposed to store
12732 items that were downloaded from a substitute server---and then queries
12733 all the substitute servers. It then reports those store items for which
12734 the servers obtained a result different from the local build.
12735
12736 @cindex non-determinism, in package builds
12737 As an example, @code{guix.example.org} always gets a different answer.
12738 Conversely, @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}} agrees with local builds, except in the
12739 case of Git. This might indicate that the build process of Git is
12740 non-deterministic, meaning that its output varies as a function of
12741 various things that Guix does not fully control, in spite of building
12742 packages in isolated environments (@pxref{Features}). Most common
12743 sources of non-determinism include the addition of timestamps in build
12744 results, the inclusion of random numbers, and directory listings sorted
12745 by inode number. See @uref{https://reproducible-builds.org/docs/}, for
12746 more information.
12747
12748 To find out what is wrong with this Git binary, the easiest approach is
12749 to run:
12750
12751 @example
12752 guix challenge git \
12753 --diff=diffoscope \
12754 --substitute-urls="https://@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER} https://guix.example.org"
12755 @end example
12756
12757 This automatically invokes @command{diffoscope}, which displays detailed
12758 information about files that differ.
12759
12760 Alternatively, we can do something along these lines (@pxref{Invoking guix
12761 archive}):
12762
12763 @example
12764 $ wget -q -O - https://@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}/nar/lzip/@dots{}-git-2.5.0 \
12765 | lzip -d | guix archive -x /tmp/git
12766 $ diff -ur --no-dereference /gnu/store/@dots{}-git.2.5.0 /tmp/git
12767 @end example
12768
12769 This command shows the difference between the files resulting from the
12770 local build, and the files resulting from the build on
12771 @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}} (@pxref{Overview, Comparing and Merging Files,,
12772 diffutils, Comparing and Merging Files}). The @command{diff} command
12773 works great for text files. When binary files differ, a better option
12774 is @uref{https://diffoscope.org/, Diffoscope}, a tool that helps
12775 visualize differences for all kinds of files.
12776
12777 Once you have done that work, you can tell whether the differences are due
12778 to a non-deterministic build process or to a malicious server. We try
12779 hard to remove sources of non-determinism in packages to make it easier
12780 to verify substitutes, but of course, this is a process that
12781 involves not just Guix, but a large part of the free software community.
12782 In the meantime, @command{guix challenge} is one tool to help address
12783 the problem.
12784
12785 If you are writing packages for Guix, you are encouraged to check
12786 whether @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}} and other substitute servers obtain the
12787 same build result as you did with:
12788
12789 @example
12790 $ guix challenge @var{package}
12791 @end example
12792
12793 @noindent
12794 where @var{package} is a package specification such as
12795 @code{guile@@2.0} or @code{glibc:debug}.
12796
12797 The general syntax is:
12798
12799 @example
12800 guix challenge @var{options} [@var{packages}@dots{}]
12801 @end example
12802
12803 When a difference is found between the hash of a locally-built item and
12804 that of a server-provided substitute, or among substitutes provided by
12805 different servers, the command displays it as in the example above and
12806 its exit code is 2 (other non-zero exit codes denote other kinds of
12807 errors).
12808
12809 The one option that matters is:
12810
12811 @table @code
12812
12813 @item --substitute-urls=@var{urls}
12814 Consider @var{urls} the whitespace-separated list of substitute source
12815 URLs to compare to.
12816
12817 @item --diff=@var{mode}
12818 Upon mismatches, show differences according to @var{mode}, one of:
12819
12820 @table @asis
12821 @item @code{simple} (the default)
12822 Show the list of files that differ.
12823
12824 @item @code{diffoscope}
12825 @itemx @var{command}
12826 Invoke @uref{https://diffoscope.org/, Diffoscope}, passing it
12827 two directories whose contents do not match.
12828
12829 When @var{command} is an absolute file name, run @var{command} instead
12830 of Diffoscope.
12831
12832 @item @code{none}
12833 Do not show further details about the differences.
12834 @end table
12835
12836 Thus, unless @option{--diff=none} is passed, @command{guix challenge}
12837 downloads the store items from the given substitute servers so that it
12838 can compare them.
12839
12840 @item --verbose
12841 @itemx -v
12842 Show details about matches (identical contents) in addition to
12843 information about mismatches.
12844
12845 @end table
12846
12847 @node Invoking guix copy
12848 @section Invoking @command{guix copy}
12849
12850 @cindex copy, of store items, over SSH
12851 @cindex SSH, copy of store items
12852 @cindex sharing store items across machines
12853 @cindex transferring store items across machines
12854 The @command{guix copy} command copies items from the store of one
12855 machine to that of another machine over a secure shell (SSH)
12856 connection@footnote{This command is available only when Guile-SSH was
12857 found. @xref{Requirements}, for details.}. For example, the following
12858 command copies the @code{coreutils} package, the user's profile, and all
12859 their dependencies over to @var{host}, logged in as @var{user}:
12860
12861 @example
12862 guix copy --to=@var{user}@@@var{host} \
12863 coreutils `readlink -f ~/.guix-profile`
12864 @end example
12865
12866 If some of the items to be copied are already present on @var{host},
12867 they are not actually sent.
12868
12869 The command below retrieves @code{libreoffice} and @code{gimp} from
12870 @var{host}, assuming they are available there:
12871
12872 @example
12873 guix copy --from=@var{host} libreoffice gimp
12874 @end example
12875
12876 The SSH connection is established using the Guile-SSH client, which is
12877 compatible with OpenSSH: it honors @file{~/.ssh/known_hosts} and
12878 @file{~/.ssh/config}, and uses the SSH agent for authentication.
12879
12880 The key used to sign items that are sent must be accepted by the remote
12881 machine. Likewise, the key used by the remote machine to sign items you
12882 are retrieving must be in @file{/etc/guix/acl} so it is accepted by your
12883 own daemon. @xref{Invoking guix archive}, for more information about
12884 store item authentication.
12885
12886 The general syntax is:
12887
12888 @example
12889 guix copy [--to=@var{spec}|--from=@var{spec}] @var{items}@dots{}
12890 @end example
12891
12892 You must always specify one of the following options:
12893
12894 @table @code
12895 @item --to=@var{spec}
12896 @itemx --from=@var{spec}
12897 Specify the host to send to or receive from. @var{spec} must be an SSH
12898 spec such as @code{example.org}, @code{charlie@@example.org}, or
12899 @code{charlie@@example.org:2222}.
12900 @end table
12901
12902 The @var{items} can be either package names, such as @code{gimp}, or
12903 store items, such as @file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-idutils-4.6}.
12904
12905 When specifying the name of a package to send, it is first built if
12906 needed, unless @option{--dry-run} was specified. Common build options
12907 are supported (@pxref{Common Build Options}).
12908
12909
12910 @node Invoking guix container
12911 @section Invoking @command{guix container}
12912 @cindex container
12913 @cindex @command{guix container}
12914 @quotation Note
12915 As of version @value{VERSION}, this tool is experimental. The interface
12916 is subject to radical change in the future.
12917 @end quotation
12918
12919 The purpose of @command{guix container} is to manipulate processes
12920 running within an isolated environment, commonly known as a
12921 ``container'', typically created by the @command{guix environment}
12922 (@pxref{Invoking guix environment}) and @command{guix system container}
12923 (@pxref{Invoking guix system}) commands.
12924
12925 The general syntax is:
12926
12927 @example
12928 guix container @var{action} @var{options}@dots{}
12929 @end example
12930
12931 @var{action} specifies the operation to perform with a container, and
12932 @var{options} specifies the context-specific arguments for the action.
12933
12934 The following actions are available:
12935
12936 @table @code
12937 @item exec
12938 Execute a command within the context of a running container.
12939
12940 The syntax is:
12941
12942 @example
12943 guix container exec @var{pid} @var{program} @var{arguments}@dots{}
12944 @end example
12945
12946 @var{pid} specifies the process ID of the running container.
12947 @var{program} specifies an executable file name within the root file
12948 system of the container. @var{arguments} are the additional options that
12949 will be passed to @var{program}.
12950
12951 The following command launches an interactive login shell inside a
12952 Guix system container, started by @command{guix system container}, and whose
12953 process ID is 9001:
12954
12955 @example
12956 guix container exec 9001 /run/current-system/profile/bin/bash --login
12957 @end example
12958
12959 Note that the @var{pid} cannot be the parent process of a container. It
12960 must be PID 1 of the container or one of its child processes.
12961
12962 @end table
12963
12964 @node Invoking guix weather
12965 @section Invoking @command{guix weather}
12966
12967 Occasionally you're grumpy because substitutes are lacking and you end
12968 up building packages by yourself (@pxref{Substitutes}). The
12969 @command{guix weather} command reports on substitute availability on the
12970 specified servers so you can have an idea of whether you'll be grumpy
12971 today. It can sometimes be useful info as a user, but it is primarily
12972 useful to people running @command{guix publish} (@pxref{Invoking guix
12973 publish}).
12974
12975 @cindex statistics, for substitutes
12976 @cindex availability of substitutes
12977 @cindex substitute availability
12978 @cindex weather, substitute availability
12979 Here's a sample run:
12980
12981 @example
12982 $ guix weather --substitute-urls=https://guix.example.org
12983 computing 5,872 package derivations for x86_64-linux...
12984 looking for 6,128 store items on https://guix.example.org..
12985 updating list of substitutes from 'https://guix.example.org'... 100.0%
12986 https://guix.example.org
12987 43.4% substitutes available (2,658 out of 6,128)
12988 7,032.5 MiB of nars (compressed)
12989 19,824.2 MiB on disk (uncompressed)
12990 0.030 seconds per request (182.9 seconds in total)
12991 33.5 requests per second
12992
12993 9.8% (342 out of 3,470) of the missing items are queued
12994 867 queued builds
12995 x86_64-linux: 518 (59.7%)
12996 i686-linux: 221 (25.5%)
12997 aarch64-linux: 128 (14.8%)
12998 build rate: 23.41 builds per hour
12999 x86_64-linux: 11.16 builds per hour
13000 i686-linux: 6.03 builds per hour
13001 aarch64-linux: 6.41 builds per hour
13002 @end example
13003
13004 @cindex continuous integration, statistics
13005 As you can see, it reports the fraction of all the packages for which
13006 substitutes are available on the server---regardless of whether
13007 substitutes are enabled, and regardless of whether this server's signing
13008 key is authorized. It also reports the size of the compressed archives
13009 (``nars'') provided by the server, the size the corresponding store
13010 items occupy in the store (assuming deduplication is turned off), and
13011 the server's throughput. The second part gives continuous integration
13012 (CI) statistics, if the server supports it. In addition, using the
13013 @option{--coverage} option, @command{guix weather} can list ``important''
13014 package substitutes missing on the server (see below).
13015
13016 To achieve that, @command{guix weather} queries over HTTP(S) meta-data
13017 (@dfn{narinfos}) for all the relevant store items. Like @command{guix
13018 challenge}, it ignores signatures on those substitutes, which is
13019 innocuous since the command only gathers statistics and cannot install
13020 those substitutes.
13021
13022 The general syntax is:
13023
13024 @example
13025 guix weather @var{options}@dots{} [@var{packages}@dots{}]
13026 @end example
13027
13028 When @var{packages} is omitted, @command{guix weather} checks the availability
13029 of substitutes for @emph{all} the packages, or for those specified with
13030 @option{--manifest}; otherwise it only considers the specified packages. It
13031 is also possible to query specific system types with @option{--system}.
13032 @command{guix weather} exits with a non-zero code when the fraction of
13033 available substitutes is below 100%.
13034
13035 The available options are listed below.
13036
13037 @table @code
13038 @item --substitute-urls=@var{urls}
13039 @var{urls} is the space-separated list of substitute server URLs to
13040 query. When this option is omitted, the default set of substitute
13041 servers is queried.
13042
13043 @item --system=@var{system}
13044 @itemx -s @var{system}
13045 Query substitutes for @var{system}---e.g., @code{aarch64-linux}. This
13046 option can be repeated, in which case @command{guix weather} will query
13047 substitutes for several system types.
13048
13049 @item --manifest=@var{file}
13050 Instead of querying substitutes for all the packages, only ask for those
13051 specified in @var{file}. @var{file} must contain a @dfn{manifest}, as
13052 with the @code{-m} option of @command{guix package} (@pxref{Invoking
13053 guix package}).
13054
13055 This option can be repeated several times, in which case the manifests
13056 are concatenated.
13057
13058 @item --coverage[=@var{count}]
13059 @itemx -c [@var{count}]
13060 Report on substitute coverage for packages: list packages with at least
13061 @var{count} dependents (zero by default) for which substitutes are
13062 unavailable. Dependent packages themselves are not listed: if @var{b} depends
13063 on @var{a} and @var{a} has no substitutes, only @var{a} is listed, even though
13064 @var{b} usually lacks substitutes as well. The result looks like this:
13065
13066 @example
13067 $ guix weather --substitute-urls=@value{SUBSTITUTE-URL} -c 10
13068 computing 8,983 package derivations for x86_64-linux...
13069 looking for 9,343 store items on @value{SUBSTITUTE-URL}...
13070 updating substitutes from '@value{SUBSTITUTE-URL}'... 100.0%
13071 @value{SUBSTITUTE-URL}
13072 64.7% substitutes available (6,047 out of 9,343)
13073 @dots{}
13074 2502 packages are missing from '@value{SUBSTITUTE-URL}' for 'x86_64-linux', among which:
13075 58 kcoreaddons@@5.49.0 /gnu/store/@dots{}-kcoreaddons-5.49.0
13076 46 qgpgme@@1.11.1 /gnu/store/@dots{}-qgpgme-1.11.1
13077 37 perl-http-cookiejar@@0.008 /gnu/store/@dots{}-perl-http-cookiejar-0.008
13078 @dots{}
13079 @end example
13080
13081 What this example shows is that @code{kcoreaddons} and presumably the 58
13082 packages that depend on it have no substitutes at
13083 @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}}; likewise for @code{qgpgme} and the 46
13084 packages that depend on it.
13085
13086 If you are a Guix developer, or if you are taking care of this build farm,
13087 you'll probably want to have a closer look at these packages: they may simply
13088 fail to build.
13089
13090 @item --display-missing
13091 Display the list of store items for which substitutes are missing.
13092 @end table
13093
13094 @node Invoking guix processes
13095 @section Invoking @command{guix processes}
13096
13097 The @command{guix processes} command can be useful to developers and system
13098 administrators, especially on multi-user machines and on build farms: it lists
13099 the current sessions (connections to the daemon), as well as information about
13100 the processes involved@footnote{Remote sessions, when @command{guix-daemon} is
13101 started with @option{--listen} specifying a TCP endpoint, are @emph{not}
13102 listed.}. Here's an example of the information it returns:
13103
13104 @example
13105 $ sudo guix processes
13106 SessionPID: 19002
13107 ClientPID: 19090
13108 ClientCommand: guix environment --ad-hoc python
13109
13110 SessionPID: 19402
13111 ClientPID: 19367
13112 ClientCommand: guix publish -u guix-publish -p 3000 -C 9 @dots{}
13113
13114 SessionPID: 19444
13115 ClientPID: 19419
13116 ClientCommand: cuirass --cache-directory /var/cache/cuirass @dots{}
13117 LockHeld: /gnu/store/@dots{}-perl-ipc-cmd-0.96.lock
13118 LockHeld: /gnu/store/@dots{}-python-six-bootstrap-1.11.0.lock
13119 LockHeld: /gnu/store/@dots{}-libjpeg-turbo-2.0.0.lock
13120 ChildPID: 20495
13121 ChildCommand: guix offload x86_64-linux 7200 1 28800
13122 ChildPID: 27733
13123 ChildCommand: guix offload x86_64-linux 7200 1 28800
13124 ChildPID: 27793
13125 ChildCommand: guix offload x86_64-linux 7200 1 28800
13126 @end example
13127
13128 In this example we see that @command{guix-daemon} has three clients:
13129 @command{guix environment}, @command{guix publish}, and the Cuirass continuous
13130 integration tool; their process identifier (PID) is given by the
13131 @code{ClientPID} field. The @code{SessionPID} field gives the PID of the
13132 @command{guix-daemon} sub-process of this particular session.
13133
13134 The @code{LockHeld} fields show which store items are currently locked
13135 by this session, which corresponds to store items being built or
13136 substituted (the @code{LockHeld} field is not displayed when
13137 @command{guix processes} is not running as root). Last, by looking at
13138 the @code{ChildPID} and @code{ChildCommand} fields, we understand that
13139 these three builds are being offloaded (@pxref{Daemon Offload Setup}).
13140
13141 The output is in Recutils format so we can use the handy @command{recsel}
13142 command to select sessions of interest (@pxref{Selection Expressions,,,
13143 recutils, GNU recutils manual}). As an example, the command shows the command
13144 line and PID of the client that triggered the build of a Perl package:
13145
13146 @example
13147 $ sudo guix processes | \
13148 recsel -p ClientPID,ClientCommand -e 'LockHeld ~ "perl"'
13149 ClientPID: 19419
13150 ClientCommand: cuirass --cache-directory /var/cache/cuirass @dots{}
13151 @end example
13152
13153 Additional options are listed below.
13154
13155 @table @code
13156 @item --format=@var{format}
13157 @itemx -f @var{format}
13158 Produce output in the specified @var{format}, one of:
13159
13160 @table @code
13161 @item recutils
13162 The default option. It outputs a set of Session recutils records
13163 that include each @code{ChildProcess} as a field.
13164
13165 @item normalized
13166 Normalize the output records into record sets (@pxref{Record Sets,,,
13167 recutils, GNU recutils manual}). Normalizing into record sets allows
13168 joins across record types. The example below lists the PID of each
13169 @code{ChildProcess} and the associated PID for @code{Session} that
13170 spawned the @code{ChildProcess} where the @code{Session} was started
13171 using @command{guix build}.
13172
13173 @example
13174 $ guix processes --format=normalized | \
13175 recsel \
13176 -j Session \
13177 -t ChildProcess \
13178 -p Session.PID,PID \
13179 -e 'Session.ClientCommand ~ "guix build"'
13180 PID: 4435
13181 Session_PID: 4278
13182
13183 PID: 4554
13184 Session_PID: 4278
13185
13186 PID: 4646
13187 Session_PID: 4278
13188 @end example
13189 @end table
13190 @end table
13191
13192 @node System Configuration
13193 @chapter System Configuration
13194
13195 @cindex system configuration
13196 Guix System supports a consistent whole-system configuration
13197 mechanism. By that we mean that all aspects of the global system
13198 configuration---such as the available system services, timezone and
13199 locale settings, user accounts---are declared in a single place. Such
13200 a @dfn{system configuration} can be @dfn{instantiated}---i.e., effected.
13201
13202 One of the advantages of putting all the system configuration under the
13203 control of Guix is that it supports transactional system upgrades, and
13204 makes it possible to roll back to a previous system instantiation,
13205 should something go wrong with the new one (@pxref{Features}). Another
13206 advantage is that it makes it easy to replicate the exact same configuration
13207 across different machines, or at different points in time, without
13208 having to resort to additional administration tools layered on top of
13209 the own tools of the system.
13210 @c Yes, we're talking of Puppet, Chef, & co. here. ↑
13211
13212 This section describes this mechanism. First we focus on the system
13213 administrator's viewpoint---explaining how the system is configured and
13214 instantiated. Then we show how this mechanism can be extended, for
13215 instance to support new system services.
13216
13217 @menu
13218 * Using the Configuration System:: Customizing your GNU system.
13219 * operating-system Reference:: Detail of operating-system declarations.
13220 * File Systems:: Configuring file system mounts.
13221 * Mapped Devices:: Block device extra processing.
13222 * User Accounts:: Specifying user accounts.
13223 * Keyboard Layout:: How the system interprets key strokes.
13224 * Locales:: Language and cultural convention settings.
13225 * Services:: Specifying system services.
13226 * Setuid Programs:: Programs running with root privileges.
13227 * X.509 Certificates:: Authenticating HTTPS servers.
13228 * Name Service Switch:: Configuring libc's name service switch.
13229 * Initial RAM Disk:: Linux-Libre bootstrapping.
13230 * Bootloader Configuration:: Configuring the boot loader.
13231 * Invoking guix system:: Instantiating a system configuration.
13232 * Invoking guix deploy:: Deploying a system configuration to a remote host.
13233 * Running Guix in a VM:: How to run Guix System in a virtual machine.
13234 * Defining Services:: Adding new service definitions.
13235 @end menu
13236
13237 @node Using the Configuration System
13238 @section Using the Configuration System
13239
13240 The operating system is configured by providing an
13241 @code{operating-system} declaration in a file that can then be passed to
13242 the @command{guix system} command (@pxref{Invoking guix system}). A
13243 simple setup, with the default system services, the default Linux-Libre
13244 kernel, initial RAM disk, and boot loader looks like this:
13245
13246 @findex operating-system
13247 @lisp
13248 @include os-config-bare-bones.texi
13249 @end lisp
13250
13251 This example should be self-describing. Some of the fields defined
13252 above, such as @code{host-name} and @code{bootloader}, are mandatory.
13253 Others, such as @code{packages} and @code{services}, can be omitted, in
13254 which case they get a default value.
13255
13256 Below we discuss the effect of some of the most important fields
13257 (@pxref{operating-system Reference}, for details about all the available
13258 fields), and how to @dfn{instantiate} the operating system using
13259 @command{guix system}.
13260
13261 @unnumberedsubsec Bootloader
13262
13263 @cindex legacy boot, on Intel machines
13264 @cindex BIOS boot, on Intel machines
13265 @cindex UEFI boot
13266 @cindex EFI boot
13267 The @code{bootloader} field describes the method that will be used to boot
13268 your system. Machines based on Intel processors can boot in ``legacy'' BIOS
13269 mode, as in the example above. However, more recent machines rely instead on
13270 the @dfn{Unified Extensible Firmware Interface} (UEFI) to boot. In that case,
13271 the @code{bootloader} field should contain something along these lines:
13272
13273 @lisp
13274 (bootloader-configuration
13275 (bootloader grub-efi-bootloader)
13276 (target "/boot/efi"))
13277 @end lisp
13278
13279 @xref{Bootloader Configuration}, for more information on the available
13280 configuration options.
13281
13282 @unnumberedsubsec Globally-Visible Packages
13283
13284 @vindex %base-packages
13285 The @code{packages} field lists packages that will be globally visible
13286 on the system, for all user accounts---i.e., in every user's @env{PATH}
13287 environment variable---in addition to the per-user profiles
13288 (@pxref{Invoking guix package}). The @code{%base-packages} variable
13289 provides all the tools one would expect for basic user and administrator
13290 tasks---including the GNU Core Utilities, the GNU Networking Utilities,
13291 the GNU Zile lightweight text editor, @command{find}, @command{grep},
13292 etc. The example above adds GNU@tie{}Screen to those,
13293 taken from the @code{(gnu packages screen)}
13294 module (@pxref{Package Modules}). The
13295 @code{(list package output)} syntax can be used to add a specific output
13296 of a package:
13297
13298 @lisp
13299 (use-modules (gnu packages))
13300 (use-modules (gnu packages dns))
13301
13302 (operating-system
13303 ;; ...
13304 (packages (cons (list bind "utils")
13305 %base-packages)))
13306 @end lisp
13307
13308 @findex specification->package
13309 Referring to packages by variable name, like @code{bind} above, has
13310 the advantage of being unambiguous; it also allows typos and such to be
13311 diagnosed right away as ``unbound variables''. The downside is that one
13312 needs to know which module defines which package, and to augment the
13313 @code{use-package-modules} line accordingly. To avoid that, one can use
13314 the @code{specification->package} procedure of the @code{(gnu packages)}
13315 module, which returns the best package for a given name or name and
13316 version:
13317
13318 @lisp
13319 (use-modules (gnu packages))
13320
13321 (operating-system
13322 ;; ...
13323 (packages (append (map specification->package
13324 '("tcpdump" "htop" "gnupg@@2.0"))
13325 %base-packages)))
13326 @end lisp
13327
13328 @unnumberedsubsec System Services
13329
13330 @cindex services
13331 @vindex %base-services
13332 The @code{services} field lists @dfn{system services} to be made
13333 available when the system starts (@pxref{Services}).
13334 The @code{operating-system} declaration above specifies that, in
13335 addition to the basic services, we want the OpenSSH secure shell
13336 daemon listening on port 2222 (@pxref{Networking Services,
13337 @code{openssh-service-type}}). Under the hood,
13338 @code{openssh-service-type} arranges so that @command{sshd} is started with the
13339 right command-line options, possibly with supporting configuration files
13340 generated as needed (@pxref{Defining Services}).
13341
13342 @cindex customization, of services
13343 @findex modify-services
13344 Occasionally, instead of using the base services as is, you will want to
13345 customize them. To do this, use @code{modify-services} (@pxref{Service
13346 Reference, @code{modify-services}}) to modify the list.
13347
13348 For example, suppose you want to modify @code{guix-daemon} and Mingetty
13349 (the console log-in) in the @code{%base-services} list (@pxref{Base
13350 Services, @code{%base-services}}). To do that, you can write the
13351 following in your operating system declaration:
13352
13353 @lisp
13354 (define %my-services
13355 ;; My very own list of services.
13356 (modify-services %base-services
13357 (guix-service-type config =>
13358 (guix-configuration
13359 (inherit config)
13360 ;; Fetch substitutes from example.org.
13361 (substitute-urls
13362 (list "https://example.org/guix"
13363 "https://ci.guix.gnu.org"))))
13364 (mingetty-service-type config =>
13365 (mingetty-configuration
13366 (inherit config)
13367 ;; Automatially log in as "guest".
13368 (auto-login "guest")))))
13369
13370 (operating-system
13371 ;; @dots{}
13372 (services %my-services))
13373 @end lisp
13374
13375 This changes the configuration---i.e., the service parameters---of the
13376 @code{guix-service-type} instance, and that of all the
13377 @code{mingetty-service-type} instances in the @code{%base-services} list.
13378 Observe how this is accomplished: first, we arrange for the original
13379 configuration to be bound to the identifier @code{config} in the
13380 @var{body}, and then we write the @var{body} so that it evaluates to the
13381 desired configuration. In particular, notice how we use @code{inherit}
13382 to create a new configuration which has the same values as the old
13383 configuration, but with a few modifications.
13384
13385 @cindex encrypted disk
13386 The configuration for a typical ``desktop'' usage, with an encrypted
13387 root partition, the X11 display
13388 server, GNOME and Xfce (users can choose which of these desktop
13389 environments to use at the log-in screen by pressing @kbd{F1}), network
13390 management, power management, and more, would look like this:
13391
13392 @lisp
13393 @include os-config-desktop.texi
13394 @end lisp
13395
13396 A graphical system with a choice of lightweight window managers
13397 instead of full-blown desktop environments would look like this:
13398
13399 @lisp
13400 @include os-config-lightweight-desktop.texi
13401 @end lisp
13402
13403 This example refers to the @file{/boot/efi} file system by its UUID,
13404 @code{1234-ABCD}. Replace this UUID with the right UUID on your system,
13405 as returned by the @command{blkid} command.
13406
13407 @xref{Desktop Services}, for the exact list of services provided by
13408 @code{%desktop-services}. @xref{X.509 Certificates}, for background
13409 information about the @code{nss-certs} package that is used here.
13410
13411 Again, @code{%desktop-services} is just a list of service objects. If
13412 you want to remove services from there, you can do so using the
13413 procedures for list filtering (@pxref{SRFI-1 Filtering and
13414 Partitioning,,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}). For instance, the
13415 following expression returns a list that contains all the services in
13416 @code{%desktop-services} minus the Avahi service:
13417
13418 @lisp
13419 (remove (lambda (service)
13420 (eq? (service-kind service) avahi-service-type))
13421 %desktop-services)
13422 @end lisp
13423
13424 @unnumberedsubsec Instantiating the System
13425
13426 Assuming the @code{operating-system} declaration
13427 is stored in the @file{my-system-config.scm}
13428 file, the @command{guix system reconfigure my-system-config.scm} command
13429 instantiates that configuration, and makes it the default GRUB boot
13430 entry (@pxref{Invoking guix system}).
13431
13432 The normal way to change the system configuration is by updating this
13433 file and re-running @command{guix system reconfigure}. One should never
13434 have to touch files in @file{/etc} or to run commands that modify the
13435 system state such as @command{useradd} or @command{grub-install}. In
13436 fact, you must avoid that since that would not only void your warranty
13437 but also prevent you from rolling back to previous versions of your
13438 system, should you ever need to.
13439
13440 @cindex roll-back, of the operating system
13441 Speaking of roll-back, each time you run @command{guix system
13442 reconfigure}, a new @dfn{generation} of the system is created---without
13443 modifying or deleting previous generations. Old system generations get
13444 an entry in the bootloader boot menu, allowing you to boot them in case
13445 something went wrong with the latest generation. Reassuring, no? The
13446 @command{guix system list-generations} command lists the system
13447 generations available on disk. It is also possible to roll back the
13448 system via the commands @command{guix system roll-back} and
13449 @command{guix system switch-generation}.
13450
13451 Although the @command{guix system reconfigure} command will not modify
13452 previous generations, you must take care when the current generation is not
13453 the latest (e.g., after invoking @command{guix system roll-back}), since
13454 the operation might overwrite a later generation (@pxref{Invoking guix
13455 system}).
13456
13457 @unnumberedsubsec The Programming Interface
13458
13459 At the Scheme level, the bulk of an @code{operating-system} declaration
13460 is instantiated with the following monadic procedure (@pxref{The Store
13461 Monad}):
13462
13463 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} operating-system-derivation os
13464 Return a derivation that builds @var{os}, an @code{operating-system}
13465 object (@pxref{Derivations}).
13466
13467 The output of the derivation is a single directory that refers to all
13468 the packages, configuration files, and other supporting files needed to
13469 instantiate @var{os}.
13470 @end deffn
13471
13472 This procedure is provided by the @code{(gnu system)} module. Along
13473 with @code{(gnu services)} (@pxref{Services}), this module contains the
13474 guts of Guix System. Make sure to visit it!
13475
13476
13477 @node operating-system Reference
13478 @section @code{operating-system} Reference
13479
13480 This section summarizes all the options available in
13481 @code{operating-system} declarations (@pxref{Using the Configuration
13482 System}).
13483
13484 @deftp {Data Type} operating-system
13485 This is the data type representing an operating system configuration.
13486 By that, we mean all the global system configuration, not per-user
13487 configuration (@pxref{Using the Configuration System}).
13488
13489 @table @asis
13490 @item @code{kernel} (default: @code{linux-libre})
13491 The package object of the operating system kernel to
13492 use@footnote{Currently only the Linux-libre kernel is fully supported.
13493 Using GNU@tie{}mach with the GNU@tie{}Hurd is experimental and only
13494 available when building a virtual machine disk image.}.
13495
13496 @cindex hurd
13497 @item @code{hurd} (default: @code{#f})
13498 The package object of the Hurd to be started by the kernel. When this
13499 field is set, produce a GNU/Hurd operating system. In that case,
13500 @code{kernel} must also be set to the @code{gnumach} package---the
13501 microkernel the Hurd runs on.
13502
13503 @quotation Warning
13504 This feature is experimental and only supported for disk images.
13505 @end quotation
13506
13507 @item @code{kernel-loadable-modules} (default: '())
13508 A list of objects (usually packages) to collect loadable kernel modules
13509 from--e.g. @code{(list ddcci-driver-linux)}.
13510
13511 @item @code{kernel-arguments} (default: @code{%default-kernel-arguments})
13512 List of strings or gexps representing additional arguments to pass on
13513 the command-line of the kernel---e.g., @code{("console=ttyS0")}.
13514
13515 @item @code{bootloader}
13516 The system bootloader configuration object. @xref{Bootloader Configuration}.
13517
13518 @item @code{label}
13519 This is the label (a string) as it appears in the bootloader's menu entry.
13520 The default label includes the kernel name and version.
13521
13522 @item @code{keyboard-layout} (default: @code{#f})
13523 This field specifies the keyboard layout to use in the console. It can be
13524 either @code{#f}, in which case the default keyboard layout is used (usually
13525 US English), or a @code{<keyboard-layout>} record. @xref{Keyboard Layout},
13526 for more information.
13527
13528 This keyboard layout is in effect as soon as the kernel has booted. For
13529 instance, it is the keyboard layout in effect when you type a passphrase if
13530 your root file system is on a @code{luks-device-mapping} mapped device
13531 (@pxref{Mapped Devices}).
13532
13533 @quotation Note
13534 This does @emph{not} specify the keyboard layout used by the bootloader, nor
13535 that used by the graphical display server. @xref{Bootloader Configuration},
13536 for information on how to specify the bootloader's keyboard layout. @xref{X
13537 Window}, for information on how to specify the keyboard layout used by the X
13538 Window System.
13539 @end quotation
13540
13541 @item @code{initrd-modules} (default: @code{%base-initrd-modules})
13542 @cindex initrd
13543 @cindex initial RAM disk
13544 The list of Linux kernel modules that need to be available in the
13545 initial RAM disk. @xref{Initial RAM Disk}.
13546
13547 @item @code{initrd} (default: @code{base-initrd})
13548 A procedure that returns an initial RAM disk for the Linux
13549 kernel. This field is provided to support low-level customization and
13550 should rarely be needed for casual use. @xref{Initial RAM Disk}.
13551
13552 @item @code{firmware} (default: @code{%base-firmware})
13553 @cindex firmware
13554 List of firmware packages loadable by the operating system kernel.
13555
13556 The default includes firmware needed for Atheros- and Broadcom-based
13557 WiFi devices (Linux-libre modules @code{ath9k} and @code{b43-open},
13558 respectively). @xref{Hardware Considerations}, for more info on
13559 supported hardware.
13560
13561 @item @code{host-name}
13562 The host name.
13563
13564 @item @code{hosts-file}
13565 @cindex hosts file
13566 A file-like object (@pxref{G-Expressions, file-like objects}) for use as
13567 @file{/etc/hosts} (@pxref{Host Names,,, libc, The GNU C Library
13568 Reference Manual}). The default is a file with entries for
13569 @code{localhost} and @var{host-name}.
13570
13571 @item @code{mapped-devices} (default: @code{'()})
13572 A list of mapped devices. @xref{Mapped Devices}.
13573
13574 @item @code{file-systems}
13575 A list of file systems. @xref{File Systems}.
13576
13577 @cindex swap devices
13578 @cindex swap space
13579 @item @code{swap-devices} (default: @code{'()})
13580 A list of UUIDs, file system labels, or strings identifying devices or
13581 files to be used for ``swap
13582 space'' (@pxref{Memory Concepts,,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference
13583 Manual}). Here are some examples:
13584
13585 @table @code
13586 @item (list (uuid "4dab5feb-d176-45de-b287-9b0a6e4c01cb"))
13587 Use the swap partition with the given UUID@. You can learn the UUID of a
13588 Linux swap partition by running @command{swaplabel @var{device}}, where
13589 @var{device} is the @file{/dev} file name of that partition.
13590
13591 @item (list (file-system-label "swap"))
13592 Use the partition with label @code{swap}. Again, the
13593 @command{swaplabel} command allows you to view and change the label of a
13594 Linux swap partition.
13595
13596 @item (list "/swapfile")
13597 Use the file @file{/swapfile} as swap space.
13598
13599 @item (list "/dev/sda3" "/dev/sdb2")
13600 Use the @file{/dev/sda3} and @file{/dev/sdb2} partitions as swap space.
13601 We recommend referring to swap devices by UUIDs or labels as shown above
13602 instead.
13603 @end table
13604
13605 It is possible to specify a swap file in a file system on a mapped
13606 device (under @file{/dev/mapper}), provided that the necessary device
13607 mapping and file system are also specified. @xref{Mapped Devices} and
13608 @ref{File Systems}.
13609
13610 @item @code{users} (default: @code{%base-user-accounts})
13611 @itemx @code{groups} (default: @code{%base-groups})
13612 List of user accounts and groups. @xref{User Accounts}.
13613
13614 If the @code{users} list lacks a user account with UID@tie{}0, a
13615 ``root'' account with UID@tie{}0 is automatically added.
13616
13617 @item @code{skeletons} (default: @code{(default-skeletons)})
13618 A list of target file name/file-like object tuples (@pxref{G-Expressions,
13619 file-like objects}). These are the skeleton files that will be added to
13620 the home directory of newly-created user accounts.
13621
13622 For instance, a valid value may look like this:
13623
13624 @lisp
13625 `((".bashrc" ,(plain-file "bashrc" "echo Hello\n"))
13626 (".guile" ,(plain-file "guile"
13627 "(use-modules (ice-9 readline))
13628 (activate-readline)")))
13629 @end lisp
13630
13631 @item @code{issue} (default: @code{%default-issue})
13632 A string denoting the contents of the @file{/etc/issue} file, which is
13633 displayed when users log in on a text console.
13634
13635 @item @code{packages} (default: @code{%base-packages})
13636 A list of packages to be installed in the global profile, which is accessible
13637 at @file{/run/current-system/profile}. Each element is either a package
13638 variable or a package/output tuple. Here's a simple example of both:
13639
13640 @lisp
13641 (cons* git ; the default "out" output
13642 (list git "send-email") ; another output of git
13643 %base-packages) ; the default set
13644 @end lisp
13645
13646 The default set includes core utilities and it is good practice to
13647 install non-core utilities in user profiles (@pxref{Invoking guix
13648 package}).
13649
13650 @item @code{timezone}
13651 A timezone identifying string---e.g., @code{"Europe/Paris"}.
13652
13653 You can run the @command{tzselect} command to find out which timezone
13654 string corresponds to your region. Choosing an invalid timezone name
13655 causes @command{guix system} to fail.
13656
13657 @item @code{locale} (default: @code{"en_US.utf8"})
13658 The name of the default locale (@pxref{Locale Names,,, libc, The GNU C
13659 Library Reference Manual}). @xref{Locales}, for more information.
13660
13661 @item @code{locale-definitions} (default: @code{%default-locale-definitions})
13662 The list of locale definitions to be compiled and that may be used at
13663 run time. @xref{Locales}.
13664
13665 @item @code{locale-libcs} (default: @code{(list @var{glibc})})
13666 The list of GNU@tie{}libc packages whose locale data and tools are used
13667 to build the locale definitions. @xref{Locales}, for compatibility
13668 considerations that justify this option.
13669
13670 @item @code{name-service-switch} (default: @code{%default-nss})
13671 Configuration of the libc name service switch (NSS)---a
13672 @code{<name-service-switch>} object. @xref{Name Service Switch}, for
13673 details.
13674
13675 @item @code{services} (default: @code{%base-services})
13676 A list of service objects denoting system services. @xref{Services}.
13677
13678 @cindex essential services
13679 @item @code{essential-services} (default: ...)
13680 The list of ``essential services''---i.e., things like instances of
13681 @code{system-service-type} and @code{host-name-service-type} (@pxref{Service
13682 Reference}), which are derived from the operating system definition itself.
13683 As a user you should @emph{never} need to touch this field.
13684
13685 @item @code{pam-services} (default: @code{(base-pam-services)})
13686 @cindex PAM
13687 @cindex pluggable authentication modules
13688 Linux @dfn{pluggable authentication module} (PAM) services.
13689 @c FIXME: Add xref to PAM services section.
13690
13691 @item @code{setuid-programs} (default: @code{%setuid-programs})
13692 List of string-valued G-expressions denoting setuid programs.
13693 @xref{Setuid Programs}.
13694
13695 @item @code{sudoers-file} (default: @code{%sudoers-specification})
13696 @cindex sudoers file
13697 The contents of the @file{/etc/sudoers} file as a file-like object
13698 (@pxref{G-Expressions, @code{local-file} and @code{plain-file}}).
13699
13700 This file specifies which users can use the @command{sudo} command, what
13701 they are allowed to do, and what privileges they may gain. The default
13702 is that only @code{root} and members of the @code{wheel} group may use
13703 @code{sudo}.
13704
13705 @end table
13706
13707 @deffn {Scheme Syntax} this-operating-system
13708 When used in the @emph{lexical scope} of an operating system field definition,
13709 this identifier resolves to the operating system being defined.
13710
13711 The example below shows how to refer to the operating system being defined in
13712 the definition of the @code{label} field:
13713
13714 @lisp
13715 (use-modules (gnu) (guix))
13716
13717 (operating-system
13718 ;; ...
13719 (label (package-full-name
13720 (operating-system-kernel this-operating-system))))
13721 @end lisp
13722
13723 It is an error to refer to @code{this-operating-system} outside an operating
13724 system definition.
13725 @end deffn
13726
13727 @end deftp
13728
13729 @node File Systems
13730 @section File Systems
13731
13732 The list of file systems to be mounted is specified in the
13733 @code{file-systems} field of the operating system declaration
13734 (@pxref{Using the Configuration System}). Each file system is declared
13735 using the @code{file-system} form, like this:
13736
13737 @lisp
13738 (file-system
13739 (mount-point "/home")
13740 (device "/dev/sda3")
13741 (type "ext4"))
13742 @end lisp
13743
13744 As usual, some of the fields are mandatory---those shown in the example
13745 above---while others can be omitted. These are described below.
13746
13747 @deftp {Data Type} file-system
13748 Objects of this type represent file systems to be mounted. They
13749 contain the following members:
13750
13751 @table @asis
13752 @item @code{type}
13753 This is a string specifying the type of the file system---e.g.,
13754 @code{"ext4"}.
13755
13756 @item @code{mount-point}
13757 This designates the place where the file system is to be mounted.
13758
13759 @item @code{device}
13760 This names the ``source'' of the file system. It can be one of three
13761 things: a file system label, a file system UUID, or the name of a
13762 @file{/dev} node. Labels and UUIDs offer a way to refer to file
13763 systems without having to hard-code their actual device
13764 name@footnote{Note that, while it is tempting to use
13765 @file{/dev/disk/by-uuid} and similar device names to achieve the same
13766 result, this is not recommended: These special device nodes are created
13767 by the udev daemon and may be unavailable at the time the device is
13768 mounted.}.
13769
13770 @findex file-system-label
13771 File system labels are created using the @code{file-system-label}
13772 procedure, UUIDs are created using @code{uuid}, and @file{/dev} node are
13773 plain strings. Here's an example of a file system referred to by its
13774 label, as shown by the @command{e2label} command:
13775
13776 @lisp
13777 (file-system
13778 (mount-point "/home")
13779 (type "ext4")
13780 (device (file-system-label "my-home")))
13781 @end lisp
13782
13783 @findex uuid
13784 UUIDs are converted from their string representation (as shown by the
13785 @command{tune2fs -l} command) using the @code{uuid} form@footnote{The
13786 @code{uuid} form expects 16-byte UUIDs as defined in
13787 @uref{https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4122, RFC@tie{}4122}. This is the
13788 form of UUID used by the ext2 family of file systems and others, but it
13789 is different from ``UUIDs'' found in FAT file systems, for instance.},
13790 like this:
13791
13792 @lisp
13793 (file-system
13794 (mount-point "/home")
13795 (type "ext4")
13796 (device (uuid "4dab5feb-d176-45de-b287-9b0a6e4c01cb")))
13797 @end lisp
13798
13799 When the source of a file system is a mapped device (@pxref{Mapped
13800 Devices}), its @code{device} field @emph{must} refer to the mapped
13801 device name---e.g., @file{"/dev/mapper/root-partition"}.
13802 This is required so that
13803 the system knows that mounting the file system depends on having the
13804 corresponding device mapping established.
13805
13806 @item @code{flags} (default: @code{'()})
13807 This is a list of symbols denoting mount flags. Recognized flags
13808 include @code{read-only}, @code{bind-mount}, @code{no-dev} (disallow
13809 access to special files), @code{no-suid} (ignore setuid and setgid
13810 bits), @code{no-atime} (do not update file access times),
13811 @code{strict-atime} (update file access time), @code{lazy-time} (only
13812 update time on the in-memory version of the file inode), and
13813 @code{no-exec} (disallow program execution).
13814 @xref{Mount-Unmount-Remount,,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference
13815 Manual}, for more information on these flags.
13816
13817 @item @code{options} (default: @code{#f})
13818 This is either @code{#f}, or a string denoting mount options passed to
13819 the file system driver. @xref{Mount-Unmount-Remount,,, libc, The GNU C
13820 Library Reference Manual}, for details and run @command{man 8 mount} for
13821 options for various file systems. Note that the
13822 @code{file-system-options->alist} and @code{alist->file-system-options}
13823 procedures from @code{(gnu system file-systems)} can be used to convert
13824 file system options given as an association list to the string
13825 representation, and vice-versa.
13826
13827 @item @code{mount?} (default: @code{#t})
13828 This value indicates whether to automatically mount the file system when
13829 the system is brought up. When set to @code{#f}, the file system gets
13830 an entry in @file{/etc/fstab} (read by the @command{mount} command) but
13831 is not automatically mounted.
13832
13833 @item @code{needed-for-boot?} (default: @code{#f})
13834 This Boolean value indicates whether the file system is needed when
13835 booting. If that is true, then the file system is mounted when the
13836 initial RAM disk (initrd) is loaded. This is always the case, for
13837 instance, for the root file system.
13838
13839 @item @code{check?} (default: @code{#t})
13840 This Boolean indicates whether the file system needs to be checked for
13841 errors before being mounted.
13842
13843 @item @code{create-mount-point?} (default: @code{#f})
13844 When true, the mount point is created if it does not exist yet.
13845
13846 @item @code{mount-may-fail?} (default: @code{#f})
13847 When true, this indicates that mounting this file system can fail but
13848 that should not be considered an error. This is useful in unusual
13849 cases; an example of this is @code{efivarfs}, a file system that can
13850 only be mounted on EFI/UEFI systems.
13851
13852 @item @code{dependencies} (default: @code{'()})
13853 This is a list of @code{<file-system>} or @code{<mapped-device>} objects
13854 representing file systems that must be mounted or mapped devices that
13855 must be opened before (and unmounted or closed after) this one.
13856
13857 As an example, consider a hierarchy of mounts: @file{/sys/fs/cgroup} is
13858 a dependency of @file{/sys/fs/cgroup/cpu} and
13859 @file{/sys/fs/cgroup/memory}.
13860
13861 Another example is a file system that depends on a mapped device, for
13862 example for an encrypted partition (@pxref{Mapped Devices}).
13863 @end table
13864 @end deftp
13865
13866 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} file-system-label @var{str}
13867 This procedure returns an opaque file system label from @var{str}, a
13868 string:
13869
13870 @lisp
13871 (file-system-label "home")
13872 @result{} #<file-system-label "home">
13873 @end lisp
13874
13875 File system labels are used to refer to file systems by label rather
13876 than by device name. See above for examples.
13877 @end deffn
13878
13879 The @code{(gnu system file-systems)} exports the following useful
13880 variables.
13881
13882 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %base-file-systems
13883 These are essential file systems that are required on normal systems,
13884 such as @code{%pseudo-terminal-file-system} and @code{%immutable-store} (see
13885 below). Operating system declarations should always contain at least
13886 these.
13887 @end defvr
13888
13889 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %pseudo-terminal-file-system
13890 This is the file system to be mounted as @file{/dev/pts}. It supports
13891 @dfn{pseudo-terminals} created @i{via} @code{openpty} and similar
13892 functions (@pxref{Pseudo-Terminals,,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference
13893 Manual}). Pseudo-terminals are used by terminal emulators such as
13894 @command{xterm}.
13895 @end defvr
13896
13897 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %shared-memory-file-system
13898 This file system is mounted as @file{/dev/shm} and is used to support
13899 memory sharing across processes (@pxref{Memory-mapped I/O,
13900 @code{shm_open},, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}).
13901 @end defvr
13902
13903 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %immutable-store
13904 This file system performs a read-only ``bind mount'' of
13905 @file{/gnu/store}, making it read-only for all the users including
13906 @code{root}. This prevents against accidental modification by software
13907 running as @code{root} or by system administrators.
13908
13909 The daemon itself is still able to write to the store: it remounts it
13910 read-write in its own ``name space.''
13911 @end defvr
13912
13913 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %binary-format-file-system
13914 The @code{binfmt_misc} file system, which allows handling of arbitrary
13915 executable file types to be delegated to user space. This requires the
13916 @code{binfmt.ko} kernel module to be loaded.
13917 @end defvr
13918
13919 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %fuse-control-file-system
13920 The @code{fusectl} file system, which allows unprivileged users to mount
13921 and unmount user-space FUSE file systems. This requires the
13922 @code{fuse.ko} kernel module to be loaded.
13923 @end defvr
13924
13925 The @code{(gnu system uuid)} module provides tools to deal with file
13926 system ``unique identifiers'' (UUIDs).
13927
13928 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} uuid @var{str} [@var{type}]
13929 Return an opaque UUID (unique identifier) object of the given @var{type}
13930 (a symbol) by parsing @var{str} (a string):
13931
13932 @lisp
13933 (uuid "4dab5feb-d176-45de-b287-9b0a6e4c01cb")
13934 @result{} #<<uuid> type: dce bv: @dots{}>
13935
13936 (uuid "1234-ABCD" 'fat)
13937 @result{} #<<uuid> type: fat bv: @dots{}>
13938 @end lisp
13939
13940 @var{type} may be one of @code{dce}, @code{iso9660}, @code{fat},
13941 @code{ntfs}, or one of the commonly found synonyms for these.
13942
13943 UUIDs are another way to unambiguously refer to file systems in
13944 operating system configuration. See the examples above.
13945 @end deffn
13946
13947
13948 @node Btrfs file system
13949 @subsection Btrfs file system
13950
13951 The Btrfs has special features, such as subvolumes, that merit being
13952 explained in more details. The following section attempts to cover
13953 basic as well as complex uses of a Btrfs file system with the Guix
13954 System.
13955
13956 In its simplest usage, a Btrfs file system can be described, for
13957 example, by:
13958
13959 @lisp
13960 (file-system
13961 (mount-point "/home")
13962 (type "btrfs")
13963 (device (file-system-label "my-home")))
13964 @end lisp
13965
13966 The example below is more complex, as it makes use of a Btrfs
13967 subvolume, named @code{rootfs}. The parent Btrfs file system is labeled
13968 @code{my-btrfs-pool}, and is located on an encrypted device (hence the
13969 dependency on @code{mapped-devices}):
13970
13971 @lisp
13972 (file-system
13973 (device (file-system-label "my-btrfs-pool"))
13974 (mount-point "/")
13975 (type "btrfs")
13976 (options "subvol=rootfs")
13977 (dependencies mapped-devices))
13978 @end lisp
13979
13980 Some bootloaders, for example GRUB, only mount a Btrfs partition at its
13981 top level during the early boot, and rely on their configuration to
13982 refer to the correct subvolume path within that top level. The
13983 bootloaders operating in this way typically produce their configuration
13984 on a running system where the Btrfs partitions are already mounted and
13985 where the subvolume information is readily available. As an example,
13986 @command{grub-mkconfig}, the configuration generator command shipped
13987 with GRUB, reads @file{/proc/self/mountinfo} to determine the top-level
13988 path of a subvolume.
13989
13990 The Guix System produces a bootloader configuration using the operating
13991 system configuration as its sole input; it is therefore necessary to
13992 extract the subvolume name on which @file{/gnu/store} lives (if any)
13993 from that operating system configuration. To better illustrate,
13994 consider a subvolume named 'rootfs' which contains the root file system
13995 data. In such situation, the GRUB bootloader would only see the top
13996 level of the root Btrfs partition, e.g.:
13997
13998 @example
13999 / (top level)
14000 ├── rootfs (subvolume directory)
14001 ├── gnu (normal directory)
14002 ├── store (normal directory)
14003 [...]
14004 @end example
14005
14006 Thus, the subvolume name must be prepended to the @file{/gnu/store} path
14007 of the kernel, initrd binaries and any other files referred to in the
14008 GRUB configuration that must be found during the early boot.
14009
14010 The next example shows a nested hierarchy of subvolumes and
14011 directories:
14012
14013 @example
14014 / (top level)
14015 ├── rootfs (subvolume)
14016 ├── gnu (normal directory)
14017 ├── store (subvolume)
14018 [...]
14019 @end example
14020
14021 This scenario would work without mounting the 'store' subvolume.
14022 Mounting 'rootfs' is sufficient, since the subvolume name matches its
14023 intended mount point in the file system hierarchy. Alternatively, the
14024 'store' subvolume could be referred to by setting the @code{subvol}
14025 option to either @code{/rootfs/gnu/store} or @code{rootfs/gnu/store}.
14026
14027 Finally, a more contrived example of nested subvolumes:
14028
14029 @example
14030 / (top level)
14031 ├── root-snapshots (subvolume)
14032 ├── root-current (subvolume)
14033 ├── guix-store (subvolume)
14034 [...]
14035 @end example
14036
14037 Here, the 'guix-store' subvolume doesn't match its intended mount point,
14038 so it is necessary to mount it. The subvolume must be fully specified,
14039 by passing its file name to the @code{subvol} option. To illustrate,
14040 the 'guix-store' subvolume could be mounted on @file{/gnu/store} by using
14041 a file system declaration such as:
14042
14043 @lisp
14044 (file-system
14045 (device (file-system-label "btrfs-pool-1"))
14046 (mount-point "/gnu/store")
14047 (type "btrfs")
14048 (options "subvol=root-snapshots/root-current/guix-store,\
14049 compress-force=zstd,space_cache=v2"))
14050 @end lisp
14051
14052 @node Mapped Devices
14053 @section Mapped Devices
14054
14055 @cindex device mapping
14056 @cindex mapped devices
14057 The Linux kernel has a notion of @dfn{device mapping}: a block device,
14058 such as a hard disk partition, can be @dfn{mapped} into another device,
14059 usually in @code{/dev/mapper/},
14060 with additional processing over the data that flows through
14061 it@footnote{Note that the GNU@tie{}Hurd makes no difference between the
14062 concept of a ``mapped device'' and that of a file system: both boil down
14063 to @emph{translating} input/output operations made on a file to
14064 operations on its backing store. Thus, the Hurd implements mapped
14065 devices, like file systems, using the generic @dfn{translator} mechanism
14066 (@pxref{Translators,,, hurd, The GNU Hurd Reference Manual}).}. A
14067 typical example is encryption device mapping: all writes to the mapped
14068 device are encrypted, and all reads are deciphered, transparently.
14069 Guix extends this notion by considering any device or set of devices that
14070 are @dfn{transformed} in some way to create a new device; for instance,
14071 RAID devices are obtained by @dfn{assembling} several other devices, such
14072 as hard disks or partitions, into a new one that behaves as one partition.
14073
14074 Mapped devices are declared using the @code{mapped-device} form,
14075 defined as follows; for examples, see below.
14076
14077 @deftp {Data Type} mapped-device
14078 Objects of this type represent device mappings that will be made when
14079 the system boots up.
14080
14081 @table @code
14082 @item source
14083 This is either a string specifying the name of the block device to be mapped,
14084 such as @code{"/dev/sda3"}, or a list of such strings when several devices
14085 need to be assembled for creating a new one. In case of LVM this is a
14086 string specifying name of the volume group to be mapped.
14087
14088 @item target
14089 This string specifies the name of the resulting mapped device. For
14090 kernel mappers such as encrypted devices of type @code{luks-device-mapping},
14091 specifying @code{"my-partition"} leads to the creation of
14092 the @code{"/dev/mapper/my-partition"} device.
14093 For RAID devices of type @code{raid-device-mapping}, the full device name
14094 such as @code{"/dev/md0"} needs to be given.
14095 LVM logical volumes of type @code{lvm-device-mapping} need to
14096 be specified as @code{"VGNAME-LVNAME"}.
14097
14098 @item targets
14099 This list of strings specifies names of the resulting mapped devices in case
14100 there are several. The format is identical to @var{target}.
14101
14102 @item type
14103 This must be a @code{mapped-device-kind} object, which specifies how
14104 @var{source} is mapped to @var{target}.
14105 @end table
14106 @end deftp
14107
14108 @defvr {Scheme Variable} luks-device-mapping
14109 This defines LUKS block device encryption using the @command{cryptsetup}
14110 command from the package with the same name. It relies on the
14111 @code{dm-crypt} Linux kernel module.
14112 @end defvr
14113
14114 @defvr {Scheme Variable} raid-device-mapping
14115 This defines a RAID device, which is assembled using the @code{mdadm}
14116 command from the package with the same name. It requires a Linux kernel
14117 module for the appropriate RAID level to be loaded, such as @code{raid456}
14118 for RAID-4, RAID-5 or RAID-6, or @code{raid10} for RAID-10.
14119 @end defvr
14120
14121 @cindex LVM, logical volume manager
14122 @defvr {Scheme Variable} lvm-device-mapping
14123 This defines one or more logical volumes for the Linux
14124 @uref{https://www.sourceware.org/lvm2/, Logical Volume Manager (LVM)}.
14125 The volume group is activated by the @command{vgchange} command from the
14126 @code{lvm2} package.
14127 @end defvr
14128
14129 @cindex disk encryption
14130 @cindex LUKS
14131 The following example specifies a mapping from @file{/dev/sda3} to
14132 @file{/dev/mapper/home} using LUKS---the
14133 @url{https://gitlab.com/cryptsetup/cryptsetup,Linux Unified Key Setup}, a
14134 standard mechanism for disk encryption.
14135 The @file{/dev/mapper/home}
14136 device can then be used as the @code{device} of a @code{file-system}
14137 declaration (@pxref{File Systems}).
14138
14139 @lisp
14140 (mapped-device
14141 (source "/dev/sda3")
14142 (target "home")
14143 (type luks-device-mapping))
14144 @end lisp
14145
14146 Alternatively, to become independent of device numbering, one may obtain
14147 the LUKS UUID (@dfn{unique identifier}) of the source device by a
14148 command like:
14149
14150 @example
14151 cryptsetup luksUUID /dev/sda3
14152 @end example
14153
14154 and use it as follows:
14155
14156 @lisp
14157 (mapped-device
14158 (source (uuid "cb67fc72-0d54-4c88-9d4b-b225f30b0f44"))
14159 (target "home")
14160 (type luks-device-mapping))
14161 @end lisp
14162
14163 @cindex swap encryption
14164 It is also desirable to encrypt swap space, since swap space may contain
14165 sensitive data. One way to accomplish that is to use a swap file in a
14166 file system on a device mapped via LUKS encryption. In this way, the
14167 swap file is encrypted because the entire device is encrypted.
14168 @xref{Preparing for Installation,,Disk Partitioning}, for an example.
14169
14170 A RAID device formed of the partitions @file{/dev/sda1} and @file{/dev/sdb1}
14171 may be declared as follows:
14172
14173 @lisp
14174 (mapped-device
14175 (source (list "/dev/sda1" "/dev/sdb1"))
14176 (target "/dev/md0")
14177 (type raid-device-mapping))
14178 @end lisp
14179
14180 The @file{/dev/md0} device can then be used as the @code{device} of a
14181 @code{file-system} declaration (@pxref{File Systems}).
14182 Note that the RAID level need not be given; it is chosen during the
14183 initial creation and formatting of the RAID device and is determined
14184 automatically later.
14185
14186 LVM logical volumes ``alpha'' and ``beta'' from volume group ``vg0'' can
14187 be declared as follows:
14188
14189 @lisp
14190 (mapped-device
14191 (source "vg0")
14192 (targets (list "vg0-alpha" "vg0-beta"))
14193 (type lvm-device-mapping))
14194 @end lisp
14195
14196 Devices @file{/dev/mapper/vg0-alpha} and @file{/dev/mapper/vg0-beta} can
14197 then be used as the @code{device} of a @code{file-system} declaration
14198 (@pxref{File Systems}).
14199
14200 @node User Accounts
14201 @section User Accounts
14202
14203 @cindex users
14204 @cindex accounts
14205 @cindex user accounts
14206 User accounts and groups are entirely managed through the
14207 @code{operating-system} declaration. They are specified with the
14208 @code{user-account} and @code{user-group} forms:
14209
14210 @lisp
14211 (user-account
14212 (name "alice")
14213 (group "users")
14214 (supplementary-groups '("wheel" ;allow use of sudo, etc.
14215 "audio" ;sound card
14216 "video" ;video devices such as webcams
14217 "cdrom")) ;the good ol' CD-ROM
14218 (comment "Bob's sister"))
14219 @end lisp
14220
14221 Here's a user account that uses a different shell and a custom home
14222 directory (the default would be @file{"/home/bob"}):
14223
14224 @lisp
14225 (user-account
14226 (name "bob")
14227 (group "users")
14228 (comment "Alice's bro")
14229 (shell (file-append zsh "/bin/zsh"))
14230 (home-directory "/home/robert"))
14231 @end lisp
14232
14233 When booting or upon completion of @command{guix system reconfigure},
14234 the system ensures that only the user accounts and groups specified in
14235 the @code{operating-system} declaration exist, and with the specified
14236 properties. Thus, account or group creations or modifications made by
14237 directly invoking commands such as @command{useradd} are lost upon
14238 reconfiguration or reboot. This ensures that the system remains exactly
14239 as declared.
14240
14241 @deftp {Data Type} user-account
14242 Objects of this type represent user accounts. The following members may
14243 be specified:
14244
14245 @table @asis
14246 @item @code{name}
14247 The name of the user account.
14248
14249 @item @code{group}
14250 @cindex groups
14251 This is the name (a string) or identifier (a number) of the user group
14252 this account belongs to.
14253
14254 @item @code{supplementary-groups} (default: @code{'()})
14255 Optionally, this can be defined as a list of group names that this
14256 account belongs to.
14257
14258 @item @code{uid} (default: @code{#f})
14259 This is the user ID for this account (a number), or @code{#f}. In the
14260 latter case, a number is automatically chosen by the system when the
14261 account is created.
14262
14263 @item @code{comment} (default: @code{""})
14264 A comment about the account, such as the account owner's full name.
14265
14266 @item @code{home-directory}
14267 This is the name of the home directory for the account.
14268
14269 @item @code{create-home-directory?} (default: @code{#t})
14270 Indicates whether the home directory of this account should be created
14271 if it does not exist yet.
14272
14273 @item @code{shell} (default: Bash)
14274 This is a G-expression denoting the file name of a program to be used as
14275 the shell (@pxref{G-Expressions}). For example, you would refer to the
14276 Bash executable like this:
14277
14278 @lisp
14279 (file-append bash "/bin/bash")
14280 @end lisp
14281
14282 @noindent
14283 ... and to the Zsh executable like that:
14284
14285 @lisp
14286 (file-append zsh "/bin/zsh")
14287 @end lisp
14288
14289 @item @code{system?} (default: @code{#f})
14290 This Boolean value indicates whether the account is a ``system''
14291 account. System accounts are sometimes treated specially; for instance,
14292 graphical login managers do not list them.
14293
14294 @anchor{user-account-password}
14295 @cindex password, for user accounts
14296 @item @code{password} (default: @code{#f})
14297 You would normally leave this field to @code{#f}, initialize user
14298 passwords as @code{root} with the @command{passwd} command, and then let
14299 users change it with @command{passwd}. Passwords set with
14300 @command{passwd} are of course preserved across reboot and
14301 reconfiguration.
14302
14303 If you @emph{do} want to set an initial password for an account, then
14304 this field must contain the encrypted password, as a string. You can use the
14305 @code{crypt} procedure for this purpose:
14306
14307 @lisp
14308 (user-account
14309 (name "charlie")
14310 (group "users")
14311
14312 ;; Specify a SHA-512-hashed initial password.
14313 (password (crypt "InitialPassword!" "$6$abc")))
14314 @end lisp
14315
14316 @quotation Note
14317 The hash of this initial password will be available in a file in
14318 @file{/gnu/store}, readable by all the users, so this method must be used with
14319 care.
14320 @end quotation
14321
14322 @xref{Passphrase Storage,,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}, for
14323 more information on password encryption, and @ref{Encryption,,, guile, GNU
14324 Guile Reference Manual}, for information on Guile's @code{crypt} procedure.
14325
14326 @end table
14327 @end deftp
14328
14329 @cindex groups
14330 User group declarations are even simpler:
14331
14332 @lisp
14333 (user-group (name "students"))
14334 @end lisp
14335
14336 @deftp {Data Type} user-group
14337 This type is for, well, user groups. There are just a few fields:
14338
14339 @table @asis
14340 @item @code{name}
14341 The name of the group.
14342
14343 @item @code{id} (default: @code{#f})
14344 The group identifier (a number). If @code{#f}, a new number is
14345 automatically allocated when the group is created.
14346
14347 @item @code{system?} (default: @code{#f})
14348 This Boolean value indicates whether the group is a ``system'' group.
14349 System groups have low numerical IDs.
14350
14351 @item @code{password} (default: @code{#f})
14352 What, user groups can have a password? Well, apparently yes. Unless
14353 @code{#f}, this field specifies the password of the group.
14354
14355 @end table
14356 @end deftp
14357
14358 For convenience, a variable lists all the basic user groups one may
14359 expect:
14360
14361 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %base-groups
14362 This is the list of basic user groups that users and/or packages expect
14363 to be present on the system. This includes groups such as ``root'',
14364 ``wheel'', and ``users'', as well as groups used to control access to
14365 specific devices such as ``audio'', ``disk'', and ``cdrom''.
14366 @end defvr
14367
14368 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %base-user-accounts
14369 This is the list of basic system accounts that programs may expect to
14370 find on a GNU/Linux system, such as the ``nobody'' account.
14371
14372 Note that the ``root'' account is not included here. It is a
14373 special-case and is automatically added whether or not it is specified.
14374 @end defvr
14375
14376 @node Keyboard Layout
14377 @section Keyboard Layout
14378
14379 @cindex keyboard layout
14380 @cindex keymap
14381 To specify what each key of your keyboard does, you need to tell the operating
14382 system what @dfn{keyboard layout} you want to use. The default, when nothing
14383 is specified, is the US English QWERTY layout for 105-key PC keyboards.
14384 However, German speakers will usually prefer the German QWERTZ layout, French
14385 speakers will want the AZERTY layout, and so on; hackers might prefer Dvorak
14386 or bépo, and they might even want to further customize the effect of some of
14387 the keys. This section explains how to get that done.
14388
14389 @cindex keyboard layout, definition
14390 There are three components that will want to know about your keyboard layout:
14391
14392 @itemize
14393 @item
14394 The @emph{bootloader} may want to know what keyboard layout you want to use
14395 (@pxref{Bootloader Configuration, @code{keyboard-layout}}). This is useful if
14396 you want, for instance, to make sure that you can type the passphrase of your
14397 encrypted root partition using the right layout.
14398
14399 @item
14400 The @emph{operating system kernel}, Linux, will need that so that the console
14401 is properly configured (@pxref{operating-system Reference,
14402 @code{keyboard-layout}}).
14403
14404 @item
14405 The @emph{graphical display server}, usually Xorg, also has its own idea of
14406 the keyboard layout (@pxref{X Window, @code{keyboard-layout}}).
14407 @end itemize
14408
14409 Guix allows you to configure all three separately but, fortunately, it allows
14410 you to share the same keyboard layout for all three components.
14411
14412 @cindex XKB, keyboard layouts
14413 Keyboard layouts are represented by records created by the
14414 @code{keyboard-layout} procedure of @code{(gnu system keyboard)}. Following
14415 the X Keyboard extension (XKB), each layout has four attributes: a name (often
14416 a language code such as ``fi'' for Finnish or ``jp'' for Japanese), an
14417 optional variant name, an optional keyboard model name, and a possibly empty
14418 list of additional options. In most cases the layout name is all you care
14419 about.
14420
14421 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} keyboard-layout @var{name} [@var{variant}] @
14422 [#:model] [#:options '()]
14423 Return a new keyboard layout with the given @var{name} and @var{variant}.
14424
14425 @var{name} must be a string such as @code{"fr"}; @var{variant} must be a
14426 string such as @code{"bepo"} or @code{"nodeadkeys"}. See the
14427 @code{xkeyboard-config} package for valid options.
14428 @end deffn
14429
14430 Here are a few examples:
14431
14432 @lisp
14433 ;; The German QWERTZ layout. Here we assume a standard
14434 ;; "pc105" keyboard model.
14435 (keyboard-layout "de")
14436
14437 ;; The bépo variant of the French layout.
14438 (keyboard-layout "fr" "bepo")
14439
14440 ;; The Catalan layout.
14441 (keyboard-layout "es" "cat")
14442
14443 ;; Arabic layout with "Alt-Shift" to switch to US layout.
14444 (keyboard-layout "ar,us" #:options '("grp:alt_shift_toggle"))
14445
14446 ;; The Latin American Spanish layout. In addition, the
14447 ;; "Caps Lock" key is used as an additional "Ctrl" key,
14448 ;; and the "Menu" key is used as a "Compose" key to enter
14449 ;; accented letters.
14450 (keyboard-layout "latam"
14451 #:options '("ctrl:nocaps" "compose:menu"))
14452
14453 ;; The Russian layout for a ThinkPad keyboard.
14454 (keyboard-layout "ru" #:model "thinkpad")
14455
14456 ;; The "US international" layout, which is the US layout plus
14457 ;; dead keys to enter accented characters. This is for an
14458 ;; Apple MacBook keyboard.
14459 (keyboard-layout "us" "intl" #:model "macbook78")
14460 @end lisp
14461
14462 See the @file{share/X11/xkb} directory of the @code{xkeyboard-config} package
14463 for a complete list of supported layouts, variants, and models.
14464
14465 @cindex keyboard layout, configuration
14466 Let's say you want your system to use the Turkish keyboard layout throughout
14467 your system---bootloader, console, and Xorg. Here's what your system
14468 configuration would look like:
14469
14470 @findex set-xorg-configuration
14471 @lisp
14472 ;; Using the Turkish layout for the bootloader, the console,
14473 ;; and for Xorg.
14474
14475 (operating-system
14476 ;; ...
14477 (keyboard-layout (keyboard-layout "tr")) ;for the console
14478 (bootloader (bootloader-configuration
14479 (bootloader grub-efi-bootloader)
14480 (target "/boot/efi")
14481 (keyboard-layout keyboard-layout))) ;for GRUB
14482 (services (cons (set-xorg-configuration
14483 (xorg-configuration ;for Xorg
14484 (keyboard-layout keyboard-layout)))
14485 %desktop-services)))
14486 @end lisp
14487
14488 In the example above, for GRUB and for Xorg, we just refer to the
14489 @code{keyboard-layout} field defined above, but we could just as well refer to
14490 a different layout. The @code{set-xorg-configuration} procedure communicates
14491 the desired Xorg configuration to the graphical log-in manager, by default
14492 GDM.
14493
14494 We've discussed how to specify the @emph{default} keyboard layout of your
14495 system when it starts, but you can also adjust it at run time:
14496
14497 @itemize
14498 @item
14499 If you're using GNOME, its settings panel has a ``Region & Language'' entry
14500 where you can select one or more keyboard layouts.
14501
14502 @item
14503 Under Xorg, the @command{setxkbmap} command (from the same-named package)
14504 allows you to change the current layout. For example, this is how you would
14505 change the layout to US Dvorak:
14506
14507 @example
14508 setxkbmap us dvorak
14509 @end example
14510
14511 @item
14512 The @code{loadkeys} command changes the keyboard layout in effect in the Linux
14513 console. However, note that @code{loadkeys} does @emph{not} use the XKB
14514 keyboard layout categorization described above. The command below loads the
14515 French bépo layout:
14516
14517 @example
14518 loadkeys fr-bepo
14519 @end example
14520 @end itemize
14521
14522 @node Locales
14523 @section Locales
14524
14525 @cindex locale
14526 A @dfn{locale} defines cultural conventions for a particular language
14527 and region of the world (@pxref{Locales,,, libc, The GNU C Library
14528 Reference Manual}). Each locale has a name that typically has the form
14529 @code{@var{language}_@var{territory}.@var{codeset}}---e.g.,
14530 @code{fr_LU.utf8} designates the locale for the French language, with
14531 cultural conventions from Luxembourg, and using the UTF-8 encoding.
14532
14533 @cindex locale definition
14534 Usually, you will want to specify the default locale for the machine
14535 using the @code{locale} field of the @code{operating-system} declaration
14536 (@pxref{operating-system Reference, @code{locale}}).
14537
14538 The selected locale is automatically added to the @dfn{locale
14539 definitions} known to the system if needed, with its codeset inferred
14540 from its name---e.g., @code{bo_CN.utf8} will be assumed to use the
14541 @code{UTF-8} codeset. Additional locale definitions can be specified in
14542 the @code{locale-definitions} slot of @code{operating-system}---this is
14543 useful, for instance, if the codeset could not be inferred from the
14544 locale name. The default set of locale definitions includes some widely
14545 used locales, but not all the available locales, in order to save space.
14546
14547 For instance, to add the North Frisian locale for Germany, the value of
14548 that field may be:
14549
14550 @lisp
14551 (cons (locale-definition
14552 (name "fy_DE.utf8") (source "fy_DE"))
14553 %default-locale-definitions)
14554 @end lisp
14555
14556 Likewise, to save space, one might want @code{locale-definitions} to
14557 list only the locales that are actually used, as in:
14558
14559 @lisp
14560 (list (locale-definition
14561 (name "ja_JP.eucjp") (source "ja_JP")
14562 (charset "EUC-JP")))
14563 @end lisp
14564
14565 @vindex LOCPATH
14566 The compiled locale definitions are available at
14567 @file{/run/current-system/locale/X.Y}, where @code{X.Y} is the libc
14568 version, which is the default location where the GNU@tie{}libc provided
14569 by Guix looks for locale data. This can be overridden using the
14570 @env{LOCPATH} environment variable (@pxref{locales-and-locpath,
14571 @env{LOCPATH} and locale packages}).
14572
14573 The @code{locale-definition} form is provided by the @code{(gnu system
14574 locale)} module. Details are given below.
14575
14576 @deftp {Data Type} locale-definition
14577 This is the data type of a locale definition.
14578
14579 @table @asis
14580
14581 @item @code{name}
14582 The name of the locale. @xref{Locale Names,,, libc, The GNU C Library
14583 Reference Manual}, for more information on locale names.
14584
14585 @item @code{source}
14586 The name of the source for that locale. This is typically the
14587 @code{@var{language}_@var{territory}} part of the locale name.
14588
14589 @item @code{charset} (default: @code{"UTF-8"})
14590 The ``character set'' or ``code set'' for that locale,
14591 @uref{https://www.iana.org/assignments/character-sets, as defined by
14592 IANA}.
14593
14594 @end table
14595 @end deftp
14596
14597 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %default-locale-definitions
14598 A list of commonly used UTF-8 locales, used as the default
14599 value of the @code{locale-definitions} field of @code{operating-system}
14600 declarations.
14601
14602 @cindex locale name
14603 @cindex normalized codeset in locale names
14604 These locale definitions use the @dfn{normalized codeset} for the part
14605 that follows the dot in the name (@pxref{Using gettextized software,
14606 normalized codeset,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}). So for
14607 instance it has @code{uk_UA.utf8} but @emph{not}, say,
14608 @code{uk_UA.UTF-8}.
14609 @end defvr
14610
14611 @subsection Locale Data Compatibility Considerations
14612
14613 @cindex incompatibility, of locale data
14614 @code{operating-system} declarations provide a @code{locale-libcs} field
14615 to specify the GNU@tie{}libc packages that are used to compile locale
14616 declarations (@pxref{operating-system Reference}). ``Why would I
14617 care?'', you may ask. Well, it turns out that the binary format of
14618 locale data is occasionally incompatible from one libc version to
14619 another.
14620
14621 @c See <https://sourceware.org/ml/libc-alpha/2015-09/msg00575.html>
14622 @c and <https://lists.gnu.org/archive/html/guix-devel/2015-08/msg00737.html>.
14623 For instance, a program linked against libc version 2.21 is unable to
14624 read locale data produced with libc 2.22; worse, that program
14625 @emph{aborts} instead of simply ignoring the incompatible locale
14626 data@footnote{Versions 2.23 and later of GNU@tie{}libc will simply skip
14627 the incompatible locale data, which is already an improvement.}.
14628 Similarly, a program linked against libc 2.22 can read most, but not
14629 all, of the locale data from libc 2.21 (specifically, @env{LC_COLLATE}
14630 data is incompatible); thus calls to @code{setlocale} may fail, but
14631 programs will not abort.
14632
14633 The ``problem'' with Guix is that users have a lot of freedom: They can
14634 choose whether and when to upgrade software in their profiles, and might
14635 be using a libc version different from the one the system administrator
14636 used to build the system-wide locale data.
14637
14638 Fortunately, unprivileged users can also install their own locale data
14639 and define @env{GUIX_LOCPATH} accordingly (@pxref{locales-and-locpath,
14640 @env{GUIX_LOCPATH} and locale packages}).
14641
14642 Still, it is best if the system-wide locale data at
14643 @file{/run/current-system/locale} is built for all the libc versions
14644 actually in use on the system, so that all the programs can access
14645 it---this is especially crucial on a multi-user system. To do that, the
14646 administrator can specify several libc packages in the
14647 @code{locale-libcs} field of @code{operating-system}:
14648
14649 @lisp
14650 (use-package-modules base)
14651
14652 (operating-system
14653 ;; @dots{}
14654 (locale-libcs (list glibc-2.21 (canonical-package glibc))))
14655 @end lisp
14656
14657 This example would lead to a system containing locale definitions for
14658 both libc 2.21 and the current version of libc in
14659 @file{/run/current-system/locale}.
14660
14661
14662 @node Services
14663 @section Services
14664
14665 @cindex system services
14666 An important part of preparing an @code{operating-system} declaration is
14667 listing @dfn{system services} and their configuration (@pxref{Using the
14668 Configuration System}). System services are typically daemons launched
14669 when the system boots, or other actions needed at that time---e.g.,
14670 configuring network access.
14671
14672 Guix has a broad definition of ``service'' (@pxref{Service
14673 Composition}), but many services are managed by the GNU@tie{}Shepherd
14674 (@pxref{Shepherd Services}). On a running system, the @command{herd}
14675 command allows you to list the available services, show their status,
14676 start and stop them, or do other specific operations (@pxref{Jump
14677 Start,,, shepherd, The GNU Shepherd Manual}). For example:
14678
14679 @example
14680 # herd status
14681 @end example
14682
14683 The above command, run as @code{root}, lists the currently defined
14684 services. The @command{herd doc} command shows a synopsis of the given
14685 service and its associated actions:
14686
14687 @example
14688 # herd doc nscd
14689 Run libc's name service cache daemon (nscd).
14690
14691 # herd doc nscd action invalidate
14692 invalidate: Invalidate the given cache--e.g., 'hosts' for host name lookups.
14693 @end example
14694
14695 The @command{start}, @command{stop}, and @command{restart} sub-commands
14696 have the effect you would expect. For instance, the commands below stop
14697 the nscd service and restart the Xorg display server:
14698
14699 @example
14700 # herd stop nscd
14701 Service nscd has been stopped.
14702 # herd restart xorg-server
14703 Service xorg-server has been stopped.
14704 Service xorg-server has been started.
14705 @end example
14706
14707 The following sections document the available services, starting with
14708 the core services, that may be used in an @code{operating-system}
14709 declaration.
14710
14711 @menu
14712 * Base Services:: Essential system services.
14713 * Scheduled Job Execution:: The mcron service.
14714 * Log Rotation:: The rottlog service.
14715 * Networking Services:: Network setup, SSH daemon, etc.
14716 * Unattended Upgrades:: Automated system upgrades.
14717 * X Window:: Graphical display.
14718 * Printing Services:: Local and remote printer support.
14719 * Desktop Services:: D-Bus and desktop services.
14720 * Sound Services:: ALSA and Pulseaudio services.
14721 * Database Services:: SQL databases, key-value stores, etc.
14722 * Mail Services:: IMAP, POP3, SMTP, and all that.
14723 * Messaging Services:: Messaging services.
14724 * Telephony Services:: Telephony services.
14725 * File-Sharing Services:: File-sharing services.
14726 * Monitoring Services:: Monitoring services.
14727 * Kerberos Services:: Kerberos services.
14728 * LDAP Services:: LDAP services.
14729 * Web Services:: Web servers.
14730 * Certificate Services:: TLS certificates via Let's Encrypt.
14731 * DNS Services:: DNS daemons.
14732 * VPN Services:: VPN daemons.
14733 * Network File System:: NFS related services.
14734 * Continuous Integration:: The Cuirass service.
14735 * Power Management Services:: Extending battery life.
14736 * Audio Services:: The MPD.
14737 * Virtualization Services:: Virtualization services.
14738 * Version Control Services:: Providing remote access to Git repositories.
14739 * Game Services:: Game servers.
14740 * PAM Mount Service:: Service to mount volumes when logging in.
14741 * Guix Services:: Services relating specifically to Guix.
14742 * Linux Services:: Services tied to the Linux kernel.
14743 * Hurd Services:: Services specific for a Hurd System.
14744 * Miscellaneous Services:: Other services.
14745 @end menu
14746
14747 @node Base Services
14748 @subsection Base Services
14749
14750 The @code{(gnu services base)} module provides definitions for the basic
14751 services that one expects from the system. The services exported by
14752 this module are listed below.
14753
14754 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %base-services
14755 This variable contains a list of basic services (@pxref{Service Types
14756 and Services}, for more information on service objects) one would
14757 expect from the system: a login service (mingetty) on each tty, syslogd,
14758 the libc name service cache daemon (nscd), the udev device manager, and
14759 more.
14760
14761 This is the default value of the @code{services} field of
14762 @code{operating-system} declarations. Usually, when customizing a
14763 system, you will want to append services to @code{%base-services}, like
14764 this:
14765
14766 @lisp
14767 (append (list (service avahi-service-type)
14768 (service openssh-service-type))
14769 %base-services)
14770 @end lisp
14771 @end defvr
14772
14773 @defvr {Scheme Variable} special-files-service-type
14774 This is the service that sets up ``special files'' such as
14775 @file{/bin/sh}; an instance of it is part of @code{%base-services}.
14776
14777 The value associated with @code{special-files-service-type} services
14778 must be a list of tuples where the first element is the ``special file''
14779 and the second element is its target. By default it is:
14780
14781 @cindex @file{/bin/sh}
14782 @cindex @file{sh}, in @file{/bin}
14783 @lisp
14784 `(("/bin/sh" ,(file-append bash "/bin/sh")))
14785 @end lisp
14786
14787 @cindex @file{/usr/bin/env}
14788 @cindex @file{env}, in @file{/usr/bin}
14789 If you want to add, say, @code{/usr/bin/env} to your system, you can
14790 change it to:
14791
14792 @lisp
14793 `(("/bin/sh" ,(file-append bash "/bin/sh"))
14794 ("/usr/bin/env" ,(file-append coreutils "/bin/env")))
14795 @end lisp
14796
14797 Since this is part of @code{%base-services}, you can use
14798 @code{modify-services} to customize the set of special files
14799 (@pxref{Service Reference, @code{modify-services}}). But the simple way
14800 to add a special file is @i{via} the @code{extra-special-file} procedure
14801 (see below).
14802 @end defvr
14803
14804 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} extra-special-file @var{file} @var{target}
14805 Use @var{target} as the ``special file'' @var{file}.
14806
14807 For example, adding the following lines to the @code{services} field of
14808 your operating system declaration leads to a @file{/usr/bin/env}
14809 symlink:
14810
14811 @lisp
14812 (extra-special-file "/usr/bin/env"
14813 (file-append coreutils "/bin/env"))
14814 @end lisp
14815 @end deffn
14816
14817 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} host-name-service @var{name}
14818 Return a service that sets the host name to @var{name}.
14819 @end deffn
14820
14821 @defvr {Scheme Variable} console-font-service-type
14822 Install the given fonts on the specified ttys (fonts are per
14823 virtual console on the kernel Linux). The value of this service is a list of
14824 tty/font pairs. The font can be the name of a font provided by the @code{kbd}
14825 package or any valid argument to @command{setfont}, as in this example:
14826
14827 @lisp
14828 `(("tty1" . "LatGrkCyr-8x16")
14829 ("tty2" . ,(file-append
14830 font-tamzen
14831 "/share/kbd/consolefonts/TamzenForPowerline10x20.psf"))
14832 ("tty3" . ,(file-append
14833 font-terminus
14834 "/share/consolefonts/ter-132n"))) ; for HDPI
14835 @end lisp
14836 @end defvr
14837
14838 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} login-service @var{config}
14839 Return a service to run login according to @var{config}, a
14840 @code{<login-configuration>} object, which specifies the message of the day,
14841 among other things.
14842 @end deffn
14843
14844 @deftp {Data Type} login-configuration
14845 This is the data type representing the configuration of login.
14846
14847 @table @asis
14848
14849 @item @code{motd}
14850 @cindex message of the day
14851 A file-like object containing the ``message of the day''.
14852
14853 @item @code{allow-empty-passwords?} (default: @code{#t})
14854 Allow empty passwords by default so that first-time users can log in when
14855 the 'root' account has just been created.
14856
14857 @end table
14858 @end deftp
14859
14860 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} mingetty-service @var{config}
14861 Return a service to run mingetty according to @var{config}, a
14862 @code{<mingetty-configuration>} object, which specifies the tty to run, among
14863 other things.
14864 @end deffn
14865
14866 @deftp {Data Type} mingetty-configuration
14867 This is the data type representing the configuration of Mingetty, which
14868 provides the default implementation of virtual console log-in.
14869
14870 @table @asis
14871
14872 @item @code{tty}
14873 The name of the console this Mingetty runs on---e.g., @code{"tty1"}.
14874
14875 @item @code{auto-login} (default: @code{#f})
14876 When true, this field must be a string denoting the user name under
14877 which the system automatically logs in. When it is @code{#f}, a
14878 user name and password must be entered to log in.
14879
14880 @item @code{login-program} (default: @code{#f})
14881 This must be either @code{#f}, in which case the default log-in program
14882 is used (@command{login} from the Shadow tool suite), or a gexp denoting
14883 the name of the log-in program.
14884
14885 @item @code{login-pause?} (default: @code{#f})
14886 When set to @code{#t} in conjunction with @var{auto-login}, the user
14887 will have to press a key before the log-in shell is launched.
14888
14889 @item @code{clear-on-logout?} (default: @code{#t})
14890 When set to @code{#t}, the screen will be cleared after logout.
14891
14892 @item @code{mingetty} (default: @var{mingetty})
14893 The Mingetty package to use.
14894
14895 @end table
14896 @end deftp
14897
14898 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} agetty-service @var{config}
14899 Return a service to run agetty according to @var{config}, an
14900 @code{<agetty-configuration>} object, which specifies the tty to run,
14901 among other things.
14902 @end deffn
14903
14904 @deftp {Data Type} agetty-configuration
14905 This is the data type representing the configuration of agetty, which
14906 implements virtual and serial console log-in. See the @code{agetty(8)}
14907 man page for more information.
14908
14909 @table @asis
14910
14911 @item @code{tty}
14912 The name of the console this agetty runs on, as a string---e.g.,
14913 @code{"ttyS0"}. This argument is optional, it will default to
14914 a reasonable default serial port used by the kernel Linux.
14915
14916 For this, if there is a value for an option @code{agetty.tty} in the kernel
14917 command line, agetty will extract the device name of the serial port
14918 from it and use that.
14919
14920 If not and if there is a value for an option @code{console} with a tty in
14921 the Linux command line, agetty will extract the device name of the
14922 serial port from it and use that.
14923
14924 In both cases, agetty will leave the other serial device settings
14925 (baud rate etc.)@: alone---in the hope that Linux pinned them to the
14926 correct values.
14927
14928 @item @code{baud-rate} (default: @code{#f})
14929 A string containing a comma-separated list of one or more baud rates, in
14930 descending order.
14931
14932 @item @code{term} (default: @code{#f})
14933 A string containing the value used for the @env{TERM} environment
14934 variable.
14935
14936 @item @code{eight-bits?} (default: @code{#f})
14937 When @code{#t}, the tty is assumed to be 8-bit clean, and parity detection is
14938 disabled.
14939
14940 @item @code{auto-login} (default: @code{#f})
14941 When passed a login name, as a string, the specified user will be logged
14942 in automatically without prompting for their login name or password.
14943
14944 @item @code{no-reset?} (default: @code{#f})
14945 When @code{#t}, don't reset terminal cflags (control modes).
14946
14947 @item @code{host} (default: @code{#f})
14948 This accepts a string containing the ``login_host'', which will be written
14949 into the @file{/var/run/utmpx} file.
14950
14951 @item @code{remote?} (default: @code{#f})
14952 When set to @code{#t} in conjunction with @var{host}, this will add an
14953 @code{-r} fakehost option to the command line of the login program
14954 specified in @var{login-program}.
14955
14956 @item @code{flow-control?} (default: @code{#f})
14957 When set to @code{#t}, enable hardware (RTS/CTS) flow control.
14958
14959 @item @code{no-issue?} (default: @code{#f})
14960 When set to @code{#t}, the contents of the @file{/etc/issue} file will
14961 not be displayed before presenting the login prompt.
14962
14963 @item @code{init-string} (default: @code{#f})
14964 This accepts a string that will be sent to the tty or modem before
14965 sending anything else. It can be used to initialize a modem.
14966
14967 @item @code{no-clear?} (default: @code{#f})
14968 When set to @code{#t}, agetty will not clear the screen before showing
14969 the login prompt.
14970
14971 @item @code{login-program} (default: (file-append shadow "/bin/login"))
14972 This must be either a gexp denoting the name of a log-in program, or
14973 unset, in which case the default value is the @command{login} from the
14974 Shadow tool suite.
14975
14976 @item @code{local-line} (default: @code{#f})
14977 Control the CLOCAL line flag. This accepts one of three symbols as
14978 arguments, @code{'auto}, @code{'always}, or @code{'never}. If @code{#f},
14979 the default value chosen by agetty is @code{'auto}.
14980
14981 @item @code{extract-baud?} (default: @code{#f})
14982 When set to @code{#t}, instruct agetty to try to extract the baud rate
14983 from the status messages produced by certain types of modems.
14984
14985 @item @code{skip-login?} (default: @code{#f})
14986 When set to @code{#t}, do not prompt the user for a login name. This
14987 can be used with @var{login-program} field to use non-standard login
14988 systems.
14989
14990 @item @code{no-newline?} (default: @code{#f})
14991 When set to @code{#t}, do not print a newline before printing the
14992 @file{/etc/issue} file.
14993
14994 @c Is this dangerous only when used with login-program, or always?
14995 @item @code{login-options} (default: @code{#f})
14996 This option accepts a string containing options that are passed to the
14997 login program. When used with the @var{login-program}, be aware that a
14998 malicious user could try to enter a login name containing embedded
14999 options that could be parsed by the login program.
15000
15001 @item @code{login-pause} (default: @code{#f})
15002 When set to @code{#t}, wait for any key before showing the login prompt.
15003 This can be used in conjunction with @var{auto-login} to save memory by
15004 lazily spawning shells.
15005
15006 @item @code{chroot} (default: @code{#f})
15007 Change root to the specified directory. This option accepts a directory
15008 path as a string.
15009
15010 @item @code{hangup?} (default: @code{#f})
15011 Use the Linux system call @code{vhangup} to do a virtual hangup of the
15012 specified terminal.
15013
15014 @item @code{keep-baud?} (default: @code{#f})
15015 When set to @code{#t}, try to keep the existing baud rate. The baud
15016 rates from @var{baud-rate} are used when agetty receives a @key{BREAK}
15017 character.
15018
15019 @item @code{timeout} (default: @code{#f})
15020 When set to an integer value, terminate if no user name could be read
15021 within @var{timeout} seconds.
15022
15023 @item @code{detect-case?} (default: @code{#f})
15024 When set to @code{#t}, turn on support for detecting an uppercase-only
15025 terminal. This setting will detect a login name containing only
15026 uppercase letters as indicating an uppercase-only terminal and turn on
15027 some upper-to-lower case conversions. Note that this will not support
15028 Unicode characters.
15029
15030 @item @code{wait-cr?} (default: @code{#f})
15031 When set to @code{#t}, wait for the user or modem to send a
15032 carriage-return or linefeed character before displaying
15033 @file{/etc/issue} or login prompt. This is typically used with the
15034 @var{init-string} option.
15035
15036 @item @code{no-hints?} (default: @code{#f})
15037 When set to @code{#t}, do not print hints about Num, Caps, and Scroll
15038 locks.
15039
15040 @item @code{no-hostname?} (default: @code{#f})
15041 By default, the hostname is printed. When this option is set to
15042 @code{#t}, no hostname will be shown at all.
15043
15044 @item @code{long-hostname?} (default: @code{#f})
15045 By default, the hostname is only printed until the first dot. When this
15046 option is set to @code{#t}, the fully qualified hostname by
15047 @code{gethostname} or @code{getaddrinfo} is shown.
15048
15049 @item @code{erase-characters} (default: @code{#f})
15050 This option accepts a string of additional characters that should be
15051 interpreted as backspace when the user types their login name.
15052
15053 @item @code{kill-characters} (default: @code{#f})
15054 This option accepts a string that should be interpreted to mean ``ignore
15055 all previous characters'' (also called a ``kill'' character) when the user
15056 types their login name.
15057
15058 @item @code{chdir} (default: @code{#f})
15059 This option accepts, as a string, a directory path that will be changed
15060 to before login.
15061
15062 @item @code{delay} (default: @code{#f})
15063 This options accepts, as an integer, the number of seconds to sleep
15064 before opening the tty and displaying the login prompt.
15065
15066 @item @code{nice} (default: @code{#f})
15067 This option accepts, as an integer, the nice value with which to run the
15068 @command{login} program.
15069
15070 @item @code{extra-options} (default: @code{'()})
15071 This option provides an ``escape hatch'' for the user to provide arbitrary
15072 command-line arguments to @command{agetty} as a list of strings.
15073
15074 @end table
15075 @end deftp
15076
15077 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} kmscon-service-type @var{config}
15078 Return a service to run @uref{https://www.freedesktop.org/wiki/Software/kmscon,kmscon}
15079 according to @var{config}, a @code{<kmscon-configuration>} object, which
15080 specifies the tty to run, among other things.
15081 @end deffn
15082
15083 @deftp {Data Type} kmscon-configuration
15084 This is the data type representing the configuration of Kmscon, which
15085 implements virtual console log-in.
15086
15087 @table @asis
15088
15089 @item @code{virtual-terminal}
15090 The name of the console this Kmscon runs on---e.g., @code{"tty1"}.
15091
15092 @item @code{login-program} (default: @code{#~(string-append #$shadow "/bin/login")})
15093 A gexp denoting the name of the log-in program. The default log-in program is
15094 @command{login} from the Shadow tool suite.
15095
15096 @item @code{login-arguments} (default: @code{'("-p")})
15097 A list of arguments to pass to @command{login}.
15098
15099 @item @code{auto-login} (default: @code{#f})
15100 When passed a login name, as a string, the specified user will be logged
15101 in automatically without prompting for their login name or password.
15102
15103 @item @code{hardware-acceleration?} (default: #f)
15104 Whether to use hardware acceleration.
15105
15106 @item @code{kmscon} (default: @var{kmscon})
15107 The Kmscon package to use.
15108
15109 @end table
15110 @end deftp
15111
15112 @cindex name service cache daemon
15113 @cindex nscd
15114 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} nscd-service [@var{config}] [#:glibc glibc] @
15115 [#:name-services '()]
15116 Return a service that runs the libc name service cache daemon (nscd) with the
15117 given @var{config}---an @code{<nscd-configuration>} object. @xref{Name
15118 Service Switch}, for an example.
15119
15120 For convenience, the Shepherd service for nscd provides the following actions:
15121
15122 @table @code
15123 @item invalidate
15124 @cindex cache invalidation, nscd
15125 @cindex nscd, cache invalidation
15126 This invalidate the given cache. For instance, running:
15127
15128 @example
15129 herd invalidate nscd hosts
15130 @end example
15131
15132 @noindent
15133 invalidates the host name lookup cache of nscd.
15134
15135 @item statistics
15136 Running @command{herd statistics nscd} displays information about nscd usage
15137 and caches.
15138 @end table
15139
15140 @end deffn
15141
15142 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %nscd-default-configuration
15143 This is the default @code{<nscd-configuration>} value (see below) used
15144 by @code{nscd-service}. It uses the caches defined by
15145 @code{%nscd-default-caches}; see below.
15146 @end defvr
15147
15148 @deftp {Data Type} nscd-configuration
15149 This is the data type representing the name service cache daemon (nscd)
15150 configuration.
15151
15152 @table @asis
15153
15154 @item @code{name-services} (default: @code{'()})
15155 List of packages denoting @dfn{name services} that must be visible to
15156 the nscd---e.g., @code{(list @var{nss-mdns})}.
15157
15158 @item @code{glibc} (default: @var{glibc})
15159 Package object denoting the GNU C Library providing the @command{nscd}
15160 command.
15161
15162 @item @code{log-file} (default: @code{"/var/log/nscd.log"})
15163 Name of the nscd log file. This is where debugging output goes when
15164 @code{debug-level} is strictly positive.
15165
15166 @item @code{debug-level} (default: @code{0})
15167 Integer denoting the debugging levels. Higher numbers mean that more
15168 debugging output is logged.
15169
15170 @item @code{caches} (default: @code{%nscd-default-caches})
15171 List of @code{<nscd-cache>} objects denoting things to be cached; see
15172 below.
15173
15174 @end table
15175 @end deftp
15176
15177 @deftp {Data Type} nscd-cache
15178 Data type representing a cache database of nscd and its parameters.
15179
15180 @table @asis
15181
15182 @item @code{database}
15183 This is a symbol representing the name of the database to be cached.
15184 Valid values are @code{passwd}, @code{group}, @code{hosts}, and
15185 @code{services}, which designate the corresponding NSS database
15186 (@pxref{NSS Basics,,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}).
15187
15188 @item @code{positive-time-to-live}
15189 @itemx @code{negative-time-to-live} (default: @code{20})
15190 A number representing the number of seconds during which a positive or
15191 negative lookup result remains in cache.
15192
15193 @item @code{check-files?} (default: @code{#t})
15194 Whether to check for updates of the files corresponding to
15195 @var{database}.
15196
15197 For instance, when @var{database} is @code{hosts}, setting this flag
15198 instructs nscd to check for updates in @file{/etc/hosts} and to take
15199 them into account.
15200
15201 @item @code{persistent?} (default: @code{#t})
15202 Whether the cache should be stored persistently on disk.
15203
15204 @item @code{shared?} (default: @code{#t})
15205 Whether the cache should be shared among users.
15206
15207 @item @code{max-database-size} (default: 32@tie{}MiB)
15208 Maximum size in bytes of the database cache.
15209
15210 @c XXX: 'suggested-size' and 'auto-propagate?' seem to be expert
15211 @c settings, so leave them out.
15212
15213 @end table
15214 @end deftp
15215
15216 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %nscd-default-caches
15217 List of @code{<nscd-cache>} objects used by default by
15218 @code{nscd-configuration} (see above).
15219
15220 It enables persistent and aggressive caching of service and host name
15221 lookups. The latter provides better host name lookup performance,
15222 resilience in the face of unreliable name servers, and also better
15223 privacy---often the result of host name lookups is in local cache, so
15224 external name servers do not even need to be queried.
15225 @end defvr
15226
15227 @anchor{syslog-configuration-type}
15228 @cindex syslog
15229 @cindex logging
15230 @deftp {Data Type} syslog-configuration
15231 This data type represents the configuration of the syslog daemon.
15232
15233 @table @asis
15234 @item @code{syslogd} (default: @code{#~(string-append #$inetutils "/libexec/syslogd")})
15235 The syslog daemon to use.
15236
15237 @item @code{config-file} (default: @code{%default-syslog.conf})
15238 The syslog configuration file to use.
15239
15240 @end table
15241 @end deftp
15242
15243 @anchor{syslog-service}
15244 @cindex syslog
15245 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} syslog-service @var{config}
15246 Return a service that runs a syslog daemon according to @var{config}.
15247
15248 @xref{syslogd invocation,,, inetutils, GNU Inetutils}, for more
15249 information on the configuration file syntax.
15250 @end deffn
15251
15252 @defvr {Scheme Variable} guix-service-type
15253 This is the type of the service that runs the build daemon,
15254 @command{guix-daemon} (@pxref{Invoking guix-daemon}). Its value must be a
15255 @code{guix-configuration} record as described below.
15256 @end defvr
15257
15258 @anchor{guix-configuration-type}
15259 @deftp {Data Type} guix-configuration
15260 This data type represents the configuration of the Guix build daemon.
15261 @xref{Invoking guix-daemon}, for more information.
15262
15263 @table @asis
15264 @item @code{guix} (default: @var{guix})
15265 The Guix package to use.
15266
15267 @item @code{build-group} (default: @code{"guixbuild"})
15268 Name of the group for build user accounts.
15269
15270 @item @code{build-accounts} (default: @code{10})
15271 Number of build user accounts to create.
15272
15273 @item @code{authorize-key?} (default: @code{#t})
15274 @cindex substitutes, authorization thereof
15275 Whether to authorize the substitute keys listed in
15276 @code{authorized-keys}---by default that of @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}}
15277 (@pxref{Substitutes}).
15278
15279 When @code{authorize-key?} is true, @file{/etc/guix/acl} cannot be
15280 changed by invoking @command{guix archive --authorize}. You must
15281 instead adjust @code{guix-configuration} as you wish and reconfigure the
15282 system. This ensures that your operating system configuration file is
15283 self-contained.
15284
15285 @quotation Note
15286 When booting or reconfiguring to a system where @code{authorize-key?}
15287 is true, the existing @file{/etc/guix/acl} file is backed up as
15288 @file{/etc/guix/acl.bak} if it was determined to be a manually modified
15289 file. This is to facilitate migration from earlier versions, which
15290 allowed for in-place modifications to @file{/etc/guix/acl}.
15291 @end quotation
15292
15293 @vindex %default-authorized-guix-keys
15294 @item @code{authorized-keys} (default: @code{%default-authorized-guix-keys})
15295 The list of authorized key files for archive imports, as a list of
15296 string-valued gexps (@pxref{Invoking guix archive}). By default, it
15297 contains that of @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}} (@pxref{Substitutes}).
15298 See @code{substitute-urls} below for an example on how to change it.
15299
15300 @item @code{use-substitutes?} (default: @code{#t})
15301 Whether to use substitutes.
15302
15303 @item @code{substitute-urls} (default: @code{%default-substitute-urls})
15304 The list of URLs where to look for substitutes by default.
15305
15306 Suppose you would like to fetch substitutes from @code{guix.example.org}
15307 in addition to @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}}. You will need to do
15308 two things: (1) add @code{guix.example.org} to @code{substitute-urls},
15309 and (2) authorize its signing key, having done appropriate checks
15310 (@pxref{Substitute Server Authorization}). The configuration below does
15311 exactly that:
15312
15313 @lisp
15314 (guix-configuration
15315 (substitute-urls
15316 (append (list "https://guix.example.org")
15317 %default-substitute-urls))
15318 (authorized-keys
15319 (append (list (local-file "./guix.example.org-key.pub"))
15320 %default-authorized-guix-keys)))
15321 @end lisp
15322
15323 This example assumes that the file @file{./guix.example.org-key.pub}
15324 contains the public key that @code{guix.example.org} uses to sign
15325 substitutes.
15326
15327 @item @code{max-silent-time} (default: @code{0})
15328 @itemx @code{timeout} (default: @code{0})
15329 The number of seconds of silence and the number of seconds of activity,
15330 respectively, after which a build process times out. A value of zero
15331 disables the timeout.
15332
15333 @item @code{log-compression} (default: @code{'bzip2})
15334 The type of compression used for build logs---one of @code{gzip},
15335 @code{bzip2}, or @code{none}.
15336
15337 @item @code{discover?} (default: @code{#f})
15338 Whether to discover substitute servers on the local network using mDNS
15339 and DNS-SD.
15340
15341 @item @code{extra-options} (default: @code{'()})
15342 List of extra command-line options for @command{guix-daemon}.
15343
15344 @item @code{log-file} (default: @code{"/var/log/guix-daemon.log"})
15345 File where @command{guix-daemon}'s standard output and standard error
15346 are written.
15347
15348 @cindex HTTP proxy, for @code{guix-daemon}
15349 @cindex proxy, for @code{guix-daemon} HTTP access
15350 @item @code{http-proxy} (default: @code{#f})
15351 The URL of the HTTP and HTTPS proxy used for downloading fixed-output
15352 derivations and substitutes.
15353
15354 It is also possible to change the daemon's proxy at run time through the
15355 @code{set-http-proxy} action, which restarts it:
15356
15357 @example
15358 herd set-http-proxy guix-daemon http://localhost:8118
15359 @end example
15360
15361 To clear the proxy settings, run:
15362
15363 @example
15364 herd set-http-proxy guix-daemon
15365 @end example
15366
15367 @item @code{tmpdir} (default: @code{#f})
15368 A directory path where the @command{guix-daemon} will perform builds.
15369
15370 @end table
15371 @end deftp
15372
15373 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} udev-service [#:udev @var{eudev} #:rules @code{'()}]
15374 Run @var{udev}, which populates the @file{/dev} directory dynamically.
15375 udev rules can be provided as a list of files through the @var{rules}
15376 variable. The procedures @code{udev-rule}, @code{udev-rules-service}
15377 and @code{file->udev-rule} from @code{(gnu services base)} simplify the
15378 creation of such rule files.
15379
15380 The @command{herd rules udev} command, as root, returns the name of the
15381 directory containing all the active udev rules.
15382 @end deffn
15383
15384 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} udev-rule [@var{file-name} @var{contents}]
15385 Return a udev-rule file named @var{file-name} containing the rules
15386 defined by the @var{contents} literal.
15387
15388 In the following example, a rule for a USB device is defined to be
15389 stored in the file @file{90-usb-thing.rules}. The rule runs a script
15390 upon detecting a USB device with a given product identifier.
15391
15392 @lisp
15393 (define %example-udev-rule
15394 (udev-rule
15395 "90-usb-thing.rules"
15396 (string-append "ACTION==\"add\", SUBSYSTEM==\"usb\", "
15397 "ATTR@{product@}==\"Example\", "
15398 "RUN+=\"/path/to/script\"")))
15399 @end lisp
15400 @end deffn
15401
15402 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} udev-rules-service [@var{name} @var{rules}] @
15403 [#:groups @var{groups}]
15404 Return a service that extends @code{udev-service-type } with @var{rules}
15405 and @code{account-service-type} with @var{groups} as system groups.
15406 This works by creating a singleton service type
15407 @code{@var{name}-udev-rules}, of which the returned service is an
15408 instance.
15409
15410 Here we show how it can be used to extend @code{udev-service-type} with the
15411 previously defined rule @code{%example-udev-rule}.
15412
15413 @lisp
15414 (operating-system
15415 ;; @dots{}
15416 (services
15417 (cons (udev-rules-service 'usb-thing %example-udev-rule)
15418 %desktop-services)))
15419 @end lisp
15420 @end deffn
15421
15422 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} file->udev-rule [@var{file-name} @var{file}]
15423 Return a udev file named @var{file-name} containing the rules defined
15424 within @var{file}, a file-like object.
15425
15426 The following example showcases how we can use an existing rule file.
15427
15428 @lisp
15429 (use-modules (guix download) ;for url-fetch
15430 (guix packages) ;for origin
15431 @dots{})
15432
15433 (define %android-udev-rules
15434 (file->udev-rule
15435 "51-android-udev.rules"
15436 (let ((version "20170910"))
15437 (origin
15438 (method url-fetch)
15439 (uri (string-append "https://raw.githubusercontent.com/M0Rf30/"
15440 "android-udev-rules/" version "/51-android.rules"))
15441 (sha256
15442 (base32 "0lmmagpyb6xsq6zcr2w1cyx9qmjqmajkvrdbhjx32gqf1d9is003"))))))
15443 @end lisp
15444 @end deffn
15445
15446 Additionally, Guix package definitions can be included in @var{rules} in
15447 order to extend the udev rules with the definitions found under their
15448 @file{lib/udev/rules.d} sub-directory. In lieu of the previous
15449 @var{file->udev-rule} example, we could have used the
15450 @var{android-udev-rules} package which exists in Guix in the @code{(gnu
15451 packages android)} module.
15452
15453 The following example shows how to use the @var{android-udev-rules}
15454 package so that the Android tool @command{adb} can detect devices
15455 without root privileges. It also details how to create the
15456 @code{adbusers} group, which is required for the proper functioning of
15457 the rules defined within the @code{android-udev-rules} package. To
15458 create such a group, we must define it both as part of the
15459 @code{supplementary-groups} of our @code{user-account} declaration, as
15460 well as in the @var{groups} of the @code{udev-rules-service} procedure.
15461
15462 @lisp
15463 (use-modules (gnu packages android) ;for android-udev-rules
15464 (gnu system shadow) ;for user-group
15465 @dots{})
15466
15467 (operating-system
15468 ;; @dots{}
15469 (users (cons (user-account
15470 ;; @dots{}
15471 (supplementary-groups
15472 '("adbusers" ;for adb
15473 "wheel" "netdev" "audio" "video")))))
15474 ;; @dots{}
15475 (services
15476 (cons (udev-rules-service 'android android-udev-rules
15477 #:groups '("adbusers"))
15478 %desktop-services)))
15479 @end lisp
15480
15481 @defvr {Scheme Variable} urandom-seed-service-type
15482 Save some entropy in @code{%random-seed-file} to seed @file{/dev/urandom}
15483 when rebooting. It also tries to seed @file{/dev/urandom} from
15484 @file{/dev/hwrng} while booting, if @file{/dev/hwrng} exists and is
15485 readable.
15486 @end defvr
15487
15488 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %random-seed-file
15489 This is the name of the file where some random bytes are saved by
15490 @var{urandom-seed-service} to seed @file{/dev/urandom} when rebooting.
15491 It defaults to @file{/var/lib/random-seed}.
15492 @end defvr
15493
15494 @cindex mouse
15495 @cindex gpm
15496 @defvr {Scheme Variable} gpm-service-type
15497 This is the type of the service that runs GPM, the @dfn{general-purpose
15498 mouse daemon}, which provides mouse support to the Linux console. GPM
15499 allows users to use the mouse in the console, notably to select, copy,
15500 and paste text.
15501
15502 The value for services of this type must be a @code{gpm-configuration}
15503 (see below). This service is not part of @code{%base-services}.
15504 @end defvr
15505
15506 @deftp {Data Type} gpm-configuration
15507 Data type representing the configuration of GPM.
15508
15509 @table @asis
15510 @item @code{options} (default: @code{%default-gpm-options})
15511 Command-line options passed to @command{gpm}. The default set of
15512 options instruct @command{gpm} to listen to mouse events on
15513 @file{/dev/input/mice}. @xref{Command Line,,, gpm, gpm manual}, for
15514 more information.
15515
15516 @item @code{gpm} (default: @code{gpm})
15517 The GPM package to use.
15518
15519 @end table
15520 @end deftp
15521
15522 @anchor{guix-publish-service-type}
15523 @deffn {Scheme Variable} guix-publish-service-type
15524 This is the service type for @command{guix publish} (@pxref{Invoking
15525 guix publish}). Its value must be a @code{guix-publish-configuration}
15526 object, as described below.
15527
15528 This assumes that @file{/etc/guix} already contains a signing key pair as
15529 created by @command{guix archive --generate-key} (@pxref{Invoking guix
15530 archive}). If that is not the case, the service will fail to start.
15531 @end deffn
15532
15533 @deftp {Data Type} guix-publish-configuration
15534 Data type representing the configuration of the @code{guix publish}
15535 service.
15536
15537 @table @asis
15538 @item @code{guix} (default: @code{guix})
15539 The Guix package to use.
15540
15541 @item @code{port} (default: @code{80})
15542 The TCP port to listen for connections.
15543
15544 @item @code{host} (default: @code{"localhost"})
15545 The host (and thus, network interface) to listen to. Use
15546 @code{"0.0.0.0"} to listen on all the network interfaces.
15547
15548 @item @code{advertise?} (default: @code{#f})
15549 When true, advertise the service on the local network @i{via} the DNS-SD
15550 protocol, using Avahi.
15551
15552 This allows neighboring Guix devices with discovery on (see
15553 @code{guix-configuration} above) to discover this @command{guix publish}
15554 instance and to automatically download substitutes from it.
15555
15556 @item @code{compression} (default: @code{'(("gzip" 3))})
15557 This is a list of compression method/level tuple used when compressing
15558 substitutes. For example, to compress all substitutes with @emph{both} lzip
15559 at level 7 and gzip at level 9, write:
15560
15561 @lisp
15562 '(("lzip" 7) ("gzip" 9))
15563 @end lisp
15564
15565 Level 9 achieves the best compression ratio at the expense of increased CPU
15566 usage, whereas level 1 achieves fast compression. @xref{Invoking guix
15567 publish}, for more information on the available compression methods and
15568 the tradeoffs involved.
15569
15570 An empty list disables compression altogether.
15571
15572 @item @code{nar-path} (default: @code{"nar"})
15573 The URL path at which ``nars'' can be fetched. @xref{Invoking guix
15574 publish, @option{--nar-path}}, for details.
15575
15576 @item @code{cache} (default: @code{#f})
15577 When it is @code{#f}, disable caching and instead generate archives on
15578 demand. Otherwise, this should be the name of a directory---e.g.,
15579 @code{"/var/cache/guix/publish"}---where @command{guix publish} caches
15580 archives and meta-data ready to be sent. @xref{Invoking guix publish,
15581 @option{--cache}}, for more information on the tradeoffs involved.
15582
15583 @item @code{workers} (default: @code{#f})
15584 When it is an integer, this is the number of worker threads used for
15585 caching; when @code{#f}, the number of processors is used.
15586 @xref{Invoking guix publish, @option{--workers}}, for more information.
15587
15588 @item @code{cache-bypass-threshold} (default: 10 MiB)
15589 When @code{cache} is true, this is the maximum size in bytes of a store
15590 item for which @command{guix publish} may bypass its cache in case of a
15591 cache miss. @xref{Invoking guix publish,
15592 @option{--cache-bypass-threshold}}, for more information.
15593
15594 @item @code{ttl} (default: @code{#f})
15595 When it is an integer, this denotes the @dfn{time-to-live} in seconds
15596 of the published archives. @xref{Invoking guix publish, @option{--ttl}},
15597 for more information.
15598 @end table
15599 @end deftp
15600
15601 @anchor{rngd-service}
15602 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} rngd-service [#:rng-tools @var{rng-tools}] @
15603 [#:device "/dev/hwrng"]
15604 Return a service that runs the @command{rngd} program from @var{rng-tools}
15605 to add @var{device} to the kernel's entropy pool. The service will fail if
15606 @var{device} does not exist.
15607 @end deffn
15608
15609 @anchor{pam-limits-service}
15610 @cindex session limits
15611 @cindex ulimit
15612 @cindex priority
15613 @cindex realtime
15614 @cindex jackd
15615 @cindex nofile
15616 @cindex open file descriptors
15617 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} pam-limits-service [#:limits @code{'()}]
15618
15619 Return a service that installs a configuration file for the
15620 @uref{http://linux-pam.org/Linux-PAM-html/sag-pam_limits.html,
15621 @code{pam_limits} module}. The procedure optionally takes a list of
15622 @code{pam-limits-entry} values, which can be used to specify
15623 @code{ulimit} limits and @code{nice} priority limits to user sessions.
15624
15625 The following limits definition sets two hard and soft limits for all
15626 login sessions of users in the @code{realtime} group:
15627
15628 @lisp
15629 (pam-limits-service
15630 (list
15631 (pam-limits-entry "@@realtime" 'both 'rtprio 99)
15632 (pam-limits-entry "@@realtime" 'both 'memlock 'unlimited)))
15633 @end lisp
15634
15635 The first entry increases the maximum realtime priority for
15636 non-privileged processes; the second entry lifts any restriction of the
15637 maximum address space that can be locked in memory. These settings are
15638 commonly used for real-time audio systems.
15639
15640 Another useful example is raising the maximum number of open file
15641 descriptors that can be used:
15642
15643 @lisp
15644 (pam-limits-service
15645 (list
15646 (pam-limits-entry "*" 'both 'nofile 100000)))
15647 @end lisp
15648
15649 In the above example, the asterisk means the limit should apply to any
15650 user. It is important to ensure the chosen value doesn't exceed the
15651 maximum system value visible in the @file{/proc/sys/fs/file-max} file,
15652 else the users would be prevented from login in. For more information
15653 about the Pluggable Authentication Module (PAM) limits, refer to the
15654 @samp{pam_limits} man page from the @code{linux-pam} package.
15655 @end deffn
15656
15657 @node Scheduled Job Execution
15658 @subsection Scheduled Job Execution
15659
15660 @cindex cron
15661 @cindex mcron
15662 @cindex scheduling jobs
15663 The @code{(gnu services mcron)} module provides an interface to
15664 GNU@tie{}mcron, a daemon to run jobs at scheduled times (@pxref{Top,,,
15665 mcron, GNU@tie{}mcron}). GNU@tie{}mcron is similar to the traditional
15666 Unix @command{cron} daemon; the main difference is that it is
15667 implemented in Guile Scheme, which provides a lot of flexibility when
15668 specifying the scheduling of jobs and their actions.
15669
15670 The example below defines an operating system that runs the
15671 @command{updatedb} (@pxref{Invoking updatedb,,, find, Finding Files})
15672 and the @command{guix gc} commands (@pxref{Invoking guix gc}) daily, as
15673 well as the @command{mkid} command on behalf of an unprivileged user
15674 (@pxref{mkid invocation,,, idutils, ID Database Utilities}). It uses
15675 gexps to introduce job definitions that are passed to mcron
15676 (@pxref{G-Expressions}).
15677
15678 @lisp
15679 (use-modules (guix) (gnu) (gnu services mcron))
15680 (use-package-modules base idutils)
15681
15682 (define updatedb-job
15683 ;; Run 'updatedb' at 3AM every day. Here we write the
15684 ;; job's action as a Scheme procedure.
15685 #~(job '(next-hour '(3))
15686 (lambda ()
15687 (execl (string-append #$findutils "/bin/updatedb")
15688 "updatedb"
15689 "--prunepaths=/tmp /var/tmp /gnu/store"))))
15690
15691 (define garbage-collector-job
15692 ;; Collect garbage 5 minutes after midnight every day.
15693 ;; The job's action is a shell command.
15694 #~(job "5 0 * * *" ;Vixie cron syntax
15695 "guix gc -F 1G"))
15696
15697 (define idutils-job
15698 ;; Update the index database as user "charlie" at 12:15PM
15699 ;; and 19:15PM. This runs from the user's home directory.
15700 #~(job '(next-minute-from (next-hour '(12 19)) '(15))
15701 (string-append #$idutils "/bin/mkid src")
15702 #:user "charlie"))
15703
15704 (operating-system
15705 ;; @dots{}
15706
15707 ;; %BASE-SERVICES already includes an instance of
15708 ;; 'mcron-service-type', which we extend with additional
15709 ;; jobs using 'simple-service'.
15710 (services (cons (simple-service 'my-cron-jobs
15711 mcron-service-type
15712 (list garbage-collector-job
15713 updatedb-job
15714 idutils-job))
15715 %base-services)))
15716 @end lisp
15717
15718 For more complex jobs defined in Scheme where you need control over the top
15719 level, for instance to introduce a @code{use-modules} form, you can move your
15720 code to a separate program using the @code{program-file} procedure of the
15721 @code{(guix gexp)} module (@pxref{G-Expressions}). The example below
15722 illustrates that.
15723
15724 @lisp
15725 (define %battery-alert-job
15726 ;; Beep when the battery percentage falls below %MIN-LEVEL.
15727 #~(job
15728 '(next-minute (range 0 60 1))
15729 #$(program-file
15730 "battery-alert.scm"
15731 (with-imported-modules (source-module-closure
15732 '((guix build utils)))
15733 #~(begin
15734 (use-modules (guix build utils)
15735 (ice-9 popen)
15736 (ice-9 regex)
15737 (ice-9 textual-ports)
15738 (srfi srfi-2))
15739
15740 (define %min-level 20)
15741
15742 (setenv "LC_ALL" "C") ;ensure English output
15743 (and-let* ((input-pipe (open-pipe*
15744 OPEN_READ
15745 #$(file-append acpi "/bin/acpi")))
15746 (output (get-string-all input-pipe))
15747 (m (string-match "Discharging, ([0-9]+)%" output))
15748 (level (string->number (match:substring m 1)))
15749 ((< level %min-level)))
15750 (format #t "warning: Battery level is low (~a%)~%" level)
15751 (invoke #$(file-append beep "/bin/beep") "-r5")))))))
15752 @end lisp
15753
15754 @xref{Guile Syntax, mcron job specifications,, mcron, GNU@tie{}mcron},
15755 for more information on mcron job specifications. Below is the
15756 reference of the mcron service.
15757
15758 On a running system, you can use the @code{schedule} action of the service to
15759 visualize the mcron jobs that will be executed next:
15760
15761 @example
15762 # herd schedule mcron
15763 @end example
15764
15765 @noindent
15766 The example above lists the next five tasks that will be executed, but you can
15767 also specify the number of tasks to display:
15768
15769 @example
15770 # herd schedule mcron 10
15771 @end example
15772
15773 @defvr {Scheme Variable} mcron-service-type
15774 This is the type of the @code{mcron} service, whose value is an
15775 @code{mcron-configuration} object.
15776
15777 This service type can be the target of a service extension that provides
15778 it additional job specifications (@pxref{Service Composition}). In
15779 other words, it is possible to define services that provide additional
15780 mcron jobs to run.
15781 @end defvr
15782
15783 @deftp {Data Type} mcron-configuration
15784 Data type representing the configuration of mcron.
15785
15786 @table @asis
15787 @item @code{mcron} (default: @var{mcron})
15788 The mcron package to use.
15789
15790 @item @code{jobs}
15791 This is a list of gexps (@pxref{G-Expressions}), where each gexp
15792 corresponds to an mcron job specification (@pxref{Syntax, mcron job
15793 specifications,, mcron, GNU@tie{}mcron}).
15794 @end table
15795 @end deftp
15796
15797
15798 @node Log Rotation
15799 @subsection Log Rotation
15800
15801 @cindex rottlog
15802 @cindex log rotation
15803 @cindex logging
15804 Log files such as those found in @file{/var/log} tend to grow endlessly,
15805 so it's a good idea to @dfn{rotate} them once in a while---i.e., archive
15806 their contents in separate files, possibly compressed. The @code{(gnu
15807 services admin)} module provides an interface to GNU@tie{}Rot[t]log, a
15808 log rotation tool (@pxref{Top,,, rottlog, GNU Rot[t]log Manual}).
15809
15810 This service is part of @code{%base-services}, and thus enabled by
15811 default, with the default settings, for commonly encountered log files.
15812 The example below shows how to extend it with an additional
15813 @dfn{rotation}, should you need to do that (usually, services that
15814 produce log files already take care of that):
15815
15816 @lisp
15817 (use-modules (guix) (gnu))
15818 (use-service-modules admin)
15819
15820 (define my-log-files
15821 ;; Log files that I want to rotate.
15822 '("/var/log/something.log" "/var/log/another.log"))
15823
15824 (operating-system
15825 ;; @dots{}
15826 (services (cons (simple-service 'rotate-my-stuff
15827 rottlog-service-type
15828 (list (log-rotation
15829 (frequency 'daily)
15830 (files my-log-files))))
15831 %base-services)))
15832 @end lisp
15833
15834 @defvr {Scheme Variable} rottlog-service-type
15835 This is the type of the Rottlog service, whose value is a
15836 @code{rottlog-configuration} object.
15837
15838 Other services can extend this one with new @code{log-rotation} objects
15839 (see below), thereby augmenting the set of files to be rotated.
15840
15841 This service type can define mcron jobs (@pxref{Scheduled Job
15842 Execution}) to run the rottlog service.
15843 @end defvr
15844
15845 @deftp {Data Type} rottlog-configuration
15846 Data type representing the configuration of rottlog.
15847
15848 @table @asis
15849 @item @code{rottlog} (default: @code{rottlog})
15850 The Rottlog package to use.
15851
15852 @item @code{rc-file} (default: @code{(file-append rottlog "/etc/rc")})
15853 The Rottlog configuration file to use (@pxref{Mandatory RC Variables,,,
15854 rottlog, GNU Rot[t]log Manual}).
15855
15856 @item @code{rotations} (default: @code{%default-rotations})
15857 A list of @code{log-rotation} objects as defined below.
15858
15859 @item @code{jobs}
15860 This is a list of gexps where each gexp corresponds to an mcron job
15861 specification (@pxref{Scheduled Job Execution}).
15862 @end table
15863 @end deftp
15864
15865 @deftp {Data Type} log-rotation
15866 Data type representing the rotation of a group of log files.
15867
15868 Taking an example from the Rottlog manual (@pxref{Period Related File
15869 Examples,,, rottlog, GNU Rot[t]log Manual}), a log rotation might be
15870 defined like this:
15871
15872 @lisp
15873 (log-rotation
15874 (frequency 'daily)
15875 (files '("/var/log/apache/*"))
15876 (options '("storedir apache-archives"
15877 "rotate 6"
15878 "notifempty"
15879 "nocompress")))
15880 @end lisp
15881
15882 The list of fields is as follows:
15883
15884 @table @asis
15885 @item @code{frequency} (default: @code{'weekly})
15886 The log rotation frequency, a symbol.
15887
15888 @item @code{files}
15889 The list of files or file glob patterns to rotate.
15890
15891 @item @code{options} (default: @code{'()})
15892 The list of rottlog options for this rotation (@pxref{Configuration
15893 parameters,,, rottlog, GNU Rot[t]lg Manual}).
15894
15895 @item @code{post-rotate} (default: @code{#f})
15896 Either @code{#f} or a gexp to execute once the rotation has completed.
15897 @end table
15898 @end deftp
15899
15900 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %default-rotations
15901 Specifies weekly rotation of @code{%rotated-files} and of
15902 @file{/var/log/guix-daemon.log}.
15903 @end defvr
15904
15905 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %rotated-files
15906 The list of syslog-controlled files to be rotated. By default it is:
15907 @code{'("/var/log/messages" "/var/log/secure" "/var/log/debug" \
15908 "/var/log/maillog")}.
15909 @end defvr
15910
15911 @node Networking Services
15912 @subsection Networking Services
15913
15914 The @code{(gnu services networking)} module provides services to configure
15915 the network interface.
15916
15917 @cindex DHCP, networking service
15918 @defvr {Scheme Variable} dhcp-client-service-type
15919 This is the type of services that run @var{dhcp}, a Dynamic Host Configuration
15920 Protocol (DHCP) client, on all the non-loopback network interfaces. Its value
15921 is the DHCP client package to use, @code{isc-dhcp} by default.
15922 @end defvr
15923
15924 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} dhcpd-service-type
15925 This type defines a service that runs a DHCP daemon. To create a
15926 service of this type, you must supply a @code{<dhcpd-configuration>}.
15927 For example:
15928
15929 @lisp
15930 (service dhcpd-service-type
15931 (dhcpd-configuration
15932 (config-file (local-file "my-dhcpd.conf"))
15933 (interfaces '("enp0s25"))))
15934 @end lisp
15935 @end deffn
15936
15937 @deftp {Data Type} dhcpd-configuration
15938 @table @asis
15939 @item @code{package} (default: @code{isc-dhcp})
15940 The package that provides the DHCP daemon. This package is expected to
15941 provide the daemon at @file{sbin/dhcpd} relative to its output
15942 directory. The default package is the
15943 @uref{https://www.isc.org/products/DHCP, ISC's DHCP server}.
15944 @item @code{config-file} (default: @code{#f})
15945 The configuration file to use. This is required. It will be passed to
15946 @code{dhcpd} via its @code{-cf} option. This may be any ``file-like''
15947 object (@pxref{G-Expressions, file-like objects}). See @code{man
15948 dhcpd.conf} for details on the configuration file syntax.
15949 @item @code{version} (default: @code{"4"})
15950 The DHCP version to use. The ISC DHCP server supports the values ``4'',
15951 ``6'', and ``4o6''. These correspond to the @code{dhcpd} program
15952 options @code{-4}, @code{-6}, and @code{-4o6}. See @code{man dhcpd} for
15953 details.
15954 @item @code{run-directory} (default: @code{"/run/dhcpd"})
15955 The run directory to use. At service activation time, this directory
15956 will be created if it does not exist.
15957 @item @code{pid-file} (default: @code{"/run/dhcpd/dhcpd.pid"})
15958 The PID file to use. This corresponds to the @code{-pf} option of
15959 @code{dhcpd}. See @code{man dhcpd} for details.
15960 @item @code{interfaces} (default: @code{'()})
15961 The names of the network interfaces on which dhcpd should listen for
15962 broadcasts. If this list is not empty, then its elements (which must be
15963 strings) will be appended to the @code{dhcpd} invocation when starting
15964 the daemon. It may not be necessary to explicitly specify any
15965 interfaces here; see @code{man dhcpd} for details.
15966 @end table
15967 @end deftp
15968
15969 @defvr {Scheme Variable} static-networking-service-type
15970 This is the type for statically-configured network interfaces.
15971 @c TODO Document <static-networking> data structures.
15972 @end defvr
15973
15974 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} static-networking-service @var{interface} @var{ip} @
15975 [#:netmask #f] [#:gateway #f] [#:name-servers @code{'()}] @
15976 [#:requirement @code{'(udev)}]
15977 Return a service that starts @var{interface} with address @var{ip}. If
15978 @var{netmask} is true, use it as the network mask. If @var{gateway} is true,
15979 it must be a string specifying the default network gateway. @var{requirement}
15980 can be used to declare a dependency on another service before configuring the
15981 interface.
15982
15983 This procedure can be called several times, one for each network
15984 interface of interest. Behind the scenes what it does is extend
15985 @code{static-networking-service-type} with additional network interfaces
15986 to handle.
15987
15988 For example:
15989
15990 @lisp
15991 (static-networking-service "eno1" "192.168.1.82"
15992 #:gateway "192.168.1.2"
15993 #:name-servers '("192.168.1.2"))
15994 @end lisp
15995 @end deffn
15996
15997 @cindex wicd
15998 @cindex wireless
15999 @cindex WiFi
16000 @cindex network management
16001 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} wicd-service [#:wicd @var{wicd}]
16002 Return a service that runs @url{https://launchpad.net/wicd,Wicd}, a network
16003 management daemon that aims to simplify wired and wireless networking.
16004
16005 This service adds the @var{wicd} package to the global profile, providing
16006 several commands to interact with the daemon and configure networking:
16007 @command{wicd-client}, a graphical user interface, and the @command{wicd-cli}
16008 and @command{wicd-curses} user interfaces.
16009 @end deffn
16010
16011 @cindex ModemManager
16012
16013 @defvr {Scheme Variable} modem-manager-service-type
16014 This is the service type for the
16015 @uref{https://wiki.gnome.org/Projects/ModemManager, ModemManager}
16016 service. The value for this service type is a
16017 @code{modem-manager-configuration} record.
16018
16019 This service is part of @code{%desktop-services} (@pxref{Desktop
16020 Services}).
16021 @end defvr
16022
16023 @deftp {Data Type} modem-manager-configuration
16024 Data type representing the configuration of ModemManager.
16025
16026 @table @asis
16027 @item @code{modem-manager} (default: @code{modem-manager})
16028 The ModemManager package to use.
16029
16030 @end table
16031 @end deftp
16032
16033 @cindex USB_ModeSwitch
16034 @cindex Modeswitching
16035
16036 @defvr {Scheme Variable} usb-modeswitch-service-type
16037 This is the service type for the
16038 @uref{https://www.draisberghof.de/usb_modeswitch/, USB_ModeSwitch}
16039 service. The value for this service type is
16040 a @code{usb-modeswitch-configuration} record.
16041
16042 When plugged in, some USB modems (and other USB devices) initially present
16043 themselves as a read-only storage medium and not as a modem. They need to be
16044 @dfn{modeswitched} before they are usable. The USB_ModeSwitch service type
16045 installs udev rules to automatically modeswitch these devices when they are
16046 plugged in.
16047
16048 This service is part of @code{%desktop-services} (@pxref{Desktop
16049 Services}).
16050 @end defvr
16051
16052 @deftp {Data Type} usb-modeswitch-configuration
16053 Data type representing the configuration of USB_ModeSwitch.
16054
16055 @table @asis
16056 @item @code{usb-modeswitch} (default: @code{usb-modeswitch})
16057 The USB_ModeSwitch package providing the binaries for modeswitching.
16058
16059 @item @code{usb-modeswitch-data} (default: @code{usb-modeswitch-data})
16060 The package providing the device data and udev rules file used by
16061 USB_ModeSwitch.
16062
16063 @item @code{config-file} (default: @code{#~(string-append #$usb-modeswitch:dispatcher "/etc/usb_modeswitch.conf")})
16064 Which config file to use for the USB_ModeSwitch dispatcher. By default the
16065 config file shipped with USB_ModeSwitch is used which disables logging to
16066 @file{/var/log} among other default settings. If set to @code{#f}, no config
16067 file is used.
16068
16069 @end table
16070 @end deftp
16071
16072 @cindex NetworkManager
16073
16074 @defvr {Scheme Variable} network-manager-service-type
16075 This is the service type for the
16076 @uref{https://wiki.gnome.org/Projects/NetworkManager, NetworkManager}
16077 service. The value for this service type is a
16078 @code{network-manager-configuration} record.
16079
16080 This service is part of @code{%desktop-services} (@pxref{Desktop
16081 Services}).
16082 @end defvr
16083
16084 @deftp {Data Type} network-manager-configuration
16085 Data type representing the configuration of NetworkManager.
16086
16087 @table @asis
16088 @item @code{network-manager} (default: @code{network-manager})
16089 The NetworkManager package to use.
16090
16091 @item @code{dns} (default: @code{"default"})
16092 Processing mode for DNS, which affects how NetworkManager uses the
16093 @code{resolv.conf} configuration file.
16094
16095 @table @samp
16096 @item default
16097 NetworkManager will update @code{resolv.conf} to reflect the nameservers
16098 provided by currently active connections.
16099
16100 @item dnsmasq
16101 NetworkManager will run @code{dnsmasq} as a local caching nameserver, using a
16102 @dfn{conditional forwarding} configuration if you are connected to a VPN, and
16103 then update @code{resolv.conf} to point to the local nameserver.
16104
16105 With this setting, you can share your network connection. For example when
16106 you want to share your network connection to another laptop @i{via} an
16107 Ethernet cable, you can open @command{nm-connection-editor} and configure the
16108 Wired connection's method for IPv4 and IPv6 to be ``Shared to other computers''
16109 and reestablish the connection (or reboot).
16110
16111 You can also set up a @dfn{host-to-guest connection} to QEMU VMs
16112 (@pxref{Installing Guix in a VM}). With a host-to-guest connection, you can
16113 e.g.@: access a Web server running on the VM (@pxref{Web Services}) from a Web
16114 browser on your host system, or connect to the VM @i{via} SSH
16115 (@pxref{Networking Services, @code{openssh-service-type}}). To set up a
16116 host-to-guest connection, run this command once:
16117
16118 @example
16119 nmcli connection add type tun \
16120 connection.interface-name tap0 \
16121 tun.mode tap tun.owner $(id -u) \
16122 ipv4.method shared \
16123 ipv4.addresses 172.28.112.1/24
16124 @end example
16125
16126 Then each time you launch your QEMU VM (@pxref{Running Guix in a VM}), pass
16127 @option{-nic tap,ifname=tap0,script=no,downscript=no} to
16128 @command{qemu-system-...}.
16129
16130 @item none
16131 NetworkManager will not modify @code{resolv.conf}.
16132 @end table
16133
16134 @item @code{vpn-plugins} (default: @code{'()})
16135 This is the list of available plugins for virtual private networks
16136 (VPNs). An example of this is the @code{network-manager-openvpn}
16137 package, which allows NetworkManager to manage VPNs @i{via} OpenVPN.
16138
16139 @end table
16140 @end deftp
16141
16142 @cindex Connman
16143 @deffn {Scheme Variable} connman-service-type
16144 This is the service type to run @url{https://01.org/connman,Connman},
16145 a network connection manager.
16146
16147 Its value must be an
16148 @code{connman-configuration} record as in this example:
16149
16150 @lisp
16151 (service connman-service-type
16152 (connman-configuration
16153 (disable-vpn? #t)))
16154 @end lisp
16155
16156 See below for details about @code{connman-configuration}.
16157 @end deffn
16158
16159 @deftp {Data Type} connman-configuration
16160 Data Type representing the configuration of connman.
16161
16162 @table @asis
16163 @item @code{connman} (default: @var{connman})
16164 The connman package to use.
16165
16166 @item @code{disable-vpn?} (default: @code{#f})
16167 When true, disable connman's vpn plugin.
16168 @end table
16169 @end deftp
16170
16171 @cindex WPA Supplicant
16172 @defvr {Scheme Variable} wpa-supplicant-service-type
16173 This is the service type to run @url{https://w1.fi/wpa_supplicant/,WPA
16174 supplicant}, an authentication daemon required to authenticate against
16175 encrypted WiFi or ethernet networks.
16176 @end defvr
16177
16178 @deftp {Data Type} wpa-supplicant-configuration
16179 Data type representing the configuration of WPA Supplicant.
16180
16181 It takes the following parameters:
16182
16183 @table @asis
16184 @item @code{wpa-supplicant} (default: @code{wpa-supplicant})
16185 The WPA Supplicant package to use.
16186
16187 @item @code{requirement} (default: @code{'(user-processes loopback syslogd)}
16188 List of services that should be started before WPA Supplicant starts.
16189
16190 @item @code{dbus?} (default: @code{#t})
16191 Whether to listen for requests on D-Bus.
16192
16193 @item @code{pid-file} (default: @code{"/var/run/wpa_supplicant.pid"})
16194 Where to store the PID file.
16195
16196 @item @code{interface} (default: @code{#f})
16197 If this is set, it must specify the name of a network interface that
16198 WPA supplicant will control.
16199
16200 @item @code{config-file} (default: @code{#f})
16201 Optional configuration file to use.
16202
16203 @item @code{extra-options} (default: @code{'()})
16204 List of additional command-line arguments to pass to the daemon.
16205 @end table
16206 @end deftp
16207
16208 @cindex hostapd service, for Wi-Fi access points
16209 @cindex Wi-Fi access points, hostapd service
16210 @defvr {Scheme Variable} hostapd-service-type
16211 This is the service type to run the @uref{https://w1.fi/hostapd/,
16212 hostapd} daemon to set up WiFi (IEEE 802.11) access points and
16213 authentication servers. Its associated value must be a
16214 @code{hostapd-configuration} as shown below:
16215
16216 @lisp
16217 ;; Use wlan1 to run the access point for "My Network".
16218 (service hostapd-service-type
16219 (hostapd-configuration
16220 (interface "wlan1")
16221 (ssid "My Network")
16222 (channel 12)))
16223 @end lisp
16224 @end defvr
16225
16226 @deftp {Data Type} hostapd-configuration
16227 This data type represents the configuration of the hostapd service, with
16228 the following fields:
16229
16230 @table @asis
16231 @item @code{package} (default: @code{hostapd})
16232 The hostapd package to use.
16233
16234 @item @code{interface} (default: @code{"wlan0"})
16235 The network interface to run the WiFi access point.
16236
16237 @item @code{ssid}
16238 The SSID (@dfn{service set identifier}), a string that identifies this
16239 network.
16240
16241 @item @code{broadcast-ssid?} (default: @code{#t})
16242 Whether to broadcast this SSID.
16243
16244 @item @code{channel} (default: @code{1})
16245 The WiFi channel to use.
16246
16247 @item @code{driver} (default: @code{"nl80211"})
16248 The driver interface type. @code{"nl80211"} is used with all Linux
16249 mac80211 drivers. Use @code{"none"} if building hostapd as a standalone
16250 RADIUS server that does # not control any wireless/wired driver.
16251
16252 @item @code{extra-settings} (default: @code{""})
16253 Extra settings to append as-is to the hostapd configuration file. See
16254 @uref{https://w1.fi/cgit/hostap/plain/hostapd/hostapd.conf} for the
16255 configuration file reference.
16256 @end table
16257 @end deftp
16258
16259 @defvr {Scheme Variable} simulated-wifi-service-type
16260 This is the type of a service to simulate WiFi networking, which can be
16261 useful in virtual machines for testing purposes. The service loads the
16262 Linux kernel
16263 @uref{https://www.kernel.org/doc/html/latest/networking/mac80211_hwsim/mac80211_hwsim.html,
16264 @code{mac80211_hwsim} module} and starts hostapd to create a pseudo WiFi
16265 network that can be seen on @code{wlan0}, by default.
16266
16267 The service's value is a @code{hostapd-configuration} record.
16268 @end defvr
16269
16270 @cindex iptables
16271 @defvr {Scheme Variable} iptables-service-type
16272 This is the service type to set up an iptables configuration. iptables is a
16273 packet filtering framework supported by the Linux kernel. This service
16274 supports configuring iptables for both IPv4 and IPv6. A simple example
16275 configuration rejecting all incoming connections except those to the ssh port
16276 22 is shown below.
16277
16278 @lisp
16279 (service iptables-service-type
16280 (iptables-configuration
16281 (ipv4-rules (plain-file "iptables.rules" "*filter
16282 :INPUT ACCEPT
16283 :FORWARD ACCEPT
16284 :OUTPUT ACCEPT
16285 -A INPUT -p tcp --dport 22 -j ACCEPT
16286 -A INPUT -j REJECT --reject-with icmp-port-unreachable
16287 COMMIT
16288 "))
16289 (ipv6-rules (plain-file "ip6tables.rules" "*filter
16290 :INPUT ACCEPT
16291 :FORWARD ACCEPT
16292 :OUTPUT ACCEPT
16293 -A INPUT -p tcp --dport 22 -j ACCEPT
16294 -A INPUT -j REJECT --reject-with icmp6-port-unreachable
16295 COMMIT
16296 "))))
16297 @end lisp
16298 @end defvr
16299
16300 @deftp {Data Type} iptables-configuration
16301 The data type representing the configuration of iptables.
16302
16303 @table @asis
16304 @item @code{iptables} (default: @code{iptables})
16305 The iptables package that provides @code{iptables-restore} and
16306 @code{ip6tables-restore}.
16307 @item @code{ipv4-rules} (default: @code{%iptables-accept-all-rules})
16308 The iptables rules to use. It will be passed to @code{iptables-restore}.
16309 This may be any ``file-like'' object (@pxref{G-Expressions, file-like
16310 objects}).
16311 @item @code{ipv6-rules} (default: @code{%iptables-accept-all-rules})
16312 The ip6tables rules to use. It will be passed to @code{ip6tables-restore}.
16313 This may be any ``file-like'' object (@pxref{G-Expressions, file-like
16314 objects}).
16315 @end table
16316 @end deftp
16317
16318 @cindex nftables
16319 @defvr {Scheme Variable} nftables-service-type
16320 This is the service type to set up a nftables configuration. nftables is a
16321 netfilter project that aims to replace the existing iptables, ip6tables,
16322 arptables and ebtables framework. It provides a new packet filtering
16323 framework, a new user-space utility @command{nft}, and a compatibility layer
16324 for iptables. This service comes with a default ruleset
16325 @code{%default-nftables-ruleset} that rejecting all incomming connections
16326 except those to the ssh port 22. To use it, simply write:
16327
16328 @lisp
16329 (service nftables-service-type)
16330 @end lisp
16331 @end defvr
16332
16333 @deftp {Data Type} nftables-configuration
16334 The data type representing the configuration of nftables.
16335
16336 @table @asis
16337 @item @code{package} (default: @code{nftables})
16338 The nftables package that provides @command{nft}.
16339 @item @code{ruleset} (default: @code{%default-nftables-ruleset})
16340 The nftables ruleset to use. This may be any ``file-like'' object
16341 (@pxref{G-Expressions, file-like objects}).
16342 @end table
16343 @end deftp
16344
16345 @cindex NTP (Network Time Protocol), service
16346 @cindex ntpd, service for the Network Time Protocol daemon
16347 @cindex real time clock
16348 @defvr {Scheme Variable} ntp-service-type
16349 This is the type of the service running the @uref{https://www.ntp.org,
16350 Network Time Protocol (NTP)} daemon, @command{ntpd}. The daemon will keep the
16351 system clock synchronized with that of the specified NTP servers.
16352
16353 The value of this service is an @code{ntpd-configuration} object, as described
16354 below.
16355 @end defvr
16356
16357 @deftp {Data Type} ntp-configuration
16358 This is the data type for the NTP service configuration.
16359
16360 @table @asis
16361 @item @code{servers} (default: @code{%ntp-servers})
16362 This is the list of servers (@code{<ntp-server>} records) with which
16363 @command{ntpd} will be synchronized. See the @code{ntp-server} data type
16364 definition below.
16365
16366 @item @code{allow-large-adjustment?} (default: @code{#t})
16367 This determines whether @command{ntpd} is allowed to make an initial
16368 adjustment of more than 1,000 seconds.
16369
16370 @item @code{ntp} (default: @code{ntp})
16371 The NTP package to use.
16372 @end table
16373 @end deftp
16374
16375 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %ntp-servers
16376 List of host names used as the default NTP servers. These are servers of the
16377 @uref{https://www.ntppool.org/en/, NTP Pool Project}.
16378 @end defvr
16379
16380 @deftp {Data Type} ntp-server
16381 The data type representing the configuration of a NTP server.
16382
16383 @table @asis
16384 @item @code{type} (default: @code{'server})
16385 The type of the NTP server, given as a symbol. One of @code{'pool},
16386 @code{'server}, @code{'peer}, @code{'broadcast} or @code{'manycastclient}.
16387
16388 @item @code{address}
16389 The address of the server, as a string.
16390
16391 @item @code{options}
16392 NTPD options to use with that specific server, given as a list of option names
16393 and/or of option names and values tuples. The following example define a server
16394 to use with the options @option{iburst} and @option{prefer}, as well as
16395 @option{version} 3 and a @option{maxpoll} time of 16 seconds.
16396
16397 @example
16398 (ntp-server
16399 (type 'server)
16400 (address "some.ntp.server.org")
16401 (options `(iburst (version 3) (maxpoll 16) prefer))))
16402 @end example
16403 @end table
16404 @end deftp
16405
16406 @cindex OpenNTPD
16407 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} openntpd-service-type
16408 Run the @command{ntpd}, the Network Time Protocol (NTP) daemon, as implemented
16409 by @uref{http://www.openntpd.org, OpenNTPD}. The daemon will keep the system
16410 clock synchronized with that of the given servers.
16411
16412 @lisp
16413 (service
16414 openntpd-service-type
16415 (openntpd-configuration
16416 (listen-on '("127.0.0.1" "::1"))
16417 (sensor '("udcf0 correction 70000"))
16418 (constraint-from '("www.gnu.org"))
16419 (constraints-from '("https://www.google.com/"))))
16420
16421 @end lisp
16422 @end deffn
16423
16424 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %openntpd-servers
16425 This variable is a list of the server addresses defined in
16426 @code{%ntp-servers}.
16427 @end defvr
16428
16429 @deftp {Data Type} openntpd-configuration
16430 @table @asis
16431 @item @code{openntpd} (default: @code{(file-append openntpd "/sbin/ntpd")})
16432 The openntpd executable to use.
16433 @item @code{listen-on} (default: @code{'("127.0.0.1" "::1")})
16434 A list of local IP addresses or hostnames the ntpd daemon should listen on.
16435 @item @code{query-from} (default: @code{'()})
16436 A list of local IP address the ntpd daemon should use for outgoing queries.
16437 @item @code{sensor} (default: @code{'()})
16438 Specify a list of timedelta sensor devices ntpd should use. @code{ntpd}
16439 will listen to each sensor that actually exists and ignore non-existent ones.
16440 See @uref{https://man.openbsd.org/ntpd.conf, upstream documentation} for more
16441 information.
16442 @item @code{server} (default: @code{'()})
16443 Specify a list of IP addresses or hostnames of NTP servers to synchronize to.
16444 @item @code{servers} (default: @code{%openntp-servers})
16445 Specify a list of IP addresses or hostnames of NTP pools to synchronize to.
16446 @item @code{constraint-from} (default: @code{'()})
16447 @code{ntpd} can be configured to query the ‘Date’ from trusted HTTPS servers via TLS.
16448 This time information is not used for precision but acts as an authenticated
16449 constraint, thereby reducing the impact of unauthenticated NTP
16450 man-in-the-middle attacks.
16451 Specify a list of URLs, IP addresses or hostnames of HTTPS servers to provide
16452 a constraint.
16453 @item @code{constraints-from} (default: @code{'()})
16454 As with constraint from, specify a list of URLs, IP addresses or hostnames of
16455 HTTPS servers to provide a constraint. Should the hostname resolve to multiple
16456 IP addresses, @code{ntpd} will calculate a median constraint from all of them.
16457 @end table
16458 @end deftp
16459
16460 @cindex inetd
16461 @deffn {Scheme variable} inetd-service-type
16462 This service runs the @command{inetd} (@pxref{inetd invocation,,,
16463 inetutils, GNU Inetutils}) daemon. @command{inetd} listens for
16464 connections on internet sockets, and lazily starts the specified server
16465 program when a connection is made on one of these sockets.
16466
16467 The value of this service is an @code{inetd-configuration} object. The
16468 following example configures the @command{inetd} daemon to provide the
16469 built-in @command{echo} service, as well as an smtp service which
16470 forwards smtp traffic over ssh to a server @code{smtp-server} behind a
16471 gateway @code{hostname}:
16472
16473 @lisp
16474 (service
16475 inetd-service-type
16476 (inetd-configuration
16477 (entries (list
16478 (inetd-entry
16479 (name "echo")
16480 (socket-type 'stream)
16481 (protocol "tcp")
16482 (wait? #f)
16483 (user "root"))
16484 (inetd-entry
16485 (node "127.0.0.1")
16486 (name "smtp")
16487 (socket-type 'stream)
16488 (protocol "tcp")
16489 (wait? #f)
16490 (user "root")
16491 (program (file-append openssh "/bin/ssh"))
16492 (arguments
16493 '("ssh" "-qT" "-i" "/path/to/ssh_key"
16494 "-W" "smtp-server:25" "user@@hostname")))))))
16495 @end lisp
16496
16497 See below for more details about @code{inetd-configuration}.
16498 @end deffn
16499
16500 @deftp {Data Type} inetd-configuration
16501 Data type representing the configuration of @command{inetd}.
16502
16503 @table @asis
16504 @item @code{program} (default: @code{(file-append inetutils "/libexec/inetd")})
16505 The @command{inetd} executable to use.
16506
16507 @item @code{entries} (default: @code{'()})
16508 A list of @command{inetd} service entries. Each entry should be created
16509 by the @code{inetd-entry} constructor.
16510 @end table
16511 @end deftp
16512
16513 @deftp {Data Type} inetd-entry
16514 Data type representing an entry in the @command{inetd} configuration.
16515 Each entry corresponds to a socket where @command{inetd} will listen for
16516 requests.
16517
16518 @table @asis
16519 @item @code{node} (default: @code{#f})
16520 Optional string, a comma-separated list of local addresses
16521 @command{inetd} should use when listening for this service.
16522 @xref{Configuration file,,, inetutils, GNU Inetutils} for a complete
16523 description of all options.
16524 @item @code{name}
16525 A string, the name must correspond to an entry in @code{/etc/services}.
16526 @item @code{socket-type}
16527 One of @code{'stream}, @code{'dgram}, @code{'raw}, @code{'rdm} or
16528 @code{'seqpacket}.
16529 @item @code{protocol}
16530 A string, must correspond to an entry in @code{/etc/protocols}.
16531 @item @code{wait?} (default: @code{#t})
16532 Whether @command{inetd} should wait for the server to exit before
16533 listening to new service requests.
16534 @item @code{user}
16535 A string containing the user (and, optionally, group) name of the user
16536 as whom the server should run. The group name can be specified in a
16537 suffix, separated by a colon or period, i.e.@: @code{"user"},
16538 @code{"user:group"} or @code{"user.group"}.
16539 @item @code{program} (default: @code{"internal"})
16540 The server program which will serve the requests, or @code{"internal"}
16541 if @command{inetd} should use a built-in service.
16542 @item @code{arguments} (default: @code{'()})
16543 A list strings or file-like objects, which are the server program's
16544 arguments, starting with the zeroth argument, i.e.@: the name of the
16545 program itself. For @command{inetd}'s internal services, this entry
16546 must be @code{'()} or @code{'("internal")}.
16547 @end table
16548
16549 @xref{Configuration file,,, inetutils, GNU Inetutils} for a more
16550 detailed discussion of each configuration field.
16551 @end deftp
16552
16553 @cindex Tor
16554 @defvr {Scheme Variable} tor-service-type
16555 This is the type for a service that runs the @uref{https://torproject.org,
16556 Tor} anonymous networking daemon. The service is configured using a
16557 @code{<tor-configuration>} record. By default, the Tor daemon runs as the
16558 @code{tor} unprivileged user, which is a member of the @code{tor} group.
16559
16560 @end defvr
16561
16562 @deftp {Data Type} tor-configuration
16563 @table @asis
16564 @item @code{tor} (default: @code{tor})
16565 The package that provides the Tor daemon. This package is expected to provide
16566 the daemon at @file{bin/tor} relative to its output directory. The default
16567 package is the @uref{https://www.torproject.org, Tor Project's}
16568 implementation.
16569
16570 @item @code{config-file} (default: @code{(plain-file "empty" "")})
16571 The configuration file to use. It will be appended to a default configuration
16572 file, and the final configuration file will be passed to @code{tor} via its
16573 @code{-f} option. This may be any ``file-like'' object (@pxref{G-Expressions,
16574 file-like objects}). See @code{man tor} for details on the configuration file
16575 syntax.
16576
16577 @item @code{hidden-services} (default: @code{'()})
16578 The list of @code{<hidden-service>} records to use. For any hidden service
16579 you include in this list, appropriate configuration to enable the hidden
16580 service will be automatically added to the default configuration file. You
16581 may conveniently create @code{<hidden-service>} records using the
16582 @code{tor-hidden-service} procedure described below.
16583
16584 @item @code{socks-socket-type} (default: @code{'tcp})
16585 The default socket type that Tor should use for its SOCKS socket. This must
16586 be either @code{'tcp} or @code{'unix}. If it is @code{'tcp}, then by default
16587 Tor will listen on TCP port 9050 on the loopback interface (i.e., localhost).
16588 If it is @code{'unix}, then Tor will listen on the UNIX domain socket
16589 @file{/var/run/tor/socks-sock}, which will be made writable by members of the
16590 @code{tor} group.
16591
16592 If you want to customize the SOCKS socket in more detail, leave
16593 @code{socks-socket-type} at its default value of @code{'tcp} and use
16594 @code{config-file} to override the default by providing your own
16595 @code{SocksPort} option.
16596
16597 @item @code{control-socket?} (default: @code{#f})
16598 Whether or not to provide a ``control socket'' by which Tor can be
16599 controlled to, for instance, dynamically instantiate tor onion services.
16600 If @code{#t}, Tor will listen for control commands on the UNIX domain socket
16601 @file{/var/run/tor/control-sock}, which will be made writable by members of the
16602 @code{tor} group.
16603
16604 @end table
16605 @end deftp
16606
16607 @cindex hidden service
16608 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} tor-hidden-service @var{name} @var{mapping}
16609 Define a new Tor @dfn{hidden service} called @var{name} and implementing
16610 @var{mapping}. @var{mapping} is a list of port/host tuples, such as:
16611
16612 @example
16613 '((22 "127.0.0.1:22")
16614 (80 "127.0.0.1:8080"))
16615 @end example
16616
16617 In this example, port 22 of the hidden service is mapped to local port 22, and
16618 port 80 is mapped to local port 8080.
16619
16620 This creates a @file{/var/lib/tor/hidden-services/@var{name}} directory, where
16621 the @file{hostname} file contains the @code{.onion} host name for the hidden
16622 service.
16623
16624 See @uref{https://www.torproject.org/docs/tor-hidden-service.html.en, the Tor
16625 project's documentation} for more information.
16626 @end deffn
16627
16628 The @code{(gnu services rsync)} module provides the following services:
16629
16630 You might want an rsync daemon if you have files that you want available
16631 so anyone (or just yourself) can download existing files or upload new
16632 files.
16633
16634 @deffn {Scheme Variable} rsync-service-type
16635 This is the service type for the @uref{https://rsync.samba.org, rsync} daemon,
16636 The value for this service type is a
16637 @command{rsync-configuration} record as in this example:
16638
16639 @lisp
16640 (service rsync-service-type)
16641 @end lisp
16642
16643 See below for details about @code{rsync-configuration}.
16644 @end deffn
16645
16646 @deftp {Data Type} rsync-configuration
16647 Data type representing the configuration for @code{rsync-service}.
16648
16649 @table @asis
16650 @item @code{package} (default: @var{rsync})
16651 @code{rsync} package to use.
16652
16653 @item @code{port-number} (default: @code{873})
16654 TCP port on which @command{rsync} listens for incoming connections. If port
16655 is less than @code{1024} @command{rsync} needs to be started as the
16656 @code{root} user and group.
16657
16658 @item @code{pid-file} (default: @code{"/var/run/rsyncd/rsyncd.pid"})
16659 Name of the file where @command{rsync} writes its PID.
16660
16661 @item @code{lock-file} (default: @code{"/var/run/rsyncd/rsyncd.lock"})
16662 Name of the file where @command{rsync} writes its lock file.
16663
16664 @item @code{log-file} (default: @code{"/var/log/rsyncd.log"})
16665 Name of the file where @command{rsync} writes its log file.
16666
16667 @item @code{use-chroot?} (default: @var{#t})
16668 Whether to use chroot for @command{rsync} shared directory.
16669
16670 @item @code{share-path} (default: @file{/srv/rsync})
16671 Location of the @command{rsync} shared directory.
16672
16673 @item @code{share-comment} (default: @code{"Rsync share"})
16674 Comment of the @command{rsync} shared directory.
16675
16676 @item @code{read-only?} (default: @var{#f})
16677 Read-write permissions to shared directory.
16678
16679 @item @code{timeout} (default: @code{300})
16680 I/O timeout in seconds.
16681
16682 @item @code{user} (default: @var{"root"})
16683 Owner of the @code{rsync} process.
16684
16685 @item @code{group} (default: @var{"root"})
16686 Group of the @code{rsync} process.
16687
16688 @item @code{uid} (default: @var{"rsyncd"})
16689 User name or user ID that file transfers to and from that module should take
16690 place as when the daemon was run as @code{root}.
16691
16692 @item @code{gid} (default: @var{"rsyncd"})
16693 Group name or group ID that will be used when accessing the module.
16694
16695 @end table
16696 @end deftp
16697
16698 The @code{(gnu services syncthing)} module provides the following services:
16699 @cindex syncthing
16700
16701 You might want a syncthing daemon if you have files between two or more
16702 computers and want to sync them in real time, safely protected from
16703 prying eyes.
16704
16705 @deffn {Scheme Variable} syncthing-service-type
16706 This is the service type for the @uref{https://syncthing.net/,
16707 syncthing} daemon, The value for this service type is a
16708 @command{syncthing-configuration} record as in this example:
16709
16710 @lisp
16711 (service syncthing-service-type
16712 (syncthing-configuration (user "alice")))
16713 @end lisp
16714
16715 See below for details about @code{syncthing-configuration}.
16716
16717 @deftp {Data Type} syncthing-configuration
16718 Data type representing the configuration for @code{syncthing-service-type}.
16719
16720 @table @asis
16721 @item @code{syncthing} (default: @var{syncthing})
16722 @code{syncthing} package to use.
16723
16724 @item @code{arguments} (default: @var{'()})
16725 List of command-line arguments passing to @code{syncthing} binary.
16726
16727 @item @code{logflags} (default: @var{0})
16728 Sum of loging flags, see
16729 @uref{https://docs.syncthing.net/users/syncthing.html#cmdoption-logflags, Syncthing documentation logflags}.
16730
16731 @item @code{user} (default: @var{#f})
16732 The user as which the Syncthing service is to be run.
16733 This assumes that the specified user exists.
16734
16735 @item @code{group} (default: @var{"users"})
16736 The group as which the Syncthing service is to be run.
16737 This assumes that the specified group exists.
16738
16739 @item @code{home} (default: @var{#f})
16740 Common configuration and data directory. The default configuration
16741 directory is @file{$HOME} of the specified Syncthing @code{user}.
16742
16743 @end table
16744 @end deftp
16745 @end deffn
16746
16747 Furthermore, @code{(gnu services ssh)} provides the following services.
16748 @cindex SSH
16749 @cindex SSH server
16750
16751 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} lsh-service [#:host-key "/etc/lsh/host-key"] @
16752 [#:daemonic? #t] [#:interfaces '()] [#:port-number 22] @
16753 [#:allow-empty-passwords? #f] [#:root-login? #f] @
16754 [#:syslog-output? #t] [#:x11-forwarding? #t] @
16755 [#:tcp/ip-forwarding? #t] [#:password-authentication? #t] @
16756 [#:public-key-authentication? #t] [#:initialize? #t]
16757 Run the @command{lshd} program from @var{lsh} to listen on port @var{port-number}.
16758 @var{host-key} must designate a file containing the host key, and readable
16759 only by root.
16760
16761 When @var{daemonic?} is true, @command{lshd} will detach from the
16762 controlling terminal and log its output to syslogd, unless one sets
16763 @var{syslog-output?} to false. Obviously, it also makes lsh-service
16764 depend on existence of syslogd service. When @var{pid-file?} is true,
16765 @command{lshd} writes its PID to the file called @var{pid-file}.
16766
16767 When @var{initialize?} is true, automatically create the seed and host key
16768 upon service activation if they do not exist yet. This may take long and
16769 require interaction.
16770
16771 When @var{initialize?} is false, it is up to the user to initialize the
16772 randomness generator (@pxref{lsh-make-seed,,, lsh, LSH Manual}), and to create
16773 a key pair with the private key stored in file @var{host-key} (@pxref{lshd
16774 basics,,, lsh, LSH Manual}).
16775
16776 When @var{interfaces} is empty, lshd listens for connections on all the
16777 network interfaces; otherwise, @var{interfaces} must be a list of host names
16778 or addresses.
16779
16780 @var{allow-empty-passwords?} specifies whether to accept log-ins with empty
16781 passwords, and @var{root-login?} specifies whether to accept log-ins as
16782 root.
16783
16784 The other options should be self-descriptive.
16785 @end deffn
16786
16787 @cindex SSH
16788 @cindex SSH server
16789 @deffn {Scheme Variable} openssh-service-type
16790 This is the type for the @uref{http://www.openssh.org, OpenSSH} secure
16791 shell daemon, @command{sshd}. Its value must be an
16792 @code{openssh-configuration} record as in this example:
16793
16794 @lisp
16795 (service openssh-service-type
16796 (openssh-configuration
16797 (x11-forwarding? #t)
16798 (permit-root-login 'without-password)
16799 (authorized-keys
16800 `(("alice" ,(local-file "alice.pub"))
16801 ("bob" ,(local-file "bob.pub"))))))
16802 @end lisp
16803
16804 See below for details about @code{openssh-configuration}.
16805
16806 This service can be extended with extra authorized keys, as in this
16807 example:
16808
16809 @lisp
16810 (service-extension openssh-service-type
16811 (const `(("charlie"
16812 ,(local-file "charlie.pub")))))
16813 @end lisp
16814 @end deffn
16815
16816 @deftp {Data Type} openssh-configuration
16817 This is the configuration record for OpenSSH's @command{sshd}.
16818
16819 @table @asis
16820 @item @code{openssh} (default @var{openssh})
16821 The Openssh package to use.
16822
16823 @item @code{pid-file} (default: @code{"/var/run/sshd.pid"})
16824 Name of the file where @command{sshd} writes its PID.
16825
16826 @item @code{port-number} (default: @code{22})
16827 TCP port on which @command{sshd} listens for incoming connections.
16828
16829 @item @code{permit-root-login} (default: @code{#f})
16830 This field determines whether and when to allow logins as root. If
16831 @code{#f}, root logins are disallowed; if @code{#t}, they are allowed.
16832 If it's the symbol @code{'without-password}, then root logins are
16833 permitted but not with password-based authentication.
16834
16835 @item @code{allow-empty-passwords?} (default: @code{#f})
16836 When true, users with empty passwords may log in. When false, they may
16837 not.
16838
16839 @item @code{password-authentication?} (default: @code{#t})
16840 When true, users may log in with their password. When false, they have
16841 other authentication methods.
16842
16843 @item @code{public-key-authentication?} (default: @code{#t})
16844 When true, users may log in using public key authentication. When
16845 false, users have to use other authentication method.
16846
16847 Authorized public keys are stored in @file{~/.ssh/authorized_keys}.
16848 This is used only by protocol version 2.
16849
16850 @item @code{x11-forwarding?} (default: @code{#f})
16851 When true, forwarding of X11 graphical client connections is
16852 enabled---in other words, @command{ssh} options @option{-X} and
16853 @option{-Y} will work.
16854
16855 @item @code{allow-agent-forwarding?} (default: @code{#t})
16856 Whether to allow agent forwarding.
16857
16858 @item @code{allow-tcp-forwarding?} (default: @code{#t})
16859 Whether to allow TCP forwarding.
16860
16861 @item @code{gateway-ports?} (default: @code{#f})
16862 Whether to allow gateway ports.
16863
16864 @item @code{challenge-response-authentication?} (default: @code{#f})
16865 Specifies whether challenge response authentication is allowed (e.g.@: via
16866 PAM).
16867
16868 @item @code{use-pam?} (default: @code{#t})
16869 Enables the Pluggable Authentication Module interface. If set to
16870 @code{#t}, this will enable PAM authentication using
16871 @code{challenge-response-authentication?} and
16872 @code{password-authentication?}, in addition to PAM account and session
16873 module processing for all authentication types.
16874
16875 Because PAM challenge response authentication usually serves an
16876 equivalent role to password authentication, you should disable either
16877 @code{challenge-response-authentication?} or
16878 @code{password-authentication?}.
16879
16880 @item @code{print-last-log?} (default: @code{#t})
16881 Specifies whether @command{sshd} should print the date and time of the
16882 last user login when a user logs in interactively.
16883
16884 @item @code{subsystems} (default: @code{'(("sftp" "internal-sftp"))})
16885 Configures external subsystems (e.g.@: file transfer daemon).
16886
16887 This is a list of two-element lists, each of which containing the
16888 subsystem name and a command (with optional arguments) to execute upon
16889 subsystem request.
16890
16891 The command @command{internal-sftp} implements an in-process SFTP
16892 server. Alternatively, one can specify the @command{sftp-server} command:
16893 @lisp
16894 (service openssh-service-type
16895 (openssh-configuration
16896 (subsystems
16897 `(("sftp" ,(file-append openssh "/libexec/sftp-server"))))))
16898 @end lisp
16899
16900 @item @code{accepted-environment} (default: @code{'()})
16901 List of strings describing which environment variables may be exported.
16902
16903 Each string gets on its own line. See the @code{AcceptEnv} option in
16904 @code{man sshd_config}.
16905
16906 This example allows ssh-clients to export the @env{COLORTERM} variable.
16907 It is set by terminal emulators, which support colors. You can use it in
16908 your shell's resource file to enable colors for the prompt and commands
16909 if this variable is set.
16910
16911 @lisp
16912 (service openssh-service-type
16913 (openssh-configuration
16914 (accepted-environment '("COLORTERM"))))
16915 @end lisp
16916
16917 @item @code{authorized-keys} (default: @code{'()})
16918 @cindex authorized keys, SSH
16919 @cindex SSH authorized keys
16920 This is the list of authorized keys. Each element of the list is a user
16921 name followed by one or more file-like objects that represent SSH public
16922 keys. For example:
16923
16924 @lisp
16925 (openssh-configuration
16926 (authorized-keys
16927 `(("rekado" ,(local-file "rekado.pub"))
16928 ("chris" ,(local-file "chris.pub"))
16929 ("root" ,(local-file "rekado.pub") ,(local-file "chris.pub")))))
16930 @end lisp
16931
16932 @noindent
16933 registers the specified public keys for user accounts @code{rekado},
16934 @code{chris}, and @code{root}.
16935
16936 Additional authorized keys can be specified @i{via}
16937 @code{service-extension}.
16938
16939 Note that this does @emph{not} interfere with the use of
16940 @file{~/.ssh/authorized_keys}.
16941
16942 @item @code{log-level} (default: @code{'info})
16943 This is a symbol specifying the logging level: @code{quiet}, @code{fatal},
16944 @code{error}, @code{info}, @code{verbose}, @code{debug}, etc. See the man
16945 page for @file{sshd_config} for the full list of level names.
16946
16947 @item @code{extra-content} (default: @code{""})
16948 This field can be used to append arbitrary text to the configuration file. It
16949 is especially useful for elaborate configurations that cannot be expressed
16950 otherwise. This configuration, for example, would generally disable root
16951 logins, but permit them from one specific IP address:
16952
16953 @lisp
16954 (openssh-configuration
16955 (extra-content "\
16956 Match Address 192.168.0.1
16957 PermitRootLogin yes"))
16958 @end lisp
16959
16960 @end table
16961 @end deftp
16962
16963 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} dropbear-service [@var{config}]
16964 Run the @uref{https://matt.ucc.asn.au/dropbear/dropbear.html,Dropbear SSH
16965 daemon} with the given @var{config}, a @code{<dropbear-configuration>}
16966 object.
16967
16968 For example, to specify a Dropbear service listening on port 1234, add
16969 this call to the operating system's @code{services} field:
16970
16971 @lisp
16972 (dropbear-service (dropbear-configuration
16973 (port-number 1234)))
16974 @end lisp
16975 @end deffn
16976
16977 @deftp {Data Type} dropbear-configuration
16978 This data type represents the configuration of a Dropbear SSH daemon.
16979
16980 @table @asis
16981 @item @code{dropbear} (default: @var{dropbear})
16982 The Dropbear package to use.
16983
16984 @item @code{port-number} (default: 22)
16985 The TCP port where the daemon waits for incoming connections.
16986
16987 @item @code{syslog-output?} (default: @code{#t})
16988 Whether to enable syslog output.
16989
16990 @item @code{pid-file} (default: @code{"/var/run/dropbear.pid"})
16991 File name of the daemon's PID file.
16992
16993 @item @code{root-login?} (default: @code{#f})
16994 Whether to allow @code{root} logins.
16995
16996 @item @code{allow-empty-passwords?} (default: @code{#f})
16997 Whether to allow empty passwords.
16998
16999 @item @code{password-authentication?} (default: @code{#t})
17000 Whether to enable password-based authentication.
17001 @end table
17002 @end deftp
17003
17004 @cindex AutoSSH
17005 @deffn {Scheme Variable} autossh-service-type
17006 This is the type for the @uref{https://www.harding.motd.ca/autossh,
17007 AutoSSH} program that runs a copy of @command{ssh} and monitors it,
17008 restarting it as necessary should it die or stop passing traffic.
17009 AutoSSH can be run manually from the command-line by passing arguments
17010 to the binary @command{autossh} from the package @code{autossh}, but it
17011 can also be run as a Guix service. This latter use case is documented
17012 here.
17013
17014 AutoSSH can be used to forward local traffic to a remote machine using
17015 an SSH tunnel, and it respects the @file{~/.ssh/config} of the user it
17016 is run as.
17017
17018 For example, to specify a service running autossh as the user
17019 @code{pino} and forwarding all local connections to port @code{8081} to
17020 @code{remote:8081} using an SSH tunnel, add this call to the operating
17021 system's @code{services} field:
17022
17023 @lisp
17024 (service autossh-service-type
17025 (autossh-configuration
17026 (user "pino")
17027 (ssh-options (list "-T" "-N" "-L" "8081:localhost:8081" "remote.net"))))
17028 @end lisp
17029 @end deffn
17030
17031 @deftp {Data Type} autossh-configuration
17032 This data type represents the configuration of an AutoSSH service.
17033
17034 @table @asis
17035
17036 @item @code{user} (default @code{"autossh"})
17037 The user as which the AutoSSH service is to be run.
17038 This assumes that the specified user exists.
17039
17040 @item @code{poll} (default @code{600})
17041 Specifies the connection poll time in seconds.
17042
17043 @item @code{first-poll} (default @code{#f})
17044 Specifies how many seconds AutoSSH waits before the first connection
17045 test. After this first test, polling is resumed at the pace defined in
17046 @code{poll}. When set to @code{#f}, the first poll is not treated
17047 specially and will also use the connection poll specified in
17048 @code{poll}.
17049
17050 @item @code{gate-time} (default @code{30})
17051 Specifies how many seconds an SSH connection must be active before it is
17052 considered successful.
17053
17054 @item @code{log-level} (default @code{1})
17055 The log level, corresponding to the levels used by syslog---so @code{0}
17056 is the most silent while @code{7} is the chattiest.
17057
17058 @item @code{max-start} (default @code{#f})
17059 The maximum number of times SSH may be (re)started before AutoSSH exits.
17060 When set to @code{#f}, no maximum is configured and AutoSSH may restart indefinitely.
17061
17062 @item @code{message} (default @code{""})
17063 The message to append to the echo message sent when testing connections.
17064
17065 @item @code{port} (default @code{"0"})
17066 The ports used for monitoring the connection. When set to @code{"0"},
17067 monitoring is disabled. When set to @code{"@var{n}"} where @var{n} is
17068 a positive integer, ports @var{n} and @var{n}+1 are used for
17069 monitoring the connection, such that port @var{n} is the base
17070 monitoring port and @code{n+1} is the echo port. When set to
17071 @code{"@var{n}:@var{m}"} where @var{n} and @var{m} are positive
17072 integers, the ports @var{n} and @var{m} are used for monitoring the
17073 connection, such that port @var{n} is the base monitoring port and
17074 @var{m} is the echo port.
17075
17076 @item @code{ssh-options} (default @code{'()})
17077 The list of command-line arguments to pass to @command{ssh} when it is
17078 run. Options @option{-f} and @option{-M} are reserved for AutoSSH and
17079 may cause undefined behaviour.
17080
17081 @end table
17082 @end deftp
17083
17084 @cindex WebSSH
17085 @deffn {Scheme Variable} webssh-service-type
17086 This is the type for the @uref{https://webssh.huashengdun.org/, WebSSH}
17087 program that runs a web SSH client. WebSSH can be run manually from the
17088 command-line by passing arguments to the binary @command{wssh} from the
17089 package @code{webssh}, but it can also be run as a Guix service. This
17090 latter use case is documented here.
17091
17092 For example, to specify a service running WebSSH on loopback interface
17093 on port @code{8888} with reject policy with a list of allowed to
17094 connection hosts, and NGINX as a reverse-proxy to this service listening
17095 for HTTPS connection, add this call to the operating system's
17096 @code{services} field:
17097
17098 @lisp
17099 (service webssh-service-type
17100 (webssh-configuration (address "127.0.0.1")
17101 (port 8888)
17102 (policy 'reject)
17103 (known-hosts '("localhost ecdsa-sha2-nistp256 AAAA…"
17104 "127.0.0.1 ecdsa-sha2-nistp256 AAAA…"))))
17105
17106 (service nginx-service-type
17107 (nginx-configuration
17108 (server-blocks
17109 (list
17110 (nginx-server-configuration
17111 (inherit %webssh-configuration-nginx)
17112 (server-name '("webssh.example.com"))
17113 (listen '("443 ssl"))
17114 (ssl-certificate (letsencrypt-certificate "webssh.example.com"))
17115 (ssl-certificate-key (letsencrypt-key "webssh.example.com"))
17116 (locations
17117 (cons (nginx-location-configuration
17118 (uri "/.well-known")
17119 (body '("root /var/www;")))
17120 (nginx-server-configuration-locations %webssh-configuration-nginx))))))))
17121 @end lisp
17122 @end deffn
17123
17124 @deftp {Data Type} webssh-configuration
17125 Data type representing the configuration for @code{webssh-service}.
17126
17127 @table @asis
17128 @item @code{package} (default: @var{webssh})
17129 @code{webssh} package to use.
17130
17131 @item @code{user-name} (default: @var{"webssh"})
17132 User name or user ID that file transfers to and from that module should take
17133 place.
17134
17135 @item @code{group-name} (default: @var{"webssh"})
17136 Group name or group ID that will be used when accessing the module.
17137
17138 @item @code{address} (default: @var{#f})
17139 IP address on which @command{webssh} listens for incoming connections.
17140
17141 @item @code{port} (default: @var{8888})
17142 TCP port on which @command{webssh} listens for incoming connections.
17143
17144 @item @code{policy} (default: @var{#f})
17145 Connection policy. @var{reject} policy requires to specify @var{known-hosts}.
17146
17147 @item @code{known-hosts} (default: @var{'()})
17148 List of hosts which allowed for SSH connection from @command{webssh}.
17149
17150 @item @code{log-file} (default: @file{"/var/log/webssh.log"})
17151 Name of the file where @command{webssh} writes its log file.
17152
17153 @item @code{log-level} (default: @var{#f})
17154 Logging level.
17155
17156 @end table
17157 @end deftp
17158
17159 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %facebook-host-aliases
17160 This variable contains a string for use in @file{/etc/hosts}
17161 (@pxref{Host Names,,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}). Each
17162 line contains a entry that maps a known server name of the Facebook
17163 on-line service---e.g., @code{www.facebook.com}---to the local
17164 host---@code{127.0.0.1} or its IPv6 equivalent, @code{::1}.
17165
17166 This variable is typically used in the @code{hosts-file} field of an
17167 @code{operating-system} declaration (@pxref{operating-system Reference,
17168 @file{/etc/hosts}}):
17169
17170 @lisp
17171 (use-modules (gnu) (guix))
17172
17173 (operating-system
17174 (host-name "mymachine")
17175 ;; ...
17176 (hosts-file
17177 ;; Create a /etc/hosts file with aliases for "localhost"
17178 ;; and "mymachine", as well as for Facebook servers.
17179 (plain-file "hosts"
17180 (string-append (local-host-aliases host-name)
17181 %facebook-host-aliases))))
17182 @end lisp
17183
17184 This mechanism can prevent programs running locally, such as Web
17185 browsers, from accessing Facebook.
17186 @end defvr
17187
17188 The @code{(gnu services avahi)} provides the following definition.
17189
17190 @defvr {Scheme Variable} avahi-service-type
17191 This is the service that runs @command{avahi-daemon}, a system-wide
17192 mDNS/DNS-SD responder that allows for service discovery and
17193 ``zero-configuration'' host name lookups (see @uref{https://avahi.org/}).
17194 Its value must be an @code{avahi-configuration} record---see below.
17195
17196 This service extends the name service cache daemon (nscd) so that it can
17197 resolve @code{.local} host names using
17198 @uref{https://0pointer.de/lennart/projects/nss-mdns/, nss-mdns}. @xref{Name
17199 Service Switch}, for information on host name resolution.
17200
17201 Additionally, add the @var{avahi} package to the system profile so that
17202 commands such as @command{avahi-browse} are directly usable.
17203 @end defvr
17204
17205 @deftp {Data Type} avahi-configuration
17206 Data type representation the configuration for Avahi.
17207
17208 @table @asis
17209
17210 @item @code{host-name} (default: @code{#f})
17211 If different from @code{#f}, use that as the host name to
17212 publish for this machine; otherwise, use the machine's actual host name.
17213
17214 @item @code{publish?} (default: @code{#t})
17215 When true, allow host names and services to be published (broadcast) over the
17216 network.
17217
17218 @item @code{publish-workstation?} (default: @code{#t})
17219 When true, @command{avahi-daemon} publishes the machine's host name and IP
17220 address via mDNS on the local network. To view the host names published on
17221 your local network, you can run:
17222
17223 @example
17224 avahi-browse _workstation._tcp
17225 @end example
17226
17227 @item @code{wide-area?} (default: @code{#f})
17228 When true, DNS-SD over unicast DNS is enabled.
17229
17230 @item @code{ipv4?} (default: @code{#t})
17231 @itemx @code{ipv6?} (default: @code{#t})
17232 These fields determine whether to use IPv4/IPv6 sockets.
17233
17234 @item @code{domains-to-browse} (default: @code{'()})
17235 This is a list of domains to browse.
17236 @end table
17237 @end deftp
17238
17239 @deffn {Scheme Variable} openvswitch-service-type
17240 This is the type of the @uref{https://www.openvswitch.org, Open vSwitch}
17241 service, whose value should be an @code{openvswitch-configuration}
17242 object.
17243 @end deffn
17244
17245 @deftp {Data Type} openvswitch-configuration
17246 Data type representing the configuration of Open vSwitch, a multilayer
17247 virtual switch which is designed to enable massive network automation
17248 through programmatic extension.
17249
17250 @table @asis
17251 @item @code{package} (default: @var{openvswitch})
17252 Package object of the Open vSwitch.
17253
17254 @end table
17255 @end deftp
17256
17257 @defvr {Scheme Variable} pagekite-service-type
17258 This is the service type for the @uref{https://pagekite.net, PageKite} service,
17259 a tunneling solution for making localhost servers publicly visible, even from
17260 behind restrictive firewalls or NAT without forwarded ports. The value for
17261 this service type is a @code{pagekite-configuration} record.
17262
17263 Here's an example exposing the local HTTP and SSH daemons:
17264
17265 @lisp
17266 (service pagekite-service-type
17267 (pagekite-configuration
17268 (kites '("http:@@kitename:localhost:80:@@kitesecret"
17269 "raw/22:@@kitename:localhost:22:@@kitesecret"))
17270 (extra-file "/etc/pagekite.rc")))
17271 @end lisp
17272 @end defvr
17273
17274 @deftp {Data Type} pagekite-configuration
17275 Data type representing the configuration of PageKite.
17276
17277 @table @asis
17278 @item @code{package} (default: @var{pagekite})
17279 Package object of PageKite.
17280
17281 @item @code{kitename} (default: @code{#f})
17282 PageKite name for authenticating to the frontend server.
17283
17284 @item @code{kitesecret} (default: @code{#f})
17285 Shared secret for authenticating to the frontend server. You should probably
17286 put this inside @code{extra-file} instead.
17287
17288 @item @code{frontend} (default: @code{#f})
17289 Connect to the named PageKite frontend server instead of the
17290 @uref{https://pagekite.net,,pagekite.net} service.
17291
17292 @item @code{kites} (default: @code{'("http:@@kitename:localhost:80:@@kitesecret")})
17293 List of service kites to use. Exposes HTTP on port 80 by default. The format
17294 is @code{proto:kitename:host:port:secret}.
17295
17296 @item @code{extra-file} (default: @code{#f})
17297 Extra configuration file to read, which you are expected to create manually.
17298 Use this to add additional options and manage shared secrets out-of-band.
17299
17300 @end table
17301 @end deftp
17302
17303 @defvr {Scheme Variable} yggdrasil-service-type
17304 The service type for connecting to the @uref{https://yggdrasil-network.github.io/,
17305 Yggdrasil network}, an early-stage implementation of a fully end-to-end
17306 encrypted IPv6 network.
17307
17308 @quotation
17309 Yggdrasil provides name-independent routing with cryptographically generated
17310 addresses. Static addressing means you can keep the same address as long as
17311 you want, even if you move to a new location, or generate a new address (by
17312 generating new keys) whenever you want.
17313 @uref{https://yggdrasil-network.github.io/2018/07/28/addressing.html}
17314 @end quotation
17315
17316 Pass it a value of @code{yggdrasil-configuration} to connect it to public
17317 peers and/or local peers.
17318
17319 Here is an example using public peers and a static address. The static
17320 signing and encryption keys are defined in @file{/etc/yggdrasil-private.conf}
17321 (the default value for @code{config-file}).
17322
17323 @lisp
17324 ;; part of the operating-system declaration
17325 (service yggdrasil-service-type
17326 (yggdrasil-configuration
17327 (autoconf? #f) ;; use only the public peers
17328 (json-config
17329 ;; choose one from
17330 ;; https://github.com/yggdrasil-network/public-peers
17331 '((peers . #("tcp://1.2.3.4:1337"))))
17332 ;; /etc/yggdrasil-private.conf is the default value for config-file
17333 ))
17334 @end lisp
17335 @example
17336 # sample content for /etc/yggdrasil-private.conf
17337 @{
17338 # Your public encryption key. Your peers may ask you for this to put
17339 # into their AllowedEncryptionPublicKeys configuration.
17340 EncryptionPublicKey: 378dc5...
17341
17342 # Your private encryption key. DO NOT share this with anyone!
17343 EncryptionPrivateKey: 0777...
17344
17345 # Your public signing key. You should not ordinarily need to share
17346 # this with anyone.
17347 SigningPublicKey: e1664...
17348
17349 # Your private signing key. DO NOT share this with anyone!
17350 SigningPrivateKey: 0589d...
17351 @}
17352 @end example
17353 @end defvr
17354
17355 @deftp {Data Type} yggdrasil-configuration
17356 Data type representing the configuration of Yggdrasil.
17357
17358 @table @asis
17359 @item @code{package} (default: @code{yggdrasil})
17360 Package object of Yggdrasil.
17361
17362 @item @code{json-config} (default: @code{'()})
17363 Contents of @file{/etc/yggdrasil.conf}. Will be merged with
17364 @file{/etc/yggdrasil-private.conf}. Note that these settings are stored in
17365 the Guix store, which is readable to all users. @strong{Do not store your
17366 private keys in it}. See the output of @code{yggdrasil -genconf} for a
17367 quick overview of valid keys and their default values.
17368
17369 @item @code{autoconf?} (default: @code{#f})
17370 Whether to use automatic mode. Enabling it makes Yggdrasil use adynamic IP
17371 and peer with IPv6 neighbors.
17372
17373 @item @code{log-level} (default: @code{'info})
17374 How much detail to include in logs. Use @code{'debug} for more detail.
17375
17376 @item @code{log-to} (default: @code{'stdout})
17377 Where to send logs. By default, the service logs standard output to
17378 @file{/var/log/yggdrasil.log}. The alternative is @code{'syslog}, which
17379 sends output to the running syslog service.
17380
17381 @item @code{config-file} (default: @code{"/etc/yggdrasil-private.conf"})
17382 What HJSON file to load sensitive data from. This is where private keys
17383 should be stored, which are necessary to specify if you don't want a
17384 randomized address after each restart. Use @code{#f} to disable. Options
17385 defined in this file take precedence over @code{json-config}. Use the output
17386 of @code{yggdrasil -genconf} as a starting point. To configure a static
17387 address, delete everything except these options:
17388
17389 @itemize
17390 @item @code{EncryptionPublicKey}
17391 @item @code{EncryptionPrivateKey}
17392 @item @code{SigningPublicKey}
17393 @item @code{SigningPrivateKey}
17394 @end itemize
17395 @end table
17396 @end deftp
17397
17398 @cindex keepalived
17399 @deffn {Scheme Variable} keepalived-service-type
17400 This is the type for the @uref{https://www.keepalived.org/, Keepalived}
17401 routing software, @command{keepalived}. Its value must be an
17402 @code{keepalived-configuration} record as in this example for master
17403 machine:
17404
17405 @lisp
17406 (service keepalived-service-type
17407 (keepalived-configuration
17408 (config-file (local-file "keepalived-master.conf"))))
17409 @end lisp
17410
17411 where @file{keepalived-master.conf}:
17412
17413 @example
17414 vrrp_instance my-group @{
17415 state MASTER
17416 interface enp9s0
17417 virtual_router_id 100
17418 priority 100
17419 unicast_peer @{ 10.0.0.2 @}
17420 virtual_ipaddress @{
17421 10.0.0.4/24
17422 @}
17423 @}
17424 @end example
17425
17426 and for backup machine:
17427
17428 @lisp
17429 (service keepalived-service-type
17430 (keepalived-configuration
17431 (config-file (local-file "keepalived-backup.conf"))))
17432 @end lisp
17433
17434 where @file{keepalived-backup.conf}:
17435
17436 @example
17437 vrrp_instance my-group @{
17438 state BACKUP
17439 interface enp9s0
17440 virtual_router_id 100
17441 priority 99
17442 unicast_peer @{ 10.0.0.3 @}
17443 virtual_ipaddress @{
17444 10.0.0.4/24
17445 @}
17446 @}
17447 @end example
17448 @end deffn
17449
17450 @node Unattended Upgrades
17451 @subsection Unattended Upgrades
17452
17453 @cindex unattended upgrades
17454 @cindex upgrades, unattended
17455 Guix provides a service to perform @emph{unattended upgrades}:
17456 periodically, the system automatically reconfigures itself from the
17457 latest Guix. Guix System has several properties that make unattended
17458 upgrades safe:
17459
17460 @itemize
17461 @item
17462 upgrades are transactional (either the upgrade succeeds or it fails, but
17463 you cannot end up with an ``in-between'' system state);
17464 @item
17465 the upgrade log is kept---you can view it with @command{guix system
17466 list-generations}---and you can roll back to any previous generation,
17467 should the upgraded system fail to behave as intended;
17468 @item
17469 channel code is authenticated so you know you can only run genuine code
17470 (@pxref{Channels});
17471 @item
17472 @command{guix system reconfigure} prevents downgrades, which makes it
17473 immune to @dfn{downgrade attacks}.
17474 @end itemize
17475
17476 To set up unattended upgrades, add an instance of
17477 @code{unattended-upgrade-service-type} like the one below to the list of
17478 your operating system services:
17479
17480 @lisp
17481 (service unattended-upgrade-service-type)
17482 @end lisp
17483
17484 The defaults above set up weekly upgrades: every Sunday at midnight.
17485 You do not need to provide the operating system configuration file: it
17486 uses @file{/run/current-system/configuration.scm}, which ensures it
17487 always uses your latest configuration---@pxref{provenance-service-type},
17488 for more information about this file.
17489
17490 There are several things that can be configured, in particular the
17491 periodicity and services (daemons) to be restarted upon completion.
17492 When the upgrade is successful, the service takes care of deleting
17493 system generations older that some threshold, as per @command{guix
17494 system delete-generations}. See the reference below for details.
17495
17496 To ensure that upgrades are actually happening, you can run
17497 @command{guix system describe}. To investigate upgrade failures, visit
17498 the unattended upgrade log file (see below).
17499
17500 @defvr {Scheme Variable} unattended-upgrade-service-type
17501 This is the service type for unattended upgrades. It sets up an mcron
17502 job (@pxref{Scheduled Job Execution}) that runs @command{guix system
17503 reconfigure} from the latest version of the specified channels.
17504
17505 Its value must be a @code{unattended-upgrade-configuration} record (see
17506 below).
17507 @end defvr
17508
17509 @deftp {Data Type} unattended-upgrade-configuration
17510 This data type represents the configuration of the unattended upgrade
17511 service. The following fields are available:
17512
17513 @table @asis
17514 @item @code{schedule} (default: @code{"30 01 * * 0"})
17515 This is the schedule of upgrades, expressed as a gexp containing an
17516 mcron job schedule (@pxref{Guile Syntax, mcron job specifications,,
17517 mcron, GNU@tie{}mcron}).
17518
17519 @item @code{channels} (default: @code{#~%default-channels})
17520 This gexp specifies the channels to use for the upgrade
17521 (@pxref{Channels}). By default, the tip of the official @code{guix}
17522 channel is used.
17523
17524 @item @code{operating-system-file} (default: @code{"/run/current-system/configuration.scm"})
17525 This field specifies the operating system configuration file to use.
17526 The default is to reuse the config file of the current configuration.
17527
17528 There are cases, though, where referring to
17529 @file{/run/current-system/configuration.scm} is not enough, for instance
17530 because that file refers to extra files (SSH public keys, extra
17531 configuration files, etc.) @i{via} @code{local-file} and similar
17532 constructs. For those cases, we recommend something along these lines:
17533
17534 @lisp
17535 (unattended-upgrade-configuration
17536 (operating-system-file
17537 (file-append (local-file "." "config-dir" #:recursive? #t)
17538 "/config.scm")))
17539 @end lisp
17540
17541 The effect here is to import all of the current directory into the
17542 store, and to refer to @file{config.scm} within that directory.
17543 Therefore, uses of @code{local-file} within @file{config.scm} will work
17544 as expected. @xref{G-Expressions}, for information about
17545 @code{local-file} and @code{file-append}.
17546
17547 @item @code{services-to-restart} (default: @code{'(mcron)})
17548 This field specifies the Shepherd services to restart when the upgrade
17549 completes.
17550
17551 Those services are restarted right away upon completion, as with
17552 @command{herd restart}, which ensures that the latest version is
17553 running---remember that by default @command{guix system reconfigure}
17554 only restarts services that are not currently running, which is
17555 conservative: it minimizes disruption but leaves outdated services
17556 running.
17557
17558 Use @command{herd status} to find out candidates for restarting.
17559 @xref{Services}, for general information about services. Common
17560 services to restart would include @code{ntpd} and @code{ssh-daemon}.
17561
17562 By default, the @code{mcron} service is restarted. This ensures that
17563 the latest version of the unattended upgrade job will be used next time.
17564
17565 @item @code{system-expiration} (default: @code{(* 3 30 24 3600)})
17566 This is the expiration time in seconds for system generations. System
17567 generations older that this amount of time are deleted with
17568 @command{guix system delete-generations} when an upgrade completes.
17569
17570 @quotation Note
17571 The unattended upgrade service does not run the garbage collector. You
17572 will probably want to set up your own mcron job to run @command{guix gc}
17573 periodically.
17574 @end quotation
17575
17576 @item @code{maximum-duration} (default: @code{3600})
17577 Maximum duration in seconds for the upgrade; past that time, the upgrade
17578 aborts.
17579
17580 This is primarily useful to ensure the upgrade does not end up
17581 rebuilding or re-downloading ``the world''.
17582
17583 @item @code{log-file} (default: @code{"/var/log/unattended-upgrade.log"})
17584 File where unattended upgrades are logged.
17585 @end table
17586 @end deftp
17587
17588 @node X Window
17589 @subsection X Window
17590
17591 @cindex X11
17592 @cindex X Window System
17593 @cindex login manager
17594 Support for the X Window graphical display system---specifically
17595 Xorg---is provided by the @code{(gnu services xorg)} module. Note that
17596 there is no @code{xorg-service} procedure. Instead, the X server is
17597 started by the @dfn{login manager}, by default the GNOME Display Manager (GDM).
17598
17599 @cindex GDM
17600 @cindex GNOME, login manager
17601 GDM of course allows users to log in into window managers and desktop
17602 environments other than GNOME; for those using GNOME, GDM is required for
17603 features such as automatic screen locking.
17604
17605 @cindex window manager
17606 To use X11, you must install at least one @dfn{window manager}---for
17607 example the @code{windowmaker} or @code{openbox} packages---preferably
17608 by adding it to the @code{packages} field of your operating system
17609 definition (@pxref{operating-system Reference, system-wide packages}).
17610
17611 @defvr {Scheme Variable} gdm-service-type
17612 This is the type for the @uref{https://wiki.gnome.org/Projects/GDM/, GNOME
17613 Desktop Manager} (GDM), a program that manages graphical display servers and
17614 handles graphical user logins. Its value must be a @code{gdm-configuration}
17615 (see below).
17616
17617 @cindex session types (X11)
17618 @cindex X11 session types
17619 GDM looks for @dfn{session types} described by the @file{.desktop} files in
17620 @file{/run/current-system/profile/share/xsessions} and allows users to choose
17621 a session from the log-in screen. Packages such as @code{gnome}, @code{xfce},
17622 and @code{i3} provide @file{.desktop} files; adding them to the system-wide
17623 set of packages automatically makes them available at the log-in screen.
17624
17625 In addition, @file{~/.xsession} files are honored. When available,
17626 @file{~/.xsession} must be an executable that starts a window manager
17627 and/or other X clients.
17628 @end defvr
17629
17630 @deftp {Data Type} gdm-configuration
17631 @table @asis
17632 @item @code{auto-login?} (default: @code{#f})
17633 @itemx @code{default-user} (default: @code{#f})
17634 When @code{auto-login?} is false, GDM presents a log-in screen.
17635
17636 When @code{auto-login?} is true, GDM logs in directly as
17637 @code{default-user}.
17638
17639 @item @code{debug?} (default: @code{#f})
17640 When true, GDM writes debug messages to its log.
17641
17642 @item @code{gnome-shell-assets} (default: ...)
17643 List of GNOME Shell assets needed by GDM: icon theme, fonts, etc.
17644
17645 @item @code{xorg-configuration} (default: @code{(xorg-configuration)})
17646 Configuration of the Xorg graphical server.
17647
17648 @item @code{xsession} (default: @code{(xinitrc)})
17649 Script to run before starting a X session.
17650
17651 @item @code{dbus-daemon} (default: @code{dbus-daemon-wrapper})
17652 File name of the @code{dbus-daemon} executable.
17653
17654 @item @code{gdm} (default: @code{gdm})
17655 The GDM package to use.
17656 @end table
17657 @end deftp
17658
17659 @defvr {Scheme Variable} slim-service-type
17660 This is the type for the SLiM graphical login manager for X11.
17661
17662 Like GDM, SLiM looks for session types described by @file{.desktop} files and
17663 allows users to choose a session from the log-in screen using @kbd{F1}. It
17664 also honors @file{~/.xsession} files.
17665
17666 Unlike GDM, SLiM does not spawn the user session on a different VT after
17667 logging in, which means that you can only start one graphical session. If you
17668 want to be able to run multiple graphical sessions at the same time you have
17669 to add multiple SLiM services to your system services. The following example
17670 shows how to replace the default GDM service with two SLiM services on tty7
17671 and tty8.
17672
17673 @lisp
17674 (use-modules (gnu services)
17675 (gnu services desktop)
17676 (gnu services xorg)
17677 (srfi srfi-1)) ;for 'remove'
17678
17679 (operating-system
17680 ;; ...
17681 (services (cons* (service slim-service-type (slim-configuration
17682 (display ":0")
17683 (vt "vt7")))
17684 (service slim-service-type (slim-configuration
17685 (display ":1")
17686 (vt "vt8")))
17687 (remove (lambda (service)
17688 (eq? (service-kind service) gdm-service-type))
17689 %desktop-services))))
17690 @end lisp
17691
17692 @end defvr
17693
17694 @deftp {Data Type} slim-configuration
17695 Data type representing the configuration of @code{slim-service-type}.
17696
17697 @table @asis
17698 @item @code{allow-empty-passwords?} (default: @code{#t})
17699 Whether to allow logins with empty passwords.
17700
17701 @item @code{auto-login?} (default: @code{#f})
17702 @itemx @code{default-user} (default: @code{""})
17703 When @code{auto-login?} is false, SLiM presents a log-in screen.
17704
17705 When @code{auto-login?} is true, SLiM logs in directly as
17706 @code{default-user}.
17707
17708 @item @code{theme} (default: @code{%default-slim-theme})
17709 @itemx @code{theme-name} (default: @code{%default-slim-theme-name})
17710 The graphical theme to use and its name.
17711
17712 @item @code{auto-login-session} (default: @code{#f})
17713 If true, this must be the name of the executable to start as the default
17714 session---e.g., @code{(file-append windowmaker "/bin/windowmaker")}.
17715
17716 If false, a session described by one of the available @file{.desktop}
17717 files in @code{/run/current-system/profile} and @code{~/.guix-profile}
17718 will be used.
17719
17720 @quotation Note
17721 You must install at least one window manager in the system profile or in
17722 your user profile. Failing to do that, if @code{auto-login-session} is
17723 false, you will be unable to log in.
17724 @end quotation
17725
17726 @item @code{xorg-configuration} (default @code{(xorg-configuration)})
17727 Configuration of the Xorg graphical server.
17728
17729 @item @code{display} (default @code{":0"})
17730 The display on which to start the Xorg graphical server.
17731
17732 @item @code{vt} (default @code{"vt7"})
17733 The VT on which to start the Xorg graphical server.
17734
17735 @item @code{xauth} (default: @code{xauth})
17736 The XAuth package to use.
17737
17738 @item @code{shepherd} (default: @code{shepherd})
17739 The Shepherd package used when invoking @command{halt} and
17740 @command{reboot}.
17741
17742 @item @code{sessreg} (default: @code{sessreg})
17743 The sessreg package used in order to register the session.
17744
17745 @item @code{slim} (default: @code{slim})
17746 The SLiM package to use.
17747 @end table
17748 @end deftp
17749
17750 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %default-theme
17751 @defvrx {Scheme Variable} %default-theme-name
17752 The default SLiM theme and its name.
17753 @end defvr
17754
17755
17756 @deftp {Data Type} sddm-configuration
17757 This is the data type representing the SDDM service configuration.
17758
17759 @table @asis
17760 @item @code{display-server} (default: "x11")
17761 Select display server to use for the greeter. Valid values are
17762 @samp{"x11"} or @samp{"wayland"}.
17763
17764 @item @code{numlock} (default: "on")
17765 Valid values are @samp{"on"}, @samp{"off"} or @samp{"none"}.
17766
17767 @item @code{halt-command} (default @code{#~(string-apppend #$shepherd "/sbin/halt")})
17768 Command to run when halting.
17769
17770 @item @code{reboot-command} (default @code{#~(string-append #$shepherd "/sbin/reboot")})
17771 Command to run when rebooting.
17772
17773 @item @code{theme} (default "maldives")
17774 Theme to use. Default themes provided by SDDM are @samp{"elarun"},
17775 @samp{"maldives"} or @samp{"maya"}.
17776
17777 @item @code{themes-directory} (default "/run/current-system/profile/share/sddm/themes")
17778 Directory to look for themes.
17779
17780 @item @code{faces-directory} (default "/run/current-system/profile/share/sddm/faces")
17781 Directory to look for faces.
17782
17783 @item @code{default-path} (default "/run/current-system/profile/bin")
17784 Default PATH to use.
17785
17786 @item @code{minimum-uid} (default: 1000)
17787 Minimum UID displayed in SDDM and allowed for log-in.
17788
17789 @item @code{maximum-uid} (default: 2000)
17790 Maximum UID to display in SDDM.
17791
17792 @item @code{remember-last-user?} (default #t)
17793 Remember last user.
17794
17795 @item @code{remember-last-session?} (default #t)
17796 Remember last session.
17797
17798 @item @code{hide-users} (default "")
17799 Usernames to hide from SDDM greeter.
17800
17801 @item @code{hide-shells} (default @code{#~(string-append #$shadow "/sbin/nologin")})
17802 Users with shells listed will be hidden from the SDDM greeter.
17803
17804 @item @code{session-command} (default @code{#~(string-append #$sddm "/share/sddm/scripts/wayland-session")})
17805 Script to run before starting a wayland session.
17806
17807 @item @code{sessions-directory} (default "/run/current-system/profile/share/wayland-sessions")
17808 Directory to look for desktop files starting wayland sessions.
17809
17810 @item @code{xorg-configuration} (default @code{(xorg-configuration)})
17811 Configuration of the Xorg graphical server.
17812
17813 @item @code{xauth-path} (default @code{#~(string-append #$xauth "/bin/xauth")})
17814 Path to xauth.
17815
17816 @item @code{xephyr-path} (default @code{#~(string-append #$xorg-server "/bin/Xephyr")})
17817 Path to Xephyr.
17818
17819 @item @code{xdisplay-start} (default @code{#~(string-append #$sddm "/share/sddm/scripts/Xsetup")})
17820 Script to run after starting xorg-server.
17821
17822 @item @code{xdisplay-stop} (default @code{#~(string-append #$sddm "/share/sddm/scripts/Xstop")})
17823 Script to run before stopping xorg-server.
17824
17825 @item @code{xsession-command} (default: @code{xinitrc})
17826 Script to run before starting a X session.
17827
17828 @item @code{xsessions-directory} (default: "/run/current-system/profile/share/xsessions")
17829 Directory to look for desktop files starting X sessions.
17830
17831 @item @code{minimum-vt} (default: 7)
17832 Minimum VT to use.
17833
17834 @item @code{auto-login-user} (default "")
17835 User to use for auto-login.
17836
17837 @item @code{auto-login-session} (default "")
17838 Desktop file to use for auto-login.
17839
17840 @item @code{relogin?} (default #f)
17841 Relogin after logout.
17842
17843 @end table
17844 @end deftp
17845
17846 @cindex login manager
17847 @cindex X11 login
17848 @defvr {Scheme Variable} sddm-service-type
17849 This is the type of the service to run the
17850 @uref{https://github.com/sddm/sddm,SDDM display manager}. Its value
17851 must be a @code{sddm-configuration} record (see below).
17852
17853 Here's an example use:
17854
17855 @lisp
17856 (service sddm-service-type
17857 (sddm-configuration
17858 (auto-login-user "alice")
17859 (auto-login-session "xfce.desktop")))
17860 @end lisp
17861 @end defvr
17862
17863 @deftp {Data Type} sddm-configuration
17864 This data type represents the configuration of the SDDM login manager.
17865 The available fields are:
17866
17867 @table @asis
17868 @item @code{sddm} (default: @code{sddm})
17869 The SDDM package to use.
17870
17871 @item @code{display-server} (default: @code{"x11"})
17872 This must be either @code{"x11"} or @code{"wayland"}.
17873
17874 @c FIXME: Add more fields.
17875
17876 @item @code{auto-login-user} (default: @code{""})
17877 If non-empty, this is the user account under which to log in
17878 automatically.
17879
17880 @item @code{auto-login-session} (default: @code{""})
17881 If non-empty, this is the @file{.desktop} file name to use as the
17882 auto-login session.
17883 @end table
17884 @end deftp
17885
17886 @cindex Xorg, configuration
17887 @deftp {Data Type} xorg-configuration
17888 This data type represents the configuration of the Xorg graphical display
17889 server. Note that there is no Xorg service; instead, the X server is started
17890 by a ``display manager'' such as GDM, SDDM, and SLiM@. Thus, the configuration
17891 of these display managers aggregates an @code{xorg-configuration} record.
17892
17893 @table @asis
17894 @item @code{modules} (default: @code{%default-xorg-modules})
17895 This is a list of @dfn{module packages} loaded by the Xorg
17896 server---e.g., @code{xf86-video-vesa}, @code{xf86-input-keyboard}, and so on.
17897
17898 @item @code{fonts} (default: @code{%default-xorg-fonts})
17899 This is a list of font directories to add to the server's @dfn{font path}.
17900
17901 @item @code{drivers} (default: @code{'()})
17902 This must be either the empty list, in which case Xorg chooses a graphics
17903 driver automatically, or a list of driver names that will be tried in this
17904 order---e.g., @code{("modesetting" "vesa")}.
17905
17906 @item @code{resolutions} (default: @code{'()})
17907 When @code{resolutions} is the empty list, Xorg chooses an appropriate screen
17908 resolution. Otherwise, it must be a list of resolutions---e.g., @code{((1024
17909 768) (640 480))}.
17910
17911 @cindex keyboard layout, for Xorg
17912 @cindex keymap, for Xorg
17913 @item @code{keyboard-layout} (default: @code{#f})
17914 If this is @code{#f}, Xorg uses the default keyboard layout---usually US
17915 English (``qwerty'') for a 105-key PC keyboard.
17916
17917 Otherwise this must be a @code{keyboard-layout} object specifying the keyboard
17918 layout in use when Xorg is running. @xref{Keyboard Layout}, for more
17919 information on how to specify the keyboard layout.
17920
17921 @item @code{extra-config} (default: @code{'()})
17922 This is a list of strings or objects appended to the configuration file. It
17923 is used to pass extra text to be added verbatim to the configuration file.
17924
17925 @item @code{server} (default: @code{xorg-server})
17926 This is the package providing the Xorg server.
17927
17928 @item @code{server-arguments} (default: @code{%default-xorg-server-arguments})
17929 This is the list of command-line arguments to pass to the X server. The
17930 default is @code{-nolisten tcp}.
17931 @end table
17932 @end deftp
17933
17934 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} set-xorg-configuration @var{config} @
17935 [@var{login-manager-service-type}]
17936 Tell the log-in manager (of type @var{login-manager-service-type}) to use
17937 @var{config}, an @code{<xorg-configuration>} record.
17938
17939 Since the Xorg configuration is embedded in the log-in manager's
17940 configuration---e.g., @code{gdm-configuration}---this procedure provides a
17941 shorthand to set the Xorg configuration.
17942 @end deffn
17943
17944 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} xorg-start-command [@var{config}]
17945 Return a @code{startx} script in which the modules, fonts, etc. specified
17946 in @var{config}, are available. The result should be used in place of
17947 @code{startx}.
17948
17949 Usually the X server is started by a login manager.
17950 @end deffn
17951
17952
17953 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} screen-locker-service @var{package} [@var{program}]
17954 Add @var{package}, a package for a screen locker or screen saver whose
17955 command is @var{program}, to the set of setuid programs and add a PAM entry
17956 for it. For example:
17957
17958 @lisp
17959 (screen-locker-service xlockmore "xlock")
17960 @end lisp
17961
17962 makes the good ol' XlockMore usable.
17963 @end deffn
17964
17965
17966 @node Printing Services
17967 @subsection Printing Services
17968
17969 @cindex printer support with CUPS
17970 The @code{(gnu services cups)} module provides a Guix service definition
17971 for the CUPS printing service. To add printer support to a Guix
17972 system, add a @code{cups-service} to the operating system definition:
17973
17974 @deffn {Scheme Variable} cups-service-type
17975 The service type for the CUPS print server. Its value should be a valid
17976 CUPS configuration (see below). To use the default settings, simply
17977 write:
17978 @lisp
17979 (service cups-service-type)
17980 @end lisp
17981 @end deffn
17982
17983 The CUPS configuration controls the basic things about your CUPS
17984 installation: what interfaces it listens on, what to do if a print job
17985 fails, how much logging to do, and so on. To actually add a printer,
17986 you have to visit the @url{http://localhost:631} URL, or use a tool such
17987 as GNOME's printer configuration services. By default, configuring a
17988 CUPS service will generate a self-signed certificate if needed, for
17989 secure connections to the print server.
17990
17991 Suppose you want to enable the Web interface of CUPS and also add
17992 support for Epson printers @i{via} the @code{epson-inkjet-printer-escpr}
17993 package and for HP printers @i{via} the @code{hplip-minimal} package.
17994 You can do that directly, like this (you need to use the
17995 @code{(gnu packages cups)} module):
17996
17997 @lisp
17998 (service cups-service-type
17999 (cups-configuration
18000 (web-interface? #t)
18001 (extensions
18002 (list cups-filters epson-inkjet-printer-escpr hplip-minimal))))
18003 @end lisp
18004
18005 Note: If you wish to use the Qt5 based GUI which comes with the hplip
18006 package then it is suggested that you install the @code{hplip} package,
18007 either in your OS configuration file or as your user.
18008
18009 The available configuration parameters follow. Each parameter
18010 definition is preceded by its type; for example, @samp{string-list foo}
18011 indicates that the @code{foo} parameter should be specified as a list of
18012 strings. There is also a way to specify the configuration as a string,
18013 if you have an old @code{cupsd.conf} file that you want to port over
18014 from some other system; see the end for more details.
18015
18016 @c The following documentation was initially generated by
18017 @c (generate-documentation) in (gnu services cups). Manually maintained
18018 @c documentation is better, so we shouldn't hesitate to edit below as
18019 @c needed. However if the change you want to make to this documentation
18020 @c can be done in an automated way, it's probably easier to change
18021 @c (generate-documentation) than to make it below and have to deal with
18022 @c the churn as CUPS updates.
18023
18024
18025 Available @code{cups-configuration} fields are:
18026
18027 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} package cups
18028 The CUPS package.
18029 @end deftypevr
18030
18031 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} package-list extensions (default: @code{(list brlaser cups-filters epson-inkjet-printer-escpr foomatic-filters hplip-minimal splix)})
18032 Drivers and other extensions to the CUPS package.
18033 @end deftypevr
18034
18035 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} files-configuration files-configuration
18036 Configuration of where to write logs, what directories to use for print
18037 spools, and related privileged configuration parameters.
18038
18039 Available @code{files-configuration} fields are:
18040
18041 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} log-location access-log
18042 Defines the access log filename. Specifying a blank filename disables
18043 access log generation. The value @code{stderr} causes log entries to be
18044 sent to the standard error file when the scheduler is running in the
18045 foreground, or to the system log daemon when run in the background. The
18046 value @code{syslog} causes log entries to be sent to the system log
18047 daemon. The server name may be included in filenames using the string
18048 @code{%s}, as in @code{/var/log/cups/%s-access_log}.
18049
18050 Defaults to @samp{"/var/log/cups/access_log"}.
18051 @end deftypevr
18052
18053 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} file-name cache-dir
18054 Where CUPS should cache data.
18055
18056 Defaults to @samp{"/var/cache/cups"}.
18057 @end deftypevr
18058
18059 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} string config-file-perm
18060 Specifies the permissions for all configuration files that the scheduler
18061 writes.
18062
18063 Note that the permissions for the printers.conf file are currently
18064 masked to only allow access from the scheduler user (typically root).
18065 This is done because printer device URIs sometimes contain sensitive
18066 authentication information that should not be generally known on the
18067 system. There is no way to disable this security feature.
18068
18069 Defaults to @samp{"0640"}.
18070 @end deftypevr
18071
18072 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} log-location error-log
18073 Defines the error log filename. Specifying a blank filename disables
18074 error log generation. The value @code{stderr} causes log entries to be
18075 sent to the standard error file when the scheduler is running in the
18076 foreground, or to the system log daemon when run in the background. The
18077 value @code{syslog} causes log entries to be sent to the system log
18078 daemon. The server name may be included in filenames using the string
18079 @code{%s}, as in @code{/var/log/cups/%s-error_log}.
18080
18081 Defaults to @samp{"/var/log/cups/error_log"}.
18082 @end deftypevr
18083
18084 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} string fatal-errors
18085 Specifies which errors are fatal, causing the scheduler to exit. The
18086 kind strings are:
18087
18088 @table @code
18089 @item none
18090 No errors are fatal.
18091
18092 @item all
18093 All of the errors below are fatal.
18094
18095 @item browse
18096 Browsing initialization errors are fatal, for example failed connections
18097 to the DNS-SD daemon.
18098
18099 @item config
18100 Configuration file syntax errors are fatal.
18101
18102 @item listen
18103 Listen or Port errors are fatal, except for IPv6 failures on the
18104 loopback or @code{any} addresses.
18105
18106 @item log
18107 Log file creation or write errors are fatal.
18108
18109 @item permissions
18110 Bad startup file permissions are fatal, for example shared TLS
18111 certificate and key files with world-read permissions.
18112 @end table
18113
18114 Defaults to @samp{"all -browse"}.
18115 @end deftypevr
18116
18117 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} boolean file-device?
18118 Specifies whether the file pseudo-device can be used for new printer
18119 queues. The URI @uref{file:///dev/null} is always allowed.
18120
18121 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
18122 @end deftypevr
18123
18124 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} string group
18125 Specifies the group name or ID that will be used when executing external
18126 programs.
18127
18128 Defaults to @samp{"lp"}.
18129 @end deftypevr
18130
18131 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} string log-file-perm
18132 Specifies the permissions for all log files that the scheduler writes.
18133
18134 Defaults to @samp{"0644"}.
18135 @end deftypevr
18136
18137 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} log-location page-log
18138 Defines the page log filename. Specifying a blank filename disables
18139 page log generation. The value @code{stderr} causes log entries to be
18140 sent to the standard error file when the scheduler is running in the
18141 foreground, or to the system log daemon when run in the background. The
18142 value @code{syslog} causes log entries to be sent to the system log
18143 daemon. The server name may be included in filenames using the string
18144 @code{%s}, as in @code{/var/log/cups/%s-page_log}.
18145
18146 Defaults to @samp{"/var/log/cups/page_log"}.
18147 @end deftypevr
18148
18149 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} string remote-root
18150 Specifies the username that is associated with unauthenticated accesses
18151 by clients claiming to be the root user. The default is @code{remroot}.
18152
18153 Defaults to @samp{"remroot"}.
18154 @end deftypevr
18155
18156 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} file-name request-root
18157 Specifies the directory that contains print jobs and other HTTP request
18158 data.
18159
18160 Defaults to @samp{"/var/spool/cups"}.
18161 @end deftypevr
18162
18163 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} sandboxing sandboxing
18164 Specifies the level of security sandboxing that is applied to print
18165 filters, backends, and other child processes of the scheduler; either
18166 @code{relaxed} or @code{strict}. This directive is currently only
18167 used/supported on macOS.
18168
18169 Defaults to @samp{strict}.
18170 @end deftypevr
18171
18172 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} file-name server-keychain
18173 Specifies the location of TLS certificates and private keys. CUPS will
18174 look for public and private keys in this directory: @file{.crt} files
18175 for PEM-encoded certificates and corresponding @file{.key} files for
18176 PEM-encoded private keys.
18177
18178 Defaults to @samp{"/etc/cups/ssl"}.
18179 @end deftypevr
18180
18181 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} file-name server-root
18182 Specifies the directory containing the server configuration files.
18183
18184 Defaults to @samp{"/etc/cups"}.
18185 @end deftypevr
18186
18187 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} boolean sync-on-close?
18188 Specifies whether the scheduler calls fsync(2) after writing
18189 configuration or state files.
18190
18191 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
18192 @end deftypevr
18193
18194 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list system-group
18195 Specifies the group(s) to use for @code{@@SYSTEM} group authentication.
18196 @end deftypevr
18197
18198 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} file-name temp-dir
18199 Specifies the directory where temporary files are stored.
18200
18201 Defaults to @samp{"/var/spool/cups/tmp"}.
18202 @end deftypevr
18203
18204 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} string user
18205 Specifies the user name or ID that is used when running external
18206 programs.
18207
18208 Defaults to @samp{"lp"}.
18209 @end deftypevr
18210
18211 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} string set-env
18212 Set the specified environment variable to be passed to child processes.
18213
18214 Defaults to @samp{"variable value"}.
18215 @end deftypevr
18216 @end deftypevr
18217
18218 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} access-log-level access-log-level
18219 Specifies the logging level for the AccessLog file. The @code{config}
18220 level logs when printers and classes are added, deleted, or modified and
18221 when configuration files are accessed or updated. The @code{actions}
18222 level logs when print jobs are submitted, held, released, modified, or
18223 canceled, and any of the conditions for @code{config}. The @code{all}
18224 level logs all requests.
18225
18226 Defaults to @samp{actions}.
18227 @end deftypevr
18228
18229 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} boolean auto-purge-jobs?
18230 Specifies whether to purge job history data automatically when it is no
18231 longer required for quotas.
18232
18233 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
18234 @end deftypevr
18235
18236 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} comma-separated-string-list browse-dns-sd-sub-types
18237 Specifies a list of DNS-SD sub-types to advertise for each shared printer.
18238 For example, @samp{"_cups" "_print"} will tell network clients that both
18239 CUPS sharing and IPP Everywhere are supported.
18240
18241 Defaults to @samp{"_cups"}.
18242 @end deftypevr
18243
18244 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} browse-local-protocols browse-local-protocols
18245 Specifies which protocols to use for local printer sharing.
18246
18247 Defaults to @samp{dnssd}.
18248 @end deftypevr
18249
18250 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} boolean browse-web-if?
18251 Specifies whether the CUPS web interface is advertised.
18252
18253 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
18254 @end deftypevr
18255
18256 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} boolean browsing?
18257 Specifies whether shared printers are advertised.
18258
18259 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
18260 @end deftypevr
18261
18262 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} string classification
18263 Specifies the security classification of the server. Any valid banner
18264 name can be used, including @samp{"classified"}, @samp{"confidential"},
18265 @samp{"secret"}, @samp{"topsecret"}, and @samp{"unclassified"}, or the
18266 banner can be omitted to disable secure printing functions.
18267
18268 Defaults to @samp{""}.
18269 @end deftypevr
18270
18271 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} boolean classify-override?
18272 Specifies whether users may override the classification (cover page) of
18273 individual print jobs using the @code{job-sheets} option.
18274
18275 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
18276 @end deftypevr
18277
18278 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} default-auth-type default-auth-type
18279 Specifies the default type of authentication to use.
18280
18281 Defaults to @samp{Basic}.
18282 @end deftypevr
18283
18284 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} default-encryption default-encryption
18285 Specifies whether encryption will be used for authenticated requests.
18286
18287 Defaults to @samp{Required}.
18288 @end deftypevr
18289
18290 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} string default-language
18291 Specifies the default language to use for text and web content.
18292
18293 Defaults to @samp{"en"}.
18294 @end deftypevr
18295
18296 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} string default-paper-size
18297 Specifies the default paper size for new print queues. @samp{"Auto"}
18298 uses a locale-specific default, while @samp{"None"} specifies there is
18299 no default paper size. Specific size names are typically
18300 @samp{"Letter"} or @samp{"A4"}.
18301
18302 Defaults to @samp{"Auto"}.
18303 @end deftypevr
18304
18305 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} string default-policy
18306 Specifies the default access policy to use.
18307
18308 Defaults to @samp{"default"}.
18309 @end deftypevr
18310
18311 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} boolean default-shared?
18312 Specifies whether local printers are shared by default.
18313
18314 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
18315 @end deftypevr
18316
18317 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer dirty-clean-interval
18318 Specifies the delay for updating of configuration and state files, in
18319 seconds. A value of 0 causes the update to happen as soon as possible,
18320 typically within a few milliseconds.
18321
18322 Defaults to @samp{30}.
18323 @end deftypevr
18324
18325 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} error-policy error-policy
18326 Specifies what to do when an error occurs. Possible values are
18327 @code{abort-job}, which will discard the failed print job;
18328 @code{retry-job}, which will retry the job at a later time;
18329 @code{retry-current-job}, which retries the failed job immediately; and
18330 @code{stop-printer}, which stops the printer.
18331
18332 Defaults to @samp{stop-printer}.
18333 @end deftypevr
18334
18335 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer filter-limit
18336 Specifies the maximum cost of filters that are run concurrently, which
18337 can be used to minimize disk, memory, and CPU resource problems. A
18338 limit of 0 disables filter limiting. An average print to a
18339 non-PostScript printer needs a filter limit of about 200. A PostScript
18340 printer needs about half that (100). Setting the limit below these
18341 thresholds will effectively limit the scheduler to printing a single job
18342 at any time.
18343
18344 Defaults to @samp{0}.
18345 @end deftypevr
18346
18347 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer filter-nice
18348 Specifies the scheduling priority of filters that are run to print a
18349 job. The nice value ranges from 0, the highest priority, to 19, the
18350 lowest priority.
18351
18352 Defaults to @samp{0}.
18353 @end deftypevr
18354
18355 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} host-name-lookups host-name-lookups
18356 Specifies whether to do reverse lookups on connecting clients. The
18357 @code{double} setting causes @code{cupsd} to verify that the hostname
18358 resolved from the address matches one of the addresses returned for that
18359 hostname. Double lookups also prevent clients with unregistered
18360 addresses from connecting to your server. Only set this option to
18361 @code{#t} or @code{double} if absolutely required.
18362
18363 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
18364 @end deftypevr
18365
18366 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer job-kill-delay
18367 Specifies the number of seconds to wait before killing the filters and
18368 backend associated with a canceled or held job.
18369
18370 Defaults to @samp{30}.
18371 @end deftypevr
18372
18373 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer job-retry-interval
18374 Specifies the interval between retries of jobs in seconds. This is
18375 typically used for fax queues but can also be used with normal print
18376 queues whose error policy is @code{retry-job} or
18377 @code{retry-current-job}.
18378
18379 Defaults to @samp{30}.
18380 @end deftypevr
18381
18382 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer job-retry-limit
18383 Specifies the number of retries that are done for jobs. This is
18384 typically used for fax queues but can also be used with normal print
18385 queues whose error policy is @code{retry-job} or
18386 @code{retry-current-job}.
18387
18388 Defaults to @samp{5}.
18389 @end deftypevr
18390
18391 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} boolean keep-alive?
18392 Specifies whether to support HTTP keep-alive connections.
18393
18394 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
18395 @end deftypevr
18396
18397 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer keep-alive-timeout
18398 Specifies how long an idle client connection remains open, in seconds.
18399
18400 Defaults to @samp{30}.
18401 @end deftypevr
18402
18403 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer limit-request-body
18404 Specifies the maximum size of print files, IPP requests, and HTML form
18405 data. A limit of 0 disables the limit check.
18406
18407 Defaults to @samp{0}.
18408 @end deftypevr
18409
18410 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} multiline-string-list listen
18411 Listens on the specified interfaces for connections. Valid values are
18412 of the form @var{address}:@var{port}, where @var{address} is either an
18413 IPv6 address enclosed in brackets, an IPv4 address, or @code{*} to
18414 indicate all addresses. Values can also be file names of local UNIX
18415 domain sockets. The Listen directive is similar to the Port directive
18416 but allows you to restrict access to specific interfaces or networks.
18417 @end deftypevr
18418
18419 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer listen-back-log
18420 Specifies the number of pending connections that will be allowed. This
18421 normally only affects very busy servers that have reached the MaxClients
18422 limit, but can also be triggered by large numbers of simultaneous
18423 connections. When the limit is reached, the operating system will
18424 refuse additional connections until the scheduler can accept the pending
18425 ones.
18426
18427 Defaults to @samp{128}.
18428 @end deftypevr
18429
18430 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} location-access-control-list location-access-controls
18431 Specifies a set of additional access controls.
18432
18433 Available @code{location-access-controls} fields are:
18434
18435 @deftypevr {@code{location-access-controls} parameter} file-name path
18436 Specifies the URI path to which the access control applies.
18437 @end deftypevr
18438
18439 @deftypevr {@code{location-access-controls} parameter} access-control-list access-controls
18440 Access controls for all access to this path, in the same format as the
18441 @code{access-controls} of @code{operation-access-control}.
18442
18443 Defaults to @samp{()}.
18444 @end deftypevr
18445
18446 @deftypevr {@code{location-access-controls} parameter} method-access-control-list method-access-controls
18447 Access controls for method-specific access to this path.
18448
18449 Defaults to @samp{()}.
18450
18451 Available @code{method-access-controls} fields are:
18452
18453 @deftypevr {@code{method-access-controls} parameter} boolean reverse?
18454 If @code{#t}, apply access controls to all methods except the listed
18455 methods. Otherwise apply to only the listed methods.
18456
18457 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
18458 @end deftypevr
18459
18460 @deftypevr {@code{method-access-controls} parameter} method-list methods
18461 Methods to which this access control applies.
18462
18463 Defaults to @samp{()}.
18464 @end deftypevr
18465
18466 @deftypevr {@code{method-access-controls} parameter} access-control-list access-controls
18467 Access control directives, as a list of strings. Each string should be
18468 one directive, such as @samp{"Order allow,deny"}.
18469
18470 Defaults to @samp{()}.
18471 @end deftypevr
18472 @end deftypevr
18473 @end deftypevr
18474
18475 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer log-debug-history
18476 Specifies the number of debugging messages that are retained for logging
18477 if an error occurs in a print job. Debug messages are logged regardless
18478 of the LogLevel setting.
18479
18480 Defaults to @samp{100}.
18481 @end deftypevr
18482
18483 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} log-level log-level
18484 Specifies the level of logging for the ErrorLog file. The value
18485 @code{none} stops all logging while @code{debug2} logs everything.
18486
18487 Defaults to @samp{info}.
18488 @end deftypevr
18489
18490 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} log-time-format log-time-format
18491 Specifies the format of the date and time in the log files. The value
18492 @code{standard} logs whole seconds while @code{usecs} logs microseconds.
18493
18494 Defaults to @samp{standard}.
18495 @end deftypevr
18496
18497 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer max-clients
18498 Specifies the maximum number of simultaneous clients that are allowed by
18499 the scheduler.
18500
18501 Defaults to @samp{100}.
18502 @end deftypevr
18503
18504 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer max-clients-per-host
18505 Specifies the maximum number of simultaneous clients that are allowed
18506 from a single address.
18507
18508 Defaults to @samp{100}.
18509 @end deftypevr
18510
18511 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer max-copies
18512 Specifies the maximum number of copies that a user can print of each
18513 job.
18514
18515 Defaults to @samp{9999}.
18516 @end deftypevr
18517
18518 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer max-hold-time
18519 Specifies the maximum time a job may remain in the @code{indefinite}
18520 hold state before it is canceled. A value of 0 disables cancellation of
18521 held jobs.
18522
18523 Defaults to @samp{0}.
18524 @end deftypevr
18525
18526 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer max-jobs
18527 Specifies the maximum number of simultaneous jobs that are allowed. Set
18528 to 0 to allow an unlimited number of jobs.
18529
18530 Defaults to @samp{500}.
18531 @end deftypevr
18532
18533 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer max-jobs-per-printer
18534 Specifies the maximum number of simultaneous jobs that are allowed per
18535 printer. A value of 0 allows up to MaxJobs jobs per printer.
18536
18537 Defaults to @samp{0}.
18538 @end deftypevr
18539
18540 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer max-jobs-per-user
18541 Specifies the maximum number of simultaneous jobs that are allowed per
18542 user. A value of 0 allows up to MaxJobs jobs per user.
18543
18544 Defaults to @samp{0}.
18545 @end deftypevr
18546
18547 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer max-job-time
18548 Specifies the maximum time a job may take to print before it is
18549 canceled, in seconds. Set to 0 to disable cancellation of ``stuck'' jobs.
18550
18551 Defaults to @samp{10800}.
18552 @end deftypevr
18553
18554 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer max-log-size
18555 Specifies the maximum size of the log files before they are rotated, in
18556 bytes. The value 0 disables log rotation.
18557
18558 Defaults to @samp{1048576}.
18559 @end deftypevr
18560
18561 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer multiple-operation-timeout
18562 Specifies the maximum amount of time to allow between files in a
18563 multiple file print job, in seconds.
18564
18565 Defaults to @samp{300}.
18566 @end deftypevr
18567
18568 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} string page-log-format
18569 Specifies the format of PageLog lines. Sequences beginning with percent
18570 (@samp{%}) characters are replaced with the corresponding information,
18571 while all other characters are copied literally. The following percent
18572 sequences are recognized:
18573
18574 @table @samp
18575 @item %%
18576 insert a single percent character
18577
18578 @item %@{name@}
18579 insert the value of the specified IPP attribute
18580
18581 @item %C
18582 insert the number of copies for the current page
18583
18584 @item %P
18585 insert the current page number
18586
18587 @item %T
18588 insert the current date and time in common log format
18589
18590 @item %j
18591 insert the job ID
18592
18593 @item %p
18594 insert the printer name
18595
18596 @item %u
18597 insert the username
18598 @end table
18599
18600 A value of the empty string disables page logging. The string @code{%p
18601 %u %j %T %P %C %@{job-billing@} %@{job-originating-host-name@}
18602 %@{job-name@} %@{media@} %@{sides@}} creates a page log with the
18603 standard items.
18604
18605 Defaults to @samp{""}.
18606 @end deftypevr
18607
18608 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} environment-variables environment-variables
18609 Passes the specified environment variable(s) to child processes; a list
18610 of strings.
18611
18612 Defaults to @samp{()}.
18613 @end deftypevr
18614
18615 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} policy-configuration-list policies
18616 Specifies named access control policies.
18617
18618 Available @code{policy-configuration} fields are:
18619
18620 @deftypevr {@code{policy-configuration} parameter} string name
18621 Name of the policy.
18622 @end deftypevr
18623
18624 @deftypevr {@code{policy-configuration} parameter} string job-private-access
18625 Specifies an access list for a job's private values. @code{@@ACL} maps
18626 to the printer's requesting-user-name-allowed or
18627 requesting-user-name-denied values. @code{@@OWNER} maps to the job's
18628 owner. @code{@@SYSTEM} maps to the groups listed for the
18629 @code{system-group} field of the @code{files-config} configuration,
18630 which is reified into the @code{cups-files.conf(5)} file. Other
18631 possible elements of the access list include specific user names, and
18632 @code{@@@var{group}} to indicate members of a specific group. The
18633 access list may also be simply @code{all} or @code{default}.
18634
18635 Defaults to @samp{"@@OWNER @@SYSTEM"}.
18636 @end deftypevr
18637
18638 @deftypevr {@code{policy-configuration} parameter} string job-private-values
18639 Specifies the list of job values to make private, or @code{all},
18640 @code{default}, or @code{none}.
18641
18642 Defaults to @samp{"job-name job-originating-host-name
18643 job-originating-user-name phone"}.
18644 @end deftypevr
18645
18646 @deftypevr {@code{policy-configuration} parameter} string subscription-private-access
18647 Specifies an access list for a subscription's private values.
18648 @code{@@ACL} maps to the printer's requesting-user-name-allowed or
18649 requesting-user-name-denied values. @code{@@OWNER} maps to the job's
18650 owner. @code{@@SYSTEM} maps to the groups listed for the
18651 @code{system-group} field of the @code{files-config} configuration,
18652 which is reified into the @code{cups-files.conf(5)} file. Other
18653 possible elements of the access list include specific user names, and
18654 @code{@@@var{group}} to indicate members of a specific group. The
18655 access list may also be simply @code{all} or @code{default}.
18656
18657 Defaults to @samp{"@@OWNER @@SYSTEM"}.
18658 @end deftypevr
18659
18660 @deftypevr {@code{policy-configuration} parameter} string subscription-private-values
18661 Specifies the list of job values to make private, or @code{all},
18662 @code{default}, or @code{none}.
18663
18664 Defaults to @samp{"notify-events notify-pull-method notify-recipient-uri
18665 notify-subscriber-user-name notify-user-data"}.
18666 @end deftypevr
18667
18668 @deftypevr {@code{policy-configuration} parameter} operation-access-control-list access-controls
18669 Access control by IPP operation.
18670
18671 Defaults to @samp{()}.
18672 @end deftypevr
18673 @end deftypevr
18674
18675 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} boolean-or-non-negative-integer preserve-job-files
18676 Specifies whether job files (documents) are preserved after a job is
18677 printed. If a numeric value is specified, job files are preserved for
18678 the indicated number of seconds after printing. Otherwise a boolean
18679 value applies indefinitely.
18680
18681 Defaults to @samp{86400}.
18682 @end deftypevr
18683
18684 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} boolean-or-non-negative-integer preserve-job-history
18685 Specifies whether the job history is preserved after a job is printed.
18686 If a numeric value is specified, the job history is preserved for the
18687 indicated number of seconds after printing. If @code{#t}, the job
18688 history is preserved until the MaxJobs limit is reached.
18689
18690 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
18691 @end deftypevr
18692
18693 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer reload-timeout
18694 Specifies the amount of time to wait for job completion before
18695 restarting the scheduler.
18696
18697 Defaults to @samp{30}.
18698 @end deftypevr
18699
18700 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} string rip-cache
18701 Specifies the maximum amount of memory to use when converting documents
18702 into bitmaps for a printer.
18703
18704 Defaults to @samp{"128m"}.
18705 @end deftypevr
18706
18707 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} string server-admin
18708 Specifies the email address of the server administrator.
18709
18710 Defaults to @samp{"root@@localhost.localdomain"}.
18711 @end deftypevr
18712
18713 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} host-name-list-or-* server-alias
18714 The ServerAlias directive is used for HTTP Host header validation when
18715 clients connect to the scheduler from external interfaces. Using the
18716 special name @code{*} can expose your system to known browser-based DNS
18717 rebinding attacks, even when accessing sites through a firewall. If the
18718 auto-discovery of alternate names does not work, we recommend listing
18719 each alternate name with a ServerAlias directive instead of using
18720 @code{*}.
18721
18722 Defaults to @samp{*}.
18723 @end deftypevr
18724
18725 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} string server-name
18726 Specifies the fully-qualified host name of the server.
18727
18728 Defaults to @samp{"localhost"}.
18729 @end deftypevr
18730
18731 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} server-tokens server-tokens
18732 Specifies what information is included in the Server header of HTTP
18733 responses. @code{None} disables the Server header. @code{ProductOnly}
18734 reports @code{CUPS}. @code{Major} reports @code{CUPS 2}. @code{Minor}
18735 reports @code{CUPS 2.0}. @code{Minimal} reports @code{CUPS 2.0.0}.
18736 @code{OS} reports @code{CUPS 2.0.0 (@var{uname})} where @var{uname} is
18737 the output of the @code{uname} command. @code{Full} reports @code{CUPS
18738 2.0.0 (@var{uname}) IPP/2.0}.
18739
18740 Defaults to @samp{Minimal}.
18741 @end deftypevr
18742
18743 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} multiline-string-list ssl-listen
18744 Listens on the specified interfaces for encrypted connections. Valid
18745 values are of the form @var{address}:@var{port}, where @var{address} is
18746 either an IPv6 address enclosed in brackets, an IPv4 address, or
18747 @code{*} to indicate all addresses.
18748
18749 Defaults to @samp{()}.
18750 @end deftypevr
18751
18752 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} ssl-options ssl-options
18753 Sets encryption options. By default, CUPS only supports encryption
18754 using TLS v1.0 or higher using known secure cipher suites. Security is
18755 reduced when @code{Allow} options are used, and enhanced when @code{Deny}
18756 options are used. The @code{AllowRC4} option enables the 128-bit RC4 cipher
18757 suites, which are required for some older clients. The @code{AllowSSL3} option
18758 enables SSL v3.0, which is required for some older clients that do not support
18759 TLS v1.0. The @code{DenyCBC} option disables all CBC cipher suites. The
18760 @code{DenyTLS1.0} option disables TLS v1.0 support - this sets the minimum
18761 protocol version to TLS v1.1.
18762
18763 Defaults to @samp{()}.
18764 @end deftypevr
18765
18766 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} boolean strict-conformance?
18767 Specifies whether the scheduler requires clients to strictly adhere to
18768 the IPP specifications.
18769
18770 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
18771 @end deftypevr
18772
18773 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer timeout
18774 Specifies the HTTP request timeout, in seconds.
18775
18776 Defaults to @samp{300}.
18777
18778 @end deftypevr
18779
18780 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} boolean web-interface?
18781 Specifies whether the web interface is enabled.
18782
18783 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
18784 @end deftypevr
18785
18786 At this point you're probably thinking ``oh dear, Guix manual, I like
18787 you but you can stop already with the configuration options''. Indeed.
18788 However, one more point: it could be that you have an existing
18789 @code{cupsd.conf} that you want to use. In that case, you can pass an
18790 @code{opaque-cups-configuration} as the configuration of a
18791 @code{cups-service-type}.
18792
18793 Available @code{opaque-cups-configuration} fields are:
18794
18795 @deftypevr {@code{opaque-cups-configuration} parameter} package cups
18796 The CUPS package.
18797 @end deftypevr
18798
18799 @deftypevr {@code{opaque-cups-configuration} parameter} string cupsd.conf
18800 The contents of the @code{cupsd.conf}, as a string.
18801 @end deftypevr
18802
18803 @deftypevr {@code{opaque-cups-configuration} parameter} string cups-files.conf
18804 The contents of the @code{cups-files.conf} file, as a string.
18805 @end deftypevr
18806
18807 For example, if your @code{cupsd.conf} and @code{cups-files.conf} are in
18808 strings of the same name, you could instantiate a CUPS service like
18809 this:
18810
18811 @lisp
18812 (service cups-service-type
18813 (opaque-cups-configuration
18814 (cupsd.conf cupsd.conf)
18815 (cups-files.conf cups-files.conf)))
18816 @end lisp
18817
18818
18819 @node Desktop Services
18820 @subsection Desktop Services
18821
18822 The @code{(gnu services desktop)} module provides services that are
18823 usually useful in the context of a ``desktop'' setup---that is, on a
18824 machine running a graphical display server, possibly with graphical user
18825 interfaces, etc. It also defines services that provide specific desktop
18826 environments like GNOME, Xfce or MATE.
18827
18828 To simplify things, the module defines a variable containing the set of
18829 services that users typically expect on a machine with a graphical
18830 environment and networking:
18831
18832 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %desktop-services
18833 This is a list of services that builds upon @code{%base-services} and
18834 adds or adjusts services for a typical ``desktop'' setup.
18835
18836 In particular, it adds a graphical login manager (@pxref{X Window,
18837 @code{gdm-service-type}}), screen lockers, a network management tool
18838 (@pxref{Networking Services, @code{network-manager-service-type}}) with modem
18839 support (@pxref{Networking Services, @code{modem-manager-service-type}}),
18840 energy and color management services, the @code{elogind} login and seat
18841 manager, the Polkit privilege service, the GeoClue location service, the
18842 AccountsService daemon that allows authorized users change system passwords,
18843 an NTP client (@pxref{Networking Services}), the Avahi daemon, and has the
18844 name service switch service configured to be able to use @code{nss-mdns}
18845 (@pxref{Name Service Switch, mDNS}).
18846 @end defvr
18847
18848 The @code{%desktop-services} variable can be used as the @code{services}
18849 field of an @code{operating-system} declaration (@pxref{operating-system
18850 Reference, @code{services}}).
18851
18852 Additionally, the @code{gnome-desktop-service-type},
18853 @code{xfce-desktop-service}, @code{mate-desktop-service-type},
18854 @code{lxqt-desktop-service-type} and @code{enlightenment-desktop-service-type}
18855 procedures can add GNOME, Xfce, MATE and/or Enlightenment to a system. To
18856 ``add GNOME'' means that system-level services like the backlight adjustment
18857 helpers and the power management utilities are added to the system, extending
18858 @code{polkit} and @code{dbus} appropriately, allowing GNOME to operate with
18859 elevated privileges on a limited number of special-purpose system interfaces.
18860 Additionally, adding a service made by @code{gnome-desktop-service-type} adds
18861 the GNOME metapackage to the system profile. Likewise, adding the Xfce
18862 service not only adds the @code{xfce} metapackage to the system profile, but
18863 it also gives the Thunar file manager the ability to open a ``root-mode'' file
18864 management window, if the user authenticates using the administrator's
18865 password via the standard polkit graphical interface. To ``add MATE'' means
18866 that @code{polkit} and @code{dbus} are extended appropriately, allowing MATE
18867 to operate with elevated privileges on a limited number of special-purpose
18868 system interfaces. Additionally, adding a service of type
18869 @code{mate-desktop-service-type} adds the MATE metapackage to the system
18870 profile. ``Adding Enlightenment'' means that @code{dbus} is extended
18871 appropriately, and several of Enlightenment's binaries are set as setuid,
18872 allowing Enlightenment's screen locker and other functionality to work as
18873 expected.
18874
18875 The desktop environments in Guix use the Xorg display server by
18876 default. If you'd like to use the newer display server protocol
18877 called Wayland, you need to use the @code{sddm-service} instead of
18878 GDM as the graphical login manager. You should then
18879 select the ``GNOME (Wayland)'' session in SDDM@. Alternatively you can
18880 also try starting GNOME on Wayland manually from a TTY with the
18881 command ``XDG_SESSION_TYPE=wayland exec dbus-run-session
18882 gnome-session``. Currently only GNOME has support for Wayland.
18883
18884 @defvr {Scheme Variable} gnome-desktop-service-type
18885 This is the type of the service that adds the @uref{https://www.gnome.org,
18886 GNOME} desktop environment. Its value is a @code{gnome-desktop-configuration}
18887 object (see below).
18888
18889 This service adds the @code{gnome} package to the system profile, and extends
18890 polkit with the actions from @code{gnome-settings-daemon}.
18891 @end defvr
18892
18893 @deftp {Data Type} gnome-desktop-configuration
18894 Configuration record for the GNOME desktop environment.
18895
18896 @table @asis
18897 @item @code{gnome} (default: @code{gnome})
18898 The GNOME package to use.
18899 @end table
18900 @end deftp
18901
18902 @defvr {Scheme Variable} xfce-desktop-service-type
18903 This is the type of a service to run the @uref{Xfce, https://xfce.org/}
18904 desktop environment. Its value is an @code{xfce-desktop-configuration} object
18905 (see below).
18906
18907 This service adds the @code{xfce} package to the system profile, and
18908 extends polkit with the ability for @code{thunar} to manipulate the file
18909 system as root from within a user session, after the user has authenticated
18910 with the administrator's password.
18911
18912 Note that @code{xfce4-panel} and its plugin packages should be installed in
18913 the same profile to ensure compatibility. When using this service, you should
18914 add extra plugins (@code{xfce4-whiskermenu-plugin},
18915 @code{xfce4-weather-plugin}, etc.) to the @code{packages} field of your
18916 @code{operating-system}.
18917 @end defvr
18918
18919 @deftp {Data Type} xfce-desktop-configuration
18920 Configuration record for the Xfce desktop environment.
18921
18922 @table @asis
18923 @item @code{xfce} (default: @code{xfce})
18924 The Xfce package to use.
18925 @end table
18926 @end deftp
18927
18928 @deffn {Scheme Variable} mate-desktop-service-type
18929 This is the type of the service that runs the @uref{https://mate-desktop.org/,
18930 MATE desktop environment}. Its value is a @code{mate-desktop-configuration}
18931 object (see below).
18932
18933 This service adds the @code{mate} package to the system
18934 profile, and extends polkit with the actions from
18935 @code{mate-settings-daemon}.
18936 @end deffn
18937
18938 @deftp {Data Type} mate-desktop-configuration
18939 Configuration record for the MATE desktop environment.
18940
18941 @table @asis
18942 @item @code{mate} (default: @code{mate})
18943 The MATE package to use.
18944 @end table
18945 @end deftp
18946
18947 @deffn {Scheme Variable} lxqt-desktop-service-type
18948 This is the type of the service that runs the @uref{https://lxqt.github.io,
18949 LXQt desktop environment}. Its value is a @code{lxqt-desktop-configuration}
18950 object (see below).
18951
18952 This service adds the @code{lxqt} package to the system
18953 profile.
18954 @end deffn
18955
18956 @deftp {Data Type} lxqt-desktop-configuration
18957 Configuration record for the LXQt desktop environment.
18958
18959 @table @asis
18960 @item @code{lxqt} (default: @code{lxqt})
18961 The LXQT package to use.
18962 @end table
18963 @end deftp
18964
18965 @deffn {Scheme Variable} enlightenment-desktop-service-type
18966 Return a service that adds the @code{enlightenment} package to the system
18967 profile, and extends dbus with actions from @code{efl}.
18968 @end deffn
18969
18970 @deftp {Data Type} enlightenment-desktop-service-configuration
18971 @table @asis
18972 @item @code{enlightenment} (default: @code{enlightenment})
18973 The enlightenment package to use.
18974 @end table
18975 @end deftp
18976
18977 Because the GNOME, Xfce and MATE desktop services pull in so many packages,
18978 the default @code{%desktop-services} variable doesn't include any of
18979 them by default. To add GNOME, Xfce or MATE, just @code{cons} them onto
18980 @code{%desktop-services} in the @code{services} field of your
18981 @code{operating-system}:
18982
18983 @lisp
18984 (use-modules (gnu))
18985 (use-service-modules desktop)
18986 (operating-system
18987 ...
18988 ;; cons* adds items to the list given as its last argument.
18989 (services (cons* (service gnome-desktop-service-type)
18990 (service xfce-desktop-service)
18991 %desktop-services))
18992 ...)
18993 @end lisp
18994
18995 These desktop environments will then be available as options in the
18996 graphical login window.
18997
18998 The actual service definitions included in @code{%desktop-services} and
18999 provided by @code{(gnu services dbus)} and @code{(gnu services desktop)}
19000 are described below.
19001
19002 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} dbus-service [#:dbus @var{dbus}] [#:services '()]
19003 Return a service that runs the ``system bus'', using @var{dbus}, with
19004 support for @var{services}.
19005
19006 @uref{https://dbus.freedesktop.org/, D-Bus} is an inter-process communication
19007 facility. Its system bus is used to allow system services to communicate
19008 and to be notified of system-wide events.
19009
19010 @var{services} must be a list of packages that provide an
19011 @file{etc/dbus-1/system.d} directory containing additional D-Bus configuration
19012 and policy files. For example, to allow avahi-daemon to use the system bus,
19013 @var{services} must be equal to @code{(list avahi)}.
19014 @end deffn
19015
19016 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} elogind-service [#:config @var{config}]
19017 Return a service that runs the @code{elogind} login and
19018 seat management daemon. @uref{https://github.com/elogind/elogind,
19019 Elogind} exposes a D-Bus interface that can be used to know which users
19020 are logged in, know what kind of sessions they have open, suspend the
19021 system, inhibit system suspend, reboot the system, and other tasks.
19022
19023 Elogind handles most system-level power events for a computer, for
19024 example suspending the system when a lid is closed, or shutting it down
19025 when the power button is pressed.
19026
19027 The @var{config} keyword argument specifies the configuration for
19028 elogind, and should be the result of an @code{(elogind-configuration
19029 (@var{parameter} @var{value})...)} invocation. Available parameters and
19030 their default values are:
19031
19032 @table @code
19033 @item kill-user-processes?
19034 @code{#f}
19035 @item kill-only-users
19036 @code{()}
19037 @item kill-exclude-users
19038 @code{("root")}
19039 @item inhibit-delay-max-seconds
19040 @code{5}
19041 @item handle-power-key
19042 @code{poweroff}
19043 @item handle-suspend-key
19044 @code{suspend}
19045 @item handle-hibernate-key
19046 @code{hibernate}
19047 @item handle-lid-switch
19048 @code{suspend}
19049 @item handle-lid-switch-docked
19050 @code{ignore}
19051 @item handle-lid-switch-external-power
19052 @code{ignore}
19053 @item power-key-ignore-inhibited?
19054 @code{#f}
19055 @item suspend-key-ignore-inhibited?
19056 @code{#f}
19057 @item hibernate-key-ignore-inhibited?
19058 @code{#f}
19059 @item lid-switch-ignore-inhibited?
19060 @code{#t}
19061 @item holdoff-timeout-seconds
19062 @code{30}
19063 @item idle-action
19064 @code{ignore}
19065 @item idle-action-seconds
19066 @code{(* 30 60)}
19067 @item runtime-directory-size-percent
19068 @code{10}
19069 @item runtime-directory-size
19070 @code{#f}
19071 @item remove-ipc?
19072 @code{#t}
19073 @item suspend-state
19074 @code{("mem" "standby" "freeze")}
19075 @item suspend-mode
19076 @code{()}
19077 @item hibernate-state
19078 @code{("disk")}
19079 @item hibernate-mode
19080 @code{("platform" "shutdown")}
19081 @item hybrid-sleep-state
19082 @code{("disk")}
19083 @item hybrid-sleep-mode
19084 @code{("suspend" "platform" "shutdown")}
19085 @end table
19086 @end deffn
19087
19088 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} accountsservice-service @
19089 [#:accountsservice @var{accountsservice}]
19090 Return a service that runs AccountsService, a system service that can
19091 list available accounts, change their passwords, and so on.
19092 AccountsService integrates with PolicyKit to enable unprivileged users
19093 to acquire the capability to modify their system configuration.
19094 @uref{https://www.freedesktop.org/wiki/Software/AccountsService/, the
19095 accountsservice web site} for more information.
19096
19097 The @var{accountsservice} keyword argument is the @code{accountsservice}
19098 package to expose as a service.
19099 @end deffn
19100
19101 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} polkit-service @
19102 [#:polkit @var{polkit}]
19103 Return a service that runs the
19104 @uref{https://www.freedesktop.org/wiki/Software/polkit/, Polkit privilege
19105 management service}, which allows system administrators to grant access to
19106 privileged operations in a structured way. By querying the Polkit service, a
19107 privileged system component can know when it should grant additional
19108 capabilities to ordinary users. For example, an ordinary user can be granted
19109 the capability to suspend the system if the user is logged in locally.
19110 @end deffn
19111
19112 @defvr {Scheme Variable} polkit-wheel-service
19113 Service that adds the @code{wheel} group as admins to the Polkit
19114 service. This makes it so that users in the @code{wheel} group are queried
19115 for their own passwords when performing administrative actions instead of
19116 @code{root}'s, similar to the behaviour used by @code{sudo}.
19117 @end defvr
19118
19119 @defvr {Scheme Variable} upower-service-type
19120 Service that runs @uref{https://upower.freedesktop.org/, @command{upowerd}}, a
19121 system-wide monitor for power consumption and battery levels, with the given
19122 configuration settings.
19123
19124 It implements the @code{org.freedesktop.UPower} D-Bus interface, and is
19125 notably used by GNOME.
19126 @end defvr
19127
19128 @deftp {Data Type} upower-configuration
19129 Data type representation the configuration for UPower.
19130
19131 @table @asis
19132
19133 @item @code{upower} (default: @var{upower})
19134 Package to use for @code{upower}.
19135
19136 @item @code{watts-up-pro?} (default: @code{#f})
19137 Enable the Watts Up Pro device.
19138
19139 @item @code{poll-batteries?} (default: @code{#t})
19140 Enable polling the kernel for battery level changes.
19141
19142 @item @code{ignore-lid?} (default: @code{#f})
19143 Ignore the lid state, this can be useful if it's incorrect on a device.
19144
19145 @item @code{use-percentage-for-policy?} (default: @code{#f})
19146 Whether battery percentage based policy should be used. The default is to use
19147 the time left, change to @code{#t} to use the percentage.
19148
19149 @item @code{percentage-low} (default: @code{10})
19150 When @code{use-percentage-for-policy?} is @code{#t}, this sets the percentage
19151 at which the battery is considered low.
19152
19153 @item @code{percentage-critical} (default: @code{3})
19154 When @code{use-percentage-for-policy?} is @code{#t}, this sets the percentage
19155 at which the battery is considered critical.
19156
19157 @item @code{percentage-action} (default: @code{2})
19158 When @code{use-percentage-for-policy?} is @code{#t}, this sets the percentage
19159 at which action will be taken.
19160
19161 @item @code{time-low} (default: @code{1200})
19162 When @code{use-time-for-policy?} is @code{#f}, this sets the time remaining in
19163 seconds at which the battery is considered low.
19164
19165 @item @code{time-critical} (default: @code{300})
19166 When @code{use-time-for-policy?} is @code{#f}, this sets the time remaining in
19167 seconds at which the battery is considered critical.
19168
19169 @item @code{time-action} (default: @code{120})
19170 When @code{use-time-for-policy?} is @code{#f}, this sets the time remaining in
19171 seconds at which action will be taken.
19172
19173 @item @code{critical-power-action} (default: @code{'hybrid-sleep})
19174 The action taken when @code{percentage-action} or @code{time-action} is
19175 reached (depending on the configuration of @code{use-percentage-for-policy?}).
19176
19177 Possible values are:
19178
19179 @itemize @bullet
19180 @item
19181 @code{'power-off}
19182
19183 @item
19184 @code{'hibernate}
19185
19186 @item
19187 @code{'hybrid-sleep}.
19188 @end itemize
19189
19190 @end table
19191 @end deftp
19192
19193 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} udisks-service [#:udisks @var{udisks}]
19194 Return a service for @uref{https://udisks.freedesktop.org/docs/latest/,
19195 UDisks}, a @dfn{disk management} daemon that provides user interfaces
19196 with notifications and ways to mount/unmount disks. Programs that talk
19197 to UDisks include the @command{udisksctl} command, part of UDisks, and
19198 GNOME Disks. Note that Udisks relies on the @command{mount} command, so
19199 it will only be able to use the file-system utilities installed in the
19200 system profile. For example if you want to be able to mount NTFS
19201 file-systems in read and write fashion, you'll need to have
19202 @code{ntfs-3g} installed system-wide.
19203 @end deffn
19204
19205 @deffn {Scheme Variable} colord-service-type
19206 This is the type of the service that runs @command{colord}, a system
19207 service with a D-Bus
19208 interface to manage the color profiles of input and output devices such as
19209 screens and scanners. It is notably used by the GNOME Color Manager graphical
19210 tool. See @uref{https://www.freedesktop.org/software/colord/, the colord web
19211 site} for more information.
19212 @end deffn
19213
19214 @cindex scanner access
19215 @defvr {Scheme Variable} sane-service-type
19216 This service provides access to scanners @i{via}
19217 @uref{http://www.sane-project.org, SANE} by installing the necessary
19218 udev rules. It is included in @code{%desktop-services} (@pxref{Desktop
19219 Services}) and relies by default on @code{sane-backends-minimal} package
19220 (see below) for hardware support.
19221 @end defvr
19222
19223 @defvr {Scheme Variable} sane-backends-minimal
19224 The default package which the @code{sane-service-type} installs. It
19225 supports many recent scanners.
19226 @end defvr
19227
19228 @defvr {Scheme Variable} sane-backends
19229 This package includes support for all scanners that
19230 @code{sane-backends-minimal} supports, plus older Hewlett-Packard
19231 scanners supported by @code{hplip} package. In order to use this on
19232 a system which relies on @code{%desktop-services}, you may use
19233 @code{modify-services} (@pxref{Service Reference,
19234 @code{modify-services}}) as illustrated below:
19235
19236 @lisp
19237 (use-modules (gnu))
19238 (use-service-modules
19239 @dots{}
19240 desktop)
19241 (use-package-modules
19242 @dots{}
19243 scanner)
19244
19245 (define %my-desktop-services
19246 ;; List of desktop services that supports a broader range of scanners.
19247 (modify-services %desktop-services
19248 (sane-service-type _ => sane-backends)))
19249
19250 (operating-system
19251 @dots{}
19252 (services %my-desktop-services)
19253 @end lisp
19254 @end defvr
19255
19256 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} geoclue-application name [#:allowed? #t] [#:system? #f] [#:users '()]
19257 Return a configuration allowing an application to access GeoClue
19258 location data. @var{name} is the Desktop ID of the application, without
19259 the @code{.desktop} part. If @var{allowed?} is true, the application
19260 will have access to location information by default. The boolean
19261 @var{system?} value indicates whether an application is a system component
19262 or not. Finally @var{users} is a list of UIDs of all users for which
19263 this application is allowed location info access. An empty users list
19264 means that all users are allowed.
19265 @end deffn
19266
19267 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %standard-geoclue-applications
19268 The standard list of well-known GeoClue application configurations,
19269 granting authority to the GNOME date-and-time utility to ask for the
19270 current location in order to set the time zone, and allowing the
19271 IceCat and Epiphany web browsers to request location information.
19272 IceCat and Epiphany both query the user before allowing a web page to
19273 know the user's location.
19274 @end defvr
19275
19276 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} geoclue-service [#:colord @var{colord}] @
19277 [#:whitelist '()] @
19278 [#:wifi-geolocation-url "https://location.services.mozilla.com/v1/geolocate?key=geoclue"] @
19279 [#:submit-data? #f]
19280 [#:wifi-submission-url "https://location.services.mozilla.com/v1/submit?key=geoclue"] @
19281 [#:submission-nick "geoclue"] @
19282 [#:applications %standard-geoclue-applications]
19283 Return a service that runs the GeoClue location service. This service
19284 provides a D-Bus interface to allow applications to request access to a
19285 user's physical location, and optionally to add information to online
19286 location databases. See
19287 @uref{https://wiki.freedesktop.org/www/Software/GeoClue/, the GeoClue
19288 web site} for more information.
19289 @end deffn
19290
19291 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} bluetooth-service [#:bluez @var{bluez}] @
19292 [@w{#:auto-enable? #f}]
19293 Return a service that runs the @command{bluetoothd} daemon, which
19294 manages all the Bluetooth devices and provides a number of D-Bus
19295 interfaces. When AUTO-ENABLE? is true, the bluetooth controller is
19296 powered automatically at boot, which can be useful when using a
19297 bluetooth keyboard or mouse.
19298
19299 Users need to be in the @code{lp} group to access the D-Bus service.
19300 @end deffn
19301
19302 @defvr {Scheme Variable} gnome-keyring-service-type
19303 This is the type of the service that adds the
19304 @uref{https://wiki.gnome.org/Projects/GnomeKeyring, GNOME Keyring}. Its
19305 value is a @code{gnome-keyring-configuration} object (see below).
19306
19307 This service adds the @code{gnome-keyring} package to the system profile
19308 and extends PAM with entries using @code{pam_gnome_keyring.so}, unlocking
19309 a user's login keyring when they log in or setting its password with passwd.
19310 @end defvr
19311
19312 @deftp {Data Type} gnome-keyring-configuration
19313 Configuration record for the GNOME Keyring service.
19314
19315 @table @asis
19316 @item @code{keyring} (default: @code{gnome-keyring})
19317 The GNOME keyring package to use.
19318
19319 @item @code{pam-services}
19320 A list of @code{(@var{service} . @var{kind})} pairs denoting PAM
19321 services to extend, where @var{service} is the name of an existing
19322 service to extend and @var{kind} is one of @code{login} or
19323 @code{passwd}.
19324
19325 If @code{login} is given, it adds an optional
19326 @code{pam_gnome_keyring.so} to the auth block without arguments and to
19327 the session block with @code{auto_start}. If @code{passwd} is given, it
19328 adds an optional @code{pam_gnome_keyring.so} to the password block
19329 without arguments.
19330
19331 By default, this field contains ``gdm-password'' with the value @code{login}
19332 and ``passwd'' is with the value @code{passwd}.
19333 @end table
19334 @end deftp
19335
19336
19337 @node Sound Services
19338 @subsection Sound Services
19339
19340 @cindex sound support
19341 @cindex ALSA
19342 @cindex PulseAudio, sound support
19343
19344 The @code{(gnu services sound)} module provides a service to configure the
19345 Advanced Linux Sound Architecture (ALSA) system, which makes PulseAudio the
19346 preferred ALSA output driver.
19347
19348 @deffn {Scheme Variable} alsa-service-type
19349 This is the type for the @uref{https://alsa-project.org/, Advanced Linux Sound
19350 Architecture} (ALSA) system, which generates the @file{/etc/asound.conf}
19351 configuration file. The value for this type is a @command{alsa-configuration}
19352 record as in this example:
19353
19354 @lisp
19355 (service alsa-service-type)
19356 @end lisp
19357
19358 See below for details about @code{alsa-configuration}.
19359 @end deffn
19360
19361 @deftp {Data Type} alsa-configuration
19362 Data type representing the configuration for @code{alsa-service}.
19363
19364 @table @asis
19365 @item @code{alsa-plugins} (default: @var{alsa-plugins})
19366 @code{alsa-plugins} package to use.
19367
19368 @item @code{pulseaudio?} (default: @var{#t})
19369 Whether ALSA applications should transparently be made to use the
19370 @uref{https://www.pulseaudio.org/, PulseAudio} sound server.
19371
19372 Using PulseAudio allows you to run several sound-producing applications
19373 at the same time and to individual control them @i{via}
19374 @command{pavucontrol}, among other things.
19375
19376 @item @code{extra-options} (default: @var{""})
19377 String to append to the @file{/etc/asound.conf} file.
19378
19379 @end table
19380 @end deftp
19381
19382 Individual users who want to override the system configuration of ALSA can do
19383 it with the @file{~/.asoundrc} file:
19384
19385 @example
19386 # In guix, we have to specify the absolute path for plugins.
19387 pcm_type.jack @{
19388 lib "/home/alice/.guix-profile/lib/alsa-lib/libasound_module_pcm_jack.so"
19389 @}
19390
19391 # Routing ALSA to jack:
19392 # <http://jackaudio.org/faq/routing_alsa.html>.
19393 pcm.rawjack @{
19394 type jack
19395 playback_ports @{
19396 0 system:playback_1
19397 1 system:playback_2
19398 @}
19399
19400 capture_ports @{
19401 0 system:capture_1
19402 1 system:capture_2
19403 @}
19404 @}
19405
19406 pcm.!default @{
19407 type plug
19408 slave @{
19409 pcm "rawjack"
19410 @}
19411 @}
19412 @end example
19413
19414 See @uref{https://www.alsa-project.org/main/index.php/Asoundrc} for the
19415 details.
19416
19417 @deffn {Scheme Variable} pulseaudio-service-type
19418 This is the type for the @uref{https://www.pulseaudio.org/, PulseAudio}
19419 sound server. It exists to allow system overrides of the default settings
19420 via @code{pulseaudio-configuration}, see below.
19421
19422 @quotation Warning
19423 This service overrides per-user configuration files. If you want
19424 PulseAudio to honor configuration files in @file{~/.config/pulse} you
19425 have to unset the environment variables @env{PULSE_CONFIG} and
19426 @env{PULSE_CLIENTCONFIG} in your @file{~/.bash_profile}.
19427 @end quotation
19428
19429 @quotation Warning
19430 This service on its own does not ensure, that the @code{pulseaudio} package
19431 exists on your machine. It merely adds configuration files for it, as
19432 detailed below. In the (admittedly unlikely) case, that you find yourself
19433 without a @code{pulseaudio} package, consider enabling it through the
19434 @code{alsa-service-type} above.
19435 @end quotation
19436 @end deffn
19437
19438 @deftp {Data Type} pulseaudio-configuration
19439 Data type representing the configuration for @code{pulseaudio-service}.
19440
19441 @table @asis
19442 @item @code{client-conf} (default: @code{'()})
19443 List of settings to set in @file{client.conf}.
19444 Accepts a list of strings or a symbol-value pairs. A string will be
19445 inserted as-is with a newline added. A pair will be formatted as
19446 ``key = value'', again with a newline added.
19447
19448 @item @code{daemon-conf} (default: @code{'((flat-volumes . no))})
19449 List of settings to set in @file{daemon.conf}, formatted just like
19450 @var{client-conf}.
19451
19452 @item @code{script-file} (default: @code{(file-append pulseaudio "/etc/pulse/default.pa")})
19453 Script file to use as @file{default.pa}.
19454
19455 @item @code{system-script-file} (default: @code{(file-append pulseaudio "/etc/pulse/system.pa")})
19456 Script file to use as @file{system.pa}.
19457 @end table
19458 @end deftp
19459
19460 @deffn {Scheme Variable} ladspa-service-type
19461 This service sets the @var{LADSPA_PATH} variable, so that programs, which
19462 respect it, e.g. PulseAudio, can load LADSPA plugins.
19463
19464 The following example will setup the service to enable modules from the
19465 @code{swh-plugins} package:
19466
19467 @lisp
19468 (service ladspa-service-type
19469 (ladspa-configuration (plugins (list swh-plugins))))
19470 @end lisp
19471
19472 See @uref{http://plugin.org.uk/ladspa-swh/docs/ladspa-swh.html} for the
19473 details.
19474
19475 @end deffn
19476
19477 @node Database Services
19478 @subsection Database Services
19479
19480 @cindex database
19481 @cindex SQL
19482 The @code{(gnu services databases)} module provides the following services.
19483
19484 @subsubheading PostgreSQL
19485
19486 The following example describes a PostgreSQL service with the default
19487 configuration.
19488
19489 @lisp
19490 (service postgresql-service-type
19491 (postgresql-configuration
19492 (postgresql postgresql-10)))
19493 @end lisp
19494
19495 If the services fails to start, it may be due to an incompatible
19496 cluster already present in @var{data-directory}. Adjust it (or, if you
19497 don't need the cluster anymore, delete @var{data-directory}), then
19498 restart the service.
19499
19500 Peer authentication is used by default and the @code{postgres} user
19501 account has no shell, which prevents the direct execution of @code{psql}
19502 commands as this user. To use @code{psql}, you can temporarily log in
19503 as @code{postgres} using a shell, create a PostgreSQL superuser with the
19504 same name as one of the system users and then create the associated
19505 database.
19506
19507 @example
19508 sudo -u postgres -s /bin/sh
19509 createuser --interactive
19510 createdb $MY_USER_LOGIN # Replace appropriately.
19511 @end example
19512
19513 @deftp {Data Type} postgresql-configuration
19514 Data type representing the configuration for the
19515 @code{postgresql-service-type}.
19516
19517 @table @asis
19518 @item @code{postgresql}
19519 PostgreSQL package to use for the service.
19520
19521 @item @code{port} (default: @code{5432})
19522 Port on which PostgreSQL should listen.
19523
19524 @item @code{locale} (default: @code{"en_US.utf8"})
19525 Locale to use as the default when creating the database cluster.
19526
19527 @item @code{config-file} (default: @code{(postgresql-config-file)})
19528 The configuration file to use when running PostgreSQL@. The default
19529 behaviour uses the postgresql-config-file record with the default values
19530 for the fields.
19531
19532 @item @code{log-directory} (default: @code{"/var/log/postgresql"})
19533 The directory where @command{pg_ctl} output will be written in a file
19534 named @code{"pg_ctl.log"}. This file can be useful to debug PostgreSQL
19535 configuration errors for instance.
19536
19537 @item @code{data-directory} (default: @code{"/var/lib/postgresql/data"})
19538 Directory in which to store the data.
19539
19540 @item @code{extension-packages} (default: @code{'()})
19541 @cindex postgresql extension-packages
19542 Additional extensions are loaded from packages listed in
19543 @var{extension-packages}. Extensions are available at runtime. For instance,
19544 to create a geographic database using the @code{postgis} extension, a user can
19545 configure the postgresql-service as in this example:
19546
19547 @cindex postgis
19548 @lisp
19549 (use-package-modules databases geo)
19550
19551 (operating-system
19552 ...
19553 ;; postgresql is required to run `psql' but postgis is not required for
19554 ;; proper operation.
19555 (packages (cons* postgresql %base-packages))
19556 (services
19557 (cons*
19558 (service postgresql-service-type
19559 (postgresql-configuration
19560 (postgresql postgresql-10)
19561 (extension-packages (list postgis))))
19562 %base-services)))
19563 @end lisp
19564
19565 Then the extension becomes visible and you can initialise an empty geographic
19566 database in this way:
19567
19568 @example
19569 psql -U postgres
19570 > create database postgistest;
19571 > \connect postgistest;
19572 > create extension postgis;
19573 > create extension postgis_topology;
19574 @end example
19575
19576 There is no need to add this field for contrib extensions such as hstore or
19577 dblink as they are already loadable by postgresql. This field is only
19578 required to add extensions provided by other packages.
19579
19580 @end table
19581 @end deftp
19582
19583 @deftp {Data Type} postgresql-config-file
19584 Data type representing the PostgreSQL configuration file. As shown in
19585 the following example, this can be used to customize the configuration
19586 of PostgreSQL@. Note that you can use any G-expression or filename in
19587 place of this record, if you already have a configuration file you'd
19588 like to use for example.
19589
19590 @lisp
19591 (service postgresql-service-type
19592 (postgresql-configuration
19593 (config-file
19594 (postgresql-config-file
19595 (log-destination "stderr")
19596 (hba-file
19597 (plain-file "pg_hba.conf"
19598 "
19599 local all all trust
19600 host all all 127.0.0.1/32 md5
19601 host all all ::1/128 md5"))
19602 (extra-config
19603 '(("session_preload_libraries" "auto_explain")
19604 ("random_page_cost" 2)
19605 ("auto_explain.log_min_duration" "100 ms")
19606 ("work_mem" "500 MB")
19607 ("logging_collector" #t)
19608 ("log_directory" "/var/log/postgresql")))))))
19609 @end lisp
19610
19611 @table @asis
19612 @item @code{log-destination} (default: @code{"syslog"})
19613 The logging method to use for PostgreSQL@. Multiple values are accepted,
19614 separated by commas.
19615
19616 @item @code{hba-file} (default: @code{%default-postgres-hba})
19617 Filename or G-expression for the host-based authentication
19618 configuration.
19619
19620 @item @code{ident-file} (default: @code{%default-postgres-ident})
19621 Filename or G-expression for the user name mapping configuration.
19622
19623 @item @code{socket-directory} (default: @code{"/var/run/postgresql"})
19624 Specifies the directory of the Unix-domain socket(s) on which PostgreSQL
19625 is to listen for connections from client applications. If set to
19626 @code{#false} PostgreSQL does not listen on any Unix-domain sockets, in
19627 which case only TCP/IP sockets can be used to connect to the server.
19628
19629 @item @code{extra-config} (default: @code{'()})
19630 List of additional keys and values to include in the PostgreSQL config
19631 file. Each entry in the list should be a list where the first element
19632 is the key, and the remaining elements are the values.
19633
19634 The values can be numbers, booleans or strings and will be mapped to
19635 PostgreSQL parameters types @code{Boolean}, @code{String},
19636 @code{Numeric}, @code{Numeric with Unit} and @code{Enumerated} described
19637 @uref{https://www.postgresql.org/docs/current/config-setting.html,
19638 here}.
19639
19640 @end table
19641 @end deftp
19642
19643 @deffn {Scheme Variable} postgresql-role-service-type
19644 This service allows to create PostgreSQL roles and databases after
19645 PostgreSQL service start. Here is an example of its use.
19646
19647 @lisp
19648 (service postgresql-role-service-type
19649 (postgresql-role-configuration
19650 (roles
19651 (list (postgresql-role
19652 (name "test")
19653 (create-database? #t))))))
19654 @end lisp
19655
19656 This service can be extended with extra roles, as in this
19657 example:
19658
19659 @lisp
19660 (service-extension postgresql-role-service-type
19661 (const (postgresql-role
19662 (name "alice")
19663 (create-database? #t))))
19664 @end lisp
19665 @end deffn
19666
19667 @deftp {Data Type} postgresql-role
19668 PostgreSQL manages database access permissions using the concept of
19669 roles. A role can be thought of as either a database user, or a group
19670 of database users, depending on how the role is set up. Roles can own
19671 database objects (for example, tables) and can assign privileges on
19672 those objects to other roles to control who has access to which objects.
19673
19674 @table @asis
19675 @item @code{name}
19676 The role name.
19677
19678 @item @code{permissions} (default: @code{'(createdb login)})
19679 The role permissions list. Supported permissions are @code{bypassrls},
19680 @code{createdb}, @code{createrole}, @code{login}, @code{replication} and
19681 @code{superuser}.
19682
19683 @item @code{create-database?} (default: @code{#f})
19684 Whether to create a database with the same name as the role.
19685
19686 @end table
19687 @end deftp
19688
19689 @deftp {Data Type} postgresql-role-configuration
19690 Data type representing the configuration of
19691 @var{postgresql-role-service-type}.
19692
19693 @table @asis
19694 @item @code{host} (default: @code{"/var/run/postgresql"})
19695 The PostgreSQL host to connect to.
19696
19697 @item @code{log} (default: @code{"/var/log/postgresql_roles.log"})
19698 File name of the log file.
19699
19700 @item @code{roles} (default: @code{'()})
19701 The initial PostgreSQL roles to create.
19702 @end table
19703 @end deftp
19704
19705 @subsubheading MariaDB/MySQL
19706
19707 @defvr {Scheme Variable} mysql-service-type
19708 This is the service type for a MySQL or MariaDB database server. Its value
19709 is a @code{mysql-configuration} object that specifies which package to use,
19710 as well as various settings for the @command{mysqld} daemon.
19711 @end defvr
19712
19713 @deftp {Data Type} mysql-configuration
19714 Data type representing the configuration of @var{mysql-service-type}.
19715
19716 @table @asis
19717 @item @code{mysql} (default: @var{mariadb})
19718 Package object of the MySQL database server, can be either @var{mariadb}
19719 or @var{mysql}.
19720
19721 For MySQL, a temporary root password will be displayed at activation time.
19722 For MariaDB, the root password is empty.
19723
19724 @item @code{bind-address} (default: @code{"127.0.0.1"})
19725 The IP on which to listen for network connections. Use @code{"0.0.0.0"}
19726 to bind to all available network interfaces.
19727
19728 @item @code{port} (default: @code{3306})
19729 TCP port on which the database server listens for incoming connections.
19730
19731 @item @code{socket} (default: @code{"/run/mysqld/mysqld.sock"})
19732 Socket file to use for local (non-network) connections.
19733
19734 @item @code{extra-content} (default: @code{""})
19735 Additional settings for the @file{my.cnf} configuration file.
19736
19737 @item @code{auto-upgrade?} (default: @code{#t})
19738 Whether to automatically run @command{mysql_upgrade} after starting the
19739 service. This is necessary to upgrade the @dfn{system schema} after
19740 ``major'' updates (such as switching from MariaDB 10.4 to 10.5), but can
19741 be disabled if you would rather do that manually.
19742
19743 @end table
19744 @end deftp
19745
19746 @subsubheading Memcached
19747
19748 @defvr {Scheme Variable} memcached-service-type
19749 This is the service type for the @uref{https://memcached.org/,
19750 Memcached} service, which provides a distributed in memory cache. The
19751 value for the service type is a @code{memcached-configuration} object.
19752 @end defvr
19753
19754 @lisp
19755 (service memcached-service-type)
19756 @end lisp
19757
19758 @deftp {Data Type} memcached-configuration
19759 Data type representing the configuration of memcached.
19760
19761 @table @asis
19762 @item @code{memcached} (default: @code{memcached})
19763 The Memcached package to use.
19764
19765 @item @code{interfaces} (default: @code{'("0.0.0.0")})
19766 Network interfaces on which to listen.
19767
19768 @item @code{tcp-port} (default: @code{11211})
19769 Port on which to accept connections.
19770
19771 @item @code{udp-port} (default: @code{11211})
19772 Port on which to accept UDP connections on, a value of 0 will disable
19773 listening on a UDP socket.
19774
19775 @item @code{additional-options} (default: @code{'()})
19776 Additional command line options to pass to @code{memcached}.
19777 @end table
19778 @end deftp
19779
19780 @subsubheading MongoDB
19781
19782 @defvr {Scheme Variable} mongodb-service-type
19783 This is the service type for @uref{https://www.mongodb.com/, MongoDB}.
19784 The value for the service type is a @code{mongodb-configuration} object.
19785 @end defvr
19786
19787 @lisp
19788 (service mongodb-service-type)
19789 @end lisp
19790
19791 @deftp {Data Type} mongodb-configuration
19792 Data type representing the configuration of mongodb.
19793
19794 @table @asis
19795 @item @code{mongodb} (default: @code{mongodb})
19796 The MongoDB package to use.
19797
19798 @item @code{config-file} (default: @code{%default-mongodb-configuration-file})
19799 The configuration file for MongoDB.
19800
19801 @item @code{data-directory} (default: @code{"/var/lib/mongodb"})
19802 This value is used to create the directory, so that it exists and is
19803 owned by the mongodb user. It should match the data-directory which
19804 MongoDB is configured to use through the configuration file.
19805 @end table
19806 @end deftp
19807
19808 @subsubheading Redis
19809
19810 @defvr {Scheme Variable} redis-service-type
19811 This is the service type for the @uref{https://redis.io/, Redis}
19812 key/value store, whose value is a @code{redis-configuration} object.
19813 @end defvr
19814
19815 @deftp {Data Type} redis-configuration
19816 Data type representing the configuration of redis.
19817
19818 @table @asis
19819 @item @code{redis} (default: @code{redis})
19820 The Redis package to use.
19821
19822 @item @code{bind} (default: @code{"127.0.0.1"})
19823 Network interface on which to listen.
19824
19825 @item @code{port} (default: @code{6379})
19826 Port on which to accept connections on, a value of 0 will disable
19827 listening on a TCP socket.
19828
19829 @item @code{working-directory} (default: @code{"/var/lib/redis"})
19830 Directory in which to store the database and related files.
19831 @end table
19832 @end deftp
19833
19834 @node Mail Services
19835 @subsection Mail Services
19836
19837 @cindex mail
19838 @cindex email
19839 The @code{(gnu services mail)} module provides Guix service definitions
19840 for email services: IMAP, POP3, and LMTP servers, as well as mail
19841 transport agents (MTAs). Lots of acronyms! These services are detailed
19842 in the subsections below.
19843
19844 @subsubheading Dovecot Service
19845
19846 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} dovecot-service [#:config (dovecot-configuration)]
19847 Return a service that runs the Dovecot IMAP/POP3/LMTP mail server.
19848 @end deffn
19849
19850 By default, Dovecot does not need much configuration; the default
19851 configuration object created by @code{(dovecot-configuration)} will
19852 suffice if your mail is delivered to @code{~/Maildir}. A self-signed
19853 certificate will be generated for TLS-protected connections, though
19854 Dovecot will also listen on cleartext ports by default. There are a
19855 number of options, though, which mail administrators might need to change,
19856 and as is the case with other services, Guix allows the system
19857 administrator to specify these parameters via a uniform Scheme interface.
19858
19859 For example, to specify that mail is located at @code{maildir~/.mail},
19860 one would instantiate the Dovecot service like this:
19861
19862 @lisp
19863 (dovecot-service #:config
19864 (dovecot-configuration
19865 (mail-location "maildir:~/.mail")))
19866 @end lisp
19867
19868 The available configuration parameters follow. Each parameter
19869 definition is preceded by its type; for example, @samp{string-list foo}
19870 indicates that the @code{foo} parameter should be specified as a list of
19871 strings. There is also a way to specify the configuration as a string,
19872 if you have an old @code{dovecot.conf} file that you want to port over
19873 from some other system; see the end for more details.
19874
19875 @c The following documentation was initially generated by
19876 @c (generate-documentation) in (gnu services mail). Manually maintained
19877 @c documentation is better, so we shouldn't hesitate to edit below as
19878 @c needed. However if the change you want to make to this documentation
19879 @c can be done in an automated way, it's probably easier to change
19880 @c (generate-documentation) than to make it below and have to deal with
19881 @c the churn as dovecot updates.
19882
19883 Available @code{dovecot-configuration} fields are:
19884
19885 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} package dovecot
19886 The dovecot package.
19887 @end deftypevr
19888
19889 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} comma-separated-string-list listen
19890 A list of IPs or hosts where to listen for connections. @samp{*}
19891 listens on all IPv4 interfaces, @samp{::} listens on all IPv6
19892 interfaces. If you want to specify non-default ports or anything more
19893 complex, customize the address and port fields of the
19894 @samp{inet-listener} of the specific services you are interested in.
19895 @end deftypevr
19896
19897 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} protocol-configuration-list protocols
19898 List of protocols we want to serve. Available protocols include
19899 @samp{imap}, @samp{pop3}, and @samp{lmtp}.
19900
19901 Available @code{protocol-configuration} fields are:
19902
19903 @deftypevr {@code{protocol-configuration} parameter} string name
19904 The name of the protocol.
19905 @end deftypevr
19906
19907 @deftypevr {@code{protocol-configuration} parameter} string auth-socket-path
19908 UNIX socket path to the master authentication server to find users.
19909 This is used by imap (for shared users) and lda.
19910 It defaults to @samp{"/var/run/dovecot/auth-userdb"}.
19911 @end deftypevr
19912
19913 @deftypevr {@code{protocol-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list mail-plugins
19914 Space separated list of plugins to load.
19915 @end deftypevr
19916
19917 @deftypevr {@code{protocol-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer mail-max-userip-connections
19918 Maximum number of IMAP connections allowed for a user from each IP
19919 address. NOTE: The username is compared case-sensitively.
19920 Defaults to @samp{10}.
19921 @end deftypevr
19922
19923 @end deftypevr
19924
19925 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} service-configuration-list services
19926 List of services to enable. Available services include @samp{imap},
19927 @samp{imap-login}, @samp{pop3}, @samp{pop3-login}, @samp{auth}, and
19928 @samp{lmtp}.
19929
19930 Available @code{service-configuration} fields are:
19931
19932 @deftypevr {@code{service-configuration} parameter} string kind
19933 The service kind. Valid values include @code{director},
19934 @code{imap-login}, @code{pop3-login}, @code{lmtp}, @code{imap},
19935 @code{pop3}, @code{auth}, @code{auth-worker}, @code{dict},
19936 @code{tcpwrap}, @code{quota-warning}, or anything else.
19937 @end deftypevr
19938
19939 @deftypevr {@code{service-configuration} parameter} listener-configuration-list listeners
19940 Listeners for the service. A listener is either a
19941 @code{unix-listener-configuration}, a @code{fifo-listener-configuration}, or
19942 an @code{inet-listener-configuration}.
19943 Defaults to @samp{()}.
19944
19945 Available @code{unix-listener-configuration} fields are:
19946
19947 @deftypevr {@code{unix-listener-configuration} parameter} string path
19948 Path to the file, relative to @code{base-dir} field. This is also used as
19949 the section name.
19950 @end deftypevr
19951
19952 @deftypevr {@code{unix-listener-configuration} parameter} string mode
19953 The access mode for the socket.
19954 Defaults to @samp{"0600"}.
19955 @end deftypevr
19956
19957 @deftypevr {@code{unix-listener-configuration} parameter} string user
19958 The user to own the socket.
19959 Defaults to @samp{""}.
19960 @end deftypevr
19961
19962 @deftypevr {@code{unix-listener-configuration} parameter} string group
19963 The group to own the socket.
19964 Defaults to @samp{""}.
19965 @end deftypevr
19966
19967
19968 Available @code{fifo-listener-configuration} fields are:
19969
19970 @deftypevr {@code{fifo-listener-configuration} parameter} string path
19971 Path to the file, relative to @code{base-dir} field. This is also used as
19972 the section name.
19973 @end deftypevr
19974
19975 @deftypevr {@code{fifo-listener-configuration} parameter} string mode
19976 The access mode for the socket.
19977 Defaults to @samp{"0600"}.
19978 @end deftypevr
19979
19980 @deftypevr {@code{fifo-listener-configuration} parameter} string user
19981 The user to own the socket.
19982 Defaults to @samp{""}.
19983 @end deftypevr
19984
19985 @deftypevr {@code{fifo-listener-configuration} parameter} string group
19986 The group to own the socket.
19987 Defaults to @samp{""}.
19988 @end deftypevr
19989
19990
19991 Available @code{inet-listener-configuration} fields are:
19992
19993 @deftypevr {@code{inet-listener-configuration} parameter} string protocol
19994 The protocol to listen for.
19995 @end deftypevr
19996
19997 @deftypevr {@code{inet-listener-configuration} parameter} string address
19998 The address on which to listen, or empty for all addresses.
19999 Defaults to @samp{""}.
20000 @end deftypevr
20001
20002 @deftypevr {@code{inet-listener-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer port
20003 The port on which to listen.
20004 @end deftypevr
20005
20006 @deftypevr {@code{inet-listener-configuration} parameter} boolean ssl?
20007 Whether to use SSL for this service; @samp{yes}, @samp{no}, or
20008 @samp{required}.
20009 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
20010 @end deftypevr
20011
20012 @end deftypevr
20013
20014 @deftypevr {@code{service-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer client-limit
20015 Maximum number of simultaneous client connections per process. Once
20016 this number of connections is received, the next incoming connection
20017 will prompt Dovecot to spawn another process. If set to 0,
20018 @code{default-client-limit} is used instead.
20019
20020 Defaults to @samp{0}.
20021
20022 @end deftypevr
20023
20024 @deftypevr {@code{service-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer service-count
20025 Number of connections to handle before starting a new process.
20026 Typically the only useful values are 0 (unlimited) or 1. 1 is more
20027 secure, but 0 is faster. <doc/wiki/LoginProcess.txt>.
20028 Defaults to @samp{1}.
20029
20030 @end deftypevr
20031
20032 @deftypevr {@code{service-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer process-limit
20033 Maximum number of processes that can exist for this service. If set to
20034 0, @code{default-process-limit} is used instead.
20035
20036 Defaults to @samp{0}.
20037
20038 @end deftypevr
20039
20040 @deftypevr {@code{service-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer process-min-avail
20041 Number of processes to always keep waiting for more connections.
20042 Defaults to @samp{0}.
20043 @end deftypevr
20044
20045 @deftypevr {@code{service-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer vsz-limit
20046 If you set @samp{service-count 0}, you probably need to grow
20047 this.
20048 Defaults to @samp{256000000}.
20049 @end deftypevr
20050
20051 @end deftypevr
20052
20053 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} dict-configuration dict
20054 Dict configuration, as created by the @code{dict-configuration}
20055 constructor.
20056
20057 Available @code{dict-configuration} fields are:
20058
20059 @deftypevr {@code{dict-configuration} parameter} free-form-fields entries
20060 A list of key-value pairs that this dict should hold.
20061 Defaults to @samp{()}.
20062 @end deftypevr
20063
20064 @end deftypevr
20065
20066 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} passdb-configuration-list passdbs
20067 A list of passdb configurations, each one created by the
20068 @code{passdb-configuration} constructor.
20069
20070 Available @code{passdb-configuration} fields are:
20071
20072 @deftypevr {@code{passdb-configuration} parameter} string driver
20073 The driver that the passdb should use. Valid values include
20074 @samp{pam}, @samp{passwd}, @samp{shadow}, @samp{bsdauth}, and
20075 @samp{static}.
20076 Defaults to @samp{"pam"}.
20077 @end deftypevr
20078
20079 @deftypevr {@code{passdb-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list args
20080 Space separated list of arguments to the passdb driver.
20081 Defaults to @samp{""}.
20082 @end deftypevr
20083
20084 @end deftypevr
20085
20086 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} userdb-configuration-list userdbs
20087 List of userdb configurations, each one created by the
20088 @code{userdb-configuration} constructor.
20089
20090 Available @code{userdb-configuration} fields are:
20091
20092 @deftypevr {@code{userdb-configuration} parameter} string driver
20093 The driver that the userdb should use. Valid values include
20094 @samp{passwd} and @samp{static}.
20095 Defaults to @samp{"passwd"}.
20096 @end deftypevr
20097
20098 @deftypevr {@code{userdb-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list args
20099 Space separated list of arguments to the userdb driver.
20100 Defaults to @samp{""}.
20101 @end deftypevr
20102
20103 @deftypevr {@code{userdb-configuration} parameter} free-form-args override-fields
20104 Override fields from passwd.
20105 Defaults to @samp{()}.
20106 @end deftypevr
20107
20108 @end deftypevr
20109
20110 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} plugin-configuration plugin-configuration
20111 Plug-in configuration, created by the @code{plugin-configuration}
20112 constructor.
20113 @end deftypevr
20114
20115 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} list-of-namespace-configuration namespaces
20116 List of namespaces. Each item in the list is created by the
20117 @code{namespace-configuration} constructor.
20118
20119 Available @code{namespace-configuration} fields are:
20120
20121 @deftypevr {@code{namespace-configuration} parameter} string name
20122 Name for this namespace.
20123 @end deftypevr
20124
20125 @deftypevr {@code{namespace-configuration} parameter} string type
20126 Namespace type: @samp{private}, @samp{shared} or @samp{public}.
20127 Defaults to @samp{"private"}.
20128 @end deftypevr
20129
20130 @deftypevr {@code{namespace-configuration} parameter} string separator
20131 Hierarchy separator to use. You should use the same separator for
20132 all namespaces or some clients get confused. @samp{/} is usually a good
20133 one. The default however depends on the underlying mail storage
20134 format.
20135 Defaults to @samp{""}.
20136 @end deftypevr
20137
20138 @deftypevr {@code{namespace-configuration} parameter} string prefix
20139 Prefix required to access this namespace. This needs to be
20140 different for all namespaces. For example @samp{Public/}.
20141 Defaults to @samp{""}.
20142 @end deftypevr
20143
20144 @deftypevr {@code{namespace-configuration} parameter} string location
20145 Physical location of the mailbox. This is in the same format as
20146 mail_location, which is also the default for it.
20147 Defaults to @samp{""}.
20148 @end deftypevr
20149
20150 @deftypevr {@code{namespace-configuration} parameter} boolean inbox?
20151 There can be only one INBOX, and this setting defines which
20152 namespace has it.
20153 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
20154 @end deftypevr
20155
20156 @deftypevr {@code{namespace-configuration} parameter} boolean hidden?
20157 If namespace is hidden, it's not advertised to clients via NAMESPACE
20158 extension. You'll most likely also want to set @samp{list? #f}. This is mostly
20159 useful when converting from another server with different namespaces
20160 which you want to deprecate but still keep working. For example you can
20161 create hidden namespaces with prefixes @samp{~/mail/}, @samp{~%u/mail/}
20162 and @samp{mail/}.
20163 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
20164 @end deftypevr
20165
20166 @deftypevr {@code{namespace-configuration} parameter} boolean list?
20167 Show the mailboxes under this namespace with the LIST command. This
20168 makes the namespace visible for clients that do not support the NAMESPACE
20169 extension. The special @code{children} value lists child mailboxes, but
20170 hides the namespace prefix.
20171 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
20172 @end deftypevr
20173
20174 @deftypevr {@code{namespace-configuration} parameter} boolean subscriptions?
20175 Namespace handles its own subscriptions. If set to @code{#f}, the
20176 parent namespace handles them. The empty prefix should always have this
20177 as @code{#t}).
20178 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
20179 @end deftypevr
20180
20181 @deftypevr {@code{namespace-configuration} parameter} mailbox-configuration-list mailboxes
20182 List of predefined mailboxes in this namespace.
20183 Defaults to @samp{()}.
20184
20185 Available @code{mailbox-configuration} fields are:
20186
20187 @deftypevr {@code{mailbox-configuration} parameter} string name
20188 Name for this mailbox.
20189 @end deftypevr
20190
20191 @deftypevr {@code{mailbox-configuration} parameter} string auto
20192 @samp{create} will automatically create this mailbox.
20193 @samp{subscribe} will both create and subscribe to the mailbox.
20194 Defaults to @samp{"no"}.
20195 @end deftypevr
20196
20197 @deftypevr {@code{mailbox-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list special-use
20198 List of IMAP @code{SPECIAL-USE} attributes as specified by RFC 6154.
20199 Valid values are @code{\All}, @code{\Archive}, @code{\Drafts},
20200 @code{\Flagged}, @code{\Junk}, @code{\Sent}, and @code{\Trash}.
20201 Defaults to @samp{()}.
20202 @end deftypevr
20203
20204 @end deftypevr
20205
20206 @end deftypevr
20207
20208 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} file-name base-dir
20209 Base directory where to store runtime data.
20210 Defaults to @samp{"/var/run/dovecot/"}.
20211 @end deftypevr
20212
20213 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string login-greeting
20214 Greeting message for clients.
20215 Defaults to @samp{"Dovecot ready."}.
20216 @end deftypevr
20217
20218 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list login-trusted-networks
20219 List of trusted network ranges. Connections from these IPs are
20220 allowed to override their IP addresses and ports (for logging and for
20221 authentication checks). @samp{disable-plaintext-auth} is also ignored
20222 for these networks. Typically you would specify your IMAP proxy servers
20223 here.
20224 Defaults to @samp{()}.
20225 @end deftypevr
20226
20227 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list login-access-sockets
20228 List of login access check sockets (e.g.@: tcpwrap).
20229 Defaults to @samp{()}.
20230 @end deftypevr
20231
20232 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean verbose-proctitle?
20233 Show more verbose process titles (in ps). Currently shows user name
20234 and IP address. Useful for seeing who is actually using the IMAP
20235 processes (e.g.@: shared mailboxes or if the same uid is used for multiple
20236 accounts).
20237 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
20238 @end deftypevr
20239
20240 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean shutdown-clients?
20241 Should all processes be killed when Dovecot master process shuts down.
20242 Setting this to @code{#f} means that Dovecot can be upgraded without
20243 forcing existing client connections to close (although that could also
20244 be a problem if the upgrade is e.g.@: due to a security fix).
20245 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
20246 @end deftypevr
20247
20248 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer doveadm-worker-count
20249 If non-zero, run mail commands via this many connections to doveadm
20250 server, instead of running them directly in the same process.
20251 Defaults to @samp{0}.
20252 @end deftypevr
20253
20254 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string doveadm-socket-path
20255 UNIX socket or host:port used for connecting to doveadm server.
20256 Defaults to @samp{"doveadm-server"}.
20257 @end deftypevr
20258
20259 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list import-environment
20260 List of environment variables that are preserved on Dovecot startup
20261 and passed down to all of its child processes. You can also give
20262 key=value pairs to always set specific settings.
20263 @end deftypevr
20264
20265 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean disable-plaintext-auth?
20266 Disable LOGIN command and all other plaintext authentications unless
20267 SSL/TLS is used (LOGINDISABLED capability). Note that if the remote IP
20268 matches the local IP (i.e.@: you're connecting from the same computer),
20269 the connection is considered secure and plaintext authentication is
20270 allowed. See also ssl=required setting.
20271 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
20272 @end deftypevr
20273
20274 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer auth-cache-size
20275 Authentication cache size (e.g.@: @samp{#e10e6}). 0 means it's disabled.
20276 Note that bsdauth, PAM and vpopmail require @samp{cache-key} to be set
20277 for caching to be used.
20278 Defaults to @samp{0}.
20279 @end deftypevr
20280
20281 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-cache-ttl
20282 Time to live for cached data. After TTL expires the cached record
20283 is no longer used, *except* if the main database lookup returns internal
20284 failure. We also try to handle password changes automatically: If
20285 user's previous authentication was successful, but this one wasn't, the
20286 cache isn't used. For now this works only with plaintext
20287 authentication.
20288 Defaults to @samp{"1 hour"}.
20289 @end deftypevr
20290
20291 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-cache-negative-ttl
20292 TTL for negative hits (user not found, password mismatch).
20293 0 disables caching them completely.
20294 Defaults to @samp{"1 hour"}.
20295 @end deftypevr
20296
20297 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list auth-realms
20298 List of realms for SASL authentication mechanisms that need them.
20299 You can leave it empty if you don't want to support multiple realms.
20300 Many clients simply use the first one listed here, so keep the default
20301 realm first.
20302 Defaults to @samp{()}.
20303 @end deftypevr
20304
20305 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-default-realm
20306 Default realm/domain to use if none was specified. This is used for
20307 both SASL realms and appending @@domain to username in plaintext
20308 logins.
20309 Defaults to @samp{""}.
20310 @end deftypevr
20311
20312 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-username-chars
20313 List of allowed characters in username. If the user-given username
20314 contains a character not listed in here, the login automatically fails.
20315 This is just an extra check to make sure user can't exploit any
20316 potential quote escaping vulnerabilities with SQL/LDAP databases. If
20317 you want to allow all characters, set this value to empty.
20318 Defaults to @samp{"abcdefghijklmnopqrstuvwxyzABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQRSTUVWXYZ01234567890.-_@@"}.
20319 @end deftypevr
20320
20321 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-username-translation
20322 Username character translations before it's looked up from
20323 databases. The value contains series of from -> to characters. For
20324 example @samp{#@@/@@} means that @samp{#} and @samp{/} characters are
20325 translated to @samp{@@}.
20326 Defaults to @samp{""}.
20327 @end deftypevr
20328
20329 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-username-format
20330 Username formatting before it's looked up from databases. You can
20331 use the standard variables here, e.g.@: %Lu would lowercase the username,
20332 %n would drop away the domain if it was given, or @samp{%n-AT-%d} would
20333 change the @samp{@@} into @samp{-AT-}. This translation is done after
20334 @samp{auth-username-translation} changes.
20335 Defaults to @samp{"%Lu"}.
20336 @end deftypevr
20337
20338 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-master-user-separator
20339 If you want to allow master users to log in by specifying the master
20340 username within the normal username string (i.e.@: not using SASL
20341 mechanism's support for it), you can specify the separator character
20342 here. The format is then <username><separator><master username>.
20343 UW-IMAP uses @samp{*} as the separator, so that could be a good
20344 choice.
20345 Defaults to @samp{""}.
20346 @end deftypevr
20347
20348 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-anonymous-username
20349 Username to use for users logging in with ANONYMOUS SASL
20350 mechanism.
20351 Defaults to @samp{"anonymous"}.
20352 @end deftypevr
20353
20354 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer auth-worker-max-count
20355 Maximum number of dovecot-auth worker processes. They're used to
20356 execute blocking passdb and userdb queries (e.g.@: MySQL and PAM).
20357 They're automatically created and destroyed as needed.
20358 Defaults to @samp{30}.
20359 @end deftypevr
20360
20361 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-gssapi-hostname
20362 Host name to use in GSSAPI principal names. The default is to use
20363 the name returned by gethostname(). Use @samp{$ALL} (with quotes) to
20364 allow all keytab entries.
20365 Defaults to @samp{""}.
20366 @end deftypevr
20367
20368 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-krb5-keytab
20369 Kerberos keytab to use for the GSSAPI mechanism. Will use the
20370 system default (usually @file{/etc/krb5.keytab}) if not specified. You may
20371 need to change the auth service to run as root to be able to read this
20372 file.
20373 Defaults to @samp{""}.
20374 @end deftypevr
20375
20376 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean auth-use-winbind?
20377 Do NTLM and GSS-SPNEGO authentication using Samba's winbind daemon
20378 and @samp{ntlm-auth} helper.
20379 <doc/wiki/Authentication/Mechanisms/Winbind.txt>.
20380 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
20381 @end deftypevr
20382
20383 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} file-name auth-winbind-helper-path
20384 Path for Samba's @samp{ntlm-auth} helper binary.
20385 Defaults to @samp{"/usr/bin/ntlm_auth"}.
20386 @end deftypevr
20387
20388 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-failure-delay
20389 Time to delay before replying to failed authentications.
20390 Defaults to @samp{"2 secs"}.
20391 @end deftypevr
20392
20393 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean auth-ssl-require-client-cert?
20394 Require a valid SSL client certificate or the authentication
20395 fails.
20396 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
20397 @end deftypevr
20398
20399 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean auth-ssl-username-from-cert?
20400 Take the username from client's SSL certificate, using
20401 @code{X509_NAME_get_text_by_NID()} which returns the subject's DN's
20402 CommonName.
20403 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
20404 @end deftypevr
20405
20406 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list auth-mechanisms
20407 List of wanted authentication mechanisms. Supported mechanisms are:
20408 @samp{plain}, @samp{login}, @samp{digest-md5}, @samp{cram-md5},
20409 @samp{ntlm}, @samp{rpa}, @samp{apop}, @samp{anonymous}, @samp{gssapi},
20410 @samp{otp}, @samp{skey}, and @samp{gss-spnego}. NOTE: See also
20411 @samp{disable-plaintext-auth} setting.
20412 @end deftypevr
20413
20414 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list director-servers
20415 List of IPs or hostnames to all director servers, including ourself.
20416 Ports can be specified as ip:port. The default port is the same as what
20417 director service's @samp{inet-listener} is using.
20418 Defaults to @samp{()}.
20419 @end deftypevr
20420
20421 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list director-mail-servers
20422 List of IPs or hostnames to all backend mail servers. Ranges are
20423 allowed too, like 10.0.0.10-10.0.0.30.
20424 Defaults to @samp{()}.
20425 @end deftypevr
20426
20427 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string director-user-expire
20428 How long to redirect users to a specific server after it no longer
20429 has any connections.
20430 Defaults to @samp{"15 min"}.
20431 @end deftypevr
20432
20433 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string director-username-hash
20434 How the username is translated before being hashed. Useful values
20435 include %Ln if user can log in with or without @@domain, %Ld if mailboxes
20436 are shared within domain.
20437 Defaults to @samp{"%Lu"}.
20438 @end deftypevr
20439
20440 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string log-path
20441 Log file to use for error messages. @samp{syslog} logs to syslog,
20442 @samp{/dev/stderr} logs to stderr.
20443 Defaults to @samp{"syslog"}.
20444 @end deftypevr
20445
20446 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string info-log-path
20447 Log file to use for informational messages. Defaults to
20448 @samp{log-path}.
20449 Defaults to @samp{""}.
20450 @end deftypevr
20451
20452 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string debug-log-path
20453 Log file to use for debug messages. Defaults to
20454 @samp{info-log-path}.
20455 Defaults to @samp{""}.
20456 @end deftypevr
20457
20458 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string syslog-facility
20459 Syslog facility to use if you're logging to syslog. Usually if you
20460 don't want to use @samp{mail}, you'll use local0..local7. Also other
20461 standard facilities are supported.
20462 Defaults to @samp{"mail"}.
20463 @end deftypevr
20464
20465 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean auth-verbose?
20466 Log unsuccessful authentication attempts and the reasons why they
20467 failed.
20468 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
20469 @end deftypevr
20470
20471 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-verbose-passwords
20472 In case of password mismatches, log the attempted password. Valid
20473 values are no, plain and sha1. sha1 can be useful for detecting brute
20474 force password attempts vs. user simply trying the same password over
20475 and over again. You can also truncate the value to n chars by appending
20476 ":n" (e.g.@: sha1:6).
20477 Defaults to @samp{"no"}.
20478 @end deftypevr
20479
20480 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean auth-debug?
20481 Even more verbose logging for debugging purposes. Shows for example
20482 SQL queries.
20483 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
20484 @end deftypevr
20485
20486 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean auth-debug-passwords?
20487 In case of password mismatches, log the passwords and used scheme so
20488 the problem can be debugged. Enabling this also enables
20489 @samp{auth-debug}.
20490 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
20491 @end deftypevr
20492
20493 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean mail-debug?
20494 Enable mail process debugging. This can help you figure out why
20495 Dovecot isn't finding your mails.
20496 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
20497 @end deftypevr
20498
20499 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean verbose-ssl?
20500 Show protocol level SSL errors.
20501 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
20502 @end deftypevr
20503
20504 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string log-timestamp
20505 Prefix for each line written to log file. % codes are in
20506 strftime(3) format.
20507 Defaults to @samp{"\"%b %d %H:%M:%S \""}.
20508 @end deftypevr
20509
20510 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list login-log-format-elements
20511 List of elements we want to log. The elements which have a
20512 non-empty variable value are joined together to form a comma-separated
20513 string.
20514 @end deftypevr
20515
20516 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string login-log-format
20517 Login log format. %s contains @samp{login-log-format-elements}
20518 string, %$ contains the data we want to log.
20519 Defaults to @samp{"%$: %s"}.
20520 @end deftypevr
20521
20522 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-log-prefix
20523 Log prefix for mail processes. See doc/wiki/Variables.txt for list
20524 of possible variables you can use.
20525 Defaults to @samp{"\"%s(%u)<%@{pid@}><%@{session@}>: \""}.
20526 @end deftypevr
20527
20528 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string deliver-log-format
20529 Format to use for logging mail deliveries. You can use variables:
20530 @table @code
20531 @item %$
20532 Delivery status message (e.g.@: @samp{saved to INBOX})
20533 @item %m
20534 Message-ID
20535 @item %s
20536 Subject
20537 @item %f
20538 From address
20539 @item %p
20540 Physical size
20541 @item %w
20542 Virtual size.
20543 @end table
20544 Defaults to @samp{"msgid=%m: %$"}.
20545 @end deftypevr
20546
20547 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-location
20548 Location for users' mailboxes. The default is empty, which means
20549 that Dovecot tries to find the mailboxes automatically. This won't work
20550 if the user doesn't yet have any mail, so you should explicitly tell
20551 Dovecot the full location.
20552
20553 If you're using mbox, giving a path to the INBOX
20554 file (e.g.@: @file{/var/mail/%u}) isn't enough. You'll also need to tell Dovecot
20555 where the other mailboxes are kept. This is called the @emph{root mail
20556 directory}, and it must be the first path given in the
20557 @samp{mail-location} setting.
20558
20559 There are a few special variables you can use, e.g.:
20560
20561 @table @samp
20562 @item %u
20563 username
20564 @item %n
20565 user part in user@@domain, same as %u if there's no domain
20566 @item %d
20567 domain part in user@@domain, empty if there's no domain
20568 @item %h
20569 home director
20570 @end table
20571
20572 See doc/wiki/Variables.txt for full list. Some examples:
20573 @table @samp
20574 @item maildir:~/Maildir
20575 @item mbox:~/mail:INBOX=/var/mail/%u
20576 @item mbox:/var/mail/%d/%1n/%n:INDEX=/var/indexes/%d/%1n/%
20577 @end table
20578 Defaults to @samp{""}.
20579 @end deftypevr
20580
20581 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-uid
20582 System user and group used to access mails. If you use multiple,
20583 userdb can override these by returning uid or gid fields. You can use
20584 either numbers or names. <doc/wiki/UserIds.txt>.
20585 Defaults to @samp{""}.
20586 @end deftypevr
20587
20588 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-gid
20589
20590 Defaults to @samp{""}.
20591 @end deftypevr
20592
20593 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-privileged-group
20594 Group to enable temporarily for privileged operations. Currently
20595 this is used only with INBOX when either its initial creation or
20596 dotlocking fails. Typically this is set to @samp{"mail"} to give access to
20597 @file{/var/mail}.
20598 Defaults to @samp{""}.
20599 @end deftypevr
20600
20601 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-access-groups
20602 Grant access to these supplementary groups for mail processes.
20603 Typically these are used to set up access to shared mailboxes. Note
20604 that it may be dangerous to set these if users can create symlinks
20605 (e.g.@: if @samp{mail} group is set here, @code{ln -s /var/mail ~/mail/var}
20606 could allow a user to delete others' mailboxes, or @code{ln -s
20607 /secret/shared/box ~/mail/mybox} would allow reading it). Defaults to
20608 @samp{""}.
20609 @end deftypevr
20610
20611 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean mail-full-filesystem-access?
20612 Allow full file system access to clients. There's no access checks
20613 other than what the operating system does for the active UID/GID@. It
20614 works with both maildir and mboxes, allowing you to prefix mailboxes
20615 names with e.g.@: @file{/path/} or @file{~user/}.
20616 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
20617 @end deftypevr
20618
20619 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean mmap-disable?
20620 Don't use @code{mmap()} at all. This is required if you store indexes to
20621 shared file systems (NFS or clustered file system).
20622 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
20623 @end deftypevr
20624
20625 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean dotlock-use-excl?
20626 Rely on @samp{O_EXCL} to work when creating dotlock files. NFS
20627 supports @samp{O_EXCL} since version 3, so this should be safe to use
20628 nowadays by default.
20629 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
20630 @end deftypevr
20631
20632 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-fsync
20633 When to use fsync() or fdatasync() calls:
20634 @table @code
20635 @item optimized
20636 Whenever necessary to avoid losing important data
20637 @item always
20638 Useful with e.g.@: NFS when @code{write()}s are delayed
20639 @item never
20640 Never use it (best performance, but crashes can lose data).
20641 @end table
20642 Defaults to @samp{"optimized"}.
20643 @end deftypevr
20644
20645 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean mail-nfs-storage?
20646 Mail storage exists in NFS@. Set this to yes to make Dovecot flush
20647 NFS caches whenever needed. If you're using only a single mail server
20648 this isn't needed.
20649 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
20650 @end deftypevr
20651
20652 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean mail-nfs-index?
20653 Mail index files also exist in NFS@. Setting this to yes requires
20654 @samp{mmap-disable? #t} and @samp{fsync-disable? #f}.
20655 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
20656 @end deftypevr
20657
20658 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string lock-method
20659 Locking method for index files. Alternatives are fcntl, flock and
20660 dotlock. Dotlocking uses some tricks which may create more disk I/O
20661 than other locking methods. NFS users: flock doesn't work, remember to
20662 change @samp{mmap-disable}.
20663 Defaults to @samp{"fcntl"}.
20664 @end deftypevr
20665
20666 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} file-name mail-temp-dir
20667 Directory in which LDA/LMTP temporarily stores incoming mails >128
20668 kB.
20669 Defaults to @samp{"/tmp"}.
20670 @end deftypevr
20671
20672 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer first-valid-uid
20673 Valid UID range for users. This is mostly to make sure that users can't
20674 log in as daemons or other system users. Note that denying root logins is
20675 hardcoded to dovecot binary and can't be done even if @samp{first-valid-uid}
20676 is set to 0.
20677 Defaults to @samp{500}.
20678 @end deftypevr
20679
20680 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer last-valid-uid
20681
20682 Defaults to @samp{0}.
20683 @end deftypevr
20684
20685 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer first-valid-gid
20686 Valid GID range for users. Users having non-valid GID as primary group ID
20687 aren't allowed to log in. If user belongs to supplementary groups with
20688 non-valid GIDs, those groups are not set.
20689 Defaults to @samp{1}.
20690 @end deftypevr
20691
20692 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer last-valid-gid
20693
20694 Defaults to @samp{0}.
20695 @end deftypevr
20696
20697 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer mail-max-keyword-length
20698 Maximum allowed length for mail keyword name. It's only forced when
20699 trying to create new keywords.
20700 Defaults to @samp{50}.
20701 @end deftypevr
20702
20703 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} colon-separated-file-name-list valid-chroot-dirs
20704 List of directories under which chrooting is allowed for mail
20705 processes (i.e.@: @file{/var/mail} will allow chrooting to @file{/var/mail/foo/bar}
20706 too). This setting doesn't affect @samp{login-chroot}
20707 @samp{mail-chroot} or auth chroot settings. If this setting is empty,
20708 @samp{/./} in home dirs are ignored. WARNING: Never add directories here
20709 which local users can modify, that may lead to root exploit. Usually
20710 this should be done only if you don't allow shell access for users.
20711 <doc/wiki/Chrooting.txt>.
20712 Defaults to @samp{()}.
20713 @end deftypevr
20714
20715 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-chroot
20716 Default chroot directory for mail processes. This can be overridden
20717 for specific users in user database by giving @samp{/./} in user's home
20718 directory (e.g.@: @samp{/home/./user} chroots into @file{/home}). Note that usually
20719 there is no real need to do chrooting, Dovecot doesn't allow users to
20720 access files outside their mail directory anyway. If your home
20721 directories are prefixed with the chroot directory, append @samp{/.} to
20722 @samp{mail-chroot}. <doc/wiki/Chrooting.txt>.
20723 Defaults to @samp{""}.
20724 @end deftypevr
20725
20726 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} file-name auth-socket-path
20727 UNIX socket path to master authentication server to find users.
20728 This is used by imap (for shared users) and lda.
20729 Defaults to @samp{"/var/run/dovecot/auth-userdb"}.
20730 @end deftypevr
20731
20732 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} file-name mail-plugin-dir
20733 Directory where to look up mail plugins.
20734 Defaults to @samp{"/usr/lib/dovecot"}.
20735 @end deftypevr
20736
20737 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list mail-plugins
20738 List of plugins to load for all services. Plugins specific to IMAP,
20739 LDA, etc.@: are added to this list in their own .conf files.
20740 Defaults to @samp{()}.
20741 @end deftypevr
20742
20743 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer mail-cache-min-mail-count
20744 The minimum number of mails in a mailbox before updates are done to
20745 cache file. This allows optimizing Dovecot's behavior to do less disk
20746 writes at the cost of more disk reads.
20747 Defaults to @samp{0}.
20748 @end deftypevr
20749
20750 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mailbox-idle-check-interval
20751 When IDLE command is running, mailbox is checked once in a while to
20752 see if there are any new mails or other changes. This setting defines
20753 the minimum time to wait between those checks. Dovecot can also use
20754 dnotify, inotify and kqueue to find out immediately when changes
20755 occur.
20756 Defaults to @samp{"30 secs"}.
20757 @end deftypevr
20758
20759 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean mail-save-crlf?
20760 Save mails with CR+LF instead of plain LF@. This makes sending those
20761 mails take less CPU, especially with sendfile() syscall with Linux and
20762 FreeBSD@. But it also creates a bit more disk I/O which may just make it
20763 slower. Also note that if other software reads the mboxes/maildirs,
20764 they may handle the extra CRs wrong and cause problems.
20765 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
20766 @end deftypevr
20767
20768 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean maildir-stat-dirs?
20769 By default LIST command returns all entries in maildir beginning
20770 with a dot. Enabling this option makes Dovecot return only entries
20771 which are directories. This is done by stat()ing each entry, so it
20772 causes more disk I/O.
20773 (For systems setting struct @samp{dirent->d_type} this check is free
20774 and it's done always regardless of this setting).
20775 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
20776 @end deftypevr
20777
20778 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean maildir-copy-with-hardlinks?
20779 When copying a message, do it with hard links whenever possible.
20780 This makes the performance much better, and it's unlikely to have any
20781 side effects.
20782 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
20783 @end deftypevr
20784
20785 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean maildir-very-dirty-syncs?
20786 Assume Dovecot is the only MUA accessing Maildir: Scan cur/
20787 directory only when its mtime changes unexpectedly or when we can't find
20788 the mail otherwise.
20789 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
20790 @end deftypevr
20791
20792 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list mbox-read-locks
20793 Which locking methods to use for locking mbox. There are four
20794 available:
20795
20796 @table @code
20797 @item dotlock
20798 Create <mailbox>.lock file. This is the oldest and most NFS-safe
20799 solution. If you want to use /var/mail/ like directory, the users will
20800 need write access to that directory.
20801 @item dotlock-try
20802 Same as dotlock, but if it fails because of permissions or because there
20803 isn't enough disk space, just skip it.
20804 @item fcntl
20805 Use this if possible. Works with NFS too if lockd is used.
20806 @item flock
20807 May not exist in all systems. Doesn't work with NFS.
20808 @item lockf
20809 May not exist in all systems. Doesn't work with NFS.
20810 @end table
20811
20812 You can use multiple locking methods; if you do the order they're declared
20813 in is important to avoid deadlocks if other MTAs/MUAs are using multiple
20814 locking methods as well. Some operating systems don't allow using some of
20815 them simultaneously.
20816 @end deftypevr
20817
20818 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list mbox-write-locks
20819
20820 @end deftypevr
20821
20822 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mbox-lock-timeout
20823 Maximum time to wait for lock (all of them) before aborting.
20824 Defaults to @samp{"5 mins"}.
20825 @end deftypevr
20826
20827 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mbox-dotlock-change-timeout
20828 If dotlock exists but the mailbox isn't modified in any way,
20829 override the lock file after this much time.
20830 Defaults to @samp{"2 mins"}.
20831 @end deftypevr
20832
20833 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean mbox-dirty-syncs?
20834 When mbox changes unexpectedly we have to fully read it to find out
20835 what changed. If the mbox is large this can take a long time. Since
20836 the change is usually just a newly appended mail, it'd be faster to
20837 simply read the new mails. If this setting is enabled, Dovecot does
20838 this but still safely fallbacks to re-reading the whole mbox file
20839 whenever something in mbox isn't how it's expected to be. The only real
20840 downside to this setting is that if some other MUA changes message
20841 flags, Dovecot doesn't notice it immediately. Note that a full sync is
20842 done with SELECT, EXAMINE, EXPUNGE and CHECK commands.
20843 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
20844 @end deftypevr
20845
20846 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean mbox-very-dirty-syncs?
20847 Like @samp{mbox-dirty-syncs}, but don't do full syncs even with SELECT,
20848 EXAMINE, EXPUNGE or CHECK commands. If this is set,
20849 @samp{mbox-dirty-syncs} is ignored.
20850 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
20851 @end deftypevr
20852
20853 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean mbox-lazy-writes?
20854 Delay writing mbox headers until doing a full write sync (EXPUNGE
20855 and CHECK commands and when closing the mailbox). This is especially
20856 useful for POP3 where clients often delete all mails. The downside is
20857 that our changes aren't immediately visible to other MUAs.
20858 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
20859 @end deftypevr
20860
20861 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer mbox-min-index-size
20862 If mbox size is smaller than this (e.g.@: 100k), don't write index
20863 files. If an index file already exists it's still read, just not
20864 updated.
20865 Defaults to @samp{0}.
20866 @end deftypevr
20867
20868 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer mdbox-rotate-size
20869 Maximum dbox file size until it's rotated.
20870 Defaults to @samp{10000000}.
20871 @end deftypevr
20872
20873 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mdbox-rotate-interval
20874 Maximum dbox file age until it's rotated. Typically in days. Day
20875 begins from midnight, so 1d = today, 2d = yesterday, etc. 0 = check
20876 disabled.
20877 Defaults to @samp{"1d"}.
20878 @end deftypevr
20879
20880 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean mdbox-preallocate-space?
20881 When creating new mdbox files, immediately preallocate their size to
20882 @samp{mdbox-rotate-size}. This setting currently works only in Linux
20883 with some file systems (ext4, xfs).
20884 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
20885 @end deftypevr
20886
20887 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-attachment-dir
20888 sdbox and mdbox support saving mail attachments to external files,
20889 which also allows single instance storage for them. Other backends
20890 don't support this for now.
20891
20892 WARNING: This feature hasn't been tested much yet. Use at your own risk.
20893
20894 Directory root where to store mail attachments. Disabled, if empty.
20895 Defaults to @samp{""}.
20896 @end deftypevr
20897
20898 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer mail-attachment-min-size
20899 Attachments smaller than this aren't saved externally. It's also
20900 possible to write a plugin to disable saving specific attachments
20901 externally.
20902 Defaults to @samp{128000}.
20903 @end deftypevr
20904
20905 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-attachment-fs
20906 File system backend to use for saving attachments:
20907 @table @code
20908 @item posix
20909 No SiS done by Dovecot (but this might help FS's own deduplication)
20910 @item sis posix
20911 SiS with immediate byte-by-byte comparison during saving
20912 @item sis-queue posix
20913 SiS with delayed comparison and deduplication.
20914 @end table
20915 Defaults to @samp{"sis posix"}.
20916 @end deftypevr
20917
20918 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-attachment-hash
20919 Hash format to use in attachment filenames. You can add any text and
20920 variables: @code{%@{md4@}}, @code{%@{md5@}}, @code{%@{sha1@}},
20921 @code{%@{sha256@}}, @code{%@{sha512@}}, @code{%@{size@}}. Variables can be
20922 truncated, e.g.@: @code{%@{sha256:80@}} returns only first 80 bits.
20923 Defaults to @samp{"%@{sha1@}"}.
20924 @end deftypevr
20925
20926 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer default-process-limit
20927
20928 Defaults to @samp{100}.
20929 @end deftypevr
20930
20931 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer default-client-limit
20932
20933 Defaults to @samp{1000}.
20934 @end deftypevr
20935
20936 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer default-vsz-limit
20937 Default VSZ (virtual memory size) limit for service processes.
20938 This is mainly intended to catch and kill processes that leak memory
20939 before they eat up everything.
20940 Defaults to @samp{256000000}.
20941 @end deftypevr
20942
20943 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string default-login-user
20944 Login user is internally used by login processes. This is the most
20945 untrusted user in Dovecot system. It shouldn't have access to anything
20946 at all.
20947 Defaults to @samp{"dovenull"}.
20948 @end deftypevr
20949
20950 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string default-internal-user
20951 Internal user is used by unprivileged processes. It should be
20952 separate from login user, so that login processes can't disturb other
20953 processes.
20954 Defaults to @samp{"dovecot"}.
20955 @end deftypevr
20956
20957 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string ssl?
20958 SSL/TLS support: yes, no, required. <doc/wiki/SSL.txt>.
20959 Defaults to @samp{"required"}.
20960 @end deftypevr
20961
20962 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string ssl-cert
20963 PEM encoded X.509 SSL/TLS certificate (public key).
20964 Defaults to @samp{"</etc/dovecot/default.pem"}.
20965 @end deftypevr
20966
20967 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string ssl-key
20968 PEM encoded SSL/TLS private key. The key is opened before
20969 dropping root privileges, so keep the key file unreadable by anyone but
20970 root.
20971 Defaults to @samp{"</etc/dovecot/private/default.pem"}.
20972 @end deftypevr
20973
20974 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string ssl-key-password
20975 If key file is password protected, give the password here.
20976 Alternatively give it when starting dovecot with -p parameter. Since
20977 this file is often world-readable, you may want to place this setting
20978 instead to a different.
20979 Defaults to @samp{""}.
20980 @end deftypevr
20981
20982 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string ssl-ca
20983 PEM encoded trusted certificate authority. Set this only if you
20984 intend to use @samp{ssl-verify-client-cert? #t}. The file should
20985 contain the CA certificate(s) followed by the matching
20986 CRL(s). (e.g.@: @samp{ssl-ca </etc/ssl/certs/ca.pem}).
20987 Defaults to @samp{""}.
20988 @end deftypevr
20989
20990 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean ssl-require-crl?
20991 Require that CRL check succeeds for client certificates.
20992 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
20993 @end deftypevr
20994
20995 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean ssl-verify-client-cert?
20996 Request client to send a certificate. If you also want to require
20997 it, set @samp{auth-ssl-require-client-cert? #t} in auth section.
20998 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
20999 @end deftypevr
21000
21001 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string ssl-cert-username-field
21002 Which field from certificate to use for username. commonName and
21003 x500UniqueIdentifier are the usual choices. You'll also need to set
21004 @samp{auth-ssl-username-from-cert? #t}.
21005 Defaults to @samp{"commonName"}.
21006 @end deftypevr
21007
21008 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string ssl-min-protocol
21009 Minimum SSL protocol version to accept.
21010 Defaults to @samp{"TLSv1"}.
21011 @end deftypevr
21012
21013 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string ssl-cipher-list
21014 SSL ciphers to use.
21015 Defaults to @samp{"ALL:!kRSA:!SRP:!kDHd:!DSS:!aNULL:!eNULL:!EXPORT:!DES:!3DES:!MD5:!PSK:!RC4:!ADH:!LOW@@STRENGTH"}.
21016 @end deftypevr
21017
21018 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string ssl-crypto-device
21019 SSL crypto device to use, for valid values run "openssl engine".
21020 Defaults to @samp{""}.
21021 @end deftypevr
21022
21023 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string postmaster-address
21024 Address to use when sending rejection mails.
21025 %d expands to recipient domain.
21026 Defaults to @samp{"postmaster@@%d"}.
21027 @end deftypevr
21028
21029 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string hostname
21030 Hostname to use in various parts of sent mails (e.g.@: in Message-Id)
21031 and in LMTP replies. Default is the system's real hostname@@domain.
21032 Defaults to @samp{""}.
21033 @end deftypevr
21034
21035 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean quota-full-tempfail?
21036 If user is over quota, return with temporary failure instead of
21037 bouncing the mail.
21038 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
21039 @end deftypevr
21040
21041 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} file-name sendmail-path
21042 Binary to use for sending mails.
21043 Defaults to @samp{"/usr/sbin/sendmail"}.
21044 @end deftypevr
21045
21046 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string submission-host
21047 If non-empty, send mails via this SMTP host[:port] instead of
21048 sendmail.
21049 Defaults to @samp{""}.
21050 @end deftypevr
21051
21052 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string rejection-subject
21053 Subject: header to use for rejection mails. You can use the same
21054 variables as for @samp{rejection-reason} below.
21055 Defaults to @samp{"Rejected: %s"}.
21056 @end deftypevr
21057
21058 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string rejection-reason
21059 Human readable error message for rejection mails. You can use
21060 variables:
21061
21062 @table @code
21063 @item %n
21064 CRLF
21065 @item %r
21066 reason
21067 @item %s
21068 original subject
21069 @item %t
21070 recipient
21071 @end table
21072 Defaults to @samp{"Your message to <%t> was automatically rejected:%n%r"}.
21073 @end deftypevr
21074
21075 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string recipient-delimiter
21076 Delimiter character between local-part and detail in email
21077 address.
21078 Defaults to @samp{"+"}.
21079 @end deftypevr
21080
21081 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string lda-original-recipient-header
21082 Header where the original recipient address (SMTP's RCPT TO:
21083 address) is taken from if not available elsewhere. With dovecot-lda -a
21084 parameter overrides this. A commonly used header for this is
21085 X-Original-To.
21086 Defaults to @samp{""}.
21087 @end deftypevr
21088
21089 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean lda-mailbox-autocreate?
21090 Should saving a mail to a nonexistent mailbox automatically create
21091 it?.
21092 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
21093 @end deftypevr
21094
21095 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean lda-mailbox-autosubscribe?
21096 Should automatically created mailboxes be also automatically
21097 subscribed?.
21098 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
21099 @end deftypevr
21100
21101 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer imap-max-line-length
21102 Maximum IMAP command line length. Some clients generate very long
21103 command lines with huge mailboxes, so you may need to raise this if you
21104 get "Too long argument" or "IMAP command line too large" errors
21105 often.
21106 Defaults to @samp{64000}.
21107 @end deftypevr
21108
21109 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string imap-logout-format
21110 IMAP logout format string:
21111 @table @code
21112 @item %i
21113 total number of bytes read from client
21114 @item %o
21115 total number of bytes sent to client.
21116 @end table
21117 See @file{doc/wiki/Variables.txt} for a list of all the variables you can use.
21118 Defaults to @samp{"in=%i out=%o deleted=%@{deleted@} expunged=%@{expunged@} trashed=%@{trashed@} hdr_count=%@{fetch_hdr_count@} hdr_bytes=%@{fetch_hdr_bytes@} body_count=%@{fetch_body_count@} body_bytes=%@{fetch_body_bytes@}"}.
21119 @end deftypevr
21120
21121 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string imap-capability
21122 Override the IMAP CAPABILITY response. If the value begins with '+',
21123 add the given capabilities on top of the defaults (e.g.@: +XFOO XBAR).
21124 Defaults to @samp{""}.
21125 @end deftypevr
21126
21127 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string imap-idle-notify-interval
21128 How long to wait between "OK Still here" notifications when client
21129 is IDLEing.
21130 Defaults to @samp{"2 mins"}.
21131 @end deftypevr
21132
21133 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string imap-id-send
21134 ID field names and values to send to clients. Using * as the value
21135 makes Dovecot use the default value. The following fields have default
21136 values currently: name, version, os, os-version, support-url,
21137 support-email.
21138 Defaults to @samp{""}.
21139 @end deftypevr
21140
21141 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string imap-id-log
21142 ID fields sent by client to log. * means everything.
21143 Defaults to @samp{""}.
21144 @end deftypevr
21145
21146 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list imap-client-workarounds
21147 Workarounds for various client bugs:
21148
21149 @table @code
21150 @item delay-newmail
21151 Send EXISTS/RECENT new mail notifications only when replying to NOOP and
21152 CHECK commands. Some clients ignore them otherwise, for example OSX
21153 Mail (<v2.1). Outlook Express breaks more badly though, without this it
21154 may show user "Message no longer in server" errors. Note that OE6
21155 still breaks even with this workaround if synchronization is set to
21156 "Headers Only".
21157
21158 @item tb-extra-mailbox-sep
21159 Thunderbird gets somehow confused with LAYOUT=fs (mbox and dbox) and
21160 adds extra @samp{/} suffixes to mailbox names. This option causes Dovecot to
21161 ignore the extra @samp{/} instead of treating it as invalid mailbox name.
21162
21163 @item tb-lsub-flags
21164 Show \Noselect flags for LSUB replies with LAYOUT=fs (e.g.@: mbox).
21165 This makes Thunderbird realize they aren't selectable and show them
21166 greyed out, instead of only later giving "not selectable" popup error.
21167 @end table
21168 Defaults to @samp{()}.
21169 @end deftypevr
21170
21171 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string imap-urlauth-host
21172 Host allowed in URLAUTH URLs sent by client. "*" allows all.
21173 Defaults to @samp{""}.
21174 @end deftypevr
21175
21176
21177 Whew! Lots of configuration options. The nice thing about it though is
21178 that Guix has a complete interface to Dovecot's configuration
21179 language. This allows not only a nice way to declare configurations,
21180 but also offers reflective capabilities as well: users can write code to
21181 inspect and transform configurations from within Scheme.
21182
21183 However, it could be that you just want to get a @code{dovecot.conf} up
21184 and running. In that case, you can pass an
21185 @code{opaque-dovecot-configuration} as the @code{#:config} parameter to
21186 @code{dovecot-service}. As its name indicates, an opaque configuration
21187 does not have easy reflective capabilities.
21188
21189 Available @code{opaque-dovecot-configuration} fields are:
21190
21191 @deftypevr {@code{opaque-dovecot-configuration} parameter} package dovecot
21192 The dovecot package.
21193 @end deftypevr
21194
21195 @deftypevr {@code{opaque-dovecot-configuration} parameter} string string
21196 The contents of the @code{dovecot.conf}, as a string.
21197 @end deftypevr
21198
21199 For example, if your @code{dovecot.conf} is just the empty string, you
21200 could instantiate a dovecot service like this:
21201
21202 @lisp
21203 (dovecot-service #:config
21204 (opaque-dovecot-configuration
21205 (string "")))
21206 @end lisp
21207
21208 @subsubheading OpenSMTPD Service
21209
21210 @deffn {Scheme Variable} opensmtpd-service-type
21211 This is the type of the @uref{https://www.opensmtpd.org, OpenSMTPD}
21212 service, whose value should be an @code{opensmtpd-configuration} object
21213 as in this example:
21214
21215 @lisp
21216 (service opensmtpd-service-type
21217 (opensmtpd-configuration
21218 (config-file (local-file "./my-smtpd.conf"))))
21219 @end lisp
21220 @end deffn
21221
21222 @deftp {Data Type} opensmtpd-configuration
21223 Data type representing the configuration of opensmtpd.
21224
21225 @table @asis
21226 @item @code{package} (default: @var{opensmtpd})
21227 Package object of the OpenSMTPD SMTP server.
21228
21229 @item @code{config-file} (default: @code{%default-opensmtpd-file})
21230 File-like object of the OpenSMTPD configuration file to use. By default
21231 it listens on the loopback network interface, and allows for mail from
21232 users and daemons on the local machine, as well as permitting email to
21233 remote servers. Run @command{man smtpd.conf} for more information.
21234
21235 @end table
21236 @end deftp
21237
21238 @subsubheading Exim Service
21239
21240 @cindex mail transfer agent (MTA)
21241 @cindex MTA (mail transfer agent)
21242 @cindex SMTP
21243
21244 @deffn {Scheme Variable} exim-service-type
21245 This is the type of the @uref{https://exim.org, Exim} mail transfer
21246 agent (MTA), whose value should be an @code{exim-configuration} object
21247 as in this example:
21248
21249 @lisp
21250 (service exim-service-type
21251 (exim-configuration
21252 (config-file (local-file "./my-exim.conf"))))
21253 @end lisp
21254 @end deffn
21255
21256 In order to use an @code{exim-service-type} service you must also have a
21257 @code{mail-aliases-service-type} service present in your
21258 @code{operating-system} (even if it has no aliases).
21259
21260 @deftp {Data Type} exim-configuration
21261 Data type representing the configuration of exim.
21262
21263 @table @asis
21264 @item @code{package} (default: @var{exim})
21265 Package object of the Exim server.
21266
21267 @item @code{config-file} (default: @code{#f})
21268 File-like object of the Exim configuration file to use. If its value is
21269 @code{#f} then use the default configuration file from the package
21270 provided in @code{package}. The resulting configuration file is loaded
21271 after setting the @code{exim_user} and @code{exim_group} configuration
21272 variables.
21273
21274 @end table
21275 @end deftp
21276
21277 @subsubheading Getmail service
21278
21279 @cindex IMAP
21280 @cindex POP
21281
21282 @deffn {Scheme Variable} getmail-service-type
21283 This is the type of the @uref{http://pyropus.ca/software/getmail/, Getmail}
21284 mail retriever, whose value should be an @code{getmail-configuration}.
21285 @end deffn
21286
21287 Available @code{getmail-configuration} fields are:
21288
21289 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-configuration} parameter} symbol name
21290 A symbol to identify the getmail service.
21291
21292 Defaults to @samp{"unset"}.
21293
21294 @end deftypevr
21295
21296 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-configuration} parameter} package package
21297 The getmail package to use.
21298
21299 @end deftypevr
21300
21301 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-configuration} parameter} string user
21302 The user to run getmail as.
21303
21304 Defaults to @samp{"getmail"}.
21305
21306 @end deftypevr
21307
21308 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-configuration} parameter} string group
21309 The group to run getmail as.
21310
21311 Defaults to @samp{"getmail"}.
21312
21313 @end deftypevr
21314
21315 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-configuration} parameter} string directory
21316 The getmail directory to use.
21317
21318 Defaults to @samp{"/var/lib/getmail/default"}.
21319
21320 @end deftypevr
21321
21322 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-configuration} parameter} getmail-configuration-file rcfile
21323 The getmail configuration file to use.
21324
21325 Available @code{getmail-configuration-file} fields are:
21326
21327 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-configuration-file} parameter} getmail-retriever-configuration retriever
21328 What mail account to retrieve mail from, and how to access that account.
21329
21330 Available @code{getmail-retriever-configuration} fields are:
21331
21332 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-retriever-configuration} parameter} string type
21333 The type of mail retriever to use. Valid values include @samp{passwd}
21334 and @samp{static}.
21335
21336 Defaults to @samp{"SimpleIMAPSSLRetriever"}.
21337
21338 @end deftypevr
21339
21340 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-retriever-configuration} parameter} string server
21341 Username to login to the mail server with.
21342
21343 Defaults to @samp{unset}.
21344
21345 @end deftypevr
21346
21347 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-retriever-configuration} parameter} string username
21348 Username to login to the mail server with.
21349
21350 Defaults to @samp{unset}.
21351
21352 @end deftypevr
21353
21354 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-retriever-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer port
21355 Port number to connect to.
21356
21357 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
21358
21359 @end deftypevr
21360
21361 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-retriever-configuration} parameter} string password
21362 Override fields from passwd.
21363
21364 Defaults to @samp{""}.
21365
21366 @end deftypevr
21367
21368 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-retriever-configuration} parameter} list password-command
21369 Override fields from passwd.
21370
21371 Defaults to @samp{()}.
21372
21373 @end deftypevr
21374
21375 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-retriever-configuration} parameter} string keyfile
21376 PEM-formatted key file to use for the TLS negotiation.
21377
21378 Defaults to @samp{""}.
21379
21380 @end deftypevr
21381
21382 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-retriever-configuration} parameter} string certfile
21383 PEM-formatted certificate file to use for the TLS negotiation.
21384
21385 Defaults to @samp{""}.
21386
21387 @end deftypevr
21388
21389 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-retriever-configuration} parameter} string ca-certs
21390 CA certificates to use.
21391
21392 Defaults to @samp{""}.
21393
21394 @end deftypevr
21395
21396 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-retriever-configuration} parameter} parameter-alist extra-parameters
21397 Extra retriever parameters.
21398
21399 Defaults to @samp{()}.
21400
21401 @end deftypevr
21402
21403 @end deftypevr
21404
21405 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-configuration-file} parameter} getmail-destination-configuration destination
21406 What to do with retrieved messages.
21407
21408 Available @code{getmail-destination-configuration} fields are:
21409
21410 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-destination-configuration} parameter} string type
21411 The type of mail destination. Valid values include @samp{Maildir},
21412 @samp{Mboxrd} and @samp{MDA_external}.
21413
21414 Defaults to @samp{unset}.
21415
21416 @end deftypevr
21417
21418 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-destination-configuration} parameter} string-or-filelike path
21419 The path option for the mail destination. The behaviour depends on the
21420 chosen type.
21421
21422 Defaults to @samp{""}.
21423
21424 @end deftypevr
21425
21426 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-destination-configuration} parameter} parameter-alist extra-parameters
21427 Extra destination parameters
21428
21429 Defaults to @samp{()}.
21430
21431 @end deftypevr
21432
21433 @end deftypevr
21434
21435 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-configuration-file} parameter} getmail-options-configuration options
21436 Configure getmail.
21437
21438 Available @code{getmail-options-configuration} fields are:
21439
21440 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-options-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer verbose
21441 If set to @samp{0}, getmail will only print warnings and errors. A
21442 value of @samp{1} means that messages will be printed about retrieving
21443 and deleting messages. If set to @samp{2}, getmail will print messages
21444 about each of it's actions.
21445
21446 Defaults to @samp{1}.
21447
21448 @end deftypevr
21449
21450 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-options-configuration} parameter} boolean read-all
21451 If true, getmail will retrieve all available messages. Otherwise it
21452 will only retrieve messages it hasn't seen previously.
21453
21454 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
21455
21456 @end deftypevr
21457
21458 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-options-configuration} parameter} boolean delete
21459 If set to true, messages will be deleted from the server after
21460 retrieving and successfully delivering them. Otherwise, messages will
21461 be left on the server.
21462
21463 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
21464
21465 @end deftypevr
21466
21467 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-options-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer delete-after
21468 Getmail will delete messages this number of days after seeing them, if
21469 they have been delivered. This means messages will be left on the
21470 server this number of days after delivering them. A value of @samp{0}
21471 disabled this feature.
21472
21473 Defaults to @samp{0}.
21474
21475 @end deftypevr
21476
21477 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-options-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer delete-bigger-than
21478 Delete messages larger than this of bytes after retrieving them, even if
21479 the delete and delete-after options are disabled. A value of @samp{0}
21480 disables this feature.
21481
21482 Defaults to @samp{0}.
21483
21484 @end deftypevr
21485
21486 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-options-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer max-bytes-per-session
21487 Retrieve messages totalling up to this number of bytes before closing
21488 the session with the server. A value of @samp{0} disables this feature.
21489
21490 Defaults to @samp{0}.
21491
21492 @end deftypevr
21493
21494 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-options-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer max-message-size
21495 Don't retrieve messages larger than this number of bytes. A value of
21496 @samp{0} disables this feature.
21497
21498 Defaults to @samp{0}.
21499
21500 @end deftypevr
21501
21502 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-options-configuration} parameter} boolean delivered-to
21503 If true, getmail will add a Delivered-To header to messages.
21504
21505 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
21506
21507 @end deftypevr
21508
21509 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-options-configuration} parameter} boolean received
21510 If set, getmail adds a Received header to the messages.
21511
21512 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
21513
21514 @end deftypevr
21515
21516 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-options-configuration} parameter} string message-log
21517 Getmail will record a log of its actions to the named file. A value of
21518 @samp{""} disables this feature.
21519
21520 Defaults to @samp{""}.
21521
21522 @end deftypevr
21523
21524 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-options-configuration} parameter} boolean message-log-syslog
21525 If true, getmail will record a log of its actions using the system
21526 logger.
21527
21528 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
21529
21530 @end deftypevr
21531
21532 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-options-configuration} parameter} boolean message-log-verbose
21533 If true, getmail will log information about messages not retrieved and
21534 the reason for not retrieving them, as well as starting and ending
21535 information lines.
21536
21537 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
21538
21539 @end deftypevr
21540
21541 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-options-configuration} parameter} parameter-alist extra-parameters
21542 Extra options to include.
21543
21544 Defaults to @samp{()}.
21545
21546 @end deftypevr
21547
21548 @end deftypevr
21549
21550 @end deftypevr
21551
21552 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-configuration} parameter} list idle
21553 A list of mailboxes that getmail should wait on the server for new mail
21554 notifications. This depends on the server supporting the IDLE
21555 extension.
21556
21557 Defaults to @samp{()}.
21558
21559 @end deftypevr
21560
21561 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-configuration} parameter} list environment-variables
21562 Environment variables to set for getmail.
21563
21564 Defaults to @samp{()}.
21565
21566 @end deftypevr
21567
21568 @subsubheading Mail Aliases Service
21569
21570 @cindex email aliases
21571 @cindex aliases, for email addresses
21572
21573 @deffn {Scheme Variable} mail-aliases-service-type
21574 This is the type of the service which provides @code{/etc/aliases},
21575 specifying how to deliver mail to users on this system.
21576
21577 @lisp
21578 (service mail-aliases-service-type
21579 '(("postmaster" "bob")
21580 ("bob" "bob@@example.com" "bob@@example2.com")))
21581 @end lisp
21582 @end deffn
21583
21584 The configuration for a @code{mail-aliases-service-type} service is an
21585 association list denoting how to deliver mail that comes to this
21586 system. Each entry is of the form @code{(alias addresses ...)}, with
21587 @code{alias} specifying the local alias and @code{addresses} specifying
21588 where to deliver this user's mail.
21589
21590 The aliases aren't required to exist as users on the local system. In
21591 the above example, there doesn't need to be a @code{postmaster} entry in
21592 the @code{operating-system}'s @code{user-accounts} in order to deliver
21593 the @code{postmaster} mail to @code{bob} (which subsequently would
21594 deliver mail to @code{bob@@example.com} and @code{bob@@example2.com}).
21595
21596 @subsubheading GNU Mailutils IMAP4 Daemon
21597 @cindex GNU Mailutils IMAP4 Daemon
21598
21599 @deffn {Scheme Variable} imap4d-service-type
21600 This is the type of the GNU Mailutils IMAP4 Daemon (@pxref{imap4d,,,
21601 mailutils, GNU Mailutils Manual}), whose value should be an
21602 @code{imap4d-configuration} object as in this example:
21603
21604 @lisp
21605 (service imap4d-service-type
21606 (imap4d-configuration
21607 (config-file (local-file "imap4d.conf"))))
21608 @end lisp
21609 @end deffn
21610
21611 @deftp {Data Type} imap4d-configuration
21612 Data type representing the configuration of @command{imap4d}.
21613
21614 @table @asis
21615 @item @code{package} (default: @code{mailutils})
21616 The package that provides @command{imap4d}.
21617
21618 @item @code{config-file} (default: @code{%default-imap4d-config-file})
21619 File-like object of the configuration file to use, by default it will listen
21620 on TCP port 143 of @code{localhost}. @xref{Conf-imap4d,,, mailutils, GNU
21621 Mailutils Manual}, for details.
21622
21623 @end table
21624 @end deftp
21625
21626 @subsubheading Radicale Service
21627 @cindex CalDAV
21628 @cindex CardDAV
21629
21630 @deffn {Scheme Variable} radicale-service-type
21631 This is the type of the @uref{https://radicale.org, Radicale} CalDAV/CardDAV
21632 server whose value should be a @code{radicale-configuration}.
21633 @end deffn
21634
21635 @deftp {Data Type} radicale-configuration
21636 Data type representing the configuration of @command{radicale}.
21637
21638 @table @asis
21639 @item @code{package} (default: @code{radicale})
21640 The package that provides @command{radicale}.
21641
21642 @item @code{config-file} (default: @code{%default-radicale-config-file})
21643 File-like object of the configuration file to use, by default it will listen
21644 on TCP port 5232 of @code{localhost} and use the @code{htpasswd} file at
21645 @file{/var/lib/radicale/users} with no (@code{plain}) encryption.
21646
21647 @end table
21648 @end deftp
21649
21650 @node Messaging Services
21651 @subsection Messaging Services
21652
21653 @cindex messaging
21654 @cindex jabber
21655 @cindex XMPP
21656 The @code{(gnu services messaging)} module provides Guix service
21657 definitions for messaging services. Currently it provides the following
21658 services:
21659
21660 @subsubheading Prosody Service
21661
21662 @deffn {Scheme Variable} prosody-service-type
21663 This is the type for the @uref{https://prosody.im, Prosody XMPP
21664 communication server}. Its value must be a @code{prosody-configuration}
21665 record as in this example:
21666
21667 @lisp
21668 (service prosody-service-type
21669 (prosody-configuration
21670 (modules-enabled (cons* "groups" "mam" %default-modules-enabled))
21671 (int-components
21672 (list
21673 (int-component-configuration
21674 (hostname "conference.example.net")
21675 (plugin "muc")
21676 (mod-muc (mod-muc-configuration)))))
21677 (virtualhosts
21678 (list
21679 (virtualhost-configuration
21680 (domain "example.net"))))))
21681 @end lisp
21682
21683 See below for details about @code{prosody-configuration}.
21684
21685 @end deffn
21686
21687 By default, Prosody does not need much configuration. Only one
21688 @code{virtualhosts} field is needed: it specifies the domain you wish
21689 Prosody to serve.
21690
21691 You can perform various sanity checks on the generated configuration
21692 with the @code{prosodyctl check} command.
21693
21694 Prosodyctl will also help you to import certificates from the
21695 @code{letsencrypt} directory so that the @code{prosody} user can access
21696 them. See @url{https://prosody.im/doc/letsencrypt}.
21697
21698 @example
21699 prosodyctl --root cert import /etc/letsencrypt/live
21700 @end example
21701
21702 The available configuration parameters follow. Each parameter
21703 definition is preceded by its type; for example, @samp{string-list foo}
21704 indicates that the @code{foo} parameter should be specified as a list of
21705 strings. Types starting with @code{maybe-} denote parameters that won't
21706 show up in @code{prosody.cfg.lua} when their value is @code{'disabled}.
21707
21708 There is also a way to specify the configuration as a string, if you
21709 have an old @code{prosody.cfg.lua} file that you want to port over from
21710 some other system; see the end for more details.
21711
21712 The @code{file-object} type designates either a file-like object
21713 (@pxref{G-Expressions, file-like objects}) or a file name.
21714
21715 @c The following documentation was initially generated by
21716 @c (generate-documentation) in (gnu services messaging). Manually maintained
21717 @c documentation is better, so we shouldn't hesitate to edit below as
21718 @c needed. However if the change you want to make to this documentation
21719 @c can be done in an automated way, it's probably easier to change
21720 @c (generate-documentation) than to make it below and have to deal with
21721 @c the churn as Prosody updates.
21722
21723 Available @code{prosody-configuration} fields are:
21724
21725 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} package prosody
21726 The Prosody package.
21727 @end deftypevr
21728
21729 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} file-name data-path
21730 Location of the Prosody data storage directory. See
21731 @url{https://prosody.im/doc/configure}.
21732 Defaults to @samp{"/var/lib/prosody"}.
21733 @end deftypevr
21734
21735 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} file-object-list plugin-paths
21736 Additional plugin directories. They are searched in all the specified
21737 paths in order. See @url{https://prosody.im/doc/plugins_directory}.
21738 Defaults to @samp{()}.
21739 @end deftypevr
21740
21741 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} file-name certificates
21742 Every virtual host and component needs a certificate so that clients and
21743 servers can securely verify its identity. Prosody will automatically load
21744 certificates/keys from the directory specified here.
21745 Defaults to @samp{"/etc/prosody/certs"}.
21746 @end deftypevr
21747
21748 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} string-list admins
21749 This is a list of accounts that are admins for the server. Note that you
21750 must create the accounts separately. See @url{https://prosody.im/doc/admins} and
21751 @url{https://prosody.im/doc/creating_accounts}.
21752 Example: @code{(admins '("user1@@example.com" "user2@@example.net"))}
21753 Defaults to @samp{()}.
21754 @end deftypevr
21755
21756 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} boolean use-libevent?
21757 Enable use of libevent for better performance under high load. See
21758 @url{https://prosody.im/doc/libevent}.
21759 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
21760 @end deftypevr
21761
21762 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} module-list modules-enabled
21763 This is the list of modules Prosody will load on startup. It looks for
21764 @code{mod_modulename.lua} in the plugins folder, so make sure that exists too.
21765 Documentation on modules can be found at:
21766 @url{https://prosody.im/doc/modules}.
21767 Defaults to @samp{("roster" "saslauth" "tls" "dialback" "disco" "carbons" "private" "blocklist" "vcard" "version" "uptime" "time" "ping" "pep" "register" "admin_adhoc")}.
21768 @end deftypevr
21769
21770 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} string-list modules-disabled
21771 @samp{"offline"}, @samp{"c2s"} and @samp{"s2s"} are auto-loaded, but
21772 should you want to disable them then add them to this list.
21773 Defaults to @samp{()}.
21774 @end deftypevr
21775
21776 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} file-object groups-file
21777 Path to a text file where the shared groups are defined. If this path is
21778 empty then @samp{mod_groups} does nothing. See
21779 @url{https://prosody.im/doc/modules/mod_groups}.
21780 Defaults to @samp{"/var/lib/prosody/sharedgroups.txt"}.
21781 @end deftypevr
21782
21783 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} boolean allow-registration?
21784 Disable account creation by default, for security. See
21785 @url{https://prosody.im/doc/creating_accounts}.
21786 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
21787 @end deftypevr
21788
21789 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} maybe-ssl-configuration ssl
21790 These are the SSL/TLS-related settings. Most of them are disabled so to
21791 use Prosody's defaults. If you do not completely understand these options, do
21792 not add them to your config, it is easy to lower the security of your server
21793 using them. See @url{https://prosody.im/doc/advanced_ssl_config}.
21794
21795 Available @code{ssl-configuration} fields are:
21796
21797 @deftypevr {@code{ssl-configuration} parameter} maybe-string protocol
21798 This determines what handshake to use.
21799 @end deftypevr
21800
21801 @deftypevr {@code{ssl-configuration} parameter} maybe-file-name key
21802 Path to your private key file.
21803 @end deftypevr
21804
21805 @deftypevr {@code{ssl-configuration} parameter} maybe-file-name certificate
21806 Path to your certificate file.
21807 @end deftypevr
21808
21809 @deftypevr {@code{ssl-configuration} parameter} file-object capath
21810 Path to directory containing root certificates that you wish Prosody to
21811 trust when verifying the certificates of remote servers.
21812 Defaults to @samp{"/etc/ssl/certs"}.
21813 @end deftypevr
21814
21815 @deftypevr {@code{ssl-configuration} parameter} maybe-file-object cafile
21816 Path to a file containing root certificates that you wish Prosody to trust.
21817 Similar to @code{capath} but with all certificates concatenated together.
21818 @end deftypevr
21819
21820 @deftypevr {@code{ssl-configuration} parameter} maybe-string-list verify
21821 A list of verification options (these mostly map to OpenSSL's
21822 @code{set_verify()} flags).
21823 @end deftypevr
21824
21825 @deftypevr {@code{ssl-configuration} parameter} maybe-string-list options
21826 A list of general options relating to SSL/TLS@. These map to OpenSSL's
21827 @code{set_options()}. For a full list of options available in LuaSec, see the
21828 LuaSec source.
21829 @end deftypevr
21830
21831 @deftypevr {@code{ssl-configuration} parameter} maybe-non-negative-integer depth
21832 How long a chain of certificate authorities to check when looking for a
21833 trusted root certificate.
21834 @end deftypevr
21835
21836 @deftypevr {@code{ssl-configuration} parameter} maybe-string ciphers
21837 An OpenSSL cipher string. This selects what ciphers Prosody will offer to
21838 clients, and in what order.
21839 @end deftypevr
21840
21841 @deftypevr {@code{ssl-configuration} parameter} maybe-file-name dhparam
21842 A path to a file containing parameters for Diffie-Hellman key exchange. You
21843 can create such a file with:
21844 @code{openssl dhparam -out /etc/prosody/certs/dh-2048.pem 2048}
21845 @end deftypevr
21846
21847 @deftypevr {@code{ssl-configuration} parameter} maybe-string curve
21848 Curve for Elliptic curve Diffie-Hellman. Prosody's default is
21849 @samp{"secp384r1"}.
21850 @end deftypevr
21851
21852 @deftypevr {@code{ssl-configuration} parameter} maybe-string-list verifyext
21853 A list of ``extra'' verification options.
21854 @end deftypevr
21855
21856 @deftypevr {@code{ssl-configuration} parameter} maybe-string password
21857 Password for encrypted private keys.
21858 @end deftypevr
21859
21860 @end deftypevr
21861
21862 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} boolean c2s-require-encryption?
21863 Whether to force all client-to-server connections to be encrypted or not.
21864 See @url{https://prosody.im/doc/modules/mod_tls}.
21865 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
21866 @end deftypevr
21867
21868 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} string-list disable-sasl-mechanisms
21869 Set of mechanisms that will never be offered. See
21870 @url{https://prosody.im/doc/modules/mod_saslauth}.
21871 Defaults to @samp{("DIGEST-MD5")}.
21872 @end deftypevr
21873
21874 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} boolean s2s-require-encryption?
21875 Whether to force all server-to-server connections to be encrypted or not.
21876 See @url{https://prosody.im/doc/modules/mod_tls}.
21877 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
21878 @end deftypevr
21879
21880 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} boolean s2s-secure-auth?
21881 Whether to require encryption and certificate authentication. This
21882 provides ideal security, but requires servers you communicate with to support
21883 encryption AND present valid, trusted certificates. See
21884 @url{https://prosody.im/doc/s2s#security}.
21885 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
21886 @end deftypevr
21887
21888 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} string-list s2s-insecure-domains
21889 Many servers don't support encryption or have invalid or self-signed
21890 certificates. You can list domains here that will not be required to
21891 authenticate using certificates. They will be authenticated using DNS@. See
21892 @url{https://prosody.im/doc/s2s#security}.
21893 Defaults to @samp{()}.
21894 @end deftypevr
21895
21896 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} string-list s2s-secure-domains
21897 Even if you leave @code{s2s-secure-auth?} disabled, you can still require
21898 valid certificates for some domains by specifying a list here. See
21899 @url{https://prosody.im/doc/s2s#security}.
21900 Defaults to @samp{()}.
21901 @end deftypevr
21902
21903 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} string authentication
21904 Select the authentication backend to use. The default provider stores
21905 passwords in plaintext and uses Prosody's configured data storage to store the
21906 authentication data. If you do not trust your server please see
21907 @url{https://prosody.im/doc/modules/mod_auth_internal_hashed} for information
21908 about using the hashed backend. See also
21909 @url{https://prosody.im/doc/authentication}
21910 Defaults to @samp{"internal_plain"}.
21911 @end deftypevr
21912
21913 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} maybe-string log
21914 Set logging options. Advanced logging configuration is not yet supported
21915 by the Prosody service. See @url{https://prosody.im/doc/logging}.
21916 Defaults to @samp{"*syslog"}.
21917 @end deftypevr
21918
21919 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} file-name pidfile
21920 File to write pid in. See @url{https://prosody.im/doc/modules/mod_posix}.
21921 Defaults to @samp{"/var/run/prosody/prosody.pid"}.
21922 @end deftypevr
21923
21924 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} maybe-non-negative-integer http-max-content-size
21925 Maximum allowed size of the HTTP body (in bytes).
21926 @end deftypevr
21927
21928 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} maybe-string http-external-url
21929 Some modules expose their own URL in various ways. This URL is built
21930 from the protocol, host and port used. If Prosody sits behind a proxy, the
21931 public URL will be @code{http-external-url} instead. See
21932 @url{https://prosody.im/doc/http#external_url}.
21933 @end deftypevr
21934
21935 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} virtualhost-configuration-list virtualhosts
21936 A host in Prosody is a domain on which user accounts can be created. For
21937 example if you want your users to have addresses like
21938 @samp{"john.smith@@example.com"} then you need to add a host
21939 @samp{"example.com"}. All options in this list will apply only to this host.
21940
21941 Note: the name @emph{virtual} host is used in configuration to avoid confusion with
21942 the actual physical host that Prosody is installed on. A single Prosody
21943 instance can serve many domains, each one defined as a VirtualHost entry in
21944 Prosody's configuration. Conversely a server that hosts a single domain would
21945 have just one VirtualHost entry.
21946
21947 See @url{https://prosody.im/doc/configure#virtual_host_settings}.
21948
21949 Available @code{virtualhost-configuration} fields are:
21950
21951 all these @code{prosody-configuration} fields: @code{admins}, @code{use-libevent?}, @code{modules-enabled}, @code{modules-disabled}, @code{groups-file}, @code{allow-registration?}, @code{ssl}, @code{c2s-require-encryption?}, @code{disable-sasl-mechanisms}, @code{s2s-require-encryption?}, @code{s2s-secure-auth?}, @code{s2s-insecure-domains}, @code{s2s-secure-domains}, @code{authentication}, @code{log}, @code{http-max-content-size}, @code{http-external-url}, @code{raw-content}, plus:
21952 @deftypevr {@code{virtualhost-configuration} parameter} string domain
21953 Domain you wish Prosody to serve.
21954 @end deftypevr
21955
21956 @end deftypevr
21957
21958 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} int-component-configuration-list int-components
21959 Components are extra services on a server which are available to clients,
21960 usually on a subdomain of the main server (such as
21961 @samp{"mycomponent.example.com"}). Example components might be chatroom
21962 servers, user directories, or gateways to other protocols.
21963
21964 Internal components are implemented with Prosody-specific plugins. To add an
21965 internal component, you simply fill the hostname field, and the plugin you wish
21966 to use for the component.
21967
21968 See @url{https://prosody.im/doc/components}.
21969 Defaults to @samp{()}.
21970
21971 Available @code{int-component-configuration} fields are:
21972
21973 all these @code{prosody-configuration} fields: @code{admins}, @code{use-libevent?}, @code{modules-enabled}, @code{modules-disabled}, @code{groups-file}, @code{allow-registration?}, @code{ssl}, @code{c2s-require-encryption?}, @code{disable-sasl-mechanisms}, @code{s2s-require-encryption?}, @code{s2s-secure-auth?}, @code{s2s-insecure-domains}, @code{s2s-secure-domains}, @code{authentication}, @code{log}, @code{http-max-content-size}, @code{http-external-url}, @code{raw-content}, plus:
21974 @deftypevr {@code{int-component-configuration} parameter} string hostname
21975 Hostname of the component.
21976 @end deftypevr
21977
21978 @deftypevr {@code{int-component-configuration} parameter} string plugin
21979 Plugin you wish to use for the component.
21980 @end deftypevr
21981
21982 @deftypevr {@code{int-component-configuration} parameter} maybe-mod-muc-configuration mod-muc
21983 Multi-user chat (MUC) is Prosody's module for allowing you to create
21984 hosted chatrooms/conferences for XMPP users.
21985
21986 General information on setting up and using multi-user chatrooms can be found
21987 in the ``Chatrooms'' documentation (@url{https://prosody.im/doc/chatrooms}),
21988 which you should read if you are new to XMPP chatrooms.
21989
21990 See also @url{https://prosody.im/doc/modules/mod_muc}.
21991
21992 Available @code{mod-muc-configuration} fields are:
21993
21994 @deftypevr {@code{mod-muc-configuration} parameter} string name
21995 The name to return in service discovery responses.
21996 Defaults to @samp{"Prosody Chatrooms"}.
21997 @end deftypevr
21998
21999 @deftypevr {@code{mod-muc-configuration} parameter} string-or-boolean restrict-room-creation
22000 If @samp{#t}, this will only allow admins to create new chatrooms.
22001 Otherwise anyone can create a room. The value @samp{"local"} restricts room
22002 creation to users on the service's parent domain. E.g.@: @samp{user@@example.com}
22003 can create rooms on @samp{rooms.example.com}. The value @samp{"admin"}
22004 restricts to service administrators only.
22005 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
22006 @end deftypevr
22007
22008 @deftypevr {@code{mod-muc-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer max-history-messages
22009 Maximum number of history messages that will be sent to the member that has
22010 just joined the room.
22011 Defaults to @samp{20}.
22012 @end deftypevr
22013
22014 @end deftypevr
22015
22016 @end deftypevr
22017
22018 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} ext-component-configuration-list ext-components
22019 External components use XEP-0114, which most standalone components
22020 support. To add an external component, you simply fill the hostname field. See
22021 @url{https://prosody.im/doc/components}.
22022 Defaults to @samp{()}.
22023
22024 Available @code{ext-component-configuration} fields are:
22025
22026 all these @code{prosody-configuration} fields: @code{admins}, @code{use-libevent?}, @code{modules-enabled}, @code{modules-disabled}, @code{groups-file}, @code{allow-registration?}, @code{ssl}, @code{c2s-require-encryption?}, @code{disable-sasl-mechanisms}, @code{s2s-require-encryption?}, @code{s2s-secure-auth?}, @code{s2s-insecure-domains}, @code{s2s-secure-domains}, @code{authentication}, @code{log}, @code{http-max-content-size}, @code{http-external-url}, @code{raw-content}, plus:
22027 @deftypevr {@code{ext-component-configuration} parameter} string component-secret
22028 Password which the component will use to log in.
22029 @end deftypevr
22030
22031 @deftypevr {@code{ext-component-configuration} parameter} string hostname
22032 Hostname of the component.
22033 @end deftypevr
22034
22035 @end deftypevr
22036
22037 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer-list component-ports
22038 Port(s) Prosody listens on for component connections.
22039 Defaults to @samp{(5347)}.
22040 @end deftypevr
22041
22042 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} string component-interface
22043 Interface Prosody listens on for component connections.
22044 Defaults to @samp{"127.0.0.1"}.
22045 @end deftypevr
22046
22047 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} maybe-raw-content raw-content
22048 Raw content that will be added to the configuration file.
22049 @end deftypevr
22050
22051 It could be that you just want to get a @code{prosody.cfg.lua}
22052 up and running. In that case, you can pass an
22053 @code{opaque-prosody-configuration} record as the value of
22054 @code{prosody-service-type}. As its name indicates, an opaque configuration
22055 does not have easy reflective capabilities.
22056 Available @code{opaque-prosody-configuration} fields are:
22057
22058 @deftypevr {@code{opaque-prosody-configuration} parameter} package prosody
22059 The prosody package.
22060 @end deftypevr
22061
22062 @deftypevr {@code{opaque-prosody-configuration} parameter} string prosody.cfg.lua
22063 The contents of the @code{prosody.cfg.lua} to use.
22064 @end deftypevr
22065
22066 For example, if your @code{prosody.cfg.lua} is just the empty
22067 string, you could instantiate a prosody service like this:
22068
22069 @lisp
22070 (service prosody-service-type
22071 (opaque-prosody-configuration
22072 (prosody.cfg.lua "")))
22073 @end lisp
22074
22075 @c end of Prosody auto-generated documentation
22076
22077 @subsubheading BitlBee Service
22078
22079 @cindex IRC (Internet Relay Chat)
22080 @cindex IRC gateway
22081 @url{https://bitlbee.org,BitlBee} is a gateway that provides an IRC
22082 interface to a variety of messaging protocols such as XMPP.
22083
22084 @defvr {Scheme Variable} bitlbee-service-type
22085 This is the service type for the @url{https://bitlbee.org,BitlBee} IRC
22086 gateway daemon. Its value is a @code{bitlbee-configuration} (see
22087 below).
22088
22089 To have BitlBee listen on port 6667 on localhost, add this line to your
22090 services:
22091
22092 @lisp
22093 (service bitlbee-service-type)
22094 @end lisp
22095 @end defvr
22096
22097 @deftp {Data Type} bitlbee-configuration
22098 This is the configuration for BitlBee, with the following fields:
22099
22100 @table @asis
22101 @item @code{interface} (default: @code{"127.0.0.1"})
22102 @itemx @code{port} (default: @code{6667})
22103 Listen on the network interface corresponding to the IP address
22104 specified in @var{interface}, on @var{port}.
22105
22106 When @var{interface} is @code{127.0.0.1}, only local clients can
22107 connect; when it is @code{0.0.0.0}, connections can come from any
22108 networking interface.
22109
22110 @item @code{bitlbee} (default: @code{bitlbee})
22111 The BitlBee package to use.
22112
22113 @item @code{plugins} (default: @code{'()})
22114 List of plugin packages to use---e.g., @code{bitlbee-discord}.
22115
22116 @item @code{extra-settings} (default: @code{""})
22117 Configuration snippet added as-is to the BitlBee configuration file.
22118 @end table
22119 @end deftp
22120
22121 @subsubheading Quassel Service
22122
22123 @cindex IRC (Internet Relay Chat)
22124 @url{https://quassel-irc.org/,Quassel} is a distributed IRC client,
22125 meaning that one or more clients can attach to and detach from the
22126 central core.
22127
22128 @defvr {Scheme Variable} quassel-service-type
22129 This is the service type for the @url{https://quassel-irc.org/,Quassel}
22130 IRC backend daemon. Its value is a @code{quassel-configuration}
22131 (see below).
22132 @end defvr
22133
22134 @deftp {Data Type} quassel-configuration
22135 This is the configuration for Quassel, with the following fields:
22136
22137 @table @asis
22138 @item @code{quassel} (default: @code{quassel})
22139 The Quassel package to use.
22140
22141 @item @code{interface} (default: @code{"::,0.0.0.0"})
22142 @item @code{port} (default: @code{4242})
22143 Listen on the network interface(s) corresponding to the IPv4 or IPv6
22144 interfaces specified in the comma delimited @var{interface}, on
22145 @var{port}.
22146
22147 @item @code{loglevel} (default: @code{"Info"})
22148 The level of logging desired. Accepted values are Debug, Info, Warning
22149 and Error.
22150 @end table
22151 @end deftp
22152
22153 @node Telephony Services
22154 @subsection Telephony Services
22155
22156 @cindex Murmur (VoIP server)
22157 @cindex VoIP server
22158 This section describes how to set up and run a Murmur server. Murmur is
22159 the server of the @uref{https://mumble.info, Mumble} voice-over-IP
22160 (VoIP) suite.
22161
22162 @deftp {Data Type} murmur-configuration
22163 The service type for the Murmur server. An example configuration can
22164 look like this:
22165
22166 @lisp
22167 (service murmur-service-type
22168 (murmur-configuration
22169 (welcome-text
22170 "Welcome to this Mumble server running on Guix!")
22171 (cert-required? #t) ;disallow text password logins
22172 (ssl-cert "/etc/letsencrypt/live/mumble.example.com/fullchain.pem")
22173 (ssl-key "/etc/letsencrypt/live/mumble.example.com/privkey.pem")))
22174 @end lisp
22175
22176 After reconfiguring your system, you can manually set the murmur @code{SuperUser}
22177 password with the command that is printed during the activation phase.
22178
22179 It is recommended to register a normal Mumble user account
22180 and grant it admin or moderator rights.
22181 You can use the @code{mumble} client to
22182 login as new normal user, register yourself, and log out.
22183 For the next step login with the name @code{SuperUser} use
22184 the @code{SuperUser} password that you set previously,
22185 and grant your newly registered mumble user administrator or moderator
22186 rights and create some channels.
22187
22188 Available @code{murmur-configuration} fields are:
22189
22190 @table @asis
22191 @item @code{package} (default: @code{mumble})
22192 Package that contains @code{bin/murmurd}.
22193
22194 @item @code{user} (default: @code{"murmur"})
22195 User who will run the Murmur server.
22196
22197 @item @code{group} (default: @code{"murmur"})
22198 Group of the user who will run the murmur server.
22199
22200 @item @code{port} (default: @code{64738})
22201 Port on which the server will listen.
22202
22203 @item @code{welcome-text} (default: @code{""})
22204 Welcome text sent to clients when they connect.
22205
22206 @item @code{server-password} (default: @code{""})
22207 Password the clients have to enter in order to connect.
22208
22209 @item @code{max-users} (default: @code{100})
22210 Maximum of users that can be connected to the server at once.
22211
22212 @item @code{max-user-bandwidth} (default: @code{#f})
22213 Maximum voice traffic a user can send per second.
22214
22215 @item @code{database-file} (default: @code{"/var/lib/murmur/db.sqlite"})
22216 File name of the sqlite database.
22217 The service's user will become the owner of the directory.
22218
22219 @item @code{log-file} (default: @code{"/var/log/murmur/murmur.log"})
22220 File name of the log file.
22221 The service's user will become the owner of the directory.
22222
22223 @item @code{autoban-attempts} (default: @code{10})
22224 Maximum number of logins a user can make in @code{autoban-timeframe}
22225 without getting auto banned for @code{autoban-time}.
22226
22227 @item @code{autoban-timeframe} (default: @code{120})
22228 Timeframe for autoban in seconds.
22229
22230 @item @code{autoban-time} (default: @code{300})
22231 Amount of time in seconds for which a client gets banned
22232 when violating the autoban limits.
22233
22234 @item @code{opus-threshold} (default: @code{100})
22235 Percentage of clients that need to support opus
22236 before switching over to opus audio codec.
22237
22238 @item @code{channel-nesting-limit} (default: @code{10})
22239 How deep channels can be nested at maximum.
22240
22241 @item @code{channelname-regex} (default: @code{#f})
22242 A string in form of a Qt regular expression that channel names must conform to.
22243
22244 @item @code{username-regex} (default: @code{#f})
22245 A string in form of a Qt regular expression that user names must conform to.
22246
22247 @item @code{text-message-length} (default: @code{5000})
22248 Maximum size in bytes that a user can send in one text chat message.
22249
22250 @item @code{image-message-length} (default: @code{(* 128 1024)})
22251 Maximum size in bytes that a user can send in one image message.
22252
22253 @item @code{cert-required?} (default: @code{#f})
22254 If it is set to @code{#t} clients that use weak password authentication
22255 will not be accepted. Users must have completed the certificate wizard to join.
22256
22257 @item @code{remember-channel?} (default: @code{#f})
22258 Should murmur remember the last channel each user was in when they disconnected
22259 and put them into the remembered channel when they rejoin.
22260
22261 @item @code{allow-html?} (default: @code{#f})
22262 Should html be allowed in text messages, user comments, and channel descriptions.
22263
22264 @item @code{allow-ping?} (default: @code{#f})
22265 Setting to true exposes the current user count, the maximum user count, and
22266 the server's maximum bandwidth per client to unauthenticated users. In the
22267 Mumble client, this information is shown in the Connect dialog.
22268
22269 Disabling this setting will prevent public listing of the server.
22270
22271 @item @code{bonjour?} (default: @code{#f})
22272 Should the server advertise itself in the local network through the bonjour protocol.
22273
22274 @item @code{send-version?} (default: @code{#f})
22275 Should the murmur server version be exposed in ping requests.
22276
22277 @item @code{log-days} (default: @code{31})
22278 Murmur also stores logs in the database, which are accessible via RPC.
22279 The default is 31 days of months, but you can set this setting to 0 to keep logs forever,
22280 or -1 to disable logging to the database.
22281
22282 @item @code{obfuscate-ips?} (default: @code{#t})
22283 Should logged ips be obfuscated to protect the privacy of users.
22284
22285 @item @code{ssl-cert} (default: @code{#f})
22286 File name of the SSL/TLS certificate used for encrypted connections.
22287
22288 @lisp
22289 (ssl-cert "/etc/letsencrypt/live/example.com/fullchain.pem")
22290 @end lisp
22291 @item @code{ssl-key} (default: @code{#f})
22292 Filepath to the ssl private key used for encrypted connections.
22293 @lisp
22294 (ssl-key "/etc/letsencrypt/live/example.com/privkey.pem")
22295 @end lisp
22296
22297 @item @code{ssl-dh-params} (default: @code{#f})
22298 File name of a PEM-encoded file with Diffie-Hellman parameters
22299 for the SSL/TLS encryption. Alternatively you set it to
22300 @code{"@@ffdhe2048"}, @code{"@@ffdhe3072"}, @code{"@@ffdhe4096"}, @code{"@@ffdhe6144"}
22301 or @code{"@@ffdhe8192"} to use bundled parameters from RFC 7919.
22302
22303 @item @code{ssl-ciphers} (default: @code{#f})
22304 The @code{ssl-ciphers} option chooses the cipher suites to make available for use
22305 in SSL/TLS.
22306
22307 This option is specified using
22308 @uref{https://www.openssl.org/docs/apps/ciphers.html#CIPHER-LIST-FORMAT,
22309 OpenSSL cipher list notation}.
22310
22311 It is recommended that you try your cipher string using 'openssl ciphers <string>'
22312 before setting it here, to get a feel for which cipher suites you will get.
22313 After setting this option, it is recommend that you inspect your Murmur log
22314 to ensure that Murmur is using the cipher suites that you expected it to.
22315
22316 Note: Changing this option may impact the backwards compatibility of your
22317 Murmur server, and can remove the ability for older Mumble clients to be able
22318 to connect to it.
22319
22320 @item @code{public-registration} (default: @code{#f})
22321 Must be a @code{<murmur-public-registration-configuration>} record or @code{#f}.
22322
22323 You can optionally register your server in the public server list that the
22324 @code{mumble} client shows on startup.
22325 You cannot register your server if you have set a @code{server-password},
22326 or set @code{allow-ping} to @code{#f}.
22327
22328 It might take a few hours until it shows up in the public list.
22329
22330 @item @code{file} (default: @code{#f})
22331 Optional alternative override for this configuration.
22332 @end table
22333 @end deftp
22334
22335 @deftp {Data Type} murmur-public-registration-configuration
22336 Configuration for public registration of a murmur service.
22337
22338 @table @asis
22339 @item @code{name}
22340 This is a display name for your server. Not to be confused with the hostname.
22341
22342 @item @code{password}
22343 A password to identify your registration.
22344 Subsequent updates will need the same password. Don't lose your password.
22345
22346 @item @code{url}
22347 This should be a @code{http://} or @code{https://} link to your web
22348 site.
22349
22350 @item @code{hostname} (default: @code{#f})
22351 By default your server will be listed by its IP address.
22352 If it is set your server will be linked by this host name instead.
22353 @end table
22354 @end deftp
22355
22356
22357
22358 @node File-Sharing Services
22359 @subsection File-Sharing Services
22360
22361 The @code{(gnu services file-sharing)} module provides services that
22362 assist with transferring files over peer-to-peer file-sharing networks.
22363
22364 @subsubheading Transmission Daemon Service
22365
22366 @uref{https://transmissionbt.com/, Transmission} is a flexible
22367 BitTorrent client that offers a variety of graphical and command-line
22368 interfaces. A @code{transmission-daemon-service-type} service provides
22369 Transmission's headless variant, @command{transmission-daemon}, as a
22370 system service, allowing users to share files via BitTorrent even when
22371 they are not logged in.
22372
22373 @deffn {Scheme Variable} transmission-daemon-service-type
22374 The service type for the Transmission Daemon BitTorrent client. Its
22375 value must be a @code{transmission-daemon-configuration} object as in
22376 this example:
22377
22378 @lisp
22379 (service transmission-daemon-service-type
22380 (transmission-daemon-configuration
22381 ;; Restrict access to the RPC ("control") interface
22382 (rpc-authentication-required? #t)
22383 (rpc-username "transmission")
22384 (rpc-password
22385 (transmission-password-hash
22386 "transmission" ; desired password
22387 "uKd1uMs9")) ; arbitrary salt value
22388
22389 ;; Accept requests from this and other hosts on the
22390 ;; local network
22391 (rpc-whitelist-enabled? #t)
22392 (rpc-whitelist '("::1" "127.0.0.1" "192.168.0.*"))
22393
22394 ;; Limit bandwidth use during work hours
22395 (alt-speed-down (* 1024 2)) ; 2 MB/s
22396 (alt-speed-up 512) ; 512 kB/s
22397
22398 (alt-speed-time-enabled? #t)
22399 (alt-speed-time-day 'weekdays)
22400 (alt-speed-time-begin
22401 (+ (* 60 8) 30)) ; 8:30 am
22402 (alt-speed-time-end
22403 (+ (* 60 (+ 12 5)) 30)))) ; 5:30 pm
22404 @end lisp
22405 @end deffn
22406
22407 Once the service is started, users can interact with the daemon through
22408 its Web interface (at @code{http://localhost:9091/}) or by using the
22409 @command{transmission-remote} command-line tool, available in the
22410 @code{transmission} package. (Emacs users may want to also consider the
22411 @code{emacs-transmission} package.) Both communicate with the daemon
22412 through its remote procedure call (RPC) interface, which by default is
22413 available to all users on the system; you may wish to change this by
22414 assigning values to the @code{rpc-authentication-required?},
22415 @code{rpc-username} and @code{rpc-password} settings, as shown in the
22416 example above and documented further below.
22417
22418 The value for @code{rpc-password} must be a password hash of the type
22419 generated and used by Transmission clients. This can be copied verbatim
22420 from an existing @file{settings.json} file, if another Transmission
22421 client is already being used. Otherwise, the
22422 @code{transmission-password-hash} and @code{transmission-random-salt}
22423 procedures provided by this module can be used to obtain a suitable hash
22424 value.
22425
22426 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} transmission-password-hash @var{password} @var{salt}
22427 Returns a string containing the result of hashing @var{password}
22428 together with @var{salt}, in the format recognized by Transmission
22429 clients for their @code{rpc-password} configuration setting.
22430
22431 @var{salt} must be an eight-character string. The
22432 @code{transmission-random-salt} procedure can be used to generate a
22433 suitable salt value at random.
22434 @end deffn
22435
22436 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} transmission-random-salt
22437 Returns a string containing a random, eight-character salt value of the
22438 type generated and used by Transmission clients, suitable for passing to
22439 the @code{transmission-password-hash} procedure.
22440 @end deffn
22441
22442 These procedures are accessible from within a Guile REPL started with
22443 the @command{guix repl} command (@pxref{Invoking guix repl}). This is
22444 useful for obtaining a random salt value to provide as the second
22445 parameter to `transmission-password-hash`, as in this example session:
22446
22447 @example
22448 $ guix repl
22449 scheme@@(guix-user)> ,use (gnu services file-sharing)
22450 scheme@@(guix-user)> (transmission-random-salt)
22451 $1 = "uKd1uMs9"
22452 @end example
22453
22454 Alternatively, a complete password hash can generated in a single step:
22455
22456 @example
22457 scheme@@(guix-user)> (transmission-password-hash "transmission"
22458 (transmission-random-salt))
22459 $2 = "@{c8bbc6d1740cd8dc819a6e25563b67812c1c19c9VtFPfdsX"
22460 @end example
22461
22462 The resulting string can be used as-is for the value of
22463 @code{rpc-password}, allowing the password to be kept hidden even in the
22464 operating-system configuration.
22465
22466 Torrent files downloaded by the daemon are directly accessible only to
22467 users in the ``transmission'' user group, who receive read-only access
22468 to the directory specified by the @code{download-dir} configuration
22469 setting (and also the directory specified by @code{incomplete-dir}, if
22470 @code{incomplete-dir-enabled?} is @code{#t}). Downloaded files can be
22471 moved to another directory or deleted altogether using
22472 @command{transmission-remote} with its @code{--move} and
22473 @code{--remove-and-delete} options.
22474
22475 If the @code{watch-dir-enabled?} setting is set to @code{#t}, users in
22476 the ``transmission'' group are able also to place @file{.torrent} files
22477 in the directory specified by @code{watch-dir} to have the corresponding
22478 torrents added by the daemon. (The @code{trash-original-torrent-files?}
22479 setting controls whether the daemon deletes these files after processing
22480 them.)
22481
22482 Some of the daemon's configuration settings can be changed temporarily
22483 by @command{transmission-remote} and similar tools. To undo these
22484 changes, use the service's @code{reload} action to have the daemon
22485 reload its settings from disk:
22486
22487 @example
22488 # herd reload transmission-daemon
22489 @end example
22490
22491 The full set of available configuration settings is defined by the
22492 @code{transmission-daemon-configuration} data type.
22493
22494 @deftp {Data Type} transmission-daemon-configuration
22495 The data type representing configuration settings for Transmission
22496 Daemon. These correspond directly to the settings recognized by
22497 Transmission clients in their @file{settings.json} file.
22498 @end deftp
22499
22500 @c The following documentation was initially generated by
22501 @c (generate-transmission-daemon-documentation) in (gnu services
22502 @c file-sharing). Manually maintained documentation is better, so we
22503 @c shouldn't hesitate to edit below as needed. However if the change
22504 @c you want to make to this documentation can be done in an automated
22505 @c way, it's probably easier to change (generate-documentation) than to
22506 @c make it below and have to deal with the churn as Transmission Daemon
22507 @c updates.
22508
22509 @c %start of fragment
22510
22511 Available @code{transmission-daemon-configuration} fields are:
22512
22513 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} package transmission
22514 The Transmission package to use.
22515
22516 @end deftypevr
22517
22518 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer stop-wait-period
22519 The period, in seconds, to wait when stopping the service for
22520 @command{transmission-daemon} to exit before killing its process. This
22521 allows the daemon time to complete its housekeeping and send a final
22522 update to trackers as it shuts down. On slow hosts, or hosts with a
22523 slow network connection, this value may need to be increased.
22524
22525 Defaults to @samp{10}.
22526
22527 @end deftypevr
22528
22529 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} string download-dir
22530 The directory to which torrent files are downloaded.
22531
22532 Defaults to @samp{"/var/lib/transmission-daemon/downloads"}.
22533
22534 @end deftypevr
22535
22536 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} boolean incomplete-dir-enabled?
22537 If @code{#t}, files will be held in @code{incomplete-dir} while their
22538 torrent is being downloaded, then moved to @code{download-dir} once the
22539 torrent is complete. Otherwise, files for all torrents (including those
22540 still being downloaded) will be placed in @code{download-dir}.
22541
22542 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
22543
22544 @end deftypevr
22545
22546 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} maybe-string incomplete-dir
22547 The directory in which files from incompletely downloaded torrents will
22548 be held when @code{incomplete-dir-enabled?} is @code{#t}.
22549
22550 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
22551
22552 @end deftypevr
22553
22554 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} umask umask
22555 The file mode creation mask used for downloaded files. (See the
22556 @command{umask} man page for more information.)
22557
22558 Defaults to @samp{18}.
22559
22560 @end deftypevr
22561
22562 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} boolean rename-partial-files?
22563 When @code{#t}, ``.part'' is appended to the name of partially
22564 downloaded files.
22565
22566 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
22567
22568 @end deftypevr
22569
22570 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} preallocation-mode preallocation
22571 The mode by which space should be preallocated for downloaded files, one
22572 of @code{none}, @code{fast} (or @code{sparse}) and @code{full}.
22573 Specifying @code{full} will minimize disk fragmentation at a cost to
22574 file-creation speed.
22575
22576 Defaults to @samp{fast}.
22577
22578 @end deftypevr
22579
22580 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} boolean watch-dir-enabled?
22581 If @code{#t}, the directory specified by @code{watch-dir} will be
22582 watched for new @file{.torrent} files and the torrents they describe
22583 added automatically (and the original files removed, if
22584 @code{trash-original-torrent-files?} is @code{#t}).
22585
22586 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
22587
22588 @end deftypevr
22589
22590 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} maybe-string watch-dir
22591 The directory to be watched for @file{.torrent} files indicating new
22592 torrents to be added, when @code{watch-dir-enabled} is @code{#t}.
22593
22594 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
22595
22596 @end deftypevr
22597
22598 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} boolean trash-original-torrent-files?
22599 When @code{#t}, @file{.torrent} files will be deleted from the watch
22600 directory once their torrent has been added (see
22601 @code{watch-directory-enabled?}).
22602
22603 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
22604
22605 @end deftypevr
22606
22607 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} boolean speed-limit-down-enabled?
22608 When @code{#t}, the daemon's download speed will be limited to the rate
22609 specified by @code{speed-limit-down}.
22610
22611 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
22612
22613 @end deftypevr
22614
22615 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer speed-limit-down
22616 The default global-maximum download speed, in kilobytes per second.
22617
22618 Defaults to @samp{100}.
22619
22620 @end deftypevr
22621
22622 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} boolean speed-limit-up-enabled?
22623 When @code{#t}, the daemon's upload speed will be limited to the rate
22624 specified by @code{speed-limit-up}.
22625
22626 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
22627
22628 @end deftypevr
22629
22630 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer speed-limit-up
22631 The default global-maximum upload speed, in kilobytes per second.
22632
22633 Defaults to @samp{100}.
22634
22635 @end deftypevr
22636
22637 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} boolean alt-speed-enabled?
22638 When @code{#t}, the alternate speed limits @code{alt-speed-down} and
22639 @code{alt-speed-up} are used (in place of @code{speed-limit-down} and
22640 @code{speed-limit-up}, if they are enabled) to constrain the daemon's
22641 bandwidth usage. This can be scheduled to occur automatically at
22642 certain times during the week; see @code{alt-speed-time-enabled?}.
22643
22644 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
22645
22646 @end deftypevr
22647
22648 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer alt-speed-down
22649 The alternate global-maximum download speed, in kilobytes per second.
22650
22651 Defaults to @samp{50}.
22652
22653 @end deftypevr
22654
22655 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer alt-speed-up
22656 The alternate global-maximum upload speed, in kilobytes per second.
22657
22658 Defaults to @samp{50}.
22659
22660 @end deftypevr
22661
22662 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} boolean alt-speed-time-enabled?
22663 When @code{#t}, the alternate speed limits @code{alt-speed-down} and
22664 @code{alt-speed-up} will be enabled automatically during the periods
22665 specified by @code{alt-speed-time-day}, @code{alt-speed-time-begin} and
22666 @code{alt-time-speed-end}.
22667
22668 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
22669
22670 @end deftypevr
22671
22672 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} day-list alt-speed-time-day
22673 The days of the week on which the alternate-speed schedule should be
22674 used, specified either as a list of days (@code{sunday}, @code{monday},
22675 and so on) or using one of the symbols @code{weekdays}, @code{weekends}
22676 or @code{all}.
22677
22678 Defaults to @samp{all}.
22679
22680 @end deftypevr
22681
22682 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer alt-speed-time-begin
22683 The time of day at which to enable the alternate speed limits, expressed
22684 as a number of minutes since midnight.
22685
22686 Defaults to @samp{540}.
22687
22688 @end deftypevr
22689
22690 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer alt-speed-time-end
22691 The time of day at which to disable the alternate speed limits,
22692 expressed as a number of minutes since midnight.
22693
22694 Defaults to @samp{1020}.
22695
22696 @end deftypevr
22697
22698 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} string bind-address-ipv4
22699 The IP address at which to listen for peer connections, or ``0.0.0.0''
22700 to listen at all available IP addresses.
22701
22702 Defaults to @samp{"0.0.0.0"}.
22703
22704 @end deftypevr
22705
22706 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} string bind-address-ipv6
22707 The IPv6 address at which to listen for peer connections, or ``::'' to
22708 listen at all available IPv6 addresses.
22709
22710 Defaults to @samp{"::"}.
22711
22712 @end deftypevr
22713
22714 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} boolean peer-port-random-on-start?
22715 If @code{#t}, when the daemon starts it will select a port at random on
22716 which to listen for peer connections, from the range specified
22717 (inclusively) by @code{peer-port-random-low} and
22718 @code{peer-port-random-high}. Otherwise, it listens on the port
22719 specified by @code{peer-port}.
22720
22721 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
22722
22723 @end deftypevr
22724
22725 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} port-number peer-port-random-low
22726 The lowest selectable port number when @code{peer-port-random-on-start?}
22727 is @code{#t}.
22728
22729 Defaults to @samp{49152}.
22730
22731 @end deftypevr
22732
22733 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} port-number peer-port-random-high
22734 The highest selectable port number when @code{peer-port-random-on-start}
22735 is @code{#t}.
22736
22737 Defaults to @samp{65535}.
22738
22739 @end deftypevr
22740
22741 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} port-number peer-port
22742 The port on which to listen for peer connections when
22743 @code{peer-port-random-on-start?} is @code{#f}.
22744
22745 Defaults to @samp{51413}.
22746
22747 @end deftypevr
22748
22749 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} boolean port-forwarding-enabled?
22750 If @code{#t}, the daemon will attempt to configure port-forwarding on an
22751 upstream gateway automatically using @acronym{UPnP} and
22752 @acronym{NAT-PMP}.
22753
22754 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
22755
22756 @end deftypevr
22757
22758 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} encryption-mode encryption
22759 The encryption preference for peer connections, one of
22760 @code{prefer-unencrypted-connections},
22761 @code{prefer-encrypted-connections} or
22762 @code{require-encrypted-connections}.
22763
22764 Defaults to @samp{prefer-encrypted-connections}.
22765
22766 @end deftypevr
22767
22768 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} maybe-string peer-congestion-algorithm
22769 The TCP congestion-control algorithm to use for peer connections,
22770 specified using a string recognized by the operating system in calls to
22771 @code{setsockopt} (or set to @code{disabled}, in which case the
22772 operating-system default is used).
22773
22774 Note that on GNU/Linux systems, the kernel must be configured to allow
22775 processes to use a congestion-control algorithm not in the default set;
22776 otherwise, it will deny these requests with ``Operation not permitted''.
22777 To see which algorithms are available on your system and which are
22778 currently permitted for use, look at the contents of the files
22779 @file{tcp_available_congestion_control} and
22780 @file{tcp_allowed_congestion_control} in the @file{/proc/sys/net/ipv4}
22781 directory.
22782
22783 As an example, to have Transmission Daemon use
22784 @uref{http://www-ece.rice.edu/networks/TCP-LP/,the TCP Low Priority
22785 congestion-control algorithm}, you'll need to modify your kernel
22786 configuration to build in support for the algorithm, then update your
22787 operating-system configuration to allow its use by adding a
22788 @code{sysctl-service-type} service (or updating the existing one's
22789 configuration) with lines like the following:
22790
22791 @lisp
22792 (service sysctl-service-type
22793 (sysctl-configuration
22794 (settings
22795 ("net.ipv4.tcp_allowed_congestion_control" .
22796 "reno cubic lp"))))
22797 @end lisp
22798
22799 The Transmission Daemon configuration can then be updated with
22800
22801 @lisp
22802 (peer-congestion-algorithm "lp")
22803 @end lisp
22804
22805 and the system reconfigured to have the changes take effect.
22806
22807 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
22808
22809 @end deftypevr
22810
22811 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} tcp-type-of-service peer-socket-tos
22812 The type of service to request in outgoing @acronym{TCP} packets, one of
22813 @code{default}, @code{low-cost}, @code{throughput}, @code{low-delay} and
22814 @code{reliability}.
22815
22816 Defaults to @samp{default}.
22817
22818 @end deftypevr
22819
22820 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer peer-limit-global
22821 The global limit on the number of connected peers.
22822
22823 Defaults to @samp{200}.
22824
22825 @end deftypevr
22826
22827 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer peer-limit-per-torrent
22828 The per-torrent limit on the number of connected peers.
22829
22830 Defaults to @samp{50}.
22831
22832 @end deftypevr
22833
22834 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer upload-slots-per-torrent
22835 The maximum number of peers to which the daemon will upload data
22836 simultaneously for each torrent.
22837
22838 Defaults to @samp{14}.
22839
22840 @end deftypevr
22841
22842 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer peer-id-ttl-hours
22843 The maximum lifespan, in hours, of the peer ID associated with each
22844 public torrent before it is regenerated.
22845
22846 Defaults to @samp{6}.
22847
22848 @end deftypevr
22849
22850 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} boolean blocklist-enabled?
22851 When @code{#t}, the daemon will ignore peers mentioned in the blocklist
22852 it has most recently downloaded from @code{blocklist-url}.
22853
22854 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
22855
22856 @end deftypevr
22857
22858 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} maybe-string blocklist-url
22859 The URL of a peer blocklist (in @acronym{P2P}-plaintext or eMule
22860 @file{.dat} format) to be periodically downloaded and applied when
22861 @code{blocklist-enabled?} is @code{#t}.
22862
22863 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
22864
22865 @end deftypevr
22866
22867 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} boolean download-queue-enabled?
22868 If @code{#t}, the daemon will be limited to downloading at most
22869 @code{download-queue-size} non-stalled torrents simultaneously.
22870
22871 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
22872
22873 @end deftypevr
22874
22875 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer download-queue-size
22876 The size of the daemon's download queue, which limits the number of
22877 non-stalled torrents it will download at any one time when
22878 @code{download-queue-enabled?} is @code{#t}.
22879
22880 Defaults to @samp{5}.
22881
22882 @end deftypevr
22883
22884 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} boolean seed-queue-enabled?
22885 If @code{#t}, the daemon will be limited to seeding at most
22886 @code{seed-queue-size} non-stalled torrents simultaneously.
22887
22888 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
22889
22890 @end deftypevr
22891
22892 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer seed-queue-size
22893 The size of the daemon's seed queue, which limits the number of
22894 non-stalled torrents it will seed at any one time when
22895 @code{seed-queue-enabled?} is @code{#t}.
22896
22897 Defaults to @samp{10}.
22898
22899 @end deftypevr
22900
22901 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} boolean queue-stalled-enabled?
22902 When @code{#t}, the daemon will consider torrents for which it has not
22903 shared data in the past @code{queue-stalled-minutes} minutes to be
22904 stalled and not count them against its @code{download-queue-size} and
22905 @code{seed-queue-size} limits.
22906
22907 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
22908
22909 @end deftypevr
22910
22911 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer queue-stalled-minutes
22912 The maximum period, in minutes, a torrent may be idle before it is
22913 considered to be stalled, when @code{queue-stalled-enabled?} is
22914 @code{#t}.
22915
22916 Defaults to @samp{30}.
22917
22918 @end deftypevr
22919
22920 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} boolean ratio-limit-enabled?
22921 When @code{#t}, a torrent being seeded will automatically be paused once
22922 it reaches the ratio specified by @code{ratio-limit}.
22923
22924 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
22925
22926 @end deftypevr
22927
22928 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} non-negative-rational ratio-limit
22929 The ratio at which a torrent being seeded will be paused, when
22930 @code{ratio-limit-enabled?} is @code{#t}.
22931
22932 Defaults to @samp{2.0}.
22933
22934 @end deftypevr
22935
22936 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} boolean idle-seeding-limit-enabled?
22937 When @code{#t}, a torrent being seeded will automatically be paused once
22938 it has been idle for @code{idle-seeding-limit} minutes.
22939
22940 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
22941
22942 @end deftypevr
22943
22944 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer idle-seeding-limit
22945 The maximum period, in minutes, a torrent being seeded may be idle
22946 before it is paused, when @code{idle-seeding-limit-enabled?} is
22947 @code{#t}.
22948
22949 Defaults to @samp{30}.
22950
22951 @end deftypevr
22952
22953 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} boolean dht-enabled?
22954 Enable @uref{http://bittorrent.org/beps/bep_0005.html,the distributed
22955 hash table (@acronym{DHT}) protocol}, which supports the use of
22956 trackerless torrents.
22957
22958 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
22959
22960 @end deftypevr
22961
22962 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} boolean lpd-enabled?
22963 Enable @uref{https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Local_Peer_Discovery,local
22964 peer discovery} (@acronym{LPD}), which allows the discovery of peers on
22965 the local network and may reduce the amount of data sent over the public
22966 Internet.
22967
22968 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
22969
22970 @end deftypevr
22971
22972 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} boolean pex-enabled?
22973 Enable @uref{https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Peer_exchange,peer exchange}
22974 (@acronym{PEX}), which reduces the daemon's reliance on external
22975 trackers and may improve its performance.
22976
22977 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
22978
22979 @end deftypevr
22980
22981 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} boolean utp-enabled?
22982 Enable @uref{http://bittorrent.org/beps/bep_0029.html,the micro
22983 transport protocol} (@acronym{uTP}), which aims to reduce the impact of
22984 BitTorrent traffic on other users of the local network while maintaining
22985 full utilization of the available bandwidth.
22986
22987 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
22988
22989 @end deftypevr
22990
22991 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} boolean rpc-enabled?
22992 If @code{#t}, enable the remote procedure call (@acronym{RPC})
22993 interface, which allows remote control of the daemon via its Web
22994 interface, the @command{transmission-remote} command-line client, and
22995 similar tools.
22996
22997 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
22998
22999 @end deftypevr
23000
23001 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} string rpc-bind-address
23002 The IP address at which to listen for @acronym{RPC} connections, or
23003 ``0.0.0.0'' to listen at all available IP addresses.
23004
23005 Defaults to @samp{"0.0.0.0"}.
23006
23007 @end deftypevr
23008
23009 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} port-number rpc-port
23010 The port on which to listen for @acronym{RPC} connections.
23011
23012 Defaults to @samp{9091}.
23013
23014 @end deftypevr
23015
23016 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} string rpc-url
23017 The path prefix to use in the @acronym{RPC}-endpoint @acronym{URL}.
23018
23019 Defaults to @samp{"/transmission/"}.
23020
23021 @end deftypevr
23022
23023 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} boolean rpc-authentication-required?
23024 When @code{#t}, clients must authenticate (see @code{rpc-username} and
23025 @code{rpc-password}) when using the @acronym{RPC} interface. Note this
23026 has the side effect of disabling host-name whitelisting (see
23027 @code{rpc-host-whitelist-enabled?}.
23028
23029 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
23030
23031 @end deftypevr
23032
23033 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} maybe-string rpc-username
23034 The username required by clients to access the @acronym{RPC} interface
23035 when @code{rpc-authentication-required?} is @code{#t}.
23036
23037 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
23038
23039 @end deftypevr
23040
23041 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} maybe-transmission-password-hash rpc-password
23042 The password required by clients to access the @acronym{RPC} interface
23043 when @code{rpc-authentication-required?} is @code{#t}. This must be
23044 specified using a password hash in the format recognized by Transmission
23045 clients, either copied from an existing @file{settings.json} file or
23046 generated using the @code{transmission-password-hash} procedure.
23047
23048 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
23049
23050 @end deftypevr
23051
23052 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} boolean rpc-whitelist-enabled?
23053 When @code{#t}, @acronym{RPC} requests will be accepted only when they
23054 originate from an address specified in @code{rpc-whitelist}.
23055
23056 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
23057
23058 @end deftypevr
23059
23060 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} string-list rpc-whitelist
23061 The list of IP and IPv6 addresses from which @acronym{RPC} requests will
23062 be accepted when @code{rpc-whitelist-enabled?} is @code{#t}. Wildcards
23063 may be specified using @samp{*}.
23064
23065 Defaults to @samp{("127.0.0.1" "::1")}.
23066
23067 @end deftypevr
23068
23069 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} boolean rpc-host-whitelist-enabled?
23070 When @code{#t}, @acronym{RPC} requests will be accepted only when they
23071 are addressed to a host named in @code{rpc-host-whitelist}. Note that
23072 requests to ``localhost'' or ``localhost.'', or to a numeric address,
23073 are always accepted regardless of these settings.
23074
23075 Note also this functionality is disabled when
23076 @code{rpc-authentication-required?} is @code{#t}.
23077
23078 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
23079
23080 @end deftypevr
23081
23082 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} string-list rpc-host-whitelist
23083 The list of host names recognized by the @acronym{RPC} server when
23084 @code{rpc-host-whitelist-enabled?} is @code{#t}.
23085
23086 Defaults to @samp{()}.
23087
23088 @end deftypevr
23089
23090 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} message-level message-level
23091 The minimum severity level of messages to be logged (to
23092 @file{/var/log/transmission.log}) by the daemon, one of @code{none} (no
23093 logging), @code{error}, @code{info} and @code{debug}.
23094
23095 Defaults to @samp{info}.
23096
23097 @end deftypevr
23098
23099 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} boolean start-added-torrents?
23100 When @code{#t}, torrents are started as soon as they are added;
23101 otherwise, they are added in ``paused'' state.
23102
23103 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
23104
23105 @end deftypevr
23106
23107 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} boolean script-torrent-done-enabled?
23108 When @code{#t}, the script specified by
23109 @code{script-torrent-done-filename} will be invoked each time a torrent
23110 completes.
23111
23112 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
23113
23114 @end deftypevr
23115
23116 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} maybe-file-object script-torrent-done-filename
23117 A file name or file-like object specifying a script to run each time a
23118 torrent completes, when @code{script-torrent-done-enabled?} is
23119 @code{#t}.
23120
23121 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
23122
23123 @end deftypevr
23124
23125 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} boolean scrape-paused-torrents-enabled?
23126 When @code{#t}, the daemon will scrape trackers for a torrent even when
23127 the torrent is paused.
23128
23129 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
23130
23131 @end deftypevr
23132
23133 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer cache-size-mb
23134 The amount of memory, in megabytes, to allocate for the daemon's
23135 in-memory cache. A larger value may increase performance by reducing
23136 the frequency of disk I/O.
23137
23138 Defaults to @samp{4}.
23139
23140 @end deftypevr
23141
23142 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} boolean prefetch-enabled?
23143 When @code{#t}, the daemon will try to improve I/O performance by
23144 hinting to the operating system which data is likely to be read next
23145 from disk to satisfy requests from peers.
23146
23147 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
23148
23149 @end deftypevr
23150
23151
23152 @c %end of fragment
23153
23154
23155
23156 @node Monitoring Services
23157 @subsection Monitoring Services
23158
23159 @subsubheading Tailon Service
23160
23161 @uref{https://tailon.readthedocs.io/, Tailon} is a web application for
23162 viewing and searching log files.
23163
23164 The following example will configure the service with default values.
23165 By default, Tailon can be accessed on port 8080 (@code{http://localhost:8080}).
23166
23167 @lisp
23168 (service tailon-service-type)
23169 @end lisp
23170
23171 The following example customises more of the Tailon configuration,
23172 adding @command{sed} to the list of allowed commands.
23173
23174 @lisp
23175 (service tailon-service-type
23176 (tailon-configuration
23177 (config-file
23178 (tailon-configuration-file
23179 (allowed-commands '("tail" "grep" "awk" "sed"))))))
23180 @end lisp
23181
23182
23183 @deftp {Data Type} tailon-configuration
23184 Data type representing the configuration of Tailon.
23185 This type has the following parameters:
23186
23187 @table @asis
23188 @item @code{config-file} (default: @code{(tailon-configuration-file)})
23189 The configuration file to use for Tailon. This can be set to a
23190 @dfn{tailon-configuration-file} record value, or any gexp
23191 (@pxref{G-Expressions}).
23192
23193 For example, to instead use a local file, the @code{local-file} function
23194 can be used:
23195
23196 @lisp
23197 (service tailon-service-type
23198 (tailon-configuration
23199 (config-file (local-file "./my-tailon.conf"))))
23200 @end lisp
23201
23202 @item @code{package} (default: @code{tailon})
23203 The tailon package to use.
23204
23205 @end table
23206 @end deftp
23207
23208 @deftp {Data Type} tailon-configuration-file
23209 Data type representing the configuration options for Tailon.
23210 This type has the following parameters:
23211
23212 @table @asis
23213 @item @code{files} (default: @code{(list "/var/log")})
23214 List of files to display. The list can include strings for a single file
23215 or directory, or a list, where the first item is the name of a
23216 subsection, and the remaining items are the files or directories in that
23217 subsection.
23218
23219 @item @code{bind} (default: @code{"localhost:8080"})
23220 Address and port to which Tailon should bind on.
23221
23222 @item @code{relative-root} (default: @code{#f})
23223 URL path to use for Tailon, set to @code{#f} to not use a path.
23224
23225 @item @code{allow-transfers?} (default: @code{#t})
23226 Allow downloading the log files in the web interface.
23227
23228 @item @code{follow-names?} (default: @code{#t})
23229 Allow tailing of not-yet existent files.
23230
23231 @item @code{tail-lines} (default: @code{200})
23232 Number of lines to read initially from each file.
23233
23234 @item @code{allowed-commands} (default: @code{(list "tail" "grep" "awk")})
23235 Commands to allow running. By default, @code{sed} is disabled.
23236
23237 @item @code{debug?} (default: @code{#f})
23238 Set @code{debug?} to @code{#t} to show debug messages.
23239
23240 @item @code{wrap-lines} (default: @code{#t})
23241 Initial line wrapping state in the web interface. Set to @code{#t} to
23242 initially wrap lines (the default), or to @code{#f} to initially not
23243 wrap lines.
23244
23245 @item @code{http-auth} (default: @code{#f})
23246 HTTP authentication type to use. Set to @code{#f} to disable
23247 authentication (the default). Supported values are @code{"digest"} or
23248 @code{"basic"}.
23249
23250 @item @code{users} (default: @code{#f})
23251 If HTTP authentication is enabled (see @code{http-auth}), access will be
23252 restricted to the credentials provided here. To configure users, use a
23253 list of pairs, where the first element of the pair is the username, and
23254 the 2nd element of the pair is the password.
23255
23256 @lisp
23257 (tailon-configuration-file
23258 (http-auth "basic")
23259 (users '(("user1" . "password1")
23260 ("user2" . "password2"))))
23261 @end lisp
23262
23263 @end table
23264 @end deftp
23265
23266
23267 @subsubheading Darkstat Service
23268 @cindex darkstat
23269 Darkstat is a packet sniffer that captures network traffic, calculates
23270 statistics about usage, and serves reports over HTTP.
23271
23272 @defvar {Scheme Variable} darkstat-service-type
23273 This is the service type for the
23274 @uref{https://unix4lyfe.org/darkstat/, darkstat}
23275 service, its value must be a @code{darkstat-configuration} record as in
23276 this example:
23277
23278 @lisp
23279 (service darkstat-service-type
23280 (darkstat-configuration
23281 (interface "eno1")))
23282 @end lisp
23283 @end defvar
23284
23285 @deftp {Data Type} darkstat-configuration
23286 Data type representing the configuration of @command{darkstat}.
23287
23288 @table @asis
23289 @item @code{package} (default: @code{darkstat})
23290 The darkstat package to use.
23291
23292 @item @code{interface}
23293 Capture traffic on the specified network interface.
23294
23295 @item @code{port} (default: @code{"667"})
23296 Bind the web interface to the specified port.
23297
23298 @item @code{bind-address} (default: @code{"127.0.0.1"})
23299 Bind the web interface to the specified address.
23300
23301 @item @code{base} (default: @code{"/"})
23302 Specify the path of the base URL@. This can be useful if
23303 @command{darkstat} is accessed via a reverse proxy.
23304
23305 @end table
23306 @end deftp
23307
23308 @subsubheading Prometheus Node Exporter Service
23309
23310 @cindex prometheus-node-exporter
23311 The Prometheus ``node exporter'' makes hardware and operating system statistics
23312 provided by the Linux kernel available for the Prometheus monitoring system.
23313 This service should be deployed on all physical nodes and virtual machines,
23314 where monitoring these statistics is desirable.
23315
23316 @defvar {Scheme variable} prometheus-node-exporter-service-type
23317 This is the service type for the
23318 @uref{https://github.com/prometheus/node_exporter/, prometheus-node-exporter}
23319 service, its value must be a @code{prometheus-node-exporter-configuration}.
23320
23321 @lisp
23322 (service prometheus-node-exporter-service-type)
23323 @end lisp
23324 @end defvar
23325
23326 @deftp {Data Type} prometheus-node-exporter-configuration
23327 Data type representing the configuration of @command{node_exporter}.
23328
23329 @table @asis
23330 @item @code{package} (default: @code{go-github-com-prometheus-node-exporter})
23331 The prometheus-node-exporter package to use.
23332
23333 @item @code{web-listen-address} (default: @code{":9100"})
23334 Bind the web interface to the specified address.
23335
23336 @item @code{textfile-directory} (default: @code{"/var/lib/prometheus/node-exporter"})
23337 This directory can be used to export metrics specific to this machine.
23338 Files containing metrics in the text format, with the filename ending in
23339 @code{.prom} should be placed in this directory.
23340
23341 @item @code{extra-options} (default: @code{'()})
23342 Extra options to pass to the Prometheus node exporter.
23343
23344 @end table
23345 @end deftp
23346
23347 @subsubheading Zabbix server
23348 @cindex zabbix zabbix-server
23349 Zabbix provides monitoring metrics, among others network utilization, CPU load
23350 and disk space consumption:
23351
23352 @itemize
23353 @item High performance, high capacity (able to monitor hundreds of thousands of devices).
23354 @item Auto-discovery of servers and network devices and interfaces.
23355 @item Low-level discovery, allows to automatically start monitoring new items, file systems or network interfaces among others.
23356 @item Distributed monitoring with centralized web administration.
23357 @item Native high performance agents.
23358 @item SLA, and ITIL KPI metrics on reporting.
23359 @item High-level (business) view of monitored resources through user-defined visual console screens and dashboards.
23360 @item Remote command execution through Zabbix proxies.
23361 @end itemize
23362
23363 @c %start of fragment
23364
23365 Available @code{zabbix-server-configuration} fields are:
23366
23367 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-server-configuration} parameter} package zabbix-server
23368 The zabbix-server package.
23369
23370 @end deftypevr
23371
23372 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-server-configuration} parameter} string user
23373 User who will run the Zabbix server.
23374
23375 Defaults to @samp{"zabbix"}.
23376
23377 @end deftypevr
23378
23379 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-server-configuration} parameter} group group
23380 Group who will run the Zabbix server.
23381
23382 Defaults to @samp{"zabbix"}.
23383
23384 @end deftypevr
23385
23386 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-server-configuration} parameter} string db-host
23387 Database host name.
23388
23389 Defaults to @samp{"127.0.0.1"}.
23390
23391 @end deftypevr
23392
23393 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-server-configuration} parameter} string db-name
23394 Database name.
23395
23396 Defaults to @samp{"zabbix"}.
23397
23398 @end deftypevr
23399
23400 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-server-configuration} parameter} string db-user
23401 Database user.
23402
23403 Defaults to @samp{"zabbix"}.
23404
23405 @end deftypevr
23406
23407 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-server-configuration} parameter} string db-password
23408 Database password. Please, use @code{include-files} with
23409 @code{DBPassword=SECRET} inside a specified file instead.
23410
23411 Defaults to @samp{""}.
23412
23413 @end deftypevr
23414
23415 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-server-configuration} parameter} number db-port
23416 Database port.
23417
23418 Defaults to @samp{5432}.
23419
23420 @end deftypevr
23421
23422 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-server-configuration} parameter} string log-type
23423 Specifies where log messages are written to:
23424
23425 @itemize @bullet
23426 @item
23427 @code{system} - syslog.
23428
23429 @item
23430 @code{file} - file specified with @code{log-file} parameter.
23431
23432 @item
23433 @code{console} - standard output.
23434
23435 @end itemize
23436
23437 Defaults to @samp{""}.
23438
23439 @end deftypevr
23440
23441 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-server-configuration} parameter} string log-file
23442 Log file name for @code{log-type} @code{file} parameter.
23443
23444 Defaults to @samp{"/var/log/zabbix/server.log"}.
23445
23446 @end deftypevr
23447
23448 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-server-configuration} parameter} string pid-file
23449 Name of PID file.
23450
23451 Defaults to @samp{"/var/run/zabbix/zabbix_server.pid"}.
23452
23453 @end deftypevr
23454
23455 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-server-configuration} parameter} string ssl-ca-location
23456 The location of certificate authority (CA) files for SSL server
23457 certificate verification.
23458
23459 Defaults to @samp{"/etc/ssl/certs/ca-certificates.crt"}.
23460
23461 @end deftypevr
23462
23463 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-server-configuration} parameter} string ssl-cert-location
23464 Location of SSL client certificates.
23465
23466 Defaults to @samp{"/etc/ssl/certs"}.
23467
23468 @end deftypevr
23469
23470 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-server-configuration} parameter} string extra-options
23471 Extra options will be appended to Zabbix server configuration file.
23472
23473 Defaults to @samp{""}.
23474
23475 @end deftypevr
23476
23477 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-server-configuration} parameter} include-files include-files
23478 You may include individual files or all files in a directory in the
23479 configuration file.
23480
23481 Defaults to @samp{()}.
23482
23483 @end deftypevr
23484
23485 @c %end of fragment
23486
23487 @subsubheading Zabbix agent
23488 @cindex zabbix zabbix-agent
23489
23490 Zabbix agent gathers information for Zabbix server.
23491
23492 @c %start of fragment
23493
23494 Available @code{zabbix-agent-configuration} fields are:
23495
23496 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-agent-configuration} parameter} package zabbix-agent
23497 The zabbix-agent package.
23498
23499 @end deftypevr
23500
23501 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-agent-configuration} parameter} string user
23502 User who will run the Zabbix agent.
23503
23504 Defaults to @samp{"zabbix"}.
23505
23506 @end deftypevr
23507
23508 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-agent-configuration} parameter} group group
23509 Group who will run the Zabbix agent.
23510
23511 Defaults to @samp{"zabbix"}.
23512
23513 @end deftypevr
23514
23515 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-agent-configuration} parameter} string hostname
23516 Unique, case sensitive hostname which is required for active checks and
23517 must match hostname as configured on the server.
23518
23519 Defaults to @samp{""}.
23520
23521 @end deftypevr
23522
23523 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-agent-configuration} parameter} string log-type
23524 Specifies where log messages are written to:
23525
23526 @itemize @bullet
23527 @item
23528 @code{system} - syslog.
23529
23530 @item
23531 @code{file} - file specified with @code{log-file} parameter.
23532
23533 @item
23534 @code{console} - standard output.
23535
23536 @end itemize
23537
23538 Defaults to @samp{""}.
23539
23540 @end deftypevr
23541
23542 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-agent-configuration} parameter} string log-file
23543 Log file name for @code{log-type} @code{file} parameter.
23544
23545 Defaults to @samp{"/var/log/zabbix/agent.log"}.
23546
23547 @end deftypevr
23548
23549 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-agent-configuration} parameter} string pid-file
23550 Name of PID file.
23551
23552 Defaults to @samp{"/var/run/zabbix/zabbix_agent.pid"}.
23553
23554 @end deftypevr
23555
23556 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-agent-configuration} parameter} list server
23557 List of IP addresses, optionally in CIDR notation, or hostnames of
23558 Zabbix servers and Zabbix proxies. Incoming connections will be
23559 accepted only from the hosts listed here.
23560
23561 Defaults to @samp{("127.0.0.1")}.
23562
23563 @end deftypevr
23564
23565 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-agent-configuration} parameter} list server-active
23566 List of IP:port (or hostname:port) pairs of Zabbix servers and Zabbix
23567 proxies for active checks. If port is not specified, default port is
23568 used. If this parameter is not specified, active checks are disabled.
23569
23570 Defaults to @samp{("127.0.0.1")}.
23571
23572 @end deftypevr
23573
23574 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-agent-configuration} parameter} string extra-options
23575 Extra options will be appended to Zabbix server configuration file.
23576
23577 Defaults to @samp{""}.
23578
23579 @end deftypevr
23580
23581 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-agent-configuration} parameter} include-files include-files
23582 You may include individual files or all files in a directory in the
23583 configuration file.
23584
23585 Defaults to @samp{()}.
23586
23587 @end deftypevr
23588
23589 @c %end of fragment
23590
23591 @subsubheading Zabbix front-end
23592 @cindex zabbix zabbix-front-end
23593
23594 This service provides a WEB interface to Zabbix server.
23595
23596 @c %start of fragment
23597
23598 Available @code{zabbix-front-end-configuration} fields are:
23599
23600 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-front-end-configuration} parameter} nginx-server-configuration-list nginx
23601 NGINX configuration.
23602
23603 @end deftypevr
23604
23605 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-front-end-configuration} parameter} string db-host
23606 Database host name.
23607
23608 Defaults to @samp{"localhost"}.
23609
23610 @end deftypevr
23611
23612 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-front-end-configuration} parameter} number db-port
23613 Database port.
23614
23615 Defaults to @samp{5432}.
23616
23617 @end deftypevr
23618
23619 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-front-end-configuration} parameter} string db-name
23620 Database name.
23621
23622 Defaults to @samp{"zabbix"}.
23623
23624 @end deftypevr
23625
23626 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-front-end-configuration} parameter} string db-user
23627 Database user.
23628
23629 Defaults to @samp{"zabbix"}.
23630
23631 @end deftypevr
23632
23633 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-front-end-configuration} parameter} string db-password
23634 Database password. Please, use @code{db-secret-file} instead.
23635
23636 Defaults to @samp{""}.
23637
23638 @end deftypevr
23639
23640 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-front-end-configuration} parameter} string db-secret-file
23641 Secret file containing the credentials for the Zabbix front-end. The value
23642 must be a local file name, not a G-expression. You are expected to create
23643 this file manually. Its contents will be copied into @file{zabbix.conf.php}
23644 as the value of @code{$DB['PASSWORD']}.
23645
23646 Defaults to @samp{""}.
23647
23648 @end deftypevr
23649
23650 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-front-end-configuration} parameter} string zabbix-host
23651 Zabbix server hostname.
23652
23653 Defaults to @samp{"localhost"}.
23654
23655 @end deftypevr
23656
23657 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-front-end-configuration} parameter} number zabbix-port
23658 Zabbix server port.
23659
23660 Defaults to @samp{10051}.
23661
23662 @end deftypevr
23663
23664
23665 @c %end of fragment
23666
23667 @node Kerberos Services
23668 @subsection Kerberos Services
23669 @cindex Kerberos
23670
23671 The @code{(gnu services kerberos)} module provides services relating to
23672 the authentication protocol @dfn{Kerberos}.
23673
23674 @subsubheading Krb5 Service
23675
23676 Programs using a Kerberos client library normally
23677 expect a configuration file in @file{/etc/krb5.conf}.
23678 This service generates such a file from a definition provided in the
23679 operating system declaration.
23680 It does not cause any daemon to be started.
23681
23682 No ``keytab'' files are provided by this service---you must explicitly create them.
23683 This service is known to work with the MIT client library, @code{mit-krb5}.
23684 Other implementations have not been tested.
23685
23686 @defvr {Scheme Variable} krb5-service-type
23687 A service type for Kerberos 5 clients.
23688 @end defvr
23689
23690 @noindent
23691 Here is an example of its use:
23692 @lisp
23693 (service krb5-service-type
23694 (krb5-configuration
23695 (default-realm "EXAMPLE.COM")
23696 (allow-weak-crypto? #t)
23697 (realms (list
23698 (krb5-realm
23699 (name "EXAMPLE.COM")
23700 (admin-server "groucho.example.com")
23701 (kdc "karl.example.com"))
23702 (krb5-realm
23703 (name "ARGRX.EDU")
23704 (admin-server "kerb-admin.argrx.edu")
23705 (kdc "keys.argrx.edu"))))))
23706 @end lisp
23707
23708 @noindent
23709 This example provides a Kerberos@tie{}5 client configuration which:
23710 @itemize
23711 @item Recognizes two realms, @i{viz:} ``EXAMPLE.COM'' and ``ARGRX.EDU'', both
23712 of which have distinct administration servers and key distribution centers;
23713 @item Will default to the realm ``EXAMPLE.COM'' if the realm is not explicitly
23714 specified by clients;
23715 @item Accepts services which only support encryption types known to be weak.
23716 @end itemize
23717
23718 The @code{krb5-realm} and @code{krb5-configuration} types have many fields.
23719 Only the most commonly used ones are described here.
23720 For a full list, and more detailed explanation of each, see the MIT
23721 @uref{https://web.mit.edu/kerberos/krb5-devel/doc/admin/conf_files/krb5_conf.html,,krb5.conf}
23722 documentation.
23723
23724
23725 @deftp {Data Type} krb5-realm
23726 @cindex realm, kerberos
23727 @table @asis
23728 @item @code{name}
23729 This field is a string identifying the name of the realm.
23730 A common convention is to use the fully qualified DNS name of your organization,
23731 converted to upper case.
23732
23733 @item @code{admin-server}
23734 This field is a string identifying the host where the administration server is
23735 running.
23736
23737 @item @code{kdc}
23738 This field is a string identifying the key distribution center
23739 for the realm.
23740 @end table
23741 @end deftp
23742
23743 @deftp {Data Type} krb5-configuration
23744
23745 @table @asis
23746 @item @code{allow-weak-crypto?} (default: @code{#f})
23747 If this flag is @code{#t} then services which only offer encryption algorithms
23748 known to be weak will be accepted.
23749
23750 @item @code{default-realm} (default: @code{#f})
23751 This field should be a string identifying the default Kerberos
23752 realm for the client.
23753 You should set this field to the name of your Kerberos realm.
23754 If this value is @code{#f}
23755 then a realm must be specified with every Kerberos principal when invoking programs
23756 such as @command{kinit}.
23757
23758 @item @code{realms}
23759 This should be a non-empty list of @code{krb5-realm} objects, which clients may
23760 access.
23761 Normally, one of them will have a @code{name} field matching the @code{default-realm}
23762 field.
23763 @end table
23764 @end deftp
23765
23766
23767 @subsubheading PAM krb5 Service
23768 @cindex pam-krb5
23769
23770 The @code{pam-krb5} service allows for login authentication and password
23771 management via Kerberos.
23772 You will need this service if you want PAM enabled applications to authenticate
23773 users using Kerberos.
23774
23775 @defvr {Scheme Variable} pam-krb5-service-type
23776 A service type for the Kerberos 5 PAM module.
23777 @end defvr
23778
23779 @deftp {Data Type} pam-krb5-configuration
23780 Data type representing the configuration of the Kerberos 5 PAM module.
23781 This type has the following parameters:
23782 @table @asis
23783 @item @code{pam-krb5} (default: @code{pam-krb5})
23784 The pam-krb5 package to use.
23785
23786 @item @code{minimum-uid} (default: @code{1000})
23787 The smallest user ID for which Kerberos authentications should be attempted.
23788 Local accounts with lower values will silently fail to authenticate.
23789 @end table
23790 @end deftp
23791
23792
23793 @node LDAP Services
23794 @subsection LDAP Services
23795 @cindex LDAP
23796 @cindex nslcd, LDAP service
23797
23798 The @code{(gnu services authentication)} module provides the
23799 @code{nslcd-service-type}, which can be used to authenticate against an LDAP
23800 server. In addition to configuring the service itself, you may want to add
23801 @code{ldap} as a name service to the Name Service Switch. @xref{Name Service
23802 Switch} for detailed information.
23803
23804 Here is a simple operating system declaration with a default configuration of
23805 the @code{nslcd-service-type} and a Name Service Switch configuration that
23806 consults the @code{ldap} name service last:
23807
23808 @lisp
23809 (use-service-modules authentication)
23810 (use-modules (gnu system nss))
23811 ...
23812 (operating-system
23813 ...
23814 (services
23815 (cons*
23816 (service nslcd-service-type)
23817 (service dhcp-client-service-type)
23818 %base-services))
23819 (name-service-switch
23820 (let ((services (list (name-service (name "db"))
23821 (name-service (name "files"))
23822 (name-service (name "ldap")))))
23823 (name-service-switch
23824 (inherit %mdns-host-lookup-nss)
23825 (password services)
23826 (shadow services)
23827 (group services)
23828 (netgroup services)
23829 (gshadow services)))))
23830 @end lisp
23831
23832 @c %start of generated documentation for nslcd-configuration
23833
23834 Available @code{nslcd-configuration} fields are:
23835
23836 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} package nss-pam-ldapd
23837 The @code{nss-pam-ldapd} package to use.
23838
23839 @end deftypevr
23840
23841 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-number threads
23842 The number of threads to start that can handle requests and perform LDAP
23843 queries. Each thread opens a separate connection to the LDAP server.
23844 The default is to start 5 threads.
23845
23846 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
23847
23848 @end deftypevr
23849
23850 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} string uid
23851 This specifies the user id with which the daemon should be run.
23852
23853 Defaults to @samp{"nslcd"}.
23854
23855 @end deftypevr
23856
23857 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} string gid
23858 This specifies the group id with which the daemon should be run.
23859
23860 Defaults to @samp{"nslcd"}.
23861
23862 @end deftypevr
23863
23864 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} log-option log
23865 This option controls the way logging is done via a list containing
23866 SCHEME and LEVEL@. The SCHEME argument may either be the symbols
23867 @samp{none} or @samp{syslog}, or an absolute file name. The LEVEL
23868 argument is optional and specifies the log level. The log level may be
23869 one of the following symbols: @samp{crit}, @samp{error}, @samp{warning},
23870 @samp{notice}, @samp{info} or @samp{debug}. All messages with the
23871 specified log level or higher are logged.
23872
23873 Defaults to @samp{("/var/log/nslcd" info)}.
23874
23875 @end deftypevr
23876
23877 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} list uri
23878 The list of LDAP server URIs. Normally, only the first server will be
23879 used with the following servers as fall-back.
23880
23881 Defaults to @samp{("ldap://localhost:389/")}.
23882
23883 @end deftypevr
23884
23885 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string ldap-version
23886 The version of the LDAP protocol to use. The default is to use the
23887 maximum version supported by the LDAP library.
23888
23889 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
23890
23891 @end deftypevr
23892
23893 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string binddn
23894 Specifies the distinguished name with which to bind to the directory
23895 server for lookups. The default is to bind anonymously.
23896
23897 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
23898
23899 @end deftypevr
23900
23901 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string bindpw
23902 Specifies the credentials with which to bind. This option is only
23903 applicable when used with binddn.
23904
23905 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
23906
23907 @end deftypevr
23908
23909 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string rootpwmoddn
23910 Specifies the distinguished name to use when the root user tries to
23911 modify a user's password using the PAM module.
23912
23913 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
23914
23915 @end deftypevr
23916
23917 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string rootpwmodpw
23918 Specifies the credentials with which to bind if the root user tries to
23919 change a user's password. This option is only applicable when used with
23920 rootpwmoddn
23921
23922 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
23923
23924 @end deftypevr
23925
23926 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string sasl-mech
23927 Specifies the SASL mechanism to be used when performing SASL
23928 authentication.
23929
23930 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
23931
23932 @end deftypevr
23933
23934 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string sasl-realm
23935 Specifies the SASL realm to be used when performing SASL authentication.
23936
23937 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
23938
23939 @end deftypevr
23940
23941 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string sasl-authcid
23942 Specifies the authentication identity to be used when performing SASL
23943 authentication.
23944
23945 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
23946
23947 @end deftypevr
23948
23949 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string sasl-authzid
23950 Specifies the authorization identity to be used when performing SASL
23951 authentication.
23952
23953 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
23954
23955 @end deftypevr
23956
23957 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-boolean sasl-canonicalize?
23958 Determines whether the LDAP server host name should be canonicalised. If
23959 this is enabled the LDAP library will do a reverse host name lookup. By
23960 default, it is left up to the LDAP library whether this check is
23961 performed or not.
23962
23963 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
23964
23965 @end deftypevr
23966
23967 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string krb5-ccname
23968 Set the name for the GSS-API Kerberos credentials cache.
23969
23970 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
23971
23972 @end deftypevr
23973
23974 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} string base
23975 The directory search base.
23976
23977 Defaults to @samp{"dc=example,dc=com"}.
23978
23979 @end deftypevr
23980
23981 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} scope-option scope
23982 Specifies the search scope (subtree, onelevel, base or children). The
23983 default scope is subtree; base scope is almost never useful for name
23984 service lookups; children scope is not supported on all servers.
23985
23986 Defaults to @samp{(subtree)}.
23987
23988 @end deftypevr
23989
23990 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-deref-option deref
23991 Specifies the policy for dereferencing aliases. The default policy is
23992 to never dereference aliases.
23993
23994 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
23995
23996 @end deftypevr
23997
23998 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-boolean referrals
23999 Specifies whether automatic referral chasing should be enabled. The
24000 default behaviour is to chase referrals.
24001
24002 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
24003
24004 @end deftypevr
24005
24006 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} list-of-map-entries maps
24007 This option allows for custom attributes to be looked up instead of the
24008 default RFC 2307 attributes. It is a list of maps, each consisting of
24009 the name of a map, the RFC 2307 attribute to match and the query
24010 expression for the attribute as it is available in the directory.
24011
24012 Defaults to @samp{()}.
24013
24014 @end deftypevr
24015
24016 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} list-of-filter-entries filters
24017 A list of filters consisting of the name of a map to which the filter
24018 applies and an LDAP search filter expression.
24019
24020 Defaults to @samp{()}.
24021
24022 @end deftypevr
24023
24024 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-number bind-timelimit
24025 Specifies the time limit in seconds to use when connecting to the
24026 directory server. The default value is 10 seconds.
24027
24028 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
24029
24030 @end deftypevr
24031
24032 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-number timelimit
24033 Specifies the time limit (in seconds) to wait for a response from the
24034 LDAP server. A value of zero, which is the default, is to wait
24035 indefinitely for searches to be completed.
24036
24037 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
24038
24039 @end deftypevr
24040
24041 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-number idle-timelimit
24042 Specifies the period if inactivity (in seconds) after which the con‐
24043 nection to the LDAP server will be closed. The default is not to time
24044 out connections.
24045
24046 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
24047
24048 @end deftypevr
24049
24050 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-number reconnect-sleeptime
24051 Specifies the number of seconds to sleep when connecting to all LDAP
24052 servers fails. By default one second is waited between the first
24053 failure and the first retry.
24054
24055 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
24056
24057 @end deftypevr
24058
24059 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-number reconnect-retrytime
24060 Specifies the time after which the LDAP server is considered to be
24061 permanently unavailable. Once this time is reached retries will be done
24062 only once per this time period. The default value is 10 seconds.
24063
24064 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
24065
24066 @end deftypevr
24067
24068 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-ssl-option ssl
24069 Specifies whether to use SSL/TLS or not (the default is not to). If
24070 'start-tls is specified then StartTLS is used rather than raw LDAP over
24071 SSL.
24072
24073 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
24074
24075 @end deftypevr
24076
24077 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-tls-reqcert-option tls-reqcert
24078 Specifies what checks to perform on a server-supplied certificate. The
24079 meaning of the values is described in the ldap.conf(5) manual page.
24080
24081 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
24082
24083 @end deftypevr
24084
24085 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string tls-cacertdir
24086 Specifies the directory containing X.509 certificates for peer authen‐
24087 tication. This parameter is ignored when using GnuTLS.
24088
24089 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
24090
24091 @end deftypevr
24092
24093 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string tls-cacertfile
24094 Specifies the path to the X.509 certificate for peer authentication.
24095
24096 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
24097
24098 @end deftypevr
24099
24100 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string tls-randfile
24101 Specifies the path to an entropy source. This parameter is ignored when
24102 using GnuTLS.
24103
24104 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
24105
24106 @end deftypevr
24107
24108 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string tls-ciphers
24109 Specifies the ciphers to use for TLS as a string.
24110
24111 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
24112
24113 @end deftypevr
24114
24115 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string tls-cert
24116 Specifies the path to the file containing the local certificate for
24117 client TLS authentication.
24118
24119 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
24120
24121 @end deftypevr
24122
24123 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string tls-key
24124 Specifies the path to the file containing the private key for client TLS
24125 authentication.
24126
24127 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
24128
24129 @end deftypevr
24130
24131 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-number pagesize
24132 Set this to a number greater than 0 to request paged results from the
24133 LDAP server in accordance with RFC2696. The default (0) is to not
24134 request paged results.
24135
24136 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
24137
24138 @end deftypevr
24139
24140 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-ignore-users-option nss-initgroups-ignoreusers
24141 This option prevents group membership lookups through LDAP for the
24142 specified users. Alternatively, the value 'all-local may be used. With
24143 that value nslcd builds a full list of non-LDAP users on startup.
24144
24145 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
24146
24147 @end deftypevr
24148
24149 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-number nss-min-uid
24150 This option ensures that LDAP users with a numeric user id lower than
24151 the specified value are ignored.
24152
24153 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
24154
24155 @end deftypevr
24156
24157 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-number nss-uid-offset
24158 This option specifies an offset that is added to all LDAP numeric user
24159 ids. This can be used to avoid user id collisions with local users.
24160
24161 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
24162
24163 @end deftypevr
24164
24165 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-number nss-gid-offset
24166 This option specifies an offset that is added to all LDAP numeric group
24167 ids. This can be used to avoid user id collisions with local groups.
24168
24169 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
24170
24171 @end deftypevr
24172
24173 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-boolean nss-nested-groups
24174 If this option is set, the member attribute of a group may point to
24175 another group. Members of nested groups are also returned in the higher
24176 level group and parent groups are returned when finding groups for a
24177 specific user. The default is not to perform extra searches for nested
24178 groups.
24179
24180 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
24181
24182 @end deftypevr
24183
24184 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-boolean nss-getgrent-skipmembers
24185 If this option is set, the group member list is not retrieved when
24186 looking up groups. Lookups for finding which groups a user belongs to
24187 will remain functional so the user will likely still get the correct
24188 groups assigned on login.
24189
24190 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
24191
24192 @end deftypevr
24193
24194 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-boolean nss-disable-enumeration
24195 If this option is set, functions which cause all user/group entries to
24196 be loaded from the directory will not succeed in doing so. This can
24197 dramatically reduce LDAP server load in situations where there are a
24198 great number of users and/or groups. This option is not recommended for
24199 most configurations.
24200
24201 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
24202
24203 @end deftypevr
24204
24205 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string validnames
24206 This option can be used to specify how user and group names are verified
24207 within the system. This pattern is used to check all user and group
24208 names that are requested and returned from LDAP.
24209
24210 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
24211
24212 @end deftypevr
24213
24214 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-boolean ignorecase
24215 This specifies whether or not to perform searches using case-insensitive
24216 matching. Enabling this could open up the system to authorization
24217 bypass vulnerabilities and introduce nscd cache poisoning
24218 vulnerabilities which allow denial of service.
24219
24220 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
24221
24222 @end deftypevr
24223
24224 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-boolean pam-authc-ppolicy
24225 This option specifies whether password policy controls are requested and
24226 handled from the LDAP server when performing user authentication.
24227
24228 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
24229
24230 @end deftypevr
24231
24232 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string pam-authc-search
24233 By default nslcd performs an LDAP search with the user's credentials
24234 after BIND (authentication) to ensure that the BIND operation was
24235 successful. The default search is a simple check to see if the user's
24236 DN exists. A search filter can be specified that will be used instead.
24237 It should return at least one entry.
24238
24239 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
24240
24241 @end deftypevr
24242
24243 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string pam-authz-search
24244 This option allows flexible fine tuning of the authorisation check that
24245 should be performed. The search filter specified is executed and if any
24246 entries match, access is granted, otherwise access is denied.
24247
24248 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
24249
24250 @end deftypevr
24251
24252 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string pam-password-prohibit-message
24253 If this option is set password modification using pam_ldap will be
24254 denied and the specified message will be presented to the user instead.
24255 The message can be used to direct the user to an alternative means of
24256 changing their password.
24257
24258 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
24259
24260 @end deftypevr
24261
24262 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} list pam-services
24263 List of pam service names for which LDAP authentication should suffice.
24264
24265 Defaults to @samp{()}.
24266
24267 @end deftypevr
24268
24269 @c %end of generated documentation for nslcd-configuration
24270
24271
24272 @node Web Services
24273 @subsection Web Services
24274
24275 @cindex web
24276 @cindex www
24277 @cindex HTTP
24278 The @code{(gnu services web)} module provides the Apache HTTP Server,
24279 the nginx web server, and also a fastcgi wrapper daemon.
24280
24281 @subsubheading Apache HTTP Server
24282
24283 @deffn {Scheme Variable} httpd-service-type
24284 Service type for the @uref{https://httpd.apache.org/,Apache HTTP} server
24285 (@dfn{httpd}). The value for this service type is a
24286 @code{httpd-configuration} record.
24287
24288 A simple example configuration is given below.
24289
24290 @lisp
24291 (service httpd-service-type
24292 (httpd-configuration
24293 (config
24294 (httpd-config-file
24295 (server-name "www.example.com")
24296 (document-root "/srv/http/www.example.com")))))
24297 @end lisp
24298
24299 Other services can also extend the @code{httpd-service-type} to add to
24300 the configuration.
24301
24302 @lisp
24303 (simple-service 'www.example.com-server httpd-service-type
24304 (list
24305 (httpd-virtualhost
24306 "*:80"
24307 (list (string-join '("ServerName www.example.com"
24308 "DocumentRoot /srv/http/www.example.com")
24309 "\n")))))
24310 @end lisp
24311 @end deffn
24312
24313 The details for the @code{httpd-configuration}, @code{httpd-module},
24314 @code{httpd-config-file} and @code{httpd-virtualhost} record types are
24315 given below.
24316
24317 @deffn {Data Type} httpd-configuration
24318 This data type represents the configuration for the httpd service.
24319
24320 @table @asis
24321 @item @code{package} (default: @code{httpd})
24322 The httpd package to use.
24323
24324 @item @code{pid-file} (default: @code{"/var/run/httpd"})
24325 The pid file used by the shepherd-service.
24326
24327 @item @code{config} (default: @code{(httpd-config-file)})
24328 The configuration file to use with the httpd service. The default value
24329 is a @code{httpd-config-file} record, but this can also be a different
24330 G-expression that generates a file, for example a @code{plain-file}. A
24331 file outside of the store can also be specified through a string.
24332
24333 @end table
24334 @end deffn
24335
24336 @deffn {Data Type} httpd-module
24337 This data type represents a module for the httpd service.
24338
24339 @table @asis
24340 @item @code{name}
24341 The name of the module.
24342
24343 @item @code{file}
24344 The file for the module. This can be relative to the httpd package being
24345 used, the absolute location of a file, or a G-expression for a file
24346 within the store, for example @code{(file-append mod-wsgi
24347 "/modules/mod_wsgi.so")}.
24348
24349 @end table
24350 @end deffn
24351
24352 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %default-httpd-modules
24353 A default list of @code{httpd-module} objects.
24354 @end defvr
24355
24356 @deffn {Data Type} httpd-config-file
24357 This data type represents a configuration file for the httpd service.
24358
24359 @table @asis
24360 @item @code{modules} (default: @code{%default-httpd-modules})
24361 The modules to load. Additional modules can be added here, or loaded by
24362 additional configuration.
24363
24364 For example, in order to handle requests for PHP files, you can use Apache’s
24365 @code{mod_proxy_fcgi} module along with @code{php-fpm-service-type}:
24366
24367 @lisp
24368 (service httpd-service-type
24369 (httpd-configuration
24370 (config
24371 (httpd-config-file
24372 (modules (cons*
24373 (httpd-module
24374 (name "proxy_module")
24375 (file "modules/mod_proxy.so"))
24376 (httpd-module
24377 (name "proxy_fcgi_module")
24378 (file "modules/mod_proxy_fcgi.so"))
24379 %default-httpd-modules))
24380 (extra-config (list "\
24381 <FilesMatch \\.php$>
24382 SetHandler \"proxy:unix:/var/run/php-fpm.sock|fcgi://localhost/\"
24383 </FilesMatch>"))))))
24384 (service php-fpm-service-type
24385 (php-fpm-configuration
24386 (socket "/var/run/php-fpm.sock")
24387 (socket-group "httpd")))
24388 @end lisp
24389
24390 @item @code{server-root} (default: @code{httpd})
24391 The @code{ServerRoot} in the configuration file, defaults to the httpd
24392 package. Directives including @code{Include} and @code{LoadModule} are
24393 taken as relative to the server root.
24394
24395 @item @code{server-name} (default: @code{#f})
24396 The @code{ServerName} in the configuration file, used to specify the
24397 request scheme, hostname and port that the server uses to identify
24398 itself.
24399
24400 This doesn't need to be set in the server config, and can be specified
24401 in virtual hosts. The default is @code{#f} to not specify a
24402 @code{ServerName}.
24403
24404 @item @code{document-root} (default: @code{"/srv/http"})
24405 The @code{DocumentRoot} from which files will be served.
24406
24407 @item @code{listen} (default: @code{'("80")})
24408 The list of values for the @code{Listen} directives in the config
24409 file. The value should be a list of strings, when each string can
24410 specify the port number to listen on, and optionally the IP address and
24411 protocol to use.
24412
24413 @item @code{pid-file} (default: @code{"/var/run/httpd"})
24414 The @code{PidFile} to use. This should match the @code{pid-file} set in
24415 the @code{httpd-configuration} so that the Shepherd service is
24416 configured correctly.
24417
24418 @item @code{error-log} (default: @code{"/var/log/httpd/error_log"})
24419 The @code{ErrorLog} to which the server will log errors.
24420
24421 @item @code{user} (default: @code{"httpd"})
24422 The @code{User} which the server will answer requests as.
24423
24424 @item @code{group} (default: @code{"httpd"})
24425 The @code{Group} which the server will answer requests as.
24426
24427 @item @code{extra-config} (default: @code{(list "TypesConfig etc/httpd/mime.types")})
24428 A flat list of strings and G-expressions which will be added to the end
24429 of the configuration file.
24430
24431 Any values which the service is extended with will be appended to this
24432 list.
24433
24434 @end table
24435 @end deffn
24436
24437 @deffn {Data Type} httpd-virtualhost
24438 This data type represents a virtualhost configuration block for the httpd service.
24439
24440 These should be added to the extra-config for the httpd-service.
24441
24442 @lisp
24443 (simple-service 'www.example.com-server httpd-service-type
24444 (list
24445 (httpd-virtualhost
24446 "*:80"
24447 (list (string-join '("ServerName www.example.com"
24448 "DocumentRoot /srv/http/www.example.com")
24449 "\n")))))
24450 @end lisp
24451
24452 @table @asis
24453 @item @code{addresses-and-ports}
24454 The addresses and ports for the @code{VirtualHost} directive.
24455
24456 @item @code{contents}
24457 The contents of the @code{VirtualHost} directive, this should be a list
24458 of strings and G-expressions.
24459
24460 @end table
24461 @end deffn
24462
24463 @subsubheading NGINX
24464
24465 @deffn {Scheme Variable} nginx-service-type
24466 Service type for the @uref{https://nginx.org/,NGinx} web server. The
24467 value for this service type is a @code{<nginx-configuration>} record.
24468
24469 A simple example configuration is given below.
24470
24471 @lisp
24472 (service nginx-service-type
24473 (nginx-configuration
24474 (server-blocks
24475 (list (nginx-server-configuration
24476 (server-name '("www.example.com"))
24477 (root "/srv/http/www.example.com"))))))
24478 @end lisp
24479
24480 In addition to adding server blocks to the service configuration
24481 directly, this service can be extended by other services to add server
24482 blocks, as in this example:
24483
24484 @lisp
24485 (simple-service 'my-extra-server nginx-service-type
24486 (list (nginx-server-configuration
24487 (root "/srv/http/extra-website")
24488 (try-files (list "$uri" "$uri/index.html")))))
24489 @end lisp
24490 @end deffn
24491
24492 At startup, @command{nginx} has not yet read its configuration file, so
24493 it uses a default file to log error messages. If it fails to load its
24494 configuration file, that is where error messages are logged. After the
24495 configuration file is loaded, the default error log file changes as per
24496 configuration. In our case, startup error messages can be found in
24497 @file{/var/run/nginx/logs/error.log}, and after configuration in
24498 @file{/var/log/nginx/error.log}. The second location can be changed
24499 with the @var{log-directory} configuration option.
24500
24501 @deffn {Data Type} nginx-configuration
24502 This data type represents the configuration for NGinx. Some
24503 configuration can be done through this and the other provided record
24504 types, or alternatively, a config file can be provided.
24505
24506 @table @asis
24507 @item @code{nginx} (default: @code{nginx})
24508 The nginx package to use.
24509
24510 @item @code{log-directory} (default: @code{"/var/log/nginx"})
24511 The directory to which NGinx will write log files.
24512
24513 @item @code{run-directory} (default: @code{"/var/run/nginx"})
24514 The directory in which NGinx will create a pid file, and write temporary
24515 files.
24516
24517 @item @code{server-blocks} (default: @code{'()})
24518 A list of @dfn{server blocks} to create in the generated configuration
24519 file, the elements should be of type
24520 @code{<nginx-server-configuration>}.
24521
24522 The following example would setup NGinx to serve @code{www.example.com}
24523 from the @code{/srv/http/www.example.com} directory, without using
24524 HTTPS.
24525 @lisp
24526 (service nginx-service-type
24527 (nginx-configuration
24528 (server-blocks
24529 (list (nginx-server-configuration
24530 (server-name '("www.example.com"))
24531 (root "/srv/http/www.example.com"))))))
24532 @end lisp
24533
24534 @item @code{upstream-blocks} (default: @code{'()})
24535 A list of @dfn{upstream blocks} to create in the generated configuration
24536 file, the elements should be of type
24537 @code{<nginx-upstream-configuration>}.
24538
24539 Configuring upstreams through the @code{upstream-blocks} can be useful
24540 when combined with @code{locations} in the
24541 @code{<nginx-server-configuration>} records. The following example
24542 creates a server configuration with one location configuration, that
24543 will proxy requests to a upstream configuration, which will handle
24544 requests with two servers.
24545
24546 @lisp
24547 (service
24548 nginx-service-type
24549 (nginx-configuration
24550 (server-blocks
24551 (list (nginx-server-configuration
24552 (server-name '("www.example.com"))
24553 (root "/srv/http/www.example.com")
24554 (locations
24555 (list
24556 (nginx-location-configuration
24557 (uri "/path1")
24558 (body '("proxy_pass http://server-proxy;"))))))))
24559 (upstream-blocks
24560 (list (nginx-upstream-configuration
24561 (name "server-proxy")
24562 (servers (list "server1.example.com"
24563 "server2.example.com")))))))
24564 @end lisp
24565
24566 @item @code{file} (default: @code{#f})
24567 If a configuration @var{file} is provided, this will be used, rather than
24568 generating a configuration file from the provided @code{log-directory},
24569 @code{run-directory}, @code{server-blocks} and @code{upstream-blocks}. For
24570 proper operation, these arguments should match what is in @var{file} to ensure
24571 that the directories are created when the service is activated.
24572
24573 This can be useful if you have an existing configuration file, or it's
24574 not possible to do what is required through the other parts of the
24575 nginx-configuration record.
24576
24577 @item @code{server-names-hash-bucket-size} (default: @code{#f})
24578 Bucket size for the server names hash tables, defaults to @code{#f} to
24579 use the size of the processors cache line.
24580
24581 @item @code{server-names-hash-bucket-max-size} (default: @code{#f})
24582 Maximum bucket size for the server names hash tables.
24583
24584 @item @code{modules} (default: @code{'()})
24585 List of nginx dynamic modules to load. This should be a list of file
24586 names of loadable modules, as in this example:
24587
24588 @lisp
24589 (modules
24590 (list
24591 (file-append nginx-accept-language-module "\
24592 /etc/nginx/modules/ngx_http_accept_language_module.so")
24593 (file-append nginx-lua-module "\
24594 /etc/nginx/modules/ngx_http_lua_module.so")))
24595 @end lisp
24596
24597 @item @code{lua-package-path} (default: @code{'()})
24598 List of nginx lua packages to load. This should be a list of package
24599 names of loadable lua modules, as in this example:
24600
24601 @lisp
24602 (lua-package-path (list lua-resty-core
24603 lua-resty-lrucache
24604 lua-resty-signal
24605 lua-tablepool
24606 lua-resty-shell))
24607 @end lisp
24608
24609 @item @code{lua-package-cpath} (default: @code{'()})
24610 List of nginx lua C packages to load. This should be a list of package
24611 names of loadable lua C modules, as in this example:
24612
24613 @lisp
24614 (lua-package-cpath (list lua-resty-signal))
24615 @end lisp
24616
24617 @item @code{global-directives} (default: @code{'((events . ()))})
24618 Association list of global directives for the top level of the nginx
24619 configuration. Values may themselves be association lists.
24620
24621 @lisp
24622 (global-directives
24623 `((worker_processes . 16)
24624 (pcre_jit . on)
24625 (events . ((worker_connections . 1024)))))
24626 @end lisp
24627
24628 @item @code{extra-content} (default: @code{""})
24629 Extra content for the @code{http} block. Should be string or a string
24630 valued G-expression.
24631
24632 @end table
24633 @end deffn
24634
24635 @deftp {Data Type} nginx-server-configuration
24636 Data type representing the configuration of an nginx server block.
24637 This type has the following parameters:
24638
24639 @table @asis
24640 @item @code{listen} (default: @code{'("80" "443 ssl")})
24641 Each @code{listen} directive sets the address and port for IP, or the
24642 path for a UNIX-domain socket on which the server will accept requests.
24643 Both address and port, or only address or only port can be specified.
24644 An address may also be a hostname, for example:
24645
24646 @lisp
24647 '("127.0.0.1:8000" "127.0.0.1" "8000" "*:8000" "localhost:8000")
24648 @end lisp
24649
24650 @item @code{server-name} (default: @code{(list 'default)})
24651 A list of server names this server represents. @code{'default} represents the
24652 default server for connections matching no other server.
24653
24654 @item @code{root} (default: @code{"/srv/http"})
24655 Root of the website nginx will serve.
24656
24657 @item @code{locations} (default: @code{'()})
24658 A list of @dfn{nginx-location-configuration} or
24659 @dfn{nginx-named-location-configuration} records to use within this
24660 server block.
24661
24662 @item @code{index} (default: @code{(list "index.html")})
24663 Index files to look for when clients ask for a directory. If it cannot be found,
24664 Nginx will send the list of files in the directory.
24665
24666 @item @code{try-files} (default: @code{'()})
24667 A list of files whose existence is checked in the specified order.
24668 @code{nginx} will use the first file it finds to process the request.
24669
24670 @item @code{ssl-certificate} (default: @code{#f})
24671 Where to find the certificate for secure connections. Set it to @code{#f} if
24672 you don't have a certificate or you don't want to use HTTPS.
24673
24674 @item @code{ssl-certificate-key} (default: @code{#f})
24675 Where to find the private key for secure connections. Set it to @code{#f} if
24676 you don't have a key or you don't want to use HTTPS.
24677
24678 @item @code{server-tokens?} (default: @code{#f})
24679 Whether the server should add its configuration to response.
24680
24681 @item @code{raw-content} (default: @code{'()})
24682 A list of raw lines added to the server block.
24683
24684 @end table
24685 @end deftp
24686
24687 @deftp {Data Type} nginx-upstream-configuration
24688 Data type representing the configuration of an nginx @code{upstream}
24689 block. This type has the following parameters:
24690
24691 @table @asis
24692 @item @code{name}
24693 Name for this group of servers.
24694
24695 @item @code{servers}
24696 Specify the addresses of the servers in the group. The address can be
24697 specified as a IP address (e.g.@: @samp{127.0.0.1}), domain name
24698 (e.g.@: @samp{backend1.example.com}) or a path to a UNIX socket using the
24699 prefix @samp{unix:}. For addresses using an IP address or domain name,
24700 the default port is 80, and a different port can be specified
24701 explicitly.
24702
24703 @end table
24704 @end deftp
24705
24706 @deftp {Data Type} nginx-location-configuration
24707 Data type representing the configuration of an nginx @code{location}
24708 block. This type has the following parameters:
24709
24710 @table @asis
24711 @item @code{uri}
24712 URI which this location block matches.
24713
24714 @anchor{nginx-location-configuration body}
24715 @item @code{body}
24716 Body of the location block, specified as a list of strings. This can contain
24717 many
24718 configuration directives. For example, to pass requests to a upstream
24719 server group defined using an @code{nginx-upstream-configuration} block,
24720 the following directive would be specified in the body @samp{(list "proxy_pass
24721 http://upstream-name;")}.
24722
24723 @end table
24724 @end deftp
24725
24726 @deftp {Data Type} nginx-named-location-configuration
24727 Data type representing the configuration of an nginx named location
24728 block. Named location blocks are used for request redirection, and not
24729 used for regular request processing. This type has the following
24730 parameters:
24731
24732 @table @asis
24733 @item @code{name}
24734 Name to identify this location block.
24735
24736 @item @code{body}
24737 @xref{nginx-location-configuration body}, as the body for named location
24738 blocks can be used in a similar way to the
24739 @code{nginx-location-configuration body}. One restriction is that the
24740 body of a named location block cannot contain location blocks.
24741
24742 @end table
24743 @end deftp
24744
24745 @subsubheading Varnish Cache
24746 @cindex Varnish
24747 Varnish is a fast cache server that sits in between web applications
24748 and end users. It proxies requests from clients and caches the
24749 accessed URLs such that multiple requests for the same resource only
24750 creates one request to the back-end.
24751
24752 @defvr {Scheme Variable} varnish-service-type
24753 Service type for the Varnish daemon.
24754 @end defvr
24755
24756 @deftp {Data Type} varnish-configuration
24757 Data type representing the @code{varnish} service configuration.
24758 This type has the following parameters:
24759
24760 @table @asis
24761 @item @code{package} (default: @code{varnish})
24762 The Varnish package to use.
24763
24764 @item @code{name} (default: @code{"default"})
24765 A name for this Varnish instance. Varnish will create a directory in
24766 @file{/var/varnish/} with this name and keep temporary files there. If
24767 the name starts with a forward slash, it is interpreted as an absolute
24768 directory name.
24769
24770 Pass the @code{-n} argument to other Varnish programs to connect to the
24771 named instance, e.g.@: @command{varnishncsa -n default}.
24772
24773 @item @code{backend} (default: @code{"localhost:8080"})
24774 The backend to use. This option has no effect if @code{vcl} is set.
24775
24776 @item @code{vcl} (default: #f)
24777 The @dfn{VCL} (Varnish Configuration Language) program to run. If this
24778 is @code{#f}, Varnish will proxy @code{backend} using the default
24779 configuration. Otherwise this must be a file-like object with valid
24780 VCL syntax.
24781
24782 @c Varnish does not support HTTPS, so keep this URL to avoid confusion.
24783 For example, to mirror @url{https://www.gnu.org,www.gnu.org} with VCL you
24784 can do something along these lines:
24785
24786 @lisp
24787 (define %gnu-mirror
24788 (plain-file "gnu.vcl"
24789 "vcl 4.1;
24790 backend gnu @{ .host = \"www.gnu.org\"; @}"))
24791
24792 (operating-system
24793 ;; @dots{}
24794 (services (cons (service varnish-service-type
24795 (varnish-configuration
24796 (listen '(":80"))
24797 (vcl %gnu-mirror)))
24798 %base-services)))
24799 @end lisp
24800
24801 The configuration of an already running Varnish instance can be inspected
24802 and changed using the @command{varnishadm} program.
24803
24804 Consult the @url{https://varnish-cache.org/docs/,Varnish User Guide} and
24805 @url{https://book.varnish-software.com/4.0/,Varnish Book} for
24806 comprehensive documentation on Varnish and its configuration language.
24807
24808 @item @code{listen} (default: @code{'("localhost:80")})
24809 List of addresses Varnish will listen on.
24810
24811 @item @code{storage} (default: @code{'("malloc,128m")})
24812 List of storage backends that will be available in VCL.
24813
24814 @item @code{parameters} (default: @code{'()})
24815 List of run-time parameters in the form @code{'(("parameter" . "value"))}.
24816
24817 @item @code{extra-options} (default: @code{'()})
24818 Additional arguments to pass to the @command{varnishd} process.
24819
24820 @end table
24821 @end deftp
24822
24823 @subsubheading Patchwork
24824 @cindex Patchwork
24825 Patchwork is a patch tracking system. It can collect patches sent to a
24826 mailing list, and display them in a web interface.
24827
24828 @defvr {Scheme Variable} patchwork-service-type
24829 Service type for Patchwork.
24830 @end defvr
24831
24832 The following example is an example of a minimal service for Patchwork, for
24833 the @code{patchwork.example.com} domain.
24834
24835 @lisp
24836 (service patchwork-service-type
24837 (patchwork-configuration
24838 (domain "patchwork.example.com")
24839 (settings-module
24840 (patchwork-settings-module
24841 (allowed-hosts (list domain))
24842 (default-from-email "patchwork@@patchwork.example.com")))
24843 (getmail-retriever-config
24844 (getmail-retriever-configuration
24845 (type "SimpleIMAPSSLRetriever")
24846 (server "imap.example.com")
24847 (port 993)
24848 (username "patchwork")
24849 (password-command
24850 (list (file-append coreutils "/bin/cat")
24851 "/etc/getmail-patchwork-imap-password"))
24852 (extra-parameters
24853 '((mailboxes . ("Patches"))))))))
24854
24855 @end lisp
24856
24857 There are three records for configuring the Patchwork service. The
24858 @code{<patchwork-configuration>} relates to the configuration for Patchwork
24859 within the HTTPD service.
24860
24861 The @code{settings-module} field within the @code{<patchwork-configuration>}
24862 record can be populated with the @code{<patchwork-settings-module>} record,
24863 which describes a settings module that is generated within the Guix store.
24864
24865 For the @code{database-configuration} field within the
24866 @code{<patchwork-settings-module>}, the
24867 @code{<patchwork-database-configuration>} must be used.
24868
24869 @deftp {Data Type} patchwork-configuration
24870 Data type representing the Patchwork service configuration. This type has the
24871 following parameters:
24872
24873 @table @asis
24874 @item @code{patchwork} (default: @code{patchwork})
24875 The Patchwork package to use.
24876
24877 @item @code{domain}
24878 The domain to use for Patchwork, this is used in the HTTPD service virtual
24879 host.
24880
24881 @item @code{settings-module}
24882 The settings module to use for Patchwork. As a Django application, Patchwork
24883 is configured with a Python module containing the settings. This can either be
24884 an instance of the @code{<patchwork-settings-module>} record, any other record
24885 that represents the settings in the store, or a directory outside of the
24886 store.
24887
24888 @item @code{static-path} (default: @code{"/static/"})
24889 The path under which the HTTPD service should serve the static files.
24890
24891 @item @code{getmail-retriever-config}
24892 The getmail-retriever-configuration record value to use with
24893 Patchwork. Getmail will be configured with this value, the messages will be
24894 delivered to Patchwork.
24895
24896 @end table
24897 @end deftp
24898
24899 @deftp {Data Type} patchwork-settings-module
24900 Data type representing a settings module for Patchwork. Some of these
24901 settings relate directly to Patchwork, but others relate to Django, the web
24902 framework used by Patchwork, or the Django Rest Framework library. This type
24903 has the following parameters:
24904
24905 @table @asis
24906 @item @code{database-configuration} (default: @code{(patchwork-database-configuration)})
24907 The database connection settings used for Patchwork. See the
24908 @code{<patchwork-database-configuration>} record type for more information.
24909
24910 @item @code{secret-key-file} (default: @code{"/etc/patchwork/django-secret-key"})
24911 Patchwork, as a Django web application uses a secret key for cryptographically
24912 signing values. This file should contain a unique unpredictable value.
24913
24914 If this file does not exist, it will be created and populated with a random
24915 value by the patchwork-setup shepherd service.
24916
24917 This setting relates to Django.
24918
24919 @item @code{allowed-hosts}
24920 A list of valid hosts for this Patchwork service. This should at least include
24921 the domain specified in the @code{<patchwork-configuration>} record.
24922
24923 This is a Django setting.
24924
24925 @item @code{default-from-email}
24926 The email address from which Patchwork should send email by default.
24927
24928 This is a Patchwork setting.
24929
24930 @item @code{static-url} (default: @code{#f})
24931 The URL to use when serving static assets. It can be part of a URL, or a full
24932 URL, but must end in a @code{/}.
24933
24934 If the default value is used, the @code{static-path} value from the
24935 @code{<patchwork-configuration>} record will be used.
24936
24937 This is a Django setting.
24938
24939 @item @code{admins} (default: @code{'()})
24940 Email addresses to send the details of errors that occur. Each value should
24941 be a list containing two elements, the name and then the email address.
24942
24943 This is a Django setting.
24944
24945 @item @code{debug?} (default: @code{#f})
24946 Whether to run Patchwork in debug mode. If set to @code{#t}, detailed error
24947 messages will be shown.
24948
24949 This is a Django setting.
24950
24951 @item @code{enable-rest-api?} (default: @code{#t})
24952 Whether to enable the Patchwork REST API.
24953
24954 This is a Patchwork setting.
24955
24956 @item @code{enable-xmlrpc?} (default: @code{#t})
24957 Whether to enable the XML RPC API.
24958
24959 This is a Patchwork setting.
24960
24961 @item @code{force-https-links?} (default: @code{#t})
24962 Whether to use HTTPS links on Patchwork pages.
24963
24964 This is a Patchwork setting.
24965
24966 @item @code{extra-settings} (default: @code{""})
24967 Extra code to place at the end of the Patchwork settings module.
24968
24969 @end table
24970 @end deftp
24971
24972 @deftp {Data Type} patchwork-database-configuration
24973 Data type representing the database configuration for Patchwork.
24974
24975 @table @asis
24976 @item @code{engine} (default: @code{"django.db.backends.postgresql_psycopg2"})
24977 The database engine to use.
24978
24979 @item @code{name} (default: @code{"patchwork"})
24980 The name of the database to use.
24981
24982 @item @code{user} (default: @code{"httpd"})
24983 The user to connect to the database as.
24984
24985 @item @code{password} (default: @code{""})
24986 The password to use when connecting to the database.
24987
24988 @item @code{host} (default: @code{""})
24989 The host to make the database connection to.
24990
24991 @item @code{port} (default: @code{""})
24992 The port on which to connect to the database.
24993
24994 @end table
24995 @end deftp
24996
24997 @subsubheading Mumi
24998
24999 @cindex Mumi, Debbugs Web interface
25000 @cindex Debbugs, Mumi Web interface
25001 @uref{https://git.elephly.net/gitweb.cgi?p=software/mumi.git, Mumi} is a
25002 Web interface to the Debbugs bug tracker, by default for
25003 @uref{https://bugs.gnu.org, the GNU instance}. Mumi is a Web server,
25004 but it also fetches and indexes mail retrieved from Debbugs.
25005
25006 @defvr {Scheme Variable} mumi-service-type
25007 This is the service type for Mumi.
25008 @end defvr
25009
25010 @deftp {Data Type} mumi-configuration
25011 Data type representing the Mumi service configuration. This type has the
25012 following fields:
25013
25014 @table @asis
25015 @item @code{mumi} (default: @code{mumi})
25016 The Mumi package to use.
25017
25018 @item @code{mailer?} (default: @code{#true})
25019 Whether to enable or disable the mailer component.
25020
25021 @item @code{mumi-configuration-sender}
25022 The email address used as the sender for comments.
25023
25024 @item @code{mumi-configuration-smtp}
25025 A URI to configure the SMTP settings for Mailutils. This could be
25026 something like @code{sendmail:///path/to/bin/msmtp} or any other URI
25027 supported by Mailutils. @xref{SMTP Mailboxes, SMTP Mailboxes,,
25028 mailutils, GNU@tie{}Mailutils}.
25029
25030 @end table
25031 @end deftp
25032
25033
25034 @subsubheading FastCGI
25035 @cindex fastcgi
25036 @cindex fcgiwrap
25037 FastCGI is an interface between the front-end and the back-end of a web
25038 service. It is a somewhat legacy facility; new web services should
25039 generally just talk HTTP between the front-end and the back-end.
25040 However there are a number of back-end services such as PHP or the
25041 optimized HTTP Git repository access that use FastCGI, so we have
25042 support for it in Guix.
25043
25044 To use FastCGI, you configure the front-end web server (e.g., nginx) to
25045 dispatch some subset of its requests to the fastcgi backend, which
25046 listens on a local TCP or UNIX socket. There is an intermediary
25047 @code{fcgiwrap} program that sits between the actual backend process and
25048 the web server. The front-end indicates which backend program to run,
25049 passing that information to the @code{fcgiwrap} process.
25050
25051 @defvr {Scheme Variable} fcgiwrap-service-type
25052 A service type for the @code{fcgiwrap} FastCGI proxy.
25053 @end defvr
25054
25055 @deftp {Data Type} fcgiwrap-configuration
25056 Data type representing the configuration of the @code{fcgiwrap} service.
25057 This type has the following parameters:
25058 @table @asis
25059 @item @code{package} (default: @code{fcgiwrap})
25060 The fcgiwrap package to use.
25061
25062 @item @code{socket} (default: @code{tcp:127.0.0.1:9000})
25063 The socket on which the @code{fcgiwrap} process should listen, as a
25064 string. Valid @var{socket} values include
25065 @code{unix:@var{/path/to/unix/socket}},
25066 @code{tcp:@var{dot.ted.qu.ad}:@var{port}} and
25067 @code{tcp6:[@var{ipv6_addr}]:port}.
25068
25069 @item @code{user} (default: @code{fcgiwrap})
25070 @itemx @code{group} (default: @code{fcgiwrap})
25071 The user and group names, as strings, under which to run the
25072 @code{fcgiwrap} process. The @code{fastcgi} service will ensure that if
25073 the user asks for the specific user or group names @code{fcgiwrap} that
25074 the corresponding user and/or group is present on the system.
25075
25076 It is possible to configure a FastCGI-backed web service to pass HTTP
25077 authentication information from the front-end to the back-end, and to
25078 allow @code{fcgiwrap} to run the back-end process as a corresponding
25079 local user. To enable this capability on the back-end, run
25080 @code{fcgiwrap} as the @code{root} user and group. Note that this
25081 capability also has to be configured on the front-end as well.
25082 @end table
25083 @end deftp
25084
25085 @cindex php-fpm
25086 PHP-FPM (FastCGI Process Manager) is an alternative PHP FastCGI implementation
25087 with some additional features useful for sites of any size.
25088
25089 These features include:
25090 @itemize @bullet
25091 @item Adaptive process spawning
25092 @item Basic statistics (similar to Apache's mod_status)
25093 @item Advanced process management with graceful stop/start
25094 @item Ability to start workers with different uid/gid/chroot/environment
25095 and different php.ini (replaces safe_mode)
25096 @item Stdout & stderr logging
25097 @item Emergency restart in case of accidental opcode cache destruction
25098 @item Accelerated upload support
25099 @item Support for a "slowlog"
25100 @item Enhancements to FastCGI, such as fastcgi_finish_request() -
25101 a special function to finish request & flush all data while continuing to do
25102 something time-consuming (video converting, stats processing, etc.)
25103 @end itemize
25104 ...@: and much more.
25105
25106 @defvr {Scheme Variable} php-fpm-service-type
25107 A Service type for @code{php-fpm}.
25108 @end defvr
25109
25110 @deftp {Data Type} php-fpm-configuration
25111 Data Type for php-fpm service configuration.
25112 @table @asis
25113 @item @code{php} (default: @code{php})
25114 The php package to use.
25115 @item @code{socket} (default: @code{(string-append "/var/run/php" (version-major (package-version php)) "-fpm.sock")})
25116 The address on which to accept FastCGI requests. Valid syntaxes are:
25117 @table @asis
25118 @item @code{"ip.add.re.ss:port"}
25119 Listen on a TCP socket to a specific address on a specific port.
25120 @item @code{"port"}
25121 Listen on a TCP socket to all addresses on a specific port.
25122 @item @code{"/path/to/unix/socket"}
25123 Listen on a unix socket.
25124 @end table
25125
25126 @item @code{user} (default: @code{php-fpm})
25127 User who will own the php worker processes.
25128 @item @code{group} (default: @code{php-fpm})
25129 Group of the worker processes.
25130 @item @code{socket-user} (default: @code{php-fpm})
25131 User who can speak to the php-fpm socket.
25132 @item @code{socket-group} (default: @code{nginx})
25133 Group that can speak to the php-fpm socket.
25134 @item @code{pid-file} (default: @code{(string-append "/var/run/php" (version-major (package-version php)) "-fpm.pid")})
25135 The process id of the php-fpm process is written to this file
25136 once the service has started.
25137 @item @code{log-file} (default: @code{(string-append "/var/log/php" (version-major (package-version php)) "-fpm.log")})
25138 Log for the php-fpm master process.
25139 @item @code{process-manager} (default: @code{(php-fpm-dynamic-process-manager-configuration)})
25140 Detailed settings for the php-fpm process manager.
25141 Must be one of:
25142 @table @asis
25143 @item @code{<php-fpm-dynamic-process-manager-configuration>}
25144 @item @code{<php-fpm-static-process-manager-configuration>}
25145 @item @code{<php-fpm-on-demand-process-manager-configuration>}
25146 @end table
25147 @item @code{display-errors} (default @code{#f})
25148 Determines whether php errors and warning should be sent to clients
25149 and displayed in their browsers.
25150 This is useful for local php development, but a security risk for public sites,
25151 as error messages can reveal passwords and personal data.
25152 @item @code{timezone} (default @code{#f})
25153 Specifies @code{php_admin_value[date.timezone]} parameter.
25154 @item @code{workers-logfile} (default @code{(string-append "/var/log/php" (version-major (package-version php)) "-fpm.www.log")})
25155 This file will log the @code{stderr} outputs of php worker processes.
25156 Can be set to @code{#f} to disable logging.
25157 @item @code{file} (default @code{#f})
25158 An optional override of the whole configuration.
25159 You can use the @code{mixed-text-file} function or an absolute filepath for it.
25160 @item @code{php-ini-file} (default @code{#f})
25161 An optional override of the default php settings.
25162 It may be any ``file-like'' object (@pxref{G-Expressions, file-like objects}).
25163 You can use the @code{mixed-text-file} function or an absolute filepath for it.
25164
25165 For local development it is useful to set a higher timeout and memory
25166 limit for spawned php processes. This be accomplished with the
25167 following operating system configuration snippet:
25168 @lisp
25169 (define %local-php-ini
25170 (plain-file "php.ini"
25171 "memory_limit = 2G
25172 max_execution_time = 1800"))
25173
25174 (operating-system
25175 ;; @dots{}
25176 (services (cons (service php-fpm-service-type
25177 (php-fpm-configuration
25178 (php-ini-file %local-php-ini)))
25179 %base-services)))
25180 @end lisp
25181
25182 Consult the @url{https://www.php.net/manual/en/ini.core.php,core php.ini
25183 directives} for comprehensive documentation on the acceptable
25184 @file{php.ini} directives.
25185 @end table
25186 @end deftp
25187
25188 @deftp {Data type} php-fpm-dynamic-process-manager-configuration
25189 Data Type for the @code{dynamic} php-fpm process manager. With the
25190 @code{dynamic} process manager, spare worker processes are kept around
25191 based on it's configured limits.
25192 @table @asis
25193 @item @code{max-children} (default: @code{5})
25194 Maximum of worker processes.
25195 @item @code{start-servers} (default: @code{2})
25196 How many worker processes should be started on start-up.
25197 @item @code{min-spare-servers} (default: @code{1})
25198 How many spare worker processes should be kept around at minimum.
25199 @item @code{max-spare-servers} (default: @code{3})
25200 How many spare worker processes should be kept around at maximum.
25201 @end table
25202 @end deftp
25203
25204 @deftp {Data type} php-fpm-static-process-manager-configuration
25205 Data Type for the @code{static} php-fpm process manager. With the
25206 @code{static} process manager, an unchanging number of worker processes
25207 are created.
25208 @table @asis
25209 @item @code{max-children} (default: @code{5})
25210 Maximum of worker processes.
25211 @end table
25212 @end deftp
25213
25214 @deftp {Data type} php-fpm-on-demand-process-manager-configuration
25215 Data Type for the @code{on-demand} php-fpm process manager. With the
25216 @code{on-demand} process manager, worker processes are only created as
25217 requests arrive.
25218 @table @asis
25219 @item @code{max-children} (default: @code{5})
25220 Maximum of worker processes.
25221 @item @code{process-idle-timeout} (default: @code{10})
25222 The time in seconds after which a process with no requests is killed.
25223 @end table
25224 @end deftp
25225
25226
25227 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} nginx-php-location @
25228 [#:nginx-package nginx] @
25229 [socket (string-append "/var/run/php" @
25230 (version-major (package-version php)) @
25231 "-fpm.sock")]
25232 A helper function to quickly add php to an @code{nginx-server-configuration}.
25233 @end deffn
25234
25235 A simple services setup for nginx with php can look like this:
25236 @lisp
25237 (services (cons* (service dhcp-client-service-type)
25238 (service php-fpm-service-type)
25239 (service nginx-service-type
25240 (nginx-server-configuration
25241 (server-name '("example.com"))
25242 (root "/srv/http/")
25243 (locations
25244 (list (nginx-php-location)))
25245 (listen '("80"))
25246 (ssl-certificate #f)
25247 (ssl-certificate-key #f)))
25248 %base-services))
25249 @end lisp
25250
25251 @cindex cat-avatar-generator
25252 The cat avatar generator is a simple service to demonstrate the use of php-fpm
25253 in @code{Nginx}. It is used to generate cat avatar from a seed, for instance
25254 the hash of a user's email address.
25255
25256 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} cat-avatar-generator-service @
25257 [#:cache-dir "/var/cache/cat-avatar-generator"] @
25258 [#:package cat-avatar-generator] @
25259 [#:configuration (nginx-server-configuration)]
25260 Returns an nginx-server-configuration that inherits @code{configuration}. It
25261 extends the nginx configuration to add a server block that serves @code{package},
25262 a version of cat-avatar-generator. During execution, cat-avatar-generator will
25263 be able to use @code{cache-dir} as its cache directory.
25264 @end deffn
25265
25266 A simple setup for cat-avatar-generator can look like this:
25267 @lisp
25268 (services (cons* (cat-avatar-generator-service
25269 #:configuration
25270 (nginx-server-configuration
25271 (server-name '("example.com"))))
25272 ...
25273 %base-services))
25274 @end lisp
25275
25276 @subsubheading Hpcguix-web
25277
25278 @cindex hpcguix-web
25279 The @uref{https://github.com/UMCUGenetics/hpcguix-web/, hpcguix-web}
25280 program is a customizable web interface to browse Guix packages,
25281 initially designed for users of high-performance computing (HPC)
25282 clusters.
25283
25284 @defvr {Scheme Variable} hpcguix-web-service-type
25285 The service type for @code{hpcguix-web}.
25286 @end defvr
25287
25288 @deftp {Data Type} hpcguix-web-configuration
25289 Data type for the hpcguix-web service configuration.
25290
25291 @table @asis
25292 @item @code{specs}
25293 A gexp (@pxref{G-Expressions}) specifying the hpcguix-web service
25294 configuration. The main items available in this spec are:
25295
25296 @table @asis
25297 @item @code{title-prefix} (default: @code{"hpcguix | "})
25298 The page title prefix.
25299
25300 @item @code{guix-command} (default: @code{"guix"})
25301 The @command{guix} command.
25302
25303 @item @code{package-filter-proc} (default: @code{(const #t)})
25304 A procedure specifying how to filter packages that are displayed.
25305
25306 @item @code{package-page-extension-proc} (default: @code{(const '())})
25307 Extension package for @code{hpcguix-web}.
25308
25309 @item @code{menu} (default: @code{'()})
25310 Additional entry in page @code{menu}.
25311
25312 @item @code{channels} (default: @code{%default-channels})
25313 List of channels from which the package list is built (@pxref{Channels}).
25314
25315 @item @code{package-list-expiration} (default: @code{(* 12 3600)})
25316 The expiration time, in seconds, after which the package list is rebuilt from
25317 the latest instances of the given channels.
25318 @end table
25319
25320 See the hpcguix-web repository for a
25321 @uref{https://github.com/UMCUGenetics/hpcguix-web/blob/master/hpcweb-configuration.scm,
25322 complete example}.
25323
25324 @item @code{package} (default: @code{hpcguix-web})
25325 The hpcguix-web package to use.
25326 @end table
25327 @end deftp
25328
25329 A typical hpcguix-web service declaration looks like this:
25330
25331 @lisp
25332 (service hpcguix-web-service-type
25333 (hpcguix-web-configuration
25334 (specs
25335 #~(define site-config
25336 (hpcweb-configuration
25337 (title-prefix "Guix-HPC - ")
25338 (menu '(("/about" "ABOUT"))))))))
25339 @end lisp
25340
25341 @quotation Note
25342 The hpcguix-web service periodically updates the package list it publishes by
25343 pulling channels from Git. To that end, it needs to access X.509 certificates
25344 so that it can authenticate Git servers when communicating over HTTPS, and it
25345 assumes that @file{/etc/ssl/certs} contains those certificates.
25346
25347 Thus, make sure to add @code{nss-certs} or another certificate package to the
25348 @code{packages} field of your configuration. @ref{X.509 Certificates}, for
25349 more information on X.509 certificates.
25350 @end quotation
25351
25352 @subsubheading gmnisrv
25353
25354 @cindex gmnisrv
25355 The @uref{https://git.sr.ht/~sircmpwn/gmnisrv, gmnisrv} program is a
25356 simple @uref{https://gemini.circumlunar.space/, Gemini} protocol server.
25357
25358 @deffn {Scheme Variable} gmnisrv-service-type
25359 This is the type of the gmnisrv service, whose value should be a
25360 @code{gmnisrv-configuration} object, as in this example:
25361
25362 @lisp
25363 (service gmnisrv-service-type
25364 (gmnisrv-configuration
25365 (config-file (local-file "./my-gmnisrv.ini"))))
25366 @end lisp
25367 @end deffn
25368
25369 @deftp {Data Type} gmnisrv-configuration
25370 Data type representing the configuration of gmnisrv.
25371
25372 @table @asis
25373 @item @code{package} (default: @var{gmnisrv})
25374 Package object of the gmnisrv server.
25375
25376 @item @code{config-file} (default: @code{%default-gmnisrv-config-file})
25377 File-like object of the gmnisrv configuration file to use. The default
25378 configuration listens on port 1965 and serves files from
25379 @file{/srv/gemini}. Certificates are stored in
25380 @file{/var/lib/gemini/certs}. For more information, run @command{man
25381 gmnisrv} and @command{man gmnisrv.ini}.
25382
25383 @end table
25384 @end deftp
25385
25386 @subsubheading Agate
25387
25388 @cindex agate
25389 The @uref{gemini://qwertqwefsday.eu/agate.gmi, Agate}
25390 (@uref{https://github.com/mbrubeck/agate, GitHub page over HTTPS})
25391 program is a simple @uref{https://gemini.circumlunar.space/, Gemini}
25392 protocol server written in Rust.
25393
25394 @deffn {Scheme Variable} agate-service-type
25395 This is the type of the agate service, whose value should be an
25396 @code{agate-service-type} object, as in this example:
25397
25398 @lisp
25399 (service agate-service-type
25400 (agate-configuration
25401 (content "/srv/gemini")
25402 (cert "/srv/cert.pem")
25403 (key "/srv/key.rsa")))
25404 @end lisp
25405
25406 The example above represents the minimal tweaking necessary to get Agate
25407 up and running. Specifying the path to the certificate and key is
25408 always necessary, as the Gemini protocol requires TLS by default.
25409
25410 To obtain a certificate and a key, you could, for example, use OpenSSL,
25411 running a command similar to the following example:
25412
25413 @example
25414 openssl req -x509 -newkey rsa:4096 -keyout key.rsa -out cert.pem \
25415 -days 3650 -nodes -subj "/CN=example.com"
25416 @end example
25417
25418 Of course, you'll have to replace @i{example.com} with your own domain
25419 name, and then point the Agate configuration towards the path of the
25420 generated key and certificate.
25421
25422 @end deffn
25423
25424 @deftp {Data Type} agate-configuration
25425 Data type representing the configuration of Agate.
25426
25427 @table @asis
25428 @item @code{package} (default: @code{agate})
25429 The package object of the Agate server.
25430
25431 @item @code{content} (default: @file{"/srv/gemini"})
25432 The directory from which Agate will serve files.
25433
25434 @item @code{cert} (default: @code{#f})
25435 The path to the TLS certificate PEM file to be used for encrypted
25436 connections. Must be filled in with a value from the user.
25437
25438 @item @code{key} (default: @code{#f})
25439 The path to the PKCS8 private key file to be used for encrypted
25440 connections. Must be filled in with a value from the user.
25441
25442 @item @code{addr} (default: @code{'("0.0.0.0:1965" "[::]:1965")})
25443 A list of the addresses to listen on.
25444
25445 @item @code{hostname} (default: @code{#f})
25446 The domain name of this Gemini server. Optional.
25447
25448 @item @code{lang} (default: @code{#f})
25449 RFC 4646 language code(s) for text/gemini documents. Optional.
25450
25451 @item @code{silent?} (default: @code{#f})
25452 Set to @code{#t} to disable logging output.
25453
25454 @item @code{serve-secret?} (default: @code{#f})
25455 Set to @code{#t} to serve secret files (files/directories starting with
25456 a dot).
25457
25458 @item @code{log-ip?} (default: @code{#t})
25459 Whether or not to output IP addresses when logging.
25460
25461 @item @code{user} (default: @code{"agate"})
25462 Owner of the @code{agate} process.
25463
25464 @item @code{group} (default: @code{"agate"})
25465 Owner's group of the @code{agate} process.
25466
25467 @item @code{log-file} (default: @file{"/var/log/agate.log"})
25468 The file which should store the logging output of Agate.
25469
25470 @end table
25471 @end deftp
25472
25473 @node Certificate Services
25474 @subsection Certificate Services
25475
25476 @cindex Web
25477 @cindex HTTP, HTTPS
25478 @cindex Let's Encrypt
25479 @cindex TLS certificates
25480 The @code{(gnu services certbot)} module provides a service to
25481 automatically obtain a valid TLS certificate from the Let's Encrypt
25482 certificate authority. These certificates can then be used to serve
25483 content securely over HTTPS or other TLS-based protocols, with the
25484 knowledge that the client will be able to verify the server's
25485 authenticity.
25486
25487 @url{https://letsencrypt.org/, Let's Encrypt} provides the
25488 @code{certbot} tool to automate the certification process. This tool
25489 first securely generates a key on the server. It then makes a request
25490 to the Let's Encrypt certificate authority (CA) to sign the key. The CA
25491 checks that the request originates from the host in question by using a
25492 challenge-response protocol, requiring the server to provide its
25493 response over HTTP@. If that protocol completes successfully, the CA
25494 signs the key, resulting in a certificate. That certificate is valid
25495 for a limited period of time, and therefore to continue to provide TLS
25496 services, the server needs to periodically ask the CA to renew its
25497 signature.
25498
25499 The certbot service automates this process: the initial key
25500 generation, the initial certification request to the Let's Encrypt
25501 service, the web server challenge/response integration, writing the
25502 certificate to disk, the automated periodic renewals, and the deployment
25503 tasks associated with the renewal (e.g.@: reloading services, copying keys
25504 with different permissions).
25505
25506 Certbot is run twice a day, at a random minute within the hour. It
25507 won't do anything until your certificates are due for renewal or
25508 revoked, but running it regularly would give your service a chance of
25509 staying online in case a Let's Encrypt-initiated revocation happened for
25510 some reason.
25511
25512 By using this service, you agree to the ACME Subscriber Agreement, which
25513 can be found there:
25514 @url{https://acme-v01.api.letsencrypt.org/directory}.
25515
25516 @defvr {Scheme Variable} certbot-service-type
25517 A service type for the @code{certbot} Let's Encrypt client. Its value
25518 must be a @code{certbot-configuration} record as in this example:
25519
25520 @lisp
25521 (define %nginx-deploy-hook
25522 (program-file
25523 "nginx-deploy-hook"
25524 #~(let ((pid (call-with-input-file "/var/run/nginx/pid" read)))
25525 (kill pid SIGHUP))))
25526
25527 (service certbot-service-type
25528 (certbot-configuration
25529 (email "foo@@example.net")
25530 (certificates
25531 (list
25532 (certificate-configuration
25533 (domains '("example.net" "www.example.net"))
25534 (deploy-hook %nginx-deploy-hook))
25535 (certificate-configuration
25536 (domains '("bar.example.net")))))))
25537 @end lisp
25538
25539 See below for details about @code{certbot-configuration}.
25540 @end defvr
25541
25542 @deftp {Data Type} certbot-configuration
25543 Data type representing the configuration of the @code{certbot} service.
25544 This type has the following parameters:
25545
25546 @table @asis
25547 @item @code{package} (default: @code{certbot})
25548 The certbot package to use.
25549
25550 @item @code{webroot} (default: @code{/var/www})
25551 The directory from which to serve the Let's Encrypt challenge/response
25552 files.
25553
25554 @item @code{certificates} (default: @code{()})
25555 A list of @code{certificates-configuration}s for which to generate
25556 certificates and request signatures. Each certificate has a @code{name}
25557 and several @code{domains}.
25558
25559 @item @code{email} (default: @code{#f})
25560 Optional email address used for registration and recovery contact.
25561 Setting this is encouraged as it allows you to receive important
25562 notifications about the account and issued certificates.
25563
25564 @item @code{server} (default: @code{#f})
25565 Optional URL of ACME server. Setting this overrides certbot's default,
25566 which is the Let's Encrypt server.
25567
25568 @item @code{rsa-key-size} (default: @code{2048})
25569 Size of the RSA key.
25570
25571 @item @code{default-location} (default: @i{see below})
25572 The default @code{nginx-location-configuration}. Because @code{certbot}
25573 needs to be able to serve challenges and responses, it needs to be able
25574 to run a web server. It does so by extending the @code{nginx} web
25575 service with an @code{nginx-server-configuration} listening on the
25576 @var{domains} on port 80, and which has a
25577 @code{nginx-location-configuration} for the @code{/.well-known/} URI
25578 path subspace used by Let's Encrypt. @xref{Web Services}, for more on
25579 these nginx configuration data types.
25580
25581 Requests to other URL paths will be matched by the
25582 @code{default-location}, which if present is added to all
25583 @code{nginx-server-configuration}s.
25584
25585 By default, the @code{default-location} will issue a redirect from
25586 @code{http://@var{domain}/...} to @code{https://@var{domain}/...}, leaving
25587 you to define what to serve on your site via @code{https}.
25588
25589 Pass @code{#f} to not issue a default location.
25590 @end table
25591 @end deftp
25592
25593 @deftp {Data Type} certificate-configuration
25594 Data type representing the configuration of a certificate.
25595 This type has the following parameters:
25596
25597 @table @asis
25598 @item @code{name} (default: @i{see below})
25599 This name is used by Certbot for housekeeping and in file paths; it
25600 doesn't affect the content of the certificate itself. To see
25601 certificate names, run @code{certbot certificates}.
25602
25603 Its default is the first provided domain.
25604
25605 @item @code{domains} (default: @code{()})
25606 The first domain provided will be the subject CN of the certificate, and
25607 all domains will be Subject Alternative Names on the certificate.
25608
25609 @item @code{challenge} (default: @code{#f})
25610 The challenge type that has to be run by certbot. If @code{#f} is specified,
25611 default to the HTTP challenge. If a value is specified, defaults to the
25612 manual plugin (see @code{authentication-hook}, @code{cleanup-hook} and
25613 the documentation at @url{https://certbot.eff.org/docs/using.html#hooks}),
25614 and gives Let's Encrypt permission to log the public IP address of the
25615 requesting machine.
25616
25617 @item @code{authentication-hook} (default: @code{#f})
25618 Command to be run in a shell once for each certificate challenge to be
25619 answered. For this command, the shell variable @code{$CERTBOT_DOMAIN}
25620 will contain the domain being authenticated, @code{$CERTBOT_VALIDATION}
25621 contains the validation string and @code{$CERTBOT_TOKEN} contains the
25622 file name of the resource requested when performing an HTTP-01 challenge.
25623
25624 @item @code{cleanup-hook} (default: @code{#f})
25625 Command to be run in a shell once for each certificate challenge that
25626 have been answered by the @code{auth-hook}. For this command, the shell
25627 variables available in the @code{auth-hook} script are still available, and
25628 additionally @code{$CERTBOT_AUTH_OUTPUT} will contain the standard output
25629 of the @code{auth-hook} script.
25630
25631 @item @code{deploy-hook} (default: @code{#f})
25632 Command to be run in a shell once for each successfully issued
25633 certificate. For this command, the shell variable
25634 @code{$RENEWED_LINEAGE} will point to the config live subdirectory (for
25635 example, @samp{"/etc/letsencrypt/live/example.com"}) containing the new
25636 certificates and keys; the shell variable @code{$RENEWED_DOMAINS} will
25637 contain a space-delimited list of renewed certificate domains (for
25638 example, @samp{"example.com www.example.com"}.
25639
25640 @end table
25641 @end deftp
25642
25643 For each @code{certificate-configuration}, the certificate is saved to
25644 @code{/etc/letsencrypt/live/@var{name}/fullchain.pem} and the key is
25645 saved to @code{/etc/letsencrypt/live/@var{name}/privkey.pem}.
25646 @node DNS Services
25647 @subsection DNS Services
25648 @cindex DNS (domain name system)
25649 @cindex domain name system (DNS)
25650
25651 The @code{(gnu services dns)} module provides services related to the
25652 @dfn{domain name system} (DNS). It provides a server service for hosting
25653 an @emph{authoritative} DNS server for multiple zones, slave or master.
25654 This service uses @uref{https://www.knot-dns.cz/, Knot DNS}. And also a
25655 caching and forwarding DNS server for the LAN, which uses
25656 @uref{http://www.thekelleys.org.uk/dnsmasq/doc.html, dnsmasq}.
25657
25658 @subsubheading Knot Service
25659
25660 An example configuration of an authoritative server for two zones, one master
25661 and one slave, is:
25662
25663 @lisp
25664 (define-zone-entries example.org.zone
25665 ;; Name TTL Class Type Data
25666 ("@@" "" "IN" "A" "127.0.0.1")
25667 ("@@" "" "IN" "NS" "ns")
25668 ("ns" "" "IN" "A" "127.0.0.1"))
25669
25670 (define master-zone
25671 (knot-zone-configuration
25672 (domain "example.org")
25673 (zone (zone-file
25674 (origin "example.org")
25675 (entries example.org.zone)))))
25676
25677 (define slave-zone
25678 (knot-zone-configuration
25679 (domain "plop.org")
25680 (dnssec-policy "default")
25681 (master (list "plop-master"))))
25682
25683 (define plop-master
25684 (knot-remote-configuration
25685 (id "plop-master")
25686 (address (list "208.76.58.171"))))
25687
25688 (operating-system
25689 ;; ...
25690 (services (cons* (service knot-service-type
25691 (knot-configuration
25692 (remotes (list plop-master))
25693 (zones (list master-zone slave-zone))))
25694 ;; ...
25695 %base-services)))
25696 @end lisp
25697
25698 @deffn {Scheme Variable} knot-service-type
25699 This is the type for the Knot DNS server.
25700
25701 Knot DNS is an authoritative DNS server, meaning that it can serve multiple
25702 zones, that is to say domain names you would buy from a registrar. This server
25703 is not a resolver, meaning that it can only resolve names for which it is
25704 authoritative. This server can be configured to serve zones as a master server
25705 or a slave server as a per-zone basis. Slave zones will get their data from
25706 masters, and will serve it as an authoritative server. From the point of view
25707 of a resolver, there is no difference between master and slave.
25708
25709 The following data types are used to configure the Knot DNS server:
25710 @end deffn
25711
25712 @deftp {Data Type} knot-key-configuration
25713 Data type representing a key.
25714 This type has the following parameters:
25715
25716 @table @asis
25717 @item @code{id} (default: @code{""})
25718 An identifier for other configuration fields to refer to this key. IDs must
25719 be unique and must not be empty.
25720
25721 @item @code{algorithm} (default: @code{#f})
25722 The algorithm to use. Choose between @code{#f}, @code{'hmac-md5},
25723 @code{'hmac-sha1}, @code{'hmac-sha224}, @code{'hmac-sha256}, @code{'hmac-sha384}
25724 and @code{'hmac-sha512}.
25725
25726 @item @code{secret} (default: @code{""})
25727 The secret key itself.
25728
25729 @end table
25730 @end deftp
25731
25732 @deftp {Data Type} knot-acl-configuration
25733 Data type representing an Access Control List (ACL) configuration.
25734 This type has the following parameters:
25735
25736 @table @asis
25737 @item @code{id} (default: @code{""})
25738 An identifier for other configuration fields to refer to this key. IDs must be
25739 unique and must not be empty.
25740
25741 @item @code{address} (default: @code{'()})
25742 An ordered list of IP addresses, network subnets, or network ranges represented
25743 with strings. The query must match one of them. Empty value means that
25744 address match is not required.
25745
25746 @item @code{key} (default: @code{'()})
25747 An ordered list of references to keys represented with strings. The string
25748 must match a key ID defined in a @code{knot-key-configuration}. No key means
25749 that a key is not require to match that ACL.
25750
25751 @item @code{action} (default: @code{'()})
25752 An ordered list of actions that are permitted or forbidden by this ACL@. Possible
25753 values are lists of zero or more elements from @code{'transfer}, @code{'notify}
25754 and @code{'update}.
25755
25756 @item @code{deny?} (default: @code{#f})
25757 When true, the ACL defines restrictions. Listed actions are forbidden. When
25758 false, listed actions are allowed.
25759
25760 @end table
25761 @end deftp
25762
25763 @deftp {Data Type} zone-entry
25764 Data type representing a record entry in a zone file.
25765 This type has the following parameters:
25766
25767 @table @asis
25768 @item @code{name} (default: @code{"@@"})
25769 The name of the record. @code{"@@"} refers to the origin of the zone. Names
25770 are relative to the origin of the zone. For example, in the @code{example.org}
25771 zone, @code{"ns.example.org"} actually refers to @code{ns.example.org.example.org}.
25772 Names ending with a dot are absolute, which means that @code{"ns.example.org."}
25773 refers to @code{ns.example.org}.
25774
25775 @item @code{ttl} (default: @code{""})
25776 The Time-To-Live (TTL) of this record. If not set, the default TTL is used.
25777
25778 @item @code{class} (default: @code{"IN"})
25779 The class of the record. Knot currently supports only @code{"IN"} and
25780 partially @code{"CH"}.
25781
25782 @item @code{type} (default: @code{"A"})
25783 The type of the record. Common types include A (IPv4 address), AAAA (IPv6
25784 address), NS (Name Server) and MX (Mail eXchange). Many other types are
25785 defined.
25786
25787 @item @code{data} (default: @code{""})
25788 The data contained in the record. For instance an IP address associated with
25789 an A record, or a domain name associated with an NS record. Remember that
25790 domain names are relative to the origin unless they end with a dot.
25791
25792 @end table
25793 @end deftp
25794
25795 @deftp {Data Type} zone-file
25796 Data type representing the content of a zone file.
25797 This type has the following parameters:
25798
25799 @table @asis
25800 @item @code{entries} (default: @code{'()})
25801 The list of entries. The SOA record is taken care of, so you don't need to
25802 put it in the list of entries. This list should probably contain an entry
25803 for your primary authoritative DNS server. Other than using a list of entries
25804 directly, you can use @code{define-zone-entries} to define a object containing
25805 the list of entries more easily, that you can later pass to the @code{entries}
25806 field of the @code{zone-file}.
25807
25808 @item @code{origin} (default: @code{""})
25809 The name of your zone. This parameter cannot be empty.
25810
25811 @item @code{ns} (default: @code{"ns"})
25812 The domain of your primary authoritative DNS server. The name is relative to
25813 the origin, unless it ends with a dot. It is mandatory that this primary
25814 DNS server corresponds to an NS record in the zone and that it is associated
25815 to an IP address in the list of entries.
25816
25817 @item @code{mail} (default: @code{"hostmaster"})
25818 An email address people can contact you at, as the owner of the zone. This
25819 is translated as @code{<mail>@@<origin>}.
25820
25821 @item @code{serial} (default: @code{1})
25822 The serial number of the zone. As this is used to keep track of changes by
25823 both slaves and resolvers, it is mandatory that it @emph{never} decreases.
25824 Always increment it when you make a change in your zone.
25825
25826 @item @code{refresh} (default: @code{(* 2 24 3600)})
25827 The frequency at which slaves will do a zone transfer. This value is a number
25828 of seconds. It can be computed by multiplications or with
25829 @code{(string->duration)}.
25830
25831 @item @code{retry} (default: @code{(* 15 60)})
25832 The period after which a slave will retry to contact its master when it fails
25833 to do so a first time.
25834
25835 @item @code{expiry} (default: @code{(* 14 24 3600)})
25836 Default TTL of records. Existing records are considered correct for at most
25837 this amount of time. After this period, resolvers will invalidate their cache
25838 and check again that it still exists.
25839
25840 @item @code{nx} (default: @code{3600})
25841 Default TTL of inexistant records. This delay is usually short because you want
25842 your new domains to reach everyone quickly.
25843
25844 @end table
25845 @end deftp
25846
25847 @deftp {Data Type} knot-remote-configuration
25848 Data type representing a remote configuration.
25849 This type has the following parameters:
25850
25851 @table @asis
25852 @item @code{id} (default: @code{""})
25853 An identifier for other configuration fields to refer to this remote. IDs must
25854 be unique and must not be empty.
25855
25856 @item @code{address} (default: @code{'()})
25857 An ordered list of destination IP addresses. Addresses are tried in sequence.
25858 An optional port can be given with the @@ separator. For instance:
25859 @code{(list "1.2.3.4" "2.3.4.5@@53")}. Default port is 53.
25860
25861 @item @code{via} (default: @code{'()})
25862 An ordered list of source IP addresses. An empty list will have Knot choose
25863 an appropriate source IP@. An optional port can be given with the @@ separator.
25864 The default is to choose at random.
25865
25866 @item @code{key} (default: @code{#f})
25867 A reference to a key, that is a string containing the identifier of a key
25868 defined in a @code{knot-key-configuration} field.
25869
25870 @end table
25871 @end deftp
25872
25873 @deftp {Data Type} knot-keystore-configuration
25874 Data type representing a keystore to hold dnssec keys.
25875 This type has the following parameters:
25876
25877 @table @asis
25878 @item @code{id} (default: @code{""})
25879 The id of the keystore. It must not be empty.
25880
25881 @item @code{backend} (default: @code{'pem})
25882 The backend to store the keys in. Can be @code{'pem} or @code{'pkcs11}.
25883
25884 @item @code{config} (default: @code{"/var/lib/knot/keys/keys"})
25885 The configuration string of the backend. An example for the PKCS#11 is:
25886 @code{"pkcs11:token=knot;pin-value=1234 /gnu/store/.../lib/pkcs11/libsofthsm2.so"}.
25887 For the pem backend, the string represents a path in the file system.
25888
25889 @end table
25890 @end deftp
25891
25892 @deftp {Data Type} knot-policy-configuration
25893 Data type representing a dnssec policy. Knot DNS is able to automatically
25894 sign your zones. It can either generate and manage your keys automatically or
25895 use keys that you generate.
25896
25897 Dnssec is usually implemented using two keys: a Key Signing Key (KSK) that is
25898 used to sign the second, and a Zone Signing Key (ZSK) that is used to sign the
25899 zone. In order to be trusted, the KSK needs to be present in the parent zone
25900 (usually a top-level domain). If your registrar supports dnssec, you will
25901 have to send them your KSK's hash so they can add a DS record in their zone.
25902 This is not automated and need to be done each time you change your KSK.
25903
25904 The policy also defines the lifetime of keys. Usually, ZSK can be changed
25905 easily and use weaker cryptographic functions (they use lower parameters) in
25906 order to sign records quickly, so they are changed often. The KSK however
25907 requires manual interaction with the registrar, so they are changed less often
25908 and use stronger parameters because they sign only one record.
25909
25910 This type has the following parameters:
25911
25912 @table @asis
25913 @item @code{id} (default: @code{""})
25914 The id of the policy. It must not be empty.
25915
25916 @item @code{keystore} (default: @code{"default"})
25917 A reference to a keystore, that is a string containing the identifier of a
25918 keystore defined in a @code{knot-keystore-configuration} field. The
25919 @code{"default"} identifier means the default keystore (a kasp database that
25920 was setup by this service).
25921
25922 @item @code{manual?} (default: @code{#f})
25923 Whether the key management is manual or automatic.
25924
25925 @item @code{single-type-signing?} (default: @code{#f})
25926 When @code{#t}, use the Single-Type Signing Scheme.
25927
25928 @item @code{algorithm} (default: @code{"ecdsap256sha256"})
25929 An algorithm of signing keys and issued signatures.
25930
25931 @item @code{ksk-size} (default: @code{256})
25932 The length of the KSK@. Note that this value is correct for the default
25933 algorithm, but would be unsecure for other algorithms.
25934
25935 @item @code{zsk-size} (default: @code{256})
25936 The length of the ZSK@. Note that this value is correct for the default
25937 algorithm, but would be unsecure for other algorithms.
25938
25939 @item @code{dnskey-ttl} (default: @code{'default})
25940 The TTL value for DNSKEY records added into zone apex. The special
25941 @code{'default} value means same as the zone SOA TTL.
25942
25943 @item @code{zsk-lifetime} (default: @code{(* 30 24 3600)})
25944 The period between ZSK publication and the next rollover initiation.
25945
25946 @item @code{propagation-delay} (default: @code{(* 24 3600)})
25947 An extra delay added for each key rollover step. This value should be high
25948 enough to cover propagation of data from the master server to all slaves.
25949
25950 @item @code{rrsig-lifetime} (default: @code{(* 14 24 3600)})
25951 A validity period of newly issued signatures.
25952
25953 @item @code{rrsig-refresh} (default: @code{(* 7 24 3600)})
25954 A period how long before a signature expiration the signature will be refreshed.
25955
25956 @item @code{nsec3?} (default: @code{#f})
25957 When @code{#t}, NSEC3 will be used instead of NSEC.
25958
25959 @item @code{nsec3-iterations} (default: @code{5})
25960 The number of additional times the hashing is performed.
25961
25962 @item @code{nsec3-salt-length} (default: @code{8})
25963 The length of a salt field in octets, which is appended to the original owner
25964 name before hashing.
25965
25966 @item @code{nsec3-salt-lifetime} (default: @code{(* 30 24 3600)})
25967 The validity period of newly issued salt field.
25968
25969 @end table
25970 @end deftp
25971
25972 @deftp {Data Type} knot-zone-configuration
25973 Data type representing a zone served by Knot.
25974 This type has the following parameters:
25975
25976 @table @asis
25977 @item @code{domain} (default: @code{""})
25978 The domain served by this configuration. It must not be empty.
25979
25980 @item @code{file} (default: @code{""})
25981 The file where this zone is saved. This parameter is ignored by master zones.
25982 Empty means default location that depends on the domain name.
25983
25984 @item @code{zone} (default: @code{(zone-file)})
25985 The content of the zone file. This parameter is ignored by slave zones. It
25986 must contain a zone-file record.
25987
25988 @item @code{master} (default: @code{'()})
25989 A list of master remotes. When empty, this zone is a master. When set, this
25990 zone is a slave. This is a list of remotes identifiers.
25991
25992 @item @code{ddns-master} (default: @code{#f})
25993 The main master. When empty, it defaults to the first master in the list of
25994 masters.
25995
25996 @item @code{notify} (default: @code{'()})
25997 A list of slave remote identifiers.
25998
25999 @item @code{acl} (default: @code{'()})
26000 A list of acl identifiers.
26001
26002 @item @code{semantic-checks?} (default: @code{#f})
26003 When set, this adds more semantic checks to the zone.
26004
26005 @item @code{disable-any?} (default: @code{#f})
26006 When set, this forbids queries of the ANY type.
26007
26008 @item @code{zonefile-sync} (default: @code{0})
26009 The delay between a modification in memory and on disk. 0 means immediate
26010 synchronization.
26011
26012 @item @code{zonefile-load} (default: @code{#f})
26013 The way the zone file contents are applied during zone load. Possible values
26014 are:
26015
26016 @itemize
26017 @item @code{#f} for using the default value from Knot,
26018 @item @code{'none} for not using the zone file at all,
26019 @item @code{'difference} for computing the difference between already available
26020 contents and zone contents and applying it to the current zone contents,
26021 @item @code{'difference-no-serial} for the same as @code{'difference}, but
26022 ignoring the SOA serial in the zone file, while the server takes care of it
26023 automatically.
26024 @item @code{'whole} for loading zone contents from the zone file.
26025 @end itemize
26026
26027 @item @code{journal-content} (default: @code{#f})
26028 The way the journal is used to store zone and its changes. Possible values
26029 are @code{'none} to not use it at all, @code{'changes} to store changes and
26030 @code{'all} to store contents. @code{#f} does not set this option, so the
26031 default value from Knot is used.
26032
26033 @item @code{max-journal-usage} (default: @code{#f})
26034 The maximum size for the journal on disk. @code{#f} does not set this option,
26035 so the default value from Knot is used.
26036
26037 @item @code{max-journal-depth} (default: @code{#f})
26038 The maximum size of the history. @code{#f} does not set this option, so the
26039 default value from Knot is used.
26040
26041 @item @code{max-zone-size} (default: @code{#f})
26042 The maximum size of the zone file. This limit is enforced for incoming
26043 transfer and updates. @code{#f} does not set this option, so the default
26044 value from Knot is used.
26045
26046 @item @code{dnssec-policy} (default: @code{#f})
26047 A reference to a @code{knot-policy-configuration} record, or the special
26048 name @code{"default"}. If the value is @code{#f}, there is no dnssec signing
26049 on this zone.
26050
26051 @item @code{serial-policy} (default: @code{'increment})
26052 A policy between @code{'increment} and @code{'unixtime}.
26053
26054 @end table
26055 @end deftp
26056
26057 @deftp {Data Type} knot-configuration
26058 Data type representing the Knot configuration.
26059 This type has the following parameters:
26060
26061 @table @asis
26062 @item @code{knot} (default: @code{knot})
26063 The Knot package.
26064
26065 @item @code{run-directory} (default: @code{"/var/run/knot"})
26066 The run directory. This directory will be used for pid file and sockets.
26067
26068 @item @code{includes} (default: @code{'()})
26069 A list of strings or file-like objects denoting other files that must be
26070 included at the top of the configuration file.
26071
26072 @cindex secrets, Knot service
26073 This can be used to manage secrets out-of-band. For example, secret
26074 keys may be stored in an out-of-band file not managed by Guix, and
26075 thus not visible in @file{/gnu/store}---e.g., you could store secret
26076 key configuration in @file{/etc/knot/secrets.conf} and add this file
26077 to the @code{includes} list.
26078
26079 One can generate a secret tsig key (for nsupdate and zone transfers with the
26080 keymgr command from the knot package. Note that the package is not automatically
26081 installed by the service. The following example shows how to generate a new
26082 tsig key:
26083
26084 @example
26085 keymgr -t mysecret > /etc/knot/secrets.conf
26086 chmod 600 /etc/knot/secrets.conf
26087 @end example
26088
26089 Also note that the generated key will be named @var{mysecret}, so it is the
26090 name that needs to be used in the @var{key} field of the
26091 @code{knot-acl-configuration} record and in other places that need to refer
26092 to that key.
26093
26094 It can also be used to add configuration not supported by this interface.
26095
26096 @item @code{listen-v4} (default: @code{"0.0.0.0"})
26097 An ip address on which to listen.
26098
26099 @item @code{listen-v6} (default: @code{"::"})
26100 An ip address on which to listen.
26101
26102 @item @code{listen-port} (default: @code{53})
26103 A port on which to listen.
26104
26105 @item @code{keys} (default: @code{'()})
26106 The list of knot-key-configuration used by this configuration.
26107
26108 @item @code{acls} (default: @code{'()})
26109 The list of knot-acl-configuration used by this configuration.
26110
26111 @item @code{remotes} (default: @code{'()})
26112 The list of knot-remote-configuration used by this configuration.
26113
26114 @item @code{zones} (default: @code{'()})
26115 The list of knot-zone-configuration used by this configuration.
26116
26117 @end table
26118 @end deftp
26119
26120 @subsubheading Knot Resolver Service
26121
26122 @deffn {Scheme Variable} knot-resolver-service-type
26123 This is the type of the knot resolver service, whose value should be
26124 an @code{knot-resolver-configuration} object as in this example:
26125
26126 @lisp
26127 (service knot-resolver-service-type
26128 (knot-resolver-configuration
26129 (kresd-config-file (plain-file "kresd.conf" "
26130 net.listen('192.168.0.1', 5353)
26131 user('knot-resolver', 'knot-resolver')
26132 modules = @{ 'hints > iterate', 'stats', 'predict' @}
26133 cache.size = 100 * MB
26134 "))))
26135 @end lisp
26136
26137 For more information, refer its @url{https://knot-resolver.readthedocs.org/en/stable/daemon.html#configuration, manual}.
26138 @end deffn
26139
26140 @deftp {Data Type} knot-resolver-configuration
26141 Data type representing the configuration of knot-resolver.
26142
26143 @table @asis
26144 @item @code{package} (default: @var{knot-resolver})
26145 Package object of the knot DNS resolver.
26146
26147 @item @code{kresd-config-file} (default: %kresd.conf)
26148 File-like object of the kresd configuration file to use, by default it
26149 will listen on @code{127.0.0.1} and @code{::1}.
26150
26151 @item @code{garbage-collection-interval} (default: 1000)
26152 Number of milliseconds for @code{kres-cache-gc} to periodically trim the cache.
26153
26154 @end table
26155 @end deftp
26156
26157
26158 @subsubheading Dnsmasq Service
26159
26160 @deffn {Scheme Variable} dnsmasq-service-type
26161 This is the type of the dnsmasq service, whose value should be an
26162 @code{dnsmasq-configuration} object as in this example:
26163
26164 @lisp
26165 (service dnsmasq-service-type
26166 (dnsmasq-configuration
26167 (no-resolv? #t)
26168 (servers '("192.168.1.1"))))
26169 @end lisp
26170 @end deffn
26171
26172 @deftp {Data Type} dnsmasq-configuration
26173 Data type representing the configuration of dnsmasq.
26174
26175 @table @asis
26176 @item @code{package} (default: @var{dnsmasq})
26177 Package object of the dnsmasq server.
26178
26179 @item @code{no-hosts?} (default: @code{#f})
26180 When true, don't read the hostnames in /etc/hosts.
26181
26182 @item @code{port} (default: @code{53})
26183 The port to listen on. Setting this to zero completely disables DNS
26184 responses, leaving only DHCP and/or TFTP functions.
26185
26186 @item @code{local-service?} (default: @code{#t})
26187 Accept DNS queries only from hosts whose address is on a local subnet,
26188 ie a subnet for which an interface exists on the server.
26189
26190 @item @code{listen-addresses} (default: @code{'()})
26191 Listen on the given IP addresses.
26192
26193 @item @code{resolv-file} (default: @code{"/etc/resolv.conf"})
26194 The file to read the IP address of the upstream nameservers from.
26195
26196 @item @code{no-resolv?} (default: @code{#f})
26197 When true, don't read @var{resolv-file}.
26198
26199 @item @code{servers} (default: @code{'()})
26200 Specify IP address of upstream servers directly.
26201
26202 @item @code{addresses} (default: @code{'()})
26203 For each entry, specify an IP address to return for any host in the
26204 given domains. Queries in the domains are never forwarded and always
26205 replied to with the specified IP address.
26206
26207 This is useful for redirecting hosts locally, for example:
26208
26209 @lisp
26210 (service dnsmasq-service-type
26211 (dnsmasq-configuration
26212 (addresses
26213 '(; Redirect to a local web-server.
26214 "/example.org/127.0.0.1"
26215 ; Redirect subdomain to a specific IP.
26216 "/subdomain.example.org/192.168.1.42"))))
26217 @end lisp
26218
26219 Note that rules in @file{/etc/hosts} take precedence over this.
26220
26221 @item @code{cache-size} (default: @code{150})
26222 Set the size of dnsmasq's cache. Setting the cache size to zero
26223 disables caching.
26224
26225 @item @code{negative-cache?} (default: @code{#t})
26226 When false, disable negative caching.
26227
26228 @item @code{tftp-enable?} (default: @code{#f})
26229 Whether to enable the built-in TFTP server.
26230
26231 @item @code{tftp-no-fail?} (default: @code{#f})
26232 If true, does not fail dnsmasq if the TFTP server could not start up.
26233
26234 @item @code{tftp-single-port?} (default: @code{#f})
26235 Whether to use only one single port for TFTP.
26236
26237 @item @code{tftp-secure?} (default: @code{#f})
26238 If true, only files owned by the user running the dnsmasq process are accessible.
26239
26240 If dnsmasq is being run as root, different rules apply:
26241 @code{tftp-secure?} has no effect, but only files which have the
26242 world-readable bit set are accessible.
26243
26244 @item @code{tftp-max} (default: @code{#f})
26245 If set, sets the maximal number of concurrent connections allowed.
26246
26247 @item @code{tftp-mtu} (default: @code{#f})
26248 If set, sets the MTU for TFTP packets to that value.
26249
26250 @item @code{tftp-no-blocksize?} (default: @code{#f})
26251 If true, stops the TFTP server from negotiating the blocksize with a client.
26252
26253 @item @code{tftp-lowercase?} (default: @code{#f})
26254 Whether to convert all filenames in TFTP requests to lowercase.
26255
26256 @item @code{tftp-port-range} (default: @code{#f})
26257 If set, fixes the dynamical ports (one per client) to the given range
26258 (@code{"<start>,<end>"}).
26259
26260 @item @code{tftp-root} (default: @code{/var/empty,lo})
26261 Look for files to transfer using TFTP relative to the given directory.
26262 When this is set, TFTP paths which include @samp{..} are rejected, to stop clients
26263 getting outside the specified root. Absolute paths (starting with @samp{/}) are
26264 allowed, but they must be within the TFTP-root. If the optional interface
26265 argument is given, the directory is only used for TFTP requests via that
26266 interface.
26267
26268 @item @code{tftp-unique-root} (default: @code{#f})
26269 If set, add the IP or hardware address of the TFTP client as a path component
26270 on the end of the TFTP-root. Only valid if a TFTP root is set and the
26271 directory exists. Defaults to adding IP address (in standard dotted-quad
26272 format).
26273
26274 For instance, if @option{--tftp-root} is @samp{/tftp} and client
26275 @samp{1.2.3.4} requests file @file{myfile} then the effective path will
26276 be @file{/tftp/1.2.3.4/myfile} if @file{/tftp/1.2.3.4} exists or
26277 @file{/tftp/myfile} otherwise. When @samp{=mac} is specified it will
26278 append the MAC address instead, using lowercase zero padded digits
26279 separated by dashes, e.g.: @samp{01-02-03-04-aa-bb}. Note that
26280 resolving MAC addresses is only possible if the client is in the local
26281 network or obtained a DHCP lease from dnsmasq.
26282
26283 @end table
26284 @end deftp
26285
26286 @subsubheading ddclient Service
26287
26288 @cindex ddclient
26289 The ddclient service described below runs the ddclient daemon, which takes
26290 care of automatically updating DNS entries for service providers such as
26291 @uref{https://dyn.com/dns/, Dyn}.
26292
26293 The following example show instantiates the service with its default
26294 configuration:
26295
26296 @lisp
26297 (service ddclient-service-type)
26298 @end lisp
26299
26300 Note that ddclient needs to access credentials that are stored in a
26301 @dfn{secret file}, by default @file{/etc/ddclient/secrets} (see
26302 @code{secret-file} below). You are expected to create this file manually, in
26303 an ``out-of-band'' fashion (you @emph{could} make this file part of the
26304 service configuration, for instance by using @code{plain-file}, but it will be
26305 world-readable @i{via} @file{/gnu/store}). See the examples in the
26306 @file{share/ddclient} directory of the @code{ddclient} package.
26307
26308 @c %start of fragment
26309
26310 Available @code{ddclient-configuration} fields are:
26311
26312 @deftypevr {@code{ddclient-configuration} parameter} package ddclient
26313 The ddclient package.
26314
26315 @end deftypevr
26316
26317 @deftypevr {@code{ddclient-configuration} parameter} integer daemon
26318 The period after which ddclient will retry to check IP and domain name.
26319
26320 Defaults to @samp{300}.
26321
26322 @end deftypevr
26323
26324 @deftypevr {@code{ddclient-configuration} parameter} boolean syslog
26325 Use syslog for the output.
26326
26327 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
26328
26329 @end deftypevr
26330
26331 @deftypevr {@code{ddclient-configuration} parameter} string mail
26332 Mail to user.
26333
26334 Defaults to @samp{"root"}.
26335
26336 @end deftypevr
26337
26338 @deftypevr {@code{ddclient-configuration} parameter} string mail-failure
26339 Mail failed update to user.
26340
26341 Defaults to @samp{"root"}.
26342
26343 @end deftypevr
26344
26345 @deftypevr {@code{ddclient-configuration} parameter} string pid
26346 The ddclient PID file.
26347
26348 Defaults to @samp{"/var/run/ddclient/ddclient.pid"}.
26349
26350 @end deftypevr
26351
26352 @deftypevr {@code{ddclient-configuration} parameter} boolean ssl
26353 Enable SSL support.
26354
26355 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
26356
26357 @end deftypevr
26358
26359 @deftypevr {@code{ddclient-configuration} parameter} string user
26360 Specifies the user name or ID that is used when running ddclient
26361 program.
26362
26363 Defaults to @samp{"ddclient"}.
26364
26365 @end deftypevr
26366
26367 @deftypevr {@code{ddclient-configuration} parameter} string group
26368 Group of the user who will run the ddclient program.
26369
26370 Defaults to @samp{"ddclient"}.
26371
26372 @end deftypevr
26373
26374 @deftypevr {@code{ddclient-configuration} parameter} string secret-file
26375 Secret file which will be appended to @file{ddclient.conf} file. This
26376 file contains credentials for use by ddclient. You are expected to
26377 create it manually.
26378
26379 Defaults to @samp{"/etc/ddclient/secrets.conf"}.
26380
26381 @end deftypevr
26382
26383 @deftypevr {@code{ddclient-configuration} parameter} list extra-options
26384 Extra options will be appended to @file{ddclient.conf} file.
26385
26386 Defaults to @samp{()}.
26387
26388 @end deftypevr
26389
26390
26391 @c %end of fragment
26392
26393
26394 @node VPN Services
26395 @subsection VPN Services
26396 @cindex VPN (virtual private network)
26397 @cindex virtual private network (VPN)
26398
26399 The @code{(gnu services vpn)} module provides services related to
26400 @dfn{virtual private networks} (VPNs).
26401
26402 @subsubheading OpenVPN
26403
26404 It provides a @emph{client} service for your machine to connect to a
26405 VPN, and a @emph{server} service for your machine to host a VPN@.
26406
26407 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} openvpn-client-service @
26408 [#:config (openvpn-client-configuration)]
26409
26410 Return a service that runs @command{openvpn}, a VPN daemon, as a client.
26411 @end deffn
26412
26413 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} openvpn-server-service @
26414 [#:config (openvpn-server-configuration)]
26415
26416 Return a service that runs @command{openvpn}, a VPN daemon, as a server.
26417
26418 Both can be run simultaneously.
26419 @end deffn
26420
26421 @c %automatically generated documentation
26422
26423 Available @code{openvpn-client-configuration} fields are:
26424
26425 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} package openvpn
26426 The OpenVPN package.
26427
26428 @end deftypevr
26429
26430 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} string pid-file
26431 The OpenVPN pid file.
26432
26433 Defaults to @samp{"/var/run/openvpn/openvpn.pid"}.
26434
26435 @end deftypevr
26436
26437 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} proto proto
26438 The protocol (UDP or TCP) used to open a channel between clients and
26439 servers.
26440
26441 Defaults to @samp{udp}.
26442
26443 @end deftypevr
26444
26445 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} dev dev
26446 The device type used to represent the VPN connection.
26447
26448 Defaults to @samp{tun}.
26449
26450 @end deftypevr
26451
26452 If you do not have some of these files (eg.@: you use a username and
26453 password), you can disable any of the following three fields by setting
26454 it to @code{'disabled}.
26455
26456 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} maybe-string ca
26457 The certificate authority to check connections against.
26458
26459 Defaults to @samp{"/etc/openvpn/ca.crt"}.
26460
26461 @end deftypevr
26462
26463 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} maybe-string cert
26464 The certificate of the machine the daemon is running on. It should be
26465 signed by the authority given in @code{ca}.
26466
26467 Defaults to @samp{"/etc/openvpn/client.crt"}.
26468
26469 @end deftypevr
26470
26471 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} maybe-string key
26472 The key of the machine the daemon is running on. It must be the key whose
26473 certificate is @code{cert}.
26474
26475 Defaults to @samp{"/etc/openvpn/client.key"}.
26476
26477 @end deftypevr
26478
26479 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} boolean comp-lzo?
26480 Whether to use the lzo compression algorithm.
26481
26482 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
26483
26484 @end deftypevr
26485
26486 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} boolean persist-key?
26487 Don't re-read key files across SIGUSR1 or --ping-restart.
26488
26489 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
26490
26491 @end deftypevr
26492
26493 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} boolean persist-tun?
26494 Don't close and reopen TUN/TAP device or run up/down scripts across
26495 SIGUSR1 or --ping-restart restarts.
26496
26497 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
26498
26499 @end deftypevr
26500
26501 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} boolean fast-io?
26502 (Experimental) Optimize TUN/TAP/UDP I/O writes by avoiding a call to
26503 poll/epoll/select prior to the write operation.
26504
26505 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
26506 @end deftypevr
26507
26508 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} number verbosity
26509 Verbosity level.
26510
26511 Defaults to @samp{3}.
26512
26513 @end deftypevr
26514
26515 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} tls-auth-client tls-auth
26516 Add an additional layer of HMAC authentication on top of the TLS control
26517 channel to protect against DoS attacks.
26518
26519 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
26520
26521 @end deftypevr
26522
26523 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} maybe-string auth-user-pass
26524 Authenticate with server using username/password. The option is a file
26525 containing username/password on 2 lines. Do not use a file-like object as it
26526 would be added to the store and readable by any user.
26527
26528 Defaults to @samp{'disabled}.
26529 @end deftypevr
26530
26531 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} key-usage verify-key-usage?
26532 Whether to check the server certificate has server usage extension.
26533
26534 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
26535
26536 @end deftypevr
26537
26538 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} bind bind?
26539 Bind to a specific local port number.
26540
26541 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
26542
26543 @end deftypevr
26544
26545 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} resolv-retry resolv-retry?
26546 Retry resolving server address.
26547
26548 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
26549
26550 @end deftypevr
26551
26552 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} openvpn-remote-list remote
26553 A list of remote servers to connect to.
26554
26555 Defaults to @samp{()}.
26556
26557 Available @code{openvpn-remote-configuration} fields are:
26558
26559 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-remote-configuration} parameter} string name
26560 Server name.
26561
26562 Defaults to @samp{"my-server"}.
26563
26564 @end deftypevr
26565
26566 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-remote-configuration} parameter} number port
26567 Port number the server listens to.
26568
26569 Defaults to @samp{1194}.
26570
26571 @end deftypevr
26572
26573 @end deftypevr
26574 @c %end of automatic openvpn-client documentation
26575
26576 @c %automatically generated documentation
26577
26578 Available @code{openvpn-server-configuration} fields are:
26579
26580 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} package openvpn
26581 The OpenVPN package.
26582
26583 @end deftypevr
26584
26585 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} string pid-file
26586 The OpenVPN pid file.
26587
26588 Defaults to @samp{"/var/run/openvpn/openvpn.pid"}.
26589
26590 @end deftypevr
26591
26592 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} proto proto
26593 The protocol (UDP or TCP) used to open a channel between clients and
26594 servers.
26595
26596 Defaults to @samp{udp}.
26597
26598 @end deftypevr
26599
26600 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} dev dev
26601 The device type used to represent the VPN connection.
26602
26603 Defaults to @samp{tun}.
26604
26605 @end deftypevr
26606
26607 If you do not have some of these files (eg.@: you use a username and
26608 password), you can disable any of the following three fields by setting
26609 it to @code{'disabled}.
26610
26611 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} maybe-string ca
26612 The certificate authority to check connections against.
26613
26614 Defaults to @samp{"/etc/openvpn/ca.crt"}.
26615
26616 @end deftypevr
26617
26618 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} maybe-string cert
26619 The certificate of the machine the daemon is running on. It should be
26620 signed by the authority given in @code{ca}.
26621
26622 Defaults to @samp{"/etc/openvpn/client.crt"}.
26623
26624 @end deftypevr
26625
26626 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} maybe-string key
26627 The key of the machine the daemon is running on. It must be the key whose
26628 certificate is @code{cert}.
26629
26630 Defaults to @samp{"/etc/openvpn/client.key"}.
26631
26632 @end deftypevr
26633
26634 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} boolean comp-lzo?
26635 Whether to use the lzo compression algorithm.
26636
26637 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
26638
26639 @end deftypevr
26640
26641 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} boolean persist-key?
26642 Don't re-read key files across SIGUSR1 or --ping-restart.
26643
26644 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
26645
26646 @end deftypevr
26647
26648 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} boolean persist-tun?
26649 Don't close and reopen TUN/TAP device or run up/down scripts across
26650 SIGUSR1 or --ping-restart restarts.
26651
26652 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
26653
26654 @end deftypevr
26655
26656 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} boolean fast-io?
26657 (Experimental) Optimize TUN/TAP/UDP I/O writes by avoiding a call to
26658 poll/epoll/select prior to the write operation.
26659
26660 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
26661 @end deftypevr
26662
26663 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} number verbosity
26664 Verbosity level.
26665
26666 Defaults to @samp{3}.
26667
26668 @end deftypevr
26669
26670 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} tls-auth-server tls-auth
26671 Add an additional layer of HMAC authentication on top of the TLS control
26672 channel to protect against DoS attacks.
26673
26674 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
26675
26676 @end deftypevr
26677
26678 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} number port
26679 Specifies the port number on which the server listens.
26680
26681 Defaults to @samp{1194}.
26682
26683 @end deftypevr
26684
26685 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} ip-mask server
26686 An ip and mask specifying the subnet inside the virtual network.
26687
26688 Defaults to @samp{"10.8.0.0 255.255.255.0"}.
26689
26690 @end deftypevr
26691
26692 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} cidr6 server-ipv6
26693 A CIDR notation specifying the IPv6 subnet inside the virtual network.
26694
26695 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
26696
26697 @end deftypevr
26698
26699 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} string dh
26700 The Diffie-Hellman parameters file.
26701
26702 Defaults to @samp{"/etc/openvpn/dh2048.pem"}.
26703
26704 @end deftypevr
26705
26706 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} string ifconfig-pool-persist
26707 The file that records client IPs.
26708
26709 Defaults to @samp{"/etc/openvpn/ipp.txt"}.
26710
26711 @end deftypevr
26712
26713 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} gateway redirect-gateway?
26714 When true, the server will act as a gateway for its clients.
26715
26716 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
26717
26718 @end deftypevr
26719
26720 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} boolean client-to-client?
26721 When true, clients are allowed to talk to each other inside the VPN.
26722
26723 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
26724
26725 @end deftypevr
26726
26727 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} keepalive keepalive
26728 Causes ping-like messages to be sent back and forth over the link so
26729 that each side knows when the other side has gone down. @code{keepalive}
26730 requires a pair. The first element is the period of the ping sending,
26731 and the second element is the timeout before considering the other side
26732 down.
26733
26734 @end deftypevr
26735
26736 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} number max-clients
26737 The maximum number of clients.
26738
26739 Defaults to @samp{100}.
26740
26741 @end deftypevr
26742
26743 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} string status
26744 The status file. This file shows a small report on current connection.
26745 It is truncated and rewritten every minute.
26746
26747 Defaults to @samp{"/var/run/openvpn/status"}.
26748
26749 @end deftypevr
26750
26751 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} openvpn-ccd-list client-config-dir
26752 The list of configuration for some clients.
26753
26754 Defaults to @samp{()}.
26755
26756 Available @code{openvpn-ccd-configuration} fields are:
26757
26758 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-ccd-configuration} parameter} string name
26759 Client name.
26760
26761 Defaults to @samp{"client"}.
26762
26763 @end deftypevr
26764
26765 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-ccd-configuration} parameter} ip-mask iroute
26766 Client own network
26767
26768 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
26769
26770 @end deftypevr
26771
26772 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-ccd-configuration} parameter} ip-mask ifconfig-push
26773 Client VPN IP.
26774
26775 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
26776
26777 @end deftypevr
26778
26779 @end deftypevr
26780
26781
26782 @c %end of automatic openvpn-server documentation
26783
26784 @subsubheading Wireguard
26785
26786 @defvr {Scheme Variable} wireguard-service-type
26787 A service type for a Wireguard tunnel interface. Its value must be a
26788 @code{wireguard-configuration} record as in this example:
26789
26790 @lisp
26791 (service wireguard-service-type
26792 (wireguard-configuration
26793 (peers
26794 (list
26795 (wireguard-peer
26796 (name "my-peer")
26797 (endpoint "my.wireguard.com:51820")
26798 (public-key "hzpKg9X1yqu1axN6iJp0mWf6BZGo8m1wteKwtTmDGF4=")
26799 (allowed-ips '("10.0.0.2/32")))))))
26800 @end lisp
26801
26802 @end defvr
26803
26804 @deftp {Data Type} wireguard-configuration
26805 Data type representing the configuration of the Wireguard service.
26806
26807 @table @asis
26808 @item @code{wireguard}
26809 The wireguard package to use for this service.
26810
26811 @item @code{interface} (default: @code{"wg0"})
26812 The interface name for the VPN.
26813
26814 @item @code{addresses} (default: @code{'("10.0.0.1/32")})
26815 The IP addresses to be assigned to the above interface.
26816
26817 @item @code{private-key} (default: @code{"/etc/wireguard/private.key"})
26818 The private key file for the interface. It is automatically generated if
26819 the file does not exist.
26820
26821 @item @code{peers} (default: @code{'()})
26822 The authorized peers on this interface. This is a list of
26823 @var{wireguard-peer} records.
26824
26825 @end table
26826 @end deftp
26827
26828 @deftp {Data Type} wireguard-peer
26829 Data type representing a Wireguard peer attached to a given interface.
26830
26831 @table @asis
26832 @item @code{name}
26833 The peer name.
26834
26835 @item @code{endpoint} (default: @code{#f})
26836 The optional endpoint for the peer, such as
26837 @code{"demo.wireguard.com:51820"}.
26838
26839 @item @code{public-key}
26840 The peer public-key represented as a base64 string.
26841
26842 @item @code{allowed-ips}
26843 A list of IP addresses from which incoming traffic for this peer is
26844 allowed and to which incoming traffic for this peer is directed.
26845
26846 @end table
26847 @end deftp
26848
26849 @node Network File System
26850 @subsection Network File System
26851 @cindex NFS
26852
26853 The @code{(gnu services nfs)} module provides the following services,
26854 which are most commonly used in relation to mounting or exporting
26855 directory trees as @dfn{network file systems} (NFS).
26856
26857 While it is possible to use the individual components that together make
26858 up a Network File System service, we recommended to configure an NFS
26859 server with the @code{nfs-service-type}.
26860
26861 @subsubheading NFS Service
26862 @cindex NFS, server
26863
26864 The NFS service takes care of setting up all NFS component services,
26865 kernel configuration file systems, and installs configuration files in
26866 the locations that NFS expects.
26867
26868 @defvr {Scheme Variable} nfs-service-type
26869 A service type for a complete NFS server.
26870 @end defvr
26871
26872 @deftp {Data Type} nfs-configuration
26873 This data type represents the configuration of the NFS service and all
26874 of its subsystems.
26875
26876 It has the following parameters:
26877 @table @asis
26878 @item @code{nfs-utils} (default: @code{nfs-utils})
26879 The nfs-utils package to use.
26880
26881 @item @code{nfs-versions} (default: @code{'("4.2" "4.1" "4.0")})
26882 If a list of string values is provided, the @command{rpc.nfsd} daemon
26883 will be limited to supporting the given versions of the NFS protocol.
26884
26885 @item @code{exports} (default: @code{'()})
26886 This is a list of directories the NFS server should export. Each entry
26887 is a list consisting of two elements: a directory name and a string
26888 containing all options. This is an example in which the directory
26889 @file{/export} is served to all NFS clients as a read-only share:
26890
26891 @lisp
26892 (nfs-configuration
26893 (exports
26894 '(("/export"
26895 "*(ro,insecure,no_subtree_check,crossmnt,fsid=0)"))))
26896 @end lisp
26897
26898 @item @code{rpcmountd-port} (default: @code{#f})
26899 The network port that the @command{rpc.mountd} daemon should use.
26900
26901 @item @code{rpcstatd-port} (default: @code{#f})
26902 The network port that the @command{rpc.statd} daemon should use.
26903
26904 @item @code{rpcbind} (default: @code{rpcbind})
26905 The rpcbind package to use.
26906
26907 @item @code{idmap-domain} (default: @code{"localdomain"})
26908 The local NFSv4 domain name.
26909
26910 @item @code{nfsd-port} (default: @code{2049})
26911 The network port that the @command{nfsd} daemon should use.
26912
26913 @item @code{nfsd-threads} (default: @code{8})
26914 The number of threads used by the @command{nfsd} daemon.
26915
26916 @item @code{nfsd-tcp?} (default: @code{#t})
26917 Whether the @command{nfsd} daemon should listen on a TCP socket.
26918
26919 @item @code{nfsd-udp?} (default: @code{#f})
26920 Whether the @command{nfsd} daemon should listen on a UDP socket.
26921
26922 @item @code{pipefs-directory} (default: @code{"/var/lib/nfs/rpc_pipefs"})
26923 The directory where the pipefs file system is mounted.
26924
26925 @item @code{debug} (default: @code{'()"})
26926 A list of subsystems for which debugging output should be enabled. This
26927 is a list of symbols. Any of these symbols are valid: @code{nfsd},
26928 @code{nfs}, @code{rpc}, @code{idmap}, @code{statd}, or @code{mountd}.
26929 @end table
26930 @end deftp
26931
26932 If you don't need a complete NFS service or prefer to build it yourself
26933 you can use the individual component services that are documented below.
26934
26935 @subsubheading RPC Bind Service
26936 @cindex rpcbind
26937
26938 The RPC Bind service provides a facility to map program numbers into
26939 universal addresses.
26940 Many NFS related services use this facility. Hence it is automatically
26941 started when a dependent service starts.
26942
26943 @defvr {Scheme Variable} rpcbind-service-type
26944 A service type for the RPC portmapper daemon.
26945 @end defvr
26946
26947
26948 @deftp {Data Type} rpcbind-configuration
26949 Data type representing the configuration of the RPC Bind Service.
26950 This type has the following parameters:
26951 @table @asis
26952 @item @code{rpcbind} (default: @code{rpcbind})
26953 The rpcbind package to use.
26954
26955 @item @code{warm-start?} (default: @code{#t})
26956 If this parameter is @code{#t}, then the daemon will read a
26957 state file on startup thus reloading state information saved by a previous
26958 instance.
26959 @end table
26960 @end deftp
26961
26962
26963 @subsubheading Pipefs Pseudo File System
26964 @cindex pipefs
26965 @cindex rpc_pipefs
26966
26967 The pipefs file system is used to transfer NFS related data
26968 between the kernel and user space programs.
26969
26970 @defvr {Scheme Variable} pipefs-service-type
26971 A service type for the pipefs pseudo file system.
26972 @end defvr
26973
26974 @deftp {Data Type} pipefs-configuration
26975 Data type representing the configuration of the pipefs pseudo file system service.
26976 This type has the following parameters:
26977 @table @asis
26978 @item @code{mount-point} (default: @code{"/var/lib/nfs/rpc_pipefs"})
26979 The directory to which the file system is to be attached.
26980 @end table
26981 @end deftp
26982
26983
26984 @subsubheading GSS Daemon Service
26985 @cindex GSSD
26986 @cindex GSS
26987 @cindex global security system
26988
26989 The @dfn{global security system} (GSS) daemon provides strong security for RPC
26990 based protocols.
26991 Before exchanging RPC requests an RPC client must establish a security
26992 context. Typically this is done using the Kerberos command @command{kinit}
26993 or automatically at login time using PAM services (@pxref{Kerberos Services}).
26994
26995 @defvr {Scheme Variable} gss-service-type
26996 A service type for the Global Security System (GSS) daemon.
26997 @end defvr
26998
26999 @deftp {Data Type} gss-configuration
27000 Data type representing the configuration of the GSS daemon service.
27001 This type has the following parameters:
27002 @table @asis
27003 @item @code{nfs-utils} (default: @code{nfs-utils})
27004 The package in which the @command{rpc.gssd} command is to be found.
27005
27006 @item @code{pipefs-directory} (default: @code{"/var/lib/nfs/rpc_pipefs"})
27007 The directory where the pipefs file system is mounted.
27008
27009 @end table
27010 @end deftp
27011
27012
27013 @subsubheading IDMAP Daemon Service
27014 @cindex idmapd
27015 @cindex name mapper
27016
27017 The idmap daemon service provides mapping between user IDs and user names.
27018 Typically it is required in order to access file systems mounted via NFSv4.
27019
27020 @defvr {Scheme Variable} idmap-service-type
27021 A service type for the Identity Mapper (IDMAP) daemon.
27022 @end defvr
27023
27024 @deftp {Data Type} idmap-configuration
27025 Data type representing the configuration of the IDMAP daemon service.
27026 This type has the following parameters:
27027 @table @asis
27028 @item @code{nfs-utils} (default: @code{nfs-utils})
27029 The package in which the @command{rpc.idmapd} command is to be found.
27030
27031 @item @code{pipefs-directory} (default: @code{"/var/lib/nfs/rpc_pipefs"})
27032 The directory where the pipefs file system is mounted.
27033
27034 @item @code{domain} (default: @code{#f})
27035 The local NFSv4 domain name.
27036 This must be a string or @code{#f}.
27037 If it is @code{#f} then the daemon will use the host's fully qualified domain name.
27038
27039 @item @code{verbosity} (default: @code{0})
27040 The verbosity level of the daemon.
27041
27042 @end table
27043 @end deftp
27044
27045 @node Continuous Integration
27046 @subsection Continuous Integration
27047
27048 @cindex continuous integration
27049 @uref{https://git.savannah.gnu.org/cgit/guix/guix-cuirass.git, Cuirass} is a
27050 continuous integration tool for Guix. It can be used both for development and
27051 for providing substitutes to others (@pxref{Substitutes}).
27052
27053 The @code{(gnu services cuirass)} module provides the following service.
27054
27055 @defvr {Scheme Procedure} cuirass-service-type
27056 The type of the Cuirass service. Its value must be a
27057 @code{cuirass-configuration} object, as described below.
27058 @end defvr
27059
27060 To add build jobs, you have to set the @code{specifications} field of the
27061 configuration. Here is an example of a service that polls the Guix repository
27062 and builds the packages from a manifest. Some of the packages are defined in
27063 the @code{"custom-packages"} input, which is the equivalent of
27064 @env{GUIX_PACKAGE_PATH}.
27065
27066 @lisp
27067 (define %cuirass-specs
27068 #~(list
27069 '((#:name . "my-manifest")
27070 (#:load-path-inputs . ("guix"))
27071 (#:package-path-inputs . ("custom-packages"))
27072 (#:proc-input . "guix")
27073 (#:proc-file . "build-aux/cuirass/gnu-system.scm")
27074 (#:proc . cuirass-jobs)
27075 (#:proc-args . ((subset . "manifests")
27076 (systems . ("x86_64-linux"))
27077 (manifests . (("config" . "guix/manifest.scm")))))
27078 (#:inputs . (((#:name . "guix")
27079 (#:url . "git://git.savannah.gnu.org/guix.git")
27080 (#:load-path . ".")
27081 (#:branch . "master")
27082 (#:no-compile? . #t))
27083 ((#:name . "config")
27084 (#:url . "https://git.example.org/config.git")
27085 (#:load-path . ".")
27086 (#:branch . "master")
27087 (#:no-compile? . #t))
27088 ((#:name . "custom-packages")
27089 (#:url . "https://git.example.org/custom-packages.git")
27090 (#:load-path . ".")
27091 (#:branch . "master")
27092 (#:no-compile? . #t)))))))
27093
27094 (service cuirass-service-type
27095 (cuirass-configuration
27096 (specifications %cuirass-specs)))
27097 @end lisp
27098
27099 While information related to build jobs is located directly in the
27100 specifications, global settings for the @command{cuirass} process are
27101 accessible in other @code{cuirass-configuration} fields.
27102
27103 @deftp {Data Type} cuirass-configuration
27104 Data type representing the configuration of Cuirass.
27105
27106 @table @asis
27107 @item @code{log-file} (default: @code{"/var/log/cuirass.log"})
27108 Location of the log file.
27109
27110 @item @code{web-log-file} (default: @code{"/var/log/cuirass-web.log"})
27111 Location of the log file used by the web interface.
27112
27113 @item @code{queries-log-file} (default: @code{#f})
27114 Location of the SQL queries log file. By default, SQL queries logging is
27115 disabled.
27116
27117 @item @code{web-queries-log-file} (default: @code{#f})
27118 Location of the web SQL queries log file. By default, web SQL queries
27119 logging is disabled.
27120
27121 @item @code{cache-directory} (default: @code{"/var/cache/cuirass"})
27122 Location of the repository cache.
27123
27124 @item @code{user} (default: @code{"cuirass"})
27125 Owner of the @code{cuirass} process.
27126
27127 @item @code{group} (default: @code{"cuirass"})
27128 Owner's group of the @code{cuirass} process.
27129
27130 @item @code{interval} (default: @code{60})
27131 Number of seconds between the poll of the repositories followed by the
27132 Cuirass jobs.
27133
27134 @item @code{queue-size} (default: @code{1})
27135 Size of the database writer queue.
27136
27137 @item @code{database} (default: @code{"/var/lib/cuirass/cuirass.db"})
27138 Location of sqlite database which contains the build results and previously
27139 added specifications.
27140
27141 @item @code{ttl} (default: @code{(* 30 24 3600)})
27142 Specifies the time-to-live (TTL) in seconds of garbage collector roots that
27143 are registered for build results. This means that build results are protected
27144 from garbage collection for at least @var{ttl} seconds.
27145
27146 @item @code{port} (default: @code{8081})
27147 Port number used by the HTTP server.
27148
27149 @item @code{host} (default: @code{"localhost"})
27150 Listen on the network interface for @var{host}. The default is to
27151 accept connections from localhost.
27152
27153 @item @code{specifications} (default: @code{#~'()})
27154 A gexp (@pxref{G-Expressions}) that evaluates to a list of specifications,
27155 where a specification is an association list
27156 (@pxref{Associations Lists,,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}) whose
27157 keys are keywords (@code{#:keyword-example}) as shown in the example
27158 above.
27159
27160 @item @code{use-substitutes?} (default: @code{#f})
27161 This allows using substitutes to avoid building every dependencies of a job
27162 from source.
27163
27164 @item @code{one-shot?} (default: @code{#f})
27165 Only evaluate specifications and build derivations once.
27166
27167 @item @code{fallback?} (default: @code{#f})
27168 When substituting a pre-built binary fails, fall back to building
27169 packages locally.
27170
27171 @item @code{extra-options} (default: @code{'()})
27172 Extra options to pass when running the Cuirass processes.
27173
27174 @item @code{cuirass} (default: @code{cuirass})
27175 The Cuirass package to use.
27176 @end table
27177 @end deftp
27178
27179 @cindex simple cuirass
27180 @subsubheading Simple Cuirass
27181
27182 The Cuirass service configuration described above can be a little
27183 intimidating. In particular, getting the right @code{specifications}
27184 can prove difficult. The @code{simple-cuirass-configuration->specs}
27185 procedure offers a way to generate those @code{specifications} and thus
27186 setup a continuous integration server more readily.
27187
27188 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} simple-cuirass-configuration->specs @var{configuration}
27189 This procedure takes a @code{simple-cuirass-configuration} record as
27190 argument and returns the corresponding Cuirass specifications gexp.
27191 @end deffn
27192
27193 @deftp {Data Type} simple-cuirass-configuration
27194 Data type representing the configuration of a simple Cuirass instance.
27195
27196 @table @asis
27197 @item @code{build} (default: @code{all})
27198 The packages to be built by Cuirass. It defaults to @code{all}, which
27199 means that all the discovered packages in the subsequent @code{channels}
27200 field are to be selected.
27201
27202 It is also possible to set this field to a list of @code{build-manifest}
27203 records, so that only the packages that are part of the declared
27204 manifests are built. This record is described below.
27205
27206 @deftp {Data Type} build-manifest
27207 @table @asis
27208 @item @code{channel-name}
27209 The name of the channel where the manifest is located.
27210
27211 @item @code{manifest}
27212 The manifest path inside the channel.
27213
27214 @end table
27215 @end deftp
27216
27217 @item @code{channels} (default: @code{%default-channels})
27218 The channels to be fetched by Cuirass (@pxref{Channels}).
27219
27220 @item @code{non-package-channels} (default: @code{'()})
27221 List the channel names that must not be searched for packages. That is
27222 often the case for the channel containing the manifest.
27223
27224 @item @code{systems} (default: @code{(list (%current-system))})
27225 Build every discovered package for each system in this list. By default
27226 only the current system is selected.
27227
27228 @end table
27229 @end deftp
27230
27231 Here is an example of how to setup a Cuirass instance that builds all
27232 the packages declared by Guix and a user repository. The package list
27233 is re-evaluated each time a commit is pushed in one of the declared
27234 channels.
27235
27236 @lisp
27237 (service cuirass-service-type
27238 (cuirass-configuration
27239 (specifications
27240 (simple-cuirass-configuration->specs
27241 (simple-cuirass-configuration
27242 (build 'all)
27243 (channels (cons (channel
27244 (name 'my-guix)
27245 (url "https://my-git-repo/guix.git"))
27246 %default-channels)))))))
27247 @end lisp
27248
27249 In the same spirit, this builds all the packages that are part of the
27250 @code{guix} or @code{my-guix} channels and declared in the manifest
27251 located in the @code{conf} channel.
27252
27253 @lisp
27254 (service cuirass-service-type
27255 (cuirass-configuration
27256 (specifications
27257 (simple-cuirass-configuration->specs
27258 (simple-cuirass-configuration
27259 (build (list
27260 (build-manifest
27261 (channel-name 'conf)
27262 (manifest "guix/manifest.scm"))))
27263 (channels (cons* (channel
27264 (name 'my-guix)
27265 (url "https://my-git-repo/guix.git"))
27266 (channel
27267 (name 'conf)
27268 (url "https://my-git-repo/conf.git"))
27269 %default-channels))
27270 (non-package-channels '(conf)))))))
27271 @end lisp
27272
27273 Finally, @code{simple-cuirass-services} takes as a second optional
27274 argument a @code{cuirass-configuration} record. It can be used to
27275 customize the configuration of the Cuirass instance.
27276
27277 @lisp
27278 (simple-cuirass-services
27279 (simple-cuirass-configuration
27280 (build 'all)
27281 (channels (cons (channel
27282 (name 'my-guix)
27283 (url "https://my-git-repo/guix.git"))
27284 %default-channels))
27285 (non-package-channels '(conf)))
27286 (cuirass-configuration
27287 (inherit %default-cuirass-config)
27288 (host "0.0.0.0"))) ;listen on all interfaces.
27289 @end lisp
27290
27291 @node Power Management Services
27292 @subsection Power Management Services
27293
27294 @cindex tlp
27295 @cindex power management with TLP
27296 @subsubheading TLP daemon
27297
27298 The @code{(gnu services pm)} module provides a Guix service definition
27299 for the Linux power management tool TLP.
27300
27301 TLP enables various powersaving modes in userspace and kernel.
27302 Contrary to @code{upower-service}, it is not a passive,
27303 monitoring tool, as it will apply custom settings each time a new power
27304 source is detected. More information can be found at
27305 @uref{https://linrunner.de/en/tlp/tlp.html, TLP home page}.
27306
27307 @deffn {Scheme Variable} tlp-service-type
27308 The service type for the TLP tool. The default settings are optimised
27309 for battery life on most systems, but you can tweak them to your heart's
27310 content by adding a valid @code{tlp-configuration}:
27311 @lisp
27312 (service tlp-service-type
27313 (tlp-configuration
27314 (cpu-scaling-governor-on-ac (list "performance"))
27315 (sched-powersave-on-bat? #t)))
27316 @end lisp
27317 @end deffn
27318
27319 Each parameter definition is preceded by its type; for example,
27320 @samp{boolean foo} indicates that the @code{foo} parameter
27321 should be specified as a boolean. Types starting with
27322 @code{maybe-} denote parameters that won't show up in TLP config file
27323 when their value is @code{'disabled}.
27324
27325 @c The following documentation was initially generated by
27326 @c (generate-tlp-documentation) in (gnu services pm). Manually maintained
27327 @c documentation is better, so we shouldn't hesitate to edit below as
27328 @c needed. However if the change you want to make to this documentation
27329 @c can be done in an automated way, it's probably easier to change
27330 @c (generate-documentation) than to make it below and have to deal with
27331 @c the churn as TLP updates.
27332
27333 Available @code{tlp-configuration} fields are:
27334
27335 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} package tlp
27336 The TLP package.
27337
27338 @end deftypevr
27339
27340 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} boolean tlp-enable?
27341 Set to true if you wish to enable TLP.
27342
27343 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
27344
27345 @end deftypevr
27346
27347 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} string tlp-default-mode
27348 Default mode when no power supply can be detected. Alternatives are AC
27349 and BAT.
27350
27351 Defaults to @samp{"AC"}.
27352
27353 @end deftypevr
27354
27355 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer disk-idle-secs-on-ac
27356 Number of seconds Linux kernel has to wait after the disk goes idle,
27357 before syncing on AC.
27358
27359 Defaults to @samp{0}.
27360
27361 @end deftypevr
27362
27363 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer disk-idle-secs-on-bat
27364 Same as @code{disk-idle-ac} but on BAT mode.
27365
27366 Defaults to @samp{2}.
27367
27368 @end deftypevr
27369
27370 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer max-lost-work-secs-on-ac
27371 Dirty pages flushing periodicity, expressed in seconds.
27372
27373 Defaults to @samp{15}.
27374
27375 @end deftypevr
27376
27377 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer max-lost-work-secs-on-bat
27378 Same as @code{max-lost-work-secs-on-ac} but on BAT mode.
27379
27380 Defaults to @samp{60}.
27381
27382 @end deftypevr
27383
27384 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-space-separated-string-list cpu-scaling-governor-on-ac
27385 CPU frequency scaling governor on AC mode. With intel_pstate driver,
27386 alternatives are powersave and performance. With acpi-cpufreq driver,
27387 alternatives are ondemand, powersave, performance and conservative.
27388
27389 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
27390
27391 @end deftypevr
27392
27393 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-space-separated-string-list cpu-scaling-governor-on-bat
27394 Same as @code{cpu-scaling-governor-on-ac} but on BAT mode.
27395
27396 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
27397
27398 @end deftypevr
27399
27400 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-non-negative-integer cpu-scaling-min-freq-on-ac
27401 Set the min available frequency for the scaling governor on AC.
27402
27403 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
27404
27405 @end deftypevr
27406
27407 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-non-negative-integer cpu-scaling-max-freq-on-ac
27408 Set the max available frequency for the scaling governor on AC.
27409
27410 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
27411
27412 @end deftypevr
27413
27414 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-non-negative-integer cpu-scaling-min-freq-on-bat
27415 Set the min available frequency for the scaling governor on BAT.
27416
27417 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
27418
27419 @end deftypevr
27420
27421 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-non-negative-integer cpu-scaling-max-freq-on-bat
27422 Set the max available frequency for the scaling governor on BAT.
27423
27424 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
27425
27426 @end deftypevr
27427
27428 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-non-negative-integer cpu-min-perf-on-ac
27429 Limit the min P-state to control the power dissipation of the CPU, in AC
27430 mode. Values are stated as a percentage of the available performance.
27431
27432 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
27433
27434 @end deftypevr
27435
27436 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-non-negative-integer cpu-max-perf-on-ac
27437 Limit the max P-state to control the power dissipation of the CPU, in AC
27438 mode. Values are stated as a percentage of the available performance.
27439
27440 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
27441
27442 @end deftypevr
27443
27444 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-non-negative-integer cpu-min-perf-on-bat
27445 Same as @code{cpu-min-perf-on-ac} on BAT mode.
27446
27447 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
27448
27449 @end deftypevr
27450
27451 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-non-negative-integer cpu-max-perf-on-bat
27452 Same as @code{cpu-max-perf-on-ac} on BAT mode.
27453
27454 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
27455
27456 @end deftypevr
27457
27458 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-boolean cpu-boost-on-ac?
27459 Enable CPU turbo boost feature on AC mode.
27460
27461 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
27462
27463 @end deftypevr
27464
27465 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-boolean cpu-boost-on-bat?
27466 Same as @code{cpu-boost-on-ac?} on BAT mode.
27467
27468 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
27469
27470 @end deftypevr
27471
27472 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} boolean sched-powersave-on-ac?
27473 Allow Linux kernel to minimize the number of CPU cores/hyper-threads
27474 used under light load conditions.
27475
27476 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
27477
27478 @end deftypevr
27479
27480 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} boolean sched-powersave-on-bat?
27481 Same as @code{sched-powersave-on-ac?} but on BAT mode.
27482
27483 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
27484
27485 @end deftypevr
27486
27487 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} boolean nmi-watchdog?
27488 Enable Linux kernel NMI watchdog.
27489
27490 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
27491
27492 @end deftypevr
27493
27494 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-string phc-controls
27495 For Linux kernels with PHC patch applied, change CPU voltages. An
27496 example value would be @samp{"F:V F:V F:V F:V"}.
27497
27498 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
27499
27500 @end deftypevr
27501
27502 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} string energy-perf-policy-on-ac
27503 Set CPU performance versus energy saving policy on AC@. Alternatives are
27504 performance, normal, powersave.
27505
27506 Defaults to @samp{"performance"}.
27507
27508 @end deftypevr
27509
27510 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} string energy-perf-policy-on-bat
27511 Same as @code{energy-perf-policy-ac} but on BAT mode.
27512
27513 Defaults to @samp{"powersave"}.
27514
27515 @end deftypevr
27516
27517 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list disks-devices
27518 Hard disk devices.
27519
27520 @end deftypevr
27521
27522 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list disk-apm-level-on-ac
27523 Hard disk advanced power management level.
27524
27525 @end deftypevr
27526
27527 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list disk-apm-level-on-bat
27528 Same as @code{disk-apm-bat} but on BAT mode.
27529
27530 @end deftypevr
27531
27532 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-space-separated-string-list disk-spindown-timeout-on-ac
27533 Hard disk spin down timeout. One value has to be specified for each
27534 declared hard disk.
27535
27536 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
27537
27538 @end deftypevr
27539
27540 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-space-separated-string-list disk-spindown-timeout-on-bat
27541 Same as @code{disk-spindown-timeout-on-ac} but on BAT mode.
27542
27543 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
27544
27545 @end deftypevr
27546
27547 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-space-separated-string-list disk-iosched
27548 Select IO scheduler for disk devices. One value has to be specified for
27549 each declared hard disk. Example alternatives are cfq, deadline and
27550 noop.
27551
27552 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
27553
27554 @end deftypevr
27555
27556 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} string sata-linkpwr-on-ac
27557 SATA aggressive link power management (ALPM) level. Alternatives are
27558 min_power, medium_power, max_performance.
27559
27560 Defaults to @samp{"max_performance"}.
27561
27562 @end deftypevr
27563
27564 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} string sata-linkpwr-on-bat
27565 Same as @code{sata-linkpwr-ac} but on BAT mode.
27566
27567 Defaults to @samp{"min_power"}.
27568
27569 @end deftypevr
27570
27571 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-string sata-linkpwr-blacklist
27572 Exclude specified SATA host devices for link power management.
27573
27574 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
27575
27576 @end deftypevr
27577
27578 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-on-off-boolean ahci-runtime-pm-on-ac?
27579 Enable Runtime Power Management for AHCI controller and disks on AC
27580 mode.
27581
27582 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
27583
27584 @end deftypevr
27585
27586 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-on-off-boolean ahci-runtime-pm-on-bat?
27587 Same as @code{ahci-runtime-pm-on-ac} on BAT mode.
27588
27589 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
27590
27591 @end deftypevr
27592
27593 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer ahci-runtime-pm-timeout
27594 Seconds of inactivity before disk is suspended.
27595
27596 Defaults to @samp{15}.
27597
27598 @end deftypevr
27599
27600 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} string pcie-aspm-on-ac
27601 PCI Express Active State Power Management level. Alternatives are
27602 default, performance, powersave.
27603
27604 Defaults to @samp{"performance"}.
27605
27606 @end deftypevr
27607
27608 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} string pcie-aspm-on-bat
27609 Same as @code{pcie-aspm-ac} but on BAT mode.
27610
27611 Defaults to @samp{"powersave"}.
27612
27613 @end deftypevr
27614
27615 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} string radeon-power-profile-on-ac
27616 Radeon graphics clock speed level. Alternatives are low, mid, high,
27617 auto, default.
27618
27619 Defaults to @samp{"high"}.
27620
27621 @end deftypevr
27622
27623 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} string radeon-power-profile-on-bat
27624 Same as @code{radeon-power-ac} but on BAT mode.
27625
27626 Defaults to @samp{"low"}.
27627
27628 @end deftypevr
27629
27630 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} string radeon-dpm-state-on-ac
27631 Radeon dynamic power management method (DPM). Alternatives are battery,
27632 performance.
27633
27634 Defaults to @samp{"performance"}.
27635
27636 @end deftypevr
27637
27638 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} string radeon-dpm-state-on-bat
27639 Same as @code{radeon-dpm-state-ac} but on BAT mode.
27640
27641 Defaults to @samp{"battery"}.
27642
27643 @end deftypevr
27644
27645 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} string radeon-dpm-perf-level-on-ac
27646 Radeon DPM performance level. Alternatives are auto, low, high.
27647
27648 Defaults to @samp{"auto"}.
27649
27650 @end deftypevr
27651
27652 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} string radeon-dpm-perf-level-on-bat
27653 Same as @code{radeon-dpm-perf-ac} but on BAT mode.
27654
27655 Defaults to @samp{"auto"}.
27656
27657 @end deftypevr
27658
27659 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} on-off-boolean wifi-pwr-on-ac?
27660 Wifi power saving mode.
27661
27662 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
27663
27664 @end deftypevr
27665
27666 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} on-off-boolean wifi-pwr-on-bat?
27667 Same as @code{wifi-power-ac?} but on BAT mode.
27668
27669 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
27670
27671 @end deftypevr
27672
27673 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} y-n-boolean wol-disable?
27674 Disable wake on LAN.
27675
27676 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
27677
27678 @end deftypevr
27679
27680 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer sound-power-save-on-ac
27681 Timeout duration in seconds before activating audio power saving on
27682 Intel HDA and AC97 devices. A value of 0 disables power saving.
27683
27684 Defaults to @samp{0}.
27685
27686 @end deftypevr
27687
27688 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer sound-power-save-on-bat
27689 Same as @code{sound-powersave-ac} but on BAT mode.
27690
27691 Defaults to @samp{1}.
27692
27693 @end deftypevr
27694
27695 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} y-n-boolean sound-power-save-controller?
27696 Disable controller in powersaving mode on Intel HDA devices.
27697
27698 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
27699
27700 @end deftypevr
27701
27702 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} boolean bay-poweroff-on-bat?
27703 Enable optical drive in UltraBay/MediaBay on BAT mode. Drive can be
27704 powered on again by releasing (and reinserting) the eject lever or by
27705 pressing the disc eject button on newer models.
27706
27707 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
27708
27709 @end deftypevr
27710
27711 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} string bay-device
27712 Name of the optical drive device to power off.
27713
27714 Defaults to @samp{"sr0"}.
27715
27716 @end deftypevr
27717
27718 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} string runtime-pm-on-ac
27719 Runtime Power Management for PCI(e) bus devices. Alternatives are on
27720 and auto.
27721
27722 Defaults to @samp{"on"}.
27723
27724 @end deftypevr
27725
27726 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} string runtime-pm-on-bat
27727 Same as @code{runtime-pm-ac} but on BAT mode.
27728
27729 Defaults to @samp{"auto"}.
27730
27731 @end deftypevr
27732
27733 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} boolean runtime-pm-all?
27734 Runtime Power Management for all PCI(e) bus devices, except blacklisted
27735 ones.
27736
27737 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
27738
27739 @end deftypevr
27740
27741 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-space-separated-string-list runtime-pm-blacklist
27742 Exclude specified PCI(e) device addresses from Runtime Power Management.
27743
27744 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
27745
27746 @end deftypevr
27747
27748 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list runtime-pm-driver-blacklist
27749 Exclude PCI(e) devices assigned to the specified drivers from Runtime
27750 Power Management.
27751
27752 @end deftypevr
27753
27754 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} boolean usb-autosuspend?
27755 Enable USB autosuspend feature.
27756
27757 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
27758
27759 @end deftypevr
27760
27761 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-string usb-blacklist
27762 Exclude specified devices from USB autosuspend.
27763
27764 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
27765
27766 @end deftypevr
27767
27768 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} boolean usb-blacklist-wwan?
27769 Exclude WWAN devices from USB autosuspend.
27770
27771 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
27772
27773 @end deftypevr
27774
27775 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-string usb-whitelist
27776 Include specified devices into USB autosuspend, even if they are already
27777 excluded by the driver or via @code{usb-blacklist-wwan?}.
27778
27779 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
27780
27781 @end deftypevr
27782
27783 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-boolean usb-autosuspend-disable-on-shutdown?
27784 Enable USB autosuspend before shutdown.
27785
27786 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
27787
27788 @end deftypevr
27789
27790 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} boolean restore-device-state-on-startup?
27791 Restore radio device state (bluetooth, wifi, wwan) from previous
27792 shutdown on system startup.
27793
27794 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
27795
27796 @end deftypevr
27797
27798 @cindex thermald
27799 @cindex CPU frequency scaling with thermald
27800 @subsubheading Thermald daemon
27801
27802 The @code{(gnu services pm)} module provides an interface to
27803 thermald, a CPU frequency scaling service which helps prevent overheating.
27804
27805 @defvr {Scheme Variable} thermald-service-type
27806 This is the service type for
27807 @uref{https://01.org/linux-thermal-daemon/, thermald}, the Linux
27808 Thermal Daemon, which is responsible for controlling the thermal state
27809 of processors and preventing overheating.
27810 @end defvr
27811
27812 @deftp {Data Type} thermald-configuration
27813 Data type representing the configuration of @code{thermald-service-type}.
27814
27815 @table @asis
27816 @item @code{ignore-cpuid-check?} (default: @code{#f})
27817 Ignore cpuid check for supported CPU models.
27818
27819 @item @code{thermald} (default: @var{thermald})
27820 Package object of thermald.
27821
27822 @end table
27823 @end deftp
27824
27825 @node Audio Services
27826 @subsection Audio Services
27827
27828 The @code{(gnu services audio)} module provides a service to start MPD
27829 (the Music Player Daemon).
27830
27831 @cindex mpd
27832 @subsubheading Music Player Daemon
27833
27834 The Music Player Daemon (MPD) is a service that can play music while
27835 being controlled from the local machine or over the network by a variety
27836 of clients.
27837
27838 The following example shows how one might run @code{mpd} as user
27839 @code{"bob"} on port @code{6666}. It uses pulseaudio for output.
27840
27841 @lisp
27842 (service mpd-service-type
27843 (mpd-configuration
27844 (user "bob")
27845 (port "6666")))
27846 @end lisp
27847
27848 @defvr {Scheme Variable} mpd-service-type
27849 The service type for @command{mpd}
27850 @end defvr
27851
27852 @deftp {Data Type} mpd-configuration
27853 Data type representing the configuration of @command{mpd}.
27854
27855 @table @asis
27856 @item @code{user} (default: @code{"mpd"})
27857 The user to run mpd as.
27858
27859 @item @code{music-dir} (default: @code{"~/Music"})
27860 The directory to scan for music files.
27861
27862 @item @code{playlist-dir} (default: @code{"~/.mpd/playlists"})
27863 The directory to store playlists.
27864
27865 @item @code{db-file} (default: @code{"~/.mpd/tag_cache"})
27866 The location of the music database.
27867
27868 @item @code{state-file} (default: @code{"~/.mpd/state"})
27869 The location of the file that stores current MPD's state.
27870
27871 @item @code{sticker-file} (default: @code{"~/.mpd/sticker.sql"})
27872 The location of the sticker database.
27873
27874 @item @code{port} (default: @code{"6600"})
27875 The port to run mpd on.
27876
27877 @item @code{address} (default: @code{"any"})
27878 The address that mpd will bind to. To use a Unix domain socket,
27879 an absolute path can be specified here.
27880
27881 @item @code{outputs} (default: @code{"(list (mpd-output))"})
27882 The audio outputs that MPD can use. By default this is a single output using pulseaudio.
27883
27884 @end table
27885 @end deftp
27886
27887 @deftp {Data Type} mpd-output
27888 Data type representing an @command{mpd} audio output.
27889
27890 @table @asis
27891 @item @code{name} (default: @code{"MPD"})
27892 The name of the audio output.
27893
27894 @item @code{type} (default: @code{"pulse"})
27895 The type of audio output.
27896
27897 @item @code{enabled?} (default: @code{#t})
27898 Specifies whether this audio output is enabled when MPD is started. By
27899 default, all audio outputs are enabled. This is just the default
27900 setting when there is no state file; with a state file, the previous
27901 state is restored.
27902
27903 @item @code{tags?} (default: @code{#t})
27904 If set to @code{#f}, then MPD will not send tags to this output. This
27905 is only useful for output plugins that can receive tags, for example the
27906 @code{httpd} output plugin.
27907
27908 @item @code{always-on?} (default: @code{#f})
27909 If set to @code{#t}, then MPD attempts to keep this audio output always
27910 open. This may be useful for streaming servers, when you don’t want to
27911 disconnect all listeners even when playback is accidentally stopped.
27912
27913 @item @code{mixer-type}
27914 This field accepts a symbol that specifies which mixer should be used
27915 for this audio output: the @code{hardware} mixer, the @code{software}
27916 mixer, the @code{null} mixer (allows setting the volume, but with no
27917 effect; this can be used as a trick to implement an external mixer
27918 External Mixer) or no mixer (@code{none}).
27919
27920 @item @code{extra-options} (default: @code{'()})
27921 An association list of option symbols to string values to be appended to
27922 the audio output configuration.
27923
27924 @end table
27925 @end deftp
27926
27927 The following example shows a configuration of @code{mpd} that provides
27928 an HTTP audio streaming output.
27929
27930 @lisp
27931 (service mpd-service-type
27932 (mpd-configuration
27933 (outputs
27934 (list (mpd-output
27935 (name "streaming")
27936 (type "httpd")
27937 (mixer-type 'null)
27938 (extra-options
27939 `((encoder . "vorbis")
27940 (port . "8080"))))))))
27941 @end lisp
27942
27943
27944 @node Virtualization Services
27945 @subsection Virtualization Services
27946
27947 The @code{(gnu services virtualization)} module provides services for
27948 the libvirt and virtlog daemons, as well as other virtualization-related
27949 services.
27950
27951 @subsubheading Libvirt daemon
27952
27953 @code{libvirtd} is the server side daemon component of the libvirt
27954 virtualization management system. This daemon runs on host servers
27955 and performs required management tasks for virtualized guests.
27956
27957 @deffn {Scheme Variable} libvirt-service-type
27958 This is the type of the @uref{https://libvirt.org, libvirt daemon}.
27959 Its value must be a @code{libvirt-configuration}.
27960
27961 @lisp
27962 (service libvirt-service-type
27963 (libvirt-configuration
27964 (unix-sock-group "libvirt")
27965 (tls-port "16555")))
27966 @end lisp
27967 @end deffn
27968
27969 @c Auto-generated with (generate-libvirt-documentation)
27970 Available @code{libvirt-configuration} fields are:
27971
27972 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} package libvirt
27973 Libvirt package.
27974
27975 @end deftypevr
27976
27977 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} boolean listen-tls?
27978 Flag listening for secure TLS connections on the public TCP/IP port.
27979 You must set @code{listen} for this to have any effect.
27980
27981 It is necessary to setup a CA and issue server certificates before using
27982 this capability.
27983
27984 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
27985
27986 @end deftypevr
27987
27988 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} boolean listen-tcp?
27989 Listen for unencrypted TCP connections on the public TCP/IP port. You must
27990 set @code{listen} for this to have any effect.
27991
27992 Using the TCP socket requires SASL authentication by default. Only SASL
27993 mechanisms which support data encryption are allowed. This is
27994 DIGEST_MD5 and GSSAPI (Kerberos5).
27995
27996 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
27997
27998 @end deftypevr
27999
28000 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string tls-port
28001 Port for accepting secure TLS connections. This can be a port number,
28002 or service name.
28003
28004 Defaults to @samp{"16514"}.
28005
28006 @end deftypevr
28007
28008 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string tcp-port
28009 Port for accepting insecure TCP connections. This can be a port number,
28010 or service name.
28011
28012 Defaults to @samp{"16509"}.
28013
28014 @end deftypevr
28015
28016 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string listen-addr
28017 IP address or hostname used for client connections.
28018
28019 Defaults to @samp{"0.0.0.0"}.
28020
28021 @end deftypevr
28022
28023 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} boolean mdns-adv?
28024 Flag toggling mDNS advertisement of the libvirt service.
28025
28026 Alternatively can disable for all services on a host by stopping the
28027 Avahi daemon.
28028
28029 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
28030
28031 @end deftypevr
28032
28033 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string mdns-name
28034 Default mDNS advertisement name. This must be unique on the immediate
28035 broadcast network.
28036
28037 Defaults to @samp{"Virtualization Host <hostname>"}.
28038
28039 @end deftypevr
28040
28041 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string unix-sock-group
28042 UNIX domain socket group ownership. This can be used to allow a
28043 'trusted' set of users access to management capabilities without
28044 becoming root.
28045
28046 Defaults to @samp{"root"}.
28047
28048 @end deftypevr
28049
28050 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string unix-sock-ro-perms
28051 UNIX socket permissions for the R/O socket. This is used for monitoring
28052 VM status only.
28053
28054 Defaults to @samp{"0777"}.
28055
28056 @end deftypevr
28057
28058 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string unix-sock-rw-perms
28059 UNIX socket permissions for the R/W socket. Default allows only root.
28060 If PolicyKit is enabled on the socket, the default will change to allow
28061 everyone (eg, 0777)
28062
28063 Defaults to @samp{"0770"}.
28064
28065 @end deftypevr
28066
28067 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string unix-sock-admin-perms
28068 UNIX socket permissions for the admin socket. Default allows only owner
28069 (root), do not change it unless you are sure to whom you are exposing
28070 the access to.
28071
28072 Defaults to @samp{"0777"}.
28073
28074 @end deftypevr
28075
28076 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string unix-sock-dir
28077 The directory in which sockets will be found/created.
28078
28079 Defaults to @samp{"/var/run/libvirt"}.
28080
28081 @end deftypevr
28082
28083 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string auth-unix-ro
28084 Authentication scheme for UNIX read-only sockets. By default socket
28085 permissions allow anyone to connect
28086
28087 Defaults to @samp{"polkit"}.
28088
28089 @end deftypevr
28090
28091 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string auth-unix-rw
28092 Authentication scheme for UNIX read-write sockets. By default socket
28093 permissions only allow root. If PolicyKit support was compiled into
28094 libvirt, the default will be to use 'polkit' auth.
28095
28096 Defaults to @samp{"polkit"}.
28097
28098 @end deftypevr
28099
28100 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string auth-tcp
28101 Authentication scheme for TCP sockets. If you don't enable SASL, then
28102 all TCP traffic is cleartext. Don't do this outside of a dev/test
28103 scenario.
28104
28105 Defaults to @samp{"sasl"}.
28106
28107 @end deftypevr
28108
28109 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string auth-tls
28110 Authentication scheme for TLS sockets. TLS sockets already have
28111 encryption provided by the TLS layer, and limited authentication is done
28112 by certificates.
28113
28114 It is possible to make use of any SASL authentication mechanism as well,
28115 by using 'sasl' for this option
28116
28117 Defaults to @samp{"none"}.
28118
28119 @end deftypevr
28120
28121 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} optional-list access-drivers
28122 API access control scheme.
28123
28124 By default an authenticated user is allowed access to all APIs. Access
28125 drivers can place restrictions on this.
28126
28127 Defaults to @samp{()}.
28128
28129 @end deftypevr
28130
28131 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string key-file
28132 Server key file path. If set to an empty string, then no private key is
28133 loaded.
28134
28135 Defaults to @samp{""}.
28136
28137 @end deftypevr
28138
28139 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string cert-file
28140 Server key file path. If set to an empty string, then no certificate is
28141 loaded.
28142
28143 Defaults to @samp{""}.
28144
28145 @end deftypevr
28146
28147 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string ca-file
28148 Server key file path. If set to an empty string, then no CA certificate
28149 is loaded.
28150
28151 Defaults to @samp{""}.
28152
28153 @end deftypevr
28154
28155 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string crl-file
28156 Certificate revocation list path. If set to an empty string, then no
28157 CRL is loaded.
28158
28159 Defaults to @samp{""}.
28160
28161 @end deftypevr
28162
28163 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} boolean tls-no-sanity-cert
28164 Disable verification of our own server certificates.
28165
28166 When libvirtd starts it performs some sanity checks against its own
28167 certificates.
28168
28169 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
28170
28171 @end deftypevr
28172
28173 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} boolean tls-no-verify-cert
28174 Disable verification of client certificates.
28175
28176 Client certificate verification is the primary authentication mechanism.
28177 Any client which does not present a certificate signed by the CA will be
28178 rejected.
28179
28180 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
28181
28182 @end deftypevr
28183
28184 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} optional-list tls-allowed-dn-list
28185 Whitelist of allowed x509 Distinguished Name.
28186
28187 Defaults to @samp{()}.
28188
28189 @end deftypevr
28190
28191 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} optional-list sasl-allowed-usernames
28192 Whitelist of allowed SASL usernames. The format for username depends on
28193 the SASL authentication mechanism.
28194
28195 Defaults to @samp{()}.
28196
28197 @end deftypevr
28198
28199 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string tls-priority
28200 Override the compile time default TLS priority string. The default is
28201 usually @samp{"NORMAL"} unless overridden at build time. Only set this is it
28202 is desired for libvirt to deviate from the global default settings.
28203
28204 Defaults to @samp{"NORMAL"}.
28205
28206 @end deftypevr
28207
28208 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer max-clients
28209 Maximum number of concurrent client connections to allow over all
28210 sockets combined.
28211
28212 Defaults to @samp{5000}.
28213
28214 @end deftypevr
28215
28216 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer max-queued-clients
28217 Maximum length of queue of connections waiting to be accepted by the
28218 daemon. Note, that some protocols supporting retransmission may obey
28219 this so that a later reattempt at connection succeeds.
28220
28221 Defaults to @samp{1000}.
28222
28223 @end deftypevr
28224
28225 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer max-anonymous-clients
28226 Maximum length of queue of accepted but not yet authenticated clients.
28227 Set this to zero to turn this feature off
28228
28229 Defaults to @samp{20}.
28230
28231 @end deftypevr
28232
28233 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer min-workers
28234 Number of workers to start up initially.
28235
28236 Defaults to @samp{5}.
28237
28238 @end deftypevr
28239
28240 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer max-workers
28241 Maximum number of worker threads.
28242
28243 If the number of active clients exceeds @code{min-workers}, then more
28244 threads are spawned, up to max_workers limit. Typically you'd want
28245 max_workers to equal maximum number of clients allowed.
28246
28247 Defaults to @samp{20}.
28248
28249 @end deftypevr
28250
28251 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer prio-workers
28252 Number of priority workers. If all workers from above pool are stuck,
28253 some calls marked as high priority (notably domainDestroy) can be
28254 executed in this pool.
28255
28256 Defaults to @samp{5}.
28257
28258 @end deftypevr
28259
28260 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer max-requests
28261 Total global limit on concurrent RPC calls.
28262
28263 Defaults to @samp{20}.
28264
28265 @end deftypevr
28266
28267 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer max-client-requests
28268 Limit on concurrent requests from a single client connection. To avoid
28269 one client monopolizing the server this should be a small fraction of
28270 the global max_requests and max_workers parameter.
28271
28272 Defaults to @samp{5}.
28273
28274 @end deftypevr
28275
28276 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer admin-min-workers
28277 Same as @code{min-workers} but for the admin interface.
28278
28279 Defaults to @samp{1}.
28280
28281 @end deftypevr
28282
28283 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer admin-max-workers
28284 Same as @code{max-workers} but for the admin interface.
28285
28286 Defaults to @samp{5}.
28287
28288 @end deftypevr
28289
28290 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer admin-max-clients
28291 Same as @code{max-clients} but for the admin interface.
28292
28293 Defaults to @samp{5}.
28294
28295 @end deftypevr
28296
28297 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer admin-max-queued-clients
28298 Same as @code{max-queued-clients} but for the admin interface.
28299
28300 Defaults to @samp{5}.
28301
28302 @end deftypevr
28303
28304 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer admin-max-client-requests
28305 Same as @code{max-client-requests} but for the admin interface.
28306
28307 Defaults to @samp{5}.
28308
28309 @end deftypevr
28310
28311 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer log-level
28312 Logging level. 4 errors, 3 warnings, 2 information, 1 debug.
28313
28314 Defaults to @samp{3}.
28315
28316 @end deftypevr
28317
28318 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string log-filters
28319 Logging filters.
28320
28321 A filter allows to select a different logging level for a given category
28322 of logs. The format for a filter is one of:
28323
28324 @itemize @bullet
28325 @item
28326 x:name
28327
28328 @item
28329 x:+name
28330
28331 @end itemize
28332
28333 where @code{name} is a string which is matched against the category
28334 given in the @code{VIR_LOG_INIT()} at the top of each libvirt source
28335 file, e.g., @samp{"remote"}, @samp{"qemu"}, or @samp{"util.json"} (the
28336 name in the filter can be a substring of the full category name, in
28337 order to match multiple similar categories), the optional @samp{"+"}
28338 prefix tells libvirt to log stack trace for each message matching name,
28339 and @code{x} is the minimal level where matching messages should be
28340 logged:
28341
28342 @itemize @bullet
28343 @item
28344 1: DEBUG
28345
28346 @item
28347 2: INFO
28348
28349 @item
28350 3: WARNING
28351
28352 @item
28353 4: ERROR
28354
28355 @end itemize
28356
28357 Multiple filters can be defined in a single filters statement, they just
28358 need to be separated by spaces.
28359
28360 Defaults to @samp{"3:remote 4:event"}.
28361
28362 @end deftypevr
28363
28364 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string log-outputs
28365 Logging outputs.
28366
28367 An output is one of the places to save logging information. The format
28368 for an output can be:
28369
28370 @table @code
28371 @item x:stderr
28372 output goes to stderr
28373
28374 @item x:syslog:name
28375 use syslog for the output and use the given name as the ident
28376
28377 @item x:file:file_path
28378 output to a file, with the given filepath
28379
28380 @item x:journald
28381 output to journald logging system
28382
28383 @end table
28384
28385 In all case the x prefix is the minimal level, acting as a filter
28386
28387 @itemize @bullet
28388 @item
28389 1: DEBUG
28390
28391 @item
28392 2: INFO
28393
28394 @item
28395 3: WARNING
28396
28397 @item
28398 4: ERROR
28399
28400 @end itemize
28401
28402 Multiple outputs can be defined, they just need to be separated by
28403 spaces.
28404
28405 Defaults to @samp{"3:stderr"}.
28406
28407 @end deftypevr
28408
28409 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer audit-level
28410 Allows usage of the auditing subsystem to be altered
28411
28412 @itemize @bullet
28413 @item
28414 0: disable all auditing
28415
28416 @item
28417 1: enable auditing, only if enabled on host
28418
28419 @item
28420 2: enable auditing, and exit if disabled on host.
28421
28422 @end itemize
28423
28424 Defaults to @samp{1}.
28425
28426 @end deftypevr
28427
28428 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} boolean audit-logging
28429 Send audit messages via libvirt logging infrastructure.
28430
28431 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
28432
28433 @end deftypevr
28434
28435 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} optional-string host-uuid
28436 Host UUID@. UUID must not have all digits be the same.
28437
28438 Defaults to @samp{""}.
28439
28440 @end deftypevr
28441
28442 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string host-uuid-source
28443 Source to read host UUID.
28444
28445 @itemize @bullet
28446 @item
28447 @code{smbios}: fetch the UUID from @code{dmidecode -s system-uuid}
28448
28449 @item
28450 @code{machine-id}: fetch the UUID from @code{/etc/machine-id}
28451
28452 @end itemize
28453
28454 If @code{dmidecode} does not provide a valid UUID a temporary UUID will
28455 be generated.
28456
28457 Defaults to @samp{"smbios"}.
28458
28459 @end deftypevr
28460
28461 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer keepalive-interval
28462 A keepalive message is sent to a client after @code{keepalive_interval}
28463 seconds of inactivity to check if the client is still responding. If
28464 set to -1, libvirtd will never send keepalive requests; however clients
28465 can still send them and the daemon will send responses.
28466
28467 Defaults to @samp{5}.
28468
28469 @end deftypevr
28470
28471 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer keepalive-count
28472 Maximum number of keepalive messages that are allowed to be sent to the
28473 client without getting any response before the connection is considered
28474 broken.
28475
28476 In other words, the connection is automatically closed approximately
28477 after @code{keepalive_interval * (keepalive_count + 1)} seconds since
28478 the last message received from the client. When @code{keepalive-count}
28479 is set to 0, connections will be automatically closed after
28480 @code{keepalive-interval} seconds of inactivity without sending any
28481 keepalive messages.
28482
28483 Defaults to @samp{5}.
28484
28485 @end deftypevr
28486
28487 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer admin-keepalive-interval
28488 Same as above but for admin interface.
28489
28490 Defaults to @samp{5}.
28491
28492 @end deftypevr
28493
28494 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer admin-keepalive-count
28495 Same as above but for admin interface.
28496
28497 Defaults to @samp{5}.
28498
28499 @end deftypevr
28500
28501 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer ovs-timeout
28502 Timeout for Open vSwitch calls.
28503
28504 The @code{ovs-vsctl} utility is used for the configuration and its
28505 timeout option is set by default to 5 seconds to avoid potential
28506 infinite waits blocking libvirt.
28507
28508 Defaults to @samp{5}.
28509
28510 @end deftypevr
28511
28512 @c %end of autogenerated docs
28513
28514 @subsubheading Virtlog daemon
28515 The virtlogd service is a server side daemon component of libvirt that is
28516 used to manage logs from virtual machine consoles.
28517
28518 This daemon is not used directly by libvirt client applications, rather it
28519 is called on their behalf by @code{libvirtd}. By maintaining the logs in a
28520 standalone daemon, the main @code{libvirtd} daemon can be restarted without
28521 risk of losing logs. The @code{virtlogd} daemon has the ability to re-exec()
28522 itself upon receiving @code{SIGUSR1}, to allow live upgrades without downtime.
28523
28524 @deffn {Scheme Variable} virtlog-service-type
28525 This is the type of the virtlog daemon.
28526 Its value must be a @code{virtlog-configuration}.
28527
28528 @lisp
28529 (service virtlog-service-type
28530 (virtlog-configuration
28531 (max-clients 1000)))
28532 @end lisp
28533 @end deffn
28534
28535 @deftypevr {@code{virtlog-configuration} parameter} integer log-level
28536 Logging level. 4 errors, 3 warnings, 2 information, 1 debug.
28537
28538 Defaults to @samp{3}.
28539
28540 @end deftypevr
28541
28542 @deftypevr {@code{virtlog-configuration} parameter} string log-filters
28543 Logging filters.
28544
28545 A filter allows to select a different logging level for a given category
28546 of logs The format for a filter is one of:
28547
28548 @itemize @bullet
28549 @item
28550 x:name
28551
28552 @item
28553 x:+name
28554
28555 @end itemize
28556
28557 where @code{name} is a string which is matched against the category
28558 given in the @code{VIR_LOG_INIT()} at the top of each libvirt source
28559 file, e.g., "remote", "qemu", or "util.json" (the name in the filter can
28560 be a substring of the full category name, in order to match multiple
28561 similar categories), the optional "+" prefix tells libvirt to log stack
28562 trace for each message matching name, and @code{x} is the minimal level
28563 where matching messages should be logged:
28564
28565 @itemize @bullet
28566 @item
28567 1: DEBUG
28568
28569 @item
28570 2: INFO
28571
28572 @item
28573 3: WARNING
28574
28575 @item
28576 4: ERROR
28577
28578 @end itemize
28579
28580 Multiple filters can be defined in a single filters statement, they just
28581 need to be separated by spaces.
28582
28583 Defaults to @samp{"3:remote 4:event"}.
28584
28585 @end deftypevr
28586
28587 @deftypevr {@code{virtlog-configuration} parameter} string log-outputs
28588 Logging outputs.
28589
28590 An output is one of the places to save logging information The format
28591 for an output can be:
28592
28593 @table @code
28594 @item x:stderr
28595 output goes to stderr
28596
28597 @item x:syslog:name
28598 use syslog for the output and use the given name as the ident
28599
28600 @item x:file:file_path
28601 output to a file, with the given filepath
28602
28603 @item x:journald
28604 output to journald logging system
28605
28606 @end table
28607
28608 In all case the x prefix is the minimal level, acting as a filter
28609
28610 @itemize @bullet
28611 @item
28612 1: DEBUG
28613
28614 @item
28615 2: INFO
28616
28617 @item
28618 3: WARNING
28619
28620 @item
28621 4: ERROR
28622
28623 @end itemize
28624
28625 Multiple outputs can be defined, they just need to be separated by
28626 spaces.
28627
28628 Defaults to @samp{"3:stderr"}.
28629
28630 @end deftypevr
28631
28632 @deftypevr {@code{virtlog-configuration} parameter} integer max-clients
28633 Maximum number of concurrent client connections to allow over all
28634 sockets combined.
28635
28636 Defaults to @samp{1024}.
28637
28638 @end deftypevr
28639
28640 @deftypevr {@code{virtlog-configuration} parameter} integer max-size
28641 Maximum file size before rolling over.
28642
28643 Defaults to @samp{2MB}
28644
28645 @end deftypevr
28646
28647 @deftypevr {@code{virtlog-configuration} parameter} integer max-backups
28648 Maximum number of backup files to keep.
28649
28650 Defaults to @samp{3}
28651
28652 @end deftypevr
28653
28654 @anchor{transparent-emulation-qemu}
28655 @subsubheading Transparent Emulation with QEMU
28656
28657 @cindex emulation
28658 @cindex @code{binfmt_misc}
28659 @code{qemu-binfmt-service-type} provides support for transparent
28660 emulation of program binaries built for different architectures---e.g.,
28661 it allows you to transparently execute an ARMv7 program on an x86_64
28662 machine. It achieves this by combining the @uref{https://www.qemu.org,
28663 QEMU} emulator and the @code{binfmt_misc} feature of the kernel Linux.
28664 This feature only allows you to emulate GNU/Linux on a different
28665 architecture, but see below for GNU/Hurd support.
28666
28667 @defvr {Scheme Variable} qemu-binfmt-service-type
28668 This is the type of the QEMU/binfmt service for transparent emulation.
28669 Its value must be a @code{qemu-binfmt-configuration} object, which
28670 specifies the QEMU package to use as well as the architecture we want to
28671 emulated:
28672
28673 @lisp
28674 (service qemu-binfmt-service-type
28675 (qemu-binfmt-configuration
28676 (platforms (lookup-qemu-platforms "arm" "aarch64"))))
28677 @end lisp
28678
28679 In this example, we enable transparent emulation for the ARM and aarch64
28680 platforms. Running @code{herd stop qemu-binfmt} turns it off, and
28681 running @code{herd start qemu-binfmt} turns it back on (@pxref{Invoking
28682 herd, the @command{herd} command,, shepherd, The GNU Shepherd Manual}).
28683 @end defvr
28684
28685 @deftp {Data Type} qemu-binfmt-configuration
28686 This is the configuration for the @code{qemu-binfmt} service.
28687
28688 @table @asis
28689 @item @code{platforms} (default: @code{'()})
28690 The list of emulated QEMU platforms. Each item must be a @dfn{platform
28691 object} as returned by @code{lookup-qemu-platforms} (see below).
28692
28693 @item @code{guix-support?} (default: @code{#t})
28694 When it is true, QEMU and all its dependencies are added to the build
28695 environment of @command{guix-daemon} (@pxref{Invoking guix-daemon,
28696 @option{--chroot-directory} option}). This allows the @code{binfmt_misc}
28697 handlers to be used within the build environment, which in turn means
28698 that you can transparently build programs for another architecture.
28699
28700 For example, let's suppose you're on an x86_64 machine and you have this
28701 service:
28702
28703 @lisp
28704 (service qemu-binfmt-service-type
28705 (qemu-binfmt-configuration
28706 (platforms (lookup-qemu-platforms "arm"))
28707 (guix-support? #t)))
28708 @end lisp
28709
28710 You can run:
28711
28712 @example
28713 guix build -s armhf-linux inkscape
28714 @end example
28715
28716 @noindent
28717 and it will build Inkscape for ARMv7 @emph{as if it were a native
28718 build}, transparently using QEMU to emulate the ARMv7 CPU@. Pretty handy
28719 if you'd like to test a package build for an architecture you don't have
28720 access to!
28721
28722 When @code{guix-support?} is set to @code{#f}, programs for other
28723 architectures can still be executed transparently, but invoking commands
28724 like @command{guix build -s armhf-linux @dots{}} will fail.
28725
28726 @item @code{qemu} (default: @code{qemu})
28727 The QEMU package to use.
28728 @end table
28729 @end deftp
28730
28731 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} lookup-qemu-platforms @var{platforms}@dots{}
28732 Return the list of QEMU platform objects corresponding to
28733 @var{platforms}@dots{}. @var{platforms} must be a list of strings
28734 corresponding to platform names, such as @code{"arm"}, @code{"sparc"},
28735 @code{"mips64el"}, and so on.
28736 @end deffn
28737
28738 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} qemu-platform? @var{obj}
28739 Return true if @var{obj} is a platform object.
28740 @end deffn
28741
28742 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} qemu-platform-name @var{platform}
28743 Return the name of @var{platform}---a string such as @code{"arm"}.
28744 @end deffn
28745
28746
28747 @subsubheading The Hurd in a Virtual Machine
28748
28749 @cindex @code{hurd}
28750 @cindex the Hurd
28751 @cindex childhurd
28752
28753 Service @code{hurd-vm} provides support for running GNU/Hurd in a
28754 virtual machine (VM), a so-called @dfn{childhurd}. This service is meant
28755 to be used on GNU/Linux and the given GNU/Hurd operating system
28756 configuration is cross-compiled. The virtual machine is a Shepherd
28757 service that can be referred to by the names @code{hurd-vm} and
28758 @code{childhurd} and be controlled with commands such as:
28759
28760 @example
28761 herd start hurd-vm
28762 herd stop childhurd
28763 @end example
28764
28765 When the service is running, you can view its console by connecting to
28766 it with a VNC client, for example with:
28767
28768 @example
28769 guix environment --ad-hoc tigervnc-client -- \
28770 vncviewer localhost:5900
28771 @end example
28772
28773 The default configuration (see @code{hurd-vm-configuration} below)
28774 spawns a secure shell (SSH) server in your GNU/Hurd system, which QEMU
28775 (the virtual machine emulator) redirects to port 10222 on the host.
28776 Thus, you can connect over SSH to the childhurd with:
28777
28778 @example
28779 ssh root@@localhost -p 10022
28780 @end example
28781
28782 The childhurd is volatile and stateless: it starts with a fresh root
28783 file system every time you restart it. By default though, all the files
28784 under @file{/etc/childhurd} on the host are copied as is to the root
28785 file system of the childhurd when it boots. This allows you to
28786 initialize ``secrets'' inside the VM: SSH host keys, authorized
28787 substitute keys, and so on---see the explanation of @code{secret-root}
28788 below.
28789
28790 @defvr {Scheme Variable} hurd-vm-service-type
28791 This is the type of the Hurd in a Virtual Machine service. Its value
28792 must be a @code{hurd-vm-configuration} object, which specifies the
28793 operating system (@pxref{operating-system Reference}) and the disk size
28794 for the Hurd Virtual Machine, the QEMU package to use as well as the
28795 options for running it.
28796
28797 For example:
28798
28799 @lisp
28800 (service hurd-vm-service-type
28801 (hurd-vm-configuration
28802 (disk-size (* 5000 (expt 2 20))) ;5G
28803 (memory-size 1024))) ;1024MiB
28804 @end lisp
28805
28806 would create a disk image big enough to build GNU@tie{}Hello, with some
28807 extra memory.
28808 @end defvr
28809
28810 @deftp {Data Type} hurd-vm-configuration
28811 The data type representing the configuration for
28812 @code{hurd-vm-service-type}.
28813
28814 @table @asis
28815 @item @code{os} (default: @var{%hurd-vm-operating-system})
28816 The operating system to instantiate. This default is bare-bones with a
28817 permissive OpenSSH secure shell daemon listening on port 2222
28818 (@pxref{Networking Services, @code{openssh-service-type}}).
28819
28820 @item @code{qemu} (default: @code{qemu-minimal})
28821 The QEMU package to use.
28822
28823 @item @code{image} (default: @var{hurd-vm-disk-image})
28824 The procedure used to build the disk-image built from this
28825 configuration.
28826
28827 @item @code{disk-size} (default: @code{'guess})
28828 The size of the disk image.
28829
28830 @item @code{memory-size} (default: @code{512})
28831 The memory size of the Virtual Machine in mebibytes.
28832
28833 @item @code{options} (default: @code{'("--snapshot")})
28834 The extra options for running QEMU.
28835
28836 @item @code{id} (default: @code{#f})
28837 If set, a non-zero positive integer used to parameterize Childhurd
28838 instances. It is appended to the service's name,
28839 e.g. @code{childhurd1}.
28840
28841 @item @code{net-options} (default: @var{hurd-vm-net-options})
28842 The procedure used to produce the list of QEMU networking options.
28843
28844 By default, it produces
28845
28846 @lisp
28847 '("--device" "rtl8139,netdev=net0"
28848 "--netdev" "user,id=net0\
28849 ,hostfwd=tcp:127.0.0.1:@var{secrets-port}-:1004\
28850 ,hostfwd=tcp:127.0.0.1:@var{ssh-port}-:2222\
28851 ,hostfwd=tcp:127.0.0.1:@var{vnc-port}-:5900")
28852 @end lisp
28853
28854 with forwarded ports:
28855
28856 @example
28857 @var{secrets-port}: @code{(+ 11004 (* 1000 @var{ID}))}
28858 @var{ssh-port}: @code{(+ 10022 (* 1000 @var{ID}))}
28859 @var{vnc-port}: @code{(+ 15900 (* 1000 @var{ID}))}
28860 @end example
28861
28862 @item @code{secret-root} (default: @file{/etc/childhurd})
28863 The root directory with out-of-band secrets to be installed into the
28864 childhurd once it runs. Childhurds are volatile which means that on
28865 every startup, secrets such as the SSH host keys and Guix signing key
28866 are recreated.
28867
28868 If the @file{/etc/childhurd} directory does not exist, the
28869 @code{secret-service} running in the Childhurd will be sent an empty
28870 list of secrets.
28871
28872 By default, the service automatically populates @file{/etc/childhurd}
28873 with the following non-volatile secrets, unless they already exist:
28874
28875 @example
28876 /etc/childhurd/etc/guix/acl
28877 /etc/childhurd/etc/guix/signing-key.pub
28878 /etc/childhurd/etc/guix/signing-key.sec
28879 /etc/childhurd/etc/ssh/ssh_host_ed25519_key
28880 /etc/childhurd/etc/ssh/ssh_host_ecdsa_key
28881 /etc/childhurd/etc/ssh/ssh_host_ed25519_key.pub
28882 /etc/childhurd/etc/ssh/ssh_host_ecdsa_key.pub
28883 @end example
28884
28885 These files are automatically sent to the guest Hurd VM when it boots,
28886 including permissions.
28887
28888 @cindex childhurd, offloading
28889 @cindex Hurd, offloading
28890 Having these files in place means that only a couple of things are
28891 missing to allow the host to offload @code{i586-gnu} builds to the
28892 childhurd:
28893
28894 @enumerate
28895 @item
28896 Authorizing the childhurd's key on the host so that the host accepts
28897 build results coming from the childhurd, which can be done like so:
28898
28899 @example
28900 guix archive --authorize < \
28901 /etc/childhurd/etc/guix/signing-key.pub
28902 @end example
28903
28904 @item
28905 Adding the childhurd to @file{/etc/guix/machines.scm} (@pxref{Daemon
28906 Offload Setup}).
28907 @end enumerate
28908
28909 We're working towards making that happen automatically---get in touch
28910 with us at @email{guix-devel@@gnu.org} to discuss it!
28911 @end table
28912 @end deftp
28913
28914 Note that by default the VM image is volatile, i.e., once stopped the
28915 contents are lost. If you want a stateful image instead, override the
28916 configuration's @code{image} and @code{options} without
28917 the @code{--snapshot} flag using something along these lines:
28918
28919 @lisp
28920 (service hurd-vm-service-type
28921 (hurd-vm-configuration
28922 (image (const "/out/of/store/writable/hurd.img"))
28923 (options '())))
28924 @end lisp
28925
28926 @subsubheading Ganeti
28927
28928 @cindex ganeti
28929
28930 @quotation Note
28931 This service is considered experimental. Configuration options may be changed
28932 in a backwards-incompatible manner, and not all features have been thorougly
28933 tested. Users of this service are encouraged to share their experience at
28934 @email{guix-devel@@gnu.org}.
28935 @end quotation
28936
28937 Ganeti is a virtual machine management system. It is designed to keep virtual
28938 machines running on a cluster of servers even in the event of hardware failures,
28939 and to make maintenance and recovery tasks easy. It consists of multiple
28940 services which are described later in this section. In addition to the Ganeti
28941 service, you will need the OpenSSH service (@pxref{Networking Services,
28942 @code{openssh-service-type}}), and update the @file{/etc/hosts} file
28943 (@pxref{operating-system Reference, @code{hosts-file}}) with the cluster name
28944 and address (or use a DNS server).
28945
28946 All nodes participating in a Ganeti cluster should have the same Ganeti and
28947 @file{/etc/hosts} configuration. Here is an example configuration for a Ganeti
28948 cluster node that supports multiple storage backends, and installs the
28949 @code{debootstrap} and @code{guix} @dfn{OS providers}:
28950
28951 @lisp
28952 (use-package-modules virtualization)
28953 (use-service-modules base ganeti networking ssh)
28954 (operating-system
28955 ;; @dots{}
28956 (host-name "node1")
28957 (hosts-file (plain-file "hosts" (format #f "
28958 127.0.0.1 localhost
28959 ::1 localhost
28960
28961 192.168.1.200 ganeti.example.com
28962 192.168.1.201 node1.example.com node1
28963 192.168.1.202 node2.example.com node2
28964 ")))
28965
28966 ;; Install QEMU so we can use KVM-based instances, and LVM, DRBD and Ceph
28967 ;; in order to use the "plain", "drbd" and "rbd" storage backends.
28968 (packages (append (map specification->package
28969 '("qemu" "lvm2" "drbd-utils" "ceph"
28970 ;; Add the debootstrap and guix OS providers.
28971 "ganeti-instance-guix" "ganeti-instance-debootstrap"))
28972 %base-packages))
28973 (services
28974 (append (list (static-networking-service "eth0" "192.168.1.201"
28975 #:netmask "255.255.255.0"
28976 #:gateway "192.168.1.254"
28977 #:name-servers '("192.168.1.252"
28978 "192.168.1.253"))
28979
28980 ;; Ganeti uses SSH to communicate between nodes.
28981 (service openssh-service-type
28982 (openssh-configuration
28983 (permit-root-login 'without-password)))
28984
28985 (service ganeti-service-type
28986 (ganeti-configuration
28987 ;; This list specifies allowed file system paths
28988 ;; for storing virtual machine images.
28989 (file-storage-paths '("/srv/ganeti/file-storage"))
28990 ;; This variable configures a single "variant" for
28991 ;; both Debootstrap and Guix that works with KVM.
28992 (os %default-ganeti-os))))
28993 %base-services)))
28994 @end lisp
28995
28996 Users are advised to read the
28997 @url{http://docs.ganeti.org/ganeti/master/html/admin.html,Ganeti
28998 administrators guide} to learn about the various cluster options and
28999 day-to-day operations. There is also a
29000 @url{https://guix.gnu.org/blog/2020/running-a-ganeti-cluster-on-guix/,blog post}
29001 describing how to configure and initialize a small cluster.
29002
29003 @defvr {Scheme Variable} ganeti-service-type
29004 This is a service type that includes all the various services that Ganeti
29005 nodes should run.
29006
29007 Its value is a @code{ganeti-configuration} object that defines the package
29008 to use for CLI operations, as well as configuration for the various daemons.
29009 Allowed file storage paths and available guest operating systems are also
29010 configured through this data type.
29011 @end defvr
29012
29013 @deftp {Data Type} ganeti-configuration
29014 The @code{ganeti} service takes the following configuration options:
29015
29016 @table @asis
29017 @item @code{ganeti} (default: @code{ganeti})
29018 The @code{ganeti} package to use. It will be installed to the system profile
29019 and make @command{gnt-cluster}, @command{gnt-instance}, etc available. Note
29020 that the value specified here does not affect the other services as each refer
29021 to a specific @code{ganeti} package (see below).
29022
29023 @item @code{noded-configuration} (default: @code{(ganeti-noded-configuration)})
29024 @itemx @code{confd-configuration} (default: @code{(ganeti-confd-configuration)})
29025 @itemx @code{wconfd-configuration} (default: @code{(ganeti-wconfd-configuration)})
29026 @itemx @code{luxid-configuration} (default: @code{(ganeti-luxid-configuration)})
29027 @itemx @code{rapi-configuration} (default: @code{(ganeti-rapi-configuration)})
29028 @itemx @code{kvmd-configuration} (default: @code{(ganeti-kvmd-configuration)})
29029 @itemx @code{mond-configuration} (default: @code{(ganeti-mond-configuration)})
29030 @itemx @code{metad-configuration} (default: @code{(ganeti-metad-configuration)})
29031 @itemx @code{watcher-configuration} (default: @code{(ganeti-watcher-configuration)})
29032 @itemx @code{cleaner-configuration} (default: @code{(ganeti-cleaner-configuration)})
29033
29034 These options control the various daemons and cron jobs that are distributed
29035 with Ganeti. The possible values for these are described in detail below.
29036 To override a setting, you must use the configuration type for that service:
29037
29038 @lisp
29039 (service ganeti-service-type
29040 (ganeti-configuration
29041 (rapi-configuration
29042 (ganeti-rapi-configuration
29043 (interface "eth1"))))
29044 (watcher-configuration
29045 (ganeti-watcher-configuration
29046 (rapi-ip "10.0.0.1"))))
29047 @end lisp
29048
29049 @item @code{file-storage-paths} (default: @code{'()})
29050 List of allowed directories for file storage backend.
29051
29052 @item @code{os} (default: @code{%default-ganeti-os})
29053 List of @code{<ganeti-os>} records.
29054 @end table
29055
29056 In essence @code{ganeti-service-type} is shorthand for declaring each service
29057 individually:
29058
29059 @lisp
29060 (service ganeti-noded-service-type)
29061 (service ganeti-confd-service-type)
29062 (service ganeti-wconfd-service-type)
29063 (service ganeti-luxid-service-type)
29064 (service ganeti-kvmd-service-type)
29065 (service ganeti-mond-service-type)
29066 (service ganeti-metad-service-type)
29067 (service ganeti-watcher-service-type)
29068 (service ganeti-cleaner-service-type)
29069 @end lisp
29070
29071 Plus a service extension for @code{etc-service-type} that configures the file
29072 storage backend and OS variants.
29073
29074 @end deftp
29075
29076 @deftp {Data Type} ganeti-os
29077 This data type is suitable for passing to the @code{os} parameter of
29078 @code{ganeti-configuration}. It takes the following parameters:
29079
29080 @table @asis
29081 @item @code{name}
29082 The name for this OS provider. It is only used to specify where the
29083 configuration ends up. Setting it to ``debootstrap'' will create
29084 @file{/etc/ganeti/instance-debootstrap}.
29085
29086 @item @code{extension}
29087 The file extension for variants of this OS type. For example
29088 @file{.conf} or @file{.scm}.
29089
29090 @item @code{variants} (default: @code{'()})
29091 List of @code{ganeti-os-variant} objects for this OS.
29092
29093 @end table
29094 @end deftp
29095
29096 @deftp {Data Type} ganeti-os-variant
29097 This is the data type for a Ganeti OS variant. It takes the following
29098 parameters:
29099
29100 @table @asis
29101 @item @code{name}
29102 The name of this variant.
29103
29104 @item @code{configuration}
29105 A configuration file for this variant.
29106 @end table
29107 @end deftp
29108
29109 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %default-debootstrap-hooks
29110 This variable contains hooks to configure networking and the GRUB bootloader.
29111 @end defvr
29112
29113 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %default-debootstrap-extra-pkgs
29114 This variable contains a list of packages suitable for a fully-virtualized guest.
29115 @end defvr
29116
29117 @deftp {Data Type} debootstrap-configuration
29118
29119 This data type creates configuration files suitable for the debootstrap OS provider.
29120
29121 @table @asis
29122 @item @code{hooks} (default: @code{%default-debootstrap-hooks})
29123 When not @code{#f}, this must be a G-expression that specifies a directory with
29124 scripts that will run when the OS is installed. It can also be a list of
29125 @code{(name . file-like)} pairs. For example:
29126
29127 @lisp
29128 `((99-hello-world . ,(plain-file "#!/bin/sh\necho Hello, World")))
29129 @end lisp
29130
29131 That will create a directory with one executable named @code{99-hello-world}
29132 and run it every time this variant is installed. If set to @code{#f}, hooks
29133 in @file{/etc/ganeti/instance-debootstrap/hooks} will be used, if any.
29134 @item @code{proxy} (default: @code{#f})
29135 Optional HTTP proxy to use.
29136 @item @code{mirror} (default: @code{#f})
29137 The Debian mirror. Typically something like @code{http://ftp.no.debian.org/debian}.
29138 The default varies depending on the distribution.
29139 @item @code{arch} (default: @code{#f})
29140 The dpkg architecture. Set to @code{armhf} to debootstrap an ARMv7 instance
29141 on an AArch64 host. Default is to use the current system architecture.
29142 @item @code{suite} (default: @code{"stable"})
29143 When set, this must be a Debian distribution ``suite'' such as @code{buster}
29144 or @code{focal}. If set to @code{#f}, the default for the OS provider is used.
29145 @item @code{extra-pkgs} (default: @code{%default-debootstrap-extra-pkgs})
29146 List of extra packages that will get installed by dpkg in addition
29147 to the minimal system.
29148 @item @code{components} (default: @code{#f})
29149 When set, must be a list of Debian repository ``components''. For example
29150 @code{'("main" "contrib")}.
29151 @item @code{generate-cache?} (default: @code{#t})
29152 Whether to automatically cache the generated debootstrap archive.
29153 @item @code{clean-cache} (default: @code{14})
29154 Discard the cache after this amount of days. Use @code{#f} to never
29155 clear the cache.
29156 @item @code{partition-style} (default: @code{'msdos})
29157 The type of partition to create. When set, it must be one of
29158 @code{'msdos}, @code{'none} or a string.
29159 @item @code{partition-alignment} (default: @code{2048})
29160 Alignment of the partition in sectors.
29161 @end table
29162 @end deftp
29163
29164 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} debootstrap-variant @var{name} @var{configuration}
29165 This is a helper procedure that creates a @code{ganeti-os-variant} record. It
29166 takes two parameters: a name and a @code{debootstrap-configuration} object.
29167 @end deffn
29168
29169 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} debootstrap-os @var{variants}@dots{}
29170 This is a helper procedure that creates a @code{ganeti-os} record. It takes
29171 a list of variants created with @code{debootstrap-variant}.
29172 @end deffn
29173
29174 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} guix-variant @var{name} @var{configuration}
29175 This is a helper procedure that creates a @code{ganeti-os-variant} record for
29176 use with the Guix OS provider. It takes a name and a G-expression that returns
29177 a ``file-like'' (@pxref{G-Expressions, file-like objects}) object containing a
29178 Guix System configuration.
29179 @end deffn
29180
29181 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} guix-os @var{variants}@dots{}
29182 This is a helper procedure that creates a @code{ganeti-os} record. It
29183 takes a list of variants produced by @code{guix-variant}.
29184 @end deffn
29185
29186 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %default-debootstrap-variants
29187 This is a convenience variable to make the debootstrap provider work
29188 ``out of the box'' without users having to declare variants manually. It
29189 contains a single debootstrap variant with the default configuration:
29190
29191 @lisp
29192 (list (debootstrap-variant
29193 "default"
29194 (debootstrap-configuration)))
29195 @end lisp
29196 @end defvr
29197
29198 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %default-guix-variants
29199 This is a convenience variable to make the Guix OS provider work without
29200 additional configuration. It creates a virtual machine that has an SSH
29201 server, a serial console, and authorizes the Ganeti hosts SSH keys.
29202
29203 @lisp
29204 (list (guix-variant
29205 "default"
29206 (file-append ganeti-instance-guix
29207 "/share/doc/ganeti-instance-guix/examples/dynamic.scm")))
29208 @end lisp
29209 @end defvr
29210
29211 Users can implement support for OS providers unbeknownst to Guix by extending
29212 the @code{ganeti-os} and @code{ganeti-os-variant} records appropriately.
29213 For example:
29214
29215 @lisp
29216 (ganeti-os
29217 (name "custom")
29218 (extension ".conf")
29219 (variants
29220 (list (ganeti-os-variant
29221 (name "foo")
29222 (configuration (plain-file "bar" "this is fine"))))))
29223 @end lisp
29224
29225 That creates @file{/etc/ganeti/instance-custom/variants/foo.conf} which points
29226 to a file in the store with contents @code{this is fine}. It also creates
29227 @file{/etc/ganeti/instance-custom/variants/variants.list} with contents @code{foo}.
29228
29229 Obviously this may not work for all OS providers out there. If you find the
29230 interface limiting, please reach out to @email{guix-devel@@gnu.org}.
29231
29232 The rest of this section documents the various services that are included by
29233 @code{ganeti-service-type}.
29234
29235 @defvr {Scheme Variable} ganeti-noded-service-type
29236 @command{ganeti-noded} is the daemon responsible for node-specific functions
29237 within the Ganeti system. The value of this service must be a
29238 @code{ganeti-noded-configuration} object.
29239 @end defvr
29240
29241 @deftp {Data Type} ganeti-noded-configuration
29242 This is the configuration for the @code{ganeti-noded} service.
29243
29244 @table @asis
29245 @item @code{ganeti} (default: @code{ganeti})
29246 The @code{ganeti} package to use for this service.
29247
29248 @item @code{port} (default: @code{1811})
29249 The TCP port on which the node daemon listens for network requests.
29250
29251 @item @code{address} (default: @code{"0.0.0.0"})
29252 The network address that the daemon will bind to. The default address means
29253 bind to all available addresses.
29254
29255 @item @code{interface} (default: @code{#f})
29256 When this is set, it must be a specific network interface (e.g.@: @code{eth0})
29257 that the daemon will bind to.
29258
29259 @item @code{max-clients} (default: @code{20})
29260 This sets a limit on the maximum number of simultaneous client connections
29261 that the daemon will handle. Connections above this count are accepted, but
29262 no responses will be sent until enough connections have closed.
29263
29264 @item @code{ssl?} (default: @code{#t})
29265 Whether to use SSL/TLS to encrypt network communications. The certificate
29266 is automatically provisioned by the cluster and can be rotated with
29267 @command{gnt-cluster renew-crypto}.
29268
29269 @item @code{ssl-key} (default: @file{"/var/lib/ganeti/server.pem"})
29270 This can be used to provide a specific encryption key for TLS communications.
29271
29272 @item @code{ssl-cert} (default: @file{"/var/lib/ganeti/server.pem"})
29273 This can be used to provide a specific certificate for TLS communications.
29274
29275 @item @code{debug?} (default: @code{#f})
29276 When true, the daemon performs additional logging for debugging purposes.
29277 Note that this will leak encryption details to the log files, use with caution.
29278
29279 @end table
29280 @end deftp
29281
29282 @defvr {Scheme Variable} ganeti-confd-service-type
29283 @command{ganeti-confd} answers queries related to the configuration of a
29284 Ganeti cluster. The purpose of this daemon is to have a highly available
29285 and fast way to query cluster configuration values. It is automatically
29286 active on all @dfn{master candidates}. The value of this service must be a
29287 @code{ganeti-confd-configuration} object.
29288
29289 @end defvr
29290
29291 @deftp {Data Type} ganeti-confd-configuration
29292 This is the configuration for the @code{ganeti-confd} service.
29293
29294 @table @asis
29295 @item @code{ganeti} (default: @code{ganeti})
29296 The @code{ganeti} package to use for this service.
29297
29298 @item @code{port} (default: @code{1814})
29299 The UDP port on which to listen for network requests.
29300
29301 @item @code{address} (default: @code{"0.0.0.0"})
29302 Network address that the daemon will bind to.
29303
29304 @item @code{debug?} (default: @code{#f})
29305 When true, the daemon performs additional logging for debugging purposes.
29306
29307 @end table
29308 @end deftp
29309
29310 @defvr {Scheme Variable} ganeti-wconfd-service-type
29311 @command{ganeti-wconfd} is the daemon that has authoritative knowledge
29312 about the cluster configuration and is the only entity that can accept
29313 changes to it. All jobs that need to modify the configuration will do so
29314 by sending appropriate requests to this daemon. It only runs on the
29315 @dfn{master node} and will automatically disable itself on other nodes.
29316
29317 The value of this service must be a
29318 @code{ganeti-wconfd-configuration} object.
29319 @end defvr
29320
29321 @deftp {Data Type} ganeti-wconfd-configuration
29322 This is the configuration for the @code{ganeti-wconfd} service.
29323
29324 @table @asis
29325 @item @code{ganeti} (default: @code{ganeti})
29326 The @code{ganeti} package to use for this service.
29327
29328 @item @code{no-voting?} (default: @code{#f})
29329 The daemon will refuse to start if the majority of cluster nodes does not
29330 agree that it is running on the master node. Set to @code{#t} to start
29331 even if a quorum can not be reached (dangerous, use with caution).
29332
29333 @item @code{debug?} (default: @code{#f})
29334 When true, the daemon performs additional logging for debugging purposes.
29335
29336 @end table
29337 @end deftp
29338
29339 @defvr {Scheme Variable} ganeti-luxid-service-type
29340 @command{ganeti-luxid} is a daemon used to answer queries related to the
29341 configuration and the current live state of a Ganeti cluster. Additionally,
29342 it is the authoritative daemon for the Ganeti job queue. Jobs can be
29343 submitted via this daemon and it schedules and starts them.
29344
29345 It takes a @code{ganeti-luxid-configuration} object.
29346 @end defvr
29347
29348 @deftp {Data Type} ganeti-luxid-configuration
29349 This is the configuration for the @code{ganeti-wconfd} service.
29350
29351 @table @asis
29352 @item @code{ganeti} (default: @code{ganeti})
29353 The @code{ganeti} package to use for this service.
29354
29355 @item @code{no-voting?} (default: @code{#f})
29356 The daemon will refuse to start if it cannot verify that the majority of
29357 cluster nodes believes that it is running on the master node. Set to
29358 @code{#t} to ignore such checks and start anyway (this can be dangerous).
29359
29360 @item @code{debug?} (default: @code{#f})
29361 When true, the daemon performs additional logging for debugging purposes.
29362
29363 @end table
29364 @end deftp
29365
29366 @defvr {Scheme Variable} ganeti-rapi-service-type
29367 @command{ganeti-rapi} provides a remote API for Ganeti clusters. It runs on
29368 the master node and can be used to perform cluster actions programmatically
29369 via a JSON-based RPC protocol.
29370
29371 Most query operations are allowed without authentication (unless
29372 @var{require-authentication?} is set), whereas write operations require
29373 explicit authorization via the @file{/var/lib/ganeti/rapi/users} file. See
29374 the @url{http://docs.ganeti.org/ganeti/master/html/rapi.html, Ganeti Remote
29375 API documentation} for more information.
29376
29377 The value of this service must be a @code{ganeti-rapi-configuration} object.
29378 @end defvr
29379
29380 @deftp {Data Type} ganeti-rapi-configuration
29381 This is the configuration for the @code{ganeti-rapi} service.
29382
29383 @table @asis
29384 @item @code{ganeti} (default: @code{ganeti})
29385 The @code{ganeti} package to use for this service.
29386
29387 @item @code{require-authentication?} (default: @code{#f})
29388 Whether to require authentication even for read-only operations.
29389
29390 @item @code{port} (default: @code{5080})
29391 The TCP port on which to listen to API requests.
29392
29393 @item @code{address} (default: @code{"0.0.0.0"})
29394 The network address that the service will bind to. By default it listens
29395 on all configured addresses.
29396
29397 @item @code{interface} (default: @code{#f})
29398 When set, it must specify a specific network interface such as @code{eth0}
29399 that the daemon will bind to.
29400
29401 @item @code{max-clients} (default: @code{20})
29402 The maximum number of simultaneous client requests to handle. Further
29403 connections are allowed, but no responses are sent until enough connections
29404 have closed.
29405
29406 @item @code{ssl?} (default: @code{#t})
29407 Whether to use SSL/TLS encryption on the RAPI port.
29408
29409 @item @code{ssl-key} (default: @file{"/var/lib/ganeti/server.pem"})
29410 This can be used to provide a specific encryption key for TLS communications.
29411
29412 @item @code{ssl-cert} (default: @file{"/var/lib/ganeti/server.pem"})
29413 This can be used to provide a specific certificate for TLS communications.
29414
29415 @item @code{debug?} (default: @code{#f})
29416 When true, the daemon performs additional logging for debugging purposes.
29417 Note that this will leak encryption details to the log files, use with caution.
29418
29419 @end table
29420 @end deftp
29421
29422 @defvr {Scheme Variable} ganeti-kvmd-service-type
29423 @command{ganeti-kvmd} is responsible for determining whether a given KVM
29424 instance was shut down by an administrator or a user. Normally Ganeti will
29425 restart an instance that was not stopped through Ganeti itself. If the
29426 cluster option @code{user_shutdown} is true, this daemon monitors the
29427 @code{QMP} socket provided by QEMU and listens for shutdown events, and
29428 marks the instance as @dfn{USER_down} instead of @dfn{ERROR_down} when
29429 it shuts down gracefully by itself.
29430
29431 It takes a @code{ganeti-kvmd-configuration} object.
29432 @end defvr
29433
29434 @deftp {Data Type} ganeti-kvmd-configuration
29435
29436 @table @asis
29437 @item @code{ganeti} (default: @code{ganeti})
29438 The @code{ganeti} package to use for this service.
29439
29440 @item @code{debug?} (default: @code{#f})
29441 When true, the daemon performs additional logging for debugging purposes.
29442
29443 @end table
29444 @end deftp
29445
29446 @defvr {Scheme Variable} ganeti-mond-service-type
29447 @command{ganeti-mond} is an optional daemon that provides Ganeti monitoring
29448 functionality. It is responsible for running data collectors and publish the
29449 collected information through a HTTP interface.
29450
29451 It takes a @code{ganeti-mond-configuration} object.
29452 @end defvr
29453
29454 @deftp {Data Type} ganeti-mond-configuration
29455
29456 @table @asis
29457 @item @code{ganeti} (default: @code{ganeti})
29458 The @code{ganeti} package to use for this service.
29459
29460 @item @code{port} (default: @code{1815})
29461 The port on which the daemon will listen.
29462
29463 @item @code{address} (default: @code{"0.0.0.0"})
29464 The network address that the daemon will bind to. By default it binds to all
29465 available interfaces.
29466
29467 @item @code{debug?} (default: @code{#f})
29468 When true, the daemon performs additional logging for debugging purposes.
29469
29470 @end table
29471 @end deftp
29472
29473 @defvr {Scheme Variable} ganeti-metad-service-type
29474 @command{ganeti-metad} is an optional daemon that can be used to provide
29475 information about the cluster to instances or OS install scripts.
29476
29477 It takes a @code{ganeti-metad-configuration} object.
29478 @end defvr
29479
29480 @deftp {Data Type} ganeti-metad-configuration
29481
29482 @table @asis
29483 @item @code{ganeti} (default: @code{ganeti})
29484 The @code{ganeti} package to use for this service.
29485
29486 @item @code{port} (default: @code{80})
29487 The port on which the daemon will listen.
29488
29489 @item @code{address} (default: @code{#f})
29490 If set, the daemon will bind to this address only. If left unset, the behavior
29491 depends on the cluster configuration.
29492
29493 @item @code{debug?} (default: @code{#f})
29494 When true, the daemon performs additional logging for debugging purposes.
29495
29496 @end table
29497 @end deftp
29498
29499 @defvr {Scheme Variable} ganeti-watcher-service-type
29500 @command{ganeti-watcher} is a script designed to run periodically and ensure
29501 the health of a cluster. It will automatically restart instances that have
29502 stopped without Ganeti's consent, and repairs DRBD links in case a node has
29503 rebooted. It also archives old cluster jobs and restarts Ganeti daemons
29504 that are not running. If the cluster parameter @code{ensure_node_health}
29505 is set, the watcher will also shutdown instances and DRBD devices if the
29506 node it is running on is declared offline by known master candidates.
29507
29508 It can be paused on all nodes with @command{gnt-cluster watcher pause}.
29509
29510 The service takes a @code{ganeti-watcher-configuration} object.
29511 @end defvr
29512
29513 @deftp {Data Type} ganeti-watcher-configuration
29514
29515 @table @asis
29516 @item @code{ganeti} (default: @code{ganeti})
29517 The @code{ganeti} package to use for this service.
29518
29519 @item @code{schedule} (default: @code{'(next-second-from (next-minute (range 0 60 5)))})
29520 How often to run the script. The default is every five minutes.
29521
29522 @item @code{rapi-ip} (default: @code{#f})
29523 This option needs to be specified only if the RAPI daemon is configured to use
29524 a particular interface or address. By default the cluster address is used.
29525
29526 @item @code{job-age} (default: @code{(* 6 3600)})
29527 Archive cluster jobs older than this age, specified in seconds. The default
29528 is 6 hours. This keeps @command{gnt-job list} manageable.
29529
29530 @item @code{verify-disks?} (default: @code{#t})
29531 If this is @code{#f}, the watcher will not try to repair broken DRBD links
29532 automatically. Administrators will need to use @command{gnt-cluster verify-disks}
29533 manually instead.
29534
29535 @item @code{debug?} (default: @code{#f})
29536 When @code{#t}, the script performs additional logging for debugging purposes.
29537
29538 @end table
29539 @end deftp
29540
29541 @defvr {Scheme Variable} ganeti-cleaner-service-type
29542 @command{ganeti-cleaner} is a script designed to run periodically and remove
29543 old files from the cluster. This service type controls two @dfn{cron jobs}:
29544 one intended for the master node that permanently purges old cluster jobs,
29545 and one intended for every node that removes expired X509 certificates, keys,
29546 and outdated @command{ganeti-watcher} information. Like all Ganeti services,
29547 it is safe to include even on non-master nodes as it will disable itself as
29548 necessary.
29549
29550 It takes a @code{ganeti-cleaner-configuration} object.
29551 @end defvr
29552
29553 @deftp {Data Type} ganeti-cleaner-configuration
29554
29555 @table @asis
29556 @item @code{ganeti} (default: @code{ganeti})
29557 The @code{ganeti} package to use for the @command{gnt-cleaner} command.
29558
29559 @item @code{master-schedule} (default: @code{"45 1 * * *"})
29560 How often to run the master cleaning job. The default is once per day, at
29561 01:45:00.
29562
29563 @item @code{node-schedule} (default: @code{"45 2 * * *"})
29564 How often to run the node cleaning job. The default is once per day, at
29565 02:45:00.
29566
29567 @end table
29568 @end deftp
29569
29570 @node Version Control Services
29571 @subsection Version Control Services
29572
29573 The @code{(gnu services version-control)} module provides a service to
29574 allow remote access to local Git repositories. There are three options:
29575 the @code{git-daemon-service}, which provides access to repositories via
29576 the @code{git://} unsecured TCP-based protocol, extending the
29577 @code{nginx} web server to proxy some requests to
29578 @code{git-http-backend}, or providing a web interface with
29579 @code{cgit-service-type}.
29580
29581 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} git-daemon-service [#:config (git-daemon-configuration)]
29582
29583 Return a service that runs @command{git daemon}, a simple TCP server to
29584 expose repositories over the Git protocol for anonymous access.
29585
29586 The optional @var{config} argument should be a
29587 @code{<git-daemon-configuration>} object, by default it allows read-only
29588 access to exported@footnote{By creating the magic file
29589 @file{git-daemon-export-ok} in the repository directory.} repositories under
29590 @file{/srv/git}.
29591
29592 @end deffn
29593
29594 @deftp {Data Type} git-daemon-configuration
29595 Data type representing the configuration for @code{git-daemon-service}.
29596
29597 @table @asis
29598 @item @code{package} (default: @code{git})
29599 Package object of the Git distributed version control system.
29600
29601 @item @code{export-all?} (default: @code{#f})
29602 Whether to allow access for all Git repositories, even if they do not
29603 have the @file{git-daemon-export-ok} file.
29604
29605 @item @code{base-path} (default: @file{/srv/git})
29606 Whether to remap all the path requests as relative to the given path.
29607 If you run @command{git daemon} with @code{(base-path "/srv/git")} on
29608 @samp{example.com}, then if you later try to pull
29609 @indicateurl{git://example.com/hello.git}, git daemon will interpret the
29610 path as @file{/srv/git/hello.git}.
29611
29612 @item @code{user-path} (default: @code{#f})
29613 Whether to allow @code{~user} notation to be used in requests. When
29614 specified with empty string, requests to
29615 @indicateurl{git://host/~alice/foo} is taken as a request to access
29616 @code{foo} repository in the home directory of user @code{alice}. If
29617 @code{(user-path "@var{path}")} is specified, the same request is taken
29618 as a request to access @file{@var{path}/foo} repository in the home
29619 directory of user @code{alice}.
29620
29621 @item @code{listen} (default: @code{'()})
29622 Whether to listen on specific IP addresses or hostnames, defaults to
29623 all.
29624
29625 @item @code{port} (default: @code{#f})
29626 Whether to listen on an alternative port, which defaults to 9418.
29627
29628 @item @code{whitelist} (default: @code{'()})
29629 If not empty, only allow access to this list of directories.
29630
29631 @item @code{extra-options} (default: @code{'()})
29632 Extra options will be passed to @command{git daemon}, please run
29633 @command{man git-daemon} for more information.
29634
29635 @end table
29636 @end deftp
29637
29638 The @code{git://} protocol lacks authentication. When you pull from a
29639 repository fetched via @code{git://}, you don't know whether the data you
29640 receive was modified or is even coming from the specified host, and your
29641 connection is subject to eavesdropping. It's better to use an authenticated
29642 and encrypted transport, such as @code{https}. Although Git allows you
29643 to serve repositories using unsophisticated file-based web servers,
29644 there is a faster protocol implemented by the @code{git-http-backend}
29645 program. This program is the back-end of a proper Git web service. It
29646 is designed to sit behind a FastCGI proxy. @xref{Web Services}, for more
29647 on running the necessary @code{fcgiwrap} daemon.
29648
29649 Guix has a separate configuration data type for serving Git repositories
29650 over HTTP.
29651
29652 @deftp {Data Type} git-http-configuration
29653 Data type representing the configuration for a future
29654 @code{git-http-service-type}; can currently be used to configure Nginx
29655 through @code{git-http-nginx-location-configuration}.
29656
29657 @table @asis
29658 @item @code{package} (default: @var{git})
29659 Package object of the Git distributed version control system.
29660
29661 @item @code{git-root} (default: @file{/srv/git})
29662 Directory containing the Git repositories to expose to the world.
29663
29664 @item @code{export-all?} (default: @code{#f})
29665 Whether to expose access for all Git repositories in @var{git-root},
29666 even if they do not have the @file{git-daemon-export-ok} file.
29667
29668 @item @code{uri-path} (default: @samp{/git/})
29669 Path prefix for Git access. With the default @samp{/git/} prefix, this
29670 will map @indicateurl{http://@var{server}/git/@var{repo}.git} to
29671 @file{/srv/git/@var{repo}.git}. Requests whose URI paths do not begin
29672 with this prefix are not passed on to this Git instance.
29673
29674 @item @code{fcgiwrap-socket} (default: @code{127.0.0.1:9000})
29675 The socket on which the @code{fcgiwrap} daemon is listening. @xref{Web
29676 Services}.
29677 @end table
29678 @end deftp
29679
29680 There is no @code{git-http-service-type}, currently; instead you can
29681 create an @code{nginx-location-configuration} from a
29682 @code{git-http-configuration} and then add that location to a web
29683 server.
29684
29685 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} git-http-nginx-location-configuration @
29686 [config=(git-http-configuration)]
29687 Compute an @code{nginx-location-configuration} that corresponds to the
29688 given Git http configuration. An example nginx service definition to
29689 serve the default @file{/srv/git} over HTTPS might be:
29690
29691 @lisp
29692 (service nginx-service-type
29693 (nginx-configuration
29694 (server-blocks
29695 (list
29696 (nginx-server-configuration
29697 (listen '("443 ssl"))
29698 (server-name "git.my-host.org")
29699 (ssl-certificate
29700 "/etc/letsencrypt/live/git.my-host.org/fullchain.pem")
29701 (ssl-certificate-key
29702 "/etc/letsencrypt/live/git.my-host.org/privkey.pem")
29703 (locations
29704 (list
29705 (git-http-nginx-location-configuration
29706 (git-http-configuration (uri-path "/"))))))))))
29707 @end lisp
29708
29709 This example assumes that you are using Let's Encrypt to get your TLS
29710 certificate. @xref{Certificate Services}. The default @code{certbot}
29711 service will redirect all HTTP traffic on @code{git.my-host.org} to
29712 HTTPS@. You will also need to add an @code{fcgiwrap} proxy to your
29713 system services. @xref{Web Services}.
29714 @end deffn
29715
29716 @subsubheading Cgit Service
29717
29718 @cindex Cgit service
29719 @cindex Git, web interface
29720 @uref{https://git.zx2c4.com/cgit/, Cgit} is a web frontend for Git
29721 repositories written in C.
29722
29723 The following example will configure the service with default values.
29724 By default, Cgit can be accessed on port 80 (@code{http://localhost:80}).
29725
29726 @lisp
29727 (service cgit-service-type)
29728 @end lisp
29729
29730 The @code{file-object} type designates either a file-like object
29731 (@pxref{G-Expressions, file-like objects}) or a string.
29732
29733 @c %start of fragment
29734
29735 Available @code{cgit-configuration} fields are:
29736
29737 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} package package
29738 The CGIT package.
29739
29740 @end deftypevr
29741
29742 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} nginx-server-configuration-list nginx
29743 NGINX configuration.
29744
29745 @end deftypevr
29746
29747 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} file-object about-filter
29748 Specifies a command which will be invoked to format the content of about
29749 pages (both top-level and for each repository).
29750
29751 Defaults to @samp{""}.
29752
29753 @end deftypevr
29754
29755 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string agefile
29756 Specifies a path, relative to each repository path, which can be used to
29757 specify the date and time of the youngest commit in the repository.
29758
29759 Defaults to @samp{""}.
29760
29761 @end deftypevr
29762
29763 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} file-object auth-filter
29764 Specifies a command that will be invoked for authenticating repository
29765 access.
29766
29767 Defaults to @samp{""}.
29768
29769 @end deftypevr
29770
29771 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string branch-sort
29772 Flag which, when set to @samp{age}, enables date ordering in the branch
29773 ref list, and when set @samp{name} enables ordering by branch name.
29774
29775 Defaults to @samp{"name"}.
29776
29777 @end deftypevr
29778
29779 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string cache-root
29780 Path used to store the cgit cache entries.
29781
29782 Defaults to @samp{"/var/cache/cgit"}.
29783
29784 @end deftypevr
29785
29786 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer cache-static-ttl
29787 Number which specifies the time-to-live, in minutes, for the cached
29788 version of repository pages accessed with a fixed SHA1.
29789
29790 Defaults to @samp{-1}.
29791
29792 @end deftypevr
29793
29794 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer cache-dynamic-ttl
29795 Number which specifies the time-to-live, in minutes, for the cached
29796 version of repository pages accessed without a fixed SHA1.
29797
29798 Defaults to @samp{5}.
29799
29800 @end deftypevr
29801
29802 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer cache-repo-ttl
29803 Number which specifies the time-to-live, in minutes, for the cached
29804 version of the repository summary page.
29805
29806 Defaults to @samp{5}.
29807
29808 @end deftypevr
29809
29810 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer cache-root-ttl
29811 Number which specifies the time-to-live, in minutes, for the cached
29812 version of the repository index page.
29813
29814 Defaults to @samp{5}.
29815
29816 @end deftypevr
29817
29818 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer cache-scanrc-ttl
29819 Number which specifies the time-to-live, in minutes, for the result of
29820 scanning a path for Git repositories.
29821
29822 Defaults to @samp{15}.
29823
29824 @end deftypevr
29825
29826 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer cache-about-ttl
29827 Number which specifies the time-to-live, in minutes, for the cached
29828 version of the repository about page.
29829
29830 Defaults to @samp{15}.
29831
29832 @end deftypevr
29833
29834 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer cache-snapshot-ttl
29835 Number which specifies the time-to-live, in minutes, for the cached
29836 version of snapshots.
29837
29838 Defaults to @samp{5}.
29839
29840 @end deftypevr
29841
29842 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer cache-size
29843 The maximum number of entries in the cgit cache. When set to @samp{0},
29844 caching is disabled.
29845
29846 Defaults to @samp{0}.
29847
29848 @end deftypevr
29849
29850 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean case-sensitive-sort?
29851 Sort items in the repo list case sensitively.
29852
29853 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
29854
29855 @end deftypevr
29856
29857 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} list clone-prefix
29858 List of common prefixes which, when combined with a repository URL,
29859 generates valid clone URLs for the repository.
29860
29861 Defaults to @samp{()}.
29862
29863 @end deftypevr
29864
29865 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} list clone-url
29866 List of @code{clone-url} templates.
29867
29868 Defaults to @samp{()}.
29869
29870 @end deftypevr
29871
29872 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} file-object commit-filter
29873 Command which will be invoked to format commit messages.
29874
29875 Defaults to @samp{""}.
29876
29877 @end deftypevr
29878
29879 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string commit-sort
29880 Flag which, when set to @samp{date}, enables strict date ordering in the
29881 commit log, and when set to @samp{topo} enables strict topological
29882 ordering.
29883
29884 Defaults to @samp{"git log"}.
29885
29886 @end deftypevr
29887
29888 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} file-object css
29889 URL which specifies the css document to include in all cgit pages.
29890
29891 Defaults to @samp{"/share/cgit/cgit.css"}.
29892
29893 @end deftypevr
29894
29895 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} file-object email-filter
29896 Specifies a command which will be invoked to format names and email
29897 address of committers, authors, and taggers, as represented in various
29898 places throughout the cgit interface.
29899
29900 Defaults to @samp{""}.
29901
29902 @end deftypevr
29903
29904 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean embedded?
29905 Flag which, when set to @samp{#t}, will make cgit generate a HTML
29906 fragment suitable for embedding in other HTML pages.
29907
29908 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
29909
29910 @end deftypevr
29911
29912 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean enable-commit-graph?
29913 Flag which, when set to @samp{#t}, will make cgit print an ASCII-art
29914 commit history graph to the left of the commit messages in the
29915 repository log page.
29916
29917 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
29918
29919 @end deftypevr
29920
29921 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean enable-filter-overrides?
29922 Flag which, when set to @samp{#t}, allows all filter settings to be
29923 overridden in repository-specific cgitrc files.
29924
29925 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
29926
29927 @end deftypevr
29928
29929 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean enable-follow-links?
29930 Flag which, when set to @samp{#t}, allows users to follow a file in the
29931 log view.
29932
29933 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
29934
29935 @end deftypevr
29936
29937 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean enable-http-clone?
29938 If set to @samp{#t}, cgit will act as an dumb HTTP endpoint for Git
29939 clones.
29940
29941 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
29942
29943 @end deftypevr
29944
29945 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean enable-index-links?
29946 Flag which, when set to @samp{#t}, will make cgit generate extra links
29947 "summary", "commit", "tree" for each repo in the repository index.
29948
29949 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
29950
29951 @end deftypevr
29952
29953 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean enable-index-owner?
29954 Flag which, when set to @samp{#t}, will make cgit display the owner of
29955 each repo in the repository index.
29956
29957 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
29958
29959 @end deftypevr
29960
29961 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean enable-log-filecount?
29962 Flag which, when set to @samp{#t}, will make cgit print the number of
29963 modified files for each commit on the repository log page.
29964
29965 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
29966
29967 @end deftypevr
29968
29969 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean enable-log-linecount?
29970 Flag which, when set to @samp{#t}, will make cgit print the number of
29971 added and removed lines for each commit on the repository log page.
29972
29973 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
29974
29975 @end deftypevr
29976
29977 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean enable-remote-branches?
29978 Flag which, when set to @code{#t}, will make cgit display remote
29979 branches in the summary and refs views.
29980
29981 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
29982
29983 @end deftypevr
29984
29985 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean enable-subject-links?
29986 Flag which, when set to @code{1}, will make cgit use the subject of the
29987 parent commit as link text when generating links to parent commits in
29988 commit view.
29989
29990 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
29991
29992 @end deftypevr
29993
29994 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean enable-html-serving?
29995 Flag which, when set to @samp{#t}, will make cgit use the subject of the
29996 parent commit as link text when generating links to parent commits in
29997 commit view.
29998
29999 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
30000
30001 @end deftypevr
30002
30003 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean enable-tree-linenumbers?
30004 Flag which, when set to @samp{#t}, will make cgit generate linenumber
30005 links for plaintext blobs printed in the tree view.
30006
30007 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
30008
30009 @end deftypevr
30010
30011 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean enable-git-config?
30012 Flag which, when set to @samp{#f}, will allow cgit to use Git config to
30013 set any repo specific settings.
30014
30015 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
30016
30017 @end deftypevr
30018
30019 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} file-object favicon
30020 URL used as link to a shortcut icon for cgit.
30021
30022 Defaults to @samp{"/favicon.ico"}.
30023
30024 @end deftypevr
30025
30026 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string footer
30027 The content of the file specified with this option will be included
30028 verbatim at the bottom of all pages (i.e.@: it replaces the standard
30029 "generated by..."@: message).
30030
30031 Defaults to @samp{""}.
30032
30033 @end deftypevr
30034
30035 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string head-include
30036 The content of the file specified with this option will be included
30037 verbatim in the HTML HEAD section on all pages.
30038
30039 Defaults to @samp{""}.
30040
30041 @end deftypevr
30042
30043 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string header
30044 The content of the file specified with this option will be included
30045 verbatim at the top of all pages.
30046
30047 Defaults to @samp{""}.
30048
30049 @end deftypevr
30050
30051 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} file-object include
30052 Name of a configfile to include before the rest of the current config-
30053 file is parsed.
30054
30055 Defaults to @samp{""}.
30056
30057 @end deftypevr
30058
30059 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string index-header
30060 The content of the file specified with this option will be included
30061 verbatim above the repository index.
30062
30063 Defaults to @samp{""}.
30064
30065 @end deftypevr
30066
30067 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string index-info
30068 The content of the file specified with this option will be included
30069 verbatim below the heading on the repository index page.
30070
30071 Defaults to @samp{""}.
30072
30073 @end deftypevr
30074
30075 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean local-time?
30076 Flag which, if set to @samp{#t}, makes cgit print commit and tag times
30077 in the servers timezone.
30078
30079 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
30080
30081 @end deftypevr
30082
30083 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} file-object logo
30084 URL which specifies the source of an image which will be used as a logo
30085 on all cgit pages.
30086
30087 Defaults to @samp{"/share/cgit/cgit.png"}.
30088
30089 @end deftypevr
30090
30091 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string logo-link
30092 URL loaded when clicking on the cgit logo image.
30093
30094 Defaults to @samp{""}.
30095
30096 @end deftypevr
30097
30098 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} file-object owner-filter
30099 Command which will be invoked to format the Owner column of the main
30100 page.
30101
30102 Defaults to @samp{""}.
30103
30104 @end deftypevr
30105
30106 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer max-atom-items
30107 Number of items to display in atom feeds view.
30108
30109 Defaults to @samp{10}.
30110
30111 @end deftypevr
30112
30113 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer max-commit-count
30114 Number of entries to list per page in "log" view.
30115
30116 Defaults to @samp{50}.
30117
30118 @end deftypevr
30119
30120 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer max-message-length
30121 Number of commit message characters to display in "log" view.
30122
30123 Defaults to @samp{80}.
30124
30125 @end deftypevr
30126
30127 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer max-repo-count
30128 Specifies the number of entries to list per page on the repository index
30129 page.
30130
30131 Defaults to @samp{50}.
30132
30133 @end deftypevr
30134
30135 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer max-repodesc-length
30136 Specifies the maximum number of repo description characters to display
30137 on the repository index page.
30138
30139 Defaults to @samp{80}.
30140
30141 @end deftypevr
30142
30143 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer max-blob-size
30144 Specifies the maximum size of a blob to display HTML for in KBytes.
30145
30146 Defaults to @samp{0}.
30147
30148 @end deftypevr
30149
30150 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string max-stats
30151 Maximum statistics period. Valid values are @samp{week},@samp{month},
30152 @samp{quarter} and @samp{year}.
30153
30154 Defaults to @samp{""}.
30155
30156 @end deftypevr
30157
30158 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} mimetype-alist mimetype
30159 Mimetype for the specified filename extension.
30160
30161 Defaults to @samp{((gif "image/gif") (html "text/html") (jpg
30162 "image/jpeg") (jpeg "image/jpeg") (pdf "application/pdf") (png
30163 "image/png") (svg "image/svg+xml"))}.
30164
30165 @end deftypevr
30166
30167 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} file-object mimetype-file
30168 Specifies the file to use for automatic mimetype lookup.
30169
30170 Defaults to @samp{""}.
30171
30172 @end deftypevr
30173
30174 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string module-link
30175 Text which will be used as the formatstring for a hyperlink when a
30176 submodule is printed in a directory listing.
30177
30178 Defaults to @samp{""}.
30179
30180 @end deftypevr
30181
30182 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean nocache?
30183 If set to the value @samp{#t} caching will be disabled.
30184
30185 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
30186
30187 @end deftypevr
30188
30189 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean noplainemail?
30190 If set to @samp{#t} showing full author email addresses will be
30191 disabled.
30192
30193 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
30194
30195 @end deftypevr
30196
30197 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean noheader?
30198 Flag which, when set to @samp{#t}, will make cgit omit the standard
30199 header on all pages.
30200
30201 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
30202
30203 @end deftypevr
30204
30205 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} project-list project-list
30206 A list of subdirectories inside of @code{repository-directory}, relative
30207 to it, that should loaded as Git repositories. An empty list means that
30208 all subdirectories will be loaded.
30209
30210 Defaults to @samp{()}.
30211
30212 @end deftypevr
30213
30214 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} file-object readme
30215 Text which will be used as default value for @code{cgit-repo-readme}.
30216
30217 Defaults to @samp{""}.
30218
30219 @end deftypevr
30220
30221 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean remove-suffix?
30222 If set to @code{#t} and @code{repository-directory} is enabled, if any
30223 repositories are found with a suffix of @code{.git}, this suffix will be
30224 removed for the URL and name.
30225
30226 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
30227
30228 @end deftypevr
30229
30230 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer renamelimit
30231 Maximum number of files to consider when detecting renames.
30232
30233 Defaults to @samp{-1}.
30234
30235 @end deftypevr
30236
30237 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string repository-sort
30238 The way in which repositories in each section are sorted.
30239
30240 Defaults to @samp{""}.
30241
30242 @end deftypevr
30243
30244 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} robots-list robots
30245 Text used as content for the @code{robots} meta-tag.
30246
30247 Defaults to @samp{("noindex" "nofollow")}.
30248
30249 @end deftypevr
30250
30251 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string root-desc
30252 Text printed below the heading on the repository index page.
30253
30254 Defaults to @samp{"a fast webinterface for the git dscm"}.
30255
30256 @end deftypevr
30257
30258 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string root-readme
30259 The content of the file specified with this option will be included
30260 verbatim below the ``about'' link on the repository index page.
30261
30262 Defaults to @samp{""}.
30263
30264 @end deftypevr
30265
30266 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string root-title
30267 Text printed as heading on the repository index page.
30268
30269 Defaults to @samp{""}.
30270
30271 @end deftypevr
30272
30273 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean scan-hidden-path
30274 If set to @samp{#t} and repository-directory is enabled,
30275 repository-directory will recurse into directories whose name starts
30276 with a period. Otherwise, repository-directory will stay away from such
30277 directories, considered as ``hidden''. Note that this does not apply to
30278 the @file{.git} directory in non-bare repos.
30279
30280 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
30281
30282 @end deftypevr
30283
30284 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} list snapshots
30285 Text which specifies the default set of snapshot formats that cgit
30286 generates links for.
30287
30288 Defaults to @samp{()}.
30289
30290 @end deftypevr
30291
30292 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} repository-directory repository-directory
30293 Name of the directory to scan for repositories (represents
30294 @code{scan-path}).
30295
30296 Defaults to @samp{"/srv/git"}.
30297
30298 @end deftypevr
30299
30300 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string section
30301 The name of the current repository section - all repositories defined
30302 after this option will inherit the current section name.
30303
30304 Defaults to @samp{""}.
30305
30306 @end deftypevr
30307
30308 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string section-sort
30309 Flag which, when set to @samp{1}, will sort the sections on the
30310 repository listing by name.
30311
30312 Defaults to @samp{""}.
30313
30314 @end deftypevr
30315
30316 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer section-from-path
30317 A number which, if defined prior to repository-directory, specifies how
30318 many path elements from each repo path to use as a default section name.
30319
30320 Defaults to @samp{0}.
30321
30322 @end deftypevr
30323
30324 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean side-by-side-diffs?
30325 If set to @samp{#t} shows side-by-side diffs instead of unidiffs per
30326 default.
30327
30328 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
30329
30330 @end deftypevr
30331
30332 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} file-object source-filter
30333 Specifies a command which will be invoked to format plaintext blobs in
30334 the tree view.
30335
30336 Defaults to @samp{""}.
30337
30338 @end deftypevr
30339
30340 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer summary-branches
30341 Specifies the number of branches to display in the repository ``summary''
30342 view.
30343
30344 Defaults to @samp{10}.
30345
30346 @end deftypevr
30347
30348 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer summary-log
30349 Specifies the number of log entries to display in the repository
30350 ``summary'' view.
30351
30352 Defaults to @samp{10}.
30353
30354 @end deftypevr
30355
30356 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer summary-tags
30357 Specifies the number of tags to display in the repository ``summary''
30358 view.
30359
30360 Defaults to @samp{10}.
30361
30362 @end deftypevr
30363
30364 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string strict-export
30365 Filename which, if specified, needs to be present within the repository
30366 for cgit to allow access to that repository.
30367
30368 Defaults to @samp{""}.
30369
30370 @end deftypevr
30371
30372 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string virtual-root
30373 URL which, if specified, will be used as root for all cgit links.
30374
30375 Defaults to @samp{"/"}.
30376
30377 @end deftypevr
30378
30379 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} repository-cgit-configuration-list repositories
30380 A list of @dfn{cgit-repo} records to use with config.
30381
30382 Defaults to @samp{()}.
30383
30384 Available @code{repository-cgit-configuration} fields are:
30385
30386 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-list snapshots
30387 A mask of snapshot formats for this repo that cgit generates links for,
30388 restricted by the global @code{snapshots} setting.
30389
30390 Defaults to @samp{()}.
30391
30392 @end deftypevr
30393
30394 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-file-object source-filter
30395 Override the default @code{source-filter}.
30396
30397 Defaults to @samp{""}.
30398
30399 @end deftypevr
30400
30401 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-string url
30402 The relative URL used to access the repository.
30403
30404 Defaults to @samp{""}.
30405
30406 @end deftypevr
30407
30408 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-file-object about-filter
30409 Override the default @code{about-filter}.
30410
30411 Defaults to @samp{""}.
30412
30413 @end deftypevr
30414
30415 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-string branch-sort
30416 Flag which, when set to @samp{age}, enables date ordering in the branch
30417 ref list, and when set to @samp{name} enables ordering by branch name.
30418
30419 Defaults to @samp{""}.
30420
30421 @end deftypevr
30422
30423 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-list clone-url
30424 A list of URLs which can be used to clone repo.
30425
30426 Defaults to @samp{()}.
30427
30428 @end deftypevr
30429
30430 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-file-object commit-filter
30431 Override the default @code{commit-filter}.
30432
30433 Defaults to @samp{""}.
30434
30435 @end deftypevr
30436
30437 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-string commit-sort
30438 Flag which, when set to @samp{date}, enables strict date ordering in the
30439 commit log, and when set to @samp{topo} enables strict topological
30440 ordering.
30441
30442 Defaults to @samp{""}.
30443
30444 @end deftypevr
30445
30446 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-string defbranch
30447 The name of the default branch for this repository. If no such branch
30448 exists in the repository, the first branch name (when sorted) is used as
30449 default instead. By default branch pointed to by HEAD, or ``master'' if
30450 there is no suitable HEAD.
30451
30452 Defaults to @samp{""}.
30453
30454 @end deftypevr
30455
30456 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-string desc
30457 The value to show as repository description.
30458
30459 Defaults to @samp{""}.
30460
30461 @end deftypevr
30462
30463 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-string homepage
30464 The value to show as repository homepage.
30465
30466 Defaults to @samp{""}.
30467
30468 @end deftypevr
30469
30470 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-file-object email-filter
30471 Override the default @code{email-filter}.
30472
30473 Defaults to @samp{""}.
30474
30475 @end deftypevr
30476
30477 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} maybe-repo-boolean enable-commit-graph?
30478 A flag which can be used to disable the global setting
30479 @code{enable-commit-graph?}.
30480
30481 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
30482
30483 @end deftypevr
30484
30485 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} maybe-repo-boolean enable-log-filecount?
30486 A flag which can be used to disable the global setting
30487 @code{enable-log-filecount?}.
30488
30489 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
30490
30491 @end deftypevr
30492
30493 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} maybe-repo-boolean enable-log-linecount?
30494 A flag which can be used to disable the global setting
30495 @code{enable-log-linecount?}.
30496
30497 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
30498
30499 @end deftypevr
30500
30501 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} maybe-repo-boolean enable-remote-branches?
30502 Flag which, when set to @code{#t}, will make cgit display remote
30503 branches in the summary and refs views.
30504
30505 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
30506
30507 @end deftypevr
30508
30509 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} maybe-repo-boolean enable-subject-links?
30510 A flag which can be used to override the global setting
30511 @code{enable-subject-links?}.
30512
30513 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
30514
30515 @end deftypevr
30516
30517 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} maybe-repo-boolean enable-html-serving?
30518 A flag which can be used to override the global setting
30519 @code{enable-html-serving?}.
30520
30521 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
30522
30523 @end deftypevr
30524
30525 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-boolean hide?
30526 Flag which, when set to @code{#t}, hides the repository from the
30527 repository index.
30528
30529 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
30530
30531 @end deftypevr
30532
30533 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-boolean ignore?
30534 Flag which, when set to @samp{#t}, ignores the repository.
30535
30536 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
30537
30538 @end deftypevr
30539
30540 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-file-object logo
30541 URL which specifies the source of an image which will be used as a logo
30542 on this repo’s pages.
30543
30544 Defaults to @samp{""}.
30545
30546 @end deftypevr
30547
30548 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-string logo-link
30549 URL loaded when clicking on the cgit logo image.
30550
30551 Defaults to @samp{""}.
30552
30553 @end deftypevr
30554
30555 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-file-object owner-filter
30556 Override the default @code{owner-filter}.
30557
30558 Defaults to @samp{""}.
30559
30560 @end deftypevr
30561
30562 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-string module-link
30563 Text which will be used as the formatstring for a hyperlink when a
30564 submodule is printed in a directory listing. The arguments for the
30565 formatstring are the path and SHA1 of the submodule commit.
30566
30567 Defaults to @samp{""}.
30568
30569 @end deftypevr
30570
30571 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} module-link-path module-link-path
30572 Text which will be used as the formatstring for a hyperlink when a
30573 submodule with the specified subdirectory path is printed in a directory
30574 listing.
30575
30576 Defaults to @samp{()}.
30577
30578 @end deftypevr
30579
30580 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-string max-stats
30581 Override the default maximum statistics period.
30582
30583 Defaults to @samp{""}.
30584
30585 @end deftypevr
30586
30587 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-string name
30588 The value to show as repository name.
30589
30590 Defaults to @samp{""}.
30591
30592 @end deftypevr
30593
30594 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-string owner
30595 A value used to identify the owner of the repository.
30596
30597 Defaults to @samp{""}.
30598
30599 @end deftypevr
30600
30601 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-string path
30602 An absolute path to the repository directory.
30603
30604 Defaults to @samp{""}.
30605
30606 @end deftypevr
30607
30608 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-string readme
30609 A path (relative to repo) which specifies a file to include verbatim as
30610 the ``About'' page for this repo.
30611
30612 Defaults to @samp{""}.
30613
30614 @end deftypevr
30615
30616 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-string section
30617 The name of the current repository section - all repositories defined
30618 after this option will inherit the current section name.
30619
30620 Defaults to @samp{""}.
30621
30622 @end deftypevr
30623
30624 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-list extra-options
30625 Extra options will be appended to cgitrc file.
30626
30627 Defaults to @samp{()}.
30628
30629 @end deftypevr
30630
30631 @end deftypevr
30632
30633 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} list extra-options
30634 Extra options will be appended to cgitrc file.
30635
30636 Defaults to @samp{()}.
30637
30638 @end deftypevr
30639
30640
30641 @c %end of fragment
30642
30643 However, it could be that you just want to get a @code{cgitrc} up and
30644 running. In that case, you can pass an @code{opaque-cgit-configuration}
30645 as a record to @code{cgit-service-type}. As its name indicates, an
30646 opaque configuration does not have easy reflective capabilities.
30647
30648 Available @code{opaque-cgit-configuration} fields are:
30649
30650 @deftypevr {@code{opaque-cgit-configuration} parameter} package cgit
30651 The cgit package.
30652 @end deftypevr
30653
30654 @deftypevr {@code{opaque-cgit-configuration} parameter} string string
30655 The contents of the @code{cgitrc}, as a string.
30656 @end deftypevr
30657
30658 For example, if your @code{cgitrc} is just the empty string, you
30659 could instantiate a cgit service like this:
30660
30661 @lisp
30662 (service cgit-service-type
30663 (opaque-cgit-configuration
30664 (cgitrc "")))
30665 @end lisp
30666
30667 @subsubheading Gitolite Service
30668
30669 @cindex Gitolite service
30670 @cindex Git, hosting
30671 @uref{https://gitolite.com/gitolite/, Gitolite} is a tool for hosting Git
30672 repositories on a central server.
30673
30674 Gitolite can handle multiple repositories and users, and supports flexible
30675 configuration of the permissions for the users on the repositories.
30676
30677 The following example will configure Gitolite using the default @code{git}
30678 user, and the provided SSH public key.
30679
30680 @lisp
30681 (service gitolite-service-type
30682 (gitolite-configuration
30683 (admin-pubkey (plain-file
30684 "yourname.pub"
30685 "ssh-rsa AAAA... guix@@example.com"))))
30686 @end lisp
30687
30688 Gitolite is configured through a special admin repository which you can clone,
30689 for example, if you setup Gitolite on @code{example.com}, you would run the
30690 following command to clone the admin repository.
30691
30692 @example
30693 git clone git@@example.com:gitolite-admin
30694 @end example
30695
30696 When the Gitolite service is activated, the provided @code{admin-pubkey} will
30697 be inserted in to the @file{keydir} directory in the gitolite-admin
30698 repository. If this results in a change in the repository, it will be
30699 committed using the message ``gitolite setup by GNU Guix''.
30700
30701 @deftp {Data Type} gitolite-configuration
30702 Data type representing the configuration for @code{gitolite-service-type}.
30703
30704 @table @asis
30705 @item @code{package} (default: @var{gitolite})
30706 Gitolite package to use.
30707
30708 @item @code{user} (default: @var{git})
30709 User to use for Gitolite. This will be user that you use when accessing
30710 Gitolite over SSH.
30711
30712 @item @code{group} (default: @var{git})
30713 Group to use for Gitolite.
30714
30715 @item @code{home-directory} (default: @var{"/var/lib/gitolite"})
30716 Directory in which to store the Gitolite configuration and repositories.
30717
30718 @item @code{rc-file} (default: @var{(gitolite-rc-file)})
30719 A ``file-like'' object (@pxref{G-Expressions, file-like objects}),
30720 representing the configuration for Gitolite.
30721
30722 @item @code{admin-pubkey} (default: @var{#f})
30723 A ``file-like'' object (@pxref{G-Expressions, file-like objects}) used to
30724 setup Gitolite. This will be inserted in to the @file{keydir} directory
30725 within the gitolite-admin repository.
30726
30727 To specify the SSH key as a string, use the @code{plain-file} function.
30728
30729 @lisp
30730 (plain-file "yourname.pub" "ssh-rsa AAAA... guix@@example.com")
30731 @end lisp
30732
30733 @end table
30734 @end deftp
30735
30736 @deftp {Data Type} gitolite-rc-file
30737 Data type representing the Gitolite RC file.
30738
30739 @table @asis
30740 @item @code{umask} (default: @code{#o0077})
30741 This controls the permissions Gitolite sets on the repositories and their
30742 contents.
30743
30744 A value like @code{#o0027} will give read access to the group used by Gitolite
30745 (by default: @code{git}). This is necessary when using Gitolite with software
30746 like cgit or gitweb.
30747
30748 @item @code{git-config-keys} (default: @code{""})
30749 Gitolite allows you to set git config values using the @samp{config}
30750 keyword. This setting allows control over the config keys to accept.
30751
30752 @item @code{roles} (default: @code{'(("READERS" . 1) ("WRITERS" . ))})
30753 Set the role names allowed to be used by users running the perms command.
30754
30755 @item @code{enable} (default: @code{'("help" "desc" "info" "perms" "writable" "ssh-authkeys" "git-config" "daemon" "gitweb")})
30756 This setting controls the commands and features to enable within Gitolite.
30757
30758 @end table
30759 @end deftp
30760
30761
30762 @node Game Services
30763 @subsection Game Services
30764
30765 @subsubheading The Battle for Wesnoth Service
30766 @cindex wesnothd
30767 @uref{https://wesnoth.org, The Battle for Wesnoth} is a fantasy, turn
30768 based tactical strategy game, with several single player campaigns, and
30769 multiplayer games (both networked and local).
30770
30771 @defvar {Scheme Variable} wesnothd-service-type
30772 Service type for the wesnothd service. Its value must be a
30773 @code{wesnothd-configuration} object. To run wesnothd in the default
30774 configuration, instantiate it as:
30775
30776 @lisp
30777 (service wesnothd-service-type)
30778 @end lisp
30779 @end defvar
30780
30781 @deftp {Data Type} wesnothd-configuration
30782 Data type representing the configuration of @command{wesnothd}.
30783
30784 @table @asis
30785 @item @code{package} (default: @code{wesnoth-server})
30786 The wesnoth server package to use.
30787
30788 @item @code{port} (default: @code{15000})
30789 The port to bind the server to.
30790 @end table
30791 @end deftp
30792
30793
30794 @node PAM Mount Service
30795 @subsection PAM Mount Service
30796 @cindex pam-mount
30797
30798 The @code{(gnu services pam-mount)} module provides a service allowing
30799 users to mount volumes when they log in. It should be able to mount any
30800 volume format supported by the system.
30801
30802 @defvar {Scheme Variable} pam-mount-service-type
30803 Service type for PAM Mount support.
30804 @end defvar
30805
30806 @deftp {Data Type} pam-mount-configuration
30807 Data type representing the configuration of PAM Mount.
30808
30809 It takes the following parameters:
30810
30811 @table @asis
30812 @item @code{rules}
30813 The configuration rules that will be used to generate
30814 @file{/etc/security/pam_mount.conf.xml}.
30815
30816 The configuration rules are SXML elements (@pxref{SXML,,, guile, GNU
30817 Guile Reference Manual}), and the default ones don't mount anything for
30818 anyone at login:
30819
30820 @lisp
30821 `((debug (@@ (enable "0")))
30822 (mntoptions (@@ (allow ,(string-join
30823 '("nosuid" "nodev" "loop"
30824 "encryption" "fsck" "nonempty"
30825 "allow_root" "allow_other")
30826 ","))))
30827 (mntoptions (@@ (require "nosuid,nodev")))
30828 (logout (@@ (wait "0")
30829 (hup "0")
30830 (term "no")
30831 (kill "no")))
30832 (mkmountpoint (@@ (enable "1")
30833 (remove "true"))))
30834 @end lisp
30835
30836 Some @code{volume} elements must be added to automatically mount volumes
30837 at login. Here's an example allowing the user @code{alice} to mount her
30838 encrypted @env{HOME} directory and allowing the user @code{bob} to mount
30839 the partition where he stores his data:
30840
30841 @lisp
30842 (define pam-mount-rules
30843 `((debug (@@ (enable "0")))
30844 (volume (@@ (user "alice")
30845 (fstype "crypt")
30846 (path "/dev/sda2")
30847 (mountpoint "/home/alice")))
30848 (volume (@@ (user "bob")
30849 (fstype "auto")
30850 (path "/dev/sdb3")
30851 (mountpoint "/home/bob/data")
30852 (options "defaults,autodefrag,compress")))
30853 (mntoptions (@@ (allow ,(string-join
30854 '("nosuid" "nodev" "loop"
30855 "encryption" "fsck" "nonempty"
30856 "allow_root" "allow_other")
30857 ","))))
30858 (mntoptions (@@ (require "nosuid,nodev")))
30859 (logout (@@ (wait "0")
30860 (hup "0")
30861 (term "no")
30862 (kill "no")))
30863 (mkmountpoint (@@ (enable "1")
30864 (remove "true")))))
30865
30866 (service pam-mount-service-type
30867 (pam-mount-configuration
30868 (rules pam-mount-rules)))
30869 @end lisp
30870
30871 The complete list of possible options can be found in the man page for
30872 @uref{http://pam-mount.sourceforge.net/pam_mount.conf.5.html, pam_mount.conf}.
30873 @end table
30874 @end deftp
30875
30876
30877 @node Guix Services
30878 @subsection Guix Services
30879
30880 @subsubheading Guix Build Coordinator
30881 The @uref{https://git.cbaines.net/guix/build-coordinator/,Guix Build
30882 Coordinator} aids in distributing derivation builds among machines
30883 running an @dfn{agent}. The build daemon is still used to build the
30884 derivations, but the Guix Build Coordinator manages allocating builds
30885 and working with the results.
30886
30887 @quotation Note
30888 This service is considered experimental. Configuration options may be
30889 changed in a backwards-incompatible manner, and not all features have
30890 been thorougly tested.
30891 @end quotation
30892
30893 The Guix Build Coordinator consists of one @dfn{coordinator}, and one or
30894 more connected @dfn{agent} processes. The coordinator process handles
30895 clients submitting builds, and allocating builds to agents. The agent
30896 processes talk to a build daemon to actually perform the builds, then
30897 send the results back to the coordinator.
30898
30899 There is a script to run the coordinator component of the Guix Build
30900 Coordinator, but the Guix service uses a custom Guile script instead, to
30901 provide better integration with G-expressions used in the configuration.
30902
30903 @defvar {Scheme Variable} guix-build-coordinator-service-type
30904 Service type for the Guix Build Coordinator. Its value must be a
30905 @code{guix-build-coordinator-configuration} object.
30906 @end defvar
30907
30908 @deftp {Data Type} guix-build-coordinator-configuration
30909 Data type representing the configuration of the Guix Build Coordinator.
30910
30911 @table @asis
30912 @item @code{package} (default: @code{guix-build-coordinator})
30913 The Guix Build Coordinator package to use.
30914
30915 @item @code{user} (default: @code{"guix-build-coordinator"})
30916 The system user to run the service as.
30917
30918 @item @code{group} (default: @code{"guix-build-coordinator"})
30919 The system group to run the service as.
30920
30921 @item @code{database-uri-string} (default: @code{"sqlite:///var/lib/guix-build-coordinator/guix_build_coordinator.db"})
30922 The URI to use for the database.
30923
30924 @item @code{agent-communication-uri} (default: @code{"http://0.0.0.0:8745"})
30925 The URI describing how to listen to requests from agent processes.
30926
30927 @item @code{client-communication-uri} (default: @code{"http://127.0.0.1:8746"})
30928 The URI describing how to listen to requests from clients. The client
30929 API allows submitting builds and currently isn't authenticated, so take
30930 care when configuring this value.
30931
30932 @item @code{allocation-strategy} (default: @code{#~basic-build-allocation-strategy})
30933 A G-expression for the allocation strategy to be used. This is a
30934 procedure that takes the datastore as an argument and populates the
30935 allocation plan in the database.
30936
30937 @item @code{hooks} (default: @var{'()})
30938 An association list of hooks. These provide a way to execute arbitrary
30939 code upon certain events, like a build result being processed.
30940
30941 @item @code{guile} (default: @code{guile-3.0-latest})
30942 The Guile package with which to run the Guix Build Coordinator.
30943
30944 @end table
30945 @end deftp
30946
30947 @defvar {Scheme Variable} guix-build-coordinator-agent-service-type
30948 Service type for a Guix Build Coordinator agent. Its value must be a
30949 @code{guix-build-coordinator-agent-configuration} object.
30950 @end defvar
30951
30952 @deftp {Data Type} guix-build-coordinator-agent-configuration
30953 Data type representing the configuration a Guix Build Coordinator agent.
30954
30955 @table @asis
30956 @item @code{package} (default: @code{guix-build-coordinator})
30957 The Guix Build Coordinator package to use.
30958
30959 @item @code{user} (default: @code{"guix-build-coordinator-agent"})
30960 The system user to run the service as.
30961
30962 @item @code{coordinator} (default: @code{"http://localhost:8745"})
30963 The URI to use when connecting to the coordinator.
30964
30965 @item @code{uuid}
30966 The UUID of the agent. This should be generated by the coordinator
30967 process, stored in the coordinator database, and used by the intended
30968 agent.
30969
30970 @item @code{password} (default: @code{#f})
30971 The password to use when connecting to the coordinator. A file to read
30972 the password from can also be specified, and this is more secure.
30973
30974 @item @code{password-file} (default: @code{#f})
30975 A file containing the password to use when connecting to the
30976 coordinator.
30977
30978 @item @code{systems} (default: @code{#f})
30979 The systems for which this agent should fetch builds. The agent process
30980 will use the current system it's running on as the default.
30981
30982 @item @code{max-parallel-builds} (default: @code{1})
30983 The number of builds to perform in parallel.
30984
30985 @item @code{derivation-substitute-urls} (default: @code{#f})
30986 URLs from which to attempt to fetch substitutes for derivations, if the
30987 derivations aren't already available.
30988
30989 @item @code{non-derivation-substitute-urls} (default: @code{#f})
30990 URLs from which to attempt to fetch substitutes for build inputs, if the
30991 input store items aren't already available.
30992
30993 @end table
30994 @end deftp
30995
30996 The Guix Build Coordinator package contains a script to query an
30997 instance of the Guix Data Service for derivations to build, and then
30998 submit builds for those derivations to the coordinator. The service
30999 type below assists in running this script. This is an additional tool
31000 that may be useful when building derivations contained within an
31001 instance of the Guix Data Service.
31002
31003 @defvar {Scheme Variable} guix-build-coordinator-queue-builds-service-type
31004 Service type for the
31005 guix-build-coordinator-queue-builds-from-guix-data-service script. Its
31006 value must be a @code{guix-build-coordinator-queue-builds-configuration}
31007 object.
31008 @end defvar
31009
31010 @deftp {Data Type} guix-build-coordinator-queue-builds-configuration
31011 Data type representing the options to the queue builds from guix data
31012 service script.
31013
31014 @table @asis
31015 @item @code{package} (default: @code{guix-build-coordinator})
31016 The Guix Build Coordinator package to use.
31017
31018 @item @code{user} (default: @code{"guix-build-coordinator-queue-builds"})
31019 The system user to run the service as.
31020
31021 @item @code{coordinator} (default: @code{"http://localhost:8745"})
31022 The URI to use when connecting to the coordinator.
31023
31024 @item @code{systems} (default: @code{#f})
31025 The systems for which to fetch derivations to build.
31026
31027 @item @code{systems-and-targets} (default: @code{#f})
31028 An association list of system and target pairs for which to fetch
31029 derivations to build.
31030
31031 @item @code{guix-data-service} (default: @code{"https://data.guix.gnu.org"})
31032 The Guix Data Service instance from which to query to find out about
31033 derivations to build.
31034
31035 @item @code{processed-commits-file} (default: @code{"/var/cache/guix-build-coordinator-queue-builds/processed-commits"})
31036 A file to record which commits have been processed, to avoid needlessly
31037 processing them again if the service is restarted.
31038
31039 @end table
31040 @end deftp
31041
31042 @subsubheading Guix Data Service
31043 The @uref{http://data.guix.gnu.org,Guix Data Service} processes, stores
31044 and provides data about GNU Guix. This includes information about
31045 packages, derivations and lint warnings.
31046
31047 The data is stored in a PostgreSQL database, and available through a web
31048 interface.
31049
31050 @defvar {Scheme Variable} guix-data-service-type
31051 Service type for the Guix Data Service. Its value must be a
31052 @code{guix-data-service-configuration} object. The service optionally
31053 extends the getmail service, as the guix-commits mailing list is used to
31054 find out about changes in the Guix git repository.
31055 @end defvar
31056
31057 @deftp {Data Type} guix-data-service-configuration
31058 Data type representing the configuration of the Guix Data Service.
31059
31060 @table @asis
31061 @item @code{package} (default: @code{guix-data-service})
31062 The Guix Data Service package to use.
31063
31064 @item @code{user} (default: @code{"guix-data-service"})
31065 The system user to run the service as.
31066
31067 @item @code{group} (default: @code{"guix-data-service"})
31068 The system group to run the service as.
31069
31070 @item @code{port} (default: @code{8765})
31071 The port to bind the web service to.
31072
31073 @item @code{host} (default: @code{"127.0.0.1"})
31074 The host to bind the web service to.
31075
31076 @item @code{getmail-idle-mailboxes} (default: @code{#f})
31077 If set, this is the list of mailboxes that the getmail service will be
31078 configured to listen to.
31079
31080 @item @code{commits-getmail-retriever-configuration} (default: @code{#f})
31081 If set, this is the @code{getmail-retriever-configuration} object with
31082 which to configure getmail to fetch mail from the guix-commits mailing
31083 list.
31084
31085 @item @code{extra-options} (default: @var{'()})
31086 Extra command line options for @code{guix-data-service}.
31087
31088 @item @code{extra-process-jobs-options} (default: @var{'()})
31089 Extra command line options for @code{guix-data-service-process-jobs}.
31090
31091 @end table
31092 @end deftp
31093
31094 @node Linux Services
31095 @subsection Linux Services
31096
31097 @cindex oom
31098 @cindex out of memory killer
31099 @cindex earlyoom
31100 @cindex early out of memory daemon
31101 @subsubheading Early OOM Service
31102
31103 @uref{https://github.com/rfjakob/earlyoom,Early OOM}, also known as
31104 Earlyoom, is a minimalist out of memory (OOM) daemon that runs in user
31105 space and provides a more responsive and configurable alternative to the
31106 in-kernel OOM killer. It is useful to prevent the system from becoming
31107 unresponsive when it runs out of memory.
31108
31109 @deffn {Scheme Variable} earlyoom-service-type
31110 The service type for running @command{earlyoom}, the Early OOM daemon.
31111 Its value must be a @code{earlyoom-configuration} object, described
31112 below. The service can be instantiated in its default configuration
31113 with:
31114
31115 @lisp
31116 (service earlyoom-service-type)
31117 @end lisp
31118 @end deffn
31119
31120 @deftp {Data Type} earlyoom-configuration
31121 This is the configuration record for the @code{earlyoom-service-type}.
31122
31123 @table @asis
31124 @item @code{earlyoom} (default: @var{earlyoom})
31125 The Earlyoom package to use.
31126
31127 @item @code{minimum-available-memory} (default: @code{10})
31128 The threshold for the minimum @emph{available} memory, in percentages.
31129
31130 @item @code{minimum-free-swap} (default: @code{10})
31131 The threshold for the minimum free swap memory, in percentages.
31132
31133 @item @code{prefer-regexp} (default: @code{#f})
31134 A regular expression (as a string) to match the names of the processes
31135 that should be preferably killed.
31136
31137 @item @code{avoid-regexp} (default: @code{#f})
31138 A regular expression (as a string) to match the names of the processes
31139 that should @emph{not} be killed.
31140
31141 @item @code{memory-report-interval} (default: @code{0})
31142 The interval in seconds at which a memory report is printed. It is
31143 disabled by default.
31144
31145 @item @code{ignore-positive-oom-score-adj?} (default: @code{#f})
31146 A boolean indicating whether the positive adjustments set in
31147 @file{/proc/*/oom_score_adj} should be ignored.
31148
31149 @item @code{show-debug-messages?} (default: @code{#f})
31150 A boolean indicating whether debug messages should be printed. The logs
31151 are saved at @file{/var/log/earlyoom.log}.
31152
31153 @item @code{send-notification-command} (default: @code{#f})
31154 This can be used to provide a custom command used for sending
31155 notifications.
31156 @end table
31157 @end deftp
31158
31159 @cindex modprobe
31160 @cindex kernel module loader
31161 @subsubheading Kernel Module Loader Service
31162
31163 The kernel module loader service allows one to load loadable kernel
31164 modules at boot. This is especially useful for modules that don't
31165 autoload and need to be manually loaded, as it's the case with
31166 @code{ddcci}.
31167
31168 @deffn {Scheme Variable} kernel-module-loader-service-type
31169 The service type for loading loadable kernel modules at boot with
31170 @command{modprobe}. Its value must be a list of strings representing
31171 module names. For example loading the drivers provided by
31172 @code{ddcci-driver-linux}, in debugging mode by passing some module
31173 parameters, can be done as follow:
31174
31175 @lisp
31176 (use-modules (gnu) (gnu services))
31177 (use-package-modules linux)
31178 (use-service-modules linux)
31179
31180 (define ddcci-config
31181 (plain-file "ddcci.conf"
31182 "options ddcci dyndbg delay=120"))
31183
31184 (operating-system
31185 ...
31186 (services (cons* (service kernel-module-loader-service-type
31187 '("ddcci" "ddcci_backlight"))
31188 (simple-service 'ddcci-config etc-service-type
31189 (list `("modprobe.d/ddcci.conf"
31190 ,ddcci-config)))
31191 %base-services))
31192 (kernel-loadable-modules (list ddcci-driver-linux)))
31193 @end lisp
31194 @end deffn
31195
31196 @cindex zram
31197 @cindex compressed swap
31198 @cindex Compressed RAM-based block devices
31199 @subsubheading Zram Device Service
31200
31201 The Zram device service provides a compressed swap device in system
31202 memory. The Linux Kernel documentation has more information about
31203 @uref{https://www.kernel.org/doc/html/latest/admin-guide/blockdev/zram.html,zram}
31204 devices.
31205
31206 @deffn {Scheme Variable} zram-device-service-type
31207 This service creates the zram block device, formats it as swap and
31208 enables it as a swap device. The service's value is a
31209 @code{zram-device-configuration} record.
31210
31211 @deftp {Data Type} zram-device-configuration
31212 This is the data type representing the configuration for the zram-device
31213 service.
31214
31215 @table @asis
31216 @item @code{size} (default @code{"1G"})
31217 This is the amount of space you wish to provide for the zram device. It
31218 accepts a string and can be a number of bytes or use a suffix, eg.:
31219 @code{"512M"} or @code{1024000}.
31220 @item @code{compression-algorithm} (default @code{'lzo})
31221 This is the compression algorithm you wish to use. It is difficult to
31222 list all the possible compression options, but common ones supported by
31223 Guix's Linux Libre Kernel include @code{'lzo}, @code{'lz4} and @code{'zstd}.
31224 @item @code{memory-limit} (default @code{0})
31225 This is the maximum amount of memory which the zram device can use.
31226 Setting it to '0' disables the limit. While it is generally expected
31227 that compression will be 2:1, it is possible that uncompressable data
31228 can be written to swap and this is a method to limit how much memory can
31229 be used. It accepts a string and can be a number of bytes or use a
31230 suffix, eg.: @code{"2G"}.
31231 @item @code{priority} (default @code{-1})
31232 This is the priority of the swap device created from the zram device.
31233 @code{swapon} accepts values between -1 and 32767, with higher values
31234 indicating higher priority. Higher priority swap will generally be used
31235 first.
31236 @end table
31237
31238 @end deftp
31239 @end deffn
31240
31241 @node Hurd Services
31242 @subsection Hurd Services
31243
31244 @defvr {Scheme Variable} hurd-console-service-type
31245 This service starts the fancy @code{VGA} console client on the Hurd.
31246
31247 The service's value is a @code{hurd-console-configuration} record.
31248 @end defvr
31249
31250 @deftp {Data Type} hurd-console-configuration
31251 This is the data type representing the configuration for the
31252 hurd-console-service.
31253
31254 @table @asis
31255 @item @code{hurd} (default: @var{hurd})
31256 The Hurd package to use.
31257 @end table
31258 @end deftp
31259
31260 @defvr {Scheme Variable} hurd-getty-service-type
31261 This service starts a tty using the Hurd @code{getty} program.
31262
31263 The service's value is a @code{hurd-getty-configuration} record.
31264 @end defvr
31265
31266 @deftp {Data Type} hurd-getty-configuration
31267 This is the data type representing the configuration for the
31268 hurd-getty-service.
31269
31270 @table @asis
31271 @item @code{hurd} (default: @var{hurd})
31272 The Hurd package to use.
31273
31274 @item @code{tty}
31275 The name of the console this Getty runs on---e.g., @code{"tty1"}.
31276
31277 @item @code{baud-rate} (default: @code{38400})
31278 An integer specifying the baud rate of the tty.
31279
31280 @end table
31281 @end deftp
31282
31283 @node Miscellaneous Services
31284 @subsection Miscellaneous Services
31285
31286 @cindex fingerprint
31287 @subsubheading Fingerprint Service
31288
31289 The @code{(gnu services authentication)} module provides a DBus service to
31290 read and identify fingerprints via a fingerprint sensor.
31291
31292 @defvr {Scheme Variable} fprintd-service-type
31293 The service type for @command{fprintd}, which provides the fingerprint
31294 reading capability.
31295
31296 @lisp
31297 (service fprintd-service-type)
31298 @end lisp
31299 @end defvr
31300
31301 @cindex sysctl
31302 @subsubheading System Control Service
31303
31304 The @code{(gnu services sysctl)} provides a service to configure kernel
31305 parameters at boot.
31306
31307 @defvr {Scheme Variable} sysctl-service-type
31308 The service type for @command{sysctl}, which modifies kernel parameters
31309 under @file{/proc/sys/}. To enable IPv4 forwarding, it can be
31310 instantiated as:
31311
31312 @lisp
31313 (service sysctl-service-type
31314 (sysctl-configuration
31315 (settings '(("net.ipv4.ip_forward" . "1")))))
31316 @end lisp
31317 @end defvr
31318
31319 @deftp {Data Type} sysctl-configuration
31320 The data type representing the configuration of @command{sysctl}.
31321
31322 @table @asis
31323 @item @code{sysctl} (default: @code{(file-append procps "/sbin/sysctl"})
31324 The @command{sysctl} executable to use.
31325
31326 @item @code{settings} (default: @code{'()})
31327 An association list specifies kernel parameters and their values.
31328 @end table
31329 @end deftp
31330
31331 @cindex pcscd
31332 @subsubheading PC/SC Smart Card Daemon Service
31333
31334 The @code{(gnu services security-token)} module provides the following service
31335 to run @command{pcscd}, the PC/SC Smart Card Daemon. @command{pcscd} is the
31336 daemon program for pcsc-lite and the MuscleCard framework. It is a resource
31337 manager that coordinates communications with smart card readers, smart cards
31338 and cryptographic tokens that are connected to the system.
31339
31340 @defvr {Scheme Variable} pcscd-service-type
31341 Service type for the @command{pcscd} service. Its value must be a
31342 @code{pcscd-configuration} object. To run pcscd in the default
31343 configuration, instantiate it as:
31344
31345 @lisp
31346 (service pcscd-service-type)
31347 @end lisp
31348 @end defvr
31349
31350 @deftp {Data Type} pcscd-configuration
31351 The data type representing the configuration of @command{pcscd}.
31352
31353 @table @asis
31354 @item @code{pcsc-lite} (default: @code{pcsc-lite})
31355 The pcsc-lite package that provides pcscd.
31356 @item @code{usb-drivers} (default: @code{(list ccid)})
31357 List of packages that provide USB drivers to pcscd. Drivers are expected to be
31358 under @file{pcsc/drivers} in the store directory of the package.
31359 @end table
31360 @end deftp
31361
31362 @cindex lirc
31363 @subsubheading Lirc Service
31364
31365 The @code{(gnu services lirc)} module provides the following service.
31366
31367 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} lirc-service [#:lirc lirc] @
31368 [#:device #f] [#:driver #f] [#:config-file #f] @
31369 [#:extra-options '()]
31370 Return a service that runs @url{http://www.lirc.org,LIRC}, a daemon that
31371 decodes infrared signals from remote controls.
31372
31373 Optionally, @var{device}, @var{driver} and @var{config-file}
31374 (configuration file name) may be specified. See @command{lircd} manual
31375 for details.
31376
31377 Finally, @var{extra-options} is a list of additional command-line options
31378 passed to @command{lircd}.
31379 @end deffn
31380
31381 @cindex spice
31382 @subsubheading Spice Service
31383
31384 The @code{(gnu services spice)} module provides the following service.
31385
31386 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} spice-vdagent-service [#:spice-vdagent]
31387 Returns a service that runs @url{https://www.spice-space.org,VDAGENT}, a daemon
31388 that enables sharing the clipboard with a vm and setting the guest display
31389 resolution when the graphical console window resizes.
31390 @end deffn
31391
31392 @cindex inputattach
31393 @subsubheading inputattach Service
31394
31395 @cindex tablet input, for Xorg
31396 @cindex touchscreen input, for Xorg
31397 The @uref{https://linuxwacom.github.io/, inputattach} service allows you to
31398 use input devices such as Wacom tablets, touchscreens, or joysticks with the
31399 Xorg display server.
31400
31401 @deffn {Scheme Variable} inputattach-service-type
31402 Type of a service that runs @command{inputattach} on a device and
31403 dispatches events from it.
31404 @end deffn
31405
31406 @deftp {Data Type} inputattach-configuration
31407 @table @asis
31408 @item @code{device-type} (default: @code{"wacom"})
31409 The type of device to connect to. Run @command{inputattach --help}, from the
31410 @code{inputattach} package, to see the list of supported device types.
31411
31412 @item @code{device} (default: @code{"/dev/ttyS0"})
31413 The device file to connect to the device.
31414
31415 @item @code{baud-rate} (default: @code{#f})
31416 Baud rate to use for the serial connection.
31417 Should be a number or @code{#f}.
31418
31419 @item @code{log-file} (default: @code{#f})
31420 If true, this must be the name of a file to log messages to.
31421 @end table
31422 @end deftp
31423
31424 @subsubheading Dictionary Service
31425 @cindex dictionary
31426 The @code{(gnu services dict)} module provides the following service:
31427
31428 @defvr {Scheme Variable} dicod-service-type
31429 This is the type of the service that runs the @command{dicod} daemon, an
31430 implementation of DICT server (@pxref{Dicod,,, dico, GNU Dico Manual}).
31431 @end defvr
31432
31433 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} dicod-service [#:config (dicod-configuration)]
31434 Return a service that runs the @command{dicod} daemon, an implementation
31435 of DICT server (@pxref{Dicod,,, dico, GNU Dico Manual}).
31436
31437 The optional @var{config} argument specifies the configuration for
31438 @command{dicod}, which should be a @code{<dicod-configuration>} object, by
31439 default it serves the GNU Collaborative International Dictionary of English.
31440
31441 You can add @command{open localhost} to your @file{~/.dico} file to make
31442 @code{localhost} the default server for @command{dico} client
31443 (@pxref{Initialization File,,, dico, GNU Dico Manual}).
31444 @end deffn
31445
31446 @deftp {Data Type} dicod-configuration
31447 Data type representing the configuration of dicod.
31448
31449 @table @asis
31450 @item @code{dico} (default: @var{dico})
31451 Package object of the GNU Dico dictionary server.
31452
31453 @item @code{interfaces} (default: @var{'("localhost")})
31454 This is the list of IP addresses and ports and possibly socket file
31455 names to listen to (@pxref{Server Settings, @code{listen} directive,,
31456 dico, GNU Dico Manual}).
31457
31458 @item @code{handlers} (default: @var{'()})
31459 List of @code{<dicod-handler>} objects denoting handlers (module instances).
31460
31461 @item @code{databases} (default: @var{(list %dicod-database:gcide)})
31462 List of @code{<dicod-database>} objects denoting dictionaries to be served.
31463 @end table
31464 @end deftp
31465
31466 @deftp {Data Type} dicod-handler
31467 Data type representing a dictionary handler (module instance).
31468
31469 @table @asis
31470 @item @code{name}
31471 Name of the handler (module instance).
31472
31473 @item @code{module} (default: @var{#f})
31474 Name of the dicod module of the handler (instance). If it is @code{#f},
31475 the module has the same name as the handler.
31476 (@pxref{Modules,,, dico, GNU Dico Manual}).
31477
31478 @item @code{options}
31479 List of strings or gexps representing the arguments for the module handler
31480 @end table
31481 @end deftp
31482
31483 @deftp {Data Type} dicod-database
31484 Data type representing a dictionary database.
31485
31486 @table @asis
31487 @item @code{name}
31488 Name of the database, will be used in DICT commands.
31489
31490 @item @code{handler}
31491 Name of the dicod handler (module instance) used by this database
31492 (@pxref{Handlers,,, dico, GNU Dico Manual}).
31493
31494 @item @code{complex?} (default: @var{#f})
31495 Whether the database configuration complex. The complex configuration
31496 will need a corresponding @code{<dicod-handler>} object, otherwise not.
31497
31498 @item @code{options}
31499 List of strings or gexps representing the arguments for the database
31500 (@pxref{Databases,,, dico, GNU Dico Manual}).
31501 @end table
31502 @end deftp
31503
31504 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %dicod-database:gcide
31505 A @code{<dicod-database>} object serving the GNU Collaborative International
31506 Dictionary of English using the @code{gcide} package.
31507 @end defvr
31508
31509 The following is an example @code{dicod-service} configuration.
31510
31511 @lisp
31512 (dicod-service #:config
31513 (dicod-configuration
31514 (handlers (list (dicod-handler
31515 (name "wordnet")
31516 (module "dictorg")
31517 (options
31518 (list #~(string-append "dbdir=" #$wordnet))))))
31519 (databases (list (dicod-database
31520 (name "wordnet")
31521 (complex? #t)
31522 (handler "wordnet")
31523 (options '("database=wn")))
31524 %dicod-database:gcide))))
31525 @end lisp
31526
31527 @cindex Docker
31528 @subsubheading Docker Service
31529
31530 The @code{(gnu services docker)} module provides the following services.
31531
31532 @defvr {Scheme Variable} docker-service-type
31533
31534 This is the type of the service that runs @url{https://www.docker.com,Docker},
31535 a daemon that can execute application bundles (sometimes referred to as
31536 ``containers'') in isolated environments.
31537
31538 @end defvr
31539
31540 @deftp {Data Type} docker-configuration
31541 This is the data type representing the configuration of Docker and Containerd.
31542
31543 @table @asis
31544
31545 @item @code{package} (default: @code{docker})
31546 The Docker daemon package to use.
31547
31548 @item @code{package} (default: @code{docker-cli})
31549 The Docker client package to use.
31550
31551 @item @code{containerd} (default: @var{containerd})
31552 The Containerd package to use.
31553
31554 @item @code{proxy} (default @var{docker-libnetwork-cmd-proxy})
31555 The Docker user-land networking proxy package to use.
31556
31557 @item @code{enable-proxy?} (default @code{#t})
31558 Enable or disable the use of the Docker user-land networking proxy.
31559
31560 @item @code{debug?} (default @code{#f})
31561 Enable or disable debug output.
31562
31563 @item @code{enable-iptables?} (default @code{#t})
31564 Enable or disable the addition of iptables rules.
31565
31566 @end table
31567 @end deftp
31568
31569 @cindex Singularity, container service
31570 @defvr {Scheme Variable} singularity-service-type
31571 This is the type of the service that allows you to run
31572 @url{https://www.sylabs.io/singularity/, Singularity}, a Docker-style tool to
31573 create and run application bundles (aka. ``containers''). The value for this
31574 service is the Singularity package to use.
31575
31576 The service does not install a daemon; instead, it installs helper programs as
31577 setuid-root (@pxref{Setuid Programs}) such that unprivileged users can invoke
31578 @command{singularity run} and similar commands.
31579 @end defvr
31580
31581 @cindex Audit
31582 @subsubheading Auditd Service
31583
31584 The @code{(gnu services auditd)} module provides the following service.
31585
31586 @defvr {Scheme Variable} auditd-service-type
31587
31588 This is the type of the service that runs
31589 @url{https://people.redhat.com/sgrubb/audit/,auditd},
31590 a daemon that tracks security-relevant information on your system.
31591
31592 Examples of things that can be tracked:
31593
31594 @enumerate
31595 @item
31596 File accesses
31597 @item
31598 System calls
31599 @item
31600 Invoked commands
31601 @item
31602 Failed login attempts
31603 @item
31604 Firewall filtering
31605 @item
31606 Network access
31607 @end enumerate
31608
31609 @command{auditctl} from the @code{audit} package can be used in order
31610 to add or remove events to be tracked (until the next reboot).
31611 In order to permanently track events, put the command line arguments
31612 of auditctl into a file called @code{audit.rules} in the configuration
31613 directory (see below).
31614 @command{aureport} from the @code{audit} package can be used in order
31615 to view a report of all recorded events.
31616 The audit daemon by default logs into the file
31617 @file{/var/log/audit.log}.
31618
31619 @end defvr
31620
31621 @deftp {Data Type} auditd-configuration
31622 This is the data type representing the configuration of auditd.
31623
31624 @table @asis
31625
31626 @item @code{audit} (default: @code{audit})
31627 The audit package to use.
31628
31629 @item @code{configuration-directory} (default: @code{%default-auditd-configuration-directory})
31630 The directory containing the configuration file for the audit package, which
31631 must be named @code{auditd.conf}, and optionally some audit rules to
31632 instantiate on startup.
31633
31634 @end table
31635 @end deftp
31636
31637 @cindex rshiny
31638 @subsubheading R-Shiny service
31639
31640 The @code{(gnu services science)} module provides the following service.
31641
31642 @defvr {Scheme Variable} rshiny-service-type
31643
31644 This is a type of service which is used to run a webapp created with
31645 @code{r-shiny}. This service sets the @env{R_LIBS_USER} environment
31646 variable and runs the provided script to call @code{runApp}.
31647
31648 @deftp {Data Type} rshiny-configuration
31649 This is the data type representing the configuration of rshiny.
31650
31651 @table @asis
31652
31653 @item @code{package} (default: @code{r-shiny})
31654 The package to use.
31655
31656 @item @code{binary} (defaunlt @code{"rshiny"})
31657 The name of the binary or shell script located at @code{package/bin/} to
31658 run when the service is run.
31659
31660 The common way to create this file is as follows:
31661
31662 @lisp
31663 @dots{}
31664 (let* ((out (assoc-ref %outputs "out"))
31665 (targetdir (string-append out "/share/" ,name))
31666 (app (string-append out "/bin/" ,name))
31667 (Rbin (string-append (assoc-ref %build-inputs "r-min")
31668 "/bin/Rscript")))
31669 ;; @dots{}
31670 (mkdir-p (string-append out "/bin"))
31671 (call-with-output-file app
31672 (lambda (port)
31673 (format port
31674 "#!~a
31675 library(shiny)
31676 setwd(\"~a\")
31677 runApp(launch.browser=0, port=4202)~%\n"
31678 Rbin targetdir))))
31679 @end lisp
31680
31681 @end table
31682 @end deftp
31683 @end defvr
31684
31685 @cindex Nix
31686 @subsubheading Nix service
31687
31688 The @code{(gnu services nix)} module provides the following service.
31689
31690 @defvr {Scheme Variable} nix-service-type
31691
31692 This is the type of the service that runs build daemon of the
31693 @url{https://nixos.org/nix/, Nix} package manager. Here is an example showing
31694 how to use it:
31695
31696 @lisp
31697 (use-modules (gnu))
31698 (use-service-modules nix)
31699 (use-package-modules package-management)
31700
31701 (operating-system
31702 ;; @dots{}
31703 (packages (append (list nix)
31704 %base-packages))
31705
31706 (services (append (list (service nix-service-type))
31707 %base-services)))
31708 @end lisp
31709
31710 After @command{guix system reconfigure} configure Nix for your user:
31711
31712 @itemize
31713 @item Add a Nix channel and update it. See
31714 @url{https://nixos.org/nix/manual/, Nix Package Manager Guide}.
31715
31716 @item Create a symlink to your profile and activate Nix profile:
31717 @end itemize
31718
31719 @example
31720 $ ln -s "/nix/var/nix/profiles/per-user/$USER/profile" ~/.nix-profile
31721 $ source /run/current-system/profile/etc/profile.d/nix.sh
31722 @end example
31723
31724 @end defvr
31725
31726 @deftp {Data Type} nix-configuration
31727 This data type represents the configuration of the Nix daemon.
31728
31729 @table @asis
31730 @item @code{nix} (default: @code{nix})
31731 The Nix package to use.
31732
31733 @item @code{sandbox} (default: @code{#t})
31734 Specifies whether builds are sandboxed by default.
31735
31736 @item @code{build-sandbox-items} (default: @code{'()})
31737 This is a list of strings or objects appended to the
31738 @code{build-sandbox-items} field of the configuration file.
31739
31740 @item @code{extra-config} (default: @code{'()})
31741 This is a list of strings or objects appended to the configuration file.
31742 It is used to pass extra text to be added verbatim to the configuration
31743 file.
31744
31745 @item @code{extra-options} (default: @code{'()})
31746 Extra command line options for @code{nix-service-type}.
31747 @end table
31748 @end deftp
31749
31750 @node Setuid Programs
31751 @section Setuid Programs
31752
31753 @cindex setuid programs
31754 Some programs need to run with ``root'' privileges, even when they are
31755 launched by unprivileged users. A notorious example is the
31756 @command{passwd} program, which users can run to change their
31757 password, and which needs to access the @file{/etc/passwd} and
31758 @file{/etc/shadow} files---something normally restricted to root, for
31759 obvious security reasons. To address that, these executables are
31760 @dfn{setuid-root}, meaning that they always run with root privileges
31761 (@pxref{How Change Persona,,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual},
31762 for more info about the setuid mechanism).
31763
31764 The store itself @emph{cannot} contain setuid programs: that would be a
31765 security issue since any user on the system can write derivations that
31766 populate the store (@pxref{The Store}). Thus, a different mechanism is
31767 used: instead of changing the setuid bit directly on files that are in
31768 the store, we let the system administrator @emph{declare} which programs
31769 should be setuid root.
31770
31771 The @code{setuid-programs} field of an @code{operating-system}
31772 declaration contains a list of G-expressions denoting the names of
31773 programs to be setuid-root (@pxref{Using the Configuration System}).
31774 For instance, the @command{passwd} program, which is part of the Shadow
31775 package, can be designated by this G-expression (@pxref{G-Expressions}):
31776
31777 @example
31778 #~(string-append #$shadow "/bin/passwd")
31779 @end example
31780
31781 A default set of setuid programs is defined by the
31782 @code{%setuid-programs} variable of the @code{(gnu system)} module.
31783
31784 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %setuid-programs
31785 A list of G-expressions denoting common programs that are setuid-root.
31786
31787 The list includes commands such as @command{passwd}, @command{ping},
31788 @command{su}, and @command{sudo}.
31789 @end defvr
31790
31791 Under the hood, the actual setuid programs are created in the
31792 @file{/run/setuid-programs} directory at system activation time. The
31793 files in this directory refer to the ``real'' binaries, which are in the
31794 store.
31795
31796 @node X.509 Certificates
31797 @section X.509 Certificates
31798
31799 @cindex HTTPS, certificates
31800 @cindex X.509 certificates
31801 @cindex TLS
31802 Web servers available over HTTPS (that is, HTTP over the transport-layer
31803 security mechanism, TLS) send client programs an @dfn{X.509 certificate}
31804 that the client can then use to @emph{authenticate} the server. To do
31805 that, clients verify that the server's certificate is signed by a
31806 so-called @dfn{certificate authority} (CA). But to verify the CA's
31807 signature, clients must have first acquired the CA's certificate.
31808
31809 Web browsers such as GNU@tie{}IceCat include their own set of CA
31810 certificates, such that they are able to verify CA signatures
31811 out-of-the-box.
31812
31813 However, most other programs that can talk HTTPS---@command{wget},
31814 @command{git}, @command{w3m}, etc.---need to be told where CA
31815 certificates can be found.
31816
31817 @cindex @code{nss-certs}
31818 In Guix, this is done by adding a package that provides certificates
31819 to the @code{packages} field of the @code{operating-system} declaration
31820 (@pxref{operating-system Reference}). Guix includes one such package,
31821 @code{nss-certs}, which is a set of CA certificates provided as part of
31822 Mozilla's Network Security Services.
31823
31824 Note that it is @emph{not} part of @code{%base-packages}, so you need to
31825 explicitly add it. The @file{/etc/ssl/certs} directory, which is where
31826 most applications and libraries look for certificates by default, points
31827 to the certificates installed globally.
31828
31829 Unprivileged users, including users of Guix on a foreign distro,
31830 can also install their own certificate package in
31831 their profile. A number of environment variables need to be defined so
31832 that applications and libraries know where to find them. Namely, the
31833 OpenSSL library honors the @env{SSL_CERT_DIR} and @env{SSL_CERT_FILE}
31834 variables. Some applications add their own environment variables; for
31835 instance, the Git version control system honors the certificate bundle
31836 pointed to by the @env{GIT_SSL_CAINFO} environment variable. Thus, you
31837 would typically run something like:
31838
31839 @example
31840 guix install nss-certs
31841 export SSL_CERT_DIR="$HOME/.guix-profile/etc/ssl/certs"
31842 export SSL_CERT_FILE="$HOME/.guix-profile/etc/ssl/certs/ca-certificates.crt"
31843 export GIT_SSL_CAINFO="$SSL_CERT_FILE"
31844 @end example
31845
31846 As another example, R requires the @env{CURL_CA_BUNDLE} environment
31847 variable to point to a certificate bundle, so you would have to run
31848 something like this:
31849
31850 @example
31851 guix install nss-certs
31852 export CURL_CA_BUNDLE="$HOME/.guix-profile/etc/ssl/certs/ca-certificates.crt"
31853 @end example
31854
31855 For other applications you may want to look up the required environment
31856 variable in the relevant documentation.
31857
31858
31859 @node Name Service Switch
31860 @section Name Service Switch
31861
31862 @cindex name service switch
31863 @cindex NSS
31864 The @code{(gnu system nss)} module provides bindings to the
31865 configuration file of the libc @dfn{name service switch} or @dfn{NSS}
31866 (@pxref{NSS Configuration File,,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference
31867 Manual}). In a nutshell, the NSS is a mechanism that allows libc to be
31868 extended with new ``name'' lookup methods for system databases, which
31869 includes host names, service names, user accounts, and more (@pxref{Name
31870 Service Switch, System Databases and Name Service Switch,, libc, The GNU
31871 C Library Reference Manual}).
31872
31873 The NSS configuration specifies, for each system database, which lookup
31874 method is to be used, and how the various methods are chained
31875 together---for instance, under which circumstances NSS should try the
31876 next method in the list. The NSS configuration is given in the
31877 @code{name-service-switch} field of @code{operating-system} declarations
31878 (@pxref{operating-system Reference, @code{name-service-switch}}).
31879
31880 @cindex nss-mdns
31881 @cindex .local, host name lookup
31882 As an example, the declaration below configures the NSS to use the
31883 @uref{https://0pointer.de/lennart/projects/nss-mdns/, @code{nss-mdns}
31884 back-end}, which supports host name lookups over multicast DNS (mDNS)
31885 for host names ending in @code{.local}:
31886
31887 @lisp
31888 (name-service-switch
31889 (hosts (list %files ;first, check /etc/hosts
31890
31891 ;; If the above did not succeed, try
31892 ;; with 'mdns_minimal'.
31893 (name-service
31894 (name "mdns_minimal")
31895
31896 ;; 'mdns_minimal' is authoritative for
31897 ;; '.local'. When it returns "not found",
31898 ;; no need to try the next methods.
31899 (reaction (lookup-specification
31900 (not-found => return))))
31901
31902 ;; Then fall back to DNS.
31903 (name-service
31904 (name "dns"))
31905
31906 ;; Finally, try with the "full" 'mdns'.
31907 (name-service
31908 (name "mdns")))))
31909 @end lisp
31910
31911 Do not worry: the @code{%mdns-host-lookup-nss} variable (see below)
31912 contains this configuration, so you will not have to type it if all you
31913 want is to have @code{.local} host lookup working.
31914
31915 Note that, in this case, in addition to setting the
31916 @code{name-service-switch} of the @code{operating-system} declaration,
31917 you also need to use @code{avahi-service-type} (@pxref{Networking Services,
31918 @code{avahi-service-type}}), or @code{%desktop-services}, which includes it
31919 (@pxref{Desktop Services}). Doing this makes @code{nss-mdns} accessible
31920 to the name service cache daemon (@pxref{Base Services,
31921 @code{nscd-service}}).
31922
31923 For convenience, the following variables provide typical NSS
31924 configurations.
31925
31926 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %default-nss
31927 This is the default name service switch configuration, a
31928 @code{name-service-switch} object.
31929 @end defvr
31930
31931 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %mdns-host-lookup-nss
31932 This is the name service switch configuration with support for host name
31933 lookup over multicast DNS (mDNS) for host names ending in @code{.local}.
31934 @end defvr
31935
31936 The reference for name service switch configuration is given below. It
31937 is a direct mapping of the configuration file format of the C library , so
31938 please refer to the C library manual for more information (@pxref{NSS
31939 Configuration File,,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}).
31940 Compared to the configuration file format of libc NSS, it has the advantage
31941 not only of adding this warm parenthetic feel that we like, but also
31942 static checks: you will know about syntax errors and typos as soon as you
31943 run @command{guix system}.
31944
31945 @deftp {Data Type} name-service-switch
31946
31947 This is the data type representation the configuration of libc's name
31948 service switch (NSS). Each field below represents one of the supported
31949 system databases.
31950
31951 @table @code
31952 @item aliases
31953 @itemx ethers
31954 @itemx group
31955 @itemx gshadow
31956 @itemx hosts
31957 @itemx initgroups
31958 @itemx netgroup
31959 @itemx networks
31960 @itemx password
31961 @itemx public-key
31962 @itemx rpc
31963 @itemx services
31964 @itemx shadow
31965 The system databases handled by the NSS@. Each of these fields must be a
31966 list of @code{<name-service>} objects (see below).
31967 @end table
31968 @end deftp
31969
31970 @deftp {Data Type} name-service
31971
31972 This is the data type representing an actual name service and the
31973 associated lookup action.
31974
31975 @table @code
31976 @item name
31977 A string denoting the name service (@pxref{Services in the NSS
31978 configuration,,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}).
31979
31980 Note that name services listed here must be visible to nscd. This is
31981 achieved by passing the @code{#:name-services} argument to
31982 @code{nscd-service} the list of packages providing the needed name
31983 services (@pxref{Base Services, @code{nscd-service}}).
31984
31985 @item reaction
31986 An action specified using the @code{lookup-specification} macro
31987 (@pxref{Actions in the NSS configuration,,, libc, The GNU C Library
31988 Reference Manual}). For example:
31989
31990 @lisp
31991 (lookup-specification (unavailable => continue)
31992 (success => return))
31993 @end lisp
31994 @end table
31995 @end deftp
31996
31997 @node Initial RAM Disk
31998 @section Initial RAM Disk
31999
32000 @cindex initrd
32001 @cindex initial RAM disk
32002 For bootstrapping purposes, the Linux-Libre kernel is passed an
32003 @dfn{initial RAM disk}, or @dfn{initrd}. An initrd contains a temporary
32004 root file system as well as an initialization script. The latter is
32005 responsible for mounting the real root file system, and for loading any
32006 kernel modules that may be needed to achieve that.
32007
32008 The @code{initrd-modules} field of an @code{operating-system}
32009 declaration allows you to specify Linux-libre kernel modules that must
32010 be available in the initrd. In particular, this is where you would list
32011 modules needed to actually drive the hard disk where your root partition
32012 is---although the default value of @code{initrd-modules} should cover
32013 most use cases. For example, assuming you need the @code{megaraid_sas}
32014 module in addition to the default modules to be able to access your root
32015 file system, you would write:
32016
32017 @lisp
32018 (operating-system
32019 ;; @dots{}
32020 (initrd-modules (cons "megaraid_sas" %base-initrd-modules)))
32021 @end lisp
32022
32023 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %base-initrd-modules
32024 This is the list of kernel modules included in the initrd by default.
32025 @end defvr
32026
32027 Furthermore, if you need lower-level customization, the @code{initrd}
32028 field of an @code{operating-system} declaration allows
32029 you to specify which initrd you would like to use. The @code{(gnu
32030 system linux-initrd)} module provides three ways to build an initrd: the
32031 high-level @code{base-initrd} procedure and the low-level
32032 @code{raw-initrd} and @code{expression->initrd} procedures.
32033
32034 The @code{base-initrd} procedure is intended to cover most common uses.
32035 For example, if you want to add a bunch of kernel modules to be loaded
32036 at boot time, you can define the @code{initrd} field of the operating
32037 system declaration like this:
32038
32039 @lisp
32040 (initrd (lambda (file-systems . rest)
32041 ;; Create a standard initrd but set up networking
32042 ;; with the parameters QEMU expects by default.
32043 (apply base-initrd file-systems
32044 #:qemu-networking? #t
32045 rest)))
32046 @end lisp
32047
32048 The @code{base-initrd} procedure also handles common use cases that
32049 involves using the system as a QEMU guest, or as a ``live'' system with
32050 volatile root file system.
32051
32052 The @code{base-initrd} procedure is built from @code{raw-initrd} procedure.
32053 Unlike @code{base-initrd}, @code{raw-initrd} doesn't do anything high-level,
32054 such as trying to guess which kernel modules and packages should be included
32055 to the initrd. An example use of @code{raw-initrd} is when a user has
32056 a custom Linux kernel configuration and default kernel modules included by
32057 @code{base-initrd} are not available.
32058
32059 The initial RAM disk produced by @code{base-initrd} or @code{raw-initrd}
32060 honors several options passed on the Linux kernel command line
32061 (that is, arguments passed @i{via} the @code{linux} command of GRUB, or the
32062 @code{-append} option of QEMU), notably:
32063
32064 @table @code
32065 @item --load=@var{boot}
32066 Tell the initial RAM disk to load @var{boot}, a file containing a Scheme
32067 program, once it has mounted the root file system.
32068
32069 Guix uses this option to yield control to a boot program that runs the
32070 service activation programs and then spawns the GNU@tie{}Shepherd, the
32071 initialization system.
32072
32073 @item --root=@var{root}
32074 Mount @var{root} as the root file system. @var{root} can be a device
32075 name like @code{/dev/sda1}, a file system label, or a file system UUID.
32076 When unspecified, the device name from the root file system of the
32077 operating system declaration is used.
32078
32079 @item --system=@var{system}
32080 Have @file{/run/booted-system} and @file{/run/current-system} point to
32081 @var{system}.
32082
32083 @item modprobe.blacklist=@var{modules}@dots{}
32084 @cindex module, black-listing
32085 @cindex black list, of kernel modules
32086 Instruct the initial RAM disk as well as the @command{modprobe} command
32087 (from the kmod package) to refuse to load @var{modules}. @var{modules}
32088 must be a comma-separated list of module names---e.g.,
32089 @code{usbkbd,9pnet}.
32090
32091 @item --repl
32092 Start a read-eval-print loop (REPL) from the initial RAM disk before it
32093 tries to load kernel modules and to mount the root file system. Our
32094 marketing team calls it @dfn{boot-to-Guile}. The Schemer in you will
32095 love it. @xref{Using Guile Interactively,,, guile, GNU Guile Reference
32096 Manual}, for more information on Guile's REPL.
32097
32098 @end table
32099
32100 Now that you know all the features that initial RAM disks produced by
32101 @code{base-initrd} and @code{raw-initrd} provide,
32102 here is how to use it and customize it further.
32103
32104 @cindex initrd
32105 @cindex initial RAM disk
32106 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} raw-initrd @var{file-systems} @
32107 [#:linux-modules '()] [#:mapped-devices '()] @
32108 [#:keyboard-layout #f] @
32109 [#:helper-packages '()] [#:qemu-networking? #f] [#:volatile-root? #f]
32110 Return a derivation that builds a raw initrd. @var{file-systems} is
32111 a list of file systems to be mounted by the initrd, possibly in addition to
32112 the root file system specified on the kernel command line via @option{--root}.
32113 @var{linux-modules} is a list of kernel modules to be loaded at boot time.
32114 @var{mapped-devices} is a list of device mappings to realize before
32115 @var{file-systems} are mounted (@pxref{Mapped Devices}).
32116 @var{helper-packages} is a list of packages to be copied in the initrd.
32117 It may
32118 include @code{e2fsck/static} or other packages needed by the initrd to check
32119 the root file system.
32120
32121 When true, @var{keyboard-layout} is a @code{<keyboard-layout>} record denoting
32122 the desired console keyboard layout. This is done before @var{mapped-devices}
32123 are set up and before @var{file-systems} are mounted such that, should the
32124 user need to enter a passphrase or use the REPL, this happens using the
32125 intended keyboard layout.
32126
32127 When @var{qemu-networking?} is true, set up networking with the standard QEMU
32128 parameters. When @var{virtio?} is true, load additional modules so that the
32129 initrd can be used as a QEMU guest with para-virtualized I/O drivers.
32130
32131 When @var{volatile-root?} is true, the root file system is writable but any changes
32132 to it are lost.
32133 @end deffn
32134
32135 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} base-initrd @var{file-systems} @
32136 [#:mapped-devices '()] [#:keyboard-layout #f] @
32137 [#:qemu-networking? #f] [#:volatile-root? #f] @
32138 [#:linux-modules '()]
32139 Return as a file-like object a generic initrd, with kernel
32140 modules taken from @var{linux}. @var{file-systems} is a list of file-systems to be
32141 mounted by the initrd, possibly in addition to the root file system specified
32142 on the kernel command line via @option{--root}. @var{mapped-devices} is a list of device
32143 mappings to realize before @var{file-systems} are mounted.
32144
32145 When true, @var{keyboard-layout} is a @code{<keyboard-layout>} record denoting
32146 the desired console keyboard layout. This is done before @var{mapped-devices}
32147 are set up and before @var{file-systems} are mounted such that, should the
32148 user need to enter a passphrase or use the REPL, this happens using the
32149 intended keyboard layout.
32150
32151 @var{qemu-networking?} and @var{volatile-root?} behaves as in @code{raw-initrd}.
32152
32153 The initrd is automatically populated with all the kernel modules necessary
32154 for @var{file-systems} and for the given options. Additional kernel
32155 modules can be listed in @var{linux-modules}. They will be added to the initrd, and
32156 loaded at boot time in the order in which they appear.
32157 @end deffn
32158
32159 Needless to say, the initrds we produce and use embed a
32160 statically-linked Guile, and the initialization program is a Guile
32161 program. That gives a lot of flexibility. The
32162 @code{expression->initrd} procedure builds such an initrd, given the
32163 program to run in that initrd.
32164
32165 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} expression->initrd @var{exp} @
32166 [#:guile %guile-3.0-static-stripped] [#:name "guile-initrd"]
32167 Return as a file-like object a Linux initrd (a gzipped cpio archive)
32168 containing @var{guile} and that evaluates @var{exp}, a G-expression,
32169 upon booting. All the derivations referenced by @var{exp} are
32170 automatically copied to the initrd.
32171 @end deffn
32172
32173 @node Bootloader Configuration
32174 @section Bootloader Configuration
32175
32176 @cindex bootloader
32177 @cindex boot loader
32178
32179 The operating system supports multiple bootloaders. The bootloader is
32180 configured using @code{bootloader-configuration} declaration. All the
32181 fields of this structure are bootloader agnostic except for one field,
32182 @code{bootloader} that indicates the bootloader to be configured and
32183 installed.
32184
32185 Some of the bootloaders do not honor every field of
32186 @code{bootloader-configuration}. For instance, the extlinux
32187 bootloader does not support themes and thus ignores the @code{theme}
32188 field.
32189
32190 @deftp {Data Type} bootloader-configuration
32191 The type of a bootloader configuration declaration.
32192
32193 @table @asis
32194
32195 @item @code{bootloader}
32196 @cindex EFI, bootloader
32197 @cindex UEFI, bootloader
32198 @cindex BIOS, bootloader
32199 The bootloader to use, as a @code{bootloader} object. For now
32200 @code{grub-bootloader}, @code{grub-efi-bootloader},
32201 @code{grub-efi-netboot-bootloader}, @code{extlinux-bootloader} and
32202 @code{u-boot-bootloader} are supported.
32203
32204 @cindex ARM, bootloaders
32205 @cindex AArch64, bootloaders
32206 Available bootloaders are described in @code{(gnu bootloader @dots{})}
32207 modules. In particular, @code{(gnu bootloader u-boot)} contains definitions
32208 of bootloaders for a wide range of ARM and AArch64 systems, using the
32209 @uref{https://www.denx.de/wiki/U-Boot/, U-Boot bootloader}.
32210
32211 @vindex grub-efi-bootloader
32212 @code{grub-efi-bootloader} allows to boot on modern systems using the
32213 @dfn{Unified Extensible Firmware Interface} (UEFI). This is what you should
32214 use if the installation image contains a @file{/sys/firmware/efi} directory
32215 when you boot it on your system.
32216
32217 @vindex grub-bootloader
32218 @code{grub-bootloader} allows you to boot in particular Intel-based machines
32219 in ``legacy'' BIOS mode.
32220
32221 @vindex grub-efi-netboot-bootloader
32222 @code{grub-efi-netboot-bootloader} allows you to boot your system over network
32223 through TFTP@. In combination with an NFS root file system this allows you to
32224 build a diskless Guix system.
32225
32226 The installation of the @code{grub-efi-netboot-bootloader} generates the content
32227 of the TFTP root directory at @code{target}
32228 (@pxref{Bootloader Configuration, @code{target}}), to be served by a TFTP server.
32229 You may want to mount your TFTP server directory onto @code{target} to move the
32230 required files to the TFTP server automatically.
32231
32232 If you plan to use an NFS root file system as well (actually if you mount the
32233 store from an NFS share), then the TFTP server needs to serve the file
32234 @file{/boot/grub/grub.cfg} and other files from the store (like GRUBs background
32235 image, the kernel (@pxref{operating-system Reference, @code{kernel}}) and the
32236 initrd (@pxref{operating-system Reference, @code{initrd}})), too. All these
32237 files from the store will be accessed by GRUB through TFTP with their normal
32238 store path, for example as
32239 @file{tftp://tftp-server/gnu/store/…-initrd/initrd.cpio.gz}.
32240
32241 Two symlinks are created to make this possible. The first symlink is
32242 @code{target}@file{/efi/Guix/boot/grub/grub.cfg} pointing to
32243 @file{../../../boot/grub/grub.cfg},
32244 where @code{target} may be @file{/boot}. In this case the link is not leaving
32245 the served TFTP root directory, but otherwise it does. The second link is
32246 @code{target}@file{/gnu/store} and points to @file{../gnu/store}. This link
32247 is leaving the served TFTP root directory.
32248
32249 The assumption behind all this is that you have an NFS server exporting the root
32250 file system for your Guix system, and additionally a TFTP server exporting your
32251 @code{target} directory—usually @file{/boot}—from that same root file system for
32252 your Guix system. In this constellation the symlinks will work.
32253
32254 For other constellations you will have to program your own bootloader installer,
32255 which then takes care to make necessary files from the store accessible through
32256 TFTP, for example by copying them into the TFTP root directory at @code{target}.
32257
32258 It is important to note that symlinks pointing outside the TFTP root directory
32259 may need to be allowed in the configuration of your TFTP server. Further the
32260 store link exposes the whole store through TFTP@. Both points need to be
32261 considered carefully for security aspects.
32262
32263 Beside the @code{grub-efi-netboot-bootloader}, the already mentioned TFTP and
32264 NFS servers, you also need a properly configured DHCP server to make the booting
32265 over netboot possible. For all this we can currently only recommend you to look
32266 for instructions about @acronym{PXE, Preboot eXecution Environment}.
32267
32268 @item @code{target}
32269 This is a string denoting the target onto which to install the
32270 bootloader.
32271
32272 The interpretation depends on the bootloader in question. For
32273 @code{grub-bootloader}, for example, it should be a device name understood by
32274 the bootloader @command{installer} command, such as @code{/dev/sda} or
32275 @code{(hd0)} (@pxref{Invoking grub-install,,, grub, GNU GRUB Manual}). For
32276 @code{grub-efi-bootloader}, it should be the mount point of the EFI file
32277 system, usually @file{/boot/efi}. For @code{grub-efi-netboot-bootloader},
32278 @code{target} should be the mount point corresponding to the TFTP root
32279 directory of your TFTP server.
32280
32281 @item @code{menu-entries} (default: @code{()})
32282 A possibly empty list of @code{menu-entry} objects (see below), denoting
32283 entries to appear in the bootloader menu, in addition to the current
32284 system entry and the entry pointing to previous system generations.
32285
32286 @item @code{default-entry} (default: @code{0})
32287 The index of the default boot menu entry. Index 0 is for the entry of the
32288 current system.
32289
32290 @item @code{timeout} (default: @code{5})
32291 The number of seconds to wait for keyboard input before booting. Set to
32292 0 to boot immediately, and to -1 to wait indefinitely.
32293
32294 @cindex keyboard layout, for the bootloader
32295 @item @code{keyboard-layout} (default: @code{#f})
32296 If this is @code{#f}, the bootloader's menu (if any) uses the default keyboard
32297 layout, usually US@tie{}English (``qwerty'').
32298
32299 Otherwise, this must be a @code{keyboard-layout} object (@pxref{Keyboard
32300 Layout}).
32301
32302 @quotation Note
32303 This option is currently ignored by bootloaders other than @code{grub} and
32304 @code{grub-efi}.
32305 @end quotation
32306
32307 @item @code{theme} (default: @var{#f})
32308 The bootloader theme object describing the theme to use. If no theme
32309 is provided, some bootloaders might use a default theme, that's true
32310 for GRUB.
32311
32312 @item @code{terminal-outputs} (default: @code{'(gfxterm)})
32313 The output terminals used for the bootloader boot menu, as a list of
32314 symbols. GRUB accepts the values: @code{console}, @code{serial},
32315 @code{serial_@{0-3@}}, @code{gfxterm}, @code{vga_text},
32316 @code{mda_text}, @code{morse}, and @code{pkmodem}. This field
32317 corresponds to the GRUB variable @code{GRUB_TERMINAL_OUTPUT} (@pxref{Simple
32318 configuration,,, grub,GNU GRUB manual}).
32319
32320 @item @code{terminal-inputs} (default: @code{'()})
32321 The input terminals used for the bootloader boot menu, as a list of
32322 symbols. For GRUB, the default is the native platform terminal as
32323 determined at run-time. GRUB accepts the values: @code{console},
32324 @code{serial}, @code{serial_@{0-3@}}, @code{at_keyboard}, and
32325 @code{usb_keyboard}. This field corresponds to the GRUB variable
32326 @code{GRUB_TERMINAL_INPUT} (@pxref{Simple configuration,,, grub,GNU GRUB
32327 manual}).
32328
32329 @item @code{serial-unit} (default: @code{#f})
32330 The serial unit used by the bootloader, as an integer from 0 to 3.
32331 For GRUB, it is chosen at run-time; currently GRUB chooses 0, which
32332 corresponds to COM1 (@pxref{Serial terminal,,, grub,GNU GRUB manual}).
32333
32334 @item @code{serial-speed} (default: @code{#f})
32335 The speed of the serial interface, as an integer. For GRUB, the
32336 default value is chosen at run-time; currently GRUB chooses
32337 9600@tie{}bps (@pxref{Serial terminal,,, grub,GNU GRUB manual}).
32338 @end table
32339
32340 @end deftp
32341
32342 @cindex dual boot
32343 @cindex boot menu
32344 Should you want to list additional boot menu entries @i{via} the
32345 @code{menu-entries} field above, you will need to create them with the
32346 @code{menu-entry} form. For example, imagine you want to be able to
32347 boot another distro (hard to imagine!), you can define a menu entry
32348 along these lines:
32349
32350 @lisp
32351 (menu-entry
32352 (label "The Other Distro")
32353 (linux "/boot/old/vmlinux-2.6.32")
32354 (linux-arguments '("root=/dev/sda2"))
32355 (initrd "/boot/old/initrd"))
32356 @end lisp
32357
32358 Details below.
32359
32360 @deftp {Data Type} menu-entry
32361 The type of an entry in the bootloader menu.
32362
32363 @table @asis
32364
32365 @item @code{label}
32366 The label to show in the menu---e.g., @code{"GNU"}.
32367
32368 @item @code{linux} (default: @code{#f})
32369 The Linux kernel image to boot, for example:
32370
32371 @lisp
32372 (file-append linux-libre "/bzImage")
32373 @end lisp
32374
32375 For GRUB, it is also possible to specify a device explicitly in the
32376 file path using GRUB's device naming convention (@pxref{Naming
32377 convention,,, grub, GNU GRUB manual}), for example:
32378
32379 @example
32380 "(hd0,msdos1)/boot/vmlinuz"
32381 @end example
32382
32383 If the device is specified explicitly as above, then the @code{device}
32384 field is ignored entirely.
32385
32386 @item @code{linux-arguments} (default: @code{()})
32387 The list of extra Linux kernel command-line arguments---e.g.,
32388 @code{("console=ttyS0")}.
32389
32390 @item @code{initrd} (default: @code{#f})
32391 A G-Expression or string denoting the file name of the initial RAM disk
32392 to use (@pxref{G-Expressions}).
32393
32394 @item @code{device} (default: @code{#f})
32395 The device where the kernel and initrd are to be found---i.e., for GRUB,
32396 @dfn{root} for this menu entry (@pxref{root,,, grub, GNU GRUB manual}).
32397
32398 This may be a file system label (a string), a file system UUID (a
32399 bytevector, @pxref{File Systems}), or @code{#f}, in which case
32400 the bootloader will search the device containing the file specified by
32401 the @code{linux} field (@pxref{search,,, grub, GNU GRUB manual}). It
32402 must @emph{not} be an OS device name such as @file{/dev/sda1}.
32403
32404 @item @code{multiboot-kernel} (default: @code{#f})
32405 The kernel to boot in Multiboot-mode (@pxref{multiboot,,, grub, GNU GRUB
32406 manual}). When this field is set, a Multiboot menu-entry is generated.
32407 For example:
32408
32409 @lisp
32410 (file-append mach "/boot/gnumach")
32411 @end lisp
32412
32413 @item @code{multiboot-arguments} (default: @code{()})
32414 The list of extra command-line arguments for the multiboot-kernel.
32415
32416 @item @code{multiboot-modules} (default: @code{()})
32417 The list of commands for loading Multiboot modules. For example:
32418
32419 @lisp
32420 (list (list (file-append hurd "/hurd/ext2fs.static") "ext2fs"
32421 @dots{})
32422 (list (file-append libc "/lib/ld.so.1") "exec"
32423 @dots{}))
32424 @end lisp
32425
32426 @end table
32427 @end deftp
32428
32429 @cindex HDPI
32430 @cindex HiDPI
32431 @cindex resolution
32432 @c FIXME: Write documentation once it's stable.
32433 For now only GRUB has theme support. GRUB themes are created using
32434 the @code{grub-theme} form, which is not fully documented yet.
32435
32436 @deftp {Data Type} grub-theme
32437 Data type representing the configuration of the GRUB theme.
32438
32439 @table @asis
32440 @item @code{gfxmode} (default: @code{'("auto")})
32441 The GRUB @code{gfxmode} to set (a list of screen resolution strings,
32442 @pxref{gfxmode,,, grub, GNU GRUB manual}).
32443 @end table
32444 @end deftp
32445
32446 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} grub-theme
32447 Return the default GRUB theme used by the operating system if no
32448 @code{theme} field is specified in @code{bootloader-configuration}
32449 record.
32450
32451 It comes with a fancy background image displaying the GNU and Guix
32452 logos.
32453 @end deffn
32454
32455 For example, to override the default resolution, you may use something
32456 like
32457
32458 @lisp
32459 (bootloader
32460 (bootloader-configuration
32461 ;; @dots{}
32462 (theme (grub-theme
32463 (inherit (grub-theme))
32464 (gfxmode '("1024x786x32" "auto"))))))
32465 @end lisp
32466
32467 @node Invoking guix system
32468 @section Invoking @code{guix system}
32469
32470 Once you have written an operating system declaration as seen in the
32471 previous section, it can be @dfn{instantiated} using the @command{guix
32472 system} command. The synopsis is:
32473
32474 @example
32475 guix system @var{options}@dots{} @var{action} @var{file}
32476 @end example
32477
32478 @var{file} must be the name of a file containing an
32479 @code{operating-system} declaration. @var{action} specifies how the
32480 operating system is instantiated. Currently the following values are
32481 supported:
32482
32483 @table @code
32484 @item search
32485 Display available service type definitions that match the given regular
32486 expressions, sorted by relevance:
32487
32488 @cindex HDPI
32489 @cindex HiDPI
32490 @cindex resolution
32491 @example
32492 $ guix system search console
32493 name: console-fonts
32494 location: gnu/services/base.scm:806:2
32495 extends: shepherd-root
32496 description: Install the given fonts on the specified ttys (fonts are per
32497 + virtual console on GNU/Linux). The value of this service is a list of
32498 + tty/font pairs. The font can be the name of a font provided by the `kbd'
32499 + package or any valid argument to `setfont', as in this example:
32500 +
32501 + '(("tty1" . "LatGrkCyr-8x16")
32502 + ("tty2" . (file-append
32503 + font-tamzen
32504 + "/share/kbd/consolefonts/TamzenForPowerline10x20.psf"))
32505 + ("tty3" . (file-append
32506 + font-terminus
32507 + "/share/consolefonts/ter-132n"))) ; for HDPI
32508 relevance: 9
32509
32510 name: mingetty
32511 location: gnu/services/base.scm:1190:2
32512 extends: shepherd-root
32513 description: Provide console login using the `mingetty' program.
32514 relevance: 2
32515
32516 name: login
32517 location: gnu/services/base.scm:860:2
32518 extends: pam
32519 description: Provide a console log-in service as specified by its
32520 + configuration value, a `login-configuration' object.
32521 relevance: 2
32522
32523 @dots{}
32524 @end example
32525
32526 As for @command{guix package --search}, the result is written in
32527 @code{recutils} format, which makes it easy to filter the output
32528 (@pxref{Top, GNU recutils databases,, recutils, GNU recutils manual}).
32529
32530 @item reconfigure
32531 Build the operating system described in @var{file}, activate it, and
32532 switch to it@footnote{This action (and the related actions
32533 @code{switch-generation} and @code{roll-back}) are usable only on
32534 systems already running Guix System.}.
32535
32536 @quotation Note
32537 @c The paragraph below refers to the problem discussed at
32538 @c <https://lists.gnu.org/archive/html/guix-devel/2014-08/msg00057.html>.
32539 It is highly recommended to run @command{guix pull} once before you run
32540 @command{guix system reconfigure} for the first time (@pxref{Invoking
32541 guix pull}). Failing to do that you would see an older version of Guix
32542 once @command{reconfigure} has completed.
32543 @end quotation
32544
32545 This effects all the configuration specified in @var{file}: user
32546 accounts, system services, global package list, setuid programs, etc.
32547 The command starts system services specified in @var{file} that are not
32548 currently running; if a service is currently running this command will
32549 arrange for it to be upgraded the next time it is stopped (e.g.@: by
32550 @code{herd stop X} or @code{herd restart X}).
32551
32552 This command creates a new generation whose number is one greater than
32553 the current generation (as reported by @command{guix system
32554 list-generations}). If that generation already exists, it will be
32555 overwritten. This behavior mirrors that of @command{guix package}
32556 (@pxref{Invoking guix package}).
32557
32558 It also adds a bootloader menu entry for the new OS configuration,
32559 ---unless @option{--no-bootloader} is passed. For GRUB, it moves
32560 entries for older configurations to a submenu, allowing you to choose
32561 an older system generation at boot time should you need it.
32562
32563 @cindex provenance tracking, of the operating system
32564 Upon completion, the new system is deployed under
32565 @file{/run/current-system}. This directory contains @dfn{provenance
32566 meta-data}: the list of channels in use (@pxref{Channels}) and
32567 @var{file} itself, when available. You can view it by running:
32568
32569 @example
32570 guix system describe
32571 @end example
32572
32573 This information is useful should you later want to inspect how this
32574 particular generation was built. In fact, assuming @var{file} is
32575 self-contained, you can later rebuild generation @var{n} of your
32576 operating system with:
32577
32578 @example
32579 guix time-machine \
32580 -C /var/guix/profiles/system-@var{n}-link/channels.scm -- \
32581 system reconfigure \
32582 /var/guix/profiles/system-@var{n}-link/configuration.scm
32583 @end example
32584
32585 You can think of it as some sort of built-in version control! Your
32586 system is not just a binary artifact: @emph{it carries its own source}.
32587 @xref{Service Reference, @code{provenance-service-type}}, for more
32588 information on provenance tracking.
32589
32590 By default, @command{reconfigure} @emph{prevents you from downgrading
32591 your system}, which could (re)introduce security vulnerabilities and
32592 also cause problems with ``stateful'' services such as database
32593 management systems. You can override that behavior by passing
32594 @option{--allow-downgrades}.
32595
32596 @item switch-generation
32597 @cindex generations
32598 Switch to an existing system generation. This action atomically
32599 switches the system profile to the specified system generation. It
32600 also rearranges the system's existing bootloader menu entries. It
32601 makes the menu entry for the specified system generation the default,
32602 and it moves the entries for the other generations to a submenu, if
32603 supported by the bootloader being used. The next time the system
32604 boots, it will use the specified system generation.
32605
32606 The bootloader itself is not being reinstalled when using this
32607 command. Thus, the installed bootloader is used with an updated
32608 configuration file.
32609
32610 The target generation can be specified explicitly by its generation
32611 number. For example, the following invocation would switch to system
32612 generation 7:
32613
32614 @example
32615 guix system switch-generation 7
32616 @end example
32617
32618 The target generation can also be specified relative to the current
32619 generation with the form @code{+N} or @code{-N}, where @code{+3} means
32620 ``3 generations ahead of the current generation,'' and @code{-1} means
32621 ``1 generation prior to the current generation.'' When specifying a
32622 negative value such as @code{-1}, you must precede it with @code{--} to
32623 prevent it from being parsed as an option. For example:
32624
32625 @example
32626 guix system switch-generation -- -1
32627 @end example
32628
32629 Currently, the effect of invoking this action is @emph{only} to switch
32630 the system profile to an existing generation and rearrange the
32631 bootloader menu entries. To actually start using the target system
32632 generation, you must reboot after running this action. In the future,
32633 it will be updated to do the same things as @command{reconfigure},
32634 like activating and deactivating services.
32635
32636 This action will fail if the specified generation does not exist.
32637
32638 @item roll-back
32639 @cindex rolling back
32640 Switch to the preceding system generation. The next time the system
32641 boots, it will use the preceding system generation. This is the inverse
32642 of @command{reconfigure}, and it is exactly the same as invoking
32643 @command{switch-generation} with an argument of @code{-1}.
32644
32645 Currently, as with @command{switch-generation}, you must reboot after
32646 running this action to actually start using the preceding system
32647 generation.
32648
32649 @item delete-generations
32650 @cindex deleting system generations
32651 @cindex saving space
32652 Delete system generations, making them candidates for garbage collection
32653 (@pxref{Invoking guix gc}, for information on how to run the ``garbage
32654 collector'').
32655
32656 This works in the same way as @samp{guix package --delete-generations}
32657 (@pxref{Invoking guix package, @option{--delete-generations}}). With no
32658 arguments, all system generations but the current one are deleted:
32659
32660 @example
32661 guix system delete-generations
32662 @end example
32663
32664 You can also select the generations you want to delete. The example below
32665 deletes all the system generations that are more than two month old:
32666
32667 @example
32668 guix system delete-generations 2m
32669 @end example
32670
32671 Running this command automatically reinstalls the bootloader with an updated
32672 list of menu entries---e.g., the ``old generations'' sub-menu in GRUB no
32673 longer lists the generations that have been deleted.
32674
32675 @item build
32676 Build the derivation of the operating system, which includes all the
32677 configuration files and programs needed to boot and run the system.
32678 This action does not actually install anything.
32679
32680 @item init
32681 Populate the given directory with all the files necessary to run the
32682 operating system specified in @var{file}. This is useful for first-time
32683 installations of Guix System. For instance:
32684
32685 @example
32686 guix system init my-os-config.scm /mnt
32687 @end example
32688
32689 copies to @file{/mnt} all the store items required by the configuration
32690 specified in @file{my-os-config.scm}. This includes configuration
32691 files, packages, and so on. It also creates other essential files
32692 needed for the system to operate correctly---e.g., the @file{/etc},
32693 @file{/var}, and @file{/run} directories, and the @file{/bin/sh} file.
32694
32695 This command also installs bootloader on the target specified in
32696 @file{my-os-config}, unless the @option{--no-bootloader} option was
32697 passed.
32698
32699 @item vm
32700 @cindex virtual machine
32701 @cindex VM
32702 @anchor{guix system vm}
32703 Build a virtual machine that contains the operating system declared in
32704 @var{file}, and return a script to run that virtual machine (VM).
32705
32706 @quotation Note
32707 The @code{vm} action and others below
32708 can use KVM support in the Linux-libre kernel. Specifically, if the
32709 machine has hardware virtualization support, the corresponding
32710 KVM kernel module should be loaded, and the @file{/dev/kvm} device node
32711 must exist and be readable and writable by the user and by the
32712 build users of the daemon (@pxref{Build Environment Setup}).
32713 @end quotation
32714
32715 Arguments given to the script are passed to QEMU as in the example
32716 below, which enables networking and requests 1@tie{}GiB of RAM for the
32717 emulated machine:
32718
32719 @example
32720 $ /gnu/store/@dots{}-run-vm.sh -m 1024 -smp 2 -net user,model=virtio-net-pci
32721 @end example
32722
32723 The VM shares its store with the host system.
32724
32725 Additional file systems can be shared between the host and the VM using
32726 the @option{--share} and @option{--expose} command-line options: the former
32727 specifies a directory to be shared with write access, while the latter
32728 provides read-only access to the shared directory.
32729
32730 The example below creates a VM in which the user's home directory is
32731 accessible read-only, and where the @file{/exchange} directory is a
32732 read-write mapping of @file{$HOME/tmp} on the host:
32733
32734 @example
32735 guix system vm my-config.scm \
32736 --expose=$HOME --share=$HOME/tmp=/exchange
32737 @end example
32738
32739 On GNU/Linux, the default is to boot directly to the kernel; this has
32740 the advantage of requiring only a very tiny root disk image since the
32741 store of the host can then be mounted.
32742
32743 The @option{--full-boot} option forces a complete boot sequence, starting
32744 with the bootloader. This requires more disk space since a root image
32745 containing at least the kernel, initrd, and bootloader data files must
32746 be created. The @option{--image-size} option can be used to specify the
32747 size of the image.
32748
32749 @cindex System images, creation in various formats
32750 @cindex Creating system images in various formats
32751 @item image
32752 @itemx docker-image
32753 Return a virtual machine, disk image, or Docker image of the operating
32754 system declared in @var{file} that stands alone. By default,
32755 @command{guix system} estimates the size of the image needed to store
32756 the system, but you can use the @option{--image-size} option to specify
32757 a value. Docker images are built to contain exactly what they need, so
32758 the @option{--image-size} option is ignored in the case of
32759 @code{docker-image}.
32760
32761 @cindex image, creating disk images
32762 The @code{image} command can produce various image types. The
32763 image type can be selected using the @option{--image-type} option. It
32764 defaults to @code{efi-raw}. When its value is @code{iso9660}, the
32765 @option{--label} option can be used to specify a volume ID with
32766 @code{image}. By default, the root file system of a disk image is
32767 mounted non-volatile; the @option{--volatile} option can be provided to
32768 make it volatile instead. When using @code{image}, the bootloader
32769 installed on the generated image is taken from the provided
32770 @code{operating-system} definition. The following example demonstrates
32771 how to generate an image that uses the @code{grub-efi-bootloader}
32772 bootloader and boot it with QEMU:
32773
32774 @example
32775 image=$(guix system image --image-type=qcow2 \
32776 gnu/system/examples/lightweight-desktop.tmpl)
32777 cp $image /tmp/my-image.qcow2
32778 chmod +w /tmp/my-image.qcow2
32779 qemu-system-x86_64 -enable-kvm -hda /tmp/my-image.qcow2 -m 1000 \
32780 -bios $(guix build ovmf)/share/firmware/ovmf_x64.bin
32781 @end example
32782
32783 When using the @code{efi-raw} image type, a raw disk image is produced;
32784 it can be copied as is to a USB stick, for instance. Assuming
32785 @code{/dev/sdc} is the device corresponding to a USB stick, one can copy
32786 the image to it using the following command:
32787
32788 @example
32789 # dd if=$(guix system image my-os.scm) of=/dev/sdc status=progress
32790 @end example
32791
32792 The @code{--list-image-types} command lists all the available image
32793 types.
32794
32795 @cindex creating virtual machine images
32796 When using the @code{qcow2} image type, the returned image is in qcow2
32797 format, which the QEMU emulator can efficiently use. @xref{Running Guix
32798 in a VM}, for more information on how to run the image in a virtual
32799 machine. The @code{grub-bootloader} bootloader is always used
32800 independently of what is declared in the @code{operating-system} file
32801 passed as argument. This is to make it easier to work with QEMU, which
32802 uses the SeaBIOS BIOS by default, expecting a bootloader to be installed
32803 in the Master Boot Record (MBR).
32804
32805 @cindex docker-image, creating docker images
32806 When using @code{docker-image}, a Docker image is produced. Guix builds
32807 the image from scratch, not from a pre-existing Docker base image. As a
32808 result, it contains @emph{exactly} what you define in the operating
32809 system configuration file. You can then load the image and launch a
32810 Docker container using commands like the following:
32811
32812 @example
32813 image_id="`docker load < guix-system-docker-image.tar.gz`"
32814 container_id="`docker create $image_id`"
32815 docker start $container_id
32816 @end example
32817
32818 This command starts a new Docker container from the specified image. It
32819 will boot the Guix system in the usual manner, which means it will
32820 start any services you have defined in the operating system
32821 configuration. You can get an interactive shell running in the container
32822 using @command{docker exec}:
32823
32824 @example
32825 docker exec -ti $container_id /run/current-system/profile/bin/bash --login
32826 @end example
32827
32828 Depending on what you run in the Docker container, it
32829 may be necessary to give the container additional permissions. For
32830 example, if you intend to build software using Guix inside of the Docker
32831 container, you may need to pass the @option{--privileged} option to
32832 @code{docker create}.
32833
32834 Last, the @option{--network} option applies to @command{guix system
32835 docker-image}: it produces an image where network is supposedly shared
32836 with the host, and thus without services like nscd or NetworkManager.
32837
32838 @item container
32839 Return a script to run the operating system declared in @var{file}
32840 within a container. Containers are a set of lightweight isolation
32841 mechanisms provided by the kernel Linux-libre. Containers are
32842 substantially less resource-demanding than full virtual machines since
32843 the kernel, shared objects, and other resources can be shared with the
32844 host system; this also means they provide thinner isolation.
32845
32846 Currently, the script must be run as root in order to support more than
32847 a single user and group. The container shares its store with the host
32848 system.
32849
32850 As with the @code{vm} action (@pxref{guix system vm}), additional file
32851 systems to be shared between the host and container can be specified
32852 using the @option{--share} and @option{--expose} options:
32853
32854 @example
32855 guix system container my-config.scm \
32856 --expose=$HOME --share=$HOME/tmp=/exchange
32857 @end example
32858
32859 @quotation Note
32860 This option requires Linux-libre 3.19 or newer.
32861 @end quotation
32862
32863 @end table
32864
32865 @var{options} can contain any of the common build options (@pxref{Common
32866 Build Options}). In addition, @var{options} can contain one of the
32867 following:
32868
32869 @table @option
32870 @item --expression=@var{expr}
32871 @itemx -e @var{expr}
32872 Consider the operating-system @var{expr} evaluates to.
32873 This is an alternative to specifying a file which evaluates to an
32874 operating system.
32875 This is used to generate the Guix system installer @pxref{Building the
32876 Installation Image}).
32877
32878 @item --system=@var{system}
32879 @itemx -s @var{system}
32880 Attempt to build for @var{system} instead of the host system type.
32881 This works as per @command{guix build} (@pxref{Invoking guix build}).
32882
32883 @item --derivation
32884 @itemx -d
32885 Return the derivation file name of the given operating system without
32886 building anything.
32887
32888 @cindex provenance tracking, of the operating system
32889 @item --save-provenance
32890 As discussed above, @command{guix system init} and @command{guix system
32891 reconfigure} always save provenance information @i{via} a dedicated
32892 service (@pxref{Service Reference, @code{provenance-service-type}}).
32893 However, other commands don't do that by default. If you wish to, say,
32894 create a virtual machine image that contains provenance information, you
32895 can run:
32896
32897 @example
32898 guix system image -t qcow2 --save-provenance config.scm
32899 @end example
32900
32901 That way, the resulting image will effectively ``embed its own source''
32902 in the form of meta-data in @file{/run/current-system}. With that
32903 information, one can rebuild the image to make sure it really contains
32904 what it pretends to contain; or they could use that to derive a variant
32905 of the image.
32906
32907 @item --image-type=@var{type}
32908 @itemx -t @var{type}
32909 For the @code{image} action, create an image with given @var{type}.
32910
32911 When this option is omitted, @command{guix system} uses the
32912 @code{efi-raw} image type.
32913
32914 @cindex ISO-9660 format
32915 @cindex CD image format
32916 @cindex DVD image format
32917 @option{--image-type=iso9660} produces an ISO-9660 image, suitable
32918 for burning on CDs and DVDs.
32919
32920 @item --image-size=@var{size}
32921 For the @code{image} action, create an image of the given @var{size}.
32922 @var{size} may be a number of bytes, or it may include a unit as a
32923 suffix (@pxref{Block size, size specifications,, coreutils, GNU
32924 Coreutils}).
32925
32926 When this option is omitted, @command{guix system} computes an estimate
32927 of the image size as a function of the size of the system declared in
32928 @var{file}.
32929
32930 @item --network
32931 @itemx -N
32932 For the @code{container} action, allow containers to access the host network,
32933 that is, do not create a network namespace.
32934
32935 @item --root=@var{file}
32936 @itemx -r @var{file}
32937 Make @var{file} a symlink to the result, and register it as a garbage
32938 collector root.
32939
32940 @item --skip-checks
32941 Skip pre-installation safety checks.
32942
32943 By default, @command{guix system init} and @command{guix system
32944 reconfigure} perform safety checks: they make sure the file systems that
32945 appear in the @code{operating-system} declaration actually exist
32946 (@pxref{File Systems}), and that any Linux kernel modules that may be
32947 needed at boot time are listed in @code{initrd-modules} (@pxref{Initial
32948 RAM Disk}). Passing this option skips these tests altogether.
32949
32950 @item --allow-downgrades
32951 Instruct @command{guix system reconfigure} to allow system downgrades.
32952
32953 By default, @command{reconfigure} prevents you from downgrading your
32954 system. It achieves that by comparing the provenance info of your
32955 system (shown by @command{guix system describe}) with that of your
32956 @command{guix} command (shown by @command{guix describe}). If the
32957 commits for @command{guix} are not descendants of those used for your
32958 system, @command{guix system reconfigure} errors out. Passing
32959 @option{--allow-downgrades} allows you to bypass these checks.
32960
32961 @quotation Note
32962 Make sure you understand its security implications before using
32963 @option{--allow-downgrades}.
32964 @end quotation
32965
32966 @cindex on-error
32967 @cindex on-error strategy
32968 @cindex error strategy
32969 @item --on-error=@var{strategy}
32970 Apply @var{strategy} when an error occurs when reading @var{file}.
32971 @var{strategy} may be one of the following:
32972
32973 @table @code
32974 @item nothing-special
32975 Report the error concisely and exit. This is the default strategy.
32976
32977 @item backtrace
32978 Likewise, but also display a backtrace.
32979
32980 @item debug
32981 Report the error and enter Guile's debugger. From there, you can run
32982 commands such as @code{,bt} to get a backtrace, @code{,locals} to
32983 display local variable values, and more generally inspect the state of the
32984 program. @xref{Debug Commands,,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}, for
32985 a list of available debugging commands.
32986 @end table
32987 @end table
32988
32989 Once you have built, configured, re-configured, and re-re-configured
32990 your Guix installation, you may find it useful to list the operating
32991 system generations available on disk---and that you can choose from the
32992 bootloader boot menu:
32993
32994 @table @code
32995
32996 @item describe
32997 Describe the current system generation: its file name, the kernel and
32998 bootloader used, etc., as well as provenance information when available.
32999
33000 @item list-generations
33001 List a summary of each generation of the operating system available on
33002 disk, in a human-readable way. This is similar to the
33003 @option{--list-generations} option of @command{guix package}
33004 (@pxref{Invoking guix package}).
33005
33006 Optionally, one can specify a pattern, with the same syntax that is used
33007 in @command{guix package --list-generations}, to restrict the list of
33008 generations displayed. For instance, the following command displays
33009 generations that are up to 10 days old:
33010
33011 @example
33012 $ guix system list-generations 10d
33013 @end example
33014
33015 @end table
33016
33017 The @command{guix system} command has even more to offer! The following
33018 sub-commands allow you to visualize how your system services relate to
33019 each other:
33020
33021 @anchor{system-extension-graph}
33022 @table @code
33023
33024 @item extension-graph
33025 Emit to standard output the @dfn{service
33026 extension graph} of the operating system defined in @var{file}
33027 (@pxref{Service Composition}, for more information on service
33028 extensions). By default the output is in Dot/Graphviz format, but you
33029 can choose a different format with @option{--graph-backend}, as with
33030 @command{guix graph} (@pxref{Invoking guix graph, @option{--backend}}):
33031
33032 The command:
33033
33034 @example
33035 $ guix system extension-graph @var{file} | xdot -
33036 @end example
33037
33038 shows the extension relations among services.
33039
33040 @anchor{system-shepherd-graph}
33041 @item shepherd-graph
33042 Emit to standard output the @dfn{dependency
33043 graph} of shepherd services of the operating system defined in
33044 @var{file}. @xref{Shepherd Services}, for more information and for an
33045 example graph.
33046
33047 Again, the default output format is Dot/Graphviz, but you can pass
33048 @option{--graph-backend} to select a different one.
33049
33050 @end table
33051
33052 @node Invoking guix deploy
33053 @section Invoking @code{guix deploy}
33054
33055 We've already seen @code{operating-system} declarations used to manage a
33056 machine's configuration locally. Suppose you need to configure multiple
33057 machines, though---perhaps you're managing a service on the web that's
33058 comprised of several servers. @command{guix deploy} enables you to use those
33059 same @code{operating-system} declarations to manage multiple remote hosts at
33060 once as a logical ``deployment''.
33061
33062 @quotation Note
33063 The functionality described in this section is still under development
33064 and is subject to change. Get in touch with us on
33065 @email{guix-devel@@gnu.org}!
33066 @end quotation
33067
33068 @example
33069 guix deploy @var{file}
33070 @end example
33071
33072 Such an invocation will deploy the machines that the code within @var{file}
33073 evaluates to. As an example, @var{file} might contain a definition like this:
33074
33075 @lisp
33076 ;; This is a Guix deployment of a "bare bones" setup, with
33077 ;; no X11 display server, to a machine with an SSH daemon
33078 ;; listening on localhost:2222. A configuration such as this
33079 ;; may be appropriate for virtual machine with ports
33080 ;; forwarded to the host's loopback interface.
33081
33082 (use-service-modules networking ssh)
33083 (use-package-modules bootloaders)
33084
33085 (define %system
33086 (operating-system
33087 (host-name "gnu-deployed")
33088 (timezone "Etc/UTC")
33089 (bootloader (bootloader-configuration
33090 (bootloader grub-bootloader)
33091 (target "/dev/vda")
33092 (terminal-outputs '(console))))
33093 (file-systems (cons (file-system
33094 (mount-point "/")
33095 (device "/dev/vda1")
33096 (type "ext4"))
33097 %base-file-systems))
33098 (services
33099 (append (list (service dhcp-client-service-type)
33100 (service openssh-service-type
33101 (openssh-configuration
33102 (permit-root-login #t)
33103 (allow-empty-passwords? #t))))
33104 %base-services))))
33105
33106 (list (machine
33107 (operating-system %system)
33108 (environment managed-host-environment-type)
33109 (configuration (machine-ssh-configuration
33110 (host-name "localhost")
33111 (system "x86_64-linux")
33112 (user "alice")
33113 (identity "./id_rsa")
33114 (port 2222)))))
33115 @end lisp
33116
33117 The file should evaluate to a list of @var{machine} objects. This example,
33118 upon being deployed, will create a new generation on the remote system
33119 realizing the @code{operating-system} declaration @code{%system}.
33120 @code{environment} and @code{configuration} specify how the machine should be
33121 provisioned---that is, how the computing resources should be created and
33122 managed. The above example does not create any resources, as a
33123 @code{'managed-host} is a machine that is already running the Guix system and
33124 available over the network. This is a particularly simple case; a more
33125 complex deployment may involve, for example, starting virtual machines through
33126 a Virtual Private Server (VPS) provider. In such a case, a different
33127 @var{environment} type would be used.
33128
33129 Do note that you first need to generate a key pair on the coordinator machine
33130 to allow the daemon to export signed archives of files from the store
33131 (@pxref{Invoking guix archive}), though this step is automatic on Guix
33132 System:
33133
33134 @example
33135 # guix archive --generate-key
33136 @end example
33137
33138 @noindent
33139 Each target machine must authorize the key of the master machine so that it
33140 accepts store items it receives from the coordinator:
33141
33142 @example
33143 # guix archive --authorize < coordinator-public-key.txt
33144 @end example
33145
33146 @code{user}, in this example, specifies the name of the user account to log in
33147 as to perform the deployment. Its default value is @code{root}, but root
33148 login over SSH may be forbidden in some cases. To work around this,
33149 @command{guix deploy} can log in as an unprivileged user and employ
33150 @code{sudo} to escalate privileges. This will only work if @code{sudo} is
33151 currently installed on the remote and can be invoked non-interactively as
33152 @code{user}. That is, the line in @code{sudoers} granting @code{user} the
33153 ability to use @code{sudo} must contain the @code{NOPASSWD} tag. This can
33154 be accomplished with the following operating system configuration snippet:
33155
33156 @lisp
33157 (use-modules ...
33158 (gnu system)) ;for %sudoers-specification
33159
33160 (define %user "username")
33161
33162 (operating-system
33163 ...
33164 (sudoers-file
33165 (plain-file "sudoers"
33166 (string-append (plain-file-content %sudoers-specification)
33167 (format #f "~a ALL = NOPASSWD: ALL~%"
33168 %user)))))
33169
33170 @end lisp
33171
33172 For more information regarding the format of the @file{sudoers} file,
33173 consult @command{man sudoers}.
33174
33175 @deftp {Data Type} machine
33176 This is the data type representing a single machine in a heterogeneous Guix
33177 deployment.
33178
33179 @table @asis
33180 @item @code{operating-system}
33181 The object of the operating system configuration to deploy.
33182
33183 @item @code{environment}
33184 An @code{environment-type} describing how the machine should be provisioned.
33185
33186 @item @code{configuration} (default: @code{#f})
33187 An object describing the configuration for the machine's @code{environment}.
33188 If the @code{environment} has a default configuration, @code{#f} may be used.
33189 If @code{#f} is used for an environment with no default configuration,
33190 however, an error will be thrown.
33191 @end table
33192 @end deftp
33193
33194 @deftp {Data Type} machine-ssh-configuration
33195 This is the data type representing the SSH client parameters for a machine
33196 with an @code{environment} of @code{managed-host-environment-type}.
33197
33198 @table @asis
33199 @item @code{host-name}
33200 @item @code{build-locally?} (default: @code{#t})
33201 If false, system derivations will be built on the machine being deployed to.
33202 @item @code{system}
33203 The system type describing the architecture of the machine being deployed
33204 to---e.g., @code{"x86_64-linux"}.
33205 @item @code{authorize?} (default: @code{#t})
33206 If true, the coordinator's signing key will be added to the remote's ACL
33207 keyring.
33208 @item @code{port} (default: @code{22})
33209 @item @code{user} (default: @code{"root"})
33210 @item @code{identity} (default: @code{#f})
33211 If specified, the path to the SSH private key to use to authenticate with the
33212 remote host.
33213
33214 @item @code{host-key} (default: @code{#f})
33215 This should be the SSH host key of the machine, which looks like this:
33216
33217 @example
33218 ssh-ed25519 AAAAC3Nz@dots{} root@@example.org
33219 @end example
33220
33221 When @code{host-key} is @code{#f}, the server is authenticated against
33222 the @file{~/.ssh/known_hosts} file, just like the OpenSSH @command{ssh}
33223 client does.
33224
33225 @item @code{allow-downgrades?} (default: @code{#f})
33226 Whether to allow potential downgrades.
33227
33228 Like @command{guix system reconfigure}, @command{guix deploy} compares
33229 the channel commits currently deployed on the remote host (as returned
33230 by @command{guix system describe}) to those currently in use (as
33231 returned by @command{guix describe}) to determine whether commits
33232 currently in use are descendants of those deployed. When this is not
33233 the case and @code{allow-downgrades?} is false, it raises an error.
33234 This ensures you do not accidentally downgrade remote machines.
33235 @end table
33236 @end deftp
33237
33238 @deftp {Data Type} digital-ocean-configuration
33239 This is the data type describing the Droplet that should be created for a
33240 machine with an @code{environment} of @code{digital-ocean-environment-type}.
33241
33242 @table @asis
33243 @item @code{ssh-key}
33244 The path to the SSH private key to use to authenticate with the remote
33245 host. In the future, this field may not exist.
33246 @item @code{tags}
33247 A list of string ``tags'' that uniquely identify the machine. Must be given
33248 such that no two machines in the deployment have the same set of tags.
33249 @item @code{region}
33250 A Digital Ocean region slug, such as @code{"nyc3"}.
33251 @item @code{size}
33252 A Digital Ocean size slug, such as @code{"s-1vcpu-1gb"}
33253 @item @code{enable-ipv6?}
33254 Whether or not the droplet should be created with IPv6 networking.
33255 @end table
33256 @end deftp
33257
33258 @node Running Guix in a VM
33259 @section Running Guix in a Virtual Machine
33260
33261 @cindex virtual machine
33262 To run Guix in a virtual machine (VM), one can use the pre-built Guix VM image
33263 distributed at
33264 @url{@value{BASE-URL}/guix-system-vm-image-@value{VERSION}.x86_64-linux.xz}.
33265 This image is a compressed image in QCOW format. You will first need to
33266 decompress with @command{xz -d}, and then you can pass it to an emulator such
33267 as QEMU (see below for details).
33268
33269 This image boots the Xfce graphical environment and it contains some
33270 commonly used tools. You can install more software in the image by running
33271 @command{guix package} in a terminal (@pxref{Invoking guix package}). You can
33272 also reconfigure the system based on its initial configuration file available
33273 as @file{/run/current-system/configuration.scm} (@pxref{Using the
33274 Configuration System}).
33275
33276 Instead of using this pre-built image, one can also build their own virtual
33277 machine image using @command{guix system vm-image} (@pxref{Invoking guix
33278 system}). The returned image is in qcow2 format, which the
33279 @uref{https://qemu.org/, QEMU emulator} can efficiently use.
33280
33281 @cindex QEMU
33282 If you built your own image, you must copy it out of the store
33283 (@pxref{The Store}) and give yourself permission to write to the copy
33284 before you can use it. When invoking QEMU, you must choose a system
33285 emulator that is suitable for your hardware platform. Here is a minimal
33286 QEMU invocation that will boot the result of @command{guix system
33287 image -t qcow2} on x86_64 hardware:
33288
33289 @example
33290 $ qemu-system-x86_64 \
33291 -nic user,model=virtio-net-pci \
33292 -enable-kvm -m 1024 \
33293 -device virtio-blk,drive=myhd \
33294 -drive if=none,file=/tmp/qemu-image,id=myhd
33295 @end example
33296
33297 Here is what each of these options means:
33298
33299 @table @code
33300 @item qemu-system-x86_64
33301 This specifies the hardware platform to emulate. This should match the
33302 host.
33303
33304 @item -nic user,model=virtio-net-pci
33305 Enable the unprivileged user-mode network stack. The guest OS can
33306 access the host but not vice versa. This is the simplest way to get the
33307 guest OS online. @code{model} specifies which network device to emulate:
33308 @code{virtio-net-pci} is a special device made for virtualized operating
33309 systems and recommended for most uses. Assuming your hardware platform is
33310 x86_64, you can get a list of available NIC models by running
33311 @command{qemu-system-x86_64 -nic model=help}.
33312
33313 @item -enable-kvm
33314 If your system has hardware virtualization extensions, enabling the
33315 virtual machine support (KVM) of the Linux kernel will make things run
33316 faster.
33317
33318 @c To run Xfce + 'guix pull', we need at least 1G of RAM.
33319 @item -m 1024
33320 RAM available to the guest OS, in mebibytes. Defaults to 128@tie{}MiB,
33321 which may be insufficient for some operations.
33322
33323 @item -device virtio-blk,drive=myhd
33324 Create a @code{virtio-blk} drive called ``myhd''. @code{virtio-blk} is a
33325 ``paravirtualization'' mechanism for block devices that allows QEMU to achieve
33326 better performance than if it were emulating a complete disk drive. See the
33327 QEMU and KVM documentation for more info.
33328
33329 @item -drive if=none,file=/tmp/qemu-image,id=myhd
33330 Use our QCOW image, the @file{/tmp/qemu-image} file, as the backing
33331 store of the ``myhd'' drive.
33332 @end table
33333
33334 The default @command{run-vm.sh} script that is returned by an invocation of
33335 @command{guix system vm} does not add a @command{-nic user} flag by default.
33336 To get network access from within the vm add the @code{(dhcp-client-service)}
33337 to your system definition and start the VM using
33338 @command{`guix system vm config.scm` -nic user}. An important caveat of using
33339 @command{-nic user} for networking is that @command{ping} will not work, because
33340 it uses the ICMP protocol. You'll have to use a different command to check for
33341 network connectivity, for example @command{guix download}.
33342
33343 @subsection Connecting Through SSH
33344
33345 @cindex SSH
33346 @cindex SSH server
33347 To enable SSH inside a VM you need to add an SSH server like
33348 @code{openssh-service-type} to your VM (@pxref{Networking Services,
33349 @code{openssh-service-type}}). In addition you need to forward the SSH port,
33350 22 by default, to the host. You can do this with
33351
33352 @example
33353 `guix system vm config.scm` -nic user,model=virtio-net-pci,hostfwd=tcp::10022-:22
33354 @end example
33355
33356 To connect to the VM you can run
33357
33358 @example
33359 ssh -o UserKnownHostsFile=/dev/null -o StrictHostKeyChecking=no -p 10022
33360 @end example
33361
33362 The @command{-p} tells @command{ssh} the port you want to connect to.
33363 @command{-o UserKnownHostsFile=/dev/null} prevents @command{ssh} from complaining
33364 every time you modify your @command{config.scm} file and the
33365 @command{-o StrictHostKeyChecking=no} prevents you from having to allow a
33366 connection to an unknown host every time you connect.
33367
33368 @subsection Using @command{virt-viewer} with Spice
33369
33370 As an alternative to the default @command{qemu} graphical client you can
33371 use the @command{remote-viewer} from the @command{virt-viewer} package. To
33372 connect pass the @command{-spice port=5930,disable-ticketing} flag to
33373 @command{qemu}. See previous section for further information on how to do this.
33374
33375 Spice also allows you to do some nice stuff like share your clipboard with your
33376 VM@. To enable that you'll also have to pass the following flags to @command{qemu}:
33377
33378 @example
33379 -device virtio-serial-pci,id=virtio-serial0,max_ports=16,bus=pci.0,addr=0x5
33380 -chardev spicevmc,name=vdagent,id=vdagent
33381 -device virtserialport,nr=1,bus=virtio-serial0.0,chardev=vdagent,
33382 name=com.redhat.spice.0
33383 @end example
33384
33385 You'll also need to add the @code{(spice-vdagent-service)} to your
33386 system definition (@pxref{Miscellaneous Services, Spice service}).
33387
33388 @node Defining Services
33389 @section Defining Services
33390
33391 The previous sections show the available services and how one can combine
33392 them in an @code{operating-system} declaration. But how do we define
33393 them in the first place? And what is a service anyway?
33394
33395 @menu
33396 * Service Composition:: The model for composing services.
33397 * Service Types and Services:: Types and services.
33398 * Service Reference:: API reference.
33399 * Shepherd Services:: A particular type of service.
33400 @end menu
33401
33402 @node Service Composition
33403 @subsection Service Composition
33404
33405 @cindex services
33406 @cindex daemons
33407 Here we define a @dfn{service} as, broadly, something that extends the
33408 functionality of the operating system. Often a service is a process---a
33409 @dfn{daemon}---started when the system boots: a secure shell server, a
33410 Web server, the Guix build daemon, etc. Sometimes a service is a daemon
33411 whose execution can be triggered by another daemon---e.g., an FTP server
33412 started by @command{inetd} or a D-Bus service activated by
33413 @command{dbus-daemon}. Occasionally, a service does not map to a
33414 daemon. For instance, the ``account'' service collects user accounts
33415 and makes sure they exist when the system runs; the ``udev'' service
33416 collects device management rules and makes them available to the eudev
33417 daemon; the @file{/etc} service populates the @file{/etc} directory
33418 of the system.
33419
33420 @cindex service extensions
33421 Guix system services are connected by @dfn{extensions}. For instance, the
33422 secure shell service @emph{extends} the Shepherd---the
33423 initialization system, running as PID@tie{}1---by giving it the command
33424 lines to start and stop the secure shell daemon (@pxref{Networking
33425 Services, @code{openssh-service-type}}); the UPower service extends the D-Bus
33426 service by passing it its @file{.service} specification, and extends the
33427 udev service by passing it device management rules (@pxref{Desktop
33428 Services, @code{upower-service}}); the Guix daemon service extends the
33429 Shepherd by passing it the command lines to start and stop the daemon,
33430 and extends the account service by passing it a list of required build
33431 user accounts (@pxref{Base Services}).
33432
33433 All in all, services and their ``extends'' relations form a directed
33434 acyclic graph (DAG). If we represent services as boxes and extensions
33435 as arrows, a typical system might provide something like this:
33436
33437 @image{images/service-graph,,5in,Typical service extension graph.}
33438
33439 @cindex system service
33440 At the bottom, we see the @dfn{system service}, which produces the
33441 directory containing everything to run and boot the system, as returned
33442 by the @command{guix system build} command. @xref{Service Reference},
33443 to learn about the other service types shown here.
33444 @xref{system-extension-graph, the @command{guix system extension-graph}
33445 command}, for information on how to generate this representation for a
33446 particular operating system definition.
33447
33448 @cindex service types
33449 Technically, developers can define @dfn{service types} to express these
33450 relations. There can be any number of services of a given type on the
33451 system---for instance, a system running two instances of the GNU secure
33452 shell server (lsh) has two instances of @code{lsh-service-type}, with
33453 different parameters.
33454
33455 The following section describes the programming interface for service
33456 types and services.
33457
33458 @node Service Types and Services
33459 @subsection Service Types and Services
33460
33461 A @dfn{service type} is a node in the DAG described above. Let us start
33462 with a simple example, the service type for the Guix build daemon
33463 (@pxref{Invoking guix-daemon}):
33464
33465 @lisp
33466 (define guix-service-type
33467 (service-type
33468 (name 'guix)
33469 (extensions
33470 (list (service-extension shepherd-root-service-type guix-shepherd-service)
33471 (service-extension account-service-type guix-accounts)
33472 (service-extension activation-service-type guix-activation)))
33473 (default-value (guix-configuration))))
33474 @end lisp
33475
33476 @noindent
33477 It defines three things:
33478
33479 @enumerate
33480 @item
33481 A name, whose sole purpose is to make inspection and debugging easier.
33482
33483 @item
33484 A list of @dfn{service extensions}, where each extension designates the
33485 target service type and a procedure that, given the parameters of the
33486 service, returns a list of objects to extend the service of that type.
33487
33488 Every service type has at least one service extension. The only
33489 exception is the @dfn{boot service type}, which is the ultimate service.
33490
33491 @item
33492 Optionally, a default value for instances of this type.
33493 @end enumerate
33494
33495 In this example, @code{guix-service-type} extends three services:
33496
33497 @table @code
33498 @item shepherd-root-service-type
33499 The @code{guix-shepherd-service} procedure defines how the Shepherd
33500 service is extended. Namely, it returns a @code{<shepherd-service>}
33501 object that defines how @command{guix-daemon} is started and stopped
33502 (@pxref{Shepherd Services}).
33503
33504 @item account-service-type
33505 This extension for this service is computed by @code{guix-accounts},
33506 which returns a list of @code{user-group} and @code{user-account}
33507 objects representing the build user accounts (@pxref{Invoking
33508 guix-daemon}).
33509
33510 @item activation-service-type
33511 Here @code{guix-activation} is a procedure that returns a gexp, which is
33512 a code snippet to run at ``activation time''---e.g., when the service is
33513 booted.
33514 @end table
33515
33516 A service of this type is instantiated like this:
33517
33518 @lisp
33519 (service guix-service-type
33520 (guix-configuration
33521 (build-accounts 5)
33522 (extra-options '("--gc-keep-derivations"))))
33523 @end lisp
33524
33525 The second argument to the @code{service} form is a value representing
33526 the parameters of this specific service instance.
33527 @xref{guix-configuration-type, @code{guix-configuration}}, for
33528 information about the @code{guix-configuration} data type. When the
33529 value is omitted, the default value specified by
33530 @code{guix-service-type} is used:
33531
33532 @lisp
33533 (service guix-service-type)
33534 @end lisp
33535
33536 @code{guix-service-type} is quite simple because it extends other
33537 services but is not extensible itself.
33538
33539 @c @subsubsubsection Extensible Service Types
33540
33541 The service type for an @emph{extensible} service looks like this:
33542
33543 @lisp
33544 (define udev-service-type
33545 (service-type (name 'udev)
33546 (extensions
33547 (list (service-extension shepherd-root-service-type
33548 udev-shepherd-service)))
33549
33550 (compose concatenate) ;concatenate the list of rules
33551 (extend (lambda (config rules)
33552 (match config
33553 (($ <udev-configuration> udev initial-rules)
33554 (udev-configuration
33555 (udev udev) ;the udev package to use
33556 (rules (append initial-rules rules)))))))))
33557 @end lisp
33558
33559 This is the service type for the
33560 @uref{https://wiki.gentoo.org/wiki/Project:Eudev, eudev device
33561 management daemon}. Compared to the previous example, in addition to an
33562 extension of @code{shepherd-root-service-type}, we see two new fields:
33563
33564 @table @code
33565 @item compose
33566 This is the procedure to @dfn{compose} the list of extensions to
33567 services of this type.
33568
33569 Services can extend the udev service by passing it lists of rules; we
33570 compose those extensions simply by concatenating them.
33571
33572 @item extend
33573 This procedure defines how the value of the service is @dfn{extended} with
33574 the composition of the extensions.
33575
33576 Udev extensions are composed into a list of rules, but the udev service
33577 value is itself a @code{<udev-configuration>} record. So here, we
33578 extend that record by appending the list of rules it contains to the
33579 list of contributed rules.
33580
33581 @item description
33582 This is a string giving an overview of the service type. The string can
33583 contain Texinfo markup (@pxref{Overview,,, texinfo, GNU Texinfo}). The
33584 @command{guix system search} command searches these strings and displays
33585 them (@pxref{Invoking guix system}).
33586 @end table
33587
33588 There can be only one instance of an extensible service type such as
33589 @code{udev-service-type}. If there were more, the
33590 @code{service-extension} specifications would be ambiguous.
33591
33592 Still here? The next section provides a reference of the programming
33593 interface for services.
33594
33595 @node Service Reference
33596 @subsection Service Reference
33597
33598 We have seen an overview of service types (@pxref{Service Types and
33599 Services}). This section provides a reference on how to manipulate
33600 services and service types. This interface is provided by the
33601 @code{(gnu services)} module.
33602
33603 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} service @var{type} [@var{value}]
33604 Return a new service of @var{type}, a @code{<service-type>} object (see
33605 below). @var{value} can be any object; it represents the parameters of
33606 this particular service instance.
33607
33608 When @var{value} is omitted, the default value specified by @var{type}
33609 is used; if @var{type} does not specify a default value, an error is
33610 raised.
33611
33612 For instance, this:
33613
33614 @lisp
33615 (service openssh-service-type)
33616 @end lisp
33617
33618 @noindent
33619 is equivalent to this:
33620
33621 @lisp
33622 (service openssh-service-type
33623 (openssh-configuration))
33624 @end lisp
33625
33626 In both cases the result is an instance of @code{openssh-service-type}
33627 with the default configuration.
33628 @end deffn
33629
33630 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} service? @var{obj}
33631 Return true if @var{obj} is a service.
33632 @end deffn
33633
33634 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} service-kind @var{service}
33635 Return the type of @var{service}---i.e., a @code{<service-type>} object.
33636 @end deffn
33637
33638 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} service-value @var{service}
33639 Return the value associated with @var{service}. It represents its
33640 parameters.
33641 @end deffn
33642
33643 Here is an example of how a service is created and manipulated:
33644
33645 @lisp
33646 (define s
33647 (service nginx-service-type
33648 (nginx-configuration
33649 (nginx nginx)
33650 (log-directory log-directory)
33651 (run-directory run-directory)
33652 (file config-file))))
33653
33654 (service? s)
33655 @result{} #t
33656
33657 (eq? (service-kind s) nginx-service-type)
33658 @result{} #t
33659 @end lisp
33660
33661 The @code{modify-services} form provides a handy way to change the
33662 parameters of some of the services of a list such as
33663 @code{%base-services} (@pxref{Base Services, @code{%base-services}}). It
33664 evaluates to a list of services. Of course, you could always use
33665 standard list combinators such as @code{map} and @code{fold} to do that
33666 (@pxref{SRFI-1, List Library,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual});
33667 @code{modify-services} simply provides a more concise form for this
33668 common pattern.
33669
33670 @deffn {Scheme Syntax} modify-services @var{services} @
33671 (@var{type} @var{variable} => @var{body}) @dots{}
33672
33673 Modify the services listed in @var{services} according to the given
33674 clauses. Each clause has the form:
33675
33676 @example
33677 (@var{type} @var{variable} => @var{body})
33678 @end example
33679
33680 where @var{type} is a service type---e.g.,
33681 @code{guix-service-type}---and @var{variable} is an identifier that is
33682 bound within the @var{body} to the service parameters---e.g., a
33683 @code{guix-configuration} instance---of the original service of that
33684 @var{type}.
33685
33686 The @var{body} should evaluate to the new service parameters, which will
33687 be used to configure the new service. This new service will replace the
33688 original in the resulting list. Because a service's service parameters
33689 are created using @code{define-record-type*}, you can write a succinct
33690 @var{body} that evaluates to the new service parameters by using the
33691 @code{inherit} feature that @code{define-record-type*} provides.
33692
33693 @xref{Using the Configuration System}, for example usage.
33694
33695 @end deffn
33696
33697 Next comes the programming interface for service types. This is
33698 something you want to know when writing new service definitions, but not
33699 necessarily when simply looking for ways to customize your
33700 @code{operating-system} declaration.
33701
33702 @deftp {Data Type} service-type
33703 @cindex service type
33704 This is the representation of a @dfn{service type} (@pxref{Service Types
33705 and Services}).
33706
33707 @table @asis
33708 @item @code{name}
33709 This is a symbol, used only to simplify inspection and debugging.
33710
33711 @item @code{extensions}
33712 A non-empty list of @code{<service-extension>} objects (see below).
33713
33714 @item @code{compose} (default: @code{#f})
33715 If this is @code{#f}, then the service type denotes services that cannot
33716 be extended---i.e., services that do not receive ``values'' from other
33717 services.
33718
33719 Otherwise, it must be a one-argument procedure. The procedure is called
33720 by @code{fold-services} and is passed a list of values collected from
33721 extensions. It may return any single value.
33722
33723 @item @code{extend} (default: @code{#f})
33724 If this is @code{#f}, services of this type cannot be extended.
33725
33726 Otherwise, it must be a two-argument procedure: @code{fold-services}
33727 calls it, passing it the initial value of the service as the first
33728 argument and the result of applying @code{compose} to the extension
33729 values as the second argument. It must return a value that is a valid
33730 parameter value for the service instance.
33731
33732 @item @code{description}
33733 This is a string, possibly using Texinfo markup, describing in a couple
33734 of sentences what the service is about. This string allows users to
33735 find about the service through @command{guix system search}
33736 (@pxref{Invoking guix system}).
33737
33738 @item @code{default-value} (default: @code{&no-default-value})
33739 The default value associated for instances of this service type. This
33740 allows users to use the @code{service} form without its second argument:
33741
33742 @lisp
33743 (service @var{type})
33744 @end lisp
33745
33746 The returned service in this case has the default value specified by
33747 @var{type}.
33748 @end table
33749
33750 @xref{Service Types and Services}, for examples.
33751 @end deftp
33752
33753 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} service-extension @var{target-type} @
33754 @var{compute}
33755 Return a new extension for services of type @var{target-type}.
33756 @var{compute} must be a one-argument procedure: @code{fold-services}
33757 calls it, passing it the value associated with the service that provides
33758 the extension; it must return a valid value for the target service.
33759 @end deffn
33760
33761 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} service-extension? @var{obj}
33762 Return true if @var{obj} is a service extension.
33763 @end deffn
33764
33765 Occasionally, you might want to simply extend an existing service. This
33766 involves creating a new service type and specifying the extension of
33767 interest, which can be verbose; the @code{simple-service} procedure
33768 provides a shorthand for this.
33769
33770 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} simple-service @var{name} @var{target} @var{value}
33771 Return a service that extends @var{target} with @var{value}. This works
33772 by creating a singleton service type @var{name}, of which the returned
33773 service is an instance.
33774
33775 For example, this extends mcron (@pxref{Scheduled Job Execution}) with
33776 an additional job:
33777
33778 @lisp
33779 (simple-service 'my-mcron-job mcron-service-type
33780 #~(job '(next-hour (3)) "guix gc -F 2G"))
33781 @end lisp
33782 @end deffn
33783
33784 At the core of the service abstraction lies the @code{fold-services}
33785 procedure, which is responsible for ``compiling'' a list of services
33786 down to a single directory that contains everything needed to boot and
33787 run the system---the directory shown by the @command{guix system build}
33788 command (@pxref{Invoking guix system}). In essence, it propagates
33789 service extensions down the service graph, updating each node parameters
33790 on the way, until it reaches the root node.
33791
33792 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} fold-services @var{services} @
33793 [#:target-type @var{system-service-type}]
33794 Fold @var{services} by propagating their extensions down to the root of
33795 type @var{target-type}; return the root service adjusted accordingly.
33796 @end deffn
33797
33798 Lastly, the @code{(gnu services)} module also defines several essential
33799 service types, some of which are listed below.
33800
33801 @defvr {Scheme Variable} system-service-type
33802 This is the root of the service graph. It produces the system directory
33803 as returned by the @command{guix system build} command.
33804 @end defvr
33805
33806 @defvr {Scheme Variable} boot-service-type
33807 The type of the ``boot service'', which produces the @dfn{boot script}.
33808 The boot script is what the initial RAM disk runs when booting.
33809 @end defvr
33810
33811 @defvr {Scheme Variable} etc-service-type
33812 The type of the @file{/etc} service. This service is used to create
33813 files under @file{/etc} and can be extended by
33814 passing it name/file tuples such as:
33815
33816 @lisp
33817 (list `("issue" ,(plain-file "issue" "Welcome!\n")))
33818 @end lisp
33819
33820 In this example, the effect would be to add an @file{/etc/issue} file
33821 pointing to the given file.
33822 @end defvr
33823
33824 @defvr {Scheme Variable} setuid-program-service-type
33825 Type for the ``setuid-program service''. This service collects lists of
33826 executable file names, passed as gexps, and adds them to the set of
33827 setuid-root programs on the system (@pxref{Setuid Programs}).
33828 @end defvr
33829
33830 @defvr {Scheme Variable} profile-service-type
33831 Type of the service that populates the @dfn{system profile}---i.e., the
33832 programs under @file{/run/current-system/profile}. Other services can
33833 extend it by passing it lists of packages to add to the system profile.
33834 @end defvr
33835
33836 @cindex provenance tracking, of the operating system
33837 @anchor{provenance-service-type}
33838 @defvr {Scheme Variable} provenance-service-type
33839 This is the type of the service that records @dfn{provenance meta-data}
33840 in the system itself. It creates several files under
33841 @file{/run/current-system}:
33842
33843 @table @file
33844 @item channels.scm
33845 This is a ``channel file'' that can be passed to @command{guix pull -C}
33846 or @command{guix time-machine -C}, and which describes the channels used
33847 to build the system, if that information was available
33848 (@pxref{Channels}).
33849
33850 @item configuration.scm
33851 This is the file that was passed as the value for this
33852 @code{provenance-service-type} service. By default, @command{guix
33853 system reconfigure} automatically passes the OS configuration file it
33854 received on the command line.
33855
33856 @item provenance
33857 This contains the same information as the two other files but in a
33858 format that is more readily processable.
33859 @end table
33860
33861 In general, these two pieces of information (channels and configuration
33862 file) are enough to reproduce the operating system ``from source''.
33863
33864 @quotation Caveats
33865 This information is necessary to rebuild your operating system, but it
33866 is not always sufficient. In particular, @file{configuration.scm}
33867 itself is insufficient if it is not self-contained---if it refers to
33868 external Guile modules or to extra files. If you want
33869 @file{configuration.scm} to be self-contained, we recommend that modules
33870 or files it refers to be part of a channel.
33871
33872 Besides, provenance meta-data is ``silent'' in the sense that it does
33873 not change the bits contained in your system, @emph{except for the
33874 meta-data bits themselves}. Two different OS configurations or sets of
33875 channels can lead to the same system, bit-for-bit; when
33876 @code{provenance-service-type} is used, these two systems will have
33877 different meta-data and thus different store file names, which makes
33878 comparison less trivial.
33879 @end quotation
33880
33881 This service is automatically added to your operating system
33882 configuration when you use @command{guix system reconfigure},
33883 @command{guix system init}, or @command{guix deploy}.
33884 @end defvr
33885
33886 @node Shepherd Services
33887 @subsection Shepherd Services
33888
33889 @cindex shepherd services
33890 @cindex PID 1
33891 @cindex init system
33892 The @code{(gnu services shepherd)} module provides a way to define
33893 services managed by the GNU@tie{}Shepherd, which is the
33894 initialization system---the first process that is started when the
33895 system boots, also known as PID@tie{}1
33896 (@pxref{Introduction,,, shepherd, The GNU Shepherd Manual}).
33897
33898 Services in the Shepherd can depend on each other. For instance, the
33899 SSH daemon may need to be started after the syslog daemon has been
33900 started, which in turn can only happen once all the file systems have
33901 been mounted. The simple operating system defined earlier (@pxref{Using
33902 the Configuration System}) results in a service graph like this:
33903
33904 @image{images/shepherd-graph,,5in,Typical shepherd service graph.}
33905
33906 You can actually generate such a graph for any operating system
33907 definition using the @command{guix system shepherd-graph} command
33908 (@pxref{system-shepherd-graph, @command{guix system shepherd-graph}}).
33909
33910 The @code{%shepherd-root-service} is a service object representing
33911 PID@tie{}1, of type @code{shepherd-root-service-type}; it can be extended
33912 by passing it lists of @code{<shepherd-service>} objects.
33913
33914 @deftp {Data Type} shepherd-service
33915 The data type representing a service managed by the Shepherd.
33916
33917 @table @asis
33918 @item @code{provision}
33919 This is a list of symbols denoting what the service provides.
33920
33921 These are the names that may be passed to @command{herd start},
33922 @command{herd status}, and similar commands (@pxref{Invoking herd,,,
33923 shepherd, The GNU Shepherd Manual}). @xref{Slots of services, the
33924 @code{provides} slot,, shepherd, The GNU Shepherd Manual}, for details.
33925
33926 @item @code{requirement} (default: @code{'()})
33927 List of symbols denoting the Shepherd services this one depends on.
33928
33929 @cindex one-shot services, for the Shepherd
33930 @item @code{one-shot?} (default: @code{#f})
33931 Whether this service is @dfn{one-shot}. One-shot services stop immediately
33932 after their @code{start} action has completed. @xref{Slots of services,,,
33933 shepherd, The GNU Shepherd Manual}, for more info.
33934
33935 @item @code{respawn?} (default: @code{#t})
33936 Whether to restart the service when it stops, for instance when the
33937 underlying process dies.
33938
33939 @item @code{start}
33940 @itemx @code{stop} (default: @code{#~(const #f)})
33941 The @code{start} and @code{stop} fields refer to the Shepherd's
33942 facilities to start and stop processes (@pxref{Service De- and
33943 Constructors,,, shepherd, The GNU Shepherd Manual}). They are given as
33944 G-expressions that get expanded in the Shepherd configuration file
33945 (@pxref{G-Expressions}).
33946
33947 @item @code{actions} (default: @code{'()})
33948 @cindex actions, of Shepherd services
33949 This is a list of @code{shepherd-action} objects (see below) defining
33950 @dfn{actions} supported by the service, in addition to the standard
33951 @code{start} and @code{stop} actions. Actions listed here become available as
33952 @command{herd} sub-commands:
33953
33954 @example
33955 herd @var{action} @var{service} [@var{arguments}@dots{}]
33956 @end example
33957
33958 @item @code{auto-start?} (default: @code{#t})
33959 Whether this service should be started automatically by the Shepherd. If it
33960 is @code{#f} the service has to be started manually with @code{herd start}.
33961
33962 @item @code{documentation}
33963 A documentation string, as shown when running:
33964
33965 @example
33966 herd doc @var{service-name}
33967 @end example
33968
33969 where @var{service-name} is one of the symbols in @code{provision}
33970 (@pxref{Invoking herd,,, shepherd, The GNU Shepherd Manual}).
33971
33972 @item @code{modules} (default: @code{%default-modules})
33973 This is the list of modules that must be in scope when @code{start} and
33974 @code{stop} are evaluated.
33975
33976 @end table
33977 @end deftp
33978
33979 @deftp {Data Type} shepherd-action
33980 This is the data type that defines additional actions implemented by a
33981 Shepherd service (see above).
33982
33983 @table @code
33984 @item name
33985 Symbol naming the action.
33986
33987 @item documentation
33988 This is a documentation string for the action. It can be viewed by running:
33989
33990 @example
33991 herd doc @var{service} action @var{action}
33992 @end example
33993
33994 @item procedure
33995 This should be a gexp that evaluates to a procedure of at least one argument,
33996 which is the ``running value'' of the service (@pxref{Slots of services,,,
33997 shepherd, The GNU Shepherd Manual}).
33998 @end table
33999
34000 The following example defines an action called @code{say-hello} that kindly
34001 greets the user:
34002
34003 @lisp
34004 (shepherd-action
34005 (name 'say-hello)
34006 (documentation "Say hi!")
34007 (procedure #~(lambda (running . args)
34008 (format #t "Hello, friend! arguments: ~s\n"
34009 args)
34010 #t)))
34011 @end lisp
34012
34013 Assuming this action is added to the @code{example} service, then you can do:
34014
34015 @example
34016 # herd say-hello example
34017 Hello, friend! arguments: ()
34018 # herd say-hello example a b c
34019 Hello, friend! arguments: ("a" "b" "c")
34020 @end example
34021
34022 This, as you can see, is a fairly sophisticated way to say hello.
34023 @xref{Service Convenience,,, shepherd, The GNU Shepherd Manual}, for more
34024 info on actions.
34025 @end deftp
34026
34027 @defvr {Scheme Variable} shepherd-root-service-type
34028 The service type for the Shepherd ``root service''---i.e., PID@tie{}1.
34029
34030 This is the service type that extensions target when they want to create
34031 shepherd services (@pxref{Service Types and Services}, for an example).
34032 Each extension must pass a list of @code{<shepherd-service>}. Its
34033 value must be a @code{shepherd-configuration}, as described below.
34034 @end defvr
34035
34036 @deftp {Data Type} shepherd-configuration
34037 This data type represents the Shepherd's configuration.
34038
34039 @table @code
34040 @item shepherd (default: @code{shepherd})
34041 The Shepherd package to use.
34042
34043 @item services (default: @code{'()})
34044 A list of @code{<shepherd-service>} to start.
34045 You should probably use the service extension
34046 mechanism instead (@pxref{Shepherd Services}).
34047 @end table
34048 @end deftp
34049
34050 The following example specifies the Shepherd package for the operating
34051 system:
34052
34053 @lisp
34054 (operating-system
34055 ;; ...
34056 (services (append (list openssh-service-type))
34057 ;; ...
34058 %desktop-services)
34059 ;; ...
34060 ;; Use own Shepherd package.
34061 (essential-services
34062 (modify-services (operating-system-default-essential-services
34063 this-operating-system)
34064 (shepherd-root-service-type config => (shepherd-configuration
34065 (inherit config)
34066 (shepherd my-shepherd))))))
34067 @end lisp
34068
34069 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %shepherd-root-service
34070 This service represents PID@tie{}1.
34071 @end defvr
34072
34073
34074 @node Documentation
34075 @chapter Documentation
34076
34077 @cindex documentation, searching for
34078 @cindex searching for documentation
34079 @cindex Info, documentation format
34080 @cindex man pages
34081 @cindex manual pages
34082 In most cases packages installed with Guix come with documentation.
34083 There are two main documentation formats: ``Info'', a browseable
34084 hypertext format used for GNU software, and ``manual pages'' (or ``man
34085 pages''), the linear documentation format traditionally found on Unix.
34086 Info manuals are accessed with the @command{info} command or with Emacs,
34087 and man pages are accessed using @command{man}.
34088
34089 You can look for documentation of software installed on your system by
34090 keyword. For example, the following command searches for information
34091 about ``TLS'' in Info manuals:
34092
34093 @example
34094 $ info -k TLS
34095 "(emacs)Network Security" -- STARTTLS
34096 "(emacs)Network Security" -- TLS
34097 "(gnutls)Core TLS API" -- gnutls_certificate_set_verify_flags
34098 "(gnutls)Core TLS API" -- gnutls_certificate_set_verify_function
34099 @dots{}
34100 @end example
34101
34102 @noindent
34103 The command below searches for the same keyword in man pages:
34104
34105 @example
34106 $ man -k TLS
34107 SSL (7) - OpenSSL SSL/TLS library
34108 certtool (1) - GnuTLS certificate tool
34109 @dots {}
34110 @end example
34111
34112 These searches are purely local to your computer so you have the
34113 guarantee that documentation you find corresponds to what you have
34114 actually installed, you can access it off-line, and your privacy is
34115 respected.
34116
34117 Once you have these results, you can view the relevant documentation by
34118 running, say:
34119
34120 @example
34121 $ info "(gnutls)Core TLS API"
34122 @end example
34123
34124 @noindent
34125 or:
34126
34127 @example
34128 $ man certtool
34129 @end example
34130
34131 Info manuals contain sections and indices as well as hyperlinks like
34132 those found in Web pages. The @command{info} reader (@pxref{Top, Info
34133 reader,, info-stnd, Stand-alone GNU Info}) and its Emacs counterpart
34134 (@pxref{Misc Help,,, emacs, The GNU Emacs Manual}) provide intuitive key
34135 bindings to navigate manuals. @xref{Getting Started,,, info, Info: An
34136 Introduction}, for an introduction to Info navigation.
34137
34138 @node Installing Debugging Files
34139 @chapter Installing Debugging Files
34140
34141 @cindex debugging files
34142 Program binaries, as produced by the GCC compilers for instance, are
34143 typically written in the ELF format, with a section containing
34144 @dfn{debugging information}. Debugging information is what allows the
34145 debugger, GDB, to map binary code to source code; it is required to
34146 debug a compiled program in good conditions.
34147
34148 This chapter explains how to use separate debug info when packages
34149 provide it, and how to rebuild packages with debug info when it's
34150 missing.
34151
34152 @menu
34153 * Separate Debug Info:: Installing 'debug' outputs.
34154 * Rebuilding Debug Info:: Building missing debug info.
34155 @end menu
34156
34157 @node Separate Debug Info
34158 @section Separate Debug Info
34159
34160 The problem with debugging information is that is takes up a fair amount
34161 of disk space. For example, debugging information for the GNU C Library
34162 weighs in at more than 60 MiB@. Thus, as a user, keeping all the
34163 debugging info of all the installed programs is usually not an option.
34164 Yet, space savings should not come at the cost of an impediment to
34165 debugging---especially in the GNU system, which should make it easier
34166 for users to exert their computing freedom (@pxref{GNU Distribution}).
34167
34168 Thankfully, the GNU Binary Utilities (Binutils) and GDB provide a
34169 mechanism that allows users to get the best of both worlds: debugging
34170 information can be stripped from the binaries and stored in separate
34171 files. GDB is then able to load debugging information from those files,
34172 when they are available (@pxref{Separate Debug Files,,, gdb, Debugging
34173 with GDB}).
34174
34175 The GNU distribution takes advantage of this by storing debugging
34176 information in the @code{lib/debug} sub-directory of a separate package
34177 output unimaginatively called @code{debug} (@pxref{Packages with
34178 Multiple Outputs}). Users can choose to install the @code{debug} output
34179 of a package when they need it. For instance, the following command
34180 installs the debugging information for the GNU C Library and for GNU
34181 Guile:
34182
34183 @example
34184 guix install glibc:debug guile:debug
34185 @end example
34186
34187 GDB must then be told to look for debug files in the user's profile, by
34188 setting the @code{debug-file-directory} variable (consider setting it
34189 from the @file{~/.gdbinit} file, @pxref{Startup,,, gdb, Debugging with
34190 GDB}):
34191
34192 @example
34193 (gdb) set debug-file-directory ~/.guix-profile/lib/debug
34194 @end example
34195
34196 From there on, GDB will pick up debugging information from the
34197 @file{.debug} files under @file{~/.guix-profile/lib/debug}.
34198
34199 In addition, you will most likely want GDB to be able to show the source
34200 code being debugged. To do that, you will have to unpack the source
34201 code of the package of interest (obtained with @code{guix build
34202 --source}, @pxref{Invoking guix build}), and to point GDB to that source
34203 directory using the @code{directory} command (@pxref{Source Path,
34204 @code{directory},, gdb, Debugging with GDB}).
34205
34206 @c XXX: keep me up-to-date
34207 The @code{debug} output mechanism in Guix is implemented by the
34208 @code{gnu-build-system} (@pxref{Build Systems}). Currently, it is
34209 opt-in---debugging information is available only for the packages with
34210 definitions explicitly declaring a @code{debug} output. To check
34211 whether a package has a @code{debug} output, use @command{guix package
34212 --list-available} (@pxref{Invoking guix package}).
34213
34214 Read on for how to deal with packages lacking a @code{debug} output.
34215
34216 @node Rebuilding Debug Info
34217 @section Rebuilding Debug Info
34218
34219 @cindex debugging info, rebuilding
34220 As we saw above, some packages, but not all, provide debugging info in a
34221 @code{debug} output. What can you do when debugging info is missing?
34222 The @option{--with-debug-info} option provides a solution to that: it
34223 allows you to rebuild the package(s) for which debugging info is
34224 missing---and only those---and to graft those onto the application
34225 you're debugging. Thus, while it's not as fast as installing a
34226 @code{debug} output, it is relatively inexpensive.
34227
34228 Let's illustrate that. Suppose you're experiencing a bug in Inkscape
34229 and would like to see what's going on in GLib, a library that's deep
34230 down in its dependency graph. As it turns out, GLib does not have a
34231 @code{debug} output and the backtrace GDB shows is all sadness:
34232
34233 @example
34234 (gdb) bt
34235 #0 0x00007ffff5f92190 in g_getenv ()
34236 from /gnu/store/@dots{}-glib-2.62.6/lib/libglib-2.0.so.0
34237 #1 0x00007ffff608a7d6 in gobject_init_ctor ()
34238 from /gnu/store/@dots{}-glib-2.62.6/lib/libgobject-2.0.so.0
34239 #2 0x00007ffff7fe275a in call_init (l=<optimized out>, argc=argc@@entry=1, argv=argv@@entry=0x7fffffffcfd8,
34240 env=env@@entry=0x7fffffffcfe8) at dl-init.c:72
34241 #3 0x00007ffff7fe2866 in call_init (env=0x7fffffffcfe8, argv=0x7fffffffcfd8, argc=1, l=<optimized out>)
34242 at dl-init.c:118
34243 @end example
34244
34245 To address that, you install Inkscape linked against a variant GLib that
34246 contains debug info:
34247
34248 @example
34249 guix install inkscape --with-debug-info=glib
34250 @end example
34251
34252 This time, debugging will be a whole lot nicer:
34253
34254 @example
34255 $ gdb --args sh -c 'exec inkscape'
34256 @dots{}
34257 (gdb) b g_getenv
34258 Function "g_getenv" not defined.
34259 Make breakpoint pending on future shared library load? (y or [n]) y
34260 Breakpoint 1 (g_getenv) pending.
34261 (gdb) r
34262 Starting program: /gnu/store/@dots{}-profile/bin/sh -c exec\ inkscape
34263 @dots{}
34264 (gdb) bt
34265 #0 g_getenv (variable=variable@@entry=0x7ffff60c7a2e "GOBJECT_DEBUG") at ../glib-2.62.6/glib/genviron.c:252
34266 #1 0x00007ffff608a7d6 in gobject_init () at ../glib-2.62.6/gobject/gtype.c:4380
34267 #2 gobject_init_ctor () at ../glib-2.62.6/gobject/gtype.c:4493
34268 #3 0x00007ffff7fe275a in call_init (l=<optimized out>, argc=argc@@entry=3, argv=argv@@entry=0x7fffffffd088,
34269 env=env@@entry=0x7fffffffd0a8) at dl-init.c:72
34270 @dots{}
34271 @end example
34272
34273 Much better!
34274
34275 Note that there can be packages for which @option{--with-debug-info}
34276 will not have the desired effect. @xref{Package Transformation Options,
34277 @option{--with-debug-info}}, for more information.
34278
34279 @node Security Updates
34280 @chapter Security Updates
34281
34282 @cindex security updates
34283 @cindex security vulnerabilities
34284 Occasionally, important security vulnerabilities are discovered in software
34285 packages and must be patched. Guix developers try hard to keep track of
34286 known vulnerabilities and to apply fixes as soon as possible in the
34287 @code{master} branch of Guix (we do not yet provide a ``stable'' branch
34288 containing only security updates). The @command{guix lint} tool helps
34289 developers find out about vulnerable versions of software packages in the
34290 distribution:
34291
34292 @smallexample
34293 $ guix lint -c cve
34294 gnu/packages/base.scm:652:2: glibc@@2.21: probably vulnerable to CVE-2015-1781, CVE-2015-7547
34295 gnu/packages/gcc.scm:334:2: gcc@@4.9.3: probably vulnerable to CVE-2015-5276
34296 gnu/packages/image.scm:312:2: openjpeg@@2.1.0: probably vulnerable to CVE-2016-1923, CVE-2016-1924
34297 @dots{}
34298 @end smallexample
34299
34300 @xref{Invoking guix lint}, for more information.
34301
34302 Guix follows a functional
34303 package management discipline (@pxref{Introduction}), which implies
34304 that, when a package is changed, @emph{every package that depends on it}
34305 must be rebuilt. This can significantly slow down the deployment of
34306 fixes in core packages such as libc or Bash, since basically the whole
34307 distribution would need to be rebuilt. Using pre-built binaries helps
34308 (@pxref{Substitutes}), but deployment may still take more time than
34309 desired.
34310
34311 @cindex grafts
34312 To address this, Guix implements @dfn{grafts}, a mechanism that allows
34313 for fast deployment of critical updates without the costs associated
34314 with a whole-distribution rebuild. The idea is to rebuild only the
34315 package that needs to be patched, and then to ``graft'' it onto packages
34316 explicitly installed by the user and that were previously referring to
34317 the original package. The cost of grafting is typically very low, and
34318 order of magnitudes lower than a full rebuild of the dependency chain.
34319
34320 @cindex replacements of packages, for grafts
34321 For instance, suppose a security update needs to be applied to Bash.
34322 Guix developers will provide a package definition for the ``fixed''
34323 Bash, say @code{bash-fixed}, in the usual way (@pxref{Defining
34324 Packages}). Then, the original package definition is augmented with a
34325 @code{replacement} field pointing to the package containing the bug fix:
34326
34327 @lisp
34328 (define bash
34329 (package
34330 (name "bash")
34331 ;; @dots{}
34332 (replacement bash-fixed)))
34333 @end lisp
34334
34335 From there on, any package depending directly or indirectly on Bash---as
34336 reported by @command{guix gc --requisites} (@pxref{Invoking guix
34337 gc})---that is installed is automatically ``rewritten'' to refer to
34338 @code{bash-fixed} instead of @code{bash}. This grafting process takes
34339 time proportional to the size of the package, usually less than a
34340 minute for an ``average'' package on a recent machine. Grafting is
34341 recursive: when an indirect dependency requires grafting, then grafting
34342 ``propagates'' up to the package that the user is installing.
34343
34344 Currently, the length of the name and version of the graft and that of
34345 the package it replaces (@code{bash-fixed} and @code{bash} in the example
34346 above) must be equal. This restriction mostly comes from the fact that
34347 grafting works by patching files, including binary files, directly.
34348 Other restrictions may apply: for instance, when adding a graft to a
34349 package providing a shared library, the original shared library and its
34350 replacement must have the same @code{SONAME} and be binary-compatible.
34351
34352 The @option{--no-grafts} command-line option allows you to forcefully
34353 avoid grafting (@pxref{Common Build Options, @option{--no-grafts}}).
34354 Thus, the command:
34355
34356 @example
34357 guix build bash --no-grafts
34358 @end example
34359
34360 @noindent
34361 returns the store file name of the original Bash, whereas:
34362
34363 @example
34364 guix build bash
34365 @end example
34366
34367 @noindent
34368 returns the store file name of the ``fixed'', replacement Bash. This
34369 allows you to distinguish between the two variants of Bash.
34370
34371 To verify which Bash your whole profile refers to, you can run
34372 (@pxref{Invoking guix gc}):
34373
34374 @example
34375 guix gc -R `readlink -f ~/.guix-profile` | grep bash
34376 @end example
34377
34378 @noindent
34379 @dots{} and compare the store file names that you get with those above.
34380 Likewise for a complete Guix system generation:
34381
34382 @example
34383 guix gc -R `guix system build my-config.scm` | grep bash
34384 @end example
34385
34386 Lastly, to check which Bash running processes are using, you can use the
34387 @command{lsof} command:
34388
34389 @example
34390 lsof | grep /gnu/store/.*bash
34391 @end example
34392
34393
34394 @node Bootstrapping
34395 @chapter Bootstrapping
34396
34397 @c Adapted from the ELS 2013 paper.
34398
34399 @cindex bootstrapping
34400
34401 Bootstrapping in our context refers to how the distribution gets built
34402 ``from nothing''. Remember that the build environment of a derivation
34403 contains nothing but its declared inputs (@pxref{Introduction}). So
34404 there's an obvious chicken-and-egg problem: how does the first package
34405 get built? How does the first compiler get compiled?
34406
34407 It is tempting to think of this question as one that only die-hard
34408 hackers may care about. However, while the answer to that question is
34409 technical in nature, its implications are wide-ranging. How the
34410 distribution is bootstrapped defines the extent to which we, as
34411 individuals and as a collective of users and hackers, can trust the
34412 software we run. It is a central concern from the standpoint of
34413 @emph{security} and from a @emph{user freedom} viewpoint.
34414
34415 @cindex bootstrap binaries
34416 The GNU system is primarily made of C code, with libc at its core. The
34417 GNU build system itself assumes the availability of a Bourne shell and
34418 command-line tools provided by GNU Coreutils, Awk, Findutils, `sed', and
34419 `grep'. Furthermore, build programs---programs that run
34420 @code{./configure}, @code{make}, etc.---are written in Guile Scheme
34421 (@pxref{Derivations}). Consequently, to be able to build anything at
34422 all, from scratch, Guix relies on pre-built binaries of Guile, GCC,
34423 Binutils, libc, and the other packages mentioned above---the
34424 @dfn{bootstrap binaries}.
34425
34426 These bootstrap binaries are ``taken for granted'', though we can also
34427 re-create them if needed (@pxref{Preparing to Use the Bootstrap
34428 Binaries}).
34429
34430 @menu
34431 * Reduced Binary Seed Bootstrap:: A Bootstrap worthy of GNU.
34432 * Preparing to Use the Bootstrap Binaries:: Building that what matters most.
34433 @end menu
34434
34435 @node Reduced Binary Seed Bootstrap
34436 @section The Reduced Binary Seed Bootstrap
34437
34438 Guix---like other GNU/Linux distributions---is traditionally bootstrapped from
34439 a set of bootstrap binaries: Bourne shell, command-line tools provided by GNU
34440 Coreutils, Awk, Findutils, `sed', and `grep' and Guile, GCC, Binutils, and the
34441 GNU C Library (@pxref{Bootstrapping}). Usually, these bootstrap binaries are
34442 ``taken for granted.''
34443
34444 Taking the bootstrap binaries for granted means that we consider them to
34445 be a correct and trustworthy ``seed'' for building the complete system.
34446 Therein lies a problem: the combined size of these bootstrap binaries is
34447 about 250MB (@pxref{Bootstrappable Builds,,, mes, GNU Mes}). Auditing
34448 or even inspecting these is next to impossible.
34449
34450 For @code{i686-linux} and @code{x86_64-linux}, Guix now features a
34451 ``Reduced Binary Seed'' bootstrap @footnote{We would like to say: ``Full
34452 Source Bootstrap'' and while we are working towards that goal it would
34453 be hyperbole to use that term for what we do now.}.
34454
34455 The Reduced Binary Seed bootstrap removes the most critical tools---from a
34456 trust perspective---from the bootstrap binaries: GCC, Binutils and the GNU C
34457 Library are replaced by: @code{bootstrap-mescc-tools} (a tiny assembler and
34458 linker) and @code{bootstrap-mes} (a small Scheme Interpreter and a C compiler
34459 written in Scheme and the Mes C Library, built for TinyCC and for GCC).
34460
34461 Using these new binary seeds the ``missing'' Binutils, GCC, and the GNU
34462 C Library are built from source. From here on the more traditional
34463 bootstrap process resumes. This approach has reduced the bootstrap
34464 binaries in size to about 145MB in Guix v1.1.
34465
34466 The next step that Guix has taken is to replace the shell and all its
34467 utilities with implementations in Guile Scheme, the @emph{Scheme-only
34468 bootstrap}. Gash (@pxref{Gash,,, gash, The Gash manual}) is a
34469 POSIX-compatible shell that replaces Bash, and it comes with Gash Utils
34470 which has minimalist replacements for Awk, the GNU Core Utilities, Grep,
34471 Gzip, Sed, and Tar. The rest of the bootstrap binary seeds that were
34472 removed are now built from source.
34473
34474 Building the GNU System from source is currently only possibly by adding
34475 some historical GNU packages as intermediate steps@footnote{Packages
34476 such as @code{gcc-2.95.3}, @code{binutils-2.14}, @code{glibc-2.2.5},
34477 @code{gzip-1.2.4}, @code{tar-1.22}, and some others. For details, see
34478 @file{gnu/packages/commencement.scm}.}. As Gash and Gash Utils mature,
34479 and GNU packages become more bootstrappable again (e.g., new releases of
34480 GNU Sed will also ship as gzipped tarballs again, as alternative to the
34481 hard to bootstrap @code{xz}-compression), this set of added packages can
34482 hopefully be reduced again.
34483
34484 The graph below shows the resulting dependency graph for
34485 @code{gcc-core-mesboot0}, the bootstrap compiler used for the
34486 traditional bootstrap of the rest of the Guix System.
34487
34488 @c ./pre-inst-env guix graph -e '(@@ (gnu packages commencement) gcc-core-mesboot0)' | sed -re 's,((bootstrap-mescc-tools|bootstrap-mes|guile-bootstrap).*shape =) box,\1 ellipse,' > doc/images/gcc-core-mesboot0-graph.dot
34489 @image{images/gcc-core-mesboot0-graph,6in,,Dependency graph of gcc-core-mesboot0}
34490
34491 The only significant binary bootstrap seeds that remain@footnote{
34492 Ignoring the 68KB @code{mescc-tools}; that will be removed later,
34493 together with @code{mes}.} are a Scheme intepreter and a Scheme
34494 compiler: GNU Mes and GNU Guile@footnote{Not shown in this graph are the
34495 static binaries for @file{bash}, @code{tar}, and @code{xz} that are used
34496 to get Guile running.}.
34497
34498 This further reduction has brought down the size of the binary seed to
34499 about 60MB for @code{i686-linux} and @code{x86_64-linux}.
34500
34501 Work is ongoing to remove all binary blobs from our free software
34502 bootstrap stack, working towards a Full Source Bootstrap. Also ongoing
34503 is work to bring these bootstraps to the @code{arm-linux} and
34504 @code{aarch64-linux} architectures and to the Hurd.
34505
34506 If you are interested, join us on @samp{#bootstrappable} on the Freenode
34507 IRC network or discuss on @email{bug-mes@@gnu.org} or
34508 @email{gash-devel@@nongnu.org}.
34509
34510 @node Preparing to Use the Bootstrap Binaries
34511 @section Preparing to Use the Bootstrap Binaries
34512
34513 @c As of Emacs 24.3, Info-mode displays the image, but since it's a
34514 @c large image, it's hard to scroll. Oh well.
34515 @image{images/bootstrap-graph,6in,,Dependency graph of the early bootstrap derivations}
34516
34517 The figure above shows the very beginning of the dependency graph of the
34518 distribution, corresponding to the package definitions of the @code{(gnu
34519 packages bootstrap)} module. A similar figure can be generated with
34520 @command{guix graph} (@pxref{Invoking guix graph}), along the lines of:
34521
34522 @example
34523 guix graph -t derivation \
34524 -e '(@@@@ (gnu packages bootstrap) %bootstrap-gcc)' \
34525 | dot -Tps > gcc.ps
34526 @end example
34527
34528 or, for the further Reduced Binary Seed bootstrap
34529
34530 @example
34531 guix graph -t derivation \
34532 -e '(@@@@ (gnu packages bootstrap) %bootstrap-mes)' \
34533 | dot -Tps > mes.ps
34534 @end example
34535
34536 At this level of detail, things are
34537 slightly complex. First, Guile itself consists of an ELF executable,
34538 along with many source and compiled Scheme files that are dynamically
34539 loaded when it runs. This gets stored in the @file{guile-2.0.7.tar.xz}
34540 tarball shown in this graph. This tarball is part of Guix's ``source''
34541 distribution, and gets inserted into the store with @code{add-to-store}
34542 (@pxref{The Store}).
34543
34544 But how do we write a derivation that unpacks this tarball and adds it
34545 to the store? To solve this problem, the @code{guile-bootstrap-2.0.drv}
34546 derivation---the first one that gets built---uses @code{bash} as its
34547 builder, which runs @code{build-bootstrap-guile.sh}, which in turn calls
34548 @code{tar} to unpack the tarball. Thus, @file{bash}, @file{tar},
34549 @file{xz}, and @file{mkdir} are statically-linked binaries, also part of
34550 the Guix source distribution, whose sole purpose is to allow the Guile
34551 tarball to be unpacked.
34552
34553 Once @code{guile-bootstrap-2.0.drv} is built, we have a functioning
34554 Guile that can be used to run subsequent build programs. Its first task
34555 is to download tarballs containing the other pre-built binaries---this
34556 is what the @file{.tar.xz.drv} derivations do. Guix modules such as
34557 @code{ftp-client.scm} are used for this purpose. The
34558 @code{module-import.drv} derivations import those modules in a directory
34559 in the store, using the original layout. The
34560 @code{module-import-compiled.drv} derivations compile those modules, and
34561 write them in an output directory with the right layout. This
34562 corresponds to the @code{#:modules} argument of
34563 @code{build-expression->derivation} (@pxref{Derivations}).
34564
34565 Finally, the various tarballs are unpacked by the derivations
34566 @code{gcc-bootstrap-0.drv}, @code{glibc-bootstrap-0.drv}, or
34567 @code{bootstrap-mes-0.drv} and @code{bootstrap-mescc-tools-0.drv}, at which
34568 point we have a working C tool chain.
34569
34570 @unnumberedsec Building the Build Tools
34571
34572 Bootstrapping is complete when we have a full tool chain that does not
34573 depend on the pre-built bootstrap tools discussed above. This
34574 no-dependency requirement is verified by checking whether the files of
34575 the final tool chain contain references to the @file{/gnu/store}
34576 directories of the bootstrap inputs. The process that leads to this
34577 ``final'' tool chain is described by the package definitions found in
34578 the @code{(gnu packages commencement)} module.
34579
34580 The @command{guix graph} command allows us to ``zoom out'' compared to
34581 the graph above, by looking at the level of package objects instead of
34582 individual derivations---remember that a package may translate to
34583 several derivations, typically one derivation to download its source,
34584 one to build the Guile modules it needs, and one to actually build the
34585 package from source. The command:
34586
34587 @example
34588 guix graph -t bag \
34589 -e '(@@@@ (gnu packages commencement)
34590 glibc-final-with-bootstrap-bash)' | xdot -
34591 @end example
34592
34593 @noindent
34594 displays the dependency graph leading to the ``final'' C
34595 library@footnote{You may notice the @code{glibc-intermediate} label,
34596 suggesting that it is not @emph{quite} final, but as a good
34597 approximation, we will consider it final.}, depicted below.
34598
34599 @image{images/bootstrap-packages,6in,,Dependency graph of the early packages}
34600
34601 @c See <https://lists.gnu.org/archive/html/gnu-system-discuss/2012-10/msg00000.html>.
34602 The first tool that gets built with the bootstrap binaries is
34603 GNU@tie{}Make---noted @code{make-boot0} above---which is a prerequisite
34604 for all the following packages. From there Findutils and Diffutils get
34605 built.
34606
34607 Then come the first-stage Binutils and GCC, built as pseudo cross
34608 tools---i.e., with @option{--target} equal to @option{--host}. They are
34609 used to build libc. Thanks to this cross-build trick, this libc is
34610 guaranteed not to hold any reference to the initial tool chain.
34611
34612 From there the final Binutils and GCC (not shown above) are built. GCC
34613 uses @command{ld} from the final Binutils, and links programs against
34614 the just-built libc. This tool chain is used to build the other
34615 packages used by Guix and by the GNU Build System: Guile, Bash,
34616 Coreutils, etc.
34617
34618 And voilà! At this point we have the complete set of build tools that
34619 the GNU Build System expects. These are in the @code{%final-inputs}
34620 variable of the @code{(gnu packages commencement)} module, and are
34621 implicitly used by any package that uses @code{gnu-build-system}
34622 (@pxref{Build Systems, @code{gnu-build-system}}).
34623
34624
34625 @unnumberedsec Building the Bootstrap Binaries
34626
34627 @cindex bootstrap binaries
34628 Because the final tool chain does not depend on the bootstrap binaries,
34629 those rarely need to be updated. Nevertheless, it is useful to have an
34630 automated way to produce them, should an update occur, and this is what
34631 the @code{(gnu packages make-bootstrap)} module provides.
34632
34633 The following command builds the tarballs containing the bootstrap binaries
34634 (Binutils, GCC, glibc, for the traditional bootstrap and linux-libre-headers,
34635 bootstrap-mescc-tools, bootstrap-mes for the Reduced Binary Seed bootstrap,
34636 and Guile, and a tarball containing a mixture of Coreutils and other basic
34637 command-line tools):
34638
34639 @example
34640 guix build bootstrap-tarballs
34641 @end example
34642
34643 The generated tarballs are those that should be referred to in the
34644 @code{(gnu packages bootstrap)} module mentioned at the beginning of
34645 this section.
34646
34647 Still here? Then perhaps by now you've started to wonder: when do we
34648 reach a fixed point? That is an interesting question! The answer is
34649 unknown, but if you would like to investigate further (and have
34650 significant computational and storage resources to do so), then let us
34651 know.
34652
34653 @unnumberedsec Reducing the Set of Bootstrap Binaries
34654
34655 Our traditional bootstrap includes GCC, GNU Libc, Guile, etc. That's a lot of
34656 binary code! Why is that a problem? It's a problem because these big chunks
34657 of binary code are practically non-auditable, which makes it hard to establish
34658 what source code produced them. Every unauditable binary also leaves us
34659 vulnerable to compiler backdoors as described by Ken Thompson in the 1984
34660 paper @emph{Reflections on Trusting Trust}.
34661
34662 This is mitigated by the fact that our bootstrap binaries were generated
34663 from an earlier Guix revision. Nevertheless it lacks the level of
34664 transparency that we get in the rest of the package dependency graph,
34665 where Guix always gives us a source-to-binary mapping. Thus, our goal
34666 is to reduce the set of bootstrap binaries to the bare minimum.
34667
34668 The @uref{https://bootstrappable.org, Bootstrappable.org web site} lists
34669 on-going projects to do that. One of these is about replacing the
34670 bootstrap GCC with a sequence of assemblers, interpreters, and compilers
34671 of increasing complexity, which could be built from source starting from
34672 a simple and auditable assembler.
34673
34674 Our first major achievement is the replacement of of GCC, the GNU C Library
34675 and Binutils by MesCC-Tools (a simple hex linker and macro assembler) and Mes
34676 (@pxref{Top, GNU Mes Reference Manual,, mes, GNU Mes}, a Scheme interpreter
34677 and C compiler in Scheme). Neither MesCC-Tools nor Mes can be fully
34678 bootstrapped yet and thus we inject them as binary seeds. We call this the
34679 Reduced Binary Seed bootstrap, as it has halved the size of our bootstrap
34680 binaries! Also, it has eliminated the C compiler binary; i686-linux and
34681 x86_64-linux Guix packages are now bootstrapped without any binary C compiler.
34682
34683 Work is ongoing to make MesCC-Tools and Mes fully bootstrappable and we are
34684 also looking at any other bootstrap binaries. Your help is welcome!
34685
34686 @node Porting
34687 @chapter Porting to a New Platform
34688
34689 As discussed above, the GNU distribution is self-contained, and
34690 self-containment is achieved by relying on pre-built ``bootstrap
34691 binaries'' (@pxref{Bootstrapping}). These binaries are specific to an
34692 operating system kernel, CPU architecture, and application binary
34693 interface (ABI). Thus, to port the distribution to a platform that is
34694 not yet supported, one must build those bootstrap binaries, and update
34695 the @code{(gnu packages bootstrap)} module to use them on that platform.
34696
34697 Fortunately, Guix can @emph{cross compile} those bootstrap binaries.
34698 When everything goes well, and assuming the GNU tool chain supports the
34699 target platform, this can be as simple as running a command like this
34700 one:
34701
34702 @example
34703 guix build --target=armv5tel-linux-gnueabi bootstrap-tarballs
34704 @end example
34705
34706 For this to work, the @code{glibc-dynamic-linker} procedure in
34707 @code{(gnu packages bootstrap)} must be augmented to return the right
34708 file name for libc's dynamic linker on that platform; likewise,
34709 @code{system->linux-architecture} in @code{(gnu packages linux)} must be
34710 taught about the new platform.
34711
34712 Once these are built, the @code{(gnu packages bootstrap)} module needs
34713 to be updated to refer to these binaries on the target platform. That
34714 is, the hashes and URLs of the bootstrap tarballs for the new platform
34715 must be added alongside those of the currently supported platforms. The
34716 bootstrap Guile tarball is treated specially: it is expected to be
34717 available locally, and @file{gnu/local.mk} has rules to download it for
34718 the supported architectures; a rule for the new platform must be added
34719 as well.
34720
34721 In practice, there may be some complications. First, it may be that the
34722 extended GNU triplet that specifies an ABI (like the @code{eabi} suffix
34723 above) is not recognized by all the GNU tools. Typically, glibc
34724 recognizes some of these, whereas GCC uses an extra @option{--with-abi}
34725 configure flag (see @code{gcc.scm} for examples of how to handle this).
34726 Second, some of the required packages could fail to build for that
34727 platform. Lastly, the generated binaries could be broken for some
34728 reason.
34729
34730 @c *********************************************************************
34731 @include contributing.texi
34732
34733 @c *********************************************************************
34734 @node Acknowledgments
34735 @chapter Acknowledgments
34736
34737 Guix is based on the @uref{https://nixos.org/nix/, Nix package manager},
34738 which was designed and
34739 implemented by Eelco Dolstra, with contributions from other people (see
34740 the @file{nix/AUTHORS} file in Guix). Nix pioneered functional package
34741 management, and promoted unprecedented features, such as transactional
34742 package upgrades and rollbacks, per-user profiles, and referentially
34743 transparent build processes. Without this work, Guix would not exist.
34744
34745 The Nix-based software distributions, Nixpkgs and NixOS, have also been
34746 an inspiration for Guix.
34747
34748 GNU@tie{}Guix itself is a collective work with contributions from a
34749 number of people. See the @file{AUTHORS} file in Guix for more
34750 information on these fine people. The @file{THANKS} file lists people
34751 who have helped by reporting bugs, taking care of the infrastructure,
34752 providing artwork and themes, making suggestions, and more---thank you!
34753
34754
34755 @c *********************************************************************
34756 @node GNU Free Documentation License
34757 @appendix GNU Free Documentation License
34758 @cindex license, GNU Free Documentation License
34759 @include fdl-1.3.texi
34760
34761 @c *********************************************************************
34762 @node Concept Index
34763 @unnumbered Concept Index
34764 @printindex cp
34765
34766 @node Programming Index
34767 @unnumbered Programming Index
34768 @syncodeindex tp fn
34769 @syncodeindex vr fn
34770 @printindex fn
34771
34772 @bye
34773
34774 @c Local Variables:
34775 @c ispell-local-dictionary: "american";
34776 @c End: